THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME : AND A COMPLETE ANALYSIS OP OUR AMERICAN SYSTEM OF GOVERNMENT, WITH A CONCISE HISTORY OF THE ORIGINAL COLONIES AND OF THE UNITED STATES, IN CHRONO- LOGICAL ORDER : FACTS AND STA- TISTICS FROM OFFICIAL SOURCES. By CHARLES BANCROFT. ■ • R. T. ROOT, PUBLISHER, BURLINGTON, IOWA. 1875. Entered according to Act of Congress, in the year 1874, By K. T. BOOT, In the office of the Librarian of Congress, at Washington, D. C. I • • . . . , . • • • ■ ••••• i ZHCo PREFACE. oo It is the object of this book to supply the means of forming an accurate idea of the American government. The author has adopted the proposition that the highest style of govern- ment is one " of the people, by the people, and for the people," and believes that a constant progress, commencing in the earli- est times, has reached its full development in the Great Re- public. He therefore traces The Footpkints of Time through all history; notes the gradual unfolding of institutions, the rise and fall of empires, the causes that produced and des- troyed the ancient republics, and the origin of the forces that o give so much more strength and stability to modern civiliza- tion. All this he considers essential to a correct appreciation [^of the wonderful events of our age and country. 00 He then proceeds to a close and clear analysis of the whole structure of the government. Each general division, with its sub-divisions, is examined in detail, but successively; so that a j definite picture of it, with all its branches, operations, and re- .0^ lations to other parts, stands before the mind as a sharply ^ defined whole. The Executive, Legislative, and Judicial divis- 7 ions — the dependent parts of each kept in proper place — •^ come in order, one after the other, before the mind, the struct- till better. It is plain that the general mind among us has grown clearer and more accurate in its judgments as experience has accumu- lated, for the original direction toward popular freedom has not changed. Various incongruities have been laid aside and oversights corrected, the severe strain of civil war and an un- heard of rapidity of growth have not shaken, but more clearly revealed the strength and unity of the nation. Yet, more in- telligence and more care would have saved us many shocks and made our success more pronounced and more brilliant. "Knowledge is power," when wisely applied; and a more accurate acquaintance with their government and its history will enable American Citizens to mould it more wisely still, to correct all defects of administration, and to speedily reach that minimum of governmental interference with the efforts and interests of the citizens which shall give them the fullest liberty consistent with security and surrender the whole round of human life, as completely as possible, to the beneficent action of natural law. C. B. CONTENTS PART FIRST. THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME, OR HISTORICAL PROGRESS. CHAPTER I. HISTORICAL PROGRESS IN THE OLD WORLD 29 Section I. The Dawn of History — Uncertainty of Tradition — Aid afforded by recent studies — Ethnology, Philology, etc. — Primitive Home of Mankind — The three great races — The first Migrations — Commencement of Civilization — China — The Euphrates — The Ham- ites in Egypt. Section II. Direction of Prehistoric Growth — Rudeness of early races — Character of the Primitive Man — Testimony of language — Imper- fection of Turanian Growth — Seen in China — Superiority of Indo- European races. Section III. Gradual Development — Condition of the first Men — Es- tablishment of the Family — Patriarchal Authority — The Growth of Monarchy — Origin of the Priesthood — Development of both in Chal- dea and Egypt — Influence of War and Commerce. Section IV. Ancient Monarchies — Five Monarchies on the Euphrates and Tigris — The Scythian, the two Hamitic, the Assyrian and the Medo-Persian Monarchies — Testimony of the ruins — Mysterious and Singular character of Egypt — Moses and the Jewish State — Tyre and its Commerce. Section V. The Grecian States — Origin, intelligence and vigor of the Greek race — Their Mythology and Heroic History — Their opposition to the dangerous centralizing tendencies of Monarchy — Greek Repub- lics — Colonization — Sparta and Athens — Commencement of Au- thentic History — Foundation of Rome — Chronological review during the time of the Roman Kings. Section VI. The Roman Republic— Character of the Romans — Greeks and Romans compared — Roman constancy. Section VII. Greece and Rome — The influence of each on the future of mankind —Chronological history from B. C. 500 to B. C. 133 — The great career of the Roman Republic. Section VIII. Decay of the Republic — Unhappy effects of conquest and wealth on Roman character — Death of the Gracchi — The Civil (11) |£ CONTENTS. Ware— Mariua, Bylla, Crassus, Pompey, Julius Ca?sar-The Senate Bnspendfl the Constitution and ends the Republic — Death of Caesar. Section IX The Roman Empire— Impossibility of restoring the Re- public— Triumvirate and wars of Augustus, Antony and Lepidus— Au- gustus Emperor of the World. Section X. Influence of Christianity — The Jewish State — Influence on it of Egypt, Asia and Greece — The New Morality of Christianity — The persecution it provokes — Its growing influence on life and man. ners _ Unhappy effect of state patronage. Section XI. The services of Great Men to Mankind — Difficulties of progress among the Ancients — Assistance rendered by Great Men- Office of early Poets — Of Legislatures — Philosophers, Socrates, Plato, Aristotle — Orators, Demosthenes and Cicero — Influence of Great con- querors on progress — Alexander the Great— Hannibal the unfortunate — Cresar. the successful— Brutus, the Patriot — Augustus the Emperor —The elements of greatness in all men — Jesus Christ the Perfect Man. Section XII. The Christian Era — Chronological history of the Emper- rors _The triumph of Christianity and its corruption — The fall of the Empire. Section XIII. Rise of Modern Nations — Incursions of Barbarians — Their settlement in Gaul — Spain, Africa, Italy and Britain — Mahomet and the great success of his followers — Charlemagne and the Popes — Failure to found a Western Empire. Section XIV. The Feudal System — Results from the condition of the Empire and the character of the invaders — Rise and character of Chiv- alry — The Crusades. - 1 < noN XV. The Liberties of the People — Influence of the Crusades— Revival of Commerce and Learning. Baci ion XVI. The Situation on the Discovery of America. Section XVII. Conclusion — Summary of Progress —The work assigned to America. CHAPTER II. Tin: DISCOVERY OF A.MEKICA 148 graphical ignorance of the Ancients — Columbus and his Ideas — His difficulty in netting a hearing — Queen Isabella of Spain — Sets sail for tin- New World — Why he thought it Asia — Origin of the name America. CHAPTER III. BIBTORT FROM L492 TO 1763 151 Various Discoveries — Sir Humphrey Gilbert fails twice to establish a Col- ony— Sir Walter Raleigh — Settlements in Florida — Jamestown — Land- i r i lt of the Puritans— Other Settlements — Liberal character of Colonial rmnents— Colonies resist oppression — Indian Wars — French Wars — Training they give the Colonies — Capture of Louisburg — Braddock's Defeat — Colonists as Soldiers. CONTENTS. 13 CHAPTER IV. HISTORY — ORIGIN OF THE REVOLUTION 162 British resolve to tax Colonies— Folly of that measure— Resistance in the Colonies— British repeal the tax, BUT CLAIM THE RIGHT— Indig- nation in the Colonies— Taxes again tried— Soldiers sent to Boston— "Boston Massacre "—Tax on Tea— Colonies Organize against it— "Bos- ton Tea Party"— Philadelphia— Boston Port Bill— First Congress— "American Association "—Battle of Lexington— Second Congress- Siege of Boston— Bunker Hill— British driven out— Battles in Canada. CHAPTER Y. FORMATION OF THE ORIGINAL UNION 1«3 History of the various stages of Union among the States— Adoption of the Articles of Confederation. CHAPTER VI. DECLARATION OF INDEPENDENCE 1«5 Noble character of this Document— It speaks for all men and all times— The Declaration. CHAPTER VII. • ARTICLES OF CONFEDERATION 181 Full text of the Articles adopted in 1777, forming the Constitution for 12 years. CHAPTER VIII. REVOLUTIONARY WAR FROM 1776 TO 1783 191 Battle of Long Island— Silent retreat at night— Washington driven across the Delaware— His success in the Jerseys— Battles near Philadelphia- Surrender of Burgoyne— Treaty with the French— French fleet— British evacuate Philadelphia— Washington's success again in the Jerseys- Southern War— Defeat of Gates— Treason of Arnold— Gen. Green and Corn wall is — Lafayette and Cornwallis — Surrender of Cornwallis at Yorktown — Review of the War — Financial Difficulties— Character of the People— Peace at Last ! CHAPTER IX. THE CONSTITUTION OF THE UNITED STATES 203 The Constitutional Convention of 1787-Defects of the Articles of Confed eration-Caution of Statesmen and the People-Result of the Conven- tion—Full text of the Constitution and Amendments. ] 4: CONTENTS. CHAPTER X. Till: l • 'M I IS BNTAL OONGE1 88 225 Names of Presidents of the Continental Congress— The various Seats of eminent from 1774 to 1789. PART SECOND. PAGE. THE GOVERNMENT UNDEK THE CONSTITUTION 226 The Three Branches of the Government— Arrangement of this Work — Excellence of the Organization— Comparison of the United States with Mexico— "With Ireland — Why it Juts prospered. THE EXECUTIVE DEPARTMENT. CHAPTER I. THE PRESIDENT 229 His place in the Government — He is its active force — Conditions of birth, age, and residence — How he is elected — His powers and duties — List of all the Presidents. CHAPTER II. THE VICE- PRESIDENT 234 Hi- position mainly honorary — His only duty — When he may become Presidents — List of Vice-Presidents. CHAPTER III. thi: cabinet 236 Number ami offices of members — Their duties — President's will supreme — Their means of aiding him — The character and ability required. CHAPTER IV. department of state 239 Title of el. id' officer— Conducts our Foreign business — Range of his duties— Qualifications required— Lists of Secretaries of State. CHAF3 ER V. f " " ■ - "iives in foreign lands 243 Thedignitj '■ Official Character— The immunities it confers — Am- Plenipotenti ! misters- Resident — Charge ioners— The high abilities required in Foreign CONTENTS. 1 5 CHAPTER VI. TREATIES — EXTRADITION TREATIES 246 Nature of a Treaty — Its binding power — Has the force of Law — The Rus- sian Treat)- in full — What Extradition Treaties are — What classes of criminals they apply to — Countries with which we have Extradition Treaties. CHAPTER VII. BUSINESS REPRESENTATIVES 256 Consuls and their duties — Their official character — Their number — Extra powers in Turkey, etc. CHAPTER VIII. PASSPORTS 258 Their character — Their protective power — Who give them. CHAPTER IX. DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY 260 Its importance — Secretary of the Treasury — Great extent of his depart- ment — Its thorough organization — The security of public funds — The various bureaus — List of Secretaries of the Treasury. CHAPTER X. THE FINANCIAL SYSTEM OF THE UNITED STATES 263 How government income is obtained — Duties— Internal Revenue —Differ- ence of views — Finance a study f< >r the people. CHAPTER XL DUTIES AND TARIFFS 266 Explanation of terms — Ease of raising revenue from Tariffs — Two kinds of Tariff— What is a Protective Tariff— Tonnage. CHAPTER XII. COLLECTION OF DUTIES 272 Custom Houses — Their number and location — Officers and their duties — Their compensation — Revenue Cutters — Ship's papers. CHAPTER XIII. GOVERNMENT COINAGE 278 The Mint — Relations to the United States Treasury— Artistic Bkill — Coins — Assay offices — Their relation to commerce and to individuals. J,; CONTENTS. CHAPTER XIV. NATIONAL BANKING 283 Relations of Currency to the Treasury— Government control of Banks and their issues — Security of Currency. CHAPTEE XV. HNANVIAL CONDITION OF THE UNITED STATES 286 it resources of the country- Aggregate wealth of the people- Resources of the general government — Public lands — Mines — National wealth— The National Debt— Reasons for not paying it at once— Table of Statistic*— Public Debt for every year— National Securities. CHAPTER XVI. WAR DEPARTMENT 291 Secretary of War — Organization of his department — Various Bureaus — List of Secretaries of War. CHAPTER XVII. THE U. S. ARMY 294 history shows great military ability — The peaceful policy of the country. CHAPTER XVIII. I HI MILITARY ACADEMY 295 [te object and location — The results secured. CHAPTER XIX. I'll' 'IS OF WAR MATEKTAI 298 Armories and Arsenals — Their uses — Location — Officers. ( HAPTER XX. A KTICLE8 OF WAR 299 iliar relations of military forces to civil government — Object of Arti- i lee of War — Range and vigor of their provisions. CHAPTER XXI. MILITARY HOSPITALS AND ASYLUMS 300 Their object— Their location— Their excellent management — Their success in the Civil War. CONTENTS. 17 CHAPTER XXII. NAVY DEPARTMENT 302 Secretary of the Navy — His duties — Various Bureaus — List of Secretaries of the Navy. CHAPTER XXIII. THE UNITED STATES NAVY 306 The U. S. a commercial country — Gratifying success of the early navy — The importance of this arm to the country — Its value to us abroad — Number of U. S. vessels of war. CHAPTER XXIV. NAVY YARDS 309 Their location and number — Materials and stores — Workshops and repairs. CHAPTER XXV. THE NAVAL ACADEMY 309 Its purposes, location and value. CHAPTER XXVI. THE NAVAL OBSERVATORY 311 Dependence of Navigation on Astronomical Science — Value of Obser- vatory. CHAPTER XXVII. COAST StJRVEY 312 Necessity of this work — Scientific accuracy — Value for commerce and defense. CHAPTER XXVIII. LIGHT HOUSES 314 Why and where they are built— Official Superintendence — Light Money. CHAPTER XXIX. LETTERS OF MARQUE AND REPRISAL 31b' Objects of Privateering— Immorality and injustice of it. CHAPTER XXX. NAVY AND MARINE HOSPITALS 318 The purpose of those institutions— Their means of support— Their location. 2 18 CONTENTS. CHAPTER XXXI. DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR 319 History of this department — Secretary of the Interior — Bureaus of the department — List of Secretaries. CHAPTER XXXII. PUBLIC LANDS 322 How the government obtained them — "What disposition is made of them — Land offices — Sale of Lands — Pre-emption — Bounty Lands — Home- steads — School Lands. CHAPTER XXXIII. HOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LANDS 326 Pre-emption Laws — Land Warrants — Soldiers' Homestead Laws — List of Land Offices. CHAPTER XXXIY. PATENTS 336 Patent office — Commissioner of Patents — Mode of obtaining a Patent. CHAPTER XXXV. PENSIONS 339 The object of Pensions — Pension office — Amount of Pensions — How paid — Pension Laws of various dates. CHAPTER XXXYI. INDIAN AFFAIRS 351 Aboriginal inhabitants— Mode of acquiring their lands— Indian Policy- Reservations — Annuities — Agents — Indian Territory — Condition and number of Indians — Their probable extinction. CHAPTER XXXVII. CEN8U8 BUREAU v 355 How the census is taken— Value of census statistics— Tables of Population. CHAPTER XXXVIII. DEPARTMENT OF AGRICULTURE 357 The objects of this department— Commissioner of Agriculture— Buildings and grounds— Extent of information collected and circulated — Value of this department. CONTENTS. 19 CHAPTER XXXIX. POST OFFICE DEPARTMENT 360 Postmaster General — Various Bureaus — Extent of organization — Its remarkable vigor and success— List of Postmasters General. CHAPTER XL. KATES OF POSTAGE ! 365 Letters— Papers— Packages— Foreign Rates. CHAPTER XLI. REGISTERED AND DEAD LETTERS 368 Security of registered letters— Certainty of finding the thief— Description of the whole process — Facts about dead letters. CHAPTER XLII. THE ATTORNEY GENERAL 372 Why he is a cabinet officer — Range of his duties. CHAPTER XLIII. PRESIDENTIAL ELECTORS 374: Object of the authors of the Constitution— Why Electors failed to meet their expectation— How they are elected and discharge their duties. CHAPTER XLIV. HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS FROM WASHINGTON TO GRANT 377 CHAPTER XLV. CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS , . 390 LEGISLATIVE DEPARTMENT. CHAPTER XLVI. CONGRESS 400 Careful separation of the different branches of government — Powers and duties of Congress — Organization and powers of the Senate — Of the House of Representatives. CHAPTER XLVII. CONGRESSIONAL DISTRICTS, CONGRESSMEN 405 Mode of electing Members of House of Representatives — Advantages of the district plan— Number of districts. 20 CONTENTS. CHAPTER XLVIII. CONGRESSIONAL LIBRARY 407 The objects of the Library— Who may use it — Duties of the Librarian. CHAPTEK XLIX. COPYRIGHTS f 408 The object ol Copyrights — Mode of applying for them — Fees — *\ill direc- tions Irom the Librarian of Congress. CHAFIER L. PRESIDING OFFICERS OF CONGRESS 411 Speaker of the House — How he is chosen — President of the Senate — Their duties and powers — List of all the Speakers oi the House. CHAPTEK LI. SUBORDINATE OFFICERS OF CONGRESS 414 Secretary of the Senate — Clerk of the House — Their duties — The Sergeant- atrArms — The Doorkeeper — The Postmaster. CHAPTER LIT. CONGRESSIONAL WORK 415 iloce oi doing business in Congress — Organization — Bills — Committees — Reports — Jonnection of two Houses — President's signature — Veto — Passing over the veto — Resolutions and their character — Amount of business done — Members of Congress and the People. CHAPTER LIII. PUBLIC FRTNTTNG 418 How it was formerly done — Changes made — People should inform them- selves. CHAPTER LIY. SIGNAL SERVICE 420 Origin of Signal Service — Scientific and useful character— Mode of con- ducting it — School of Instruction— Grades of officers— Their duties — Number of Stations— Smithsonian Institution— Its Origin, Objects and Value. CHAPTER LY. REPORTS 424 Mode of doing Legislative and Executive business— Reporta useful to fur- nish information— To facilitate business. CONTENTS. 21 CHAPTER LVI. IMPEACHMENTS 426 Who may bo impeached — House of Representatives the Accuser — Senate the Court. THE JUDICIAL DEPARTMENT 427 Importance of this Department in our System — Constitution ot the Depart- ment. CHAPTER LVII. THE 8UPREME COURT 428 The high range of its duties — Its original and appellate Jurisdiction — Its Judges— Their term of office — Officers of the Court — List of Supreme and Associate Justices. CHAPTER LYIII. CTRCuTT COURTS ^31 Their powers and uses — Circuits — Judges. CHARIER LIX. DISTRICT COURTS 434 Their : urisdiction — Appointment ot Judges — Number of districts — Places of holding. CHAPTER LX. ADMIRALTY AND MARITIME JURISDICTION 436 Confined to naval affairs— Belongs to District Courts. CHAPTER LX1. COURT OF CLAIMS ^7 Where it sits— Object to relieve Congress— Advantages to claimants against government. CHAPTER LXII. DISTRICT ATTORNEYS 439 Business confided to them — Government lawyers. CHAPTER LXIII. UNITED STATES MARSHALS 440 Where they are employed — Connection with census. 22 CONTENTS. CHAPTER LXIV. GRAND JURY 441 Admirable features of Grand Jury— Do not pronounce judgment— Security afforded to reputation. CHAPTER LXY. LOCAL GOVERNMENTS 444 General, State, County, and Municipal governments parts of a whole— No conflict— The harmonizing authority in the Supreme Court— How State governments are formed— Their powers— Modeled on the General Gov- ernment — Various Courts — Subdivisions — Counties — Towns — School districts — Minor divisions indispensable. CHAPTER LXYL INDIVIDUAL STATES 447 Circumstances of discovery of each — When and where settled — Facts in early history— The part each of the " Old Thirteen" bore in the Revolu- tionary struggle — The Surface — Climate — Agriculture— Products — Min- eral Wealth — Prosperity — Area — Population in 1870 — Circuit and Dis- trict Courts — Number of Representatives in Congress — Ports of entry and delivery — Capital — Time of holding elections — Time of meeting of Legislature — Form of enacting clause — Complete list of United States Senators from each State. THE STATES. PAGE. THE STATES. PAGE. Alabama 497 Mississippi 493 Arkansas 504 Missouri 501 Call fornia 515 Nebraska 526 Colorado .529 New Hampshire 467 Connecticut 473 New Jersey 469 Delaware; .475 New York 453 Florida 506 North Carolina 450 Georgia 448 Nevada 525 Illinois 495 Ohio .485 Indiana 490 Oregon 520 Iowa 508 Pennsylvania 456- Kansas 522 Rhode Island 477 Kentucky 481 South Carolina 462 Louisiana 487 Tennessee 483 Maine 499 Texas 511 Maryland 464 Vermont 479 Massachusetts 471 Virginia 459 Michigan 502 West Virginia 524 Minnesota 518 Wisconsin -518 CONTENTS. -j:> CHAPTER LXVII. MOTTOES AND NAMES OF THE STATES 531 Mottoes translated — Origin and meaning of name — Familiar name. CHAPTER LXVIII. THE NATIONAL DOMAIN 534 Publio domain after the Revolutionary War — Various acquisitions of ter- ritory by the General Government — Character of a Territorial govern- ment — Organized by Congress — Appointment of officers — Territorial Legislature — When a State may be formed — Constitution to be approved by Congress — Admission may be vetoed by the President. CHAPTER LXIX. INDIVIDUAL TERRITORIES 537 Discovery and early history of each — When organized — Surface — Climate Agricultural and mineral resources — Future prospects and desirableness as a location — Area — Population in 1870. TERRITORIES. PAGE. TERRITORIHS. PAGE. Al aska 547 Montana 546 Arizona 544 New Mexico 537 Dakotah 543 Washington 540 District of Columbia 549 Wyoming 548 Idaho 545 Utah 539 CHAPTER LXX. THE ANNEXATION POLICY , 550 Causes of increase of national area — A traditional policy — Importance of national unity — The Mexican War — Causes — Annexation of Territory — Excuses urged — We shall never do it again — Superior steadiness of American people — The probable future of annexation. CHAPTER LXXI. CENSUS STATISTICS 556 PART THIRD. THE PEOPLE AND THE GOVERNMENT. The government for the people alone — Early distrust of the masses and its causes — Embodied in the Federal party— Causes of its fall — Absorption of foreigners — Favorable results — Future of the people. 24 CONTENTS. CHAPTER I. SUFFRAGE AND CITIZENSHIP 562 Who are citizens— Advance in extent of suffrage— Who are voters— Citizens of States and of United States. CIIAPTEK II. CITIZENS OF FOREIGN BIRTH 564 Naturalization— Various steps in naturalization— Digest of laws. CHAPTER III. ELECTIONS 56T Who are entitled to vote for State officers — For United States officers — History of general elections — People obtain direct control. CHAPTER IV. RATIO OF REPRESENTATION 569 Changes with each census — Reason for it — Data— Present ratio and num- ber of Members of Congress. CHAPTER V. OATHS AND BONDS 574 Reasons for them — " Iron-clad oaths " — Who give bonds — Amount of bonds required. CHAPTER VI. GOVERNMENT PRISONS 577 Vigor of the government — Mildness in punishment — Why it owns no prisons. CHAPTER VII. PROCLAMATIONS 578 Who make them — Their significance. CHAPTER VIII. COMMISSIONERS 580 7arious classes of officers of this name. CHAPTER IX. OFFICIAL REGISTER 581 Officers and salaries — When published — Where obtained. CONTENTS. 25 CHAPTER X. THE UNITED STATES FLAG 582 Significance of the Flag— History of its origin— The "Star-Spangled Ban- ner " and Ft. McHenry. CHAPTER XL THE GREAT SEAL 585 Uses of Seals — How applied— Who keeps the Great Seal— History of the Great Seal— Jefferson, Adams, etc.— Failure of committees to please— Efforts of Secretary of Congress — Adams and the English Baronet — Description of the Seal. CHAPTER XII. THE ORIGIN OF LAW 588 Origin of law in various kinds of government— In the U. S. all law springs from the People — The fundamental law —Legislative acts — Laws by Treaty — Universal law. CHAPTER XIII. LAW OF NATIONS 591 Its origin— Standard authorities on International Law— How it is enforced —General features of Law of Nations— United States and England— A future Supreme Tribunal. CHAPTER XIY. RELATION OF U. S. GOVERNMENT TO RELIGION 594 Does not support religion — Shows respect to the sentiments of all its peo. pie — Consequent policy. CHAPTER XV. CHAPLAINS 596 Why employed— No sect preferred— Salaries— Where employed. CHAPTER XVI. COMPROMISES 598 Necessity of them from the commencement— Constitutional Compromise —Missouri Compromise of 1820 — Mason and Dixon's Line — Compro- mises of 1850— Their failure brings on the Civil War. CHAPTER XVII. Defined by the Constitution— The punishment inflicted TREASON , ""2 CONTENTS. CHAPTER XVIII. l'OLITICAL GEOGRAPHY I >F THE U. B 603 - tonal divisions— Their disappearance— Circuit Courts— States— District Courts— Congressional Districts— Counties— Towns— School Districts. CHAPTER XIX. HISTORY OF THE U. S. FROM 1783 TO 1812 606 Prostration of the country after tne war— Congress has no effective control of finances— Negligence of the States— Shay's rebellion in Mass.— Vig- orous action of Gen. Lincoln— "Virginia urges call of a Constitutional Convention— Meeting and result of the Convention — Last acts and dis- solution of Continental Congress — Washington's first Administration — The rise of parties, Federal and Anti-federal — Washington's second Administration — Difficulties with England — With France— Country prospers— Adams' Administration— Naval war with France — Jefferson's Administrations— Louisiana purchased — Increasing trouble with Eng- land — Madison's Administrations — War declared. CHAPTER XX. THE WAR OF 1812 620 Causes of the war— Disasters in Canada — Successes on the sea— Barbarity of British and Indians— Incompetence of U. S. officers— Second Cam- paign—Brilliant naval successes— Mortification of the British— Political opposition to the war embarrasses the Government and encourages the enemy — Third Campaign an American success — Gen. Scott in Canada — Defeat of the British at Plattsburg, on Lake Erie ; before Baltimore, at New Orleans. CHAPTER XXI. HISTORY FROM 1815 TO 1846 629 Results of the war highly favorable to the U. S. — Gains respect abroad — Party bitterness subsides — Compromise of 1820 — Great prosperity — Florida Purchase — Monroe's two Administrations — J. Q. Adams' Admin- istration — Sections divide on the Tariff— Jackson's two Administrations — Nullification of South Carolina — Jackson's promptness — Seminole war — Van Buren's Administration — Financial disasters — Harrison and Tyler — Admission of Texas — Election of Polk. CHAPTER XXII. THE MEXICAN WAR FROM 1848 TO 1860 638 Causes of the war— Battles of Palo Alto and Resaca de la Palma — Taking of Monterey— Battle of Buena Vista — Gen. Scott in Mexico— His long CONTENTS. 27 succession of victories — Enters the City of Mexico —Treaty of Guada- lupe Hidalgo— Increase of territory— Discovery of gold in California- California applies for admission as a State— Raises the violent opposition of Slave States— Compromises of 1850— Taylor and Fillmore— Pierce's Administration — Repeal of the Missouri Compromise— Troubles in Kansas — Buchanan's Administration — Preparation for Secession- Growth of the Republican party. CHAPTER XXIII. THE CIVIL WAR vw Real causes of the Civil War— The elections of Nov., 1860— Made the pre- text for Secession— South Carolina Secedes— Forts and property of the government seized in the South— Southern States successively Secede— Southern Confederacy formed— Want of energy in the Administration- Inauguration of Lincoln— The Union to be defended. CHAPTER XXIV. FIRST PHASE OF THE WAR "Si- Firing on Ft. Sumter— It electrifies the North— Call for troops— General mustering for war— Capture of Harper's Ferry and Gosport Navy Yard, Fighting in the border States— Experience gained in the general skir- mishing—Reluctance to join the great issue— Battle of Bull Run- Washington saved, if the battle is lost— Immense preparations by sea and land— Confederate government in Richmond. CHAPTER XXV. SECOND PHASE OF THE WAR u ^° The large armies have acquired much discipline and experience— Move- ment of McClellan on Richmond — Movement flanking Confederate positions on the upper Mississippi-Severe battles near Richmond— McClellan's failure-Success in the West-The rising fortunes of Grant at Donnelson, Henry, and Pitttsburg Landing— Advance of Lee— Pope's failure -Battles in Maryland - Lee's retreat -Bragg's advance and retreat— Battle of Fredericksburg— General results of the Campaign. CHAPTER XXVI. CAMPAIGN OF 1863 Emancipation proclamation-The year remarkable for the large number of engagements and formidable character of the operations -Battle of Chancellorsville and advance of Lee into Penn.- His defeat at Gettysburg and return to Va.-Capture of New Orleans-Taking ot Vicksburg-Defeatat Chickamauga retrieved by Grant-General results of the Campaign. 28 CONTENTS. CHAPTER XXVII. CAMPAIGN OF 1864 670 Struggle of Grant and Lee in Virginia— Sherman's " March to the Sea"— " Beginning of the end." CHAPTER XXVIII. CONCLUDING CAMPAIGN 675 General discouragement in the South — Capture of Seaboard cities — Re- inaugeration of the President — Fall of Petersburg and retreat of Lee — Close of the War — Assassination of Lincoln. CHAPTER XXIX. HISTORY FROM 1865 TO 1875 680 Opposed reconstruction policy of Congress and President Johnson — Fi- nancial condition — Patrons of Husbandry — Election and re-election of Gen. Grant. CHAPTER XXX. PARLIAMENTARY RULES 698 CHAPTER XXXI. STATISTICS OF THE WORLD 721 SUPPLEMENT. LEGAL FORMS — By Judge J. C. Power, of the First District of Iowa 725 Legal form of Will — Statement of Testator — Disposition of Property — Appointment of Executors — Statement of Witnesses — Circumstances of Signature — Necessity of two Witnesses — Articles of Copartnership — Statement of Agreement — Conditions Mutually agreed to — Signature — Agreement to continue Copartnership — Agreement to dissolve Co- partnership — Power of Attorney — How signed and acknowledged — Form of Submission to Arbitration — Form of Award of Arbitrators — General Form of Agreement — Agreement for sale of personal property — Agreement for sale of Real Estate — How executed and acknowledged — Form of Lease — Form of Warranty Deed — Form of acknowledgement of execution of Deed — Witnesses to signature — Mortgage Deed — Ne- gotiable Note — Non negotiable Note — Note transferable by delivery — Due bill— Receipt — What statements required in Receipt. THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. PART FIRST. CHAPTEK I. SECTION I. THE DAWN OF HISTORY. 1. The early traditions of every nation that has under- taken to relate the story of its origin, have given ns a confused account of supernatural persons and events which the judg- ment of more enlightened times has almost uniformly con- sidered fabulous and impossible. It has always been an interesting inquiry how much of fact was veiled under this mythical dress, and a great variety of ingenious and contra- dictory explanations have been produced by the learned in all ages. In most cases, as in Greece, the national religion has been based on these legends which form its authority and explanation, and they passed with the people of all early times as facts which it was impious to question. So the wise and good Socrates was supposed to have denied the existence of the national gods, and was condemned to death. This sacred guard placed over early traditions, increased at once the interest and the difficulty involved in their examination. 2. During the present century the improved methods, larger range and more exact style of inquiry, and the assist- ance and hints which one branch of study has given to others, (29) 30 THE FOOTPBINTS OF TIME. have produced the most surprising and satisfactory results. These inquiries are not yet complete ; they seem, on the con- trary, to have only commenced, and promise, ultimately, to satisfy all the useful purposes and legitimate curiosity of mankind; still, their conclusions, so far as they go, are unim- peachable. They prove themselves. The study of Ethnology, which gives an account of the races of mankind; a critical comparison of all languages, ancient and modern; the patient study and ingenious deciphering of architecture and inscriptions found in ancient ruins, and vari- ous relics of human activity imbedded in the soil of different countries, have thrown down the barriers which the glowing imaginations of the poets and the want of authentic docu- ments in early times had raised, and have given us a clue to many of the secrets of history, and a safe guide through some of the dark passages of man's primitive life. To show how this is done would require a treatise on Eth- nology, another on Comparative Philology, a third on Anti- quarian Research, and a fourth on the Geological Antiquities of Man. Each of these brings a large and valuable contribu- tion to early history. We give only a brief summary of their conclusions. 3. The human race appears to have had its birth on the high table lands of central Asia, south and east of the Caspian Sea. The structure and growth of language, and the remains of early art, indicate an extremely infantile mental condition and successive emigrations from the primitive home of the race. Families and tribes which had remained together long enough to build up a common language and strong general features of character and habit, at length separated and formed a number of families of allied races. 4. The first emigrations were made by the Turanian nations, which scattered very widely. Turanian means "out- -if theii 3 34 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. languages indicate were chiefly the care of flocks and herds. They were much farther removed from barbarism than any of the other races when they began their wanderings. Warlike, agricultural and nautical terms, and the names of wild animals ! iot often found in the common vocabulary; while family relations, domestic animals and their uses, the heavenly bodies in connection with worship and the priestly relation of the father of the family, and terms indicating a considerable culti- vation of sensibility and thoughtfulness, imply a purer social and religious condition, and more elevated mental traits, than in the primitive forefathers of the other families. Their language was highly picturesque, and its peculiar terms for natural phenomena are believed by some to have originated the mythological histories of the ancient Greeks and Romans and Teutonic nations. The ancient language used epithets and names, so glowing with personality, that the imaginative descendants of the primitive stock, when their early history was forgotten, believed them to contain an account of the origin of thing-, and the early deeds of gods and heroes; and the genius of the poets clothed the supposed marvels in the immortal dress of fiction which we find in Homer and Hesiod, in Virgil, the Indian Vedas, and the Sagas and Scalds of north- ern Europe. This, at least, is the conclusion reached by some of the most eminent scholars and philologists, whose study of the formation and growth of languages has thrown so much light on the ante-historical periods. These myths, the germs of which were embodied in their language, embellished by the supposed inspired genius of the poets, formed the literature and theology of the early historic nations, and were received as undisputed truth. '.'. The fir.-t migration of the Aryan family appears to have occurred through the passes of the Caucasus, northwest to tin' northern part of Asia Minor and Southern Europe. The Turanian nations, or " barbarians," were everywhere found in advance of them, in a very degraded condition, and the native spirit and ambition of the Aryan* people rendered them PRE-HI8T0RI0 GROWTH. ,35 the uniform conquerors. Afterward, another migration south- ward peopled India, and, in the earliest historic times, the part of the family still remaining in the ancient home of the race established the brilliant empire of the Modes and Persians, who extended their sway over all the central and western pa of Asia, broke down the ancient monarchy of Egypt, and, in the height of their power and glory, swept like a tempest into Europe with the purpose of subjugating a few self-governing tribes of their own race dwelling on the shores and among the mountains of tfie small peninsula of Greece. The failure of the mighty empire in this effort, through the indomitable res- olution of a handful of hardy republicans, forms one of the most glorious pages of history. It was a grand era in the development of civilization, and Grecian culture became the inheritance of the world. SECTION II. THE DIRECTION' OF PRE-HISTORIC GROWTH. 1. The three classes of indications on which we rely for a knowledge of the advance of mankind previous to the period when authentic history comes to our aid — the researches of geologists among the accidental traces of man's early activities, the ruins of ancient cities, and the study of the growth of lan- guage — unite in testifying to an extremely rude, feeble and childish condition of the earliest representatives of the race, and to a progressive improvement in knowledge and capacity, precisely like what occurs in the case of every individual or our kind. A fourth more general observation also confirms this view. This is the obscurity that covers the early ages. Aside from the "Bible narrative, a cloud rests on the early his- tory of every people. A long period passes before they begin to reflect, to look around and back toward their origin, and still another of groping thought and study before they are led to record their reflections and experiences. The nece ties and habit of social intercourse give rise to language and 36 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. gradually mature it; a long period would necessarily pass- before the natural aversion to other than desultory labor, the increase of population and the habit of obedience to an author- ity requiring continued painful toil, would render the massive monuments of some of the earlier peoples possible, and before their attempts at architecture could mature and originate the elaborate ruins which time has not been able to destroy during bo many centuries. 2. One of the most striking traits of pre-historic times is the simplicity and awkwardness that characterize childhood. The Chinese language has been remarked upon as showing the extremely infantile cast of mind among the people who formed and retained it to our times. Each word is a sentence, stand- ing by itself originally; the tone and gesture give it much of its signification. It would seem as if its authors had never grown to the idea of an elaborated sentence. There is an aver- age of eight words, spelled and pronounced exactly alike, for every sound -used. There are, it is said, 212 characters pro- nounced che; 138 pronouncedyboy and 1165 which all read e, and each letter is a wokI, a phrase and a sentence, and maybe an adjective, a noun, or a verb, or all three together. The difficulty of expressing shades of meaning, or all that maybe in the thought, where so much must be acquired before expres- sion is possible, has kept the Chinese mind, in many respects, in a state of childhood, though they have preserved a stability of character and institutions nowhere else observed. The primitive mind and habits are maintained as if crystalized. The principle of decay, so universal elsewhere, would seem, by Bome singular process, banished from a vast nation, as it is in the human body in Egyptian mummies. The same feature is observable in a smaller decree amonc: the Hindoos, and seems to have characterized the ancient Egyptians. 3. Such a habit of fixity among the early races, whose position secured them from disturbance by the more restless tribes, was favorable to the construction of the stupendous monuments which have been the wonder of after ages. All PRE-HISTORIC GROWTH. 37 those races have been remarkably exclusive. It was not until nearly four hundred years after the era of authentic history that Egypt was freely open to all the Greeks. These observa- tions apply only to those portions of the human family which were stranded in some quiet nook outside of the current of movement that carried along the most of mankind. Change of place, intercourse, conflict and conquest were the chief early educators. The isolated nations, after exhausting the power of their first impulses, ceased to improve. Their minds, institutions and habits stiffened and petrified. Nor did the families that wandered far from the general centre of move- ment usually acquire any high degree of development. They were characterized by unsettled habits, not favorable to highly organized institutions. 4. It was around, and westward of, the common centre of the race that a course of steady improvement went on. Here the laws of inheritance and suggestion, the stimulus of con- stant friction, and the infusion of newer and more enterprising blood worked the freest and developed the elements of a true civilization the soonest. If the legendary history of Greece is not to be trusted in its details, it at least establishes the certainty of active movement and incessant conflict out of which was, at length, evolved a noble, if incomplete, civiliza- tion. The Greeks were near enough to the scene of stirring action : in Western Asia to be benefited by its influence. with- out having their institutions frequently disturbed and broken up before they had reached any degree of maturity, as was the case with the Assyrians, Persians and Phenicians. They reaped the fruit, without sharing the disasters, of the great suririnirs back and forward which we find to have been the condition of the Asiatic peoples at the time reliable history begins to observe them. It appears to have been the same in that region (Western Asia) as far back as monument, legend, or science can trace. The fruit of this shock of rare- and mental activity matured on the spot the greatest and religious systems the world has ever known, the three greatest 30OS44 T11K FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. of which liavo survived to our own day, viz.: the Judaic, the Christian and the Mohammedan. The germs of the other i were contained in the system of Abraham and Moses. Thus the three most important influences needed for the pro- gress of civilization in the true direction were supplied in pre-historic times — the seething and surging of the nations in the West of Asia, a high religious ideal, and the primary discipline of the Greeks. 5. The lantern of science has guided us on the Track of Time by his advancing Footprints down to the period when the grand luminary, Written History, begins to shine from the hills of Greece. Looking over what was then known of Asia we find it a vast battlefield, on the western border of which were the Jews, receiving lessons of instruction or chas- tisement from the surrounding nations, and slowly evolving 1 the Master Religion of the world, the massive grandeur of Egypt is dimly visible in the south, and on the eastern hor- izon rise the immense walls and towers of the huge cities of Nineveh and Babylon. On the north and west all is dark- ness, though we subsequently learn that the elements of a high culture among the Etrurians of Italy were waiting their destruction at the hands of valiant Rome, yet to be. The Phoenicians were beginning to scour the sea and to build up a flourishing commerce, and the cities of Greece had already learned, from the tyranny of their petty kings, the advan- tages of free government. The period of authentic history is held to have commenced seven hundred and seventy-six years before the Christian era. In that year the Greeks began to record the name of the con- queror in the Olympian games — a national and religious fes- tival, which had been commenced long before — and it was culled the First Olvmpiad. It formed the first definite starting point of the true and fairly reliable historians who, some four hundred years later, began to write a carefully-studied account of what was known of their own and of other countries. It was the time when dates of passing events first began to be GRADUAL DEVELOPMENT. 39 stated in the records of the cities and kingdoms of Greece, and marks the beginning of a real civilization and culture, and the course of events began to be rescued from the magni- fying and marvel-loving imaginations of the people. 6. The seven hundred and fifty years that follow are in the highest degree interesting and important; for they record the achievements of the early manhood of humanity, as repre- sented by the nations that were most advanced in civilization, or contributed to the general progress of the world. Men developed their inherent capacities far more during that period than in all the previous centuries, however numerous they may have been. It was followed by about five hundred years of gradual decline, and that by a thousand years of con- fusion caused by the corruption of the old society and the imperfection of its elements, together with the irruption of vast hordes of barbarians, who brought in fresh and vigorous, but untamed blood, with rude and fierce manners. They were gradually tamed by fusion with the cultured races, and out of this union arose a civilization broader and more just, toward the perfection of which we ourselves are now rapidly advancing, and which, by its multiform vigor and unlimited resources, seems above the reach of decay. Its power of infusing new life into worn-out peoples and renewing the youth of nations as well as of civilizing barbarians appears irresistible. From this outlook we return to consider the steps by which Time has led us to such a desirable eminence. SECTION III. TnE GRADUAL DEVELOPMENT OF INSTITUTIONS. 1. Man, at first, had no institutions. He existed in the simplest and most spontaneous way, finding shelter in caves and clefts of the rocks and beneath the primeval forests, in op- ing his way by strong instincts which soon began to dawn into intelligence of the lowest and most material kind. How long (0 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. he led a purely animal life we have no means of knowing; but we may suppose that the necessities of self-preservation and his powerful social instincts very soon developed the germs of the family and of language. Childhood is comparatively long, and many generations must have passed before language could have acquired the distinctness and fixity that permitted it to come down through so long a period, and by so many different channels, to us. Yet there is plain evidence of an Eastern origin of all the vari- ous families of the race, and of a considerable mental develop- ment previous to the wanderings that peopled the East, the West, and the South. It has been remarked by Geologists that the introduction of any class of animal life was never made by its very lowest orders, but usually by a class inter- mediate in organization between the highest and the lowest; some of the very lowest orders being represented in our own time. 2. A tolerably hardy race, which could endure the expos- ures and overcome the difficulties that must be greater for the first few generations than ever afterward, as we have every reason to believe, was first introduced. It has been common to suppose that man must have been supplied with a fund of knowledge, and a basis of language, to have successfully met the difficulties of his condition; but the uniform law that the faculties, the innate capabilities of his race, are conferred on him, and that he works them out by a process of develop- ment is observable in his entire history, so far as we can trace it. All needful capacities being lodged in him, with strong appetites and instincts to impel him to the objects most vitally necessary to his own preservation and the continuance of his species, and the material from which to work out his predes- tined ends being placed within his reach, it is made his indis- pensable duty and his glory to realize those ends, soon or late, by his own endeavors. The evidences of his early activity, unearthed here and there by geologists, show him to have advanced by degrees from the lowest points, and such corrob- GRADUAL DEVELOPMENT. 41 orative proof as the earliest forms of language afford are decid- edly in the same direction. 3. Many of the terms employed for the first and most familiar objects with which the necessities of life brought him in contact, show the very imperfect extent of his early knowl- edge and resources, and they gradually change in a way to indicate, most significantly, a slow and laborious, but constant enlargement of ideas by experience. He advanced then, as now, by degrees. The races latest in development, as well as most vigorous and intelligent, were the Aryan, or Indo-Euro- pean. They have left the most definite traces of their early condition and advancement in the common elements of their various languages, which show very clearly how much time and toil were required to work out the features of their first Institution — The Family. The proper family type estab- lished relations of protection and dependence, of care and trust, of purity and tenderness, of provident foresight, and the shelter and comforts of Home. Apparently it was many cen- turies after the other races had begun to migrate that this last and most valuable stock commenced to be " fruitful and multiply," to tame animals for their use, to enclose and render their habitations comfortable, and to organize and designate © © their family relations down to son-in-law and daughter-in-law, as well as to name the most common domestic animals and occupations. 4. The fact doubtless existed long before common exper- ience and common consent had settled on the terms that have remained the same in the language of the Hindoos, the o © Greeks, the Romans, and the Germanic families; but by many certain signs we know that it was only gradually that the tenderness and beautv and usefulness of this institution had laid the sure foundation of a future vigorous and virtuous civilization. This race devoted themselves mainly t<> the care of flocks and herds, though we find among them the knowl- edge of wheat and some other grains: they had very little experience of war until they separated and began their wand- -ll' THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. erin we infer from the fact that their common terms are nearly all peaceful — those designating a warlike habit differing in all the various branches of the stock. Family, with them, was usually founded on marriage — the union of one man and one woman — which laid great rainte on vice and preserved the growing society from manifold evils. The other races — Turanian, Hamitic and litic — appear to have been much more careless in this respect, and admitted a vicious element into the base of Bociety, which loosened the bonds of relationship and discip- line. They practiced polygamy, which magnified the position of the father, while it deprived him of the closer and more intimate relations to his household on which refinement depends, and degraded the mother who became the simple minister of pleasure to, and the means of increasing the influ- ence of, the Patriarchal head. This point is very vividly shown in the earlier history of the Israelites where the unhap- j \ effects of polygamy are distinctly portrayed. From the same source we see how the first institution among men grad- es o ually grew into the Tribe, and the foundations of Organized Government were laid. 5. Population rapidly increased, the original progenitor, or the oldest of his male descendants, became the fountain of authority and influence, and was, in many cases, the chief or king, ■ xercising an undefined control, sometimes absolute and despotic, and again thatof amerely nominal head, the variations. taking every shade between the two. Occasionally, special gift.-, a. energy, foresight and skill, favored by circumstances, raised one in the tribe to eminence, and he became the acknowl- edged ruler to the exclusion of the patriarch, or hereditary heir ol the patriachal office, as in the case of Joseph in Egypt, and, in later times, Moses, Joshua and the Judges. found in Egypt, all agreeing as to its enormous antiquity, but disagreeing in some important points, and satisfactory tests have not yet been met with, so that the early days of Egypt are very obscure. The evidences of a clearly defined progress 44 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. are presented in its monuments, but the earliest bear so strong a resemblauce to the later that there is some reason for sup- posing that the first inhabitants had reached a considerable degree of maturity before settling there. As yet, however, that point is only an inference — the most probable escape from a difficulty. The empires established on the Euphrates, and north of that on the Tigris, mark the steps of progress very distinctly, and furnish fairly satisfactory means of com- puting their general chronology. 8. In all thesg cases it appears from monuments, traditions, and from whatever information the records of the Bible and other histories give us, that when men began to gather in com- munities, cultivate the ground and build cities, their govern- ments were controlled by kings. Despotic sovereignty was the natural and necessary instrument of government. The vigor- ous will of an admired chief concentrated the energies of the community, and a state was formed. The beginnings were very rude and improvement was slow, never reaching beyond the simple application of force as to the structure and modes of government. But another element, founded on the religious nature of mankind, which also had entered as an important influence into family government from the earliest times, became organized in the early days of monarchy, viz.: THE INSTITUTION OF A PRIESTHOOD. 9. It would appear, from such traces of a religious tendency as are found in the primary languages, that the religious instinct was awakened by an observation of the forces of nature, which struck the mind with wonder, admiration, or terror. The mysteries of growth, the power of winds and storms and waters, the calm beauty, beneficence and brilliance of the sun, moon and stars riding undisturbed in the heavens, impressed man with a sense of something superior to himself. The moods of nature suggested some unknown being with a vary- ing disposition like his own. His wants, his hopes and fears, and his sense of helplessness soon led him to seek to propitiate GRADUAL DEVELOPMENT. 45 these unknown powers. The first religion, among all the prim- itive nations, seems to have been a worship of the powers of nature. The head of the family was naturally the first priest of the family. This office increased the respect in which he was held by his multiplying descendants, and contributed to strengthen his authority. 10. But when, in the organization of cities and states, patriarchal influence decayed, and was replaced by the author- ity of the chieftain or the king, a class of men was set apart to fill the office of religious instructors, to discover the art and conduct the acts of general worship. The great mystery and uncertainty surrounding the objects of worship, required exclusive study and a supposed purity and elevation of mind impossible to others which soon raised the priesthood into an institution much revered. It acquired great influence, and afforded an opening to ambition only inferior to that of the chief or king. The two commonly united for mutual support, and thus mankind gained two institutions destined to be of incalculable value, as well as of almost boundless injury. In the earlier ages they must have been an almost unmixed good. They disciplined, the one the labors, the other the minds, of communities. They were the two most powerful instruments for initiating progress. They moulded the mass, gave it form, and directed its energies. To a certain degree they each formed a che(*k on the excess- ive tendencies of the other. But, the power of each fairly established, they often united to set very hurtful limits to spontaneous action. The king used his power to the common injury, and the priests their knowledge to the common debase- ment. The first exhausted the sources of prosperity and growth among his people to gratify his caprices and pleasni and the priesthood promoted degrading superstitions and a gross idolatry to strengthen their influence. It was for the interest of both to keep the people in pupilage, and cheek tendencies to independent action or thought. Had it been 4(3 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. possible for them to be wise and high-minded, the race would have been saved many centuries of debasement and misery. 11. These evils were, in some degree, checked by influences which have ever since been the mainspring of progress— War and Commerce. In early times, relationships of blood or of immediate interest were the chief bonds among men. All outside the family, tribe, or nation were usually held as ene- mies; and passion, interest, or ambition in the ruler led to constant conflict. But the shock of peoples awakened their minds, made them acquainted with each other, made their inventions and arts in some degree common property, and mingled the thought and blood of different races; and this greatly enlarged the ideas and capacities of both conquerors and conquered. The acquaintance made in this way, with men and countries, led to an interchange of products, during quiet times, and trade and commerce soon sprung up. This, appeal- ing to the best interests and instincts of the most enterprising among the people, has always been a powerful instrument of advancement. It led to distant voyages and travels, to obser- vation and intercourse, with a view to pecuniary advantage, to inventions and improvements in industry and art, that kept the peoples so related in a state of constant progress. 12. A growing population required increasing attention to agriculture and the mechanic arts, and increasing wealth led to architectural display and the increase of instruments of luxury, the production of which disciplined the skill of the artisan and contributed to the general growth. All these were the elements and foundation of civilization. An organization commenced, and a state founded, the king soon found leisure to look about and envy the wealth and territories of his neigh- bor, lie made war and commenced a career of conquest, or fell, under defeat, into his neighbor's hand, when time took a step forward, and a new consolidation, wider and higher than the former, was laid on a broader base. Slowly but surely an advance was made. 13. We are now to observe this gradual development in ANCIENT MONAKOIIIKS. 47 the successive history of five monarchies in Asia and the king- dom of Egypt, down to the time when they all fell before the conquering power of Greece, under Alexander the Great, which introduces new and tar higher elements of progress among the civilized races, and forms the full opening of a new Era. SECTION IV. ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 1. The Chaldean Monarchy was the first in order of time. It seems very likely that the first settlement which, in the slow development of the earliest races, finally produced an organ- ized kingdom on the lower part of the Euphrates, was made somewhere in the neighborhood of 3000 years before the Christian Era. It is, however, a matter of dispute between the best authorities whether it can be placed so far back. The monuments of that age are difficult to decipher, but it seems pretty certain that a Scythian or Turanian government prece- ded that which the traditions of ancient history, the statements of the Bible, and the indications of the ruins unite in placing at k 22:'»l B. 0. The founder appears as Nimrod, or Bilu-Nipur. Many indications render it fairly certain that the early forma- tive stages of a kingdom had already passed, and that Nimrod merely changed the capital. The first people had learned to subdue their soil, had begun to build and to bring language and art to some degree of order, when it appears that a I lam- i tic race, more advanced than they, and showing strong like- ness to the early Egyptians, mingled with them. In the first inscriptions the language is Turanian, but the character Ilam- itic, or Egyptian. So far as can be judged, the displacement was peaceful and gradual. About the time above named, a man of great genius, Nimrod, a Eamite, or Cushite. as he is termed in the Mosaic record, a "mighty hunter," as his name implies, founded a kingdom farther up the Euphrates, and the plain which lay between the rivers Euphrates and Tigris. 4S THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 2. The existence of the first empire is dimly made out, and that is all. Nimrod had clearly a foundation to build on, and he made a great impression on his own times. After his death he was deified under the name of Bel, and became the favorite among the fifteen or sixteen principal deities of the early Chaldeans. These gods and goddesses seem to represent the heavenly bodies; while the earlier Turanian worship was a veneration of the powers of nature. Nimrod's dynasty appears to have covered a period of about two hundred and fifty years, including the reigns of eleven kings. They made great advancement in draining the marshy valley and reg- ulating the supply of moisture to the growing crops. They became expert in the manufacture of cloths and in building with bricks which are covered with inscriptions. The priest- hood acquired a strong development at this time, as appears in the ruins and inscriptions of their temples. The kings do not appear to have been very warlike, or to have extended their dominion far. 3. A second Chaldean kingdom was founded about 1976 B. C. It is called Elam in the Bible, and furnishes the first known example of what was afterward so often seen in that region — an extensive kingdom formed by a series of rapid conquests, that fell to pieces again as soon as a vigorous hand failed to uphold it. The kingdom continued till about B. C. 1500. Kudur-Lagamer, the Chedor-Laomer of the Mosaic account, overran a territory one thousand miles in length by five hundred in width. In one of his incursions into Pales- tine his forces were defeated by Abraham, which ended a con- trol over that region lasting twelve years. There is no indi- cation that the following sovereigns exerted authority beyond Chaldea and Babylonia. There, however, they grew rich and civilized, extending their commerce to India and Egypt, becoming famous and en vied for their splendor and luxury. A single small dwell- ing house of that period lias been preserved in the ruins of Chedor-Laomer's capital "Ur of the Chaldees," south of ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 49 Babylon. It was built on a platform of dried brick.-, the walls of great thickness, with two arched doors, and, appa- rently, lighted from the roof. The rooms were long and nar- row. Iron was at that time unknown. All implements were of stone or bronze. Religion seemed to increase in its gross- ness, apparently under the policy of the priesthood, who laid the foundation of astronomical seience and began to acquire the reputation for hidden knowledge for which they became famous in after centuries. Nothing of any importance is related of the kings of this monarchy except the one con- queror. Despotism and priestly craft kept most of the feeble tendencies to political improvement curbed — waiting for bet- ter times. That arrived with the advent of the Assyrian /u/ipire, about B. C. 1500. 4. It appears that for a long time before, a family, or tribe, of Shemites had been settled in Chaldea, where they acquired its civilization and arts, and some time about 13. C. 1600 emigrated north, settling on the river Tigris. They were a strong race, physically and mentally, quite too fierce and resolute to be held in leading-strings by the Chaldean priesthood. The country they occupied was higher and more varied, abundantly supplied with stone, which was wanting in Babylonia and Chaldea. Here, in process of time, the most vigorous and progressive race that had yet been seen among the families of man, built up a succession of cities within a small circuit, each of which was, at different times, the capital, and which were all finally united and made the famous Nineveh of the Greek historians, and the immense "city of three days' journey.'" visited by the Jewish prophet, Jonah. Within a few years these ruins have been examined by competent men of science with great care, and have been found to confirm the Bible narrative, in all essential points, and most of the glowing descriptions of pro- fane historians; while their higher style of art and greater vigor and pride of achievement led them t>> build monuments 4 50 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. and engrave records that promise to make us very intimately acquainted with their social, political and moral life. 5. They seem to have acquired the habit in Chaldea of rais- ing a vast elevated mound for their more important buildings. The largest mound is found to be nearly one hundred feet high, and to cover an area of one hundred acres, and on the summit of this were placed their temples and the palaces of their kings. This immense foundation, it is said, would require the labor of twenty thousand men for six years. After this were to be constructed their vast buildings, cov- ered with sculptures and adorned with statues. Another mound, higher but embracing a smaller area — about forty acres — served the same purpose. They were extremely religious in their way, but the vigor of the kings appears to have overshadowed the priesthood much more than in Chaldea. It seems to have been about three hundred years after the establishment of this enterpris- ing stock in Assyria that they became famous for foreign conquest. Babylon had been gradually rising in importance, often in subjection, more or less nominal, to the growing northern power, but retaining its own kings and habits. 6. The reign of Shalmaneser I., about 1290 B. C, was dis- tinguished by his building a new city and improving his kingdom; and his successor, in 1270, signalized his reign by establishing, for a time, a complete sovereignty over Babylon, and the historical Assyrian empire is commonly dated from that event. For a century and a half there are few important records. Tiglath-Pileser I., in B. C. 1130, commenced a series <>f efforts to extend his dominions by conquest, which his success led him to describe with unusual detail. It embraces five campaigns and a description of the conquest of all the neighboring people. He established a compact and powerful empire, which was surrounded by wild tribes whose conquest was of little honor or value, and whom it was difficult to hold long in subjection. In a return from a campaign against Babylon, which he had conquered, he suffered a great reverse, ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 51 losing the images of his gods which he kept in his camp for protection and assistance in his enterprises; and they were carried to Babylon, remaining there, it is said, 400 years. A long period of apparent quiet was followed, after more than two hundred years, by another warlike king who pushed his conquests to the Mediterranean sea. His public works were larger and more magnificent than those of any of his prede- cessors. He has recorded ten successful campaigns. 7. His son, Shalmaneser II., increased the number, extent and thoroughness of the conquests of his father. Still, most of the countries conquered retained their laws and govern- ment, simply paying an annual tribute, and the conquest set lightly on them. Babylon seems to have retained compara- tive independence. In the following reign, Babylon was cap- tured and remained some time tributary to Assyria and the Ninus, or Iva-lush IV., whose wife was the celebrated Semi- ramis, still further extended Assyrian poWer. The wonderful tales related by Grecian historians of Semiramis are not con- firmed by the monuments. She appears to have been an energetic Babylonian princess, the principal queen of Ninus, who ruled conjointly with him. The novelty of a female ruler in that rude age, and the splendor of the empire at the time, seem to have originated the fabulous tales related of her. 8. At this time the development of the people of all the western parts of Asia was so great, and the wars as well as peaceful intercourse of different nations had so stimulated them all, that improvement kept a tolerably even step. Mul- titudes of populous cities and kingdoms existed in all direc- tions. The magnificence of Solomon belongs to this period, the Jewish monarchy having reached the height of its glory and power, too high to be long endured by the proud and enterprising Assyrians. Commerce filled the east with acti- vity and manufactures flourished, in 6ome directions reaching a high degree of excellence. A true progress marked the general course of human effort. The psalms of David show to what a lofty point the religious ideas of that age were 52 TIIE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. capable of being carried. Industrial pursuits and agriculture reached, in the next hundred and fifty years, the highest development they ever attained in some regions. 9. In the midst of this busy industry Nineveh rose, peer- less in grandeur, enriching herself with the tribute and spoils of all countries, beautified by the master race, which was wise enough not to dry up the sources of their prosperity by the destruction of cities and kingdoms. The common policy, up to nearly the close of her splendid career, was to leave the real resources of all conquered nations untouched. After defeating her opposer in a battle, she received the submission of the king, imposed a heavy tax, or forced contribution, and an en le. Their signal failure had the effect to greatly stimulate the development of the Greek national spirit, and to awaken its intellectual enthusiasm, and the mighty armies of the Persians were destined to be annihilated by the small but resolute forces of the little republics. 16. Thirteen sovereigns ruled during the continuance of the Persian empire. Except the conquest of Egypt, they did not very greatly extend the boundaries formed by Cyrus; but the national features of the subject peoples were gradually effaced, and the whole brought to the common level of civilization. "When Alexander, the great Grecian soldier, appeared with his army of 35,000 men he scattered the hosts of the Persian king, Darius, as the wind drives the leaves of the forest; and the vast empire, so long accustomed to bow to the fate of bat- tles, became the unresisting heritage of the conquerer. These five great monarchies were continuous — in part on the same soil — the centre having always been the fertile val- leys of the Euphrates and the Tigris; the successor stepping into the place and carrying out the general plans of his imme- diate predecessor, but on a broader scale and in an increasingly enlightened manner. Through all these long centuries a mys- terious, and, apparently, still more ancient race had occupied Egypt, only occasionally interfering with, or being disturbed by, the surging sea of strife that raged and foamed so near them, which at length forced them from their seclusion and bore them on in the general tide of improvement. 17. The Egyptian monarchy presents many very curious and difficult problems. Possessing the most perfect organiza- tion in the earliest times of which we have any knowledge, the traces of its beginnings quite fail us, although, more than any other nation, it loved to build great and impressive monuments and record on them, in the most minute manner, the singular habits and monotonous daily life of its people. The first of those monuments, which, by many signs, must date very nearly afi far back in the remote past, as the earliest dawn of ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 57 organization among any other people of whom wo can gather any certain traces, indicate a long settled state, a high degree of organization, considerable culture and great resources. 18. The first king, who is called Menes by several inde- pendent and very ancient authorities, made his reign memora- ble by a system of vast and useful public works. It is conjec- tured that the previous rulers were the sacerdotal class and that, up to that time, they had no kings. The habits of the people were quiet and peaceful, and they seem to have been first gathered around temples. In all stages of their history, down to the time when foreign intrusion by force disorganized their peculiar institutions, the priesthood was the most influ- ential element in their constitution, and their sway seems to have been, in some respects, singularly mild and beneficent. Except for the extreme inflexibility and minuteness of their regulations, which repressed all spontaneous growth, and the gross and absurd worship of animals which they introduced, they might be considered an unmixed blessing to those early times. It is certain that they were successful in controlling men and moulding them to their own views without produc- ing discontent or revolt. 19. Everything in Egypt was remarkable — its river, its country, and the institutions and habits of its people. The Egyptians dwelt in the valley of the Nile for a space of 500 miles above its mouth; but this valley was so narrow that' the habitable part of it contained only about 6,000 square miles in all. It was shut in by the Red sea on the east and by track- less deserts on the west, and a fall of rain was so rare as to be considered a prodigy. In June each year their mysterious river, whose sources are yet almost unknown, began to rise rill it covered the whole valley like a vast sea. The rise ami tall occupied the summer months and to the middle of October. The waters left a rich coating of mud and slime, which ren- dered the valley fertile beyond measure. The productive e son occupied the remainder of the year, and their agricultural resources were only limited hv thHr Rlrill in spreading and 58 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. husbanding the fertilizing waters. Vast canals and reservoirs covered the whole valley. Lake Moeris, a reservoir partly natural and partly artificial, was said by the first Greek his- torian, Herodotus, to have been 400 miles in circuit. When the waters had reached their highest point, the cisterns, canals and lakes were filled and the waters kept in reserve for late periods of the year, and a succession of crops. 20. The mysterious character of the river seems to have deeply impressed the nation with awe and reverence for unseen powers, and contributed to the influence of the priestly caste. Their peculiar source of wealth and the amount of leisure periodically afforded, perhaps led to the construction of the temples and palaces, whose gloomy strength is as mysterious as their river, or the origin of the people. Far back in the twilight of time, Thebes, the " city of a hundred gates," was a colossal capital. Its vast temples and palaces were built on a scale of grandeur that seems almost superhuman; yet, before history begins its narrative in Greece, Thebes had had its youth, its long period of splendor and glory, its hoary age, and was already a thing of the past, and nearly in ruins ; not by vio- lence or conquest, but by the natural transfer of the center of activities to another region. Considering the small extent of Egypt, its always overflowing population, and the tenacious habits of the Egyptians, nothing could more impressively show its great age. 21. Egyptian sculpture was descriptive of religious cere- monies on the temples, and on the palaces of domestic life and general habits, and furnishes us with details of the whole social structure and all their industrial pursuits, as well as the events in the campaigns of their few warlike monarchs. Add to these the minute delineation of their temple service and religious teachings, and its ruins describe the entire round of its ancient life. The people were divided into classes, or castes, the son being obliged to follow the occupation of the father; and all branches of business and industry, public and private, were arranged in ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 59 the most methodical manner. The priest, the soldier, the hus- bandman, the artisan of whatever branch, was so because his ancestors had been such for numberless generations. A king could be selected either from the priestly or the soldier caste; but he must previously have been initiated into all the myste- ries of the priesthood, and therefore Moses, the acknowledged heir of the throne, " was learned in all the wisdom of the Egypt- ians." Otherwise, not belonging to the priestly caste, he must have remained in ignorance. With this exception, the priest alone had the key of knowledge, and all the employments requiring intellectual studies, or scientific culture, as we should now say, were filled from that class. They kept all records, measurements, and apportionments of land; prescribed the times, seasons, and conduct of all public transaction^; were the constitutional advisers of the king; they were physicians, astronomers, philosophers, and guides of the people in every respect. They alone did the thinking, and they guarded their prerogative with the most jealous care. 22. A people are debased and gross in proportion to their ignorance, and the ignorant masses of Egypt were amused with the greatest possible multiplication of gods, and their leisure and simple minds fully occupied in religious ceremo- nies and absurd fictions. But the priests were as wise and moderate as they were crafty and persistent. Their discipline was extremely judicious and well administered, and was laid on the king as well and sternly, as to his general life, as on the lowest peasant. The priesthood were as absolute, as im- partial, and as unvarying from age to age as it is possible to conceive. Their services to humanity were very great. They laid the foundation among men, of unvarying law, of diligence in the employment of time, of exactness in the division of labor, and inculcated, in an effective way, the idea of divine justice and of immortality. 23. Their "wisdom " was the highest and the most fruitful that was, perhaps, possible in their times ; their fame was wide-spread, and their iniiuence on the legislation of other 60 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. lands lias laid all ages under great obligations. The political economy of the Jews was the product of one of their most intelligent disciples, and the fact that he was so probably added greatly to his influence and success with his own people; and all the great legislators, philosophers, and historians of Greece went to them to complete their education. In after times, when the nation lost its liberty and became the province of a distant kingdom, they sunk the priest in the scholar, and Egypt had the largest libraries and the most eminent philoso- phers in the world. After Greece was carried, as it were, bodily, to Rome, far down into the Christian Era, Alexandria was the university of the world. The history of Egypt is thus entirely peculiar, being mainly that of its own influential class. They impressed a peaceful, generally virtuous, laborious, as well as monotonous charac- ter on its history, and, besides the vast monuments which the patient industry they inspired reared up, and the names of their interminable list of kings, there was, perhaps, little to record. 24. The entire number of their dynasties of kings, as they have handed them down to us, is thirty-two, the last being the Ptolemies, founded by a Greek general of that name, after the death of Alexander the Great, which lasted more than three hundred years, closing B. C. 44. The first twelve dynas- ties are called the Old Empire, whose period it is impossible to determine accurately. The five following dynasties are ascribed to the reign of foreigners, called " shepherd kings," who are supposed to have established their authority between the times of Joseph and Moses, and are called the Middle Empire; while thirteen dynasties, including the royal families that reigned down to the time of the conquest of Egypt by the Persians, comprise the New Empire. They were generally exclusive, shut up within themselves, too much absorbed in exact observance of the endless routine prescribed by their priests to be inclined to the ambition of foreign conquest; but several of their kings gathered large armies and invaded ANCIENT MONARCHIES. 61 Palestine and Syria, or made a trial of strength with the Assyrians or Babylonians. They never made permanent con- quests in that direction. Some of the later kings became friendly to the Greeks, and employed them in their armies, to the great disgust of their subjects, the soldier caste retir- ing, almost in a body, to Ethiopia, and refusing to return. The kingdom 6oon after fell into the hands of foreigners, and the accumulated discipline, knowledge and wealth of that wise people became the inheritance of humanity. Nebuchadnezzar was the first who made a conquest of Egypt, but the country soon regained its independence. It was not till after the death of Cyrus, and when the details of the new Medo-Persian kingdom had been settled, that Cam- byses, the son of Cyrus, subdued the whole of Egypt, and made it a Persian province, in which condition it remained most of the time to the Grecian invasion. 25. About twenty-five hundred years before the time of Alexander the Great, the cities of Sidon and Tyre were founded, in Phenicia, on the eastern shore of the Mediter- ranean sea. Their territory extended only twenty miles back from the sea. They were of the Semite race, and their enter- prising spirit led them to build ships and become at first pirates and then merchants. They were thrifty and grew rich, improved their vessels and became famous for their com- merce. They at length planted colonies for trading purposes on the northern coasts of Africa, in Sicily and in Spain. One of those colonies, Carthage, became more wealthy and powerful than the parent state. The merchandise they gath- ered from distant countries they distributed through Asia by a land trade, and their caravans reached Nineveh, Babylon and Persia, and, for long periods, were almost the only link that joined Egypt to the rest of the busy and growing world. They learned many useful things among the Egyptians, among others the invention of letters, or at least hints on which they improved. Many flourishing cities were built up by this internal commerce in places surrounded by desert regions, as 62 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. Baalbek and Palmyra in Syria, and Petra in Arabia, a city excavated in the rocks, which, lying between Syria and Phe- necia in the north and the rich districts of Arabia in the south, and between Babylon and Persia on the east and Egypt on the west, became a great mercantile depot. The Pheni- cians were the busiest and most enterprising people of ancient times. Their vessels reached the shores of England, where they had valuable mines of tin, as of silver in Spain; they visited the northwest coasts of Africa and the Madeira islands, and brought the rich products of India and gold from eastern Africa to the markets of the world. The amount of their con- tributions to civilization and progress by making known the discoveries and arts of distant nations to each other, by caus- ing roads and inns to be built, and facilitating communica- tion, was immense; as well as by awakening the love of gain and turning the activities of a part of mankind from warlike to more peaceful and useful pursuits. The arts and inventions that have done the most, in the long run, for the improve- ment of men, as shipbuilding and writing, were communicated from one nation to another. Their commercial routes were the highways over which the intelligent and inquiring Greeks traveled in search of the knowledge which they used for the education of their people. Tyre was destroyed by Alexander B.C. 332; but he replaced it the same year by building Alex- andria, at the mouth of the Nile. 26. We have thus seen nations and institutions gradually unfolding, passing through a period of youth, of vigorous organic action, and finally decaying, to give place to another of higher order which inherited all its general gain and pro- ceeded to carry still further the banner of civilization. As this process continues the field widens, and with the increas- ing number and variety of the elements engaged in acting upon one another, the product becomes more valuable, the organization more complete and the institutions more asefnl. The institutions purely political, however, the modes of THE GRECIAN STATER. 63 government and the style of administering them, are imper- fect, at best. They are too arbitrary, too restrictive- the masses are too large and too closely crowded to permit free play to the component parts. The mingling of the whole was, at first, evidently necessary to prevent the crystalizing of the separate nationalities and the arrest of progress; but when that process was stopped and a plastic condition and pro- gressive tendency assured, the absolute despotism of the king and the priest stood in the way of advance. They had educated society and developed its resources until a power of vast combination had been gained; then a change must be intro- duced, or the entire resources of the civilized world would be employed to repress its further advancement, the fountains of wealth would be exhausted and the springs of activity dried up. This barrier against a destructive centralization had long been preparing among the Grecian states. SECTION V. THE GRECIAN STATES. 1. They were of the Aryan race, and showed a high capacity to receive the lessons taught by the experience and genius of all the past, and make them the stepping-stone to a higher civilization and freer institutions. They were pre- ceded in the occupation of Greece by the Pelasgi, of the same stock, but too rude and uncultured to leave many traces of their presence except the ruins of immense Cyclopean buildings, without inscriptions, indicating only a dawning culture, but a vigorous combination of physical force. The mythic history of Greece is in part a veiled and distorted account of the struggles of Ilellens, or true Greeks, against those uncouth aborigines; the actual facts being mingled by the lively creative fancy of their poete with the religious tra- ditions brought from their original home. The highly pia turesque language of the primitive Aryan people accorded with the imaginative and observant character of that fam- 64 T1IE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. ily, and its inclination to extemporize some plausible explanation of the natural phenomena which awakened their attention, and, apparently, suggested the general course of in- vention and embellishment adopted by the poets, who were the historians, the theologians, and the only literary class of their period. Thus the early speculations and crude religious ideas assumed, in poetic hands, an exceedingly fanciful and marvel- ous garb; and their heroes, who succeeded in overcoming the difficulties of a new settlement, and in laying the foundation of their communities in a rude country filled with men and beasts almost equally wild and savage, were endowed by their grateful and admiring descendants with superhuman quali- ties, and wonder and reverence ascribed to them a descent from the gods. 2. A characteristic feature of Grecian heroic mythology is the number and mutual contests of these mythical heroes which indicate a leading characteristic of the nation — a dis- position toward independence and decentralization. Every small community had its divine hero, and insisted on main- taining its government in its own hands. In the early times the immediate descendants of these local benefactors com- monly obtained the sovereignty, more or less qualified, over their city and community. They all greatly respected the tie that bound them together in kinship as one race; but they never would permit it to deprive them of local independence. If they had a king he should be of their own tribe and choice; if they were ruled with harshness it should be only because they chose to submit to their own tyrant. They seldom per- mitted another community to manage their internal affairs. Various leagues were early formed among contiguous cities or states closely related by origin; but they dealt only in mutters of common interest, and if one city or king was acknowledged as the head, it was only in a general sense for the Kike of realizing some general plan. 3. This instinctive and resolute refusal to accept a central- ized government was a new and important feature in the his- Till: liKlXTAN STATES. I J.". tory of men in a civilized, or highly organized state. It was the direct opposite of that which characterized Asiatic and African civilization, and held the Greek race open to a spontaneous growth and a mental development which made them the benefactors of the human family. With less indi- viduality and mental force, or a less favorable time and situa- tion, it would have kept them forever barbarous; but time had matured them and the nations about them, and their restless spirit of inquiry and constant movement among them- selves stood in the place of the foreign action and shock of races that proved so beneficial and necessary to the Asiatics. The Egyptian, Chinese and Hindoo peoples reached a certain point of well regulated order, apparently by an original impulse, and stopped; the Chaldean, Assyrian and Persian races kept in the stream of progress by a sort of mechanical or forcible stir and intermingling of races and civilizations; and the principle accomplished, in each case, all it was capable of. Time and progress then transferred the care of the best interests of mankind to intelligence as embodied in the Greek race. Without being conscious of such a high destiny, they fulfilled it with fidelity, and remained true to themselves and faithful to the impulses of their own minds until humanity required training of a different kind, and another race, receiv- ing their mental culture, added to it administrative ability and carried the old world as high as it could possibly go on its ancient base. 4. It seems probable that about B. C. 2000, or in the time of Abraham, the progenitors of the Greeks reached that country from the highlands east of the Caspian Sea. Greece extends about 220 miles from north to south, and 160 from east to west, with a very irregular outline, and contains about 34,000 square miles, much of this being mountainous and barren. The separation of the different states by these mountain ranges much favored the disposition of the people to local independence, and formed a bold and hardy race. Access from three sides to the sea led to commerce and colonization, while 5 G6 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. it brought them into frequent contact with the most civilized people of the east without endangering their independence, and the lofty mountains on the north were an effectual barrier to the irruption of the wild and wandering tribes of northern Asia and Europe. Early in the history of the Greeks colonies came from Egypt and Phenicia and introduced the arts of those countries, then the most civilized in the world. This was about the time that the Jewish nation was founded by Moses, and we can easily understand that the native intelli- gence of the Greeks and their teachable spirit, led them to profit greatly by this early light. 5. The most celebrated traditions of this people relate to an expedition by the collective young chivalry of Greece, called the "Argonautic," which indicates their enterprising spirit and early acquaintance with the sea, and also seems to have introduced the habit of planting colonies. Two wars against Thebes, in the central part of Greece, induced by the ambition and combinations of the kings of the various States, seem to have made much impression on the whole nation, while a combination of nearly all of its petty sovereigns, gath- ering an immense army, stated at 100,000 men, to punish an injury done to one of their number by the King of Troy, on the opposite coast of Asia, occupied ten years, and tilled the whole country with confusion. This was soon followed by an event called the Return of the Heracleidse, or descendants of Hercules — a mythic hero of great celebrity — to their ancient dominion in the southern peninsula, called the Pelopen- esus. It appears to have been attended by the migration of one tribe into the domains of another, which they forcibly dis- posseesed and produced the emigration of the conquered peo- ple into Asia, where they formed extensive colonies — inde- pendent — but preserving a love for their race, and forming an important element in Greek progress. 6. The commotions and miseries of this period and of subsequent times, which had their rise mainly in this, most of which were due to the restless ambition and personal quarrels THE OKKCIAN STAT1 -. 61 •of their kings, came at length to disgust the spirited and pro- gressive people with that form of government, and before tin- time that authentic history begins they had very generally set aside the kings and established a democracy; and where this was not the case, as in Sparta, the power of the kings became so limited that they were little more than leading magistrates in their respective cities. This was not often done by violent revolution, but generally in a quiet way, showing the steady and intelligent resolution of the people. This rare nation knew how to adapt its governments to its needs. Not that everything went on without struggle or diffi- culty, nor that they did not share in the rude and sanguinary passions of their times. Their governments were often unset- tled; there were frequent conflicts among aspirants for place and power in the state; they had a balance of power among the leading states to maintain; and the want of a strong central authority led to innumerable collisions and sometimes to deso- lating wars. But amidst all the confusion and imperfection of an early civilization they still maintained such an independ- ence of any superior in each state that they could settle their internal affairs to suit themselves. They were yet uneducated men, in the enthusiastic young manhood of the world, but with spirit enough to be free. 7. Thar freedom had many defects. The true character, of freedom was imperfectly apprehended in that age of the world. It was often violent; and much Grecian blood was shed by Greeks. It was frequently turbulent; and sometimes the strife of parties and factions did great injury to the wel- fare of the state. It was usually a restricted liberty in which all the inhabitants did not share, for the slave, the freedman, and the foreigner were admitted to no influence in the govern- ment, or in framing the laws; and there was always much oppression and injustice somewhere. It was not a well under- stood and well balanced liberty, as we comprehend it, but it left room for a large amount of tree and spontaneous action. It made little account of the individual; that point was to be • • THE FOOTEBTNTS OF TIME. learned and made duly prominent after the lapse of more than two thousand years. The Greek identified himself with hit state. He would not have it large in order that each free cit- izen might have a personal influence in it. His public life was an education to him; and the very defects of his institu- tions fitted them more perfectly to meet the wants of that age than anything more complete could have clone. 8. They developed rapidly under a system so free from restraint, coupled with a nature so ardent, and a thirst for knowledge so absorbing. Still it was at least two hundred years after they had re-arranged their primitive modes of gov- ernment before they reached a degree of order and system that influenced them to record events as they passed, and observe the world outside of their state, and even then their most learned men wrote little. Men were absorbed in their private matters, or in the affairs of the state. They thought little of the future; they were devoting themselves diligently to the only means of education that existed in those days* intercourse and action. Their priesthood was quite different from what we found it in Chaldea and Egypt. They did not form a class, nor attempt to exercise an influence on govern- ment. They were appointed from the body of the citizens to offer sacrifices and conduct religious ceremonies. The high spirited and active minded Greeks were not fit subjects for the dominion of a priestly caste. Although Cecrops, an Egyptian, settled and civilized Athens, and introduced some of the social arrangements of his country, he did not plant the all-controlling priesthood. The Athenians, of all other Greeks, were the thoughtful, progressive intelligence of the nation. The poets compiled the geneaologies and histories of the L ri >d>, the heroes, and the past records of the people. There was no other literature, there were no other sources of information but those from which the poets drew — tradition and inherited customs. Of these the poets explained the origin and reason, and no one thought of questioning their tales. They were supposed to be inspired; and their marvel- THE GRECIAN STATES. 69 his legends rested, to a certain extent, on monuments, habits, and oral tradition. Their lively narratives charmed and satis tied the public mind and gratified their pride. It was only in later years that the philosophers explained them away. In the early days they had no standard by which to critici-. them. All they required was that they should oner a pleasing explanation. The wisest of the Greeks came, ultimately, to believe in one God who ruled with wisdom and justice, and they laid the foundation of all useful knowledge by teaching men to think and reason; but true science was not possible in their age of the world. They, however, prepared the way for it. 9. Their religion was cheerful and bright, they had altars and temples in great numbers, and countless ceremonies in honor of particular deities. One class of these was festi- vals, or games, established, according to tradition, by their divine heroes. The Olympian Games were the most celebrated, and took place every fiftieth month at Olympia. In the year 776 B. C. they began to record the name of the victor in these games, and as that Mas done ever afterward, this became a fixed date and the interval between each was called an Olympiad. It was the beginning of reliable history, although it was one hundred and fifty years later that men of real wisdom, exten- sive observation and careful study began to flourish. But the eagerness with which the people sought information, and the honor in which they held men of thought and wisdom, encour- d study, reflection and travel for the sake of knowledge, so that this class, in time, became extremely numerous. Their researches, and systems of what they held to be truth, were often imperfect, and, in many parts, false; but they were upright and earnest in the studies that were then possible, and did as much good, one might say, by their failures as by their successes. Inquirers, in after times, noted vohen and how they failed : so that all their pioneer work was useful — their mistakes for a warning, their success for instruction. 10. The course of Grecian development took two contrary directions, under the two leading states, Sparta and Athens. 7' » THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. The last represents the generally received idea of Greece — as a land where the people were lively and beautiful, intelligent and richly endowed with taste in the arts, or an exquisitely quick and thorough judgment of fitness, developed to the very highest point. Sparta, on the other hand, through its whole career, was a military state. Somewhere about one hundred years before the first Olympiad (B. C. 776), a lawgiver, named Lycurgns, had reformed the institutions of the Spartan state with the avowed and only object to render it capable of pro- ducing the most vigorous and hardy warriors. He made an equal distribution of lands, which were cultivated by the ancient inhabitants, reduced to slavery. They were called Helots, and were treated with great cruelty. Lycurgns abol- ished every species of luxury, subjected the young, both boys and girls, to the most rigorous training, and discouraged all the amenities of family and social life that he supposed might interfere with the rude hardiness of the soldier. The whole intelligence, activity and vigor of the Greek mind was, in this state, confined to military life. These institutions continued to exist in Sparta for more than five hundred years. Among any other race they would have secured to them the supreme dominion of the nation; but among this liberty loving people they merely sufficed to render them the general leaders in war, and one, only, among the most powerful and respectable Greek states. Besides, this experiment shows that there is little real advantage in systematically trampling down the native instincts of humanity in order to promote superiority in a particular direction. 11. The entirely spontaneous character of the Athenians made them, in general, the equal of the Spartans in military fame, and gloriously eminent in many other directions. But the various members of the Greek nation seem to have been made, by their intelligence and the earnestness, the completeness, of all their lines of development, the pioneers of humanity in their experiments. They exhausted all the capacities of a com- plete military education in an entire state, and presented the THE GRECIAN STATES. 71 most perfect achievements of a genius that had no models to commence on, in poetry, in painting, in Bculpture, in philoso- phy and in such elements of science as were possible to human- ity in their day. It is worthy of remark that most of the Greek colonies, the Fhenicians and their colonies, and a great part of the numer- ous nations in Italy became republican about the same time — as did the Romans later — and that those states which pre- served hereditary monarchy, or tyrants — as those kings were called who were elected by the populace — had counterbalanced the individual despotism of the kingly office by various insti- tutions that controlled and limited it. 12. At the period when history began to be carefully writ- ten and dates accurately given, civilization was under full career and rapidly moving westward. The Greeks had been struggling with the difficulties of the early times for more than a thousand years and had already begun to mature the insti- tutions and to show the traits of character that afterwards made them so eminent and so useful in advancing the progress of mankind. The Tyrians, or commercial people of Phenicia, had formed the net- work of communication with all the parts of the earth then sufficiently civilized to produce anything which could be useful to the rest of the world, and Italy was alive with the energies of the primitive races, mainly Aryan — some of them transplanted from the East, and possessing many of the highest elements of the ancient culture — who fought the Romans with a vigor and.persistence that contrib- uted much to the discipline and strong development of that remarkable people, to whose instruction the Greek colonies in eastern Italy added not a little. From this point the advance of the center of development toward the western continent, and of mental preparation for more perfect ideals of government was continuous. A more complete view of this progress will be gained by considering the general events of each century apart, or in chronolog order. i 2 THK FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 13. B. C. 776. This is the first definite and positive date in reliable history and commences the First Olympiad. The Olympic religious and national festival was celebrated by foot and chariot races, boxing, wrestling, etc., and was commenced by religious sacrifices and ceremonies, mainly in honor of the Apollo. This peaceable assembly of all the representa- tive* of the Grecian race was one of the chief means of main- taining the national union, and greatly promoted the main- tenance and importance of a kind of national congress, called the Aniphictyonic League. The first object of this League was the protection of their common worship; but it came to have, afterward, considerable importance as a political body; its decrees having the character and force of the Laws of Na- tions in modern times. It was composed of two delegates from each of the twelve leading states of Greece, and held two meetings yearly; one at Delphi, where was a celebrated tem- ple and oracle of Apollo, and one at Thermopylae. The twelve chief cities of the yEolian colonies of Greece in Asia Minor, and also the same number of Ionian colonies on the same coast more to the south, had each Amphictyonic, or International Leagues; but the Greeks from all the various regions they settled, as well as from the mother country, took a pride in participating in the Olympic games. 14. B. C. 753. This is one of the most important dates in the history of mankind. In this year, Rome, " The Eternal City." was founded by a band of adventurers and outlaws, under the lead of the twin brothers, Romulus and Remus. A spirit of adventure was the most characteristic feature of that era, in Greece and about the Mediterranean sea, together with a passion for colonizing, or founding new states. Educa- tion, or growth, seems to pursue parallel lines in the same era, - 1 that the same general tendencies move the masses of widely Beparated nations. Greece began, at this period, to send out a large number of colonists, in rapid succession, to Italy and the islands of the Mediterranean. The tendencj 7 had com- menced more than three centuries before, but the colonies had •I HE GRECIAN STATES. . :. not gone far from the native state, and only one bad been es tablished in Italy, at Cumse. Carthage, a commercial colony of the Tyrians, had been founded 127 years before, and was bow beginning to rival the parent city. Koine gathered its popnla'tion from all the neighboring states. The mingling of races has always been favorable to the progress of mankind. A single race, isolating itself and receiving no new blood or impulses from without becomes stationary and fixed in all its habits and advancement ceases beyond a certain point. The men who founded Rome were, apparently, a crowd of adventurers who had resolved to found a state After building the walls of their city and providing themselves with habitations, they were destitute of wives erious want which would soon leave their new citv without inhabitants. They remedied it in true Roman style — by vio- lence. They made a festival without the walls to celebrate the founding of their state, and invited their nearest neighbor-, the Sabines, to take part in it. The Sabines came with their wives and daughters. At a concerted moment the young Romans each seized a young Sabine woman, and carried her off into the city; the gates were closed and each proceeded to make his captive his wife. The Sabines were powerless to prevent the deed, but they soon made war on their violent sons-in-law, and the young city would have been destroyed but for the interference of' the stolen women who had become satisfied with the bold deed which gave them valiant husbands. The Sabines were induced to unite with the young state so far as to build a new city adjoining and take part in its rising fortunes. Romulus was elected king by his followers, but popular institutions were established to limit his power, under the strong instinct of vigorous organization that, from the first, characterized tin new nation. The people maintained their right to make laws in conjunction with the king, and preserved a limited mon- archy for 250 years. At this time the prophet Isaiah flour- 7-i THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. islied in Judea, and the kingdom of Samaria was approaching extinction. 15. B. C. 747. The Chaldeans established, or revived, their dominion in Babylon, under their king, Nabonassur, and seem to have been independent of Assyria for a time, but after- ward to have been brought into a qualified subjection to that enterprising monarchy. It commences authentic history in the East, so far as well ascertained dates are concerned. In that year the Chaldean astronomers or priests, first introduced the Egyptian solar year, which furnished an accurate mode of measuring time. This was about the commencement of the Sixth Olympiad. Egypt was approaching its most perfect condition under its ancient system. B. C. 743. Messenian war of 23 years — Sparta conquers Messene. 16. B. C. 735. A colony from Corinth founded the cele- brated city of Syracuse in Sicily, and a fashion of colonizing seems to have obtained in Greece, which continued for a hun- dred years. The native enterprise of the Greeks, the great increase of inhabitants in their small territory, and the com- motions and contests of parties in their states, which preceded the establishment of more complete popular governments, were probably the ruling causes of these foreign emigrations, and all contributed to the increase of knowledge, improvement in navigation, and the prevalence of a commercial spirit. Mi- letus, the leading Greek city of Ionia, in Asia Minor, became almost as powerful and prosperous by her commerce as Tyre in her best days. There were Grecian colonies on the coast of Africa west of Egypt, on the eastern coast of Italy, several in Sicily, one in France. They were, generally, very enterprising and prosperous, and diffused Greek intelligence and culture over ;i large part of the world as known at that time. They usually established a republican government. Syracuse re- mained republican for 251 years. 17. B. C. 728. The Assyrian Empire was now having its palmiest days, and spreading its dominion over all the central THE GEEI l a.n mai i -. 75- parts of western Asia, from the Mediterranean to the Persian Gulf. At this tiiu.' Shalman-assur, or Shalinaneser, the king of Assvria, led away the Ten Tribes of Israel into a hopel< captivity, and planteda different race in Samaria. Soon after this time the Ethiopians from the upper Nile estahlished their dominion in Egypt, without apparently changing the general condition of things there. Three Ethiopian kings successively reigned in Egypt, and made conquests in Asia to Borne extent. 18. B. C. 600. About the beginning of this century the foundation of Greek philosophy was laid by Thales of Miletus, a Greek city in Asia, lie represents the growth and acuteness- of the Greek mind and the approach of its period of greatest activity, lie travelled into Egypt in search of wisdom, and was the most able astronomer of his times, lie calculated an eclipse of the sun, which, coming on just when two armies, the Median and Lydian, were about to engage in battle, so terrified them that they immediately separated and made peace. He was celebrated as a mathematician, and taught many truths concerning the existence of God which were far in advance of his time, and undertook to account for the origin of all things in a very bold and independent manner. He was one of the famous " Seven Wise Men " of Greece. Solon was held to be the first among the seven, lie was an Athenian law-giver and writer, and established a very wise and enlightened system of government in Athens, lie was a pure-hearted and clear- sighted man, enjoying the universal respect of the Greeks. Chilo, another of the seven, was a Spartan magistrate, held in the highest esteem for his wisdom. Pittacus of WEitylene, was a law-giver, held in high honor. Bias of Prieue, in Ionia, was a very noble-hearted and public-spirited citizen, of univer- sal reputation for wisdom. Oleobulus, of the island of Rhodes. was remarkable for his skill in answering difficult questions, and Periander of Corinth, the ruler, or tyrant, of that pli was the last of the seven. They were all living at the >ame time. They were only the most eminent among a people who could fully appreciate mental ability. The spirit of inquiry 76 Till. F00TPBINT8 OF TIME. continued to spread rapidly for two hundred years, when the greatest masters, who immortalized themselves and their race l»v their genius, appeared. 19. In the early part of this century the kingdom of l.vdia, in the central part of Asia Minor, rose to great wealth and power. The Lydian kingdom was ancient — many of its customs being similar to those of the Egyptians — and the Etrurians of Italy, a much more polished and cultivated people than the Romans who conquered them, are thought, by some eminent historians, to have been a Lydian colony planted in Italy in unknown times. The Lydian kings made war on the Asiatic Greek colonies and reduced many of them to subjection. Croesus, the last king of Lydia, was prover- bial for his vast wealth. He was conquered by Cyrus, the Persian, in the middle of the next century. c»79 B. C. Numa, the second king of Rome, is said to have died. The Romans abstained from war during nearly the whole of his reign, which was occupied in settling the inter- nal affairs of the new state, especially those relating to religion. He was followed by Tullus Hostilius, a very war- like prince, who did much to extend the Roman state. 20. About 650 B. C. a great change was introduced into Egypt, by Psammeticus, its king, who, having several rival claimants to the throne, employed the services of Greek sol- diers to overcome them. For the first time the country was freely opened to foreigners, and the power of the priesthood broken. Thus the Greeks were instrumental in changing the current of Egyptian history. The Median Kings began to make head in the east, and ventured — after various successful efforts to extend their dominion in other directions — to make direct war on Nin- eveh. At the close of the century, by the aid of the rebel- lion- Xabopolassar, they succeeded in taking and destroying that city, and the whole of that immense empire was divided between Media and Kabopolassar, who made Babylon his capital. THE GRECIAN STATES. 77 21. B. C. 590 to 500. Events in this century begin to crowd thick upon each other. The Greeks rapidly advanced; the Romans succeeded, amid constant wars, in securely estab- lishing their state in Italy, marching from conquest to con- quest, not without heavy reverses at times, from which they soon recovered. 598 — Nebuchadnezzar took Jerusalem for the first time. 594 — Solon was made archon at Athens, with almost unlim- ited power to change the existing institutions, and he introduced many very useful reforms. 588 — Jerusalem was destroyed by Nebuchadnezzar, and the Jews carried into captivity to Babylon, where they remained seventy years. Soon after, Nebuchadnezzar conquered Tyre, after a siege of many years, but he found himself in possession of the walls only, for the inhabitants had built another city on an island near by, but inaccessible to the conqueror, and left him a barren conquest. 5(50 — The most memorable event that followed was the union of Media and Persia under the military prowess of Cyrus. He first employed the forces of the Medo- Persian kingdom in Asia Minor, conquering Lydia and the rest of that region, 549 — an d dethroning Croesus. Babylon and Egypt had both entered into an alliance with Croesus against Cyrus, but before they could send Croesus effectual aid Cyrus had triumphed. He then turned his arms against Babylon 538 — Which he took by stratagem after a long siege. Egypt was afterward obliged to become tributary to the uni- versal conqueror. 534. — Cyrus, who had before been the Persian general of the united armies under the Median king, Cyaxares, who was his maternal uncle, succeeded to the kingdom, and soon after sent the Jews home to their native land. During this period the Greeks swarmed on the eastern "^ THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. part of the Mediterranean sea and carried on nearly all its commerce, the Tynans being mainly confined to the trade with India, Arabia and the various parts of the Persian empire. 529 — Occurred the death of Cyrus, full of years and glory. History has described him as the most amiable of all the great conquerors. He was succeeded by his son, Cambyses, who, to punish the revolt of the Egyptians 525 — invaded that country and made it a Persian province. 522 — Cambyses died and was succeeded by a Persian noble- man, Darius Hystaspes, the line of Cyrus being extinct. He finally broke the power of the priesthood in his dominions, which perished at once in Egypt and Bab- ylon, where they had so long reigned supreme over the minds of men. 515 — The second temple was dedicated at Jerusalem. 510 — In this year occurred a very important event in Roman history — the establishment of the republic. Kings had reigned there two hundred and forty-three years. SECTION VI. THE ROMAN REPUBLIC. 1. The Romans, more than any other people of ancient times, understood how to establish a well ordered state. Res- pect for order and law among them was very great. The idea of a government with a definite constitution, which the rulers should always respect, and which should be an adequate bul- wark to the people against oppression, had never occurred to any of the Asiatic nations. The nearest approach to it among the Greeks was in Sparta; but as their aim was directed, not so much to the general welfare of the state as to training a race of soldiers, their experiment was a failure. The Greeks had a great impatience of subjection; they had no great ambi- tion to rule, but were impulsive, and each state wanted freedom to pursue its own particular fancy. Their exhaustless energy Till. ROMAN REPUBLIC. 79 and acute minds wove devoted to the pursuit of idea] objects. Even the sober and resolute Spartan put aside every other con- sideration in order to realize his idea of a well formed, thor- oughly trained, and invincible warrior. Weakly and deformed children were destroyed in their infancy, by order of the state. The young women were subjected to the most rigorous physical training, that they might become mothers of hardy children. Physical training was one of the passions of all Greece, originating in their delight in beauty and symmetry of person. Sports that contributed to this were as pleasing to the Greeks as to our modern school-bovs. 2. Athens, which most perfectly represented the Grecian mind, esteemed a fine poet, an able writer, a skillful painter or sculptor, as much as an enthusiastic scholar of our day can do. They had a passion for beauty, and their love of liberty was in great part produced by their ardent longing for mental freedom and the gratification of their mental tastes. The wor- ship of their gods was chiefly their admiration for superhu- man majesty, sublimity, and beauty, as they conceived them, and their theology was compounded of their thirst for knowledge and their love of the mysterious, the grand, the terrible, and the beautiful. Life was of no value to them, if they could not gratify these instincts, and their tenacity in maintaining their liberties found its inspiration in them. They were a nation of mental enthusiasts. They had no love of conquest for the sake of power. They were invaded by the Persians, and a handful of Greeks conquered its im- mense hosts with ease, by their intelligence and ardor. It was only when they saw the splendor and wealth of the East, and felt that they could repeat the glorious deeds of their mythic heroes, that they became enthusiastic over the romantic idea of conquering a magnificent empire. It was the mental charm of the undertaking that gave to Alexander his miraculous success. But the Greeks were not practical. They wanted worldly wisdom. The Lacedemonians of Sparta had no adequate THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. object when they sacrificed almost all that common human- ity holds dear, to rear up model soldiers. Their ambition confined mainly to preserving the headship of their state among the petty republics of Greece; and the resources of all the states were wasted in the effort to preserve a bal- ance of power among the various members of the nation ; or in struggles of the more powerful to obtain a leading influ- ence. They had little political wisdom, when the independ- ence of their territories was secured and the governments that restrained them too much from their favorite enthusiasms were abolished. Athens and all Greece admired immensely the wise measures of Solon, when he reformed the govern- ment and gave it excellent laws. But they had not the prudence to maintain them. In ten years all was again confusion. Most of their great men who possessed a special genius for govern- ment, were abandoned when they showed the most ability for benefitting their country by their wise statesmanship. Per- icles alone, who was the most perfect embodiment of Gre- cian character, preserved his influence to the last; but it was by falling in perfectly with the tone of Grecian feeling, and he laid the foundation of innovations that corrupted and finally overthrew their liberty. He was as little practical and prudent as his countrymen. Beautiful in person, cultivated in mind, sessed of exquisite taste in literature and art, to which he devoted himself with boundless enthusiasm, Greece could always appreciate him. His age was the glory and joy of Greece; but when more homely political virtues were required to preserve his creations and protect this literary and artistic state, the people could not follow them. Their best statesmen were ostracised, banished, or slain, when their practical genius was most needed. 3. Kmne was the opposite of this. She had a genius for producing and preserving a constitution, adding to it by slow degrees, maintaining checks and balances that preserved the machinery in working order, and rendered it capable of pro- ducing the most valuable results that were possible in those THE ROMAN REPUBLIC. * I times. To rule was her passion. She was not wanting in intelligence, hnt it was the homely prudence of common life, the skill to adapt means to ends. Of all the nations, she was the first to carry organization into every part of her government, and conduct everything by inexorable system and order. If Rome was resolved to rule others, she was no less resolved to rule herself. The mission of Greece was in tho domain of thought, to develop the intellectual capabil- ities of mankind. That of Rome also required intelligence, but of a lower and more material kind. She was to teach mankind to follow an orderly development, to introduce system, to prevent ruinous clashing of interests, to teach respect for law. Greece taught the world to think to purpose; Rome to govern with effect. Each served an important pur- pose. Without either the world was not prepared for Christi- anity, which added moral order, nor for true science, which was the mature fruit of these three, and prepared the perfect civilization which was to be developed to its conclusion in a New World. 4. Rome commenced, not with the king, but with the Senate — a body of experienced men, who made the laws and appointed a king to administer them. The king, except in time of war, was only the executive, the chief magistrate. The later kings were restive under this restraint and sought to place themselves above law, and the Romans at once dis- missed them, appointing various officers to fill their place. The fundamental principles of government were not changed at ail, or very little, except by the subsequent course of develop- ment. The Romans knew how to adapt their invincible spirit of order to all changing circumstances, and when external ehanges arose corresponding changes were developed, in a regular manner, within. Thus the Roman spirit was constant under the regal gov- eminent, throughout the republic, and to the close of the empire, and had then become so thoroughly established in laws and institutions as to govern the development of the new 6 82 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. states that rose out of its ruins and produced modern civil- ization. At first the Roman government consisted only of the Senate and the king. The Senate was chosen from the body of citi- zens, and represented them. ' In the course of time the descendants of the first people became the aristocracy, called patricians, who enjoyed great privileges. A class was gradu- ally formed called the plebs, or common people, who, for some time, had no share in the government. The patricians alone could hold office, and marriage between them and plebians was illegal. But, says an able writer, "the Roman commons were the greatest commons the world ever saw, except the commons of England and America." In the course of time, by wise and prudent management, and taking advantage of favoring circumstances, resulting from the fact that they sup- plied the body of soldiers to the state, without revolution, breaking the laws, or violating the ancient constitution, they obtained changes or additions to it, one after another, until they had acquired a due influence in the conduct of affairs and became fully a match for the patricians. It was a new lesson to mankind, and one that has had great influence on the good order of .society in all later times. 5. The religious system of that great people was conducted with as much worldly prudence as all their other affairs. Their religious ceremonies were, in great part, derived from the Etruscans. They were conducted with much pomp by state officers, appointed for the purpose, embodying all the superstitions of the time, and embracing comparatively little of the lofty sentiment that was so prominent in Greece. Their religion was an affair of state, and intimately connected with the political working of the government. The gravest public business was made to depend on the flight of birds, on omens and accidents, and on the appearance of the entrails of the animals offered in the sacrifices. An artful use of these circumstances enabled the officers in power to compass many political ends. Their original gods were those of Greece, GREECE AND SOME. 83 adapted to their purposes and national character; but they readily adopted the divinities of all the nations they con- quered. Their religion was in a high degree cool and calcu- lating. The preceding observations apply especially to the periods of Greece and Koine when their peculiarities were most fully developed in the days of their greatest glory. Though always more or less characteristic, in later times they melted more or less into one another, or were toned down and transformed by decay and a rising spirit of innovation. Especially were they displaced by Christianity. SECTION VII. GREECE AND ROME. * 1. We are now prepared to return to the year 500 B. C. — and follow events in chronological order, with a fair appreciation of their import. Just before the close of the last century, Darius Hystaspes, the king of Persia, sent an army into Europe, to the north of Greece, to chastise the Scythians, and it conquered Thrace. The Greek colonies in Asia Minor, which had been recently added to the Persian empire, became restive under foreign control, and when the Persian army returned home, 500 — organized a rebellion and took and burned the city of Sardis, the ancient capital of Lydia. They were assisted by the European Greeks; but the vast resources of Persia soon enabled Darius to take vengeance on them, and Miletus was besieged and destroyed. Darius sum- moned the Grecian states to offer their submission, but Athens and Sparta sent back a defiance. Darius there- upon gathered a large armament and prepared to invade 495 — Greece, which he commenced by the conquest of Mace- don. But a tempest destroyed his ships and 20,000 men, and the expedition returned to Persia. In the 84 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. eame year the Roman plebeians obtained their first suc- cess against the patricians, by which the debts of the poor plebeians to the wealthy patricians were cancelled and Tribunes of the People appointed. 490 — This year the glory of Greece broke forth. Darius having sent another and larger army into Greece, it advanced on Athens and encamped at Marathon, within twenty-two miles of the city. The Persian host was said to number from 100,000 to 200,000 men. The Athenians had but 10,000 citizens, but armed 20,000 slaves, and the city of Plateea sent them 1,0U0 troops. Miltiades, the very able Athenian general, marched out and, taking a good position, offered battle. It was the 20th of September. The little army of the Greeks obtained a complete victory and the Persians returned home in confusion. The great services of Miltiades were rewarded with imprisonment, on a frivolous charge, and he died there of his wounds. 485 — Darius Hystaspes, the Persian king, died while prepar- ing a still larger armament for the invasion of Greece. 484 — An insurrection in Egypt completely subdued by the Persians. 480 — Xerxes, king of Persia, invaded Greece with a million soldiers. The battle at the pass of Thermopylae was fought by a thousand Spartans under Leonidas, their king, and all but one slain. The Persian fleet was beaten the same day by Themistocles, the Athenian admiral. Xerxes soon advanced on Athens, which was abandoned by its inhabitants and burned by the Persians. Soon after, Themistocles fought the Persian navy again at Salamis and totally destroyed it. Xerxes, leaving a large army in Greece, returned to Asia. 479 — The battle of Platsea ended the Persian invasion. The allied Greek army numbered 70,000, under Pausanias, the Spartan king; the Persians 300,000. The Persians are said to have had 200,000 slain, and their army was GREKOK A.NI) KOMK. 8i> totally routed. Another victory was gained on the coast of Asia Minor the same day, and the last rem- nants of the Persian fleet destroyed. 478 — Athens was rebuilt and surrounded with walls from the treasures of the conquered Persians. This was the age of great men in Greece. Phidias, her greatest sculptor, flourished at this time. The Persians, at the time of their first invasion, brought a piece of marble to com- memorate the victory of which they were confident. The Greeks caused Phidias to produce out of it a statue of Nemesis, the goddess of vengeance, and set it upon the field of Marathon. 478 — Themistocles died in banishment about this time, and Aristides of old age. Both were leading statesmen and generals of Athens during the Persian war. 470 — Socrates, the most eminent philosopher of all ancient times, was born this year. " — The death of Xerxes by assassination occurred this year. 466 — Cimon, son of Miltiades, was now the great man of Athens. He was soon superseded by Pericles. From 480 B. C. to 430 was the golden period of Athens. She was pre-eminent politically, conducting the war of the Grecian allies against Persian supremacy on the western shores of Asia and in the Mediterranean sea. Repub- lican liberty was everywhere predominant. The great- est writers, painters and sculptors lived in this period or immediately after it. Socrates, Plato, Aristotle, philosophers; iEschylus, Sophocles, Euripides, tragic poets; Zeuxis and Apelles, painters; and Phidias in sculpture, were a few among the many great names which are found in or immediately following this period. 457 — Cincinnatus was made dictator at Rome. During this period the Romans laid the foundation of their domin- ion over all Italy by waging successful war with the Etruscans and Samnites, the most vigorous and power- ful of their opponents. 86 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 450 — The Decemvirate was appointed at Rome. They were ten magistrates empowered to produce a more perfect code. It was called the " Laws of the Twelve Tables." The plebeians about this time succeeded in wresting important privileges from the patricians, which more equally balanced the different powers of the state. 2. Athens was the centre of civilization, and Greek culture and ideas were penetrating all the nations in her vicinity. Rome was rapidly developing and Carthage was at the summit of her glory. She had control . of much of the Spanish or Iberian peninsula. Persia, after absorbing all the old mon- archies of the east, was declining. The "march of empire" was distinctly defining its "westward course." It was about the middle of this century that Herodotus, the " Father of History," was rising to fame, and a few years later Xenophon, the Greek general and historian, was born. Thu- cydides, another historian, dates from this period. The great career of history now fairly commenced. 443 — Herodotus emigrated from Halicarnassus, in Asia, to Greece. 431 — The Peloponnesian war, a bitter contest between Athens and Sparta, commenced. It lasted twenty-three years, and was again revived, ending in the conquest of Athens by Sparta. This war was followed, after some time, by the rise of the power of Thebes, under their famous general, Epaminondas, who broke the power of Sparta- Thebes sunk into insignificance after his death, and Philip of Macedon commenced the subjugation of all Greece. He was followed bv Alexander the Great, who, in return for the loss of republican liberty, rendered Greece illustrious by conquering the Persian empire, and imbuing all the Eastern World with its philosophy and arts. For all these great events one hundred years were required. 429 — The death of the illustrious Pericles occurred in this year. GREECE AND SOME. 87 " — Plato, the disciple of Socrates, and, in some points, superior to him in mental discipline, was born. 420 — About this time Alcibiades, the nephew of Pericles, became prominent in Athenian affairs. lie had bril- liant powers, but little principle. 40(5 — The battle of JSgospotamos, gained by Lysander the Spartan, broke the power of Athens. 404 --Athens M-as taken by Lysander, its walls demolished, and the government of the "Thirty Tyrants" estab- lished by the Spartans. Alcibiades, banished from Athens, was assassinated by the Persians, at the insti- tution of the Spartans. 401 — Occurred the battle of Cunaxa, in Babylonia, between Cyrus, the brother of Artaxerxes, king of Persia, and that king. Cyrus, who had been governor, or satrap, in Asia Minor, gathered a large army including more than 10,000 Greeks. Cyrus was killed and his own army defeated, but the Greeks repelled all assaults. Their generals having been decoyed into the power of the Persians, on the plea of making terms with them, were treacherously slain. The army appointed other commanders, chief among whom was Xenophon, after- w rd the celebrated historian, and they made good their return to Greece. It was finely described by Xeno- phon, and known as the " Eetreat of the Ten Thou- sand." 400 — Socrates taught doctrines too pure and high-toned for his countrymen to understand, and was condemned to drink poison, as a dangerous man and despiser of the gods, in the 70th year of his age. The Athenians soon repented it. 396 — The capital of Veii, taken by the Romans, ended the contest with the Etruscans. 3S9 — Rome was conquered and, except the capitol, destroyed, by the Gauls under Brennus. The barbarians soon retired and the city was rebuilt. 88 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 384 — Aristotle, the most learned of the Grecian philosophers, was born at Stagira, in Macedon. He laid the founda- tion of scientific study, and was the tutor of Alexander the Great. 371 — Epaminondas defeated the Spartans at Leuctra, and 362 — Again at Mantinea, where he was killed. 3fin — Philip became king of Macedon, and soon began to undermine the liberties of Greece in a very artful way. 357 — The "Sacred War" against the Phocians, who had plundered the temple of Apollo, at Delphi, com- menced. 356 — Birth of Alexander the Great. Rutilius, the first pie- bean dictator at Rome. 349 — Death of Plato, the brightest light of Grecian philos- ophy. He systematized and enlarged the doctrines of Socrates. 338 — Occurred the battle of Chaeronea between Philip and the allied Athenians and Thebans. The Greeks were totally defeated and their liberty lost. Demosthenes, the most celebrated orator of the Greeks, spent his whole life and his magnificent eloquence in the efTort to rouse the Greeks against Philip; but Philip was too craftv and the Greeks too little accustomed to act in concert. For nearly a hundred years the states of Greece had been exhausted by wars among themselves, and they were too weary of fighting to make the necessary effort against so powerful and skillful an adversary. 336 — Philip was assassinated on the eve of an expedition against Persia, as chief of the Grecian states. This popular idea consoled them for the loss of liberty. Alexander succeeded his father. 335 — Thebes rebelled against Alexander, and he took and destroyed that ancient city. 334 — Alexander carried out the project of his father and invaded the Persian empire. The battle of the Granicus, his first great victory, took place this year. GREECE AND ROME. 89 333 — Darius, the Persian king, was again thoroughly defeat- ed in the battle of Issus. Damascus, in Syria, was taken and Tyre besieged by Alexander. 332 — Tyre was taken and finally destroyed, and Alexandria, at the mouth of the Nile, founded. 331 — A final battle at Arbela, in Assyria, overthrew the Persian Empire. Darius escaped, but was murdered by Bessus, one of his officers. Four years were spent by the Greeks in subduing the wild tribes on the east- ern border of the Empire, and settling the government of these vast conquests. 327 — Alexander invaded India and was constantly triumph- ant till his soldiers refused to go farther from home. They had grown tired of conquering, and Alexander reluctantly returned to Babylon to consolidate his gov- ernment. 323 — Alexander died of a fever, the result of excessive drink- ing. He left no heir, and his generals divided his empire. 322 — The Samnites obtained a temporary success by surpris- ing a .Roman army in a narrow defile of the mountains called the Candine Forks, and subjected it to a humili- ating capitulation. The Romans never bowed before misfortune or defeat. They prosecuted the war with invincible resolution until the Samnite power ' was wholly broken, a contest, in all, of about 50 years, which was soon followed by the complete subjugation of the whole peninsula. 3. In this year died the two greatest Grecians, Demos- thens, the orator, by suicide; and Aristotle, by old age. On the death of Alexander, Demosthenes aroused the Athenians to make a stand for their liberties. Few of the Grecian states joined them and they were totally defeated by Antipater, the governor appointed by Alexander. Demosthenes avoided punishment by taking poison. The Achaian League, about forty years after, maintained the liberties of Greece for fifty 90 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. years or more, which then fell before the invincible Romans. Fur many years all the eastern world was in confusion from the struggles of competitors for the Empire of Alexander. Ptolemy established himself soon and firmly in Egypt, and Seleucus, after various 312 — Reverses, obtained full possession of the eastern parts of the empire, Babylonia, Assyria and Persia. This year is called the era of the Seleucidae. Asia Minor and Greece were a scene of the greatest confusion for seventy years, so far as rulers were concerned. But nearly all these were Greeks, and Greek culture and philosophy exerted a wide spread influence. In the end it became fully evident that the want of genius in the Greek mind to organize, and steadiness in Greek char- acter to sustain, settled institutions was absolute. They had, at different times, men of the greatest ability, but when they passed away their plans and institutions perished with them. The acute and accomplished Greeks were ever children in the science of govern- ment, and the advent of Rome alone, whose special skill was in government, saved the world from irre- trievable anarchy or fatal despotism. 300 — The Roman plebeans completed their struggle for con- stitutional liberty by acquiring a share in the priestly office, which was essential to the full value of their other victories over the patricians, and the Roman con- stitution was complete. It was maintained very fairly for more that one hundred and fifty years, when the spoils of their conquests corrupted the virtue of the citizens and produced the internal disorder that, about a century later still brought about the establishment of the Roman Empire. Yet the forms of government, municipal and other regulations, and the administra- tion of justice, though often interfered with in particu- lar cases, were so well settled on sound principles, and secured so uniformly the welfare of society, that they GREECE AND ROME. 91 were preserved longest from general ruin, and revived first in more modern times. Greek thought and cul- ture, and Roman law remained indestructible. 290 — The Samnites, Sabines and Gauls, being all defeated, Home was virtually mistress of Italy, although the Grecian cities on the eastern coast remained to be sub- dued. They had little strength in themselves against a power so warlike, and invited Pyrrhus, the king of 281 — Epirus, to their assistance. He twice defeated the Roman consuls, but they inflicted on him so much loss that they vainly offered him battle immediately after, and rejected all his overtures to treat for peace. He was at length vanquished and obliged to abandon Italy to the Republic. 4. The Romans soon subdued all opposition and began to look about for other lands to conquer. 264 — The Carthaginians, on the opposite coast of Africa, had become a colossal power, and sought to establish their control over Sicily — not an easy task, since it had many colonies of Greeks whose national spirit and bravery did not desert them. In this year a call for assistance from a plundering band who had captured a Greek city, a part of whom had also invited Carthaginian aid, brought Rome and Carthage in conflict. The Cartha- ginians were enraged at this interference with an island which they had long intended to make their own, and raised an immense army to drive out the intruders. The Romans defeated the army and took Agrigentum, one of the best strongholds of the Carthaginians on the island. 260 — The Carthaginians were masters of the sea, and the Romans had little knowledge of naval affairs. Taking a Carthaginian vessel which had been driven ashore for a model, they, in a short time, created a fleet and worsted their enemies on their own special element. 92 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 256 The Romans again defeated the Carthaginians in a sea fight near the island of Lipara. 255 — The Romans determined to carry the war into Africa, and fitting out a large fleet, inflicted a still heavier loss on the Carthaginian armaments, landed in Africa and defeated an immense army. The Carthaginians sued for peace, but the terms proposed by Regulus, the Roman general, were so severe that they resolved to continue the war. A Grecian general, Xanthippus, took command of their army and totally defeated the Romans, taking Regulus prisoner, and destroying or 248 — capturing all his army but 2000. The Romans lost three fleets by storms, but conquered once in a sea fight, and defeated an army in Sicily. The Carthagini- ans again sought peace, but the Romans would not abate their first terms, and continued the war until the 240 — Carthaginians, completely humbled, accepted the severe alternative of submission or destruction. The temple of Janus, the god of war, never shut but in time of absolute peace, was now closed for the second time since the building of the city. The people, whose special occupation was war, soon grew tired of peace, and carried on various conflicts with the Gauls settled at the foot of the Alps in the 227 — north of Italy. They invaded Illyria, on the east coast of the Adriatic Sea, whose people were very trouble- some pirates. This war was again renewed with a more complete defeat of the Illyrians. They had before this subdued Sardinia and Corsica. 219- The Carthaginians pursued their conquests in Spain, and the celebrated Hannibal took Saguntum, which 218 — brought on the second Punic war, as the war with Car- thage was termed. 217 — Hannibal, with great celerity, crossed the Pyrenees and the Alps — having first completed the conquest of GREECK AND ROME. 93 Spain — and defeated the Romans in the battle of Tici- nus, and again at Trebia. 217 — The Achaian confederacy, now in the height of its glory in maintaining the liberties of Greece, united all the Greeks in a confederacy under the influence of Philip, king of Macedon, with the hope of arresting the power and ambition of Koine. 216 — Hannibal inflicted a dreadful defeat on the Romans near the Thrasymenean Lake. The Romans were greatly alarmed, and made Fabius Maximus dictator, whose habit of refusing a pitched battle, wearing out his adversary by skirmishes and cutting off his sup- plies, is called '-The Fabian Policy." This plan is, by maneuvering and delay, to wear out and destroy an invader in detail without peril of defeat in battle. The Romans kept armies in Spain to prevent the Car- thaginians from sending reinforcements to Hannibal. 215 — At the close of this year Fabius resigned his dictator- ship and the consuls appointed to succeed him aban- doned his policy. They offered battle to Hannibal at Cannse and the army was annihilated. 40,000 Romans were slain on the Held. These defeats had destroyed the flower of their fighting population, but Roman courage and resolution always rose with defeat. - They did not despair, but raised a fresh army and put Fabius again at its head, against whom the talents of Hannibal were vain. They fomented disturbances in Greece to keep Philip, King of Macedon at home, and beseiged Svracuse in Sicily, which had joined the Carthaginians, 212 — for three years, and then took it by stratagem. Ar- chimedes, a celebrated mathematician of Syracuse, who had protracted the siege by his ingenious and power- ful engines was killed in the sack of the city. Soon 210 — after the whole island was 6ubdued and remained a Ro- man province. 206 — Asdrubal, the brother of Hannibal, general of the Car- 94 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. thaginian forces in Spain, crossed the Pyrenees and the Alps to reinforce Hannibal, but was defeated by the Romans and slain before Hannibal knew of his march. 202 — Scipio, who had conquered in Spain, led an army into Africa, Hannibal being considered too formidable to attack, though his forces were very small. Scipio put 40,000 Numidians, allies of Carthage, to the sword, besieged the neighboring cities and defeated a large Carthaginian army. Hannibal was now called home to defend the metropolis. He fought a battle with raw 201 — troops, at Zama, and was defeated — 20,000 Carthagi- nians being slain. The Carthaginians begged for peace, Hannibal declaring that the war could not be protracted. The Roman terms left them little but their city. Such was the fruit of inflexible resolution. 5. The Romans are an example of a people, who, from first to last, had one clearly defined end, to which everything else was subservient. They formed their state for conquest, and that idea controlled the Kingdom, the Republic and the Em- pire. They were much wiser than the Spartans, for, devoting themselves to war, they meant to secure and enjoy all the fruits of conquest, and they did all that was possible to promote the prosperity of their people that they might produce warriors in abundance; but they relied mainly on actual war for disci- pline. They were constantly exercised in the art in the field and the orderly and sensible instinct of the race made disci- pline a matter of course. They were sometimes defeated when they encountered unfamiliar difficulties, or by the mistakes of their leaders, but never abandoned a purpose once adopted and never sued for peace. Morally, the object they set before them was entirely unjus- tifiable, according to the standard of national rights accepted in our day. But such a conception never entered the minds of men in the ancient times. It is the fruit of modern civil- ization alone. The Etonians, and many a nation after them, must work out the destructive consequences of that doctrine GREECE AM) ROME. 95 that "Might makes Right" before the universal ense of mankind would recoil from it. It was the accepted doctrine of the ancients, and lias not yet disappeared from the world. 197 — Sicily, Spain and Carthage were conquered, and Roman valor looked around for opportunities of winning fresh laurels. Philip of Macedon, an ambitious prince, threat- ened the Athenians, who implored help from Rome. An army immediately proceeded to Greece, penetrated into Macedonia, and completely defeated Philip at Cy- nocephalae. 6. The Romans were now the mightiest people in the civ- ilized world. Their obstinate contests with the vigorous na- tions of the West had often perilled the existence of their state, and a people of ordinary stamina and persistance would not, at the best, have risen above the rank of the Etruscans and Samnites, nor have made Rome greater than Syracuse or Car- thage. They, however, matured and grew into an invincible power, whose solid and stately grandeur struck the intelligent but unpractical Greeks with admiration, and all the old, peoples of the East with awe. The Romans were not without admiration for the ancient valor and the graceful culture of the Greeks. When, two hun- dred and fifty years before, the Romans revised their laws, un- der the Decern virate, they sent to Athens to obtain models from that republic. Athens was now treated by them with much consideration, and finally became the University City of the Empire. When Roman influence became paramount after the battle of Cynocephalre they did not at once proceed with brutal force against the land of Beauty and Art, but took it under their protection, and proclaimed the full liberty of the Grecian States. It filled the Greeks with transport, and for some time Rome played the noble and dignified pari of a disinterested protector; but when the Achaians, under their excellent and talented leader PhilopCBDien, Bought to realize the fact of liberty, the Romans abandoned that pretence and made Greece a Roman province. Thus the whole of Europe 96 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. that was sufficiently civilized to maintain a settled government was ruled by the .Roman Republic. The period of rude and restless valor among the Greeks was past. The stage of culti- vation they had reached inclined them to the quiet and elegant refinements of the scholar, and they readily received the Ro- man rule which suppressed the turbulanceof ambitious adven- turers and suffered no oppression but their own. The Romans represented the strength of the male element in human nature, the Greeks the grace of the female. They now coalesced, were married, so to speak, and the product of their union was, in the course of ages, modern civilization, which, when mature, was to share the eminent qualities of both. 7. The broken fragments of Alexander's immense empire in Western Asia and Egypt were all that now stood between Rome and the mastery of the world. The Roman people were too well convinced that it was their grand destiny to achieve universal dominion to hasten prematurely the con- quest of the primitive home of civilization. They watchfully waited until the course of events should throw the dominions of the Selencidse and the Ptolemys into their hands, without offending the majesty of the republic by an undignified vio- lence and haste. 190 — Antioehus the Great, who now reigned over the empire of the Seleucidte, with true Grecian imprudence, became ambitious of conquests in Europe. He invaded Greece 191 — and was defeated at Thermopylae by the Romans and driven into Asia. The younger Scipio, brother of the conqueror of Hannibal, followed and totally defeated 189 — him at Magnesia, in Asia Minor. He purchased peace by the loss of all the fruits of his ambition, but was left in possession of the Syrian kingdom. The failure „ to destroy so powerful an enemy appears to have brought on the two Scipios the rebuke of the repub- lic, the conqueror of Carthage having aided his brother in the war. They were condemned to a heavy tine, which Scipio Africanus refused to pay and went into GKEECE AND ROME. 183— exile, where lie died. His death occurred in the same year that Hannibal, pursued by the vengeance of the Romans for having aided Antiochus, committed suicide by taking poison to avoid falling into their hands; and in this year also Philopcemen, the last patriotic hero 170 — of Greece, was slain by his enemies. Perses, king of Macedon, revolted, and, after some successes, was finally overthrown under the walls of Pydna and dethroned. 168 — The Carthaginians could not altogether forget their ancient greatness, and Inning displeased the Romans by some independence of action, it was resolved to 148 — destroy their city. With the courage of despair they set the Romans at defiance, and defended themselves with a resolute bravery that engaged the lively sympa- thies of all after times for their painful fate. For two years they maintained the combat against their pitiless foes, who could pardon everything but rivalry in their 146 — sweeping ambition, and then perished in the ruins of their once glorious metropolis. A revolt of the Acha- ians was punished, in the same year, by the destruction of the splendid city of Corinth, in Greece. 140 — The embers of independence in Spain broke forth in war, which was checked by the assassination of Viriathes, a patriotic chieftain of great ability, and 133 — quenched in blood by the self-destruction of the citi zens of Numantium. About the same time the republic acquired the kingdom of Pergamus, cover- ing the richest parts of Asia Minor, by the will of Attains, its king, who, on his death, bequeathed it to Rome. This led, in a few years, to contests with the neighboring Asiatic sovereigns, and resulted, in about half a century, in the conquest and reduction into the state of Roman provinces of all Western Asia 7 98 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIM* SECTION VIII. DECAY OF THE ROMAN REPUBLIC. 1. But while Rome was thus steadily advancing to uni- rersal dominion, great and unfortunate changes were taking place in its internal constitution. The spoils of Carthage and the east, rich in accumulations of the industry, commerce and art of two thousand years, flowed into Rome and was gathered into the hands of those in power; the equilibrium between the plebeans and the patricians was lost; the selling of captives taken in war filled Italy with slaves; and the inequality of conditions produced the most disastrous conse- quences. 133 — The eldest son of a noble house, the Gracchi, under- took to stem the torrent that was sweeping away the ancient barriers of the constitution, and to raise the people from the misery into which the increase of patrician wealth and power and the innumerable mul- titudes of slaves had plunged them. In the year in which Numantia fell and Spain was thoroughly sub- dued, Tiberius Gracchus was slain in a tumult, pro- duced by the patricians, who determined that his project should not succeed. He had attempted to revive the old agrarian law, by which the landed pos- sessions of the republic were shared among the people as well as the patricians, which would have rescued the plebeans from poverty and oppression; but the patri- cians were too powerful and too violent. He was removed by assassination. 2. 121 — Twelve years later his brother, Caius Gracchus, attempted the same thing and was likewise slain. This point was vital to the internal liberties of Rome. The failure of the Gracchi announced the overthrow of the constitution; and, after seventy years of civil anarchy and the murderous conflict of rival factions, the empire was found the only refuge against the ruin DECAY OF THE ROMAN REPUBLIC. 99 of the state. Vigorous Koine, who could govern all the world but herself, must have a master, and became the prey of the strongest. It is a melancholy history, a sad conclusion for a people whose strength and gran- deur of character had made them masters of the world, but a perfectly legitimate result of the immoral prin- ciple that lay at the foundation of the state. That principle legalized the doctrine of force, or robbery on the grandest scale. They carried it out with great con- sistency and skill, with all the ability of a race emi- nently sagacious and steady in the pursuit of an end. The conservative force that dwelt in their organiza- tion, so instinctively and exceptionally wise, and the power of religious faith, strong in a hardy and simple people, however weakened by pagan ignorance and superstition, long maintained the integrity of their institutions — but Greek culture, too imperfect not to culminate in skepticism, came in to confuse their moral sense at the same time that boundless wealth flowed into their hands to corrupt their manners, that slavery assumed gigantic proportions to demoralize labor, and the conquest of the world relieved them from the severe discipline that might not, otherwise, have left them the leisure to become deeply vicious. The sternness of even Roman character was unequal to the heavy strain and virtue gave way. The native vigor of the race made them as excessive in imrestrained passion as wise in council and invincible in war. The cruelty and rapacity that were common in the civil wars of the Republic, and under many of the early emperors, educated giants in crime, and only the Roman spirit in the army, and the vigorous organization everywhere maintained through the institutions established in the subject world by Roman law, could have held its vast dominions together. Rome had vitality and sense to govern others, even in the midst of civil war. 100 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 3. From the death of the Gracchi to the consulship 107 — Of Marius, Koine was in a tumult of corrupt intrigue,, which rendered easy the usurpation and inhuman cruelty of Jugurtha, king of Numidia. Marius, a ple- bian of the lowest rank, became consul. He was unequaled at once as a general and a tyrant. He con- quered 106 — Jugurtha, who was brought to Rome and starved in prison. In the same year Cicero, the great Roman orator, was born. A vast horde of Cimbri and Teutons from northern 105 — Europe, invaded Gaul and defeated several Roman con- suls. 100 — Marius led an army against these barbarians and defeated them, more than 100,000 being slain or made prisoners. He was equally successful in a second engagement. During the w r ar 200,000 barbarians were slain and 90,000 taken prisoners. A revolt of the slaves was put down about the same time with circum- stances of extreme cruelty. More than a million of these unfortunates were slain or thrown to wild beasts for the amusement of the Roman populace. 4. 100 — In this year Julius Caesar, one of the greatest men of any time, and virtual founder of the Roman Empire, was born. His supreme ability put an end to civil dis- sention and saved society from total ruin. 90 — The Italian allies revolted against Rome. They claimed the privileges of Roman citizenship, which the Senate refused. A war of three years followed and half a million of men perished, when, having conquered them, the Senate granted their first request. 88 — Mithridates, king of Pontus, talented and ambitious, sought to drive the Romans out of Asia and Greece* and warred with them for twenty-five years. Sylla procured the banishment of his rival, Marius, and con- ducted the war against Mithridates. DECAY OF THE ROMAN REPUBLIC. 101 €6 — Marina regained power in the absence of Sylla and slaughtered his enemies, the patricians, without mercy, but soon after died. 83 — Sylla, after obliging Mithridates to sue for peace, hastened to Home, conquered his enemies, and slew more than 6,000 Roman citizens in revenge. 81 — Sylla caused himself to be made perpetual dictator 77 — But after three years resigned and soon after died from the effects of his vices. Civil war was continued for a time in Spain and Italy, but finally put down by Pom- 70 — pey, the greatest general of the patrician party. The war of the gladiators — men trained to fight in the theatres for the amusement of the populace — broke out under an able leader, Spartacus, who, collecting an army of 120,000 gladiators, endangered Koine itself, but 70 — he was conquered by Crassus. Spartacus was defeated and killed. It was the inhuman oppression of the patricians that produced all these dreadful conflicts. 65 — Pompey and Crassus, by paying court to the people, were made consuls. Pompey proceeded to Asia and made war on Mithridates, who was again formidable, 63 — whom he defeated and slew in battle. He subdued nearly all western Asia, visiting Jerusalem, and treat- ing the Jews with kindness. He also cleared the Med- iterranean of pirates, who had always infested it. 62 — A dangerous conspiracy of Cataline, a patrician of the most corrupt morals, at the head of the depraved young nobility of the time, would have been successful but for the ability and eloquence of Cicero, who was consul. Cataline and his fellow conspirators were taken and slain. 59 — Caesar, Pompey, and Crassus formed the first "Trium- virate," and divided the rule of the world between them. Csesar was the head of the popular party. He 57 — took Gaul as his government. Here he spent eight years in his " Gallic wars," showing unparalleled talent6 102 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. as a general, training his army to become invincible in battle, and completely subduing the fierce Gauls. He 55 — entered Britain and laid the foundation of civiliza- tion there, thus carrying the march of empire to its farthest bounds in Europe. 5. 49 — He was ordered to return and lay down his authori- ty by the Roman Senate, headed by Pompey, who was now his enemy. They were the rival champions of the two parties in the state, the people and the patricians, whose quarrels had so long filled Rome with tumult and slaughter. The tribunes in Caesar's interest inter- posed a veto, which the Roman Constitution authorized them to do. The Senate voted to suspend the Consti- tution, which really terminated the Roman Republic, Jan. 7, B. C. 49. Caesar at once crossed the river Ru- bicon, the boundary of his government, and marched his army on Rome. Pompey and the aristocratic party fled in haste, leaving the public treasure behind. In sixty days Caesar had possession of all Italy. Sicily, Sardinia, and Spain were next conquered from the offi- cers of Pompey, when he returned to Rome, and was created dictator by his party. He treated all his ene- mies with clemency. Pompey had gone into Greece, 48 — where he gathered a large army. Caesar followed with his veteran legions, and defeated him in the battle of Pharsalia in Thessaly. Pompey fled to Egypt, where he was treacherously slain, to the great indignation of Caesar, who would shed no blood but in necessary battle. Thus he became sole master of the world. In a conflict with the Egyptians in Alexandria Caesar 6et on fire their fleet, he being attended by but few troops, and the conflagration extended to the Alexan- drian Library, filled with inestimable treasures of ancient literature, which were destroyed, to the great loss of future generations. Caesar soon subdued Egypt, DECAY OF THE KOMAN REPUBLIC. 103 47 — defeated Pharnaces, son of Mithridates, and returned to Rome. 46 — lie soon passed into Africa, where he defeated his ene- mies. The celebrated Cato, an inflexible enemy of Caesar, committed suicide rather than submit to him. In Spain he soon after defeated the sons of Pompey, the last of his foes in arms. He rebuilt Carthage and 45 — Corinth. He projected many great public works and useful reforms. The whole power of Roman sovereign- 44 — ty was formally conferred on him by the people, when he was suddenly assassinated by a band of senators and certain conspirators, who imagined it possible to restore the ancient Republic. His nephew, Augustus, succeed- ed him soon after. 43 — The eminent Cicero, never a friend to Caesar, was assas- sinated by the connivance of Augustus. 42 — The republican and aristocratic conspirators were de- feated by Augustus and Antony at Philippi, in Greece. Brutus and Cassius, the republican leaders, and assas- sins of Caesar, were slain. The second " Triumvirate," composed of Augustus, Antony and Lepidus, having acquired possession of all the powers of the state, ruth- lessly murdered thousands of their political enemies. They soon grew jealous of each other, and fought and intrigued for eleven years, Augustus, with great pru- dence; firmly settling himself in Rome, and Antony becoming the slave of the beautiful and infamous Cleo- patra, queen of Egypt. 31 — At length, at the battle of Actium, Antony was de- feated, and soon after both Antony and Cleopatra com- mitted suicide. Egypt became formally a Roman province, and Augustus absolute emperor of the world. 104 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. SECTION IX. THE ROMAN EMPIRE. 1. B.C. 28 — In this year Augustus, having fully consolidated his power, was formally recognized emperor. During all the contests of factions, and when Home was itself in the throes of revolution, the subjection of all the provinces to the imperial city, and whoever was in power there, was rigorously main- tained. The inhabitants were protected from invasion, and if they were often oppressed by Roman governors, it was far less than under their native rulers, and, in general, they w T ere not desirous of a change. Roman law and order, and the power of appeal from great injustice to the Roman senate or emperor, maintained a state of generally tranquil prosperity, only dis- turbed by the contests of rivals for the control of the imperial city and its power. A long period of almost absolute quiet followed the estab- lishment of the empire, which gave Rome and Italy great satisfaction, after nearly a hundred years of civil war. It is called the " Augustan Age," when industry and commerce, literature and the arts, reached their highest development. The Roman Empire and the Christian era commenced nearly together. During the thirty years that followed the battle of Actium, which secured to Augustus the sole control of the civilized world, by the defeat of his last rival, Antony, he was occupied in organizing the vast machinery of his government, and centralizing all the parts of the administration in his own person. For near three hundred years Western Asia and Greece had been a scene of violent commotion. Rival adven- turers were constantly seeking to reconstruct the empire of Alexander. Some of these had the genius and the good for- tune to succeed, in part at least, and swayed a powerful scepter over a large region during their own lives, and, in some instances, their dominions were held together for several gen- erations. But there was no sufficient base for a strong and permanent government. There was no stable element on THE KoMA.N KM 1 'IKK. In. - , which to rest it. The Greeks were brave, intelligent and enterprising, and no Asiatic people could withstand a Greek army under Greek leaders; hut the Greeks were too restli too easily carried away by enthusiasm for a new leader or a new idea to be capable of upholding an empire. 2. Tims, Asia and Greece had been a vast battle field, and the battles served no general interest and founded no permanent state. The Greeks grew tired of supporting the claims of each new aspirant, who returned their favor by depriving them of liberty, and the whole eastern world readily submitted to the Romans, under whom there was, at least, a prospect of civil order. Augustus, then, had little trouble in settling the affairs of the whole empire, and, about thirty years after the battle of Actium, finding the entire world quietly content and the administration everywhere in fair working order, directed the gates of the temple of Janus to be closed, and a census to be made of all his subjects. At this time Jesus Christ was born and the Christian era commenced. The Roman Empire under Augustus was the culmination of the ancient and pagan civilization. It had great vitality, and strength enough to rule the world four hundred years longer; but it had also fatal weaknesses. We have seen that the exist- ence of the empire originated in the inability of the old society to free itself from the vices which long and great prosperity had developed. It had no purifying element strong enough to drive out the disease which its moral weakness had allowed to fasten on it. It was, in fact, based on wrong and could not but perish. Its fall was only a question of time. Its ferocious valor and contempt of the rights of nations broke down the very virtue that was essential to the stability of society. The Romans were robbers on a grand scale, and it was very natural that, when there were no more foreign nations to slay and plunder, the citizens should tall to cutting each others throats and robbing their neighbors. As this would lead to the imme- diate ruin of society and the state, the empire, which gave them an absolute master, was a necessity. 106 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME 3. But a full comprehension of the moral laws on which society, institutions and states are founded, was the last to be gained. Most modern nations have not yet attained it, not- withstanding that Christianity has so long stated the principles with clearness and force. The common mind of humanity could master them only by growth through thousands of years and innumerable experi- ences. The <>!>ject of all earthly experience is to develop the value of the individual Tnan; and the object of society, of institutions and of government, is to protect the rights and to favor the development of each man of the race. When this end is fully secured, history will have solved its problem. As the commencement of the Christian era was the turning point of history in some most important respects, it is proper to glance back and forward over the state of this problem, and the relation of Christianity to it, before proceeding with the gen- eral course of events. At first men were like children, with everything to learn; and, like children, they learned one thing at a time; and they also made an addition to their common stock of knowledge at every remove of the centre of growth. In Asia and Egypt the general lesson was industry and obedience, while the Jews, on the western shore, more or less assisted by the Assyrians, the Egyptians and the Greeks, labored at the development of a pure religion which culminated in Christianity. The removal of the centre to Greece added mental and artistic culture, and the further westward journey to Rome gave them a new class of most important ideas concerning public organization, law and order. 4. If each of these lessons had been perfect in themselves the addition made by Christianity, which defined the relations between men, the law of human rights and the doctrines essen- tial to the stability and purity of society, would have enabled mankind to build up satisfactory institutions and a complete civilization from the Roman period. But the elementary les- sons were very incomplete. The Asiatics became very super- THE ROMAN EMPIRE. 107 stitious; the Greeks could teach men the art of thinking, or exercising their minds, but they could not find the true start- ing point; they did not discover what subjects it was useful, and what it was useless, to reason upon; and wasted a good part of the thought of their times on profitless questions. Their failure to obtain a clear and valuable result from philoso- phy made men skeptical and contributed much to the decline of civilization in the time of the Roman empire. The Romans built their whole structure of law and order on force and a wholesale violation of the rights of mankind, and the minds of men became greatly confused. The doctrine of the Epicu- rean philosophers — "Let us eat and drink for to-morrow we die" — a despair of working out the problem of life to a satis- factory answer, became the most popular in the empire. The splendor and glory of Oriental, Grecian and Roman civiliza- tion seemed to end in degrading servility and superstition, in the endless and absurd speculations of so-called philosophers, and in the vast brutal tyranny of the emperors. The east failed of a pure religion that was generally accepted. Greek philosophy did not have science to guide her thought, and Rome could not be just as well as strong. 5. It was only in modern times that these lessons were made complete. The discoveries in Geography, in Astronomy, in Natural Philosophy, in Chemistry, in Geology, made men acquainted with the structure of the universe, the properties and the laws of matter, and corrected the extravagances of the ancient speculative philosophy. For want of science, Greek thought wandered about in an unreal world and lost a good part of its labor. A long experience under the control of this corrected thought was required to construct a science of Gov- ernment that should supply what was wanting to Roman jurisprudence, and Christianity itself could not be rightly understood while so many false theories and wrong practices prevailed. But the ancient times were as essential to the building up of the modern as the modern to the completion of the ancient. 108 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. It was the renewed study of the Greek classics, of Koman law, and of the original teachings of Christianity, under more favorable circumstances, and after many new experiences for a thousand years, that gave birth to all our later improvements in religion, in government and in science. The Asiatic Jews gave us in Christianity, a pure and simple worship, and a system of public morality so perfect that no society has yet been able to embody it completely in practice, although it is now recognized, very generally, as the highest conceivable standard, to be constantly aimed at and conformed to as far as possible ; the Greek Philosopher, Aristotle, gave us the first notions of science, and Koman law formed the base of modern legal practice. 6. The difficulties of progress are very great. It is not easier for nations to unlearn what they have learned amiss in their youth, than for individuals. No nation that has matured institutions has ever yet thoroughly reformed them. The best and most clear sighted minds discover their defects and show what is to be remedied ; but the force of habit and the vene- ration men feel for what is old, offer so much resistance to com- plete reforms that it has been necessary to establish and build up institutions on new principles on fresh ground. So all the light and power of science, of the reformed religion, of a more complete system of law, the greater intelligence of the masses of men and the activity of commerce and trade did not suffice to do for modern Europe what has been done with ease in America. But Europe furnished the ideas which America worked out; and the sight of those principles embodied in institutions that greatly improved the condition of mankind has reacted on Europe, and bids fair, in time, to produce a novelty in human experience — a complete regeneration of old nations and governments. When Greece rose to power it subjected but lightly, and only superficially transformed, the nations of Asia ; Rome absorbed them both, and Christianity gave its simple and noble lessons to them all. But the slight influence of Greece, Rome and Christianity on the old nations THE INFLUENCE OF CHRISTIANITY. 100 of western Asia is shown in the rise and permanence of Mohammedanism, so inferior, in all respects, to Christianity. After a career of more than twelve hundred years, it still rules many more millions than were contained in all the Roman Empire in its most prosperous days. 7. But the power of a progressive civilization constantly increases, and will, by and by, be equal to the thorough reform of even crystalized China. Without America, Europe would be still struggling with the incipient stages of reform. With it, she has gone far toward correcting the imperfections which existed one hundred years ago, and will presently complete the process. With these general observations, we proceed to examine the influence of Christianity on the old civilization. SECTION X. THE INFLUENCE OF CHRISTIANITY. 1. It was developed on the western borders of Asia, and was the completion or perfect development of the system of religion existing among the Jews from a very early period. Soon after Abraham, the father and grand patriarch of the Jews, had given his descendants the outlines of the system, they were led, by circumstances, to Egypt, and remained there for many generations. When they left Egypt, it was under the leadership of one of the greatest of the world's great men, who had been heir apparent of the Egyptian throne, and was consequently versed in all the mysterious wisdom of the priest- hood of that country. That he became wiser than they is evident from the history of his contest with them before the king when endeavoring to gain his consent to the migration of his people from the country. Instructed in all the cele- brated "wisdom of the Egyptians, " together with the reflec- tions and additions of forty solitary years as a shepherd in Arabia, he produced a remarkable system of mingled theology and legislation which has come down as a sacred record to our day. 110 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 2. The Jews were, nine hundred years afterwards, trans- ported as a nation to Babylon, remained there for more than two generations, and received such light as the Babylonian priests and Persian magi were able to give them. The con- quest of Asia by the Greeks and the vicinity of Judea to com- mercial Tyre, furnished them all the aid these nations could give in the line of religious suggestion. A Jew produced, in the early days of the Roman Empire, the simple, yet sublime teachings of Christianity. It had the comprehensiveness and directness requisite to give it authority as a universal religion. In few, but plain and convincing words, it laid down the prin- ciples of human rights and of divine law. It defined the nature and stated the sanctions of virtue in the clearest terms; tore away every covering from vice and denounced without fear the favorite ambitions and follies of men. It seems almost incredible that such a system should have had its origin even among a people like the Jews, and at the time when the Roman Empire represented the highest civilization of the world. 3. The Jews, as a nation, however, rejected and bitterly persecuted it, and the Romans, who were, on principle, ex- tremely tolerant of all foreign religions, soon became extremely hostile. It was humble, unostentatious, very simple in all its forms, carefully refrained from all interference with established government, and presented many new and consoling truths, with great force. It would have seemed that it had only to 6peak to gain a hearing and take a leading place at once in the work of the future. The few unprejudiced among the great, and thousands of the poor and oppressed whom the cruel power of the Romans had deprived of nationality, property and personal liberty, and many whose minds recoiled from the vices, crimes and skepticism of the age, heard and em- braced it with joy. But it rebuked with most severity the ambitions, the injustice and the love of luxury that were most prevalent in that age and that were most distinctly Roman. It was peculiarly severe against all other systems of religion, THE INFI.UKNCE OF OHBISTIANnY. 1 1 1 and that formed the strongest barrier against its immediate spread over the pagan world at large. It was, therefore, per- secuted with the greatest rigor for three hundred years. 4. But persecution called public attention to it and won it sympathy, and it continually spread beneath the surface of so- ciety. The brutal features of Roman character were gradually softened ; very gradually, indeed, for Roman manners aud morals were an Augean stable which it was a more than her- culean task to cleanse ; but after a time, the gigantic crimes of a Marius, a Sylla, a .Nero, or Domitian became impossible, and the horrors of the theatre, where gladiators killed each other and men were thrown to wild beasts for the amusement of the populace, became rare. Atrocious crimes awakened a disgust that showed a different view and a new standard of judgment in the community. Christianity created a purer moral atmosphere even in Rome, and while it was persecuted with the utmost barbarity. 5. It is then no matter of surprise that Christianity did not at once meet with general acceptance, and did not fully reconstruct Roman society and manners. The marvel is that it could be produced at all by an age to whose whole spirit it was so absolutely contrary . It was the doctrine of peace pro- claimed among nations who knew no occupation so glorious as war; whose institutions all rested on conquest; whose domi- nant race — admired as much as feared — was the very senilis and embodiment of martial force arrayed against the inde- pendence of all nationalities by an organization the most com- plete. It proclaimed the rights of man and the equality of all classes and persons before the Divine Law, to a people who had plunged in a common ruin Carthage and Corinth, the Republics of Greece, and the absolute rulers of monarchical Asia. It scorned equally gorgeous ceremonies of worship, the subtleties of an imperfect philosophy and pride of place and power. It is not possible to imagine a greater contrast to all the modes of habit and thought prevalent in those times. The 112 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. most sensual of all races it exhorted to spirituality, to the most cruel and insolent it preached meekness and forbearance. It placed the slave to whom the recognized laws of war left no rights, beside the master who gloried in setting his foot on the neck of the prostrate; and recognized as equals the great and the small, the ignorant and the wise, the bond and the free. "We cannot be surprised that it did not obtain immediate currency, that it was everywhere scorned and cast out, that it aroused unheard of persecutions, and that it could only obtain a triumph when the old Roman inflexibility and fierceness had died out of its degenerate children, and the spirit of the an- cient world was burned out in the hot fires of its own passions. Character does not change in a day, and the ruling impulses of a race can be modified only by slow degrees. Such is the supreme law which has ruled all history. 6. From all these causes Christianity was slow in pene- trating society and moulding institutions; but it spread so extensively that a clear sighted emperor at length found it politic to profess Christianity in order to gain the support of so large and vigorous an element against his rivals in power. Constantine was victorious and proceeded to make Christianity the state religion. It had maintained its growth by its real superiority and ever after remained the most powerful and productive among the influences that aided the progress of mankind. It Mas actively aggressive and had made the bar- barians who overthrew Rome converts to the faith before the in- vasion, and thus broke the force and diminished the disastrous effects of that event. In after times, no sooner did a barbarian tribe appear and establish itself in any part of the old empire than Christianity commenced the work of teaching and prose- lyting, which aided much in restoring order and repairing ruin. Had Christianity preserved its purity its usefulness and power would have been much greater. 7. But as it gained in numbers and in position it lost inter- nal strength. Both Oriental and Greek philosophy tainted its simple doctrines and introduced in various forms the hurtful THE SERVICES OF GREAT MEN. I L3 speculations so dear to the ancients; and when it became the court religion the simplicity of its ceremonies was gradually replaced by the pomp and splendor of pagan worship. Con Btantine and his successors in the empire assumed the virtual headship of the church, called councils and packed them for political purposes, and pronounced for or against supposed heresies. The offices of the church became the rewards of ambition and gradually a hierarchy, or regular gradation, was established in the priesthood, and both faith and manners came to be strangely in contrast with their original simplicity. Yet, Christianity, aping the forms and infected with the supersti- tions of paganism, and become the tool of the aspiring, was still alive with a youthful vigor by which she eased the fall of the old civilization, and was abundant in valuable service for the civilization yet to be. SECTION XI. THE SERVICES OF GREAT MEN TO MANKIND. 1. It is difficult for us to comprehend the embarrassments which a want of diffused information presented to the progress of the ancient days. With no books, or, at best, but very few, with little or no record of the past, or the distant present, but what confused, distorted and uncertain tradition and rumor could give, witli almost no instruments of thought and education, it would seem natural that they should fall into a hopeless bar- barism. That the} 7 raised themselves so far out of a condition so low and so helpless, that they created so many instruments for JWj is a proof of the wonderful capacity for advancement that lies in humanity, and a prophecy of stupendous things yet in store for mankind. 2. One of the most important elements of their progr< lav in their great men. It is indispensable that a man. to become great, or famous, by exercising a wide influence, should represent in a large, well defined and successful way, the gen- eral tendency and aspiration of his times. He must unite a 8 114 TIIE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. clear perception of these tendencies in his mind, with the power to give them adequate expression in his words or deeds. lie must be so far ahead of his times as to be able to clearly work out what is lying unexpressed in the general mind, but not so far ahead that it cannot come into sympathy and co-operation with him; else he will not be recognized as great. Great men are a summary of their times, or of the people they dwell among; they gather its tendencies to a point and express the undefined desire of that period. Their value for later times is that they represent the spirit of their race at that time in a form to make a striking impression, and those who have the good fortune to represent the qualities of the best races, or of nations at the most important stage of their history, become the general exemplars of mankind; teaching in a forcible and striking way the lessons which have been wrought out in the experience of a whole people for ages. 3. The poets are the first of these great men of whom his- tory gives us any account, except, perhaps, the heroes whose deeds they sung, which are more or less uncertain, because they clothed the common tradition of their times in an imag- inative and fictitious dress. The poets Homer and Hesiod had great influence on early Greece. They summed up its theology and the history of its admired heroes, and gave expression to the early thought and literary turn of that people. Their legislators came next. They gave expression to the genius of their people in institutions and laws. Lycurgus arranged the Spartan state into a military school. His laws remained in force more than five hundred years. Solon was the legislator of Athens and his laws were much admired for their wisdom and justice. The Greeks could think more wisely than they could act. Lycurgus organized the warlike spirit in Greece as well as Sparta. The small Grecian states, determined to keep Sparta and each one of the other slates from destroying their individual liberties, were trained by the necessity of combating the vigorous military organization of Sparta to great ability in war. TIIK 6EI1VI0ES OF GKEAT MEN. 1 15 Under Pericles, a republican statesman of Athens, nearly a century later than Solon, the lull glory of the Grecian genius shone forth. He encouraged his countrymen to give the sup- port to art and literature that produced the famous master pieces which have made Greece illustrious and influential to this day. 4. Socrates appeared soon after. lie was the apostle of thought. His influence in leading men to use direct and effective modes of examination and reasoning was incalcula- ble, and has perhaps had more effect on the world than the victorious career of Alexander or of the Romans, lie was followed by Plato, a disciple of his, who pushed out to further results the same principles. He is called the prince of philo- sophers, and has exerted a world-wide influence, lie had not the simplicity and plain directness of Socrates, though his mind was more polished, and he was more learned. Some scholars, however, consider his masterpieces to indicate as powerful a mind as the world has produced. He spent twelve years in travel, and used all the means of education and study then to be found. His works are still the delight of the most accomplished scholars. 5. Aristotle began his career in the last years of Plato. He was the tutor of Alexander the Great. He followed a dif- ferent line of study, wrote on logic, or the art of reasoning, on the natural sciences, and introduced method in the exercise of the mind and in study. Herodotus, Xenophon, Thucydides, and many other great writers, artists and sculptors, lived about the same period; and thus Grecians did for the mind what the Romans did for law and government — laid down the fundamental principles which formed the basis of real progress. The free government of Athens encouraged oratory and the art of persuasion. Demosthenes was the most celebrated OMtor among the Greeks, and if his Btate had onlv been more powerful he would have conquered Philip of Macedon lie was indeed one of the greatest orators of all times. Cicero, 116 TOE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. among the Romans, was a winter and orator of almost equal merit. They both lived just at the downfall of the liberties of their states, and they spoke with more effect to the times after them than to their contemporaries. If they did not succeed in preserving the liberties of Greece and Rome, they made a great impression, the name of Liberty was consecrated by their noble words, and those who destroyed it made infa- mous by their burning invectives. When a more favorable time came for restoring it, they lived again in influence, and triumphed by the memory and record of their great patriot- ism and powerful eloquence. 6. Great conquerors and warriors, in all times, have also been representative men, giving expression and gratification to the warlike spirit of their people, and producing great changes that have been favorable to the real advancement of mankind. The energies they stirred up, and the mingling of nations they produced generally promoted civilization. Alex- ander the Great displayed the wonderful genius and fertility in resources that was peculiarly Greek. His nation was almost consoled for the loss of their liberties by the conquests to which he led them. He opened to their study unknown regions, and gave their mental genius a broader play and a fuller occupation. They, to such an extent as change was possible with old civil- izations. Ilellenized the East and prepared the way for the reception of Christianity. Alexander, in three great battles, conquered the great Persian Empire with a small army. He never suffered defeat, and died at thirty-three years of age. Had he lived, he might have done what Hannibal could not do — have crushed the rising power of the Roman republic. It would have been a misfortune, for the Romans did incalcu- lable service to humanity. Greek learning- exerted its influ- ence on the East for two hundred and fifty years before its final conquest by the Etonians. Alexander did great service to mankind by his military success. Hannibal is an instance ol ;i great man not as fully representative of his own people, perhaps, and whose misfortune it was to have to struggle THE BEBVICE8 OF GREAT MEN. I 17 against a people whose united genius was greater, more) inventive, and more patient than hie own. The Roman Poinpey represented the aristocratic element of his people, and though a great general, hardly deserved to succeed. Julius Caesar possessed the merciful character and intelligence of the Greek and the prodigious energy and resolution of the Roman. His conquest of Gaul and Britain introduced civil- ization into the lands that were, five hundred years later, to begin a new career for mankind. His thorough subjection of the Gauls preserved the ancient civilization from the inroads of the vigorous Germans until all was ready for the new order of things. More than any other great man, he may he said to have heen representative of the hest spirit of his time. Perceiving that the Roman republic was dead, and could not possibly he restored, from the strength of the vices ruling in the state, he repressed its anarchy and set aside its forms, wisely and prudently, with as little bloodshed or cruelty as possible, lie thoroughly represented the practical sense and immense vigor of the true Roman. He has heen severely reproached for destroying the republic, hut the republic vir- tually fell with the Gracchi, seventy-five years before, and ho established the only government that could possibly preserve the Roman state from disorganization. 7. The office of all these, and multitudes of other great men, less representative of the greater qualities of their fel- lows, or representative of less striking features of their times, has heen to sum up the character of their people, and present their special features, condensed, for the observation of man- kind, and by their position as leaders, to give their time- an opportunity for powerful development, a.- well as to show what mankind are capable of. In this last view they stimu- late individuals to aspiration and effort. Million* of men, probably, have had the qualities of Alexander and Csesar, millions more those of Demosthenes and Cicero, "f Socri Plato and Ari.-totle, and so of all the different classes of great men, but have wanted the opportunities and peculiar stimn- 118 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. ^ lants to develop them. Whoever can appreciate them, can. with a favorable balance of faculties to give equally sound judgment, together with equally favorable circumstances, imitate them. Modern times have shown multitudes of men who, their character and talents taken as a whole, have shown themselves far greater than any of the ancients. Culture and the mingling of races will, perhaps, finally make all men greater than the greatest of the ancients. 8. Brutus, one of the murderers of Caesar, wished to restore the glories of the ancient Roman republic, and thought Caesar stood in the way. He removed him by violence, and found the difficulties greater than ever. A hundred years of conquest had sapped the virtues of the Roman people, and Brutus killed himself in despair, saying: " O Virtue! thou art but a name!" To Caesar succeeded Augustus, by a necessity of things. Without Caesar's clemency, he deluged Rome with the blood of its citizens. Afterward, however, his rule was less sanguinary, and for thirty years he ruled with mildness, though with despotism. The limited amount of virtue in pagan civilizations wore out; and notwithstanding the intelli- gence of Greece and the good sense of Rome, the ancient world was obliged to close its career as it began, by absolute monarchy. It remained for the modern world to find, among its more abundant resources, the means of forever preserving itself from decline. Education and purity, science and reli- gion, freedom and fraternity among all races and nations; a knowledge and wisdom not conceived by the ancients, a repla- cing of war and violence, which are essentially demoralizing, by peaceful means, which shall benefit all and injure none; perfectly free intercourse under the guidance of absolute jus- tice and benevolence; such is the way by which the modern world will work out the problem impossible for the old world to solve. America has gone far toward the goal. In time, all nations will be persuaded to join her in attaining it. 9. Before we proceed with the chronology of the Christian Era we must briefly notice the one perfect man, Jesus Christ. THE SERVICES OF GBEAT MEN. 1 | !l To pronounce on the miraculous and divine claims made for his character and deeds would carry us outside of our theme. We can only deal with him as with other historical men, in his historical character and relations. These are extremely re- markable. That individual sprang, like Socrates, from the poorer classes, and, like him without the advantages of education, produced a system which proved a marvel of perfection, adapt- ed to all times, but most perfectly to the most perfect state of mankind, and consequently growing up with the progress of nations to an ever-increasing influence. Its moral precepts, even in our day, are as far ahead of our civilization as that is behind a perfect condition. This man made an extraordinary impression. In three hundred years, by merely publishing his ideas in a quiet way, which was the only mode the hostility of the Roman rulers would permit, his followers overthrew the prevailing religious systems which had been established as many thousand years, and spread his influence world-wide. His birth became the commencement of the Era of Human- ity. Like Socrates, he went about among the people with a few chosen friends, setting forth his ideas, chiefly in conversa- tion. He did not write; the simple record of his life and a few of his discourses being recorded by his disciples. Again, like Socrates, his life was ended by violence. All the records of that life show that he was as perfect as we can conceive In no respect does he seem to have wanted any feature of a noble manhood, in any degree, nor to have shared the prejudices or detects of his age. He lived as we may conceive man to live when his mental and moral habits are accurately adjusted and harmonized with his relations and his duties, which lie has learned perfectly to appreciate. His public career lasted hut three years and a half, and shines in history a beam of light. He inspired his appreciative followers with rapturous admira- tion, a passionate attachment to his person, and pleasure in obedience to his teachings, stronger than death; and in th whose plans and prejudices he crossed, and whose ambitions 120 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. he rebuked, a deadly hatred which could only oe satisfied with his blood. 10. Immediately after his death his followers commenced to publish and enforce his teachings with great success, and on the outbreak of persecution, without making opposition, they scattered in all directions, proclaiming them with undimin- ished zeal. Very soon their converts numbered tens of thou- sands, in all parts of the Roman Empire. Persecution increased their fervor and their numbers, without leading them to revolt or resistance, until, in the course of time, an emperor found it politic to profess Christianity. This high patronage, and the active part the emperors took in the affairs of the church from that time, had the effect to corrupt its simplicity of manners, as the adhesion of Greek philosophers, who imported into its doctrines their crude theories, adultera- ted its teachings, and much that was quite foreign to its essen- tial character continued associated with its promulgation and institutions for fifteen hundred years, and, indeed, remnants of the same foreign element yet linger in it. Notwithstanding the embarrassing load which the fantastic distortion of its original simplicity and directness laid upon it, it continued to exert great influence, and seems destined to return, in time, to its original form and purity, and to employ its primitive power to crown the work of civilization. 11. Such is the historical report of the man who intro- duced into the process of human progress an element of unex- ampled power. An impartial estimate of the influence of Jesus Christ on history must allow that he is the most impor- tant character that has ever appeared among men. The uniiappy association of his ideas with the vagaries of an imperfect philosophy and the unwholesome ambitions of power, greatly curtailed their usefulness; but the simple majesty of his character and hi.- discourses could not always be obscured, and the luster of both has never shone more clearly nor exert- ed more influence than they do in this age. The course of the history of Christianity will be seen to be THE (MKIMI \\ BRA. 1.21 intimately connected with every stage of advancement from the time the Roman Empire began to wear out; it was the nucleus which survived its fall, around which the surging waves of invasion raged in vain, and which immediately began the work of reconstruction. SECTION XII. THE CHRISTIAN ERA. 4 — By some chronological confusion the new era has been made to begin four years before the appearance of the founder of Christianity. When Augustus had settled the whole empire he ordered the temple of Janus to be closed and a census taken of all its inhabitants, which numbered one hundred and twenty millions. On this occasion Jesus Christ was born. 10 — A Roman army under Varus was defeated and cut to pieces in Germany. It was the severest defsat the Romans had suffered since the overthrow and death of Crassus, by the Parthians, sixty-three years before. 14 — The Emperor Augustus died and was succeeded by his step-sun, Tiberius. 29 — Jesus Christ was crucified by Pontius Pilate, Roman governor of Judea, at the solicitation, and on the accu- sation, of the leading Jews. 37 — Tiberius died and was succeeded by Caligula. The commencement of the reign of Tiberius was wise and moderate, but he soon became violent and cruel. Cali- gula was a still greater monster of wickedness. 40 — Growing weary of his cruelty he was assassinated by one of his officers, and his uncle, Claudius, was raised to the throne. lie was of feeble intellect and became the tool of infamous favorites. lie was poisoned by order of his wife, Agrippina. 54 — Nero, the son of Agrippina by a former hnsband, was made emperor at seventeen years of age. He exceed* '1 122 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. all description in folly, extravagance and crime. His violence and barbarity fell generally on the patricians and members of his court, but he was esteemed by the common people, as were most of the emperors, who spent vast sums on theatres and spectacles for their amusement. The two bases of the empire were the populace and the army. The emperor was terrible and tyrannical chiefly to the patricians, while the army made him formidable to the provinces and the barbarians. A conflagration which some attributed to the orders 64 — of Nero lasted nine days and destroyed the greater part of Rome. Nero cast the blame on the Christians, who had become numerous, and raised a horrible per- secution against them. 66 — The Jews rebelled and defied the Roman Empire. 68 — Nero was dethroned by the Roman senate and army, and committed suicide to avoid punishment for his crimes. 69 — Three emperors, Galba, Otho and Vitellius, were placed on the throne in succession, but rebellions were raised against them and all were put to death. Vespasian, then besieging Jerusalem, was proclaimed emperor by his army at the desire of the rulers of the eastern prov- inces, and, in the same year, overcame all opposition and commenced the first reign since Augustus that was free from disgraceful profligacy and public crime. 70 — Titus, the son of Vespasian, captured and destroyed Jerusalem. Vespasian, during a reign of ten years, restored order and prosperity to Rome and the empire, but not without great labor and danger. 79 — Titus succeeded as emperor, and was remarkable for his clemency and care for his subjects. During his rei«*n occurred the most fearful eruption of the volcano Vesuvius on record. Herculaneum and Pompeii, two wealthy and flourishing cities, were destroyed, being I ill. 0HEI8TIAM ERA. L23 buried by the ashes. Pliny, an eminent, writer, was suffocated while observing the eruption. 81 — Titus died, to the great grief and loss of mankind, and was succeeded by his brother, Domitian, who was one of the most infamous rulers that ever desolated the earth. lie raised a violent persecution against the Christians for refusing to adore his statues and wor- ship him as a god. Among the victims was his own cousin, Clemens, who had embraced Christianity. He 96 — was assassinated by his wife and officers in self-defense, and the senate proclaimed Nerva, a native of Crete, emperor. He was remarkable for his lenity and all the gentle virtues. lie was followed, after a reign of two 98 — years, by Trajan, whom he had adopted as his colleague and successor, who is said to have been the greatest ami most deserving person of his time. He was, by birth, a Spaniard, was wise and successful as a warrior and statesman, and extremely noble as a man. He bridged the Danube and the Euphrates rivers and conquered both the Germans and Parthians on the north and east of the empire. A stain on his memory was the perse- cution of the Christians. 117 — He was succeeded by Adrian, in whose reign all the Roman laws, or annual edicts of the praetors, were compiled into one body, and law assumed the dignity of a science. He promoted literature, but continued the persecution of the Christians. A rebellion of the 139 — Jews was punished with merciless severity. lie was followed by Antoninus Pins, who suspended all perse- cution of Christians, promoted the best interests of all parts of the empire, and introduced, during a prosper- ous reign of twenty- two years, the most important reforms into every part of the government. 161 — Marcus Aurelius, called the Philosopher, succeeded. He carried on a successful war with the Germans, and made the welfare of his subjects his special tare, but 124 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. was seduced, by the pagan philosophers, into a perse- cution of the Christians. Having discovered his error he stopped it, toward the close of his reign. Com- 180 — modus, his son, inherited the purple. He also inher- ited a vicious and cruel disposition, and received a demoralizing education from his mother. He was a monster of vice and cruelty. He was assassinated in 192 — his bed by his own family and guards to save their lives. Pertinax reigned three months, but, attempting to restrain the license of the soldiery, he was murdered by them. The soldiers in Rome then proclaimed that the empire was for sale, and a rich merchant, Didius, bought it from them and reigned in Rome two months, 193 — when he was also slain by the army. Septimus Sev- erus, an able general, seized the purple which he secured against many rivals, and retained for eighteen years. His vigor alone prevented general anarchy, but he was systematically cruel. 211 — Caracalla, his son, succeeded. He was a bloody and atrocious tyrant, supported on the throne only by his soldiers, whose aid he secured by large pay. He was 217 — murdered by the commander of his guards, Macrinus, who succeeded in acquiring his place, but was soon 218 — murdered by the soldiers. They raised Heliogabalus, a 'young Syrian priest of fourteen years of age, through the assurance of his female relatives that he was the son of Caracalla, to the purple. He is described as the most cruel and infamous of all the Roman emperors. 222 — After four years of horrible crime, he was slain in a mutiny of his guard and his body thrown into the Tiber. Alexander Severus, succeeded. He was appa- rently a secret admirer of Christianity and a model 235 — prince. Be was murdered by Maximin, a Thracian peasant, who had. by his valor, risen to high command in the army, who seized the reins of power. He was successful in war, but his severity provoked mutiny in THE CHRISTIAN ERA. 1 ~J.'.> • > 238 — various parts of the empire, and he was Blain by bis own soldiers. Gordian succeeded, a heroic youth of a noble family. He Mas successful in war, but was mur- 244 — dered by his own prime minister, Philip, an Arabian, who became emperor. He favored the Christians, and reigned five years. In his reign, the thousandth year of the foundation of Rome was celebrated by public 249 — games. He was slain in a revolt by Decius, the general of his army, who occupied the throne. He raised a most violent storm of persecution against the Chris- tians, who were despoiled of their goods and driven to caves and deserts. From this time is dated the sect of 250 — anchorites, or hermits, who imagined they could acquire superior holiness by abandoning society and devoting themselves to meditation and prayer. The idea appears to have been derived from the Persian Magians. who, in this century restored the ancient dynasty and religion of the Persians, or Parsees, in Persia. During the political and social disorganization that soon commenced the anchorites became numerous, and the system was extensively prevalent for a thousand years to the great injury of active and true Christianity. 251 — Decius was slain in a battle with the Goths, who had invaded the empire, and Gallus became emperor. - 253 — He was put to death by Emilianns, who attempted to seize the reins of government, but the army elected Valerian, governor of Gaul. The empire was invaded by the Goths on the north and the Persians under their king, Sapor, on the east. From this time, it had to 259 — tight for its life. Valerian was defeated by Sapor and remained nine years in captivity, Gallienus, his eon, becoming emperor. He was extremely incompetent and a multitude of rival claimants for the Biipn authority arose in all directions. They were called "Thirty Tyrants." One of them. Odenatus, kin- Palmyra, in the Syrian desert, defeated Sapor, and 126 THE FOOTPKENTS OF TIME. Gallienus proclaimed him Lis colleague. On the death of Odenatus, his wife, Zenobia, assumed the title of " Queen of the East," conquered Egypt and ruled a wide region with success and splendor. Both Goths 262 — and Persians invaded Asia Minor. Gallienus was mur- 268 — dered and Claudius succeeded. He defeated the Goths 270 — hut died in a pestilence. Aurelian succeeded. He was an able general. He subdued the Germans and 272 — Goths, and conquered Zenobia, one of the most remark - 275 — able women of history. Aurelian was assassinated by some victims of his severity, and Tacitus, a Roman senator succeeded, but died in seven months, and was followed by Probus. He was a vigorous general, and drove back the barbarians on all sides, but attempting to employ his soldiers in labor on public works, they 282 — revolted and murdered him. Carus, the captain of the 283 — imperial guard, was raised to the throne. Dying the next year, his sons, Carinus and Kumerianus, inherited his authority, but Numerianus was assassinated in a 284 — few months by his father-in-law, and Diocletian, said to have been formerly a slave, was proclaimed emperor by the army. This was called " The Era of the Martyrs," from the long and bloody persecutions against the Chris- tians. This was the tenth general attack on them, and proved to be the last. The barbarians pressing in great force on all sides, Diocletian appointed several colleagues, and their united ability drove the invaders back. 305 — Diocletian resigned his power to Galerius, who appointed three associates, making a division of the empire. One of these, Constantius, died in Britain, and was suc- 306 — ceeded by his son, Constantine. For a time, there were six emperors, but one was killed, Galerius died, and Constantine conquered the others. 312 — Constantine changed the whole character of the empire by embracing Christianity and relying largely on that THE CHRISTIAN ERA. 127 element for the support of liie power, while he disbanded the Pretorian, or royal Guard, which had for two hun- dred rears assumed to make and unmake emperors, and whose example, imitated by the other armies, kept the world periodically disturbed by the disputes and battles of rival claimants to the imperial purple. P>v the 313 — ediet of Milan, ( !onstantine abolished all laws unfriendly to Christianity; he restored the authority of the senate and magistrates, and removed his capital from Rome to Constantinople. 324 — The pagan element was now so worn and decrepid that no general disorders resulted. Whatever was left ral- lied under Licinus, who was conquered by Constantino. It. appears to have been the strength of the Christian element and its essential hostility to the Roman prin- ciple of violent subjugation that produced so many and fierce persecutions. Had it not been for the pressure of barbarians on the empire the prevalence of that sys- tem M-ould have preserved society and the state for a thousand years more, as it actually did in the Eastern empire; but every thing that man has the management of must be affected by his limitations, his mistakes and his follies. Christianity needed a better ally, a fresher and purer society, built up by the young blood and bet- ter instincts of another and newer people. Constantino paid great respect to the clergy of the church and took a leading part in its general counsels — a great mistake and a great misfortune. 325 — His spiritual supremacy was virtually acknowledge! at the council of Nice which he convoked. 330 — Con Stan tine died leaving his vast dominions to his three 6ons, who, in the course of ten years, were reduced to one, Constantius. Alter a troubled reign of twenty 361 — years more, lie died, and was succeeded by his cousiu Julian, called the "Apostate," from his renouncing Christianity and laboring to restore the pagan religion. 128 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. In this lie signally failed. He undertook to rebuild the Jewish temple at Jerusalem, without success. 363 — He was mortally wounded in an invasion of Persia, and Mas succeeded by Jovian, who restored imperial favor 364 — to the Christian religion. He died after one years reign and Valentinian was elected emperor by the council of ministers and generals. He divided the empire with his brother, Valens, and afterward Rome and Constanti- nople usually had each an emperor. Valentinian died 375 — and was succeeded by his son, Gratian. 378 — The Huns appeared in Europe, having wandered from the borders of China, and defeated Valens with dread- ful slaughter. Valens himself was among the slain. This was the commencement of the great migrations that finally overwhelmed the Roman Empire of the west. 379 — Gratian, left sole emperor, appointed Theodosius, called The Great, his colleague, who subdued the Goths, repelled the Huns, and restored order. 383 — Gratian was murdered by the usurper Maximus. 388 — Theodosius conquered and put Maximus to death and restored Valentinian II., brother of Gratian, to the throne of the western empire. In a few years the whole 394 — empire was reunited by the death of Valentinian. Theodosius soon died, universally lamented, leaving the two empires to his sons, Honorius and Arcadius. 402 — Alaric, the Goth, invaded Italy and, though defeated, endangered the safety of Rome. 408 — Theodosius II. succeeded to the empire of the east. 410 — Alaric again invaded Italy and sacked Rome. Alaric soon after died and his forces were pursuaded, by nego- tiations, to leave Italy, but they permanently established themselves in Spain and Southern Gaul (France). Thus the empire began to fall to pieces. 425 — Honorius died and Valentinian III. became emperor. 429 — The Vandals soon conquered the Roman provinces in THE RISE OF MODERN NATIONS. 129 Africa, under their king, Genseric. They extended 440 — their conquests to Sicily. 447 — Attila, called the " Scourge of God," appeared at the head of the Huns, and Theodosius made a humiliating treaty with him to save his dominions from desolation. 448 — In the next year the Saxons and Angles were invited into Britain by the civilized Romans, to protect them from the Picts and Scots, and laid the foundation of the modern Anglo-Saxon race, and the Franks invaded Gaul laying the foundations of the modern kingdom of France. England received its name from the Angles — France from the Franks. 451 — Attila, the Hun, invaded Gaul, and was defeated at 452 — Chalons, by the united Romans and Visigoths. Attila then invaded Italy and laid it waste, but died before he 454 — had completed the ruin of the empire. Yalentinian III. was murdered, and the Vandals from Sicily invaded Italy and sacked Rome. SECTION XIII. THE RISE OF MODERN NATIONS. 476 — After a succession of puppet emperors in Rome, Odoacer abolished the name and took the title of king of Italy. He was a German in command of the auxiliaries in Roman pay. Thus ended, in disaster and disgrace, the once mighty Roman Empire. Its ruin was gradual and the barbarians who overthrew it had already embraced Christianity, so that the institutions of the church did not share its fall. 486 — Clovis, king of the Franks, defeated the Romans and Gauls at the battle of Soissons. The Ostrogoths invaded 492 — Italy under Theodoric the Great, deposed Odoacer, and founded a new kingdom. 496, — Clovis defeated the invading Germans and embraced 5U0 — Christianity. Clovis next defeated the Burgundianfl, 9 130 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME, 507 — He subdued the Visigoths and all France was united under one rule. He was of the Merovingian line, or dynasty, of kings, which lasted over two hundred years, during- which the remains of Roman civilization and the influence of the church were gradually modifying and penetrating the character of a new and energetic race. 527 — Justinian became the ruler of the Eastern or Grecian Empire. 534 — His generals waged war with the Yan dais in Africa and the Ostrogoths in Italy, and after eighteen years of conflict, succeeded in reconquering part of Italy, which the Greek emperors continued to hold nominally for about three hundred years; the seat of their repre- sentative being at Ravenna. He was called an Exarch. Home itself was left, substantially, to the control of the Christian bishop. When the Lombards founded a king- 568 — dom in the north of Italy they were prevented, by the exarch and bishop, from spreading over the southern part; and when the exarch threatened to become too powerful to suit the views of the bishop, he supported the Lombards. Thus the temporal or political power of the popes arose, and they were the politic authors of the "Balance of Power" theory, or system, that has played so large a part in European history. The result has been exceedingly favorable to progress in all direc- tions, since it has secured the independence of states, and a more various and perfect civilization by the develop- ment of the special genius of each people. Many cir- cumstances conspired to support this idea, in later times, and render it very prominent and influential. This gradual advance of the bishop of Home in political influence associated him with the mighty memories of the "Eternal City," and suggested the idea of a spiritual empire over all Christendom, which gradually became realized and quite changed the char- THE RISE OF MODERN NATIONS. I .". 1 acter of Christianity for Dear 800 years. Hurtful as it ultimately became, by reviving a universal despotism over conscience and freedom of thought, it was Loug powerful for good by giving a common centre to Europe, broken into fragments as it was by the rise of feudalism. That was disorganizing; this was centraliz- ing, and kept the channels of communication open and the missionary spirit and the elements of a restored learning in activity. Its influence in commencing and carrying forward the crusades, which substantially broke the strength of feudalism, was of immense import- ance. 622 — Mahomet arose in the Arabian peninsula, and his new religion spread with astonishing rapidity. In one hun- 732 — dred years from the death of Mahomet the Saracens had established a vast empire, covering two thirds of the Roman empire, viz.: all of the old Persian empire, Egypt, and all of nothern Africa and Spain, and threat- ened to inundate Europe. They poured a vast army over the Pyrenees into France. This was defeated in a great battle at Tours, by Charles Martel, who founded a new dynasty, replacing the Merovingian, called the Carlovingian, and made France the most powerful, as it became the leading, nation in Europe, for promoting civilization during many centuries. Ey this means the center of political influence, " The Star of Empire," took another step westward. His son, Pepin le Bref, or the Short, caused himself to be 752 — crowned king of France by the Roman Pontiff, Stephen II, which added to his own prestige, as ir also did to that of the pope. It was a sort of league between the rising temporal and spiritual powers in Europe, and Bel an example long followed. Charlemagne, or Charles the Great, the son of Pepin, ascended the tin-one in 771, 771 — and by his intelligence, energy, and wise statesmanship, by his encouragement of learning, his organizing talents 132 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. and his success in conquering and civilizing the seeth- ing mass of nationalities in Germany, he may be said to have really founded modern civilization during his long reign of forty-three years. He conquered the Lombard kingdom in Italy, and was crowned by the pope, Adrian I, " Emperor of the Romans," kneeling at the altar in Rome; but he virtually confirmed the temporal author- ity of the popes, and associated their influence in all his conquests. He thoroughly broke the spirit of the pagan Saxons, in northwestern Germany, by a war of thirty-three years, carried his conquests east over most of the present Austrian empire, civilizing and bringing the barbarians into the pale of Christendom by the aid of Christian missionaries, and conquered some portions of Spain from the Saracens. It seemed as if the history of the western Roman Empire, which had fallen three hundred years before, was to be repeated. That was the hope and dream of both Charlemagne and the Roman Pontiff, who joined hands to realize it. This new western emperor had great abilities and the church was very strong. The centre of Europe had so long been within the reach of civilizing influences, and had attained such a point of development in its various nationalities, that they read- ily accepted permanent institutions, when presented by a power so strong as that of the mighty Frank ruler. 814 — But when he died, it was found that there was no other hand strong enough to wield his sceptre. All the memories of the old empire, all the influence of the Christian church, the remains of the Roman organiza- tion, and the ripening vigor of new races, which had begun to lay aside their barbarous impulses, were united to aid the vast designs of this great statesman. But the tendencies of the new society, in general, were in a different direction. The Germanic civilization was totally different from the Roman, and had there been '1IIK FEUDAL sysi i m. 133 a succession of rulers us Large minded and strong willed as Charlemagne, they could not have repeated the his- tory of the ancient world. The tendency of the races that overthrew the empire was invincibly against cen- tralization, and instead of a new Roman Empire in western Europe, appeared the Feudal System. SECTION XIV. THE FEUDAL SYSTEM. 1. This system was the direct opposite of centralization. Under it all Christendom broke up into fragments; the king exerted but a loose general control, that continued to decrease for several centuries; and most of the real authoritv was exerted by the feudal lords from their fortified castles, which, for three hundred years, had been springing up over all the territory conquered from the Romans. It had its true origin in the marked personal assertion, the strong individuality of the Teutonic Race, which was, and is, one of its most promi- nent traits. While in their native barbarous state their armies were formed for their expeditions of foreign conquest, that proved so fatal to the Romans, on the voluntary principle. The prowess and fame of a leader, or chief, drew to him a multitude of warriors, longing for activity and booty. So long as he could lead them to success, to gain their individual ends, they obeyed him. When he failed to reward their am- bition they held themselves free to leave him. 2. It was not immense disciplined armies, but innumera- ble bands, organized in this way, that, through a long course of years, gradually overran Britain, Gaul, Spain and Italy. For four hundred years the civilized world had been accus- tomed to the control and protection of a distant ruler whose powerful armies rendered resistance vain, and all thought of organization for self-protection against the terrible barbarians Was wanting when they were attacked. Each city or region defended itself as well as possible, or submitted at once. The 134 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. conquerors took what they wanted and passed on to other lands, or spread themselves out over the province. They usually settled in the country part*, fortifying the country seats of the richer inhabitants, or building themselves castles near the larger towns, to hold them in awe. The leader con- sidered himself the owner of the conquered territory, and divided it among his followers, who settled themselves, each in his new domain, as its owner and ruler. The conquered inhabitants were his subjects from whom he took tribute. The conquerors were few in number in proportion to the con- quered; but there was little resistance throughout the old Roman provinces. Organization and spirit were wanting to them, and resistance would provoke complete ruin, since the conqueror could easily call to his aid any number of his fel- lows in return for a share of the spoils. Thus they gave what was demanded and made themselves content with what was left. The cities paid tribute, the cultivators gave a portion of their harvests to the new rulers. The territory not given to his followers was considered the property of the original leader. In return for the gift each of the recipients of ter- ritory was held bound to aid him in his wars, and each larger chief stood in similar relations to the king of his tribe or nation. Out of this grew, at length, what was called the Feudal System, feudal being derived, by some, from the old German words "fee," salary, and " od," landed possessions — a payment, or salary, in land, for services rendered, with a certain obligation to the giver. 3. The kings of the Franks — the German nation that conquered Gaul — up to the time of Charlemagne, labored to consolidate their power and rule like the Roman emperors. But the genius of their race and the peculiarities of the sit- uation were both opposed to that purpose. Charles Martel, Pepin, his son, and Charlemagne, his grandson, were all rulers of great vigor, and the last, apparently, succeeded for a time. But the military strength lay only in the scattered feudal THE FEUDAL SYSTEM. L35 chieftains, each of whom sought to build up hie own power on his own estates. It was not possible to maintain a strong itral government for any length of time, or under an ordi- nary man. For two hundred years these petty lords grew in strength at the expense of the king. They were still held to him by the necessity of supporting him in war, by a system of check-, which, in time, were increased, and still more enlarged, when the people began to make themselves felt in the twelfth century; but from the fifth to the fifteen tk cen- tury feudalism was the prevailing system in all the civilized European nations. f. It was a very rude and violent period, but some of the most happy traits of modern life grew out of it. The isola- tion of the feudal lord in his fortified chateau or castle, where his wife and children were his only equals, combined with the constant influence of the church, gradually elevated the Con- di t ion of the woman, the rudeness and violence of the time were modified by the rise of chivalry, which was, in great part, founded on this new respect for the gentler sex, and sym- pathy for her helpless condition when exposed, without a pow- ful protector, to unrestrained insolence and passion; and the feudal system held all the elements of society in suspense until the mighty forces — revived learning, the printing press. and a new commerce and industry — were ready to take a prominent part in making it what we now find it — far supe- rior to the old society. 5. Feudalism held men apart, and individually subject to the refining influence of Christian precepts, from the tilth to the ninth century, when the romantic practice of chivalry became popular as a relief from the tedium of isolation, ami a channel for the flow of the softer sentiments of respeel for woman, of compassion for weakness, and, at the same tii a vent for the martial spirit which the constant conflicts of the time cultivated. The age of chivalry indicates thai Chris- tianity was powerfully moulding the character of the new nations. Working on qualities as tern and rude as those "f -[36 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. the old Eoman of the Republic, its partial control, the begin- nings of its power, were manifested in a romantic way. The isolation of feudal life, and a sense of wrong in employing all their energies in unceasing contests of ambition produced the chivalric outbreak and the crusades. The knights of chivalry were feudal lords and gentlemen, trained in all the warlike arts of the period and in all the courtesies which the new influence of female society produced. When starting forth as knight-errants, they were exhorted by the stern feudal war- rior to valor, and by the Christian priest to gentleness toward the weak and defenseless, and they made it the business of life to wander about on horseback incased in armor, dis- plaving their warlike accomplishments and combatting petty tyranny. There was little power in the king to right the wrongs of his subjects, and brutal violence in the feudal lords had no other effectual punishment. Chivalry flourished for more than five hundred years; but its most useful clays were from 1000 to 1200. It was the first, and seems to later times a somewhat amusing indication of a more humane social state than the world had ever known. 6. The crusades commenced about 1100, the object being to rescue the sepulcher of the founder of Christianity from unbelievers. It first engaged the sympathy of the people at large, then of the feudal nobility and finally interested the ambition of kings. For two hundred years a large part of the best blood of Europe was poured out in Palestine in a vain effort to expel the Saracens from it. The transportation of armaments and supplies to that country from various parts of Europe gradually led to commerce and skill in navigation; so much of ancient civilization and knowledge as still existed in the Eastern, or Greek Empire at Constantinople, was intro- duced into modern Europe, which at the same time was re- lieved of its more turbulent and adventurous elements; and a heavy blow was given to the smaller feudal proprietors by the expense incurred in a distant expedition where they died without issue, reduced their families to poverty, or whence THE LIBERTIES OF THE PEOPLE. 1^7 they returned penniless to mortgaged estates. It rapidly hastened the movement, begun by other influences, to reduce the number of feudal proprietors, and render government more vigorous over increasingly large territories. SECTION XV. THE LIBERTIES OF THE PEOPLE. 1. Between 1000 and 1200 the independent and enterpris- ing spirit — the individualism — that we have seen at the base of European character, and which first produced the Feudal System, began to move among the masses in various ways and laid the foundation for that influence of the People that was afterward to become the most powerful element in political life. It first presented itself in the development of industrial arts and commerce in cities which obtained, as corporations, the rights, or a part of the rights, of the feudal proprietor, which they proceeded to exercise under the form of Free Cities in Germany, privileged Communes in France and commercial Republics in Italy. 2. A second development, highly favorable some centuries later to the reaction of popular freedom against centralizing despotism in the government, was the religious protest against the claims of the church over freedom of thought. This spirit grew up in Germany, and its first remote beginnings are to be found in the imperial title conferred by the pope on Charle- magne. In the course of time (a. d. 963) that title was inher- ited by the German rulers who, f<»r a long time, struggled for the control of Italy and a feudal superiority over the popes. This was carried on for two centuries with much acrimony, in which the terms Guelph, the general name of those who supported the side of the popes, and Ghibellines, of those who rallied to the emperor, came to be the watchwords of Germany and Italy. The popes triumphed in tin'- cont< -t. which vented the establishment of a vast and powerful political des- 13S THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. put ism, and gave the church a temporal kingdom in a part of Italy, with an immense spiritual empire highly embar- rassing to free mental growth. The reaction against this spiritual control produced the Protestant Reformation of the sixteenth century, in which was wrapped up the germ of mod ern Republicanism. 3. The Crusades loosened the bonds of Feudalism, taught nations and rulers to act together to gain a common object, enlarged the experiences of men immensely, and cultivated and organized the spirit of personal adventure which afterwards expended itself on commerce. It was at about the crisis of this period (1215, a. d.) that the Magna Charta — the foundation of English constitutional liberty — was produced; that the Hanseatic League and Free Cities began to flourish in Germany; the commercial republics of Venice, Genoa and Florence rose in Italy; and the communal corporations in France sprang up. They were all more or less stimulated by influences growing out of the Crusades, and brought forward the people and their distinct and separate interests and activities into political importance. This was the beginning of an entirely new order of things, which re- quired a new continent for its full development. 4. A first circumstance, above all favorable to the liberties of the people, was the Invention of Printing, producing rapid diffusion of information, the coincident revival of learning: and the foundation of modern science. All these, working together with various other agencies, . gradually swept away feudalism, checked the towering spiritual tyranny of the church and corrected a crowd of minor evils that embarrassed society, enterprise, and progress in the science of government. The intermediate stage in this progress appeared like a return to old principles. The dissolution of feudalism left the govern- ments of Europe centralized. The lords inheriting feudal rights had become intolerable despots. For a certain period the authority of the king was the bulwark behind which the people sheltered themselves from the oppressions of their THE LIBERTIES OF THE PEOPLE. L39 feudal superiors, and they united with him to reduce the feudal uobility to the comparatively harmless condition of the modern aristocracy, whose greatest distinction is social pre-eminence. It left them, indeed, a high, but not overwhelming, position in the body politic, which the growing education and wealth of the middle and lower classes constantly tended to reduce. This change was commencing when America was discovered. The feudal chief's labored to extend and strengthen their power at the expense of each other, of the king and the people. The increasing activity and importance of commerce, trade and in- dustry required the support of a broad Legislation that could not be obtained while nations were broken up into petty lord- ships, principalities and kingdoms almost independent of each other, and whose rulers were often hostile to or at war with each other; while the support of so many rulers became a heavy burden on the resources of the people. The king rep- resented the nation and was the rallying point of reform. To strengthen him was to promote the larger interests of the country. 5. For these reasons, and from the resistance offered by the feudal institutions, which had existed a thousand years, authority became centralized in the monarch to an extrava- gant degree, and this at a time when freer institution.- were most required by the larger and wiser views of the people. The great usefulness of the Roman Catholic Church in civil- izing and educating the modern nations and founding a center or common bond between them, which produced a degree of unity in their progress, had continually added to her power, while the disposition to free thought was ever becoming more pronounced. Thus two despotic forces, each claiming absolute obedience in their respective spheres, were rising in strength to a degree extremely embarrassing to the growing intelli- gence and increased activities of the commonalty. The tradi- tional authority of the church and the king came, in the course of a hundred years alter the discovery of America, to 140 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. directly oppose the most important interests and instincts of mankind. 6. The progress of the people, as distinct from that of their governments, may then be described as starting in the last great service done for Europe by the church — the organ- ization of the Crusades. The feudal system separated men too much for healthy progress, and this singular display of religious zeal united the various nationalities in a common eftbrt, and stirred up powers that had long slumbered. It was in this period that the adventurous and comprehensive activities of modern life commenced. Wealth had been largely confined to the feudal nobility. It now began to flow out through the general community. The nobles expended vast sums in fitting out princely retinues to lead to the Holy Land, for which their estates were security. They died, or returned penniless, and their lands passed into the hands of the commercial classes, whose successful diligence had made them wealthy. It was the first heavy blow to feudal institu- tions, and laid the foundation of the power of the people. Corporations and cities which had obtained the rights of feudal proprietors, employed them for the purposes of self- government, and so used an instrument of despotism to shield and sustain a virtual democracv. With this freedom of action, popular liberty, controlled in a general way by feudal obligations to the prince, king, or emperor, grew fast and strong protected by the growing despotisms of the church and the state. The Hanseatic League, in the north of Germany, was, in the fourteenth and fifteenth centuries, perhaps as wealthy and powerful as any king or emperor in Christendom; and in the sixteenth, the small commercial province of the Netherlands could defy the whole power of Spain, with the wealth of the Indies at her back. 7. The revival of learning, and the invention of the art of printing, gave an immense impulse to this uprising of the people, commenced near three hundred years before; about the same time the Portuguese discovered the way to India by THE SITUATION ON Till'. I >is. ■ OF AMF.RIOA. Ill tin' Ciijn' of Good Hope, Columbus threw open tlie "Gates of tlie West," and the wealth of both Indies flowed in a full stream through the channels of commerce and trade; that is to say, into the hands of the busy and industrious people. All events seemed to conspire to build up a base for the power and development of the commonalty. This growing intelligence and strength among the masses,. with the habit of ruling themselves under feudal forms, made a conflict with the two arrogant despotisms inevitable in the near future. Feudal institutions were still a serious and vex- atious embarrassment to freedom of movement, and a very heavy tax on industry, and the only legal way to remove it was by strengthening the central or kingly power, which con- tinued to increase for more than a hundred years; but the conflict with priestly despotism was entered on at once. A vast rebellion against the church commenced, called "The- Reformation of the Sixteenth Century," which embraced nearly all the most enterprising and commercial nations. SECTION XVI. THE SITUATION ON THE DISCOVERY OF AMERICA. 1. "We have said that great men were a kind of summary of the tendencies of their period ; an expression of a wide- spread thought or state of mind, which their fortunate combi- nation of faculties and more favorable circumstances enabled them first to state, or embody, with distinctness; that the great following they obtained, and the extensive influence which enabled them to make great changes, were due to a coincident development in their generation of the same thought- and tendencies. This explains the existence of eras in all depart- ments of life. Men grow, or progress, silently, from one to the other ; when the general progress lias reached the Buitable point it breaks out in a leader more bold and positive than the rest. The discovery of America was Buch an era: and the Buddeo 14:2 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. advance in many ways at about the same time was the result of gradual growth during many centuries. It was shown by the sudden appearance of great men in different spheres. Columbus lived in the midst of a great era. Printing, the use of the compass, the science of astronomy and the successful protest against spiritual despotism all commenced their great career just before, or just after him. The great painters, whose works are now so much esteemed, were all living in 1500. Copernicus discovered the true planetary system in the year Columbus died. Gunpowder, which enabled Cortez to conquer the Mexican Empire, came into general use about the same period. Luther commenced the Reformation, while the first adventurers were creeping, with amazed curiosity, around the shores of the American continent. The foundation of all the sciences was then laid. Correct principles were enunciated for religion, government and thought; and the laws of nature, of human relations and of religious liberty were promulgated almost simultaneously. 2. But not all the European nations, and not all of any one nation, were prepared for this vast advance. The southern part of Germany, and the people in general in southern Europe, resisted what they regarded as a dangerous innovation, and the reform spread only north and west. The close connection instituted by Constantine between church and state, which was renewed under Charlemagne, raised at this time, along series of religious wars, which contributed to embarrass Protestant- ism in the same way by the necessity under which it lay, (or supposed it lay,) of seeking the protection of princes. Luther's reorganized church became the state religion of northern Europe, and fell under government control in Switzerland and Holland. Henry VIII. of England, while yielding, like a true Englishman, to the general tendency of Lis people, in taking the reformed faith under his protection constituted himself its head. In the long contest between Catholic and Protestant, it became apparent that full religious liberty was not then pos- THE SITUATION ON THE DISC0V1 i:v 01 AMI RIGA. 1 -}:', Bible in Europe; and the more, that a political eleraenl involved in the contest. Free thought oaturallv led to free institutions, aning fixity of an old state, in the same western direction, and the old and the new unite to establish frequent stages of progress. In this way a continuous growth has been secured that impresses on advancing culture the same unity, from first t.- last, that we see in the growth and menial development of the individual man. 2. We have seen the aggregation and primary discipline of mankind in the simple but extensive despotisms of western Asia, varied in Palestine bv a theocratic system which has produced the world's great religion, and in Egypt by the pi dominance of a learned priestly caste. We saw an improve- ment made in Greece to meet the demands of intellectual 10 146 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. development. Their intelligence, however, was a spontaneous outburst, of necessity immature. Two thousand years of training, and the addition of many new elements were required before mind could rule the world; but Greece, by the attractiveness of her art and culture, set men at work on the great problem of politics and life. Rome followed to organize government and consolidate the civilizations, to ripen their fruit and transmit the seed to a more favorable time, and to new and better races. A com- plete civilization was impossible without well digested science, which had its remote roots in Greece; and law, which was gradually produced by the grand Roman republic; and a clear understanding of the profound yet simple precepts of Jesus Christ. 3. Western Europe received all the wisdom and experience of the ancient world, and labored well at the grand problem, though she did not completely solve it. She, however, made an immense advance toward it, and her children, rich in her experience, instructed at once by her success and her mis- takes, and aided always by her wisdom, found (let us hope) in America the goal of their noblest aspirations. Thus we find the spirit of progress traversing the whole course of human history, constantly advancing through all the confu- sion of rising and falling states, of battle, siege and slaughter, of victory and defeat; through the varying fortunes and ulti- mate extinction of monarchy, republic and empire; through barbaric irruption and desolation, feudal isolation, spiritual supremacy, the heroic rush and conflict of the Cross and the Crescent; amid the busy hum of industry, through the marts of trade and behind the gliding keels of commerce; through the bloody conflicts of commons, nobles, kings and kaisers to New and Free America. There the Englishman, the German, the Frenchman, the Italian, the Scandinavian, the Asiatic and the African all meet as equals. There they are free to speak, to think, and to act. They bring their common contributions of character, energy and activity to the support and enlarge- • ONCLUSION. ] 17 merit of a common country, and the spread of its influence and enlightenment through all the lands of their origin. A- America is the common ground on which all the currents and ideas of all the civilizations meet, so also it i^ the poinl from which return currents, hastened by lightning and by .-team. seek again every quarter of the earth with kindly greetings, to renew the relations broken in the original separation of the races, and to cement, by exchanges mutually profitable, a new and better unity of mankind. As the heart in the human body receives the current of blood from all parts of the system, and, having revitalized it, returns it with fresh elements of strength, so America adopts the children of all lands only to return a manhood ennobled by a sense of its own dignity through the practice of a Bystem of self-govern- ment which improves the condition and promotes the inter- est of each while it produces harm to none. 4. America, then, will colonize Ideas, extensively, when her institutions are thoroughly matured. The process, indeed, commenced with her birth, and her Spirit sails with her Bhips in every sea and visits all lands. All the past has contributed to the excellence of her foundation, and modern Europe has supplied her with the most desirable building material both of ideas and of men. Without Asia, G-reece and Rome, there would have been a very imperfect modern Europe; and without modern Europe, America must have begun at tin- beginning, with all the lessons, discoveries and discipline of thousands of years to learn. Happily, we seem authorized to believe that, as she coucludes the possible great migrati* of humanity, she has so well learned the lessons of experience as to have given due flexibility and capacity of improvement to all her institutions, and, when necessary can reconstruct herself within herself. If this be true, she will reach the goal of all progress by furnishing to each individual among her citizens such aid as a state can give to make the most of himself, to reach the fullest expression of his value. CHAPTEE II THE DISCOVERY OF AMERICA. 1. Civilization, or the history of it, at least, commenced in the Eastern continent. The Western was, until a compara- tively recent period, quite unknown to those who recorded the progress of mankind, and the events by which it was marked. The science of the most learned men and nations of ancient times did not extend to a comprehension of geography beyond the limits of their own countries, and of the countries conquered by their rulers, or those which, bordering on these, held some relations with them. 2. The world appeared to be a flat surface, and no one thought of questioning that it was so only in appearance. It was reserved for a daring Genoese sea captain, about four hundred years ago, to conceive the happy idea that this appearance was deceptive; that it was really round; and that, by sailing west- ward, the distant East, or India, might be readily reached. Columbus, having become fully satisfied that this theory was correct, and not being rich enough to lit out an expedition himself, endeavored to convince others, who had the means, of the truth of his views, and to induce them to aid him to put them to the test. 3. The Genoese, living by commerce, and, at that time wealthy and powerful, gave him no encouragement. They even regarded him as a madman. He applied to the Govern- ments of Portugal, England, and Spain, but gained little attention for many years. At length Queen Isabella, of Spain, became interested in his theories, and, with much effort, as- (148) /H8C0VKBY OF AMKKICA. li'.l eisted liltn to put them to proof. He sot sail August 3, 1492, with three small vessels, on an unknown sea. His crew were lilled with tear to find themselves so far from land, and sailing toward unknown dangers. Tie had great difficulty in calming their terrors, and was in great danger of perishing in the mutiny they contemplated. He was saved by the opportune appearance of land on the 11th of October. He had reached die group of islands lying between North and South America. The one first discovered was called, by the natives whom lie found inhabiting it, Guanahani. He named it, in remem- brance of his peril, San Salvador — St. Savior. Supposing he had reached the Indies lying to the eastward of Asia, and not dreaming of a new continent, lie called the inhabitants Indians. Cuba and Hayti, larger islands lying further south, were soon ♦-fter discovered, and he hastened to carry back the wonderful Tidings of his discovery to Spain. He reached home seven months and eleven days after his departure. 4. He and his discoveries immediately became famous. The w^rld had never been struck with a surprise so great, and all Europe was in a ferment at the news. He soon returned as Viceroy of the newly discovered lands, to establish a colony And extend his researches. Five years later, in 1498, he dis- covered the main land near the river Orinoco, in the northern part of South America. He died in 1506, unaware of the magnitude of his discoveries, still believing he had only reached India from the west, and treated with much ingratitude by the government he had so much benefited by his bold genius. The first published account of the new continent was by a Florentine, Amerigo Vespucci, who visited the main land in 1499, claimed the merit of the discovery, and gave it his name, America. His claim has long been disallowed, and Columbus duly honored as the real discoverer, though the name was never changed. 5. It is believed that North America was known to the mar- iners of the North of Europe as early as the tenth century; and that settlements, that afterwards perished, were made from 150 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. Iceland and Greenland as far south as the shores of New England. This, however, is only a dim tradition, there being no detailed and authentic history of these events left on record so far as is yet known. 6. An English mariner, by descent a Venitian, disputes with Columbus the first sight of the main continent in 1498. He first touched the coast of Labrador, and sailed as far south as Florida in the next year. It was near a hundred years later before a permanent settlement was made within the ter- ritory that is now the United States, by the English, though the city of St. Augustine was founded in Florida by the Span- iards in 1565. In 1607 a settlement was made at Jamestown, on the Poto- mac river, in Virginia, and in 1620 the Puritans of England, persecuted there for their religious views, sought liberty of worship in the new world, establishing a colony at Plymouth, in the eastern part of New England. Others followed in succession until many distinct colonies had been planted on the eastern coast of the United States ; all of which — except Florida, belonging to the Spaniards, on the south, and Canada, settled by the French, on the north — were under the control of, and received their laws from, England. CHAPTER III. ©hbonologioal history of anolo american colonization fbom 1492 to 1703. 1492 — October 12, Christopher Columbus discovered laud belonging the Western Hemisphere — one of the Bahama Islands. He touches at Cuba and Ilayti before hifl return. 1497 — John Cabot, master of an English vessel, and his son Sebastian, touched at Newfoundland in June, and soon after explored the coast of Labrador. 1498 — Columbus, on his third voyage, discovers the American Continent, near the mouth of the Orinoco river, in South America. — Sebastian Cabot, in a second voyage, first of Europeans, explores our Atlantic coast as far south as Maryland. 1499 — Amerigo Vespucci, or Americna Yespucius, a Floren- tine merchant, conducts a vessel to the coast of South America. Returning to Europe he publishes a book, claiming to have first discovered the continent, and it receives his name, America. 1500 — Columbus is sent to Spain in chains by a Spanish officer whom the jealousy of Ferdinand, the Spanish King, placed over him. Treated with injustice and neglect, he died at Valladolid. Spain, in 1606. 1512 — Ponce de Leon, a Spaniard in search of the u Fountain of Youth," discovers Florida, near St. Augustine. 1524 — John Verrazani, a Florentine, commanding b French vessel, touches the coast near Wilmington, North Can>- (151) 152 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. lina, and explores it north to Nova Scotia. He wrote a narrative describing the country and the Indians. 1535 — James Carrier, a French navigator, discovers the St. Lawrence. 1541 — lie builds a Fort at Quebec, but soon abandons it. — De Soto, a Spaniard, discovers the Mississippi. He traveled, with six hundred men, through Georgia and Alabama, and fought a bloody battle with the Indians near Mobile. These Indians had a walled town ot several thousand inhabitants. Thence he traveled west to the Mississippi and Eed Rivers. He died at the mouth of the Red river, May 21, 1542. 1553 — Persecution of the English Puritans commences. 1562 — French Huguenots attempt a settlement in Florida. They gave the name Carolina to the coast on the north. The first colony is discouraged, and returns. In the year 1564 another Huguenot colony is founded on the River May. 1565— Melendez, a Spaniard, founds St. Augustine, September 8th, with five hundred colonists. It was the first per- manent settlement in the United States. ■ — Melendez destroys the French colony. 1567— The Chevalier Gouges (French) attacks St. Augustine, and puts to death two hundred Spaniards in retaliation. 1578 — The first English settlement contemplated. Queen Elizabeth grants a patent to Sir Humphrey Gilbert " to such remote, heathen, and barbarous lands as he should find in North America." He makes two attempts to plant a colony — in 1579 and in 1583 — fails in each, and perishes with his vessel, September 23, 1583. 1584 — Sir Walter Raleigh receives a similar patent, and send* two vessels to the shores of Pamlico Sound. Queen Elizabeth names the country Virginia. 1585 — Raleigh sends a colony to Roanoke Island, but it ia unfortunate, and returns home. 1587 — He 6ends another colony, but the Spanish Armada ANGLO-AMERICAN COLONIZATION | .",:', threatening England, In* could not send it supplies for some time, and when visited, later, no trace of it could be found. Discouraged, he gives up his patent to ;i London company of merchants, who content themselves to trade with the Indians. 1602 — Bartholomew Gosnold visits New England. 1003 — Henry IV., King of France, grants Acadia (Nova Scotia) to Sieur de fiConts, who founds a colony on the Bay of Fundv, at Port Royal in 1605. 1606 — lames [., King of England, establishes the Londonand Plymouth companies for settling North America. 1607 — The Plymouth company land a colony at the mouth of the Kennebec river. It is unfortunate, and returns to England. — The London company send out an expedition, which, accidentally discovering Chesapeake Bay, enter, and found a colony on James River, at Jamestown. The romantic. Captain .John Smith was one of the colonic. This was the first permanent English settlement in North America. 160S — Smith seeking, by orders from the London company, a passage to the Pacific ocean, up the Chiekahominy, is taken prisoner by the Indians, condemned to death, and saved by Pocahontas. — Quebec founded by the French under Champlain. — The English Puritans, persecuted in England, take refuge in Holland. 1609 — Lord Delaware is appointed Governor of Virginia, which receives a new charter, and a considerable acces- sion of numbers. — Part of the expedition, however, was shipwrecked, and the colony, embracing a large unruly and indolent ele ment, is near perishing. Pocahontas repeatedly save* them from the Indians. Hudson river and Lake ( 'hum plain discovered. 1610 — Lord Delaware, having been delayed, arrives (after the 154 TIIE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME.. discouraged colonists had embarked to return U Eng- land) with supplies, and saves the settlement.' 1613 — Pocahontas marries John Rolfe, an Englishman. — The Dutch erect a fort at New York. 1615 — They build Fort Orange, near Albany. 1619 — The first General Assembly elected by the people is called in Virginia, by Governor Yeardley. Eleven bor- oughs, or towns, were each represented by two Burgesses, or citizens. It was the dawn of civil liberty in Virginia, and a germ of the future republic. 1620 — Convicts are sent to Virginia, and negro slaves intro- duced. — September 6th, the Puritans, discontented in Holland, set sail in the Mayflower, from Plymouth, England, for America, undei the auspices of the " Plymouth Com- pany." — December 21st they land on Plymouth Rock, and, amid great hardships, found a religious colony. — James I. grants a charter to the Grand Council of Plymouth for governing New England. 1621 — A district called Mariana granted to John Mason. ■ — Plymouth colony makes a treaty with Massasoit. — Cotton first planted in Virginia. 1622 — Sir Ferdinand Gorges and John Mason obtain a charter of Maine and New Hampshire. They plant a colony on the Piscataqua river. —An Indian conspiracy nearly proves fatal to the Vir- ginia colony. March 22d, at noon, an attack is made on all the settlements, and in an hour nearly a fourth part of the colony is massacred. The colonists, in a bloody war, thoroughly chastise the Indians. 1624 — Virginia becomes a royal province, but stoutly main- tains its legislative authority. 1625 — Death of Robinson, the distinguished Puritan divine, in Holland. ANOLO-AMKKICAN COLONIZATION. ].,;, 1^29— Massachusetts colony patented, and settlement made at Salem, by John Endicott. — Charlestown, Mass., founded. The Dutch colonize the west side of Delaware river. 1630 — Patent of Carolina made to Sir Robert Heath. 1631 — Massachusetts General Court confines the privilege oi voting to church members. ( 'lay borne plants a colony on Kent Island. The Dutch erect a trading fort at Hartford. lt;:^J — Maryland granted to Lord Baltimore. 1633 — ( "iinecticut colony founded. 1636 — Roger Williams founds Providence. 1697 — Pequod war in Connecticut. 1638 — Rhode Island settled by followers of Anne Hutchinson. — Harvard college founded. — Swedes and Finns settle Delaware. — Colony of New Haven founded. Persecution in Mas- sachusetts. 1640 — Montreal, Canada, founded. 1641 — New Hampshire united to Massachusetts. 1643 — The germ of the American Union is planted by a con- federation of Plymouth, Massachusetts, Connecticut, and New Haven. It was for mutual protection and support, and was kept alive about forty years. 1645 — Clay borne causes an insurrection in Maryland. The Mohawks mediate between the Dutch and Algon- quins. — Witchcraft superstition commences. 1646 — John Elliott becomes a missionary to the Indians. 1649 — The Mohawk war on the French settlements and Jesuits. 1650 — Common School laws passed in Connecticut 1651 — English " Navigation Act" forbids colonists to trade with any country but England, and restricts trade among the colonies. Tims the English make all the 156 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. profits. English merchants set the price of purchases and sales. 1651 — Persecution of the Quakers in Massachusetts. — Proprietary government subverted in Maryland. 1657 — Elliott translates the Bible into the Indian language. 1662 — Winthrop obtains a liberal charter for Hartford and New Haven. 1663 — Carolina granted to a company of Noblemen. 1661 — The Dutch conquer the Swedes on the Delaware. New York granted to the Duke of York, who sends & force to dispossess the Dutch. It is done without fighting. New Jersey granted to Berkely and Carteret. 1665 — Lake Superior discovered by Father Allouez. 1668 — St. Mary's, between Lake Superior and Lake Huron, the first French settlement within the boundaries of the United States, founded. 1670 — Mr. Locke's philosophical constitution introduced in Carolina. It soon proved an absurd failure. 1673 — The Upper Mississippi discovered by Marquette. 1675 — King Philip's war in New England. He was a warrior of great ability and activity. Fourteen town were destroyed by the Indians, and six hundred inhabitants killed. Philip is killed August 12, 1676, and the Indian tribes very nearly destroyed. 1676— Three of the Kegicides (Judges of Charles L, King of England) came to New England. — New Jersey divided into East and West Jersey, at the suggestion of Win. Penn. Bacon's rebellion in favor of popular rights, i\i Vir- ginia. 1677 — Virginia obtains a new charter. Massachusetts purchases Maine. 1678 — Sir Edmund Andross, royal governor of Xew York, usurps the government of the Jerseys. 1679 — New Hampshire becomes a royal province, but the ANGLO-AMERICAN COLONIZATION. ];,7 people make a successful stand for their legislative privileges. — Massachusetts having disregarded the Navigation Act r Edward Randolph was sent as Inspector of Customs. He failed to enforce the act, and in 1682 the charter of Massachusetts was annulled. 1580 — Charleston, South Carolina, founded. 1681 — Win. Penn receives a grant of Pennsylvania from Charles II. — Penn restores the proprietary government in the Jerseys. — He founds Philadelphia; makes a treaty with the Indi- ans; and governs East Jersey. 1682 — La Salle visits and names Louisiana. 1686 — Sir Edmund Andross being made Governor-General over New England, proceeds in a very tyrannical man- ner. He endeavored to get possession of the charter of Connecticut, but failed, though he took possession of the government. 1688 — New York and New Jersey came under the jurisdiction of Andross; but James II., the tyrannical King of England, being deposed, Massachusetts imprisoned Andross. Rhode Island and Connecticut resumed their charter governments; but Massachusetts, having given offense by resistance to the Navigation Act, never recovered her original charter. — France having espoused the cause of the dethroned king, a war broke out between France and England, known as "King William's" war. 1689 — The government of New York is seized by Jacob Leis- ler for King William. 1690 — May 1st, a Congress of colonial delegates meets at New York to concert measures for the common defense. February 18th, destruction of Schenectady, N. Y., and massacre of the inhabitants by the Indians, sent by the French, from Canada. ■—March 18th, Salmon Falls, New Hampshire, on the 158 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. Piscataqua river, is destroyed by the French and Indi- ans. Casco, Maine, is also destroyed. —Sir William Phipps, Governor of Massachusetts, invades Canada, unsuccessfully. — French Protestants settle in Virginia and Carolina. 1691 — Slaughter becomes Governor of New York. He exe- cutes Leisler. 1692 — Massachusetts receives a new charter. Her limits are enlarged, but her privileges restricted. — Texas settled by the Spaniards, at Bexar. 1695 — Rice brought to Carolina, from Africa. 1697 — The Peace of Ryswick terminates King William's war. 1698 — Piracies of Captain Kidd. He was tried and executed in England, in 1701. 1699 — Pensacola is settled by the Spaniards. 1701 — William Penn grants a new charter to Pennsylvania. 1702 — The Jersevs united and -joined to New York. " Queen Anne's war " breaks out. New England suf- fered much from the ravages of the Indians. — Governor Moore, of South Carolina, attacks St. Augus- tine, but without success. — Mobile founded by d'Iberville, with a colony of Cana- dian French. —The Massachusetts Assembly contend with the royal governor for their former liberties. Their charter is still further restricted. 1703 — Delaware (called The Territories) is separated from Pennsylvania. 1706 — The French and Spaniards invade Carolina. They are repulsed with loss. 1707 — Detroit, Michigan, settled by the French. 1710 — Many thousand Germans, from the Palatinate, settle in the colonies, from New York to the Carolinas. 1712 — A war with the Tuscaroras, in North Carolina, results in their complete defeat. They unite with the Iroquois. ANGLO- AMERICAN COLONIZATION. 1 f.'.l 1713 — Crown Point, on Lake Champlain, and Niagara, are fortified by the French. The Peace of Utrechl closes Queen Anne's war. 1715 — In a war with the Yamassees, South Carolina loses fom hundred inhabitants, but expels the Indians. 1710 — Natchez founded by the French. 1717 — Father Iiasles, a Jesuit Missionary at Norridgwock, Maine, excites the Indians to drive out the Fuglish from Maine. He is the last of the Jesuit missionaries, and is slain in the capture of Norridgwock, in August, (.724, by New England troops. 1718 — New Orleans founded by the French. 1720- A royal government supercedes the proprietary, in Car- olina. 1723 -First settlement made in Vermont. 1729 — North and South Carolina erected into separate gov- ernments. 1732 — A company in England prepare to settle Georgia. 1733 — General Oglethorpe, with a colony, arrives in Georgia. 1736 — Many Scotch Highlanders and Germans settle in Georgia. 1738 — Insurrection of the slaves in South Carolina. 1740 — Genera] Oglethorpe invades Florida. He is repulsed. The Moravians settle in Pennsylvania. 1742 — The Spanish invade Georgia, but retire with loss. 1714— " The Old French War "begins. 1745— The New England colonies raise a force and capture Louisburg, the "Gibralter of America,'' from the French. 1748 — The treaty of peace of Aix la Chapelle, restores Louis- berg to France, to the great disgust of the colonies. 1750 — The French and English both claim the Mississippi and Ohio valleys. Lawrence •Washington, and others form the Ohio Company. Parliament grants it sil hun- dred thousand acres of land on, or near, the Ohio river. 160 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. The French dispute the possession, and threaten sum- mary ejectment. 1753 — George Washington is sent by Governor Dinwiddie, ot Virginia, as an envoy to the French and Indians in Ohio. 1754 — The French build Fort D\i Quesne (now Pittsburgh). Washington defeats a French party headed by De Jumonvillc. The French are reinforced by fifteen hundred men, and Washington with four hundred men, after defending himself one day, capitulates. < — The British government, in expectation of a speedy war with France, recommend the colonies to form a Union for defense. Delegates from seven colonies meet at Albany, June 14, 1754. A plan of Union was drawn up by Benjamin Franklin. Connecticut rejected it as giving too much power to the English government. Parliament rejected it as giving too much to the colo- nies. 1755 — Braddock'c defeat in Pennsylvania. — War with the Cherokees, in Tennessee. — The French, under Dieskau, are defeated at Lake George. 1756 — War was formally declared, two years after it actually begun. 1757 — Fort William Henry, being attacked by an overwhelm- ing force of French and Indians, surrenders, and the garrison are massacred by the Indians. 1758 — July 6, Louisburg captured by the English under Gen- eral Amherst. — General Abercrombie is repulsed in an attack on Fort Ticonderoga, and Lord Howe, much liked in the colo- nies, is killed. — August 27, Fort Frontenac ; now Kingston, Canada. taken by Col. Bradstreet — November 25, Fort Du Quesne taken by the English, under General Forbes. ANGLO-AMERICAN COLONIZATION. ] g | 1759 — General Wolfe, commander of the English, and General Montcalm, of the French arm)', meet in battle on the Heights of Abraham, near Quebec. Wolfe's army conquered, but both commanders lost their lives. Que- bec capitulated. George III. ascends the throne of England. 17G0 — September 8th, Canada surrendered to the English. Massachusetts vigorously opposes " Writs of Assist- ance " (^search warrants for goods that had not paid the duty). 17G1 — The Cherokees reduced to peace by Colonel Grant. In October, Mr. Pitt, the English Prime Minister, always a friend of the colonies, resigns. 11 CHAPTER IV. CHRONOLOGICAL HISTORY OF THE ANGLO-AMERICAN COLONIES, FROM 1763 TO JULY 4, 1776. In Febrnaiy, 1763, The Peace of Paris, concluded between the governments of England and France, closed the war in America that had been so painful to the colonies from the part which the French persuaded the Indians to take in it. But, while the colonies bore a large part of the burden, (they had raised $16,000,000 of its expenses, and had lost, in battle or in hospital, 30,000 men,) of a war that drove the French out of all their possessions in Canada and east of the Missis- sippi river; they were, at the same time, trained to act in con- cert, which paved the way for a future confederation, and hardened them to war. Being called into battle under celebrated English commanders, and to fight side by side with European veterans, they had opportunity to learn the art of war, as well as to compare themselves with the soldiers of the mother coun- try and of France. This comparison was favorable to them, and inspired them with confidence in their own ability. The fatal blunders of Gen. Braddock, and the skill and bra- very of Washington and his provincial troops which, alone, saved the British army from entire annihilation in the Penn- sylvania wilderness, was never forgotten. They felt them- selves, even as raw militia, equal to the best European soldiers, when on their own ground. It was a great mistake of the Home Government to put on an arrogant tone with them just when they had learned their strength. In the year 1764 that government, plunged in debt by its long wars with the continental powers, (it amounted to (162) TfJE ANGLO-AMKKICAN COI.ii.Mm. 1C3 $700,000,000,) and on the plea tliat the colonies who had been protected, should bear a fair share of the pecuniary burden, determined to impose taxes on them. Previously they had restricted their commerce to English ports, had laid duties on various imports, and assumed authority to change the govern- ments of the colonies without their consent. Tin's had pro- duced much dissatisfaction, but had no further immediate effect than to lead them to remonstrance, evasion, or legal resistance. The proposal to lay internal taxes was quite another affair. Submission to this they thought would be fatal to their liber- tics. They resisted with general moderation, respectfully, but with determined resolution. The British ministry were provoked by this resistance, hold- ing it to be rebellion; and determined to put it down, by force, if need be. The struggle continued for ten years with grow- ing obstinacy on either side. The home government was exceedingly obtuse or it would have either proceeded to ex- tremes at once or yielded the whole case, as it finally deter- mined to do in 1776, when it was too late. In this period of lively discussion, and of organization to secure the strength of union in resistance, the separate colonies were gradually moulded into a nation, imbued with common sympathies and ideas, and moved by common interests. They had not thought of independence during all this preliminary struggle. The war had lasted a year before that idea became prominent. That was not, even then, regarded as an end, so much as an indispensable means to secure their liberties. Thus we 6ee that no taint of conspiracy attached to the revolutionary struggle. The colonies were thoroughly loyal, until loyalty came to mean loss of liberty, and the rights enjoyed bv Kn^ lishmen in England. The exercise of arbitrary power the\ Pelt it right to resist; but they exhausted all other modes and means of resistance before they resorted to arms. They did not even make a first attack. They waited till armies were sent to subjugate them, and until those armies 164 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. commenced the attack; then the whole country rose in the stern resolve to right their wrongs. 1763. The Peace of Paris was signed in February of this year. July 7th began "Pontiac's War," with the simultaneous attack on all the forts in the peninsula of Michigan, and the whole frontier of Pennsylvania and Virginia. Pontiac was an Ottawa chief, of great ability, and had drawn many Indian tribes into the war. It was virtually ended in September of the same year. 1764. April 5. — " The Sugar Act " was passed in the English Parlia- ment. This levied duties on coffee, pimento, French and East India goods, and forbade iron and lumber to be exported except to England. It was for the avowed purpose of raising a revenue, and raised instead a storm of indignation. The Massachusetts House of Representatives said: "If we are taxed and not represented, we are slaves." 1765. Feb. 27 — Was passed the obnoxious Stamp Act. Also the military law was made to authorize the ministry to send any number of troops to the colonies, for whom the colonists were to find " quarters, fire- wood, bed- ding, drink, soap, and candles." May 29 — Patrick Henry introduced five " Resolutions " into the Virginia House of Burgesses, claiming for Virgin- ians the rights of British subjects; that only their own representatives could lawfully tax them; declar- ing the attempt to vest that power in any other hands subversive of both British and American liberty. Sept. 1 — The Pennsylvania Assembly passed similar resolu- tions. Oct. 7 — A congress of delegates, or committees, from nine colonies, met in New York. It was the first Con- TIIK ANGLO- AMERICAN 0OLONIE8. !»;.•, tinental Congress. Its spirit harmonized with that of Massachusetts, Virginia, and Pennsylvania, and its u Declaration of Rights and Grievances" was cor- dially approved by all the colonial assemblies. 1766. Mar. 29 — The Stamp Act could not be enforced in America, and it was repealed by Parliament; but the repeal vas followed by another act asserting the power and right of Parliament " to bind the colonies in all cases whatsoever." Thus yielding the thing and as- serting the principle, they both strengthened the colonies by a sense of their power, and exasperated them by a total denial of their Declaration of Rights. May — Yet their triumph filled the colonies with joy, and gratitude toward the King and their English friends. Virginia voted the King a statue. 1767. June — But their exultation was short-lived. In this year taxes were levied on tea, paints, paper, glass, and lead. This led to the determination, on the part of the colonies, to pay no more taxes or duties at all. Oct 28 — The Governor of Massachusetts having refused to call the General Court (or legislative body of the col- ony) together, a public meeting was held and reso.- lutions passed to encourage " economy, industry, and manufactures," and a committee appointed to get subscribers to an agreement to discontinue the im- portation of British goods not absolute necessaries. This was imitated in other colonies. 1768. Feb. 11 — Massachusetts General Court issues a general circu- lar to other colonial assemblies, inviting cooperation for the defense of colonial rights. Tho« ladies mostly gave cordial replies. This ( reni ral ( lourt hav- July , ing been dissolved, the new one beimr called <>n to rescind this circular, refused by a vote of ninetv-two IQQ THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIMK. to seventeen. These seventeen became the butt of public scorn. Sept. 12 — Four regiments of British troops ordered to Boston. " 22 The governor had been desired, by a Boston " town meeting," to call a General Court. lie refused, and the "meeting" issued a call for delegates from the towns to a colonial convention. More than a hun- dred towns were represented in the convention meet- ing this day. Their main effort was to vindicate the " 28 colony from the charge of a rebellious spirit. The day after this meeting adjourned two regiments of British troops arrived in Boston. 1769. Jan'y — Parliament severely censures all the colonial acts, and directs that persons arrested in the colonies for treason be sent to England, to be tried. May — The Virginia Assembly take strong ground against this, and agree with the Massachusetts Convention. " 31 — The Massachusetts General Court assembles, but refuses to transact business in the midst of an armed force. After long contest with them the Governor adjourned them to Cambridge. June 13— Required to support the troops, they respectfully and temperately, but firmly, refuse, and decline to vote any supplies for government till their grievances are redressed. July 15- — All the colonies manifest the same spirit. 1770. Mar. 5 — The indignation of Boston at the presence of troops breaks out into an affray. The troops fire on the citi- zens. Three are killed and five wounded. It was called the " Boston Massacre." April — British Parliament repeals the last tax on all articles but tea. The non-importation agreements had exerted a great influence in promoting economy, encouraging manufactures, and bringing " home-made " into fash- THE ANGLO-AMERICAN COLONIES. |»;7 ion. The graduating class in Harvard College took their derives in "■ home-spun" this year. 1771. Throughout this year the same disputes were main- tained between the governor- and colonial legislatures as formerly; but as the home government did not push the struggle to an issue, there was comparative quiet, but no yielding. 1772. June 10— The Qaspe, a British revenue schooner, burned by a party from Providence, Rhode Island. Parliament offers six hundred pounds sterling and a pardon to any accomplice who will confess and give up the offenders. They were well known by colonists, but no legal evidence could ever be obtained. Oct. 28 — A committee appointed in Boston to state the rights of the colonists and correspond with other sections on this subject. They publish an address, which is extensively circulated. Franklin, agent for the colo- nies in England, republishes it there. 1773. March — This address led to the first measures for a political union of the colonies. July — The British ministry attempt to import tea into the colonies. Oct. 2 — The people of Philadelphia declare that any one who shall "aid or abet in unloading, receiving, or vending the tea is an enemy to his country." Nov. 3 — The Boston consignees required by the people to resign. They refuse. •• ~>-19 — A legal town meeting takes them in hand, and at length they resign. Dec'r — Three ships loaded with tea having arrived, the people labor for near a month to have them Bent back. Not succeeding, the cargoes are all emptied into the 6ea. 168 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. 1774. Mar. 25 — Parliament retaliated by the "Boston Port Bill," closing it to commerce. May 13-20 — Meetings held in the principal cities to consider the state of affairs, recommended the assembly of a Continental Congress. This body was appointed in all the provinces but Georgia. There were fifty-three delegates. Sept. 4 — These assemble at Philadelphia, and Peyton Randolph, of Virginia, is chosen President. They publish a " Declaration of Colonial Rights." They agree on fourteen articles as the basis of an " American Asso- ciation" to support these rights. This body was henceforth the real government, all their directions being obeyed by the people. They completed the organization of the Union and took preliminary measures for defense in case of attack. 1775. Feb. 1 — Lord Chatham introduced a bill in Parliament which might have accommodated all differences, but it was treated with great discourtesy. Parliament deter- mines to humble and subdue the colonies. April 19 — Battle of Lexington. General Gage sends eight hundred British troops to destroy some colonial mili- tary stores at Concord, twenty miles from Boston. The " minute men " assembled at Lexington, are fired on and dispersed. The troops march to Concord, destroy the stores, and hastily retreat before the gath- ering minute men, who assail them on all sides. They would have been completely destroyed but for a timely reinforcement at Lexington of nine hundred men and two cannon. The loss of British killed and wounded was nearly three hundred; of the provincials eighty- five. Boston is immediately beleagured by some twenty thousand minute men. " 22 — Massachusetts Legislature assembles. It sends depo- THE ANGLO-AMERICAN 0OLONTK8. 169 sitions, proving that the soldiers fired first, to Eng- land, with an address to the English people, declaring that they will " die or be free." This body voted a levy- of thirteen thousand men for the protection of the colony. )£ay 10 — The second Continental Congress assembled at Phil- adelphia. Colonels Ethan Allen and Benedict Arnold surprise the fortress of Ticonderoga, on Lake George, New York. Its small force of three officers and forty-four privates cannot defend it, and they surrender without fighting. Crown Point, on Lake Champlain, is occu- pied without resistance. Peyton Randolph again chosen President of Congress. « 24 — Peyton Randoph being called homo, John Hancock, of Massachusetts, is chosen President of Congress. " 25 — Generals Howe, Clinton, and Burgoyne, with large British reinforcements, arrived at Boston. June 15 — George Washington unanimously chosen commander- in-chief of the Continental forces. « i7_The battle of Bunker Hill (or Breed's Hill), near Bos- ton. The British were twice repulsed, with great loss, when the ammunition of the Americans failing, they retreated in safety. British loss over one thou- sand ; American, four hundred and fifty. British forces engaged, three thousand ; American, less than fifteen hundred. The British commander burned Charlcstown during the battle. General Warron, American, was killed. « 23— Congress issue bills of credit for $2,000,000. " 30— Articles of War arc agreed to in Congress. July g— A last petition to the King is sent, bv Itiehanl Penn, grandson of William Penn. " 17 — Another million dollars in bills of credit is issued. The liability for these was distributed among tho Colonics. 170 THE FOOTPRINTS OF T1MK. July 26 — Benjamin Franklin appointed first Postmaster Gen- eral. Aug. 30 — General Schuyler embarks on Lake Cbamplain, for an expedition against Canada. He leaves the com- mand with General Montgomery. Early in Septem- ber General A mold starts with eleven hundred men to Canada by Maine. Sept. 24 — Ethan Allen is taken prisoner, near Montreal. Oct. 18— Falmouth (now Portland, Maine) burned by the British. " 22 — Peyton Randolph, of Virginia, died. He was the first President of Congress. Nov. 3 — Montgomery captures St. Johns, Canada. " 13 — Montreal surrendered to the Americans under Mont- gomery. " 20 — $3,000,000 more in bills of credit issued by Congress, payable in eight years. Dec. 7 — Lord Dunmore, British Governor of Virginia, defeated near Norfolk, Virginia. " 13 — A navy of thirteen vessels created by Congress. Let- ters of marque and reprisal granted. « 21 — The British Parliament pass a bill declaring all Amer- ican vessels and goods, and those of all persons trad- ing with them, a lawful prize, and authorizing the impressment of American sailors into the royal navy, where they might be required to fight against their own cause and friends. " 31 — General Montgomery and Colonel Arnold make an unsuccessful attack on Quebec. Montgomery is killed, Arnold wounded, and four hundred men killed, wounded, or taken prisoners. Arnold withdrew, but kept Quebec blockaded through tho winter. 1776. Jan. 1 — Lord Dunmore, Royal Governor of Virginia, ravages the coast and burns Norfolk, but is obliged to fly to Bermuda. Tin-: a.\(,i..)-ami:kioan colonies. I7j Jan. 20 — Georgia prepares to join the other twelve colonies. Feb. 4 — Mcintosh, with an American force, destroys several vessels Loading for England, near Savannah, Georgia, " IT — Four millions more of paper money isssued by Con- gress. March 4 — Washington fortifies Dorchester Heights, overlook- ing Boston, which renders it untenable by the British. " 10 — The inhabitants and merchants of Boston plundered of their lighter property by the British army. « 17 — The British embark for Halifax, and Washington occupies the town. " 18 — Sir Archibald Campbell sails into Boston, and his whole force of seventeen hundred men are taken pris- oners. " 23 — Congress declares all British vessels a lawful prize. April 2t> — Washington removes his army to New York. May 3 — Sir Peter Parker, with ten ships of war and seven regiments, joins the force from Boston under General Clinton, at Cape Fear. " 15 — Congress declared that all authority under the British crown ought to be totally suppressed and government conducted by colonial representatives alone. This was only an expression of their sense of the danger to their interests and liberties of allowing British agents to act. June 7 — Richard Henry Lee, of Virginia, moved the Declara- tion of Independence. " 8 — American army in Canada, nnder General Sullivan, make an unsuccessful attack on the enemy. Th v are pressed bysuperi >r numbers, and retreat in good order, though with a loss of one thousand inn pris- oners, out of Canada, losing all their conquests. " 11 — Congress appointed Thomas Jefferson, John Adan Benjamin Franklin, and Robert R. Livingston a com- mittee to prepare the Declaration of Independence. 172 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME, Jim. 28 — British fleet attack Fort Moultrie, on Sullivan's Island, near Charleston, South Carolina, but were defeated with loss of two hundred men, one vessel, and death of Lord Campbell, the ex-royal Governor. July 4 — Declaration of Independence by the Congress at Philadelphia. CHAPTER V. FORMATION OF THE ORIGINAL UNION. "The Boston Tea Party " provoked the English Parliament into passing "The Boston Port Bill," closing that city to com- merce. This act led to immediate measures for assembling delegates, representing twelve colonies in North America (Georgia, only, was not represented), for the purpose of con- sultation on the measures required for the protection of colonial rights. This body, called kl The Continental Congress," assem- bled in Philadelphia, September 5, 1774. It drew up a "Declaration of Colonial Eights;" and, for the purpose of enforcing them, agreed to accept as a basis of common action fourteen articles, known as "The American Association." This was the origin of the American Union. Though it did not assume organic political power, and its ordinances were only advisory in form, it was better obeyed than most govern- ments. Arrangements were made for another Congress in May following. Its day of meeting was hastened by the battle of Lexington, and it immediately proceeded to assume the pow- ers of a General Government, at the request of some of the provincial Legislatures, and with the tacit consent of all. It received its authority from its representative character; from the imperious necessity of ahead to organize and direct; and from the voluntary obedience rendered t.» its mandates. It performed all the functions of a government until all prospect of reconciliation with Great Britain was lost, when, June 11, 1776, a committee was appointed to prepare "A Declaration of Independence." This was adopted and signed July 4. 1776. (171 174 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. On the 12th of July, a committee of one from each State reported on the terms of confederation, and the powers of Con- gress; but differences of opinion, and the pressure of military affairs prevented action on it. On the 9th of September, 1776, The name " United Colonies of America" was discarded for that of " United States of America." Georgia had appointed delegates on the 4th of July, so that there were n Thirteen United States." On Saturday, November 15, 1777, " Articles of Confederation and Perpetual Union of the United States of America " were agreed to in Congress, and sent to the States for approval. Eight of the State Legislatures had ratified these articles on the 9th of July, 1778; one ratified July 21st; one July 24th; one November 26th, of this year; one February 22d, 1779; and the last, March 1, 1781. This document was little more than a digest of the powers before assumed by Congress, and tacitly acknowledged by the States from the commencement of the war. This, now legal, bond had existed before as a free, though unspoken, submis- sion to the dictates of prudence and patriotism. CHAPTER VI. DECLARATION OF INDEPENDENCE. This immortal state paper — fl the general effusion of the 6onl of the country" at the imperiled state of liberty, and of the rights of Englishmen — was given to the world on the 4th of July, 177o. The war of the Revolution had been raging more than a year, and many of the leading minds of the country had been actuated by the hope that their wrongs would be redressed, and the mother country and her colonies reconciled . The course of events had convinced them, however, thai there would be no redress, and that no reconciliation was possible other than that based on aslavish surrender of rights and priv- ih iges dear to free men. And hence a more decided course was approved by the people, and finally adopted by their delegates in Congress, on the 2d day of July, 177G. This resolution changed the old thirteen British colonies into free and independent States. And now it remained to set forth the reason for this- act, together with the principles that should govern this new ; pie. By this declaration the new Republic, as it took its place among the powers of the world, proclaimed its faith in the truth, reality, and unchangablenees of freedom and virtue. And the astonished nations, as they read that all men are cre- ated equal, started out of their lethargy, like those who have been exiled from childhood when they suddenly hear the dimly remembered accents of their mother tongue. (178 176 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. THE DECLAKATION OF INDEPENDENCE. When, in the course of human events, it becomes necessary for one people to dissolve the political bands which have con- nected them with another, and to assume among the powers of the earth, the separate and equal station to which the laws of nature and of nature's God entitle them, a decent respect to the opinions of mankind requires that they should declare the causes which impel them to the separation. "We hold these truths to be self-evident, that all men are cre- ated equal; that they are endowed by their Creator with certain inalienable rights; that among these are life, liberty, and the pursuit of happiness. That to secure these rights, govern- ments are instituted among men, deriving their just powers from the consent of the governed ; that, whenever any form of government becomes destructive of these ends, it is the right of the people to alter or to abolish it, and to institute a new government, laying its foundation on such principles, and organizing its powers in such form, as to them shall seem most likely to effect their safety and happiness. Prudence, indeed, will dictate that governments long established should not be changed for light and transient causes; and, accordingly, all experience hath shown that mankind are more disposed to suffer, while evils are sufferable, than to right them by abolish- ing the forms to which they are accustomed. But when a long train of abuses and usurpations, pursuing invariably the same object, evinces a design to reduce them under absolute des- potism, it is their right, it is their duty to throw off such government, and to provide new guards for their future security. Such has been the patient sufferance of these colo- nies, and such is now the necessity which constrains them to alter their former systems of government. The history of the present King of Great Britain is a history of repeated injuries and usurpations, all having in direct object the establishment of an absolute tyranny over these States. To prove this,, let facts be submitted to a candid world: DEOLABATIOH OF INDKl'KNOKNOE. 177 He has refused his assent to laws the most wholesome and necessary for the public good. lie has forbidden his Governors to pass laws of immediate and pressing importance, unless suspended in their operation till his assent should be obtained; and when so suspended, h« has utterly neglected to attend to them. Ee has refused to pass other lavs for the accommodation of large distri its of people, unless those people would relinquish the right of representation in the legislature; a right inestima- ble to them, and formidable to tyrants only. IK- has called together legislative bodies at places unusual, uncomfortable, and distant from the depository of their public records, lor the sole purpose of fatiguing them into compliance with his measures. He has dissolved representative houses repeatedly for oppos- ing, with manly firmness, his invasions on the rights of the people. lie has refused, for a long time after such dissolution, to cause others to be elected; whereby the legislative powers, incapable of annihilation, have returned to the people at large for their exercise; the State remaining, in the meantime, exposed to all the danger of invasion from without, and con- vulsions within. 1 1 has endeavored to prevent the population of these State-; for that purpose, obstructing the laws for naturalization of foreigners; refusing to pass others to encourage their migra- tion hither, and raising the conditions of new appropriations of lands. He has obstructed the administration of justice, by refusing his assent to laws for establishing judiciary powers. lie ha.- made judges dependent on his will alone, for the tenure of their offices, and the amount and payment of their salaries. lie has erected a multitude of new offices, and cent hil swarms of officers to harass our people, and eat out their sub- stance. 12 178 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. Pie has kept among us, in times of peace, standing armies, without the consent of our legislature. He has affected to render the military independent of, and superior to, the civil power. He has combined with others, to subject us to a jurisdiction foreign to our constitution, and unacknowledged by our laws; giving his assent to their acts of pretended legislation. For quartering large bodies of armed troops among us: For protecting them, by a mock trial, from punishment for any murders which they should commit on the inhabitants of these States: For cutting off our trade with all parts of the world: For imposing taxes on us without our consent: For depriving us, in many cases, of the benefits of trial by Wy: For transporting us beyond seas to be tried for pretended offenses : For abolishing the free system of English laws in a neigh- boring province, establishing therein an arbitrary government, and enlarging its boundaries, so as to render it at once an example and fit instrument for introducing the same absolute rule into these colonies: For taking away our charters, abolishing our most valuable Jaws, and altering fundamentally, the powers of our government: For suspending our own legislatures, and declaring them- selves invested with power to legislate for us in all cases what- soever. He has abdicated government here, by declaring us out of his protection, and waging war against us. He has plundered our seas, ravaged our coasts, burnt oui towns, and destroyed the lives of our people. Ho is, at this time, transporting large armies of foreign mer cenaries to complete the work of death, desolation, and tyranny already begun, with circumstances of cruelty and perfith scarcely paralleled in the most barberous ages, and totalb unworthy the head of a civilized nation. DECLARATION OF INDEPENDENCE. 17!) He has constrained our fellow-citizens, taken captive on tlio high seas, to bear arms against their country, to become the executioners of their friends and brethren, or to fall themselves by their hands. He has excited domestic insurrections amongst us, and has endeavored to bring on the inhabitants of our frontiers, the merciless [ndian savages, whose known rule of warfare is an undistinguished destruction of all ages, sexes, and conditions. In every stage of these oppressions, we have petitioned for redress, in the most humble terms; our repeated petitions have been answered only by repeated injury. A prince, whose character is thus marked by every act which may define a tyrant, is unfit to be the ruler of a free people. Nor have we been wanting in attention to our British brethren. We have warned them from time to time, of attempts made by their Legislature to extend an unwarranta- ble jurisdiction over us. We have reminded them of the circumstances of our emigration and settlement here. We have appealed to their native justice and magnanimity, and we have conjured them, by the ties of our common kindred, to disavow these usurpations, which would inevitably interrupt, our connections and correspondence. They, too, have been deaf to the voice of justice and consanguinity. Wo must, therefore, acquiesce in the necessity which denounces our si aration, and hold them, as we hold the rest of mankind, enemies in war, in peace, friends. WV. therefore, the representatives of the UNITED STATES OF AMERICA, in GENERAL CONGRESS assembled, appealing to the Supreme Judge of the World for the recti- tude of our intentions, do, in the name, and by the authority of the good people of these colonies, solemnly publish dare: That these United Colonies are, and of right oug tto be, FREE AND [NDEPENDENT STATES; that they are olved from all allegiance to the British crown, and that ail political connection between them and the State ol ( I Britain, is, and ought to be, totally dissolved; and that, as 180 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. FEEE AND INDEPENDENT STATES, they have full power to levy war, conclude peace, contract alliances, establish commerce, and to do all other acts and things which INDE- PENDENT STATES may of right do. And, for the support of this declaration, and in a firm reliance on the protection of DIVINE PKOVIDENCE, we mutually pledge to each other our lives, our fortunes, and our sacred honor. The foregoing declaration was, by order of Congress, engrossed, and signed by the following members: JOHN HANCOCK. New Hampshire. josiah bartlett, William Whipple, Matthew Thornton. Rhode Island. Stephen Hopkins, William Ellery. Connecticut. Roger Sherman, Samuel Huntington, William Williams, Oliver Wolcott. New York. William Floyd, Philip Livingston, Francis Lewis, Lewis Morris. New Jersey. Richard Stockton, John Witherspoon, Francis Hopktnson, John Hart, Abraham Clark. Pennsylvania. Robert Morris, Benjamin Rusn, Benjamin Franklin, John Morton, George Clymer, James Smith, George Taylor, Jambs Wilson. George Ross. Massachusetts Bay. Samuel Adams, John Adams, Robert Treat Painb, Elbridge Gerry. Delaware. Gssar Rodney, George Reed, Thomas M'Kean. Maryland. Samuel Chase, William Paca, Thomas Stone, Charles Carroll, of Carrollton. Virginia. George Wythe, Richard Henry Lee, Thomas Jefferson, Benjamin Harrison, Thomas Nelson, Jun., Francis Lightfoot Lee. Carter Braxton. North Carolina. William Hooper Joseph Hewes, John Penn. South Carolina. Edward Rutledge, Thomas Hey wood, Jun., Thomas Lynch, Jun., Arthur Middleton. Georgia. Button Gwinnett, Lyman Hall, George Walton. CHAPTER VII. ARTICLES OF CONFEDERATION AND PERPETUAL UNION BETWEEN THE STATES. To all whom these Presents shall come. We, the under&igned I>< I, gates of the States affixed to our names, send greeting — Whereas, the Delegates of the United States of America, in Congress assembled, did, on the 15th day of November, in the year of our Lord 1777, and in the Second Year of the Inde- pendence of America, agree to certain Articles of Confedera- tion and Perpetual Union between the States of New Hamp- shire, Massachusetts Bay, Rhode Island and Providence Plantations, Connecticut, New York, New Jersey, Pennsylva- nia, Delaware, Maryland, Virginia, North Carolina, South Carolina, and Georgia, in the words following, viz.: Articles of Confederation and Perpetual Union between the States of New Hampshire, Massachusetts Bay, Rhode Island and Providence Plantations, Connecti- cut, New York, N w Jersey, Pennsylvania, Delaware^ Maryland, Virginia, North Carolina, Soidh Carolina, and Georgia. Article 1. The style of this Confederacy shall be '-The United States of America." Art. 2. Each State retains its sovereignty, freedom, and independence, and every power, jurisdiction, and right, which is not by this confederation expressly delegated to the I aited in ( !ongres8 assembled. Akt. 3. The said States hereby severally enter into a firm league of friendship with each other, for their common defense, (181) 132 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. tha security of their liberties, and their mutual and general u fare, binding themselves to assist each other against all .r attacks made upon them, or any of them, on iint of religion, sovereignty, trade, or any other pretense whatever. Ai:r. 4. The better to secure and perpetuate mutual friend- ship Miid intercourse among the people of the different States in this Union, the free inhabitants of each of these States — paupers, vagabonds, and fugitives from justice excepted — shall be entitled to all privileges and immunities of free citizens in the several States; and the people of each State shall have free ingress and egress to and from any other State, and shall enjoy tin-rein all the privileges of trade and commerce, subject to the 6ame duties, impositions, and restrictions, as the inhabitants thereof respectively, provided that such restriction shall not extend so far as to prevent the removal of property, imported into any State, to any other State of which the owner is an inhabitant; provided, also, that no imposition, duties, or restric- tion shall be laid by any State on the property of the United States, or either of them. If any person guilty of or charged with treason, felony, or other high misdemeanor in any State, shall fiee from justice, and be found in any of the United States, he shall, upon demand of the Governor, or executive power of the State from which he fled, be delivered up and removed to the State having juris- diction of his offense. l'u 11 faith and credit shall be given in each of these States,, to the records, acts, and judicial proceedings of the courts and magistrates of every other State. A 1:1. 5. For the more convenient management of the gene- ral interest of the United States, Delegates shall be annually appointed, in Bnch manner as the legislature of each State shall direct, to meet in Congress on the first Monday in November, in < \ to call a General Convention to revise the Articles of Confederation. This convention assembled in May, 1787, in Philadelphia; all the States except Rhode Island being represented. George Washington was chosen president, The members of this con vention were the representatives of a people who had proved their firmness and attachment to liberty during a long war and against great difficulties. The delegates were nun of tried patriotism, and the event has proved their wise and discrimi- (203) THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIMS. nating foresight. The system of government they planned is their most eloquent eulogy. The severe tests to which the expansion of the nation and the conflicts of sections and inter- 9te have subjected it, have served only the more fully to reveal how perfectly they comprehended the principles of a republi- can government, and their singular skill in arrangement. They combined the utmost vigor with the greatest security of rights. It is a glorious monument to their political insight. They, themselves, were not aware how profound was the wisdom, how complete the adaptation of its provisions. They signed it with many misgivings, on the 17th of September, 1787, after four months of diligent labor. It was then presented to the people tor their ratification. They were cautious and prudent in those times, and could not appreciate as we do now, the extreme value of the work that had been accomplished. Time was required to bring out its excellences, and show how few and comparatively unimportant were its defects. It was examined with careful attention, and finally adopted as follows: By Convention of Delaware 7th • December, 1787 Pennsylvania 12th December, 1787 New Jersey 18th December, 1787 Georgia 2d January, 1788 " " Connecticut 9th January, 1788 " " Massachusetts 6th February, 1788 " « Maryland 28th April, 1788 " " South Carolina 3rd May, 1788 " " New Hampshire 21st June, 1788 " " Virginia 26th June, 1788 " " New York 26th July, 1788 " " North Carolina 21st November, 1789 " Rhode Island 29th May, 1790 As shown above, two years passed before it was finally rati- fied by all the States. Both the delay and the final unanimity in its acceptance, giving testimony to the prudence and thought- fulness of the people. a u it a CONSTITUTIONAL CONVENTION. L'n,' Electors of President and Vice-President were chosen in the winter of 1788-1789. March 4th had been appointed as the time for the government to go into operation, but a delay in assembling the members of Congress deferred the inaugura- tion of Washington, as first President, until April 30th. Con- gress immediately organized the new government, and, in con- junction with the President, appointed the necessary officers. Some minor provisions were added or changed by the first Con- gress in the manner provided by the Constitution itself, that is, by a two-thirds vote in both Houses, and ratification by three-fourths of the States. Ten amendments were made at this time. The eleventh amendment was added in 1794. The twelfth in 1803. The thirteenth, fourteenth and fifteenth amendments have been added since 1863. A resolution to amend is passed by the requisite majorities in both Houses, sent to the legislatures of the States, and, when three-fourths of them have approved it, the Secretary of State causes the resolution and amendment to be published in all the States and Territories, and it becomes valid as part of the Constitution. Qontaining the wisest provisions of English law, it rejects all that is not in harmony with our circumstances, and our fun damental doctrine that all men have equal rights to life, lib- erty, and the pursuit of happiness. This it keeps continually in view, and, by the sense of dignity and worth which it tends to promote in the humblest man, gradually educates him op to the standard necessary for a free citizen, and, by its respect for the rights of all, tends to induce in each the same disposition. The wisest men of the Republic, by infusing into this docu- ment their own self-respect, and respect for others, gave tone and direction to all the future. Their own choractt rs were bo far imparted to their work as to exert a salutary influence on the destiny of the people whose fundamental law they com- piled. This document is the law of the land, obliging the high THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. to obedience, to justice, and right, and raising the lowest to an . qua] share in its political privileges, and to its vigorous pro- tection. Consequently a steady improvement in these respects has marked the growth of the country, and the benign influ- ence of this respect for inan and his rights has gone forth from the American Republic as a Regenerator among the nations of the earth. CONSTITUTION OF THE UNITED STATES OP AMERICA, AND ITS AMENDMENTS. We, the People of the United States, in order to form a more perfect, union, establish justice, insure domestic tranquil- lity, provide for the common defense, promote the general welfare, and secure the blessings of liberty to ourselves and our posterity, do ordain and establish this Constitu- tion for the United States of America. Article I. Section 1. All legislative powers herein granted shall be vested in a Congress of the United States, which shall consist of a Senate and House of Representatives. Sec. 2. The House of Representatives shall be composed of members chosen every second year by the people of the several States, and the electors in each State shall have the qualifications requisite for electors of the most numerous branch of the State Legislature. No person shall be a Representative who shall not have attained to the age of twenty-five years, and been seven years a citizen of the United States, and who shall not, when elected, lie :m inhabitant of that State in which he shall be chosen. Representatives and direct taxes shall be apportioned among the several States which may be included within this Union, according t<> their respective numbers, which shall be deter- mined by adding to the whole number of free persons, includ- ing those bound to service for a term of years, and excluding Indians not taxed, three-fifths of all other persons. The actual CONSTITUTION OF THE U. 8. 207 enumeration shall be made within three years after the first meeting of the Congress of the United States, and within every subsequent term of ten years, in such manner as they shall by law direct. The number of Representatives shall not exceed one for every thirty thousand, but each State shall have at least one Representative; and until such enumeration shall be made the State of New Hampshire shall be entitled to choose three, Massachusetts eight, Rhode Island and Providence Plantations one, Connecticut five, New York six, New Jersey four, Penn- sylvania eight, Delaware one, Maryland six, Virginia ten, North Carolina five, and Georgia three. Y\Hien vacancies happen in the representation from any State, the Executive authority thereof shall issue writs of election to fill such vacancies. The House of Representatives shall choose their Speaker and other officers, and shall have the sole power of impeachment. Seo. 3. The Senate of the United States shall be composed of two Senators from each State, chosen by the Legislature thereof for six years; and each Senator shall have one vote. Immediately after they shall be assembled in consequence of the first election, they shall be divided as equally as may be into three classes. The seats of the Senators of the first class shall be vacated at the expiration of the second year, of the second class at the expiration of the fourth year, and of the third class at the expiration of the sixth year, so that one-third may be chosen every second year; and if vacancies happen by resignation or otherwise, during the recess of the Legislature of any State, the Executive thereof may make temporary ap- pointments until the next meeting of the Legislature, which shall then fill such vacancies. No person shall be a Senator who shall not have attained to the age of thirty year?, and been nine years a citizen of the United States, and who shall not, when elected, be an inhabit- ant of that State for which he shall be chosen. The Vice-President of the United States shall bePresident of the Senate, but shall have no vote unless they be equally divided. Till-. FOOTPKLNTS OF TIME. The Senate shall choose their other officers, and also a Presi- dent pro tempore, in the absence of the Yice - President, or when he shall exercise the office of President of the United States. The Senate shall have the sole power to try all impeachments. When sitting for that purpose they shall be on oath or affirm- ation. When the President of the United States is tried, the Chief Justice shall preside. And no person shall be con- victed without the concurrence of two-thirds of the members present. Judgment, in cases of impeachment, shall not extend further than to removal from office, and disqualification to hold and enjoy any office of honor, trust, or profit under the United States ; but the party convicted shall nevertheless be liable and Mibject to indictment, trial, judgment, and punishment accord- ing to law. Sec. 4. The times, places, and manner of holding elections for Senators and Representatives shall be prescribed in each State by the Legislature thereof; but the Congress may at any time by law make or alter such regulations, except as to the places of choosing Senators. The Congress shall assemble at least once in every year, and Buch meeting shall be on the first Monday in December, unless they shall by law appoint a different day. Sec. 5. Each house shall be the judge of the election, returns, and qualifications of its own members, and a majority of each shall constitute a quorum to do business; but a smaller Dumber may adjourn from day to day, and may be authorized to compel the attendance of absent members in such manner and under such penalties as each house may provide. Bach house may determine the rules of its proceedings, pun- ish its members for disorderly behavior, and, with the concur- rence of two-thirds, expel a member. Each house shall keep a journal of its proceedings, and from time t<> time publish the same, excepting such parts as may in their judgment require secrecy; and the yeas and nays of the CONSTITUTION AND AMENDMENTS. 209 members of either house on any question shall, at the desire of one-fifth of those present, he entered on the journal. Neither house, during the session of Congress, shall, with- out the consent of the other, adjourn for more than three da nor to any other place than that in which the two houses shall be sitting. Sec. 6. The Senators and Representatives shall receive a compensation for their services, to be ascertained by law, and paid out of the Treasury of the United States. They shall in all cases, except treason, felony, and breach of the peace, be privileged from arrest during their attendance at the session of their respective Houses, and in going to and returning from the same; and for any speech or debate in either House they shall not be questioned in any other place. No Senator or Representative shall, during the time for which he was elected, be appointed to any civil office under the authority of the United States, which shall have been created, or the emoluments whereof shall have been increased during such time; and no person holding any office under the United States, shall be a member of either house during his continuance in office. Sec. 7. All bills for raising revenue shall originate in the House of Representatives; but the Senate may propose or con- cur with amendments as on other bills. Every bill which shall have passed the House of Represent- atives and the Senate, shall, before it becomes a law, be pre- sented to the President of the United States; if he approve he shall sign it; but if not, he shall return it, with his objections, to that House in which it shall have originated, who shall enter the objections at large on their journal, and proceed t«> recon- sider it. If, after such reconsideration, two-thirds of that House shall agree to pass the bill, it shall be sent, together with the objection, to the other House, by which it shall likewise be reconsidered, and if approved by two-thirds of that II<>u>«\ it shall become a law. But in all such case- the votes of both Houses shall be determined by yeas and nays, and the naj 14 210 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. of the persons voting for and against the bill shall be entered on the journal of each House respectively. If any bill shall not be returned by the President within ten days (Sundays excepted |, after it shall have been presented to him, the same si mil be a law, in like manner as if he had signed it, unless the Congress, by their adjournment, prevent its return, in which case it shall not be a law. Every order, resolution, or vote to which the concurrence of the Senate and House of Representatives may be necessary (except on a question of adjournment), shall be presented to the President of the United States, and before the same shall take effect shall be approved by him, or, being disapproved by him, shall be repassed by two-thirds of the Senate and House of Representatives, according to the rules and limitations pre- scribed in the case of a bill. Sec. 8. The Congress shall have power — To lay and collect taxes, duties, imposts and excises, to pay the debts and provide for the common defense and general welfare of the United States; but all duties, imposts, and excises shall be uniform throughout the United States; To borrow money on the credit of the United States; To regulate commerce with foreign nations, and among the several States, and with the Indian tribes; To establish a uniform rule of naturalization, and uniform laws on the subject of bankruptcies throughout the United States ; To coin money, regulate the value thereof, and of foreign coin, and fix the standard of weights and measures; To provide for the punishment of counterfeiting the securi- ties and current coin of the United States; To establish post offices and post roads; The promote the progress of sciences and useful arts, by securing, for limited times, to authors and inventors, the exclu- sive right to their respective writings and discoveries; To constitute tribunals inferior to the Supreme Court; CONSTITUTION AND AMENDMENTS. 2 I I To define and punish piracies and felonies committed on the hio-h seas, and offenses against the law of nations; To declare war, grant letters of marque and reprisal, and make rules concerning captures on land and water; To raise and support armies, but no appropriation of money to that use shall be for a longer term than two years; To provide and maintain a navy; To make rules tor the government and regulation of the land and naval forces; To provide for calling forth the militia to execute the laws of the Union, suppress insurrections, and repel invasions; To provide for organizing, arming, and disciplining the mili- tia, and for governing such part of them as may be employed in the service of the United States, reserving to the States respectively the appointment of the officers, and the authority of training the militia according to the discipline prescribed by Congress. To exercise legislation in all cases whatsoever over such dis- trict (not exceeding ten miles square) as may, by cession of particular States and the acceptance of Congress, become the seat of the government of the United States, and to exercise like authority over all places purchased by the consent of the Legislature of the State in which the saine shall be, for the erection of forts, magazines, arsenals, dock yards, and other needful buildings; and To make all laws which shall be necessary and proper for carrying into execution the foregoing powers, and all other powers vested by this Constitution in the government of the United States, or in any department or officer thereof. Sec. 9. The migration or importation of such persons as any of the States now existing shall think proper to admit, shall not be prohibited by the Congress prior to the year one thousand eight hundred and eight, but a tax or duty may be imposed on such importation, not exceeding ten dollars lor cadi person. The privilege of the writ of habeas corpus shall not be sus- 2 1 _' THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. pended, unless when in cases of rebellion or invasion the public Bafetv may require it. No bill ot attainder or ex post facto law shall be passed. No capitatioo or other direct tax shall belaid, unless in pro- portion to the census or enumeration hereinbefore dii ected to be taken. No tax or duty shall be laid on articles exported from any State. No preference shall be given by any regulation of commerce or revenue to the ports of one State over those of another; nor shall vessels bound to, or from one State, be obliged to enter, clear, or pay duties in another. No money shall be drawn from the Treasury, but in conse- quence of appropriations made by law; and a regular state- ment and account of the receipts and expenditures of all pub- lic money shall be published from time to time. No title of nobility shall be granted by the United States; and no person holding any office of profit or trust under them, shall, without the consent of the Congress, accept of any pres- ent, emolument, office, or title, of any kind whatever, from any king, prince, or foreign State. Sec. 10. No State shall enter into any treaty, alliance, or confederation; grant letters of marque and reprisal; coin money; emit bills of credit; make anything but gold and sil- ver coin a tender in payment of debts; pass any bill of attain- der, ex post facto law, or law impairing the obligation of contracts, or grant any title of nobility. No State shall, without the consent of the Congress, lay any imposts or duties on imports or exports, except what may be ali.-ulutcly necessary for executing its inspection laws, and the net produce of all duties and imposts laid by any State on imports or exports, shall be for the use of the Treasury of the United States; and all such laws shall be subject to the revis- ion and control of the Congress. No State shall, without the consent of Congress, lay any duty on tonnage, keep troops or ships of war in time of peace, CONSTITUTION AND AMENDMENTS. LM.'! enter into any agreement or compact with another Stun. with a foreign power, or engage in war, unless actually in ded, or in such imminent danger as will not admit of delay. Article II. Section 1. The Executive power shall be vested in a Presi- dent of the United States of America. He shall hold his office during the term of four years, and, together with the Vice-President chosen for the same term, be elected as fol- lows: Each State shall appoint, in such manner as the legislature thereof may direct, a number of electors, equal to the whole number of Senators and Representatives to which the State may be entitled in the Congress; but no Senator or Represen- tative, or person holding an office of trust or profit under the United States, shall be appointed an elector. [* The electors shall meet in their respective States, and vote by ballot for two persons, of whom one at least shall not be an inhabitant of the same State with themselves. And they shall make a list of all the persons voted for, and of the number of votes for each ; which list they shall sign and certify, and trans- mit sealed to the seat of the government of the United States, directed to the President of the Senate. The President of the Senate shall, in the presence of the Senate and House of- Rep- resentatives, open all the certificates, and the votes shall then be counted. The person having the greatest number of votes shall be the President, if such number be a majority of the whole number of electors appointed; and if there be more than one who have such majority, and have an equal number of votes, then the House of Representatives shall immediately choose by ballot one of them for President; and if no person have a majority, then from the five highest on the list the Baid House shall in like manner choose the President. But in choosing the President, the vote shall be taken by States, the * This clause within brackets has been superceded and annulled by the 12th amendment. 214 THE FOOTPRINTS OK TIME. representation from each State having one vote; a quorum for this purpose shall consist of a member or members from two- thirds of the Suites, and a majority of all the States shall be necessary to a choice. In every case, after the choice of the President, the person having the greatest number of votes of the electors shall be the Vice-President. But if there should remain two or more who have equal votes, the Senate shall choose from them by ballot the Vice-President.] The Congress may determine the time of choosing the elect- ors, and the day on which they shall give their votes; which day shall be the same throughout the United States. No person except a natural born citizen, or a citizen of the United States at the time of the adoption of this Constitution,, shall be eligible to the office of President; neither shall any person be eligible to that office who shall not have attained the age of thirty-five years, and been fourteen years a resident within the United States. In case of the removal of the President from office, or of his death, resignation, or inability to discharge the powers and duties of the said office, the same shall devolve on the Vice- President, and the Congress may by law provide for the case of removal, death, resignation, or inability, both of the Presi- dent and Vice-President, declaring what officer shall then act ae President, and such officer shall act accordingly, until the disability be removed, or a President shall be elected. The President shall, at stated times, receive for his services a compensation which shall neither be increased nor dimin- ished during the period for which he shall have been elected, and he .-hall Dot receive within that period any other emolu- ment from the United States, or any of them. Before he enters on the execution of his office, he shall take the following oath or affirmation: " I do solemnly swear (or affirm) that I will faithfully exe- cute the office of President of the United States, and will, to the best of my ability, preserve, protect, and defend the Con- stitution of the United States." CONSTITUTION ANT) AMENDMENTS. 215 Sec. 2. The President shall be commander-in-chief of the army and navy of the United States, and of the militia of the several States, when called into the actual service of the United States; he may require the opinion, in writing, of the princi- pal officer in each of the Executive departments, upon any subject relating to the duties of their respective offices, and he shall have power to grant reprieves and pardon for olfenses against the United States, except in cases of impeachment. He shall have power, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, to make treaties, provided two-thirds of the Sena- tors present concur; and he shall nominate, and by and with the advice of the Senate, shall appoint ambassadors, other pub- lic ministers and consuls, judges of the Supreme Court, and all other officers of the United States whose appointments are not herein otherwise provided for, and which shall be established by law; but the Congress may by law vest the appointment of such inferior officers as they think proper in the President alone, in the courts of law, or in the heads of departments. The President shall have power to fill up all vacancies that may happen during the recess of the Senate, by granting com- missions which shall expire at the end of their next session. Sec. 3. He shall from time to time give to the Congress information of the state of the Union, and recommend to their consideration such measures as he shall judge necessary and expedient; he may, on extraordinary occasions, convene both Houses, or either of them, and in case of disagreement between them, with respect to the time of adjournment, he may adjourn them to such time as he shall think proper; he shall receive ambassadors and other public ministers; he shall take cue that the laws be faithfully executed, and shall commission all the officers of the United States. Sec. 4. The President, Vice-President, and all civil officers of the United States, shall be removed from office on impeach- ment for, and conviction of treason, bribery, or other high crimes and misdemeanors. 216 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. Article III. Section 1. The judicial power of the United States shall be rested in one Supreme Court, and such inferior courts as the Congress may from time to time ordain and establish. The Judges, both of the Supreme and inferior courts, shall hold their offices during good behavior, and shall, at stated times, receive for their services a compensation, which shall not be dimin- ished during their continuance in office. Sec. 2. The judicial power shall extend to all cases, in law and equity, arising under this Constitution, the laws of the Tinted States, and treaties made, or which shall be made, under their authority; — to all cases affecting ambassadors, other pub- lic ministers, and consuls; — to all cases of admiralty and mar- itime jurisdiction;— to controversies to which the United States shall be a party; — to controversies between two or more States; — between a State and citizens of another State; — between citizens of different States ; — between citizens of the same State claiming lands under grants of different States, and between a State, or the citizens thereof, and foreign States, citizens, or subjects. In all cases affecting ambassadors, other public ministers, and consuls, and those in which a State shall be a party, the Supreme Court shall have original jurisdiction. In all the other cases before mentioned, the Supreme Court shall have appellate jurisdiction, both as to law and fact, with such exceptions, and under such regulations as the Congress shall make. The trial of all crimes, except in cases of impeachment, shall be l»y jury; and such trial shall be held in the State where the said crimes shall have been committed; but when not com- mitted within any State, the trial shall be at such place or places as the Congress may by law have directed. Seo. 3. Treason against the United States shall consist only in levying war against them, or in adhering to their enemies, giving them aid and comfort. No person shall be convicted CONSTITUTION AND AMENDMENTS. •_* ] 7 of treason unless on the testimony of two witnesses to the 3ame overt act, or on confession in open court. The Congress shall have power to declare the punishment of treason, but no attainder of treason shall work corruption of blood, or forfeiture, except during the life of the person attainted. Article IV. Section 1. Full faith and credit shall be given in each State to the public acts, records, and judicial proceedings of every other State. And the Congress may, by general laws, prescribe the manner in which such acts, records, and proceed- ings shall be proved, and the effect thereof. Sec. 2. The citizens of each State shall be entitled to all privileges and immunities of citizens in the several States. A person charged in any State with treason, felony, or other crime, who shall flee from justice, and be found in another State, shall, on demand of the Executive authority of the State from which he lied, be delivered up, to be removed to the State having jurisdiction of the crime. No person held to service or labor in one State, under the laws thereof, escaping into another, shall, in consequence of any law or regulation therein, be discharged from such service or labor, but shall be delivered up on the claim of the party to whom such service or labor may be due. Sec 3. New States may be admitted by the Congress into this Union ; but no new State shall be formed or erected within the jurisdiction of any other State; nor any State be formed by the junction of two or more States, or parts of States, without the consent of the Legislatures of the States concerned, as well as of the Congress. The Congress shall have power to dispose of and make al needful rules and regulations respecting the territory or other property belonging to the United States; and nothing in this Constitution shall be so construed as to prejudice any claims of the United States, or of any particular State. Seo. 4. The United States shall guarantee to every State 218 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. in tli is Union a Republican form of government, and shall protect each of them against invasion, and on application of the Legislature, or of the Executive (when the Legislature can- not be convened), against domestic violence. Article V. The Congress, whenever two-thirds of both Houses shall deem it necessary, shall propose amendments to this Constitu- tion, or, on the application of the Legislatures of two-thirds of the several States, shall call a convention for proposing amendments, which, in either case, shall be valid to all intents and purposes, as part of this Constitution, when ratified by the Legislatures of three-fourths of the several States, or by conventions in three-fourths thereof, as the one or the other mode of ratification may be proposed by the Congress. Pro- vided that no amendment which may be made prior to the year one thousand eight hundred and eight shall in any manner affect the first and fourth clauses in the ninth section of the first article; and that no State, without its consent, shall be deprived of its equal suffrage in the Senate. Article VI. All debts contracted, and engagements entered into, before the adoption of this Constitution, shall be as valid against the United States under this Constitution, as under the Confed- eration. This Constitution, and the laws of the United States which shall be made in pursuance thereof, and all treaties made, or which shall be made, under the authority of the United States, Bhall be the supreme law of the land; and the judges in every State shall be bound thereby, anything in the Constitution or laws of any State to the contrary notwithstanding. The Senators and Representatives before mentioned, and the members of the several State Legislatures, and all executive and judicial officers, both of the United States and of the several States. Bhall be bound by oath or affirmation, to support this Constitution; but no religious test shall ever be required as CONSTITUTION AND AMKNDMKNTS. 2 1 9 a qualification to any office or public trust under the United States. ■ Article VII. The ratification of the Conventions of nine States shall be sufficient for the establishment of this Constitution between the States so ratifying the same. Done in Convention by the unanimous consent of the States present, the seventeenth day of September, in the year of our Lord one thousand seven hundred and oi^hty-seven, and of the Independence of the United States of America, the twelfth. In Witness Whereof, We have hereunto subscribed our names. GEO. WASHINGTON, President, and Deputy from Virginia. New Hampshire. John Langdon, Nicholas Gilman. Massachusetts. Nathaniel Gokham, Rufus King. Connecticut. Wm. Sam'l Johnson, Roger Sherman. New York. Alexander Hamilton. New Jersey. Wil Livingston, Wm. Paterson, David Brearley, Jona. Dayton. Pennsylvania. B. Franklin, Robt. Morris, Thos. Fitzsimons, James Wilson, Thomas Mifflin, Geo. Clymer, Jared Inoeksoll, Gouv. Morris. Delaware. Geo. Read, John Dickinson, Jaco. Broom, Gunning Bedford, Jun'r, Richard Bassett. Maryland. James M'IIenry, Danl. Carroll, Dan. of St. Thos. Jenifer. Virginia. John Blair, James Madison, Jr. North Carolina. Wm. Blount, Hu. Williamson, Rich'd Dobbs Spaight. South Carolina. j. rutledge, Charles Pinckney, Chas. CoTEs^voRT^ Pinckney, Pierce Butlkk. Georgia. William Pew, Abr. Baldwin. WILLIAM JACKSON, Secretary. 220 the footprints of time. Articles in Addition to, and Amendatory of, the Con- stitution of the United States of America. Proposed by Congress, and ratified by the Legislatures of the several States, pursuant to the fifth article of the original Constitution. Article I. Congress shall make no law respecting an establishment of religion, or prohibiting the free exercise thereof ; or abridging the freedom of speech, or of the press; or the right of the peo- ple peaceably to assemble, and to petition the government tor a redress of grievances. Article II. A well regulated militia being necessary to the security of a free State, the right of the people to keep and bear arms shall not be infringed. Article III. No soldier shall, in time of peace, be quartered in any house without the consent of the owner, nor in time of war, but in a manner to be prescribed by law. Article IY. The right of the people to be secure in their persons, houses, papers, and effects, against unreasonable searches and seizures, shall not be violated; and no warrants shall issue but upon probable cause, supported by oath or affirmation, and particu- larly describing the place to be searched, and the persons or things to be seized. Article V. No person shall be held to answer for a capital or otherwise infamous crime, unless on a presentment or indictment of a Grand Jury, except in cases arising in the land or naval forces, or in the militia when in actual service in time of war or public danger; nor shall any person be subject for the same offense to be twice put in jeopardy of life or limb; nor shall be cons- CONSTITUTION AND AMENDM I N I - polled in any criminal case to be a witness against himself, nor be deprived of life, liberty, or property, without due process of law; nor shall private property be taken for public use, without just compensation. Akticle VI. In all criminal prosecutions, the accused shall enjoy the right to a speedy and public trial, by an impartial jury of the State and district wherein the crime shall have been commit- ted, which district shall have been previously ascertained by law, and to be informed of the nature and cause of the accusa- tion; to be confronted with the witnesses against him; to have compulsory process for obtaining witnesses in his favor; and to have the assistance of counsel for his defense. Article VII. In suits at common law, where the value in controversy shall exceed twenty dollars, the right of trial by jury shall be preserved, and no fact tried by a jury shall be otherwise re-examined in any court of the United States, than according to the rules of the common law. Article VIII. Excessive bail shall not be required, nor excessive fines imposed, nor cruel and unusual punishments inflicted. Article IX. The enumeration, in the Constitution, of certain rights, shall not be construed to deny or disparage others retained by the people. Article X. The powers not delegated to the United States by the Con- stitution, nor prohibited by it to the States, are reserved to the States respectively, or to the people. Aru (i.i XI. The judicial power of the United States shall not be con- 222 THE FOOTPRINTS OK TIME. .-trued to extend to any suit in law or equity commenced or prosecuted against one of the United States by citizens of another State, or by citizens or subjects of any foreign State. Article XII. The electors shall meet in their respective States, and vote by ballot for President and Vice-President, one of whom, at least, shall not be an inhabitant of the same State with them- selves; they shall name in their ballots the person to be voted for as President, and in distinct ballots the person voted for as V ice-President, and they shall make distinct lists of all persons voted for as President, and of all persons voted for as Vice- President, and of the number of votes for each, which list they shall sign and certify, and transmit sealed to the seat of the government of the United States, directed to the President of the Senate. The President of the Senate shall, in presence of the Senate and House of Representatives, open all the certifi- cates, and the votes shall then be counted. The person having the greatest number of votes for President, shall be the Presi- dent, if such number be a majority of the whole number of electors appointed; and if no person have such majority, then from the persons having the highest number not exceed- ing three on the list of those voted for as President, the House of Representatives shall choose immediately, by ballot, the President. But in choosing the President, the votes shall be taken by States, the representation from each State having one vote; a quorum for this purpose shall consist of a member or members from two-thirds of the States, and a majority of all the States shall be necessary to a choice. And if the House of Representatives shall not choose a President whenever the riirlit of choice shall devolve upon them, before the fourth day of March next following, then the Vice-President shall act as President, as in the case of the death or other Constitutional disability of the President. The person having the greatest number of votes as Vice-President, shall be the Vice-Presi- dent, if such number be a majority of the whole number of CONSTITUTION AND AMENDMENTS. 223 electors appointed, and if no person have a majority, then from the two highest numbers on the list, the Senate shall choose the Vice-President; a quorum for the purpose shall eon- sist of two-thirds of the whole number of Senators, and a majority of the whole number shall be necessary to a choice. But no person Constitutionally ineligible to the office of Pri dent shall be eligible to that of Vice-President ot the United States. Article XIII. Section 1. Neither slavery nor involuntary servitude, exce] >t as a punishment for crime, whereof the party shall have been duly convicted, shall exist within the United States, or any place subject to their jurisdiction. Sec. 2. Congress shall have power to enforce this article by appropriate legislation. Article XIV. Section 1. All persons born or naturalized in the United States and subject to the jurisdiction thereof, are citizens of the United States, and of the State wherein they reside. No State shall make or enforce any law which shall abridge the privileges or immunities of citizens of the United States; nor shall any State deprive any person of life, liberty, or property, without due process of law, nor deny to any person within its jurisdiction the equal protection of the laws. Sec. 2. Representatives shall be appointed among the several States according to their respective numbers, counting the whole number of persons in each State, excluding Indians not taxed; but when the right to vote at any election for the choice of electors for President and Vice-President of the United States, Representatives in Congress, the executive and judicial officers of a State, or the members of the Legislature thereof, is denied to any of the male inhabitants of such State, being twenty -one years of age and citizens of the United States, or in any way abridged except for participation in rebellion or 224 THE FOOTPRINTS OF TIME. other crimes, the basis of representation therein shall be reduced in the proportion which the number of such male citi- zens shall bear to the whole number of male citizens twenty-one years of age in such State. :). No person shall be a Senator or Representative in Congress, or elector of President and Vice-President, or hold any office, civil or military, under the United States or under any State, who, having previously taken an oath as aMember of Congress, or as an officer of the United States, or as a member of any State Legislature, or as an executive or judicial officer of any State, to support the Constitution of the United States, shall have engaged in insurrection or rebellion against the same, or given aid or comfort to the enemies thereof. But Congress may, by a vote of two-thirds of each house, remove such disability. Sec. 4. The validity of the public debt of the United States authorized by law, including debts incurred for payment of pensions and bounties for services in suppressing insurrec- tion or rebellion, shall not be questioned. But neither the United States nor any State shall assume or pay any debt or obligation incurred in the aid of insurrection or rebellion against the United States, or any loss or emancipation of any slave, but such debts, obligations, and claims shall be held illegal and void. Sec. 5. The Congress shall have power to enforce, by appropriate legislation, the provisions of this act. Article XV. Section 1. The right of citizens of the United States to vote, shall not be denied or abridged by the United States, or or by any State, on account of race, color, or previous condi- tion of servitude. Seo. )i. Congress shall have power to enforce this article by appropriate legislation. CHAPTER X. PRESIDENTS OF THE CONTINENTAL CONGRESS, AND THE VARIOUS SEATS OF GOVERNMENT FROM 1774 TO 1789. Peyton Randolph, Virginia 5th Sept., 1774 Henry Middleton, South Carolina 22d Oct., 1774 Peyton Randolph, Virginia 10th May, 1775 John Hancock, Massachusetts 24th May, 1775 Henry Laurens, South Carolina 1st Nov., 1777 John Jay, New York 10th Dec, 1778 Samuel Huntingdon, Connecticut 28th Sept., 1779 Thomas McKean, Delaware 10th July, 1781 John Hanson, Maryland 5th Nov., 1781 Elias Boudinot, New Jersey 4th " 1782 Thomas Mifflin, Pennsylvania 3d " 1783 Richard Henry Lee, Virginia 30th " 1784 Nathaniel Gorham, Massachusetts 6th Jan., 17S6 Arthur St. Clair, Pennsylvania 2d Feb., 1787 Cyrus Griffin, Virginia 22d Jan., 1788 The seat of government was established as follows : At Philadelphia, Pa., commencing September 5th, 1774, and May 10th, 1775; at Baltimore, Md., December 20th, 1770; at Phil- adelphia, Pa., March 4th, 1777; at Lancaster, Pa., September 27th, 1777; at York, Pa., September 30th, 1777; at Philadel phia, Pa., July 2d, 1778; at Princeton, N. J., June 30th, ! 783; at Annapolis, Md., November 20th, 1783; at Trenton. X. J.. November 1st, 1784; and at New York City, N. V.. -fan nary 11th, 1785. On the 4th of March, 1789, the present Constitution, which had been adopted by a convention and ratified by the requisite number of States, went into operation. 15 ( 225 > PART SECOND. THE GOVEENMENT UNDEE THE CONSTITUTION. The plan of this part of our work requires us to give a com- plete view of the government of the United States, and in such detail as to be adequate to all the purposes of the citizen and the student who wish to understand its structure and modes of working. It will be found, we think, a clear, concise, and complete account of what it is indispensable to the American to know. There are three branches, each independent, having its sphere of general action entirely distinct, and clearly denned by the Constitution; yet working in harmony w r ith the others, and lucking in, so to speak, with them at special points, like the cogs of a system of wheels. The adjustment was more perfect than the authors of the Constitution themselves believed; probably because the spirit of the whole was in harmony with the people whose interests it was designed to guard. These three branches are the Legislative, the Executive, and the Judicial. All the institutions or general subdivisions of each are given in connection, with such explanations and data as they seem to require. "We commence with the Executive, as being most immediately in contact with the people at large, having a wider field, and a larger number of distinct organiza- (226) THE GOVERNMENT UNDER THE OOHrWTTUTION. 227 tions and agents. Tliis branch exhausted, we present the Leg- islative, and finally the Judicial, closing with such matters as ■belong to the government as a whole. No human government is perfect, neither can exact and equal justice be done in every case by human laws. But the scope and design of our legislation and jurisprudence is to dis- pense justice to all, to place all on as equality before the laws, and to give the same rights to the rich and to the poor. No privileged class is known to our laws, and the lowest may aspire to the highest places of distinction and honor; many have done so, and have reached the most exalted positions. The fullest religious liberty is granted to all; every man may worship as he pleases, when and where he pleases, without molestation or fear. He is not, as in many other countries, taxed to support a chureh established by law. He may pay for religious purposes as much or as little as he pleases, and to any church he prefers, or he may pay nothing, and no one can ■call him to account or use any compulsion whatever in this matter. Every citizen has a vote for the choice of his rulers, and through his representatives a voice in making the laws by which he is governed. As to his business or calling, he may do that which best suits his interests or his tastes. He may go when or where he •desires, he may stay in the country or leave it without restraint or hindrance; in short, he may do whatsoever seemeth good to him, provided he does not infringe on the rights of others. To this liberty, to these equal rights, privileges, and advan- tages do we attribute our rapid growth and power. The advan- tages and benefits of so wise, so liberal, and so beneficenl a gov- ernment are not unknown to the people of other countries where they do not enjoy so much freedom; and this accounts for the wonderful immigration to the United States from nearly every country in Europe. This flow has continued for more than three-quarters of a century, and is still unabated. It has added many millions to the natural increase of our population, 228 THE GOVERNMENT UNDER THE CONSTITUTION. while very few of our own people ever leave their own country with the hope of bettering their condition, or of finding a gov- ernment under which they can enjoy more liberty or better protection. To gain a clearer conception of the intimate con- nection between a good government and the prosperity of the country, let us, for example, place Mexico in contrast with the United States. Mexico was settled long before the United States, and in climate and mineral wealth has the advantage of ■us; yet the ever unsettled condition of its government, together with intolerance of any but the Catholic religion, has prevented any increase of population or any advancement in anything which gives a nation respectability, greatness, or power. Let us draw another contrast by considering Ireland. An oppressive government has diminished the population, pre- vented any advancement, and impoverished the country. We might draw many such contrasts between the United States and other countries in Europe, Asia, Africa, and South America, which would convince any one who has the power to trace causes to effects, "and effects to causes, that a just and liberal government is an essential condition upon which the prosper- ity of any country dependg. THE EXECUTIVE DEPARTMENT. CHAPTER I. THE PRESIDENT. 1. Congress legislates, or enacts laws; the officers of the Supreme Court decide whether those laws are in conformity with the Constitution ; but the real ruler, the actual posse.s.-or of power, is the President. In the language of the first sec- tion of the second article of the Constitution, "The executive powers of the government shall be vested in a President of the United States of- America." The other branches of the gov- ernment decide what is to be done, and what is constitution ally legal, and the President is the agent. He executes, or pute in actual operation, the measures determined on by them. Should he attempt to do anything not so prescribed, or to do anything in an improper manner, contrary to or different from the manner prescribed by the law, he may be impeached and removed, and all the subordinate officers and agents of the g<>\ eminent released from the obligation to obey him. 2. The other branches are composed of many persons, lb- has no associate. The execution of the law requires vigor and decision, such as can be found only in a single mind and will. All history shows that there is constantf danger of power being misused, whether one, two, or any number of men are the depositaries of it; but one man is much better than two or more, when vigor and promptness are required. All the secu- rities and checks that could be applied without embarrassing his necessary freedom of action have been provided. They can not, indeed, supply the want of judgment and uprightness, and 231 1 THEFBESIDENT. bo no absolute security against mismanagement can exist ; but the danger may be in large part avoided by carefubiess in the selection of the man who is to wield the whole power of a great nation. It is :m office of great dignity, responsibility, and power, and requires a man of great ability and probity to properly fill it. 3. The President is elected for four years, and may be re- elected if the people see fit. Several times in our history the President has been once reelected, and so held the office for eight years; but none have been twice reelected, though there is no law against it. The term commences and terminates on the fourth day of March. He is elected by the people, every voter having an equal influence in the choice ; but it is not done by voting for him directly, but by voting first for men called electors, who cast their votes according to the wish of the people. This system we shall hereafter examine. 4. A Vice-President is elected at the same time and in the san>e way, who, in case of the President's death, removal, resig- nation, or inability to discharge the duties of his office, becomes acting President during the remainder of his term, or while the disability continues. The first Congress passed a lawgiving the President a salary of $25,000 per annum, with the use of a furnished house, and it remained the same until 1873, when it was raised to $50,000 per year. He is forbidden by the Con- stitution to receive any other public income during his term of office, nor is he at liberty to accept presents from any foreign, power. Before entering on the duties of his office he is required to take an oath "to preserve, protect, and defend the Constitution of the United States," to the best of his ability. 5. It is required that he shall be a native-born citizen of the United States, that he shall have been fourteen years a resident in the United States, and that he shall not be less than thirty-five years of age; which are designed to insure his attach- ment to American interests, his thorough acquaintance with American affairs, and the full maturity of his mind and char- acter. T BE I' RESIDENT. •>;;] 6. It is his duty to appoint such officers in every departing of the public service as are not otherwise provided for. II. usually sends the nomination to the Senate for their approval or consent, and when that is given appoints them by commis- sion, signed with his name, to the office. In this manner he nominates the Justices of the Supreme Court, ambassadors, resident ministers, charge-d'affaires, consuls, and other repre- sentatives of the government abroad, all the Heads of Executive Departments, and the more important subordinate officers of each department. When the Senate is not in session he may appoint all these directly, to serve until it meets again. The clerks and minor officers are usually appointed by Heads of Departments. In all other cases the advice and consent of the Senate are required before the appointment and commission can be legal. 7. It is his duty to make treaties with Foreign Powers, but these require confirmation by two-thirds of the Senate to be valid. He receives the Representatives of Foreign Powers, and superintends all diplomatic intercourse with them and with our own Representatives abroad. He is commander-in-chief of the army and navy, and must sign the commissions of all the officers in each. He may giant reprieves and pardons at his discretion, except in cases of im- peachment, and he is required to approve and sign the laws passed by Congress before they can take effect. If he does not approve a law he "vetoes" it by returning it to Congress, with his reasons for not signing it. If that body reconsiders it and ree'nacts it by a two-thirds vote of each house, it may become a law without his signature. 8. He may call extra sessions of Congress for special rea- sons, and may adjourn it in case of disagreement between the two houses as to the time of adjournment. It is his duty t»» give information to Congress, at the commencement of each session, of the state of the country, and to recommend to it such legislative enactments as he may judge are required. This is called "The President's Message," and is looked for with »•-<•> THE PRESIDENT. M C ** much interest in this and in foreign countries, since his posi- tion makes him intimately acquainted with every subject relating to the public welfare. When he considers that the occasion demands it, or when he is requested by Congress to give information on a special point, he communicates with them by similar documents, called messages. He may be impeached for treason, bribery, or other high crimes, by the House of Representatives, and tried by the Senate, the Chief Justice of the Supreme Court presiding over that body during the trial, and in case of conviction is removed from office. 9. It will be seen that he possesses great power, and that he is almost overwhelmed by responsibilities. The members of his cabinet are his constitutional advisers, and share more or less of this responsibility, although his will may override them all if he so chooses. There are many provisions for preventing an abuse of power in the Constitution and in the laws of Congress, but all history proves that nothing but watchfulness and wisdom on the part of the people can preserve to them their rights and liberties. Power, wherever lodged, is naturally aggressive. Fortunately the people themselves in this country are the source of power, and may legally restrain its exercise in their representatives and executive officers, when it threatens to become excessive. The following are the names of all the Presidents, from Washington, the first, down to the present incumbent : George Washington, Va., 30th April, 1789, to 4th March, 1797 — seven years ten months and four days. John Adams, Mass., 4th March, 1797, to 4th March, 1801 — four years. Thomas Jefferson, Va., 4th March, 1801, to 4th March, 1809 — eight years. James Madison, Va., 4th March, 1809, to 4th March, 1817 — eight years. James Monroe, Va., 4th March, 1817, to 4th March, 1825 — eight years. THK V R E S I I) E NTS. 233 John Quincy Adams, Mass., 4th March, 1825, to 4th March, 1829 — four years. Andrew Jackson, Tenn., 4th March, 1829, to 4th March, 1837 — eight years. Martin Van Buren, N. Y., 4th March, 1837, to 4th March, 1841 — four years. William H. Harrison, O., 4th March, 1841, to 4th April. 1841 — one month. John Tyler, Va., 4th April, 1841, to 4th March, 1845— three years and eleven months. James K. Polk, Tenn, 4th March, 1845, to 4th March, 1849 — four years. Zachary Taylor, La., 4th March, 1849, to 9th July, I860 — one year four months and five days. Millard Fillmore, N. Y., 9th July, 1850, to 4th March, 1853 — two years seven months and twenty-six days. Franklin Pierce, N. H., 4th March, 1853, to 4th March, 1857 — four years. James Buchanan, Pa., 4th March, 1857, to 4th March, 1861 — four years. Abraham Lincoln, 111., 4th March, 1861, to 15th April. 1865 — four years one month and ten days. Andrew Johnson, Tenn., 15th April, 1865, to 4th March, 1869 — three years ten months and twenty days. Ulysses S. Grant, TIL, 4th March, 1869, to 4th March. 1877 — eight years. Of these William H. Harrison died 4th April, 1841, jnstone month after his inauguration. On the death of Harrison. Tyler, the Vice-President, became acting President. Taylor died 9th July, 1850, and Fillmore, Vice-President, became acting IV dent. Lincoln was assassinated on the 14th April, 1865* one month and ten days after he was inaugurated upon hie second term, and Andrew Johnson, the Vice-President, became acting President — this being the third time that such an event hafl occurred since the government went *nto operation. CHAPTER II. THE VICE-PRESIDENT. i This officer is elected by the people at the same time, and in the same manner, as the President, and for the same term. He must be a native citizen of the United States, and thirty- five years of age. His high-sounding title would lead one who is but little acquainted with our government to think that he stands next to the President himself in dignity and power; that on his shoulders rests a large amount of the duties and responsibili- ties of the administration. Such, however, is not the case. He is, in fact, nearer a cipher than any of the high officers of State. He is merely the presiding officer of the Senate, with not even the power to vote, except in case of a tie vote in that body, when he may give the casting vote. It is only in case of the death, resignation, impeachment, or disability of the President to discharge his duties, that the Vice-President becomes an officer of much power or dignity. The following is a list of all the Vice-Presidents: John Adams, Mass., April 30th, 1789, to March 4th, 1797, seven years, ten months and four days. Thomas Jefferson, Va., March 4th, 1797, to March 4th, 1801 — four years. Aaron P>urr, N. Y., March 4th, 1801, to March 4th v 1805— to in- years. George Clinton, N. Y., March 4th, 1805, to April 30th 1812 — seven years, one month, and sixteen days. Elbridge Gerry, Mass., March 4th, 1813, to November 23d, 1814 — one year, seven months, and nineteen days. Daniel D. Tompkins, K Y., March 4th, 1817, to March I ill, 1825— eight years. John C. Calhoun, S. C, March 4th, 1825 to March 4th, 1833 — eight years. (334) THE VIC E -FBESID E N I S . Martin Van Buren, N. Y., March 4th, 1S33, to March 4th, 1837 — four years. Eieliard M. Johnson, Ky., March 4th, 1837, to March 1th, 1841 — four years. John Tyler, Va., March 4th, 1841. to April 4th, 1841— one month. George M. DaEas, Pa., March 4th, 1845, to March 4th, 1 849 — four years. Millard Fillmore, N. Y., March 4th, 1849, to July 9th, 1850 — one year and four months. William R. King, Ala. John C. Breckenridge, Ky., March 4th, 1857, to March 4th, 1861 — four years. Hannibal Hamlin, Me., March 4th, 1861, to March 4th. 1 B65 — four years. Andrew Johnson, Tenn., March 4th, 1865, to April 15th, 1865 — one month and eleven days. Schuyler Colfax, Ind., March 4th, 1869, to March 4th, 1-7:'. four years. Henry Wilson, Mass., March 4th, 1873, to March 4th. 1877 — four years. Of these, Clinton died April 20th, 1812; from which time till March 4th, 1813, the Vice-Presidency was vacant. Gerry died November 23d, 1814; from which time till March 4th, 1817, the Vice-Presidency was vacant. Tyler became acting President upon the death of President Harrison; and until March 4th, 1845, the Vice-Presidency was vacant. Fillmore became acting President upon the death of Preei dent Taylor, July 9th, 1850; and until March 4th. 1853, the Vice-Presidency was vacant. King was elected with President Pierce, in 1852, but died April 18th, 1853. He never took his seat, and the Yicc-IV dency was vacant till March 4th, 1857. Johnson became acting President upon the death of President Lincoln, April 15th, 1865, and the Vice-Presidency again became vacant, and remained so until March 4th, 1869. CHAPTER III. THE CABINET. 1. The members of the President's Cabinet arts seven in number, viz. : Five Secretaries, at the head of their respective departments, of State, Treasury, War, Navy, and Interior; and the Postmaster General, and Attorney General. It is through these departments and their various bureaus, officers, agents, and clerks, that the President performs most of the duties of his position, viz.: that of executing \ or putting in force, the laws of Congress. He must, therefore, necessarily take them into his counsels, and arrange, by their assistance, the conduct of public affairs. Each one has the affairs of his department so thoroughly systematized that he can tell, with a little examination, the means at his disposal for carrying into effect any special measure; and precise records of the whole state of the public service may, at all times, be found in their offices. •_'. They are also selected for their several positions from among those regarded as the most eminent statesmen of the country, and each is supposed to be specially adapted, by his experience, acquirements, and capacity, for his special position, as well as in harmony with the general policy adopted by the President. They are, therefore, properly, and ex officio (by virtue of their office), his advisers. No one else can tell as well ae they the condition of public affairs at any particular time, nor, in consequence, give as good advice on any special measure requiring such knowledge. Without their aid the President would have few means of judging what was best, or (236) THE CABINET. 237 possible, to be done at any particular crisis. They furnish the material for his decisions, and the instruments to execute them. They are heads of the Executive Departments, and, together with ftie President, who is the head of them all, bringing them all into harmony, and under the control of a Bingle purpose and will, they are called the administration. They administer, or carry on, the government. 3. In other countries these administrative heads are usually called Ministers, probably because they serve the ruler — servant being the original meaning of the term minister — and are com- monly chosen among the members of the legislative bodies — perhaps because that brings the government into closer sympathy with the legislators, and promotes harmony of action; but with us, no member of the Cabinet can have a seat in, or take any part in the proceedings of, Congress. Great care was taken to keep the different branches of the govern- ment distinct and independent of each other. Each branch, and each subdivision, is kept separate, and confined to its own range of duties, being united to the others only by its head, so that confusion and conflict might be impossible. 4. Each sub-department reports at stated intervals to its head, and he to the President, and through him to Congress; and at the same time they present such suggestions and argu- ments for legislation in regard to their several departments as their knowledge, experience, and reflections may have convinced them to be desirable. The} 7 are supposed to give their whole time and thought to the care and improvement of their several branches of the public service, and to be in condition to know what further improvement should be provided for by law, better than any one else. 5. Under Washington's administration the departments and members of Cabinet were but three — of State, <>( the Treasury, and of War. In 1798, during the administration of John Adams, the Department of the Navy was added, and its 8e tary took his seat in the Cabinet. It then had only four mem- bers down to Jackson's administration (1S2!) to 1s:17i, when tho T II K CABINET. Postmaster General was made a Cabinet officer, which increased the number to five. During Mr. Tyler's administration (1841- 1845) the Attorney General was made a member, and the number was then six. At the close of Mr. Polk's term as President, in 1849, the Department of the Interior was created, and its chief given the seventh seat in the Cabinet; since which time there has been no increase. Congress may, at their discretion, as the country grows, and the public service with it, create other great or independent departments requir- ing its representative to have a seat in the Cabinet, that the state of the entire service may be readily known from the officer most familiar with each branch. I / CHAPTER IV. DEPARTMENT OF STATE. 1. As the Chief Executive of a government cannot, for want of time, attend to all the details of the business t>elong- ing to his office, he, according to the usage of all times, appoints various officers to attend to the different branches of public business. In most countries these officers, who are next in importance to the chief of the government, are called Minis- ters. In accordance with the practice of using plain and simple terms which was adopted in this country at the begin- ning, they are called Secretaries. They are subordinates of the President and supposed to act in his name and under his direc- tion. 2. They are not specially named in the Constitution, but are several times referred to as Heads of Departments, and thus it was assumed that there would be such offices and officers, and their appointment was provided for. The first Congress under the Constitution organized these Executive Departments, the President nominating and the Senate confirming the appoint- ment of the more responsible officers. 3. The first of these in rank is called the Department of State, and its head is named the Secretary of State. He is, by a law passed in 1853, aided by an Assistant Secretary, appointed in the same manner as himself. The numerous under offi< required by the extensive business falling to this department are appointed by the Secretary at its head. 4. This Department has charge of such business ae ma] arise between this government and the governments of other (239) 240 DEPARTMENT OF 8TATE. countries. In most countries it is called the Department, or Ministry, of Foreign Affairs, but the term Department of State was preferred here. The great Seal of the United States is in his keeping, and it is his duty to affix it to all civil commissions given to officers of the United States who are appointed by the President and Senate, or by the President alone. It is his duty, under the supervision and control of the President, to conduct the correspondence with, and give instructions to, the Foreign Ministers, Consuls, and Agents of the government abroad, t<> fake charge of the official business and intercourse of the government with the representatives of foreign governments sent to us, and to attend to such other business arising from our Foreign Relations as shall be committed to him by the President. 5. It is his duty to keep in his office the original copies of all acts, resolutions, and orders of Congress. He must deliver to each Senator and Representative in Congress, and to the ( n'vernor of each State, a printed copy of the same; and during the session of each Congress he must publish the acts and reso- lutions passed by it in one newspaper in the District of Colum- bia, and in not more than two in each State and Territory of the United States. He must also publish in like manner all amendments of the Constitution, and all public treaties made and ratified between the United States and any foreign State, Prince, or Power, or with any of the Indian tribes. 6. And at the close of each session of Congress he must cause to be published 11,000 copies in book form of all the laws, etc., as before stated; and to distribute the same as directed by law to the President and Vice-President, and to every ex-Presi- dent; to all the members of the Senate and House of Repre- sentatives; to all the heads of the various departments and l.ureaus; to all the Judges of the United States Courts, their Clerks and Marshals; to all our Foreign Ministers, Consuls, and Public Agents; in short, to all the important officers of the government at home and abroad; in order that all who are in government employ may know what the laws are, and what DEE \ B I'M 1 :NT OF STATE. 'J 1 I changes have been made in acts formerly existing. The remaining copies are distributed to the States and Territorial according to the number of Representatives in Congress from each of them. 7. It is also made the duty of the Secretary of State to give passports to our own citizens who wish to travel in foreign countries; to cause passports to be issued by such Diplomatic or Consular officers of the United States as the President shall direct; to give such information to our people through the newspapers as he may from time to time receive from our Dip- lomatic and Consular agents abroad, as he may deem import- ant to the nation, respecting our commercial interests in for- eign countries, and to prepare a form of passport for the ships and vessels of the United States. 8. In the execution of extradition treaties between us and foreign governments, it is lawful for the Secretary of State, under his hand and seal of office, to issue an order for the ren- dition of any person who has been found guilty of crime in a foreign country, to any properly authorized person; that such criminal may be taken out of the United States to the country where the crime was committed. 9. It will be seen that, in addition to the duties connected with our Foreign Relations, he is a kind of General Secretary of the Legislative branch of the government, which probably led to his being called Secretary of State rather than Secretary of Foreign Affairs. The highest officer, in most other govern- ments, under the Executive, is commonly called Prime Minister; but he usually has care of the general interests of the govern- ment, internal as well as external, and the term would not be fitting to the Secretary of State. Our Foreign Relations require to be managed with great wisdom and skill, since they often involve peace and war, and the general prosperity of the country. It therefore req u i re* a man of great ability, and of extensive knowledge. He is a member of the Cabinet, and one of the advisers or counselors of the President. Ilis appointment is for four years, or during 16 242 DEPARTMENT OF STATE. a Presidential term; but lie may be removed by the President at any time, if he deems it advisable. 10. Afl a matter of historical reference, we append the names of all the statesmen who have filled this high office, commencing with the first, placing them in the order of the date6 of their appointments, together with the States from which they came: SECRETAIRES OF STATE. Thomas Jefferson, Va., Sept. 26th, 1789. Edmund Randolph, Va., Jan. 2d, 1794. Timothy Pickering, Mass., Dec. 10th, 1795. John Marshall, Va., May 13th, 1800. James Madison, Va., March 5th, 1801. Robert Smith, Md., March 6th, 1809. James Monroe, Va., April 2d, 1811. John Quincy Adams, Mass., March 4th, 1817. Henry Clay, Ky., March 7th, 1825. Martin Van Buren, N. Y., March 6th, 1829. Edward Livingston, La., May 24th, 1831. Louis McLane, Del., May 29th, 1833. John Forsyth, Ga., June 27th, 1834. Daniel Webster, Mass., March 5th, 1841. H. S. Legare, S. C, May 9th, 1843. A. P. Upshur, Va., June 24th, 1843. John Nelson, Md., Feb. 29th, 1844. John C. Calhoun, S. C, March 6th, 1844. James Buchanan, Pa., March 5th, 1845. John ML ( layton, Del., March 7th, 1849. Daniel Webster, Mass., July 20th, 1850. Edward Everett, Mass., Dec. 9th, 1851. William L. Marcy, N.Y., March 5th, 1853. Lewis Cass, Mich., March 6th, 1857. Jeremiah S. 1 Slack, Pa., Dec. 14th, 1860. William II. Seward, X. Y., March 5th, 1861. Elih.i II. Washburne, 111., March 5th, 1869. Hamilton Fish, X. Y., March 11th. 1869. Hamilton Fi6h, N. Y., reappointed March 4th, 1873. CHAPTER Y. OUR REPRESENTATIVES IN FOREIGN LANDS. 1. Nations have business with each other, as individuals have; and their governments employ agents to represent them and transact business in their name. By these means their political and commercial relations and intercourse are regulated, treaties are made, and any disputes that may arise between them settled. Officers of this character have been employed from very early times, and by all nations. They are considered to be clothed with the authority and dignity of the govern- ment they represent, and therefore the office has ever been held in great honor, and men most familiar with the affairs of their own nation, of most extensive knowledge, prudence, and wis- dom, are supposed to be selected for so eminent a service. 2. By the law (or general consent) of nations ambassadors are exempt from arrest, imprisonment, or prosecution. Any interference with them in this w r ay might hinder the execution of the duties assigned them, and be a great damage to the public welfare, and an offense of that kind committed against them is considered as a dishonor to the government whose agents they are. On the other hand they require much judg- ment and tact that their conduct may not bring discredit on their government. Their inviolable character is carried so far as to exempt their servants from arrest, and their property from seizure for debt. The law of Congress protecting the Representatives of foreign governments to this country is but a re-enactment, or acceptance, of what has been known as the Law of Nations for many centuries all over the civilized world. (243) '24 1: REPRESENTATIVES EN FOREIGN LANDS. A violation of this established usage among nations, without due atonement and satisfaction, would be recognized as a suf- ficient cause for war against the nation so offending. 3. ( )ur < iwn fi ireign ministers of all grades are appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate. They are not, however, the representatives of the President, but of the irovernment of the United States. We said of all grades, for there are grades of these officials, different in dig- nity and power. They are distinguished also by different names which indicate their rank, viz.: Ambassadors, Envoys Extraordinary and Ministers Plenipotentiary, Ministers .Resi- dent, and Charge d' Affaires. AMBASSADORS. 4. This title in our country has no very specific meaning. It designates, however, a minister of the highest grade; but does not distinguish between one who goes to reside in the country whither he is sent, and one who is sent for some special purpose; such as that of negotiating a treaty of peace, or some other particular matter with which he is charged, and when that is accomplished returns home. In the latter case he is frequently styled a commissioner, because he was duly authorized, and commissioned by his government to act for it; but in both cases the officer is an ambassador, for that word means a person authorized and sent to transact business for his government. ENVOYS EXTRAORDINARY AND MINISTERS PLENIPOTENTIARY. 5. These titles designate ministers of the highest class; but generally refer to such as go to reside in the country where sent, and with full power to act for their government, in all matters and things of a diplomatic character. Where negotiations become necessary between the two nations, permanent ministers of this grade are only sent to great powers — governments of the higher class. REPRESENTATIVES IN FOREIGN LANDS. 245 MINISTERS RESIDENT. 6. These are not considered so high in rank as those termed envoys extraordinary and ministers plenipotentiary. Yet they are clothed with nearly the same powers, but are sent to coun- tries of less importance, and receive less salaries. COMMISSIONERS. 7. There are a still lower grade of ministers (if we may call them so), or government agents, who reside abroad. They are sent to look after the interests of our government and its citizens in places of not much importance, and where there is but little to do. They also receive but small pay. CHARGE D'AFFAIRES. 8. These officials rank as the lowest grade of ministers or diplomatic officers, and are not clothed with much authority or power, excepting when authorized to act in the room of a minister of higher rank, whose place is for the time being vacant. In this case consuls have been authorized to act in place of ministers; but not unless authorized to do so by the President of the United States. SECRETARIES OF LEGATION. 9. Secretaries of Legation may with propriety be noticed under the general head of ministers, although they are not ministers of any grade, but are appointed by the same powers that appoint ministers, and accompany them merely as their secretaries. In the absence of a charge d'affaires, they are sometimes authorized to act in his place. The position is not one of great dignity, nor is the compensation large. CHAPTER VI. TREATIES — EXTRADITION TREATIES. 1. A treaty is a written contract, entered into by two- nations, on some question of interest or intercourse between them. It is precisely of the nature of a contract between two persons when they bind themselves to do, or not to do, certain things specified in the contract. That would be a treaty between individuals. Treaties between nations are only dif- ferent in the solemn and formal manner of arranging and confirming these agreements. 2. Treaties have often been of great service to the world, both in ancient and modern times. By these negotiations, wars have been prevented, friendly relations maintained, and commercial intercourse kept up, advantageously to both parties. Treaties may be negotiated by any persons properly authorized I iv their governments to do so; and any government may authorize such persons as they see fit, to perform these import- ant acts. In many cases the ordinary ministers who represent their governments to other governments, negotiate ordinary treaties. But in cases where something of an extraordinary character is to be arranged, special ministers or commissioners are sent for this express purpose. This was the case at the treaty of Ghent (so called from the name of the place where the commissioners met to arrange it), in 1814; by which a peace was brought about between England and the United States, after the last war between those powers. Special min- isters, or commissioners, as they were denominated, were appointed and sent for this very purpose. A treaty of peace (246) TREATIES. 2 I 7 was agreed upon by the commissioners of the respective coun- tries, and hostilities ceased as soon as the news reached the United States. 3. In some cases our government has authorized its com- manding generals to make a treaty with the hostile nation. It has also given the same power to the commanders of our national vessels; and also, in a few cases, to our consuls, in countries at a great distance from home, such as China, Japan, Siam, and Turkey. The persons authorized to negotiate a treaty, rarely act with- out instructions from their government, as to the times and conditions of the proposed treaty. Much, however, must be left to the sound judgment and discretion of the negotiators as to the details. 4. It must be borne in mind that a treaty, although mutu- ally agreed upon by the agents of the nations concerned, is not binding upon either party until properly ratified according to the forms of the respective governments interested. The modes of ratification differ in different governments. In ours the Constitution confers this power upon the President, by and with the advice and consent of two-thirds of the Senate. In absolute monarchies this power rests in the hands of the King or Emperor alone. As before stated, every government may confer the power to negotiate a treaty upon such agents as it pleases. It also has the power to prescribe such modes of ratifying or confirming it, as it pleases. 5. But when once made and approved, it becomes binding not only upon the respective governments that made it, bnt upon all the citizens and subjects of that government. It lias been held in this country by our greatest lawyers and states- men, that the provisions of a treaty bind Congress, the President, and every citizen as much as any Constitutional provision or act of Congress. And for this reason our treaties are published in the papers in every State and Territory in the Union, in the same manner, and to the same extent, as the lawi of Congress. 248 TREATIES. G. The violation of a treaty by either of the parties thereto, is reprehensible and criminal. It is derogatory to the charac- ter of any nation or individual that does it. It destroys the confidence of one nation in the other, leads to unfriendly feel- ings and acts between the parties, and may bring on a war, if satisfaction is not given. Yet such things have been done, and evil consequences have always followed. " If you make a bargain, stick to it," is a common, trite, and wise saying. Just here it seems proper to call attention to the fact that the Constitution prohibits any State from making any treaty with any foreign government. The reason for this provision is very obvious, for, if allowed, a State might confer privileges upon foreign powers which would be incompatible with the interests of other States. Therefore the treaty-making power is kept wholly in the hands of the general government, for in it every State has its representatives, and a voice in every treaty which it makes. 7. So numerous are the treaties which the United States has made with nearly every civilized nation upon earth, that it would require a very large volume to contain them. They are published with the laws, and generally in English and in the language of the nation with whom the treaty is made. They may be found in the United States Statutes at Large. It would require too much space in a work of this kind, to give even their titles. 8. Wars have been stopped; boundary lines between nations have been established; commercial intercourse ar- ranged; the purchase and sale of lands, and a variety of other tilings have been the subjects, and formed the matter of treaties. Several of our most important ones relate to the purchase of territory. We acquired the States of Louisiana, Arkansas, and Missouri, by a treaty with France in 1803. It was called the Louisiana purchase; for it was nothing more than a purchase and sale of lands. We also acquired Florida of Spain, in 1819, in the same way, and California and New Mexico of Mexico, in 1847. TREATIES. 249 0. The immense quantities of land purchased of the Indi- ans, were obtained by treaties with them. We are Born to say that in some cases they have treacherously violated their treaty obligations; but at the same time it should be said by way of extenuating their offense, that our own government agents appointed for the purpose of taking care of the interests of the poor Indians, have, in connection with the white traders among them, shamefully cheated and wronged them, and pro- voked them not only to disregard their obligations, but to perpetrate murders, robberies, and thefts upon the whites who live near them. At different times during the years past, the Indians have been very hostile to ns, and have waged war against the whites in their vicinity for the reasons above stated. " Honesty is the best policy." 10. In the early part of the year 1867, a treaty was nego- tiated by William II. Seward, our Secretary of State, on the part of the United States, and Edward de Stoekl, the Russian Minister to the United States, on the part of Russia, for the cession of the Russian possessions in North America to the United States. This treaty may be regarded as one of the most important of all our treaties with foreign powers; for by it the United States acquire between 350,000 and 400,000 square miles of territory, in addition to our already immense possessions; and it plan- by far the greater part of the Northwestern coast of North Amer- ica under the control of the United States government. For the purpose of giving a specimen of a treaty, and show- ing some of the details of this negotiation, we here insert it in full, as agreed upon by the contracting parties. §7,<"n>0, in gold is the consideration which the United States paid Uii>-ia for this territory. This treaty has been ratified by the United States and Russian governments, and the money, ($7,000,000 in gold) has been appropriated for the purpose, and paid to the Russian Minister. THE RUSSIAN TREATY. The following is the text of the Russian- American treaty: 250 TREATIES. The United States of America, and his Majesty, the Em- peror of all the Russias, being desirous of strengthening, if possible, the good understanding which exists between them, have l«>r that purpose appointed as their plenipotentiaries, the President of the United States, William H. Seward, Secretary of State, and his Majesty the Emperor of all the Russias, Mr. Edward de Stoekl, his Envoy Extraordinary and Minister Plenipotentiary to the United States, and the said plenipoten- tiaries, having exchanged their full powers, which were found to be in due form, have agreed upon and signed the following articles: Article I. His Majesty, the Emperor of all the Russias, agrees to cede to the United States, by this convention, imme- diately upon the exchange of the ratifications thereof, all the territory and dominion now possessed by his said Majesty on the continent of America and in the adjacent islands, the same being contained within the geographical limits herein set forth, to wit: The eastern limit is the line of demarkation between the Russian and British possessions in North America, as estab- lished by the convention between Russia and Great Britain, of February 28 (16), 1825, and described in articles third and fourth of said convention in the following terms: Commenc- ing from the southernmost point of the island called Prince of Wales' Island — which point lies in the parallel of 50 deg. 40 min. north latitude, and between the 131st and 133d deg. of west longitude, meridian of Greenwich — the said line shall ascend to the north along the channel called Portland Channel, as far as the point of the continent where it strikes the 56th degree of north latitude. From this last mentioned point the line of demarcation shall follow the summit of the moun- tains Bituated parallel to the coast as far as the point of intersection of the 141st degree of west longitude of the same meridian, and finally from the said point of intersection the Baid meridian line of the 141st degree in its prolongation as tar as the Frozen Ocean. With reference to the line of demarc- ation laid down in the preceding article, it is understood— TREATIES. 251 first, that the island called Prince of Wales' Island Bhall belong wholly to Russia, and now, by this cession, wholly to the United States; second, that whenever the summit of the moun- tains which extend in a direction parallel to the coast from the 56th degree of north latitude to the point of intersection of the 141st degree west longitude shall prove to be at the dis- tance of more than ten marine leagues from the ocean, tin- limit between the British possessions and the line of coast which is to belong to Russia as above mentioned — that is to say, the limit of the possessions ceded by this convention — shall be formed by a line parallel to the winding of the coast, and which shall never exceed the distance of ten marine leacrues therefrom. The western limit, within which the territories and dominion conveyed are contained, passes through a point in Behring's Strait on the parallel of 65 deg. 30 min. north latitude, at its intersection by the meridian which passes mid- way between the island of Krusenstern, or Ignaalook, and the island of Ratmanog, or .Noonerbook, and proceeds due north without limitation into the same Frozen Ocean. The same western limit beginning at the same initial point, proceeds thence in a course nearly northwest through Behring's Strait and Behring's Sea, so as to pass midway between the north- west part of the island of St. Lawrence and the south-east point of Cape Choukottki to the meridian of 172 deg. west longitude. Thence, from the intersection of that meridian, in a south-westerly direction, so as to pass midway between the island of Attou and the copper island of the Koranddorski couplet or group in the North Pacific Ocean, to the meridian of 193 deg. west longitude, so as to include in the territory conveyed the whole of the Aleutian Islands east of that meridian. Art. II. In the cession of territory and dominion mad.' by the preceding article, are included the right of property in all public lots and squares, vacant lands, and all pnblio buildings, barracks, and other edifices which are not private, individual property. It is, however, understood and agreed 252 TREATIES. that the churches which have been built in the ceded territory by the Russian government shall remain the property of such members of the Greek Oriental Church resident in the terri- tory as may choose to worship therein. Any government archives, papers, and documents relative to the territory and domain aforesaid, which may be now existing there, will be left in possession of the agent of the United States; but an authenticated copy of such of them as may be required will be at all times given by the United States to the Russian gov- ernment, or to such Russian officers or subjects as may apply for them. Art. III. The inhabitants of the ceded territory, according to their choice, reserving their natural allegiance, may return to Russia within three years ; but if they should prefer to remain in the ceded territory, they, with the exception of unciv- ilized tribes, shall be admitted to the enjoyment of all the rights, advantages, and immunities of citizens of the United States, and shall be maintained and protected in the free enjoy- ment of their liberty, property, and religion. The uncivilized tribes will be subject to such laws and regulations as the United States may from time to time adopt in regard to aboriginal tribes of that country. A bt. IV. His Majesty, the Emperor of all the Russias, shall appoint, with convenient dispatch, an agent or agents, for the purpose of formally delivering to a similar agent or agents, appointed on behalf of the United States, the territory, domi- nion, property, dependencies, and appurtenances which are ceded as above, and for doing any other act which may be neces- saryin regard thereto; but the cession, with the right of imme- diate possession, is nevertheless to be deemed complete and absolute on the exchange of ratifications, without waiting for such formal delivery. Akt. V. Immediately after the exchange ot the ratifications <>f this convention, any fortifications or military posts which may be in the ceded territory shall be delivered to the agent of the 1 nited States, and any Russian troops which maybe in EXTRADITION TREATIES. 253 the territory shall bo withdrawn as soon as maybe reasonably and conveniently practicable. Art. VI. In consideration of the cession aforesaid, the United States agree to pay, at the Treasury in Washington, within months after the exchange of the ratifications of this convention, to the diplomatic representative, or other agenl of His Majesty, the Emperor of all the Russias, duly authorized to receive the same, million dollars in gold. The cession of territory and dominion herein made is hereby demanded to be free and unincumbered by any reservations, privileges, fran- chises, grants, or possessions, by any associated companies,, whether corporate or incorporate, Russian or any other, or by any parties except merely private individual property holders; and the cession hereby made conveys all the rights, franchises, and privileges now belonging to Russia in the said territory or dominion and appurtenances thereto. Art. VII. When this convention shall have been duly rati- fied by the President of the United States, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, on the one part, and on the other by His Majesty, the Emperor of all the Russias, the rati- fications shall be exchanged at Washington within from the date hereof, or sooner, if possible. In faith whereof the respective plenipotentiaries have signed this convention, and thereto affixed the seals of their arms. EXTRADITION TREATIES. 1. Treaties have been made from time immemorial between rulers and nations for the purpose of promoting the inter. of one or both parties in their commercial relations, or t< > Becure allies in war ; but the kind of treaties mentioned at the head of this section are of modern origin ; and shows strongly the progress of nations toward a substantial unity of inter. and of discipline. 2. The security of society demands that when men commit a crime in one place they shall not be able to find a Bafe asylum to which they may fiy whenever the retributions of the law. 254 EXTRADITION TREATIES. which watches over the welfare of the citizen, threaten to over- take them. The readiness with which criminals can pass from one country to another since steam has made travel so speedy and pursuit for any long distance so difficult, increases the evil. "When criminals fly to another country they cannot be pun- ished there, since their courts have no jurisdiction over a criminal from another nation, unless the act was committed in the country where they were established; nor are governments usually willing to deliver an individual on accusation only, unless there is an express stipulation, or treaty to this effect, between them. To overcome the difficulty a treaty was made in 1842 between this country and England, in which it was mutually agreed that each country, on the demand of the gov- ernment of the other, should give up criminals of certain kinds named in the treaty, when these after the crime had fled into their jurisdiction. It worked well, since it multiplied the chances of punishment, and tended to check crime. 3. Subsequently, treaties of the same kind were made between the United States and the following countries : France in 1843 Prussia, and 17 other German States " 1852 Switzerland " 1855 Baden " 1857 Sweden " 1860 Venezuela, South America " 1861 The time is probably not distant when treaties of this sort will be made between us and all the civilized nations of the world; for the intercourse between us and foreign nations is greater than ever before. The effect of these international arrangements is to render the perpetration of crime more dangerous than it would be if they did not exist. Flight from the country where the crime was committed was formerly one of the most effectual methods of escaping the penalty. But extradition treaties, Atlantic cables, and land telegraphs, have nearly spoiled this game. EXTRADITION TREATIES. 255 3. An extradition treaty, then, is a mutual agreement be- tween two nations to deliver up, each to the other, upon demand and proper proof of criminality, such persons as have com- mitted crimes in one country and then fled to the other, that they may be taken back, tried, and punished where the offense was committed. But these demands for escaped criminals can not be sustained if made for every crime whatever. Thev will only be complied with when the crime is one which is named in the treaty itself. These crimes, upon examination of a number of such treaties, we find to be : 1. Murder, or an assault with an intent to commit murder. 2. Piracy. 3. Ar- son. 4:. Robbery. 5. Forgery, or the uttering of forged papers, or the making or circulating counterfeit money, either paper or coin. 6. Rape. 7. Embezzlement, and 8. Burglary. 4. It should be observed that a mere demand for an alleged offender is not sufficient. Proof enough to convince the judge before whom the case is brought must accompany the demand. He must be satisfied that the party demanded has committed the alleged offense; when this is done the judge reports his finding to the Secretary of State, whose duty then is. under his hand and seal of office, to issue the final writ of extradition; after which the criminal may be taken out of the United States (by force, if necessary), and back to the country where he com- mitted the crime, there to be dealt with according to the laws which he violated. 5. In some of our extradition treaties it is expressly stipu- lated that neither party (government) shall be bound to surren- der its own citizens, or any person for merely a political offense. In others it is agreed that the provisions in the treaty shall not apply to cases where the crime was perpetrated before the treaty was made. This plea, we think, would be held to be a good defense in all cases, whether so stipulated in the treaty or not. 6. The treaties between different nations for the surrender of criminals are so analagous to one of the provisions contained in our Constitution, that to insert it here will give the reader a 256 BUSINESS REPRESENTATIVES. clear comprehension of its meaning. It is found in the second ion of article 4, and reads thus : " A person charged in any State with treason, felony, or other crime, who shall flee from justice, and be found in another State, shall, on demand of the executive authority of the State from which he fled, be delivered up, to be removed to the State having jurisdiction of the crime." CHAPTEE VII. BUSINESS EEPRESENTATI VES. 1. These officers, called Consuls, are employed by most civil- ized nations, all those at least who have an extensive intercourse with foreign countries, and they are recognized by the Law of Nations as being clothed, when acting in their official capacity, with the authority and inviolability of their respective govern- ments. Their place of official business is protected by the flag of their country, an insult to which renders reparation or war necessary to maintain its honor. Consuls are agents of their governments, but most of their duties have reference to the interests of private citizens who may be within their Consulate. There maybe a great number of them in one country, and they are usually located in the seaports. 2. The Constitution provides that the President and Senate shall appoint all our Consuls. The President signs their com- missions, which bear the great seal of the United States, and which prove to the government where they are sent that they are duly appointed and authorized to discharge the duties of BUSINESS REPRESENTATIVES. 257 Consuls at the ports or places to which they have been ap- pointed. 3. In order to show the nature of a Consul's duties, such as the laws impose upon him, we will state the substance of several acts relating to this subject. 1. Whenever a vessel belonging to a citizen of the United States arrives at the port where he is stationed, it is his duty to receive the ship's papers, and to see if they are all correct. 2. It is his duty to provide for sick, disabled, and destitute American seamen, and to send them home by some vessel going to the United States. 3. He must hear the complaints of seamen, and settle dis- putes between the captain and men; and for good cause he may discharge the whole ship's crew. 4. It is made his duty to receive and take care of the per- sonal property of any citizen of the United States who has died within his Consulate, and to send any balance which may be left after paying his debts and necessary expenses, to the treas- ury of the United States, to be held in trust for the legal claim- ants. He must also give notice to the Secretary of State of the death of such person. 4*. For the purpose of carrying out and executing certain treaties made between the United States and China, Japan, Siam, and Turkey, Consuls to those countries have been empow- ered with judicial functions. They were allowed to act as judges, and to try and punish citizens of the United States who had committed crimes there. These, however, were extra- ordinary powers in special cases, and by no means common to the consular office. 5. In the absence of a minister or diplomatic agent of the United States, the President may authorize a Consul to perform the duties of such foreign minister; but these powers arc rarely conferred on them. Their ordinary duties relate to commercial affairs, and to such as are before stated. • '•. A Vice-Consul, or deputy Consul, is one appointed to act temporarily in case of sickness or absence of the Consul 17 258 PASSPOKTS. His powers, while acting, are the same as those of the Consul in whose place lie acts. Every Consul is required to give bonds for the faithful performance of his duties. 7. Our commerce has been extended to almost every part of the globe, and for this reason we need a great number of these officials. Their services are required at all great seaports, and at many smaller ones. The compensation varies according to the amount of business to be transacted by them, from $7,500 down to $500. Some do not receive any salary, but arc allowed the fees they are authorized to charge for their services. 8. It is his duty to give his government and countrymen all such information as he possesses in relation to the laws and practices of the country to which he is sent, which it would be important for them to know; and especially is it his duty to look after the interests and welfare of his countrymen when they are within his Consulate, and to see that no wrong or injustice is done to them by the people or government where he resides. CHAPTER VIII. PASSPORTS. 1. These are written documents, in due official form, signed and sealed by the proper authority, to convey official informa- tion, or serve as a means of protection, and to readily distin- guish the American Citizen abroad, or to give a permission or authority to go where those not having passports are forbidden to go. The passport conveys authentic information to whom it PASSPORTS. may concern, to what nation the bearer of the passport helm and second, to protect him, and secure to him all the rights and privileges which the government lias a right to claim for its citizens by virtue of any treaty of amity and friendship existing between it and the country whither its citizens may go. The passport informs the world that the bearer of it is a citi- zen of the United States, and that he travels under its protec- tion, and that it would demand and exact satisfaction of any one who wronged or injured him who bears such credentials. 2. In the United States, the Secretary of State is the officer authorized by law to issue passports. He has the authority also to cause them to be issued in foreign countries by our for- eign ministers and consuls, under such restrictions and rules as may be designated by the President. This is allowed as a matter of convenience to our citizens who happen to be in for- eign countries without them; who need their protection, and who would be subjected to much delay and expense by going or sending home to procure them. Passports are not granted to any other than citizens of the United States, whether issued by the Secretary or by any dip- lomatic or consular agent of our government. 3. Besides these passports, which are given only to our own citizens when in foreign countries, or who intend to go there, there is another kind issued to foreigners who wish to go among the Indians in the Indian territory, or on the Indian reservations. Indeed, our own citizens are not allowed to go among them without permission. But foreigners cannot go without a passport from the Secretary of War, which specifies the route over which the bearer must pass, and the length of time he is allowed to remain among them. This is done to prevent unfriendly foreigners from fomenting mischief, or from exciting unkind feelings towards our government or people. Such unfriendly feelings have been created by foreigners, and we have often experienced the bitter fruits of it, especially in times of war. 4. Still another kind of passports is used in this country. 260 DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY. and should be noticed under this head. They are passports for American ships or vessels. When they are about to sail for a foreign port, the laws of the United States require each to pro- cure one, under a penalty or fine of two hundred dollars upon the master if he departs from the United States for a foreign country (Other than some port in America), without it. The passport is prepared by the Secretary of State and is approved by the President. This is given to the master by the collector of the port from which the vessel sails, and is one of the ship's papers, by which her nationality is known, and her protection shown to be that of the United States. CHAPTER IX. DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY. 1. If the Executive Department that has charge of the public moneys is not highest, in nominal rank, it certainly does not hold a less important and interesting place in the estima- tion of the country and of the world than the Department of State. Every part of the government is dependent on this for its efficiency. It is the heart of the country. The in-and-out- flowing of the tide of money from the central point marks the pulses of the nation's prosperity. Especially has this been the ease since the Civil War, and the immense developments and changes that followed it. The banking system, making the Treasury responsible for the issue of all the hundreds of mil- lions of bunk notes used in the business of the country, adds immensely to tin- importance of the United States Treasury. 2. The management of this Department is committed to DEPARTMENT OF TIIK TKKASL.ky. 26 1 the Secretary of the Treasury. He is selected for that office by the President, and when his nomination is approved by the Senate his appointment takes place. He holds office during a presidential term, unless sooner removed. He is a member of the Cabinet and one of the President's advisers. 3. The financial policy adopted by the country depends very much on his views on that difficult question, and the interests and wealth of millions on the ability and integrity he pos- sesses. He is therefore chosen on account of his real or sup- posed qualifications on questions of finance. lie is aided in his duties by an Assistant Secretary, a Comp- troller and Second Comptroller, five Auditors, a Treasurer and his assistant, a Register and his assistant, a Commissioner of Customs, a Comptroller of the Currency and his deputy, and a Solicitor of the Treasury. All these have their offices in connection with the Treasury Department at Washington. In several of the large cities are sub-treasuries, each presided over by an assistant Treasurer, where public funds are received and disbursed. The Treasurers of the Mints are also, many of them, Assistant Treasurers of this Department. All these are appointed by the President and Senate in the same manner as the Chief Secretary. 4. The sums of money actually handled, and the accounts of all moneys received and disbursed without passing into the vaults of the Treasury, amount to many hundreds of millions annually, and require the constant service of some hundreds of clerks. These all need to have clean hands and pure hearts, which is, unfortunately, more rare among men of all classes than could be wished. Yet the whole is reduced to so accurate a system that a loss at any point immediately produces a dis turbance in the whole machinery, and a short examination Buf fices to reveal the point of difficulty and the person responsible f>r it, Accordingly, losses and defalcations are seldom expe- rienced in or near the central point of the Department If they occur, which is sometimes the case, it is usually Bome •officer at a distance who is found to be at fault, whose sphere 202 DEPAR'niENT OF THE TREASURY. of operations lies far from the centre and only occasionally passes under scrutiny. Each lias his separate sphere of duties which no one else interferes with, and assumes his own respon- sibility. •. and probably no other institution in the world loses less in proportion to the amount of money involved and the number of persons handling it. 5. Every account must be carefully examined and approved by the proper officer before it can be presented for settlement and the money paid out, and whatever moneys may flow in, none can flow out but according to some law of Congress defi- nitely appropriating it. All officers having the handling of public funds are required to give security for the faithful discharge of their duties. This must, by the requirement of the law, be done before they can enter their respective places. SECRETARIES OF THE TREASURY. Alexander Hamilton, N. Y., Sept. 12, 1789. Oliver Wolcott, Ct., Feb. 4, 1795. Samuel Dexter, Mass., Dec. 31, 1800. Albert Gallatin, Pa., May 14, 1801. George W. Campbell, Tenn., Feb. 9, 1814. Alexander J. Dallas, Pa., Oct. 6, 1814. William H. Crawford, Ga., Oct. 22, 1816. Richard Rush, Pa., Mar. 7, 1825. Samuel D. Ingham, Pa., Mar. 6, 1829. Louis McLane, Del., Aug. 8, 1831. William J. Duane, Pa., May 29, 1833. Roger B. Taney, Md., Sept. 23, 1833. Levi Woodbury, K II., June 27, 1834. Thomas Ewing, O., Mar. 5, 1841. Walter Forward, Pa., Sept. 13, 1841. John C. Spencer, K Y., Mar 3, 1843. George M. Bibb, Ky., June 15, 1844. Robert J. Walker, Miss., Mar. 5, 1845. W. M. Meredith, Pa., Mar. 7, 1849. FINANCIAL SYSTEM OF THE U. S. 263 Thomas Corwin, O., June 20, 1850. James Guthrie, Ky., Mar. 5, 1853. Howell Cobb, Ga., Mar. 6, 1857. Philip F. Thomas, Md., Dec. 10, 1860. John A. Dix, N. Y., 1861. Salmon P. Chase, O., Mar. 5, 1861. William P. Fessenden, Me., July, 1864. Hugh McCulloch, Inch, 1864. George S. Boutwell, March 11,1869. W. A. Richardson, March 17, 1873. B. H. Bristow, Ky., June 3, 1874. CHAPTEE X. THE FINANCIAL SYSTEM OF THE U. S. 1. Revenue, or the income of the government, is. derived from various sources. A tax — or duty, as it is often called — laid on goods imported into the country, is one of the most important. It is easy for a government to manage without producing a very sensible effect on the people, and has been a favorite mode of raising a revenue with nearly all governments since commerce became general. 2. The sale of public lands has, in this country, been a source of large revenue; though the desire to encourage emi- gration and develop the unsettled parts has led the government to sell them for a nominal sum. Still, these lands were so attractive and extensive as to sell rapidly and produce a con- siderable income. The Post Office Department has been a source of income, in great part supporting itself. Duti< a paid on the tonnage of vessels, the forfeiture of goods smuggled, 264 FINANCIAL SYSTEM OF THE U. S. introduced into the country without paying the lawful tax or duty, and the forfeiture of vessels used in that unlawful trade, prizes taken in Mar, and fees required to be paid to various officials when their services are employed, are minor sources of revenue. 3. When all these are not sufficient, as in time of war, or when an immense war debt is to be paid, direct taxes are laid on the property and business of the country. This is called THE INTERNAL REVENUE, and is borne with more or less patience, according as the people regard the end to be gained important. The revenues of the States are mostly derived from this source. They are not allowed to raise their revenue from foreign commerce, since that would be a tax on goods liable to be paid by the people of another State. 4. The necessity of laying large direct taxes does not, in this country, often arise in case of the General Government; but during and after the gigantic Civil "War between the North and South, when enormous expenses had to be met, and the credit of the government sustained, the direct taxes became very large indeed. In 1861 Congress passed the " Internal Revenue Law," by which twenty millions of dollars were to be annually raised from direct taxes on houses and lands in each of the States and Territories. By subsequent acts not only houses and lands were taxed, but almost every sort of property and business. Licenses were required for persons to carry on their profession, trade, or busi- ness; incomes were taxed; deeds, mortgages, notes, bonds, bank checks, and papers of almost every kind w r ere invalid unless they had a revenue stamp upon them. Manufacturers had to pay a certain per-centage on whatever they made. Scarcely any calling, trade, profession, or business escaped it, directly or indirectly. 5. To carry out these provisions, the whole country was FINANCIAL SYSTEM OF THE U. 8. divided into Revenue Districts, corresponding, so far aa con- venient, with Congressional Districts. An officer of the Tn nry Department, called the Commissioner of Internal Revenue, was appointed, charged with the duty of preparing in.-t ructions, forms, blanks, stamps, and licenses, to be used in the collection by the multitude of minor officers employed, and of oversee- ino- the whole work. Each district had its chief < 'Hirer, and his deputies, assessors, and collectors, by whom the money at length reached the Treasury at Washington. It created an army of officers to be paid. It was laid aside as soon as possi- ble, and taxation made less onerous and expensive. TIm- remark- able prosperity of the country at that particular period made it easier to bear. Direct taxes laid by the General ( J-overnment are more economically collected by the State or local officials, in all ordinary cases. This was a very extraordinary and press- ing one, and the people were so eager to put their debt in the way of extinction that it was endured with much patience for several years, when most of this cumbrous and costly machinery was laid aside. 6. The vast war debt, the large number of government officers employed in attending to the interests of so large and prosperous a country, the support of the army and navy, the great number of foreign representatives and agents of the government, and the public works necessary for the develop- ment or protection of the country, make a large revenue indis- pensable. 7. It is best when the people are free and intelligent that they be governed as little as possible— or rather that they gov- ern themselves as much as possible, and that as few officials Bfl may be live on the fruits of other people's labor. There must necessarily be an army of them, at the least; but such arrange- ments should be made that public expenses may be reduced to the lowest point, and republican simplicity everywhere reign. The principle and habit of public economy should be earn- estly insisted on, since the handling of immense sums of pub- lic money is much more demoralizing than the acquisition oi 266 DUTIES AND TARIFFS. private wealth in legitimate ways. It is a strong temptation to men of weak moral character; and private property is more likely to be carefully used and economically expended than public funds. The smaller the revenue, consistent with the general development of the country, the better. CHAPTER XI. DUTIES AND TAEIFFS. 1. Duty is a term used to designate a sum paid by foreign merchandise coming to our country for sale, for the privilege of entering and being offered to purchasers. Tariff is a rate, or scale, of duties. 2. Ever since intercourse has become frequent between dif- ferent nations commerce has been occupied in effecting inter- changes of the products and industries of each country with others. Each country has peculiarities that specially fit it for the production or manufacture of some article, or list of arti- cles, which others would be unable to produce, or would pro- duce at greater inconvenience and expense, and which is of high value to all, or many of the others. The social princi- ple has proved to be of extreme value to the improvement of men, and to their happiness; and we might say that, in this unequal distribution of capacities in the lands, and the races who inhabit them, the exercise of the social principle, on a broad scale, was made, by nature, indispensable. 3. Each nation, then, devotes itself to its special features of production, and exchanges its surplus with others for what it wants of their different surplus, to mutual profit. Just as A is a farmer, and raises grain, while B is a mechanic. Each has a natural adaptation to the business he pursues, and each needs what the other produces. So they exchange, and each has the full benefit of the success and different genius and resources of the other. Commerce is the same in principle, and interchange becomes constantly more extensive. DUTIES AMi TARIFFS. 267 4. Government naturally regulates commerce because it one of the general interests of the country. It finds an indefi nite amount of foreign merchandise waiting to enter to be pul on sale. It was long ago discovered that here was a conve- nient mode of producing a government income without dis- turbing the people with a constant demand for money to pay its expenses. Whatever foreign goods had to pay for permis- sion to enter, was quietly added to the price afterward, and s»> the people paid their taxes to the government in an indirect way in the form of a Duty. They pay the price asked, if it be within their means, without knowledge, or thought, of what part goes to the government, unless they study the subject care- fully. It has always been the case, then, that a government could get all the money it wanted, from this source, in ordinary times, with very little trouble. That mode is naturally a favor- ite with them. Whether it is the best way for the people is another question, which has been, at different times, very warmly debated in our government. It is not our place here to take up the argument, but it is worthy of a careful study by the people. 5, A Tariff of duties is established to carry on the govern- ment. There is another object that has had many advocates, and has quite commonly exerted an influence to raise the tariff on some things. It is stated in the preamble, or introduction, to the first act passed by the first Congress, on this subject. July 4th, 1789, " Whereas, it is necessary for the support of the government, for the discharge of the debts of the United States, and the encouragement and protection of moMVufao- tures, that duties be laid on goods, wares, and merchandise imported." It was considered important to protect and encour- age our manufactures, by putting so high a price on the same kind of foreign goods that ours would have the advantage and sell at a less price or greater profit. This might have been a wise measure, in the early days of tin- country, when there were few manufactures. Wnether it has been so since, or is so now, is not so clear. 268 DUTIES AND TARIFFS. 6. Every man should make up his mind what is right and "best and act as he sees to be most for the general good. It lias two disadvantages. It embarrasses the interchange that we have described as so profitable, and under a high tariff some- times practically forbids it. It is unsocial, and we declare by it, that we will, bo far as possible, live within ourselves, and have as little to do with our neighbors as we can. Besides, it is our own people who have to pay the duty, mainly, if they use the foreign goods ; or the higher price on domestic goods if they buy them; so that one class of the people, that is, the the mass of them, pay another small class large sums to manu- facture what might be bought from foreigners with less money. It is a fine thing for the manufacturers, but not quite so fine for those who buy them, unless they feel like making their •countrymen a present for every piece of goods he will manu- facture for them, beside the proper cost as made by others. It has the advantage of encouraging industries of different kinds; and has been believed to contribute greatly to the gen- eral prosperity in that way. Some think it best to let all those things arrange themselves, and leave each nation to bring us what they can produce cheapest and sell them more of what we can produce cheapest. They believe this is the secret of pros- perity, 1 tesides being more social. It is a question to be care- fully examined. It seems probable, that, in the end, all nations will agree on this policy, and raise their revenue in some other way. It is perhaps too soon to expect that, as yet. We have never been without a tariff, though there has been much discussion in Congress, and between parties, whether it should be protective or not. So it has often changed from low to high and back again. The necessities of our war, and the heavy debt, made it important, in the highest degree, to raise all the revenue we could, and the subject has not been much discussed for many years. 7. The Duties are mostly collected in the cities, and, as foreign goods come mainly by water, in the seaports of the country. Duties are often called Customs, and the places where DUTIKS AND TARIFFS. 269 they arc collected Custom Houses; and the officers Custom House Officers. These pi aces are located in ports along our coast, and there are some thousands of custom house officers of all grades. The buildings erected by the government have cost many millions of dollars. The larger part of the duties are collected in the great seaport cities, as Boston, New York, Balti- more, New Orleans, and San Francisco. Places, designated for foreign vessels to present their goods for examination and collection of the duty, are called Ports of Entry. If they are delivered at some other place, where there is no custom house they are called Ports of Delivery. S. Congress alone has power to lay these duties. There are two modes of imposing them ; sometimes one and sometimes the other being adopted, according to the views of the Con- gress legislating. They are called specific and ad valorem duties. Ad valorem means, according to the cost, and is counted on the cost in the country the article comes from. Specific duties are so much on the article, without regard to the cost. On many things imported there is no duty, and they are called "free goods." Changes are continually made in the tariff to conform to the requirements of the Treasury, the desires of the people, and the changing views of the legislators. DRAWBACKS. 9. When the duties on foreign goods have been paid, and they are afterwards exported, the duties which have been paid are refunded to the owner. The mOney thus paid baei called a drawback. All imported goods are entitled to draw- back whenever they are taken out of the United States. BOUNTIES ON EXPORTED GOODS, take money out of, instead of putting it in the treasnry,ye1 the government in a few cases has allowed bounties upon exported . rticles. Fish taken by American vessels, refined Bngar and distilled spirits made from imported sugar and molasses, are examples. This was done to encourage domestic industry and enterprise. 270 DUTIES AXD TARIFFS. CUSTOMS REVENUE FOE FIFTY-ONE YEAES. A Comparative Statement showing the Customs Revenue, Amount of Dutiable and Free Goods Imported, and the Average Rate of Duty on Imports, every year from 1821 to 1871, inclusive. Teak. 1821. [823 1823. 1824. 1825 1886. 1827. 1828. 1829. 1830. 1831. 1&32. 1833. 1834. 1835. 1836. 1837. 1838. 1839. 1840. 1841. 1842. 1843. 1944. 1845. 184fi. 1847. 1848.. 1849.. 1850.. 1851.. 1862.. 1853.. 1854.. 1855.. 1856.. 1857.. 1858.. 1859.. I860.. 1861.. 1862.. 1863.. 1864.. 1866 - 1866.. 1867.. l^irt.. i8<>9.. 1870.. 1871 Receipts from t'ut-toms. 818,475 24,066, 22,402. 25,486 31,653 26,083 27,948. 29.951 27,688. 28,389. 36.596. 29,341. 24.177 18,960 25.890 30,818 18,1:34 19,702 25.554 15.104 19,919 16,662 10,208 29,236 30,952 26.712 23,747 31,757 28.346 39,668. 49.017. 47,339. 68,931, 64,224 53.025 64.022 63,875, 41,789. 49 565, 53,187. 39.5HJ. 49.056 69.059 102.316 84.928 179,046 176,417 164,464 180,048 03 57 066 43 .024 29 ,817 86 ,871 50 ,861 97 .956 57 .251 90 .701 11 .505 05 ,118 19 .175 65 578 52 ,705 96 736 66 327 67 131 01 825 45 533 96 790 63 492 17 .746 84 ,000 43 ,357 38 .416 21 .668 00 ,865 00 ,071 00 ,739 00 ,686 00 568 00 326 00 ,865 00 .190 00 ,794 00 863 00 905 00 621 00 824 00 511 00 ,126 00 398 00 .642 00 .153 00 ,260 00 630 00 .811 00 .596 00 ,427 00 2 7. 00 IMPORTS. Free. $10,082,313 7,298,708 9.048.283 12.563,773 10,947,510 12,567,769 11,855,104 12,379,176 11.805.501 12,746,245 13.456.625 14.249,453 32,447,950 68.393,180 77.940.493 92.056.481 69.250.031 60,800,005 76.401.792 57,196,204 66,019,731 30,627,486 35,574,584 24,766,881 22,147.840 24,767,739 41,772,636 22,716.603 22,377,1X55 22.710.382 25,106,587 29,692,934 31,383.534 33,285.821 40,090,336 56.955.716 66. 729.306 80,819,275 79,721,116 90,841.749 tl 17,469,962 169,136,705 44,826,029 tM. 241, 944 54,329.588 69,728,618 45.203,970 29,379,149 41,154,568 46,500,050 57,851,808 Dutiable. Total. $52,503,411 75,942,833 68,530.979 67,985,234 85,392,565 72,406,708 67,628,964 76,130,648 62,687,026 58,1:30,6:5 89,734,499 86,779.813 75.ti70.361 58.128.152 71,955,249 97.923,554 71.739.186 52,857,399 85.690,340 49,945,315 61.926.446 69,534,001 29.179,215 83,668,154 95,11-6, 724 96,924.058 104, 'i73 002 132,282,325 125,479,774 155,427,936 191,118,345 183.252,508 236,595,113 271,276.560 221,378.184 257.684.236 294.160,835 202.293,875 259,047,014 279.872,327 218,1 a'. 191 136,635,1 24 208,Cft3.h91 275,320,951 194,226,064 375.; 83,540 372.627,601 342.21.--J 59 395,859.087 « 5,817,537 483,641,966 $62,585,724 83,241,541 77,579,267 80,549,007 96,340,075 84,974,477 79,484,068 88,509,824 74.492,527 70,876,920 103,191,124 101,029,266 108,118,311 126.521,332 149,895.742 189.980.035 140.989.217 113,717,404 162.092,132 107,141,519 127,946,177 100,162,087 64,753,199 108,4:35,035 117.254,564 121,691,797 146,545,038 154,998,628 147,a57,439 178.1:38.318 216,224,932 212.945,442 267.978,647 304,562,381 261,468,520 314,639,942 360,890,141 282,613,150 338,768,130 362,106 254 335,650,153 205,711.729 252,91!, 920 329,562,1 I 5 248,555,65.! 445.512.158 417,831.571 371,624,808 437,314,255 462,371. 5t 7 541,493,774 a o a a 35.6 31.7 32.7 3,-5 37.1 o4.6 41.3 39.3 44.3 48.8 40.8 33.8 31.9 32.6 36.0 31.6 25.3 37.8 29.9 30.4 32.2 23.1 35.7 35.1 32.5 26.5 22.5 24.0 23.0 25.2 26.0 26.0 25.0 23.5 23.0 25.0 21.5 20.0 19.0 19.0 18.14 35. IK) 33.19 37.16 43.75 47.65 47.34 48.05 45.48 46.37 a °cl _. ; ■*-» f i. 5 be 29.5 28.9 28-8 31-6 32-8 30-7 35.1 33-8 37-1 4o.0 35-4 29.0 22-4 15-0 17-2 16-2 12-4 17-3 15-8 14.1 15.6 16-6 15.7 26.9 26.4 21.9 16.2 20.4 19 2 22.3 22.6 22.2 22.0 21.1 20.3 20.3 17.7 14.8 14.6 14.7 11.79 23.84 27.30 31.04 34.17 40.19 42.22 44.25 41.17 41.11 Thcpirrmi:,;-,,. Ul these columns an- approximately, not absolutely correct, owing to the fact that the rates are computed upon the value'of merchandise, etc., imported, Yalueofga ring into consumption in the respective years. tTneec amounts do not include imports into the Southern ports during the war. from A2 220 n0revenae wae der ived, namely, iu 1861, $17,089,234; in 1862, $90,789; and in 1864, DUTIES AND TARIFFS. 2 7 ] TONNAGE. 11. Tonnage designates the capacity of a vessel for carrying goods, which depends on the tons of weight it can receive, and is computed by assigning so much space, in height, length, and breadth, to each ton. A revenue, additional to thai raised from the goods brought in vessels, is produced by a tax on the tonnage, or carrying capacity of vessels. It is laid, not only on foreign vessels, trading with our sea- ports, but on our own vessels; a distinction being made so as to produce protection in favor of our own commerce and ship-builders. This also is paid by those who buy the goods brought in these vessels; since whatever duty is laid on the carrying trade must be made up by the higher price of the arti- cle brought. It is a way of levying taxes without directly calling the attention of the people to the fact. 12. It is worthy of careful consideration whether the coun- try would not gain as much, by removing all' these embarrass- ments to commerce with other countries, and different points on our coasts, as has been gained by free trade between the dif- ferent States. The Constitution forbids taxes to be levied on inter-State commerce, or trade, and the country is undoubtedly the gainer by such a provision. In 1790 a tonnage duty of 50 cents per ton was laid on for- eign vessels, and six cents on American vessels. During the Civil War the tonnage duty was raised ten cents per ton on both foreign and American shipping. Tonnage is collected only once a year by the collector of the port where the vessel happens to be. CHAPTEK XII. COLLECTION OF DUTIES. 1. The Tariff, or Scale of Duties, laid by the Laws of Con- gress, on goods brought from foreign countries, requires to be paid when they are first introduced ; or we might say, before they are introduced. All these goods are stopped as they approach the boundary line, or on the boundary line, and carefully examined; and they can go no farther until the duties- imposed by Congress are received. "When they have u passed the Custom House " they may be as freely sold as goods pro- duced at home. No government officer has any right to inter- fere with them. They have paid the duty and have the freedom of the land. If they, by any chance or effort, get in by any other way, they are treated as stolen goods, and may be seized and confiscated. However much they may have cost their owners, however highly they may prize them, however unques- tioned was their ownership before they passed the limits of the country, if they are introduced by any other than the Custom House Door, all right and title to them by the former owners ceases, and they become the property of the government. 2. So carefully is this point guarded that not only are government officers provided for the sole purpose of watching against this illegal introduction of goods, but a premium is offered to unofficial persons to secure their aid. Any one who can point out (and prove the fact) goods of any kind, liable to duty, that have not passed the custom house, and paid that duty, is entitled to half the value of the goods; the other half belonging to the government. Smuggling, as bringing goods (272) COLLECTION OK DUTIES. JT Into the country without paying the duty is called, is held to be robbery of the government, and ranks as a serious offenc and it really is so, as long as the government produces it.- income, or part of it, in this way. The law makes it part pro- prietor in the property until its claim is settled. Besides, to take from the government is to take from the people; since they must make up, in some other way, for what is subtracted in this. 3. To secure this payment of Duty, then, a large number of officers of different grades are appointed, not only to examine the goods, determine the amount required to be paid, receive the money and keep all the accounts connected with it, but to take care that all the goods, of whatever kind, that are not permitted an entrance free of duty, shall duly pass examination, and be "entered," as it is called, at the custom house. 4. The Head of these officers is the COMMISSIONER OF CUSTOMS. He superintends the Customs Bureau in the Treasury Depart- ment. He is nominated, and, with the consent of the Senate, appointed by the President. All the accounts of officers em- ployed in the collection of duties on imports pass through his bureau for examination and adjustment; he prepares the forms of all papers used in this department of the revenue ; directs the form of keeping the accounts; brings suits when necessary for the recovery of money due from officers of the department; and makes a report of any neglect of duty to Congress. A complete summary, therefore, of the past and present condition of the customs department may be found, at any time, in his office. With so perfect a system of supervision it dues not matter how extensive the organization may be. No confusion is possible. There are more than 30,000 persons employed under this officer; and they are scattered through the whole eountry where there are Ports of Entry or Delivery, as will as keeping guard along the whole coastline and frontier oi the United States ; yet they are under as complete discipline *ud 18 274 COLLECTION OF DUTIES. surveillance as the army or navy. This bureau was organized in 1^49; its business having previously been under the over- sight of the First Comptroller of the Treasury. It has general supervision of the conduct and accounts of all customs offi- cials. The highest in rank below this are THE COLLECTOES. 5. Wherever there is a Port of Entry a Collector is ap- pointed to superintend the collection of duties, receive the money, and transmit it to the United States Treasury. He is the principal officer of the Collection District connected with this Port, which often embraces several Ports of Delivery, and is required to see that all is properly conducted in his district. He receives hi6 appointment directly from the President and Senate, and is removable at the pleasure of the President, 6. As, in ordinary times, the most of the revenue required for the support of the government is derived from Customs, this is a responsible office. Great care is required to secure the services of competent and faithful men, and the bonds they are required to give are large. He nominates the subordinate officers connected with his custom-house, and the Secretary of the Treasury appoints them, if he sees no objection. 7. The Collectors take care that all the goods, on which Congress has imposed a duty, pay the amount due. To this end he often requires one or more deputies. The entire com- merce of the part of the country falling in his district, with other countries, passes under his examination. He receives all reports, manifests, and documents required to be exhibited by all vessels, domestic and foreign, on their entry into his port, and all accounts of all the goods they have on board. On these he must estimate the duties, receive the moneys, or bonds securing their payment, and grant all permits for landing the goods. He transmits, quarterly, all the moneys collected in his department, with an accurate account of all the transactions of his office during the quarter, to the Secretary of the Treas- ury. These accounts pass to the Customs bureau, and the money to the Treasurer of the United States. COLLECTION OF DUTIES. 275 8. His duties, as described in the previous section, make him acquainted with all the imports of the country, in his District or Port. He is also required to examine the manifests of all the vessels, and the accounts of their cargoes, that leave his port for a foreign country. This secures a knowledge of all the exports of the country. It is his duty to give clearances, or permits, to all vessels leaving for foreign ports. It is unlaw- ful for any vessel to depart without this document. A ship's clearance can be properly given only when her manifest, or detailed account of the quantity, kind, and value of her cargo is ascertained to be correct. 9. We give the form of a ship's Manifest, and also of a Clearance. A SHIP'S MANIFEST. " Report and manifest of the cargo laden on board of the , whereof is master, which cargo was taken on board at the port or ports of , burthen tons, built at , in the State of , and owned by , merchants at , and bound for ." This, together with a particular description of the marks and numbers of every bale, box, case, barrel, bundle or parcel on board of the vessel, is the manifest. It must be given to the collector of whatever port the vessel arrives at; and the master of her must swear that it is in all respects a true and accurate account of all the cargo on board, to the best of his knowledge and belief. 10. The collector of the port can then compute the duties to be paid upon each article, and when these are paid, or secured to be paid, he gives permits to land tin' cargo, and deliver the goods to their respective owners. Then come in the duties of weighers, gaugers, measurers and inspectors of the customs, after permits are obtained to laud the goods. If they are such as require to be weighed, gauged, or measured, those "tii are sent to do it; and the inspector must allow nothing to 1. the ship until he has examined the marks and numbers, t<> if they correspond with the permit and the manifest If he L'Tti COLLECTION OF DUTIES. inspects that there is an attempt to defraud the government by false names and marks, he is authorized to open the package, box, case, cask, or whatever contains the goods, and to examine them. In this way smuggling is prevented, and the revenues arising from duties on imported goods secured. A SHIP'S CLEARANCE. This document is couched in the following terms : "District of , Port of , 88. "These are to certify, to all whom it may concern, thai A. B., master or commander of the ship (brig, barque, schooner' burthen tons or thereabouts, mounted with guns, navigated with men, built, and bound foi , having on board , hath here entered and cleared his said vessel according to law. " Given under our hands and seals, at the custom-house of , this day of , one thousand , and in the year of the Independence of the United States of America." This is signed by the collector and by the naval officer of the port, when the commander is prepared to depart with his vessel to his destination. 1 1. The compensation of collectors is not all given in the form of a salary, but in part the fees for services rendered, and part of the forfeitures of smuggled goods. In the larger ports it is enormous, but in the smaller ones is often insignificant. It is a common mode of doing business of this kind, and is supposed to stimulate the activity and secure the faithfulness of the officer in preventing frauds on the government. The working of this plan is sometimes complained of as inspiring an over-officiousness embarrassing to trade and unnecessarily annoying to importers; and as producing too great an inequal- ity in incomes. It is difficult to make a system quite perfect. Whether this admits of improvement remains to be seen. SURVEYORS 12- Are next in rank and authority to the Collectors. They COLLECTION 01 Dl m B, 877 are appointed in the same manner and receive their compen-u tion in the same way. The Surveyor's duty is to superintend the inspectors, weighers, measurers, and gangers in his port ; to visit all vessels arriving in it; make a detailed report of them to the Collector; and examine all goods entered for the benefit of drawback. THE NAVAL OFFICER 13. Of a port, is another of the superintendents, appointed to oversee the collection of the revenue. His appointment depends on the President and Senate, and his compensation on the amount of business done in his port, in the same manner as the Collector and Surveyor. His duties are, to some extent, parallel to those of the Collector ; or he may be called a local -examiner and auditor of the Collector's work and accounts, for the sake of accuracy and correctness. He receives copies of all manifests and entries, and computes the duties on all goods, keeping a separate record of them. He must countersign per- mits, clearances, certificates, debentures, and other documents issued by the Collector. He examines the Collector's accounts, bonds, and expenditures, and certifies to them, if correct. A great number of deputies and employees are required to carry out the details of the collection of duties, since the entire amount of imports into the country are required to be carefully examined. REVENUE CUTTERS 14. Are employed to guard against smuggling. They are vessels of small size, some steamers, and others sailing vessel-. properly manned and armed, of high powers of speed; and are stationed as a coast guard near the ports, and lines of ocean travel, to prevent the landing of imported goods before thev have paid the duty. Their officers are appointed by the Presi- dent and Senate. They look after all the ships going into any port, or any that may approach the coast; board them when within four leagues (or 12 miles) of the coast; examine the manifest of the cargo and every part of the vessel: put proper fastenings on the 278 GOVERNMENT COINAGE. hatches, to prevent unlawful communication with the hold until the Custom's officers have discharged their duty; and place a watch on board to remain until the vessel is delivered into the charge of the proper revenue officer. 15. They are revenue officers, and under the control of the Secretary of the Treasury, and the Collectors at the ports near which they are stationed. In case the President judges it best, they may be called on, at his direction, to cooperate with the Navy, and, in case they are disabled in the discharge of their duty at such times, are entitled to be treated in the same man- ner as officers and sailors in the Navy. 16. These vessels carry a pennant and ensign with such marks on them as the President may designate. If any vessel liable to seizure refuses to bring to at the direction of the com- mander of the Cutter, he is authorized to fire into it after having shown his pennant and ensign, and compel it to submit to be boarded and examined. Much depends on the vigilance of these revenue cutters, as the sums paid on goods imported amount to a great many millions of dollars, and want of due precaution would cause the income of the government to be defrauded of large sums. The commanders of revenue cutters report all matters relat- ing to their duties weekly to the Collector of the port. CHAPTER XIII. GOVERNMENT COINAGE. L. The United States mint, located at Philadelphia, is one w the most important establishments of the government. An act of Congress, passed in 1792, was the first step towards its creation. Its design was, and its principal business has been., GOVERNMENT COINAGE. 279 to etrt'n the precious metals into money. It has been for more than eighteen hundred years the usage of civilized governments to coin their own money. Ours, at a very early period of its existence, began to do the same thing, and will probably con- tinue to do it as long as it shall exist. Before the art of coin- ing was known, the precious metals were used as a standard of value, but they passed from one to another by weight. The plan of cutting them into small pieces, and then stamping their value upon them, by which their worth could be known as soon as seen, was an improvement upon the former mode. This process is denominated coining. It has of late been brought so near perfection that our pieces of money are fine specimens of art. 2. The officers, who manage and conduct the operations of, this establishment, are a Director, a Treasurer, an Assayer, a Melter and Refiner, a Chief Coiner, and an Engraver. They are all appointed by the President and Senate in the usual manner. The director appoints the assistants and clerks. All must give bonds for the faithful performance of their respective duties upon which they enter under oath. The duties of these different officers may almost be known by the names they bear. The director is the head of the institution, and the others act under his general direction, each having his appropriate duties to perform. In the month of January of each year the director must make a report to the President of the operations of the mint and its branches for the preceding year. 3. Any person may take gold or silver bullion or ores to the mint and receive it back in coin, for a very trifling expense. Before it is coined, after its value has been determined by the assayer, the director will give a certificate for it, which is ot the same value as the bullion deposited. 4. We have stated that the principal business at the mint is the conversion of the precious metals into coin or money. But this is not its exclusive business. Another part is to melt and assay these metals, and to run them into ingots or bars 380 GOVERNMENT COINAGE. either of pure or standard gold and silver, according to the wish of its owner. Until 1835 the mint at Philadelphia was the only establish- ment in the United States for coining money. But in that year a law was passed establishing branch mints at New Orleans, in Louisiana; at Charlotte, in .North Carolina; and at Dahlonega. in Georgia. In 1852, another branch was estab- lished in California; in 1862, another at Denver, in Colorado Territory; and in 1803, another at Carson City, in Nevada Territory, since made a State; in 1864, another at San Fran- cisco, in California, and another at Dallas City, in Oregon. Except the one in California, but little has ever been done at these branches. They are all similar to the principal one at Philadelphia; and the laws relating to that are made to apply to these branches. 6. The Constitution gives Congress the exclusive right to coin money, and prohibits all the States from doing it. This Congress does by the laws it passes in relation to the subject, and the various officers and workmen employed to execute the work are only the agents of Congress. The various coins which Congress has from time to time ordered to be made are of the following names and value: Gold. Value. Silver. Value. Copper. Eagle, $10 00 Dollar, $1 00 One cent, Half-Eagle, 5 00 Half-Dollar, 50 Two cents, Quar. Eag., 2 50 Quar. Dol., 25 Three cents, and Doub. Eag., 20 00 Dime, 10 formerly */ 2 c. Three Dols., 3 00 Half Dime. 5 But these are now One Dollar, 1 00 Three ct. piece, 3 discontinued. 7. Our coins are not made of pure gold and silver; a cer- tain amount of other metals being added to produce a coin that will be less affected by the friction of constant use. This alloy, or mixture, of the precious metals is called Standard gold or silver, since a definite amount of the alloy is required in all the coinage of the government for currency purposes. It does not alter the value of the coin; that being dependent on tfie actual merchantable value of the sum of the metals used. (."VKUNMKNT COINAGE. 281 By the law of 1837, standard gold and silver were declare* 1 t.> be nine hundred parts of pure metal, and one hundred pert* -alloy — equal to one-tenth alloy. Gold coins are alloyed with eilver and copper, equal parts of each. Silver coins are alloyed with copper alone. Gold is declared to be worth fifteen times as much as silver by weight. In addition to our own coins, Congress has, from time to time, passed laws declaring the value of foreign coins, and making them a legal tender. But these laws were all repealed by the act of 1857, and it was made the duty of the director of the mint to have them assayed, and to determine their weight, fineness, and value; for they are still used by banks and merchants, and pass at the value determined by the mint. The mint, up to 1861, had coined in gold, silver, and copper coin, 800,662,475 pieces, worth $799,923,362. THE UNITED STATES MINT. Statement of Domestic Gold and Silver deposited sit the United Btatea Mint and Branches, for Coinage, to June 30th, 1872. From. Gold. Silver. Gold asp Silver. California $643,965,036.09 30,648,365.24 20,338.420.96 17,141,523.K4 11,594,979.33 9,8(55,252.97 1,010,280.17 7,233,346.96 1,629,188.79 1,379.131,93 $156,423.03 176,838.57 1,114,548.48 291,681.59 1,863.74 44,110.95 8,539,868.04 403.83 $648,121,449.12 Montana 30.825.103.N1 Colorado .. . 21,452,964.39 Oregon 17,433,305.43 11,596,848.0; North Carolina 9,909,363.93 Nevada 9,550,148.21 Georgia 7,888,750.79 Virginia 1,689.188.79 -South Carolina 1,879,181 Lake Superior 1,062.540.81 39,873.08 1,088,540.81 Arizona 975,401.39 823,021.29 146,147.18 24,881.57 213,760.66 138.878.13 81,539.69 67,745.88 5.7(50,00 5,611.97 1,009.68 897.64 108.00 83,226.913. 12 1,690,402,80 1,015874.47 New Mexico. . 888,081.89 Utah 361.3iH.71 200,976.58 407,851.88 Nebraska 285.3 Alabama 218,751 Wyoming Territory Tennessee ." 86.48 188,964.66 B1.52 Washington Territory 67,745.88 New Mexico and Sonora B5&81 58.31 Dakota . • Vermont Kansas U'.-i.l 1,47 Sitka ..i iot • • Mlier Sources Parted from Silver .. 8,751.15 1.69 Fine Bars 5.898,490.02 • Parted from Gold.. Total $836,205,468.50 $88,066,498JM 282 GOVERNMENT COINAGE. ASSAY OFFICE. 1. In 1853 the Secretary of the Treasury was authorized tO' establish an office in the city of New York for the receipt, melting, relining and assaying of gold and silver bullion and foreign coins, and for casting the same into bars, ingots, or disks. The assistant treasurer of the United States in New York, is treasurer of this assay office, and the Secretary of the Treasury appoints such other clerks, assistants, and workmen as shall be necessary for the management of its business. 2. Persons having gold or silver bullion, ores or foreign coin, may deposit them in his office, and it will be refined and assayed (at no more cost than the actual expense of doing the work), its value ascertained, and the owner will be paid for it in coins of the same value and metal as that deposited. It is not coined in this office, but cast into bars, ingots or disks — either of pure metal or of standard fineness, as the owner may prefer — the true weight and value of which are stamped thereon; and the owner may either take them in payment for his bullion or foreign coin, or it will be coined for him at the United States Mint, if he wishes. The bars spoken of are often kept in that form, and are used as coin among banks, brokers,, and merchants, who receive and pay large amounts of the pre- cious metals. With them it passes as coin, for its exact weight and value are stamped upon it. 3. This establishment was located at New York more for the convenience of those who do business there, than for the necessity of such an institution; for at the mint at Philadel- phia there is a department for doing the same work as is done here. But at New York there is a larger amount of foreign coin than in any other place, and it is often advantageous to its owners to have it converted into American coin, that it may be used with greater facility. Although many foreign coins do circulate in this country, but few know their value. Conse- quently they do not pass so readily; and for this reason they are melted and run into bars of known value, or re-coined into American money. CHAPTER XIV. NATIONAL BANKING. 1. The present banking system was established by an act of Congress in 1863. The plan is quite different from any before in use, and commends itself to the whole country by the stabil- ity it gives to the currency in use in the transaction of its business, and the security it furnishes against loss of values common under the old systems. They are managed by private parties and corporations, apart from the government, but under a certain degree of supervision, and by its authority. By the act referred to any number of persons not less than five may associate themselves together for the purpose of banking, by compliance with the following conditions : 2. First : They must, under their hands and seals, make a certificate which shall specify — 1. The name assumed by such association. 2. The place where its business is to be conducted. 3. The amount of its capital stock (which cannot be less than $50,000), and the number of its shares. 4. The names of its shareholders, and the number of shares held by each. 5. The time when such association shall commence bnsini 6. A declaration that said certificate is made to enable such persons to avail themselves of the advantages of this act 3. This certificate must be properly acknowledged before some competent person, and must be sent to the comptroller of the currency in the Treasury Department, to be recorded and kept by him. When this, and all other acts which the law (283) 2b4 NA'IIONAL BANKING. requires, has been done by the association, the comptroller of the currency gives them a certificate under his hand and official seal, to that effect, and that they are authorized to commence business. This constitutes the association a corporation. They have the right to make and use a common seal, and have all the rights, and are liable to all the responsibilities of ordinary legalized corporations ; and may exist not to exceed twenty years from the passage of this act. Every shareholder is made personally liable for the debts of the association or bank, to the amount of the par value of his stock. 4. In order to secure the holders of bills issued bv these banks, they must deposit with the Treasurer of the United States, United States bonds bearing interest to an amount not less than one-third of the capital stock paid in. These bonds are safely kept by the Treasurer. The comptroller of the currency then issues to the bank an amount of bank notes equal to the amount of bonds thus deposited, less ten per cent. In case the bank should fail to redeem its circulating bills, its bonds are sold, and with the proceeds the comptroller of the currency redeems them, or orders them to be paid at the United States Treasury. The bonds held by the Treasurer as security for the redemption of the bills issued by the association, must be transferred to him in trust; thus giving him entire control of them in case it becomes necessary to sell them in order to redeem the bills of any association which may have failed to pay them on demand. 5. This act has brought a great number of banks into exist- ence, besides organizing most of the banks formerly existing under State laws under this system ; so that we have a nearly uniform system of banking all over the United States. The bills of these banks pass in any part of the country, which was not often the case formerly. In case the bank should be mis- managed, or fail to pay for any cause, there is ample security for their redemption deposited in the United States treasury, where they will be paid on presentation. 6. The bill-holder is also better protected against counter- NATIONAL BANKING. 285 feits than he was under the old system ; for all the bills issued by these associations are engraved by the government, and tin- plates and dieson which they are printed are kept by the comp- troller of the currency in the Treasury Department, The en- graving is done in the best possible manner, and it is exceed . ingly difficult to counterfeit them. Besides this, they all h;ive the imprint of the seal of the Treasury on their face, and arc numbered and countersigned by the treasurer and register. With all these guards and precautions, we have the best paper currency ever used since the establishment of the government. 7. This act necessarily threw upon the Treasury Department a great increase of labor, and in order to provide for it a sepa- rate bureau was created, which is denominated the bureau of currency, the chief officer of which is called the comptroller of currency. He acts under the general direction of the Secre- tary of the Treasury. This bureau is charged with the execution of this and all other laws that may be passed by Congress respecting the national currency. The comptroller of the cur- rency is appointed by the President and Senate, has a deputy, receives a salary of $5,000 per year, holds his office live years, has an official seal, gives bonds to the amount of $100,000, and takes and subscribes the oath of office prescribed by the Con- stitution and the laws. His duties are numerous and very responsible, he having hundreds of millions under his care. The term national banks, given to these institutions, and national currency to the bills they issue, were given from the fact that they were organized by an act of Congress, and that the security for the redemption of their bills consists exclu- sively of national bonds; no other securities will be taken. CHAPTER XV. FINANCIAL CONDITION OF THE UNITED STATES. 1. The United States government belongs to its people. Those people own property estimated at upwards of thirty billions of dollars. The public lands belonging to the govern- ment are between one and one and a half billions of acres. Besides, the public domains contain gold, silver, iron, coal, and a large number of other mineral deposits, chiefly in regions worthless for agricultural purposes, of unknown, but ascer- tained to be, at least, a very great quantity — enough to make all its present inhabitants millionaires if (besides paying the debt) their value could be divided among them. The capacity of the country for production is very far beyond what is drawn from it now. The future will probably increase it a thousand fold, for we are yet a new people, and in the act of settling ourselves to the work of development. We are very rich, if all our resources are taken into account, yet we are in debt. In five years from the commencement of the civil war the public debt had run up from less than one hun- dred million dollars to over two billion seven hundred millions. This we began to reduce at once, for as a nation we do not like to be in debt; and it was, December 1st, 1873, a little over two billion one hundred and fifty millions. The debt is, indeed, a trifle compared with our vast national property; but we do not wish to Bell our property at a loss, nor disturb the regular course ot business ; so it stands to be gradually paid in the regular course of things, as we find it to be convenient. It is a vast sum, but gives more trouble by reason of the (286) FINANCIAL CONDITION OF THE DOTTED 8TATJ -desire and determination of the people to pay it Boon, :mf May ai Issued under Act March 3d, 1864 (principal specified as payable in gold), $8,882 .'•" I^ued under Act June 30th, 1864, $125,561, 300. Total issue, $129,443,800. 288 FINANCIAL CONDITION OF THE UNITED STATES. Five-Twenties of 1865.— Dated July let, 1865. Interest, six per cent, in gold, payable January and July. They are redeemable ic five years, and payable in twenty years. Is- sued under Act March 3d, 1865, in exchange for 7-30 notes converted, and amount, August. 1st, 1868, to $372,346,350. Five-Twenties of 1865.— Dated November 1st, 1865. Redeemable after five, and pay- able in twenty years. Interest, six per cent, in gold, payable 1st of May and November. Issued under Act March 3d, 1865. $197,777,250. Five-Twenties of 1867. Dated July 1st, 1867. Redeemable in five, and payable in twentyyears. Interest, six per cent, in gold, payable 1st of January and July. Issued under Act March 3, 1865, in exchange for 7-30 notes, and amount, August 1st, 1868, to $371,346,350. Five-Twenties of 1868.— Dated July 1st, 1868. Redeemable in five, and payable in twenty years. Interest, six percent, in gold, payable let of January and July. Issued under Act March 3d, 1865, in exchange for 7-30 notes, and amount, August 1st, 1868, to $39,000,000. Ten-Forties.— Dated March 1st, 1864. Redeemable in ten and payable in forty years. Interest, five per cent, in gold, payable on the 1st of March and September on all Regis- tered Bond6, and on all Coupon Bonds of the denomination of $500 and $1,000. On the $50 and $100 Bonds, interest is paid annually, March let. Issued under Act March 3d, 1863, and Supplement, March 3d, 1864; principal, payable in gold, $194,291,500. Fives of 1870.— Redeemable at the pleasure of the United States, after May 1, 1881, in gold. Interest, five per cent, in gold, payable quarterly — February, May, August, and November let. Exempt from all taxation. Issued under Acts of July 14th, 1870, and Jan- uary 20th, 1871. Amount, $200,000,000. U. S. Pacific Railroad Currency Sixes. — Dated January 16th, 1865, and variously thereafter. ' These Bonds are issued by the Government, under Acts July 1st, 1862, and July 2d, 1864, to companies receiving their charter from Congress, which gives them the right to construct railroads to and from the Pacific Coast, and on the completion of each twenty miles of track, to receive at the rate of $16,000, $22,000, or $48,000 per mile, accord- ing to the difficulty of constructing the same. They are payable thirty years from date of issue, and are registered in (Bonds of $1,000, $5,000, and $10,000. Amount issued to September 1st, 1870, $64,618,832. All of the Bonds are ieeued " Coupon " or " Registered." Coupon Bonds can be changed into Registered Bonds, but Registered Bonds cannot be changed into Coupons. Coupon Bonds are in denominations of $50, $100, $500, and $1,000: the Regiitered Bonds the same, with addition of $5,000 and $10,000. WEALTH OF THE UNITED STATES. 2*9 States and Territories. Real and Per- Bona] Estate, Seal and P< i sona] Estate. : Estate. 1870. 1860. $30,068,518,507 $16,159,616,068 $7,135,780,22* 29,829,536,140 16,086,519,771 7,115,600,800 201,855.841 156,394,691 688,767,017 774,631,524 97. Iso.-:;:; 44,163,655 268.169,207 2,121,680,579 1,268,180,548 717.644,750 188,892,014 604,318,552 323,125,666 348. 155. 671 643,748,976 2, 132. lis. "ill 719,208,118 228,909,590 . 209,197.:; 15 1,284,922,897 69,277. 183 31,134,012 252.624.112 910.976,064 6.500,841.261 260.757.214 2,235.430.300 51,558,932 3,808,340,111 296.965.646 208,146,989 498 237,724 159,052.542 235.349.553 409.588.133 190,651,491 702.307.329 495,237,078 219.256.1;:; 207,874,618 444.271.11 1 46,242,181 78,101,500 645,895,237 871,860,282 528,835,371 247,888,266 31.327,895 66ti.lH3.112 602,118,568 190,211,000 376,919,944 815,237,438 257,168,988 52,294,418 607,324,911 501,214,898 9,181,056 228,204,882 22,161 155,707,1 I 21,062,566 22,862,270 836,426,714 156,266,006 202,650,264 28,714,688 801,628,466 764 122,777,571 219,217,81 1 578,342,286 59,78 Mississippi - 228,961,180 137,247,707 Nevada New Hampshire - 156,310,860 467,918.321 1,643,338,517 858,789,399 1,193,898,422 25,980,68'i 1.416.501 .sis 185,887,588 648.138,754 493,903,8! ' 865,200,614 122,477,170 793,249,681 108,652,886 000 1,080.809,218 North Carolina 226,800,472 Ohio 504.726.120 5,063,4' t Pennsylvania 722,486.120 80.508,794 Smith Carolina - Tennessee - Texas Vermont 2S8.257.6fM 201,241 1 52 : io. 173 92,206,049 430.701,082 West Virginia Wisconsin 278,671 668 215.983,367 73.096.297 20,179,488 $3,440,791 20,243, 10 1 5,599,752 126,878,616 6,552,681 15,184,522 31,849,798 16,159,996 13,562,164 7,016,748 - District of Columbia 41,084.915 14,01 20,811 5,596,118 5,601,466 Utah THE AVERAGE WEALTH TO EACH INDIVIIU \1.. 1. 2. 3. 4. 6. 6. i . 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. New York $ Massachusetts.. Connecticut Rhode Island California Pennsylvania .. New Jersey Ohio Illinois Maryland New Hampshire, Delaware .. Indiana 1,483. 1.463. 1.441 1,366. 1,140. 1.081. 1,088 888. 835 824 793 777 754. 14. Missouri... 15. Nevada Vermont... Wisconsin. Michigan - Iowa Oregon Nebraska.. Maine Minnesota. Kansas Kentucky.. 16. 17. is. 19. 20. 21 22 23- 24. 25. .$746.48 . 782.72 . 711.99 . 665.90 . 607.41 . 601.08 . 567.06 568 26 . 555 85 . 520.60 . 518.86 . 457.46 19 26. Louisiana. --- 27. v\< Bl Virginia.. 28. Tennessee 29. Virginia 80. Arkansas 81. 8ontl ■ rollna. 82 M issippi --•■ 88. North Carolina. lorida ■ 86. Georgia Uabama I 51 . 24 20 . 1.30 290 FINANCIAL CONDITION OF THE UNITED STATES. o •a a V k cS O « ?» M 50 t- t- (- t- XXJJCOO 88g' s ■d • pa rr cc M :o co i-» SSSSSSSS»8Ss»SSJS»S8SS«oSS« - ,.. ^ ^ ^ ** .2? a tcj^ p. p,a - - r £ , c Jy>_;» J -> < jooaoc.>uooo >>*i ti'i'-^J B. L — CL c. =■ tt C: I- m — 05«x — « « ifs o: « i- SJ i e "S — !-~ ° £ 3°, '00 1-: *i cc s: ,-xSt-T5r-?t-;i.;i!- ©i-55«3 1 S • eo ex « fc- 1- «• » «o,oo»V ;.— j.- ;.— i.-i— i-s.— »— ■— , . ~ -..-...-, " ■ -p' ^/-o orV-^3r^^o"»o -rf :c c c ci U o: ic -r - - * x t i': 't l^oo - o: iSSglSSl fcSS SS.S5 SSS h L- 388 3J8 SS SqS3 gp m t- o 00 1 o m 05 'caa,_r v'BcaafljfPBCic'ocri loooo ;200000ccOOOC*OOt^ laBB« inscsaBossa^BBi 10 . 1 1 /-» r— CO 0:0'* OO mm T-i -.£ 1- co F- as'-'* -«?=-=<* S as ssft* Stags 0ioO3-rt-.S)Q':'3CtT5T!-m ? .-h m so {— m< O m *— CO O C-t 00 t— iB r- C3 1-* O uhTCihu«j<3"Tu;w'.-.' j uwi-7Ji-< s^iss'3'a3Sdg?o!??'^^gg8SSSS'o'fi8sis' trcdw ri aa t-T^o m w £ go G coc^cicsoo i-ffiifiQH om CM *-* &i i-H CO CM C* t-1 C5 CCrl <^ ! g «« « ! c £2 c 1 _; •-2 3 g.2 " r~ c 71 S3 K S.i — *_ a a r* -,5,3w^ ^^^ ij3 - jo a fc- 1 . CO 3 : l| t « ^ » r * « H fi sj £ 2S 2 -^ *- — w .— .^- .— .— a/ w w *j u^ v^ ^_; t. qj +. q ^j ^ ™* .** >- ^^ CHAPTER XVI. WAR DEPARTMENT. Men, unfortunately, have never been able to so arrange their mutual relations as to dispense with violent and deadly contests. Although they are less frequent and shorter now than formerly, they are more costly and more destructive, and every nation is still, as formerly, obliged to anticipate the pos- sibility of war and to make provision for its sudden occurrence, that it may not be borne down and overwhelmed by the first shock. It is an event so probable, even, and especially if the country should be in a defenseless state, that it has become a maxim of prudence with statesmen to avoid war by being pre- pared for it. The nation that can best repel an attack is least likely to be attacked. Most goverments, like our own, had their birth and early history in the confusion and devastation of that great destroyer of life and property; and it is natural that the first leisure of peace should be occupied in preparing themselves, in the most effective manner possible, for both defensive and offensive ope- rations in case of its return. The Constitution contemplates the existence of an army and navy for warlike purposes, and makes the President Command- er-in-chief of both. The first Congress assembled under the Constitution hastened, in its first session, to provide him an army and navy to command by organizing the Department oi War. At its head was placed the Secretary of War, and bo necessary was it deemed to the dignity and security of the nation that he was made one of the principal officers of the government, having a seat in the cabinet and being regarded as one of the advisers of the Chief Magistrate. Se appointed by the President with the consent of the Sen- ate. A Chief Clerk, to be appointed by the Secretary, was (291) 292 WAR DEPARTMENT. provided for by the act of 1789 creating the Department, who was the second authority in it, and acted as Secretary, in case of a vacancy; but when the Civil War raised this Department to great prominence, in 1861, a law was passed authorizing the appointment of an Assistant Secretary, and, in 1863, two addi- tional Assistant Secretaries were provided for by law, all to be appointed by the President. This last measure was temporary only, designed to expire when returning peace should reduce the Department to its ordinary condition. At first the affairs of the national navy were managed by the Secretary of War. This was changed, as we shall see, when our commerce and foreign relations became more important. The Secretary of War ranks next to the President in military authority and dignity, and has the whole oversight, under him, of the army and its affairs. He makes out military commis- sions to be signed by the President, has the care of providing for the support, clothing, pay, and equipment of the army, and of all military stores required to keep the army in efficient drill, and in readiness against a possible war. He has the care of all books, records, and papers relating to the army and to military affairs. The names, grades, time of enlistment, term of service, and time of mustering out of all officers and pri- vates in the army, whether in the regular or volunteer service, are to be found in his office. All military accounts are kept and adjusted under his supervision. These cares and duties have become so numerous and important as to require a careful organization of the Department into sub-departments, or bureaus, as the Commissary's, the Quartermaster's, and the Ordnance bureaus. The general management of the whole depending on the Secretary of War, he evidently requires to be a man of judgment, thoroughly versed in military affairs, and of eminent organizing ability. A Solicitor, to have charge of the legal business of this Department, was provided for by law in 1863, to be appointed by the President and the Senate. AVAR DEPARTMENT. RKCKKTAKIKS OF WAR. Henry Knox, Mass., Sept. 12, 1789. Timothy Pickering, Pa., Jan. 2, 1795. James McIIenry, Md., Jan. 27, 1796. James Marshall, Va., May 7, 1800. Samuel Dexter, Mass., May 13, 1800. Eoger Griswold, Ct., Feb. 3, 1801. Henry Dearborn, Mass., March 5, 1801. William Eustis, Mass., March 7, 1809. John Armstrong, K Y., Jan. 13, 1813. James Monroe, Va., Sept. 27, 1814. William II. Crawford, Ga., March 2, 1815. Isaac Shelby, Ky., March 5, 1817. G. Graham, Va., April 7, 1817. John C. Calhoun, S. C, Oct. 8, 1817. James Barbour, Va., March 7, 1825. Peter B. Porter, K Y., May 26, 1828. J. II. Eaton, Tenn., March 9, 1829. Lewis Cass, Mich., Aug. 1, 1831. Benjamin F. Butler, N. Y., March 3, 1837. Joel R Poinsett, S. C, March 7, 1837. John Bell, Tenn., March 5, 1841. John McLean, 0., Sept. 13, 1841. John C. Spencer, N. Y., Oct. 12, 1841. James M. Porter, Pa., March 8, 1843. William Wilkins, Pa., Feb. 15, 1844. William L. Marcy, K Y., March 5, 1845. George W. Crawford, Ga., March 6, 1849. Charles M. Conrad, La., Aug. 8, 1850. Jefferson Davis, Miss., March 5, 1853. John B. Floyd, Va., March 6, 1857. Joseph Holt, Ky., Dec. 30, 1860. Simon Cameron, Pa., March 5, 1861. Edwin M. Stanton. Pa., Jan. 13, 1S62. Ulysses S. Grant, 111., 1868. - 294 THE UNITED STATES ARMY. J. M. Schofield, 1S68. John A. Kawlins, 111., Mch. 5, '69. Died Sept. 6, '6&. Wm. T. Sherman, Sept. 9, 1869. Win. W. Belknap, Oct. 25, 1869. " « reappointed March 17, 1873. CHAPTER XYII. THE UNITED STATES ARMY. 1. The military successes of the United States would seem to prove undeniably, that, if the nation had adopted a career of conquest as did Ancient Rome, it might have played an important part in the history of warlike peoples. The undis- ciplined militia shut up a strong army in Boston in 1774, and, had not their powder failed, would very likely have forced the British to evacuate that place immediately after the battle of Bunker Hill. 2. Washington's army, made up in large part of militia, seemed always on the point of dissolution, and yet the British, after spending more than a hundred millions in fitting out armies against them, and possessing the important superiority of free movement on the sea, for the transportation of forces easily and rapidly to any desired point, never could gain a per- manent foothold, though opposed only by a ragged, famished, and half disorganized army. 3. The war of 1812 — the Mexican War — and the Civil War, all bear testimony to the excellence of the material for military operations to be found among us. Yet we are a peace loving people. The government has never had more than the skeleton of an army in times of peace. While the Great Powers of Europe keep up armies of half a million of men, our army, very soon after the late gigantic war, was reduced THE MILITAKV A( AD1..MV. to less than 30,000 men; barely enough to keep the [ndiao order, garrison the frontiers slightly, and furnish a nucleus of soldiers and trained offieers in case of a war. By a law of of Congress, it was enacted that every sound and healthy man, with a few exceptions in special cases, between the ages of 18 and 45, should be enrolled and equipped for military duty. Then, by the laws of the States, they arc required on certain days in each year to meet in companies, regiments or brigades, for drill and practice in military exercises. 4. By these means military organizations are kept up in every part of the country, together with some knowledge of the mil- itary art. These, in time of war or domestic insurrection, may be called out with but a few days' notice; and a large army <>t* citizen soldiers can be raised in a very short time. With such facilities for raising men, it is unnecessary to keep a standing army of much magnitude. A few thousand men to guard our fortifications and military posts are sufficient. The late civil war between the South and the North gave ample evidence of this; for when it became necessary to raise a million of men, it was done in a short time, and after a little practice they became good soldiers. CHAPTEK XVIII. THE MILITAKY ACADEMY. 1. The success of military affairs in time of war depends, in great measure, on a thorough knowledge of the BCience oi war, and especially of engineering, so often requiring to be applied with haste and accuracy to the construction obstruc- tion of military defenses. It requires a complete knowlt of certain branches of mathematics, and an understanding oi their Application to warlike purposes. Various other Bpecial 296 THE MILITARY ACADEMY. studies are required to prepare men for prompt and able action in military operations. For the purpose of keeping a corps of officers, well fitted to meet these requirements, ready for possi- ble occasions A MILITARY ACADEMY was established. It is located on the west bank of the Hud- son river, at West Point, in the State of New York, and about 50 miles from the city of New York, and is one of the government institutions. It had its origin in an act of Congress passed as early as 1802. Under this act this far-famed military school was commenced, but on a scale, in every respect, very much inferior to what it has since become. 2. Its name explains its character and objects. It was established and has been continued at a great expense, for the purpose of teaching and training up young men in the science and art of war, that in any emergency the country might have a sufficient number of men, educated and skilled in all such arts and sciences as appertain to war. Hence, mathematics, engineering, gunnery, drawing, natural and experimental phi- losophy and military tactics, are among the principal branches taught. In all of these, able professors give instruction to the cadets, as the pupils are called. Chemistry, geology, and the French language are also taught at this institution. The instruction is thorough, the discipline excellent, and some of the graduates of this celebrated school rank high among the scientific men of the country. 3. Congress controls and regulates this establishment, as it does all other departments, institutions, and works belonging to the government. It enacts all laws relating to its officers, professors, and cadets, and to the management of the insti- tution. 4. By a law passed in 1843, the number of cadets to be admitted was made to correspond with the number of Sena- tors and Representatives from each State. Every State and Territory is entitled to send as many cadets as it has Senators T1IK MILITARY A.CADKMT! 297 and Representatives in Congress. This gives each Territory, however, but one; as a Territory has no Senator.-, and hut one Representative. By the same law the District of Columbia is allowed one. To give every part of the country an equal chance, it was enacted that each Congressional district in each State and Territory should be allowed to send one cadet, to he educated at West Point. These are generally nominated for appointment by the Congressmen from their respective dis- tricts, and the President appoints. The cadet must be an actual resident of the district for which he is appointed. 5. In addition to these, it is provided by the same act, that ten more cadets may be appointed at large; i. e., without regard to Congressional districts. In order to be admitted as a cadet, the candidate must be well versed in reading, writing, and arithmetic; must not be under 14 nor over 21 years of age; and must sign articles, agreeing to serve the United States eight years. After he has finished his studies and has gradua- ted, he is considered as a candidate for a commission in the army, according to the duties he may be competent to perform. 6. The Military Academy may be considered a branch of the "War Department. Men who have been educated there have rendered the country signal service in times of war. have made able commanders, and have proved themselves thoroughly skilled in military science. Not only in the military service has it been a benefit to the country, but in the civil walks of life. Many of its graduates have distinguished themselves Bfl engineers, astronomers, and in other scientific professions and useful employments. 7. There is an annual examination of the cadets, and of the general affairs of the institution, by a committee appointed by the President, for that purpose. It is composed of Congressmen and military officers. It is the duty of these examiners to attend the examination, in-; its discipline, and course of instruction, look after its fiscal affairs, and all other matters relating to the Academy, and report the same to the Secretary of War, for the use of Oongn CHAPTER XIX. DEPOTS OF WAR MATERIAL. We have seen that the government can be sure of the sup- port of the citizens in time of war and that they furnish the best kind of material of that description for military purposes. An army of great effectiveness can be organized in a compara- tively short time, when important interests of the country are at stake. Not so, however, with the arms they require to use for offensive purposes. These require time and skilled work- men to construct them. They are therefore kept in readiness for use in Depots constructed for the purpose. As early as 1794, Congress enacted that three or four arse- nals and magazines, with an armory attached to each, should be established for the safe keeping of military stores. An arse- nal is a place where arms and military stores are kept. An armory is a place where arms are made or repaired. The armories where arms are manufactured are at Springfield, in Massachusetts, and at Harpers' Ferry, in Virginia. But there are many others where they are repaired. ' In 1808, the President was authorized to purchase sites and to erect as many more arsenals and manufactories of arms as he might deem expedient. Each of these establishments was formerly under the direction of a superintendent; but they are now placed under the direction of the Ordnance Department. The office of superintendent of the armories at Springfield and Harpers' Ferry, was also abolished in 1842; and its duties hare since been performed by such officers of the ordnance corps as were designated by the President. In each armory there is employed a master armorer, who superintends the work- men. In addition to those already named there are arsenals and armories at Pittsburgh and Bridesburg, in Pennsylvania; at Washington City; at Watervliet, in New York; Watertown, (298) ARTICLES OF WAR. 299 .Muss.; at Columbus, Ohio; at Indianapolis, in Indiana; and at Rock Island, in Illinois. They are parts of the military estab- lishment of the country, and belong to the War Department CHAPTER XX. ARTICLES OF WAR. 1. An army is designed, in idea, to supply a powerful instrument of offense and defense, that shall so thoroughly organize and fuse together a large number of individuals that the whole shall act as one, and be perfectly under the control of the directing mind. An army fully realizing this idea, would suppress, in its military acts, all thoughts and sentiments of its individuals, and be used by its commanding general as he would use his own hand, arm and foot. It should move at his will, strike where, as long and as heavily as he saw hot, and be to him a perfect machine as to obedience. 2. This idea is seldom more than partially realized; but it is the aim of all military drill, discipline, and law. The Arti- cles of War are the body of laws enacted by Congress defining the relations of soldiers to their officers, so as to secure as fully as possible among a free people this thorough subordination, defin- ing the conduct of the soldier toward his superior, prescribing the duty of the officer, and securing as far as possible in con- nection with such subordination the rights of the soldier. 3. They contain general directions concerning the organi- zation, enlistment, and discharge of men, rules for Leaves of absence, punishment for absence without leave, or for desertion, and other penalties for conduct improper or criminal in a sol- dier. Many of these rules are wry strict and the penalties severe, since a neglect to obey might endanger the safety oi an army or the country, or interfere with the most important operations. War is a very exacting , orsnit. 300 MILITARY HOSPITALS AND ASYLUMS. 4. It is relaxing also in some directions and rules are made requiring, and often without effect, obedience to some of the moBt common principles and practices of morality. It often becomes quite impossible to enforce these amid the fierce excite- ment and wild disorder of active warfare. 5. Offenses committed in the army are not tried before a civil tribunal, but by a military court called a " Court Martial," for the guidance of which a special code of rules is prepared. These are characterized by the brevity, decisiveness, and sum- mary action that is so important to the effectiveness of all mil- itary affairs. The decisions of a court martial may impose all punishments even to condemning a man to death; but they are subject to modification, or commutation, or even may be wholly set aside by the President of the United States, who is Commander-in-Chief of the Army. The Articles of War relate to all things important to the welfare, effectiveness, and safety of an army, and aim to pro- vide for the comfort and protect the rights of the individual as well as circumstances permit. They consist of one hundred and one articles. The first one requires every officer in the army to subscribe to them before he enters on his duties. CHAPTER XXI. MILITARY HOSPITALS AND ASYLUMS. 1. It is plainly a dictate of humanity that a government should provide for the comfort and skillful treatment of those persons who are wounded in its service, or who become diseased wider the hardships of a military life and are disabled from active duty. Our century is specially distinguished by the benevolent care bestowed on the indigent and the suffering, in all civilized countries, and we have reason to expect that the insam: .\svr.cM. United States would take a leading place in this care for her own citizens. 2. This has been done, and all the thoughtful attention that the case called for has been given to hospitals and asylums for the disabled and suffering, both of the Army and Navy, equally in peace and war. 3. In 1851, Congress passed an act for the establishment of military asylums, for the purpose of making the same pro- vision for wounded and disabled soldiers as had already been made for that class of seamen. These institutions are located in different sections of the country where deemed most eligible and convenient for those who need such a place of refuge. They are placed under the government of a board of commis- sioners, consisting of the general in chief, and eight other military officers of high rank, who submit their acts to the Secretary of War for his approval. 4. The officers of these asylums must be taken from the army, and consist of a governor, a deputy governor, and secre- tary, who is also treasurer. The funds for their support are raised by a tax of twenty-five cents per month on the Boldiers, to which are added the fines and penalties adjudged against soldiers by courts martial, with forfeitures for desertion, &c Persons receiving pensions from the government may be admitted into these asylums upon condition that they surren- der their pensions to the use of the institution while they remain in it. The commissioners are authorized to buy sites and buildings for these institutions, and to receive donations of them. They also furnish them with whatever is necessary for the comfort of the inmates, and make such laws and regulations for their government as they deem proper. Deserters, mutineers, and habitual drunkards, are excluded from the benefits of these asylums. INSANE ASYLUM. 5. Among these benevolent institutions provided by a gen- erous government for the support of those who have faithfully NAVY DEPARTMENT. served their country, the insane asylum ought to be noticed. The title of this establishment is " the government hospital for tin- insane." Its objects are the cure and kind treatment of the insane of the army and navy, and of the District of Colum- bia. It is under the control of a board of nine visitors, all of whom must be citizens of the said District. They are appointed by the President, and annually report to the Secretary of the Interior the condition of the asylum and its inmates. They serve without compensation. 6. The superintendent must be a physician. There is a farm attached to the asylum, which is under the direction of the superintendent, who receives patients upon the order of the Secretary of the War, or the Navy, and upon the order of the Secretary of the Interior. He may receive indigent insane persons residing in the District of Columbia. If other than indigent persons are admitted, they must pay for the privilege a sum not less than the cost of their support. 7. The military hospitals in time of war are for temporary purposes, and are established wherever the army happens to be, and especially near where the great battles have been fought, that immediate relief may be given to the sick and wounded. These are established by the commanders of the army, and are under their control. And here let it be recorded to their praise, that since military hospitals were known, never have any been seen which for order, cleanliness and efficiency in administering to the comfort and care of the sick and wounded soldiers, sur- passed those of the United States during the late civil war. CHAPTER XXII. NAVY DEPARTMENT. The position of the United States naturally gives it great prominence as a naval power. Situated between the two great NAVY DBPABTMENT. oceans, with thousands of miles of coast on each, and a pro- fusion of good harbors, bays, and great rivers, accessible to large ocean vessels for long distances into the Interior; with a soil of great fertility, and numerous and inexhaustible Bonr of mineral wealth, besides all the conditions favorable to the establishment and success of manufactures — it requires la foreign markets for its various products, and an extensive com- merce is essential to its development. It should be, and per- haps it is, the strongest naval power in the world. The War of Independence was much increased in length and difficulty by the want of a navy, the maritime resources of England giving her a great superiority in striking suddenly, and in force, at distant points. It was natural, then, that so important an arm, for both attack and defense, should be prepared to act with energy, ami this was one of the first cares of the new government; and so ' efficient did this branch of national strength become in the thirty years of peace, to the war of 1812 with England, that the easiest and some of the most important successes of the Americans, in that conflict, were on the sea. The care of Naval affairs was, at first, committed to the Sec- retary of War. In 1798 it was erected into a separate Depart- ment, and a Secretary placed at its head. He was entitled to a seat in the Cabinet, as one of the advisers of the President, and received his appointment by nomination of the President and concurrence of the Senate, in the same manner as the Heads of other Departments. As the President is the highest officer, in command, in the Navy, he ranks as second, and acts under his direction. It is his duty to procure naval stores and materials, and to ovei the places where they are deposited; to attend to the con -i ruc- tion, equipment, armament, and employment of vessels of war, to make out the commissions of naval officers; to see that efficiency and discipline are maintained in the service; and to assume the control of the movements of the vessels of war that are kept cruising in every sea for the protection of our 304 NAVY DEPARTMENT. commerce and citizens in foreign parts, and the preservation of the international rights and dignity of the United States. 3. A chief clerk was formerly the second officer in rank in the Department, but, in 1861, provision was made, by Con- gress, for an Assistant Secretary, who should act as Secretary in the absence of that officer. Formerly there were five bureaus in this department, but in 1862, three more were added, making eight, as follows: 1. A Bureau of Yards and Docks. 2. A Bureau of Equipment and Recruiting. 3. A Bureau of Navigation. 4. A Bureau of Ordnance. 5. A Bureau of Construction and Repairs. 6. A Bureau of Steam Engineering. 7. A Bureau of Provisions and Clothing. 8. A Bureau of Medicine and Surgery. The President and Senate appoint all the heads of these bureaus, and select them principally from officers of high rank in the navy. They are all appointed for four years. The Secretary appoints all the numerous clerks employed in the various bureaus and assigns their duties. He must annually report to Congress the condition of his department, the manner and amount of all expenditures, fur- nish estimates for the expenses of the following year, and give such advice in regard to the naval interests of the country as his intimate knowledge of that branch of the service may sug- gest. He requires an intimate knowledge of maritime affairs, and of international law, and a high and enlightened apprecia- tion of the policy to be pursued in our official and commercial intercourse with all foreign nations. The following list embraces the names of all the Secretaries of the Navy, from George Cabot, the first, to George M. Robe- son, the present incumbent: George Cabot, Mass., May 3, 1798. Benjamin Stoddert, Mass., May 21, 1798. Robert Smith, Md., July 15, 1801. NAVY DEPARTMENT. 305 J. Crowninshield, Mass., May 3, 1805. Paul Hamilton, S. C, March 7, 1809. William Jones, Pa., Jan. 12, 1813. B. W. Crowninshield, Mass., Dec. 17, 1814. Smith Thompson, N. Y., Nov. 9, 1818. John Rogers, Mass., Sept. 1, 1823. S. L. Southard, N. J., Sept. 16, 1823. John Branch, K C, March 9, 1829. Levi Woodbury, N. EL, May 23, 1831. Mahlon Dickerson, N. J., June 30, 1834. J. K. Paulding, N. Y., June 20, 1830. G. E. Badger, N. C, March 5, 1841. Abel P. Upshur, Va., Sept. 13, 1841. David Henshaw, Mass., July 24, 1843. T. W. Gilmer, Va., Feb. 12, 1844. John Y. Mason, Va., March 14, 1844. George Bancroft, Mass., March 10, 1845. John Y, Mason, Va., Sept. 9, 1846. William B. Preston, Va., March 7, 1849. William A. Graham, K C., July 20, 1850. J. P. Kennedy, Md., July 22, 1850. J. C. Dobbin, N. C, March 5, 1853. Isaac Toucey, Ct., March 6, 1857. Gideon Welles, Ct., March 5, 1861. Adolph E. Borie, Pa., March 5, 1869. George M. Robeson, N. J., June 25, 1869. « « reappointed March 17, 1873. 20 CHAPTER XXIII. THE UNITED STATES NAVY. 1. The original thirteen States were all on the Atlantic coast, and had each one or more sea ports. They were natur- ally given to commerce, and the second Continental Congress, in December, 1775, resolved to form a navy of thirteen vessels of war. Eight were soon fitted out; but the superiority of England on the sea, and the great financial difficulties with whica Congress had to struggle during, and for some years after, the Revolutionary War, made it impossible to give any great degree of development to naval affairs. The sea swarmed with American privateers during the war, and many hundreds of English merchant vessels were captured; but Congress never was able to collect a formidable fleet. The daring exploits of Paul Jones, in European waters, and the bold and suc- cessful raids of Privateersmen under Letters of Marque and Reprisal gave indication of what might be looked for in the future, but they could not cope with British fleets. 2. The Navy Department was for some time under the con- trol of the Secretary of War; but, as the finances began to improve, care was taken to develop this important branch of national power, and a special Secretary appointed. In the war of 1812 with England 25 years of peace had unfitted the people for great immediate success in the army; but the navy was the pride and glory of the nation. The disasters attending mili- tary operations for the first year or two were more than com- pensated by the brilliant and solid advantages gained by our men of war. (306) THE UNITED STATER NAVY. 807 3. This gave a great impulse to the naval tendencies of the nation, and it soon became the settled determination of tho people to supersede England as the strongest naval power. She had been Mistress of the Seas ; there were strong reasons lor our ambition to become Masters, at least in American wat> "We had an extensive line of coast, and our "Monroe Doctrine," that Americans ought to rule America, and that European governments should never be permitted to acquire a preponde- rating influence in North America, rendered a strong navy important. Our people, however, are so largely commercial that skillful mariners are always at command; and the govern- ment has never maintained, in time of peace, a very large naval force. 4. What they can do in time of need was demonstrated during the Civil War, when the navy was increased in two years by more than 400 vessels — many of them very expensive and powerful ; proving in actual conflict the inability of the strongest land fortresses to resist them. The thousands of miles of the Atlantic and Gulf coast blockade, that was ren- dered so effective as to smother the Confederate government, so to speak, destroying its finances by rendering its cotton unavailable, is the best comment on the naval resources of the United States. The extreme boldness and vigor with which the Confederate cruisers that managed to escape the blockade fell on our merchant vessels, and laid waste our commerce, is another point in the argument ; for they were Americans, and demonstrated the natural prowess of Americans on the sea, of which we could well be proud but that it did fatal harm to our mercantile marine. 5. Not half of the vessels belonging to the navy are, how ever, now (in time of peace) in commission — that i>, in active service. The rest are either laid up, or in process of repair. Most of those in commission are employed in what is railed squadron service. The Secretary of the Naw in a late report enumerates seven of these squadron" , ,.z.: tin- European, the Asiastic, the North Atlantic, the oouth Atlantic, the North 308 THE UNTTED STATES NAVT. Pacific, the South Pacific, and the Gulf squadrons. The names given to these squadrons indicate their whereabouts, and their cruising grounds. These squadrons consist of six, eight, ten, twelve or fifteen vessels, as the work to be done may require. It is their duty to visit the seaports of the various countries along the coasts of which they cruise, in order to protect our merchantmen against pirates or enemies of any description, which may molest them or interfere with their rights and priv- ileges; and also to look after the interests and dignity of the United States. 6. The squadrons are under command of a high naval offi- cer of the rank of commodore or rear admiral, whose ship is called the flag ship of the squadron. Many of our naval offi- cers have distinguished themselves for bravery, skill, and patri- otic devotion to their country, and have occupied the highest positions of honor, and the most exalted places in the esteem and affection of their countrymen. In 1862, Congress enacted that there should be nine grades of officers in the navy, and that their corresponding rank with military officers should be as follows : 1. Rear- Admiral with Major- General. 2. Commodores " Brigadier-Generals. 3. Captains " Colonels. 4. Commanders " Lieutenant-Colonels. 5. Lieut.-Commanders. . . " Majors. 6. Lieutenants " Captains. 7. Masters " First- Lieutenants. 8. Ensigns " Second Lieutenants. Midshipmen have no corresponding rank in the army. CHAPTER XXIY. NAVY YARDS. 1. We have seen that the Secretary of the Navy has several different Bureaus, having each its separate part of naval inter- ests and stores to care for. The material for the equipment of the army is, in large part, stored in arsenals and armories ; in the navy in or near Navy Yards. Here are gathered such stores and materials as are required for the construction or repairs of vessels, and hundreds of skilled workmen, constantly employed in rendering the navy effective ; replacing vessels that have become unseaworthy, repairing damages, or building such vessels of special construction as the varying demands of the service may require. 2. These are established at different places along the coast, most convenient for the purpose. There is one at Philadelphia, Pa., at Brooklyn, N. Y., at Portsmouth, Va., at Pensacola, Fla. Here vessels are laid up when not in " commission " or active service, or are sent for repairs, or to obtain their stores before departing to their distant stations. All the officers necessary for keeping all these matters in order are stationed at these yards; and the Navy Department, by these means, preserves the same perfect system of organization and efficiency as wo have seen to characterize other branches of the executive administration. CHAPTER XXV. THE NAVAL ACADEMY. 1. Naval affairs, quite as much as military, perhapa ovon more, require the aids of science, and a careful and thorough (309) 310 THE NAVAL ACADEMY. training. Much of this, indeed, is gained in active service, but for this a basis of scientific study must be laid, and this school of preliminary instruction is called the Naval Academy. As a preliminary even to this, the government has established schools on board of ships, for the instruction of boys in navi- gation and naval warfare. These are called apprentices ; and for good conduct and proficiency in their studies, they are advanced to the Naval Academy, and placed in the line of pro- motion. 2. This school is now established at Annapolis, in the State of Maryland, near Washington. Like the Military Academy, it has its superintendent and professors. The pupils are called midshipmen. They are taught navigation and such other branches of science as are necessary to make them good sea- men and naval officers. They are selected upon nearly the same plan as cadets. Each Congressional District in every State and Territory is entitled to send two students to be educated at the Academy. The District of Columbia is also entitled to send two. Besides which, the President is allowed to appoint ten additional ones at large, and three more from the boys enlisted in the navy. 3. After their graduating examination, if they pass, they are commissioned as ensigns in the navy, and rank according to merit. Before admission, they are examined according to the regulations made by the Secretary of the Navy, and must be between the ages of fourteen and seventeen years, sound, robust, and of good constitution. 4. The course of study in this, as well as in the Military Academy, is adapted to the profession which the students are expected to follow — the one in the navy, the other in the army. Mure are educated at these great national schools than the government needs in time of peace. Many of the graduates are engaged in civil employment. Thus these institutions have been of great service to the country, outside of the army and navy, for they have added to the number of well-educated and scientific men, who may be useful in any of the walks of life. THE NAVAL 0B8EBYAT0BY. :",11 Their graduates elevate the standard of intelligence in the community, especially when they engage in the work of in- struction. Both of these institutions are supported at the expense of tue government. The tuition and board of cadets in one, and of the midshipmen in the other, costs them nothing. CHAPTEE XXYI. THE NAVAL OBSEEVATOEY. 1. An observatory is a building erected for astronomical purposes, and supplied with the necessary apparatus for study- ing the heavens. A thorough knowledge of certain portions of astronomy is indispensable to the commander of a vessel, since it is by means of this alone that he can ascertain his exact position on the open ocean out of sight of land. Nauti- cal Science and Astronomy have advanced hand in hand; and to perfect the former as much as possible the United States Government established the Naval Observatory. This institu- tion is located in "Washington, and was originated by act of Congress in 1842, and put in operation in 1844. 2. This institution owes more to that enlightened and truly patriotic President, John Q. Adams, than to any other man. He recommended it as far back as 1823, and again in his first message to Congress. But political opposition to the man prevented his recommendations from being acted upon till nearly 20 years after they were made. This opposition finally overcome, and we, and posterity after us, will reap the fruits of Mr. Adams' suggestions and labors. 3. The observatory was built and furnished with various astronomical and philosophical instruments, and a corps oi professors were appointed to watch the movements ol the heavenly bodies, and to make such observations and expen- 312 THE COAST SURVEY. ments as would enable them to determine many unsettled questions which relate to the science of navigation; and inci- dentally to another great government work, having especial reference to the same subject; that is, the coast survey. The coast survey has already been of great service to the interests of navigation — whether national or commercial ves- sels are regarded — and, when finished, much greater benefits are to be expected. When a sufficient number of observations and experiments shall have been made at the naval observa- tory, and published to the world, much valuable information will be added to what is already known. And indeed it would be disreptutable to a nation having so large a navy and such a vast number of merchant ships upon the ocean, to do nothing for or add nothing to the science of navigation. It would be an unwise policy if economy only were studied, and we would justly deserve the reproach of being penurious, short-sighted, and miserably wanting in disposition to promote the general good of the world. 4. The professors are assiduous in their labors, and publish the results of their observations and the facts they have deter- mined. These are not only of use to our own seamen, but to those of all nations who are doing business on the great deep. Here the charts made by the coast survey are deposited, and from hence all our national vessels are furnished with them, and with all the nautical instruments they require. The charts, instruments and books relating to astronomy and navigation, found here, make it the headquarters and depot of nautical science in the United States. CHAPTER XXVII. THE COAST SURVEY. 1. While the Naval Observatory is a government institution for studying the heavens in the interest of the Navy; the TRT5 0OAJ3T SUBVKY. . ; | ; ; Coast Survey is an organization employed in a thorough and scientiiic study of the shores of our country for a sufficient distance out from the land to ascertain all the features con- cealed by the water that may have a bearing on the safety of our navy and commerce. One examines the heavens, the other the depths of the waters. They are both of great importance. 2. This government undertaking has not been as vigorously prosecuted as some other enterprises conducted by it. An early as 1807, Congress passed an act authorizing the President to have this work done. Much of it has been done, yet it is not finished at this day. Our acquisition of Florida, Texas, and California has greatly extended our sea coast since the work was commenced, and its accomplishment has cost more time and labor than was anticipated at the beginning, yet we think it ought to have been completed in much less than 60 years. 3. This work, like that relating to light houses, is under the management of a board, consisting of a superintendent, two principal assistants, two naval officers, and four officers of the army. These nine constitute the board. Then there are as many officers of the army and navy employed in the execution of the work as are deemed necessary. And the public vessels, by direction of the President, may be used in order to facilitate the work, for much of it must be done at sea. The survey extends 20 leagues from the shore. The surveyors must make accurate charts of the whole coast, in which are laid down all the islands, shoals, roads or anchorage grounds within twenty leagues of any part of the shore of the United States. The courses or distances between the principal capes or headlands must be laid down, together with the soundings (depths of water) and everything else necessary to make a complete and accurate chart of every part of our coasts. 4. An annual report of this work must be made to Con- gress in December of each year, accompanied with charts, showing the progress of the work, the number of persons employed, the expenses incurred, the amount of work finished, 314 LIGHT HOUSES. and what is unfinished. These reports and charts are carefully preserved, and copies of them may be had at Washington for the use of our naval and merchant ships, to which they are of great service, as guides, whenever they are on or near the coast. This work, in its utility, is not confined to ourselves; but the important information obtained by it is of great use to the navigators of all nations who come into our ports or cruise on our coasts. They derive the same benefits from this work that we derive from theirs of the same kind. It is creditable to any nation to do such things as are beneficial to the world, such acts as contribute to the welfare of humanity. Shipwrecks belong to the list of terrible calamities which often befall those " who go down to the sea in ships, that do business in great waters." Whoever diminishes these is a public benefactor. CHAPTEE XXVIII. LIGHT HOUSES. 1. These, with Buoys, and Beacons, are a necessary practi- cal supplement to the labors of the Coast Survey. . Buoys and Beacons indicate the shoals, or dangerous rocks and reefs beneath the surface of the water, in the daytime; while light houses indicate the same, and show the mariner the bearings of the land, in the night; and, by studying, in connection with these, the charts of the coast supplied by the Coast Survey, he may make his way as securely in the night or day through the concealed dangers of the treacherous waters as a landsman along a beaten highway. They are way-marks along the sea coast, at the entrance of harbors, and on lakes and rivers. They speak a language very well understood by the seaman; and are invaluable for the protection of his vessel from the dangers of the Deep. LIGHT HOUSES. ;;j 2. Keepers are appointed by the government to keep them in repair, and to see that they are properly lighted every night We have no means of knowing the number of these useful establishments, but there must be several hundred of them ; for we have more sea coast than any other nation upon the globe, with a still greater length of lake and river shore. They are located at prominent points, and at dangerous places, all along the extensive lines of coast and shores. 3. To the end that light houses should be constructed and kept in repair, and that competent men might have the whole matter in charge, a law of 1852 authorized the President to appoint two officers of the navy of high rank, one officer of the corps of engineers of the army, one officer of the topo- graphical engineers, and two civilians of high scientific attain- ments, to form a light house boaed for the United States. This board is attached to the Treasury Department, and the Secretary of the Treasury superintends its operations. The board has in charge the building, illumination, and inspection of light houses, light vessels, buoys, beacons, sea marks, and their appendages. 4. The Secretary of the Treasury is president of the board, and may convene them whenever he deems it necessary. The law makes it the duty of the board to divide the whole of the sea, gulf, and lake coasts, into light house districts; not exceeding 12 in number. An officer of the army or navy is assigned to each district, as a light house inspector. They have the control of everything relating to light houses, light ships, buoys, beacons, or other means of directing vessels in and out of port, or of guiding them while sailing along the coast in the night. 5. As foreign vessels receive the same benefits from our light houses as our own, there is nothing unfair or illiberal in requiring them to contribute something towards the expense of maintaining them. For this purpose Congress has imposed a tax, or laid a duty of 50 cents per ton on all foreign vessels entering any ports of the United States. This is called " light 316 LETTERS OF MARQUE AND REPRISAL. money.'' It is collected in the same way as tonnage duties are, i. e., by the collector of the port where the ship arrives. Light money is not required of vessels owned by citizens of the United States, provided that they are regularly registered as the law directs, or have a sea letter. 7. A sea letter is a document or certificate, given by the collector of a port, to the captain of an American vessel, certi- fying that she belongs to a citizen or citizens of the United States. Armed with this, the captain can prove to all whom it may concern, anywhere in the world, the ownership and nationality of his vessel. This is a protection to her and her cargo, especially in times of war. It is one of a ship's papers. CHAPTER XXIX. LETTERS OF MARQUE AND REPRISAL. 1. The somewhat barbarous custom has prevailed among nations, from early times, of making war in every possible way upon the citizens of a hostile country, and of taking or destroy- ing their property, on the principle that injury to the citizens of the power warred against would diminish its power of defense and attack. This has been carried into effect on the sea by authorizing private vessels to be fitted out for warlike purposes and preying on the commerce of the enemy. Such authority is given by Letters of Marque and Reprisal. The Constitution confers on Congress the power to do this ; and Congress authorizes the President to do it. A law was passed in 1863 expressly con- veying it to him. 2. It is a formal commission given to the commander of a private armed vessel, called a privateer, authorizing him to capture the ships and goods of the subjects of a nation with which we are at war. When such letters are issued by the LETTERS OF MARQUE AND REPRISAL. ;, 1 7 United States they are signed by the President and sealed with the great seal. Without such commission, thus signed and sealed, any capture made by the commander of a private vessel would be piracy. If a capture is made, it must be made accord ing to the laws of war, as recognized by civilized nations, and according to the instructions given by the President. Any conduct on the part of a privateer, contrary to these rules, would vitiate his proceedings, and he would not be entitled to the property he had captured. 3. The captured vessel is called a prize, and must be taken into some port of the United States, or into some port of a country in amity with the United States, where legal proceed- ings are taken before some court of competent jurisdiction ; and the capture and all the circumstances of it inquired into; and if all is found to have been done according to the laws of civilized nations, the captured vessel and cargo is condemned as a prize. But if not condemned, the captors lose her. When adjudged to be a lawful prize, the ship and cargo are sold, and the money is divided between the officers and men, according to rank, and according to the laws of Congress on this subject. These laws give the whole to the captors, when the ship taken is of equal or superior force to the ship making the capture ; but if of inferior force, then the United States takes one-half. 4. Privateering, as this business is called, was once consid- ered a lawful and honorable mode of warfare. It was generally practiced between belligerent nations ; but in later days its propriety and morality have been questioned. It is beginning to be looked upon as a kind of robbery not very distantly related to piracy. That it is robbery no one can deny, and, query, " Can it be justified on the ground that the robber and the robbed are the subjects of nations at war with each other!" 5. In Europe an effort has been made to do away with this species of warfare. We hope it will yet succeed, and that all nations will agree to abolish this system of plunder. Innocent parties are generally the sufferers, while but small injury ii done to the power of the hostile nation. CHAPTEE XXX. NAVY AND MAKINE HOSPITALS. 1. These institutions are still more important for sailors than for soldiers; as the sailor is more likely to have lost his adaptation to any kind of business on land, and to lose sight of family relations by reason of his long absences to foreign regions. The government very early took this subject in hand and made ample, and extremely comfortable, provision for dis- abled seamen belonging to its navy. 2. In 1811 an act was passed to establish navy hospitals, for the exclusive use of such seamen as belonged to the navy. This new institution was at first placed under the management of a board of commissioners known as the commissioners of navy hospitals. This commission consisted of the Secretaries of the Navy, Treasury, and War. But in 1832 this was changed, and the Secretary of the Navy was made sole trustee of the navy hospital fund, which was made up of $50,000 appropriated by Congress for that purpose, together with twenty cents per month collected from seamen belonging to the navy, and the fines imposed on navy officers, seamen, and marines. The commissioners were authorized to purchase or erect suitable buildings for navy hospitals. THE MARINE HOSPITALS. 3. These are located near important seaports. At these places seamen depart for, and arrive from their voyages, and are found in the greatest numbers; and here the funds for the support of the marine hospitals are collected, as is the tonnage on ships, viz.: by the collectors of the ports. For this purpose the law authorizes the collectors of customs to demand and receive the sum of twenty cents per month from the wages of every sailor; and every master of a vessel is obliged to render to the collector an accurate account of the number of seamen (318) DEPARTMENT OF TIIE INTERIOR 319 •on board his vessel, and of the time they have been employed by him, since his last entry into any port of the United States. These twenty cents the captain must pay the collector, but he is allowed to deduct it from eacn seaman's wages. In this manner the funds for the building, furnishing, and support of the marine hospitals are raised. The collectors of the ports pay them into the United States Treasury, and the Treasurer disburses them to the directors of the hospitals as they are needed. The directors are appointed by the President. They appropriate the funds, and have the general direction and man- agement of the institutions. 4. These provisions are contained in an act entitled, "An act for the relief of sick and disabled seamen," passed in 1 7i*s. Seamen, whether in the merchant service or in the naval service of the United States, were indiscriminately taxed for the sup- port of these hospitals; and both have the same rights, privi- leges and benefits in them. The money thus collected from seamen is called "hospital money," and the fund is denomi- nated "the marine hospital fund." In 1864 there were 24 marine hospitals in the United States. CHAPTER XXXI. DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR. 1. At the first general census, in 1790, there were but lit- tle over three millions and a half of inhabitants in the United States, and these mostly settled along the Atlantic seaboard; the country was oppressed with debt, and not recovered from the effects of a desolating war. Its public business, therefore, was comparatively small in amount, and was readily manag« d by the three Departments, of State, of the Treasury, and of War. The energy of the people, and the great resources at their command, enabled them to surmount all their difficulties 320 DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR. in a short time, and the country entered on a career of remark- able prosperity. Its public business kept pace with the gen- eral expansion, and new departments were from time to time created, to improve the efficiency of the public service. 2. In 1849 Congress passed a law creating the Department of the Interior, and a Secretary of the Interior, having a seat in the Cabinet, appointed in the same manner, and possessing the same rank, as the other members of the Cabinet, was installed in office. 3. The bureau of the Commissioner of Patents was transferred from the Department of State, and the General Land Office from that of the Treasury. The supervisory power beofore exercised by the Secretary of the Treasury over the accounts of the marshals, clerks, and other officers of all the courts of the United States, was placed in the hands of the new Secretary. The office of the Commissioner of Indian Affairs, heretofore attached to the War Department, was also transferred to this ; and the powers and duties of the Secretary of War, in relation to In- dian affairs, were devolved on the Secretary of the Interior. 4. The Secretaries of War and of the Navy were by the same act relieved of their duties in regard to the Commissioner of Pensions, and those duties were thereafter to be performed by the Secretary of the new department. The Census Bureau, heretofore attached to the State Depart- ment, and the duties of the Secretary of State in relation thereto, were also transferred to this department. To the Secretary was also given the supervisory power over the lead and other mines belonging to the United States, here- tofore executed by the Secretary of the Treasury. The powers of the President over the Commissioners of Public Buildings were also transferred to him. 5. He was also charged with the control over the Board of Inspectors and Warden of the Penitentiary of the District of Columbia. The Secretary of the Interior has the same power in appoint- DKJ'AKIMIAT (»F TIIK IXTKRIOR. 32] ing and removing clerks and other subordinates in his depart- ment, that the Secretaries of the other departments had over these several bureaus before they were transferred to this department. This office has a seal, which must be affixed to the commia- sions of all its subordinate officers. The President and Senate appoint the Assistant Secretaries. From the foregoing it is easy to understand what branches of the public service are conducted in this office, and what are the duties of its Secretary. 6. The following is a list of all who have filled the office of Secretary of the Interior since the establishment of the department : Thomas H. Ewing, Ohio, March 7, 1849. T. M. T. MeKennan, Pa., 1850. Alexander H. H. Stuart, Ya., Sept. 12, 1850. Robert McClelland, Mich., March 5, 1853. Jacob Thompson, Miss., March 6, 1857. Caleb B. Smith, Ind., March 5, 1861. John P. Usher, Ind., Jan. 7, 1863. James Harlan, Iowa, 1865. Orville H. Browning, 111., 1866. Jacob I). Cox, Ohio, March 5, 1869. Columbus Delano, Ohio, Nov. 1 , 1870. " " reappointed March 17, 1873. 21 CHAPTER XXXII. PUBLIC LANDS. 1. All the laud in the United States, to which individuals or corporations have not acquired a legal title, is held by the general government. This includes the land, or the part of it not under special reservation, belonging to the Indians. As the settlements push on into the territory roamed over by the thinly scattered Indian tribes, an equitable arrangement is made with them, by which certain Eeservations, large enough for their purposes are set aside for their occupation; and an indemnity, commonly in the form of an annuity, is made them for the lands to which they renounce their right. As they are gradually melting away, their lands will soon become all, or nearly all, the property of the government. 2. The lands free for settlement are sold under certain reg- ulations; and given to certain classes — to soldiers, to actual settlers for Homesteads, to corporations to aid in promoting the public welfare — as Railroads and Colleges — and to support edu- cation in various ways; and the remainder held until required for use in the expansion of the country. Nearly 200,000,000 acres have been given to assist in build- ing railroads through unsettled parts of the country. A large part of this, however, has been only conditionally given, and not yet appropriated by the corporations. Many millions more have been given to the Slat.- a- a fund in aid of public schools and collegiate institutions -- and one thirty-sixth part is reserved, in every new township surveyed, for the benefit of public schools in that township. The rest is sold, at very low rates, to any who will buy. (822) PUBLIC LANDS. ;; •■;; 3. To manage this property a bureau was established by act of Congress, in 1812, called The General Lund ( >ffioe. H was under the oversight of the Secretary of th«' Treasury until 1849, when the Department of the Interior was established, to which it was then transferred. Its head is culled COMMISSIONER OF THE GENERAL LAND OFFICE. 4. He is appointed by the President and Senate, must take the usuul official oath before entering on his duties, and must give the usuul officiul bond. He keeps the seul of his oilier, and fixes an impression of it upon ull papers emanating from the Lund Office. He, with his clerks and assistant-, forms the bureuu, keeps all the records and pupers pertaining to tin- public lands, and performs all duties reluting thereto. lit: receives reports from surveyors and from the district land officers, gives them their instructions, and reports to the Presi dent und to Congress when required to do so. He issues ull patents for lands grunted by the United Stab -, and sends and receives by mail all papers and document.- relat- ing to his official business, at public expense. Every patent for land is issued in the name of the United States, is signed by the President und by the Commissioner of the Lund Office, and is then recorded in books kept for that purpose. SURVEYORS GENERAL AND DEPUTY SURVEYORS. 5. When it is deemed necessary and expedient to bring the lands in any particular State or section of the country into market, a surveyor general is appointed for that State or e tion, and ulso a sufficient number of deputy or assistant sur- veyors to perform the work; which is done under the direction of the surveyor general, who is himself directed by law as t.» the manner of procedure, lie is appointed for four year-. taking the usuul outh, and gives bonds for the faithful perform- ance of his duties. MODE OF SURVEYING THE PUBLIC LANDS. 6. The law directs how the lands shall be surveyed and mapped. Where it is practicable, they are laid out into ..-{ PUBLIC LANDS. square miles, each of which contains 640 acres, and is called a ■Hon. These sections are then sub-divided into halves, quarters, and eighths of sections; that is, into lots of 320, 160, and 80 acres. The boundary lines are all run north and south, and east and west. Thirty-six of these sections, which make a plat of six miles square, are put into a township. These townships are designated by numbers, but when inhabited are named by the inhabitants as their fancy dictates. v SALE OF THE PUBLIC LANDS. 7. After the lands have been surveyed and properly mapped into townships and sections, they are brought into market and offered for sale in such quantities as are wanted by the pur- chaser; from 40 acres, one-sixteenth of a section, up to a whole section; or as many sections as the buyer pleases to take. DISTKICT LAND OFFICES. 8. District land offices for the sale of lands are established for this purpose at as many places in the State or Territory where the lands are situated, as is deemed necessary for the convenience of purchasers. Here are kept maps of all the lands lying in the district, and buyers may make their selec- tions both of quantity and location as suits them. Here they will find A REGISTER OF THE LAND OFFICE AND A RECEIVER OF PUBLIC MONEY FOR LANDS. 9. The first named officer will register the application made for land in a book kept for that purpose, and the second will receive the money paid for it. These officers are appointed by the President and Senate, and report their proceedings to the General Land ( )mce at Washington. The receiver trans- mits all moneys received by him to the United States Treasury once in a month or once in three months, as directed. SCHOOL LANDS. 10. As before stated, the public lands are surveyed into PUBIIC LANDS. sections of one mile square, and thirty-six of these sections make a township. F<>r the purpose of encouraging education, Congress has enacted that section number 16, in every town- ship, shall not be sold, but reserved for the township, to be applied to the support of common schools in that town. l',\ this measure the government appropriated one thirty-sixth part of its lands to aid the work of educating the children in the new States. And in addition to this it has made other munificent donations of land for the establishment and support of colleges and other institutions of learning. 11. In addition to all this the United States have donated large tracts of land to the several States in which it lay, to aid them in building their State houses, &c. Large quantities of land have also been given to aid the construction of railroads. HOMESTEADS. 12. The government has always sold its lands at a very low price, preferring to give the people cheap farms, rather than to raise more revenue from this source. But in 1862, Congress passed an act called " the Homestead Law," the object of which was to cheapen the public lands to a mere nominal price to heads of families, male or female, or to persons 21 years of age or over, or to persons who had served in the army or navy of the United States, whether .21 years old or not. By the provisions of this act such per.- mis are allowed, for the trifling sum of ten dollars, to enter upon and claim 160 acres of land, provided the claimant swears that the land is applied for his or her own use, and tor settlement and cultivation. But no patent (deed) is to be given until the applicant has actually settled upon and cultivated the land for the space of five years. Such applicant must also make affida- vit that he has never borne arms against the United States. By this liberal policy, persons of very limited means may provide themselves with comfortable homo for life; and the unoccupied lands will be settled and occupied faster than it the old price of one dollar and twenty-live cents per acre had ;;^() PUBLIC LANDS. n demanded. The revenue from the sale of lands will of course be less, but the wealth of the country will undoubtedly be increased by the measure. 13. Exceedingly rich and valuable mines of gold, silver, copper, lead and other minerals have been found upon the pub- lic lands. That the benefits of mining them might be extended to the many, instead of being monopolized by a few, a different rule for selling them has been made. After they have been surveyed, mapped and described, they, like other lands, are offered for sale, but in quantities of not more than 40 acres. These are generally sold at auction, but no bid less than five dollars per acre will be received. If not sold at public sale, they are then subject to private sale at that price. CHAPTER XXXIII. HOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LANDS. TnERE are two classes of public lands subject to entry; one at $1.25 per acre, known as minimum, and one at $2.50, known as double minimum, the latter being the alternate sections along the lines of railroads. Title may be acquired by pur- chase at public sale, or by "private entry," and in virtue of the Pre-emption and Homestead Laws. At Public Sale. — Lands are offered at auction to the high- est bidder, pursuant to proclamation or public notice. Private Entry. — Lands subject to private entry, are those which have been once offered at public sale without finding purchasers. In order to acquire title to these lands, a written application must be made to the Land Register of the District in which the land is located, describing the tract desired. The Register certifies the fact to the Receiver, stating price, and the applicant then pays the money and takes a receipt, and at the nOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LANDS. 327 close of the month, the Register and Receiver make return of the sale to the General Land Office, when a patent or full till'' issues on due surrender of the receipt, and will be delivered at the option of the purchaser, at the General Land Office in Washington, or by the Register at the District Land Office. Land Warrants. — "When lands are to be located with land warrants, application must be made as in cash cases, accompa- nied by an assigned warrant. When the tract is $2.50 per acre, $1.25 per acre must be paid in addition to the warrant. Receipts are given and patents delivered, as in the preceding case. At the time of location, a fee of 50 cents for a 40 acre warrant, and a corresponding amount for larger ones, must be paid to the Register, and a like sum to the Receiver. Agricultural College Scrip. — This may be used in the loca- tion of lands at private entry, but is only applicable to lands subject to entry at $1.25 per acre, and is restricted to a techni- cal " quarter section," and to three sections in each township of land. The proceeding to acquire title is the same as in cash and warrant cases, the fees being the same as on warrants. This scrip may be used in payment of pre-emption claims. Pre-emption. — Any person being the head of a family, or widow, or single man over 21 years of age, and a citizen of the United States, or a person who has filed his declaration to become such, by settling upon and improving any of the "offered," "unoffered," or unsurveyed lands of the United States, may obtain a pre-emption right to purchase 1G0 acres so occupied, at the regular government price, whether it be $1.25 or $2.50 per acre. Where the tract is "offered" land. the settler must file with the District Land Office his state merit as to the fact of settlement, within thirty days thereafter, and within one year must make proof to the Land Office, of his actual residence and cultivation, and secure the land l»jv payment in cash or Land Warrant. Where the land has been surveyed and not offered at public sale, the statement must be filed within-three months after settlement, and payment made within 21 months. Where settlement is made upon un.-ur- HOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LANDS. veyed lands, the settler is required to file a statement within three months after the survey, and pay within eighteen mouths thereafter. No person is entitled to more than one pre-emption right. Tlie Homestead Privilege. — The Homestead laws give to every citizen the right to a Homestead of 160 acres minimum, or eighty acres double minimum. To obtain Homestead, applicant must swear that he is the head of a family, or over the age of twenty-one, a citizen, or has declared his intention to become such; and that the entry is for his exclusive use and benefit, and for actual settlement and cultivation. When an applicant has made actual settlement upon the land he desires, he must make affidavit of the fact before the Land Register, and pay fees amounting, on 160 acres of minimum land, to $18, or an equal sum for eighty acres of double minimum, for which he gets a receipt; and after five years' occupation and cultiva- tion of the land, he is entitled upon proof of such cultivation to a patent or full title to the Homestead. Any loyal person in the naval or military service of the United States, may acquire a Homestead by reason of his family occupying land and making the application in his stead. All officers, soldiers, and sailors who have served in the army or navy for ninety days and remained loyal, may enter 160 instead of 80 acres of double minimum lands. The fees above for entering Home- stead apply to surveyed lands in Michigan, Wisconsin, Iowa, Missouri, Minnesota. Kansas, Nebraska, Dakota, Alabama, Mississippi, Louisiana, Arkansas, Florida, Ohio, Indiana, and Illinois. In California, Nevada, Oregon, Colorado, New Mex- ico, Washington Territory, Arizona, Idaho, Utah, Wyoming, and Montana, the fees are $22 instead of $18. A settler hav- ing filed a pre-emption declaration, may change his filing into Bomestead, and receive the benefit of the Homestead laws. If a Homestead settler does not wish to remain five years on his land before obtaining title, he may pay for it in cash or Land Warrants. Lands obtained under the Homestead laws are How TO SECURE PUBLIC LAUDS. 329 exempt from liability for debts contracted prior to the issuing of the patent. United States Land Offices are located at Fort Des Moines, Council Bluffs, Fort Dodge and Sioux City, Iowa; Menasha, Falls of St. Croix, Stevens' Point, La Crosse, Bayfield and Eau Claire, Wisconsin; San Francisco, Marysville, Humboldt, Stockton, Visalia, Sacramento, and Los Angeles, California; West Point, Beatrice, Lincoln, Dakota City, and Grand Island, Nebraska; Taylor's Falls, St. Cloud, Du Luth, Alexandria, Jackson, New Ulm, and Litchfield, Minnesota; Oregon City, Eoseburg, and Le Grand, Oregon; Topeka, Junction City, Humboldt, and Augusta, Kansas; Carson City, Austin, Bel- mont, and Aurora, Nevada; Vermilion, Springfield, and Pern bina, Dakota; Denver City, Fair Play, and Central City, Colorado; Boonville, Ironton, and Springfield, Missouri ; Mobile, Huntsville, and Montgomery, Alabama; New Orleans, Monroe, Natchiloches, Louisiana; Detroit, East Saginaw, Iona, Mar- quette, and Traverse City, Michigan; Little Rock, Washington, and Clarksville, Arkansas; Boise City, and Lewiston, Idaho; Chillicothe, Ohio; Indianapolis, Indiana; Springfield, Illinois; Jackson, Mississippi; Tallahassee, Florida; Olympia, and Van- couver, Washington Territory; Helena, Montana; Prescott, Arizona; Salt Lake City, Utah. FRE-EMFflON LAWS. A pre-emption right is the right of a squatter upon the lands of the United States to purchase, in preference to others, when the land is sold. Such right is granted to the following persons: Any citizen of the United States; any person who has filed his declaration of intention to become a citizen; any head of a family; any widow; any single woman of the aire of twenty-one years or over; and any person who has made a set- tlement, erected a dwelling-house upon, and is an inhabitant of the tract sought to be entered — -provided such settlement was made since June 1, 1840, and previously to the time of application for the land, which land must, at the date of the 330 HOW TO SECUBK PUBLIC LANDS. settlement, have had the Indian title extinguished, and been surveyed by the United States. A person bringing himself within the above requirements by proof satisfactory to the Register and Receiver of the land district in which the land may lie, taken pursuant to the rules hereafter prescribed, will, after having taken the affidavit required by the Act, be entitled to enter, by legal subdivisions, any number of acres, not exceeding one hundred and sixty, or a quarter-section, to include his residence; and he may avail himself of the same at any time prior to the day of the com- mencement of the public sale, including said tract, where the land has not yet been proclaimed. Where the land was subject to private entry, June 1, 1840, and a settlement shall thereafter be made upon such land, or where the land shall become hereafter subject to private entry, and after that period a settlement shall be made, which the settler is desirous of securing, notice of such intention must be given within thirty days after such settlement; and, in all such cases, the proof, affidavit and payment must be made within twelve months after such settlement. The tracts liable to entry are embraced under the following designations: First, a regular quarter-section, notwithstanding the quantity may vary a few acres from one hnndred and sixty; or a quarter-section, which, though fractional in quantity by the passage of a navigable stream through the same, is still bounded by regular sectional and quarter-sectional lines ; second, a fractional section containing not over one hundred and sixty acres, or any tract being a detached or anomalous survey made pursuant to law, and not exceeding such quantity; third, two adjoining half-quarter-sections (in all cases to be separated by a north and south line, except on the north side of township, where the surveys are so made as to throw the excess or defi- ciency on the north and west sides of the township), of the regular quarters mentioned in the first designation ; fourth^ two half-quarter or eighty-acre subdivisions of a fractional or broken section, adjoining each other, the aggregate quantity HOW TO SICiKi: PUBLIC LANDS. 331 not exceeding one hundred and sixty acres ; fifth, a regular half-quarter and an adjoining fractional section, or an adjoin- ing half-quarter subdivision of a fractional section, the aggre- gate quantity not exceeding one hundred and sixty acres; sixth, if the pre-emptor do not wish to enter one hundred and Bixty acres, he may enter a single half-quarter section (made l>\ .1 north and south line), or an eighty-acre subdivision of a frac- tional section ; seventh, one or more adjoining forty-acre lots may be entered, the aggregate not exceeding one hundred ;md sixty acres ; and, eighth, a regular half-quarter, a half-quarter subdivision, or a fractional section, may each be taken, with one or more forty-acre subdivisions lying adjoining, the aggre- gate not exceeding one hundred and sixty acres. Forty-acre tracts, or quarter quarter-sections, may be entered in the Mime manner that eighty-acre, or half-quarter sections, have been. Only one person upon a quarter-section is protected, and he the one who made the first settlement, provided he conform to the other provisions of the law. A person who has once availed himself of the provisions of the Pre-emption Act, cannot, at any future period, or at any other land office, acquire any other right under it. No person, who is the proprietor of three hundred and twenty acres of land in any State or Territory of the United States, or who quits or abandons his residence on his own land to reside on the public land in the same State or Territory, is entitled to the benefit of the Pre-emption Acts. The approval of the tracts by the local land office is the e\ i- dence of the survey; but the land is to be construed as surveyed when the requisite lines are run on the field, and the corners established by the deputy surveyor. No assignment or trans- fers of pre-emption rights are recognized at the land office; the patents issuing to the claimants, in whose names alone the entries are made. The following description of lands are not liable to entry : f/rsb, hinds included in any reservation by any treaty, law, OT proclamation of the President of the United State-, and lands reserved for salines and for other purposes; second, lands 332 HOW TO SKCTRK PUBLIC LANDS. reserved for the support of schools ; third, lands acquired by either of the last two treaties with the Miami Indians in Indi- ana, or which may be acquired of the "Wyandot Indians in Ohio, or any other Indian reservation, to which the title has been, or may be extinguished at any time during the operation of the Pre-emption Acts, by the United States ; fourth, sections of lands reserved to the United States, alternate to other sections granted to any State for the construction of any canal, railroad, or other public improvement ; fifth, sections, or fractions of sections, included within the limits of any incorporated town; sixth, every portion of the public lands which has been selected as a site for a city or town; seventh, every parcel or lot of land actually settled and occupied for the purposes of trade and agriculture; and, eighth, all lands in which are situated any known salines or mines. Persons claiming the benefit of the Pre-emption Acts are required to file duplicate affidavits, such as are specified by law, and to furnish proof, by one or more disinterested witnesses, of the facts necessary to establish the requisites mentioned in the first paragraph of this article ; such witnesses having first been duly sworn or affirmed by some competent authority. If adverse claims are made to the same tract, each claimant is to be notified of the time and place of taking testimony, and allowed to cross-examine the opposite witnesses, and to furnish counter-proof, itself subject to cross-examination. If, by reason of distance, sickness, or infirmity, the witnesses cannot person- ally appear before the register of the land office, their deposi- tions, taken in conformity with the following regulations, may be received: The notice to adverse claimants must be in writing, and served in time to allow at least one day for every twenty miles which the party may have to travel in going to the place of taking evidence. The proof, in all cases, should consist of a simple detail of facts merely, and not of broad and general statements. If the pre-emptor be " the head of a family," the witnesses must state the facts constituting him such ; whether HOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LAND& he be a husband having a wife and children, or a widower, >>r an unmarried person under twenty-one years of age, having a family, either of relatives or others, dependent upon him, <>r hired persons. All the tacts relative to the settlement in per- son, inhabitancy, or personal residence, the time of its com- mencement, the manner and extent of its continuance, as also those sharing the apparent objects, must be Btated. It must he stated that the claimant made the settlement on the land in person ; that he has erected a dwelling upon the land ; that he lived in the same, and made it his home, etc. In the event of a decision by the land officer against the claimant, he may appeal to the Commissioner of the Land Office at Washington. No entry will be permitted until the affidavit required of the claimant fa taken. Duplicates thereof must be signed by the claimant, and the fact of the oath being taken must be certified by the register or receiver administering the same; one copy to he filed in the Register's office, and the other to be sent to the Land Office at Washington. A purchaser of public land is only required to make written application to the Register of the local land office for the tract desired to be entered, and to pay to the Receiver the purchase money therefor. Blank forms of such application are furnished gratuitously at the Land Office where the tract is desired to be entered. Soldiers' Homestead Law of 1872. The following is the full text of the Amendatory Soldiers' Homestead Bill, approved by the President on the 3d of April, 1872. Be it enacted by the Senate and House of I?> />/■< *, ndifives of the United States of America in Congress assembled: That every private soldier and officer who has served in the army of the United States during the recent rebellion for nil] days or more, and who was honorably discharged, and lias remained loyal to the government, including the troops mus- tered into the service of the United States by virtue o( the 16 334: HOW TO SECURE PUBLIC LANDS. third section of an act entitled "An act making appropriations for completing the defenses of Washington, and for other pur- poses," approved February 13th, 1862, and every seaman, marine, and officer who has served in the navy of the United States or in the marine corps, during the rebellion, for ninety days, and who was honorably discharged, and has remained loyal to the government, shall, on compliance with the pro- visions of an act entitled "An act to secure homesteads to actual settlers on the public domain, and the acts amendatory thereof, as hereinafter modified, be entitled to enter upon and receive patents for a quantity of public lands (not mineral) not exceeding one hundred and sixty acres, or one quarter-section, to be taken in compact form according to legal subdivision, including the alternate reserved section of public lands along the line of any railroad or other public work not otherwise reserved or appropriated, and other lands subject to entry under the homestead laws of the United States : Provided, the said homestead settler shall be allowed six months after locating iiis homestead within which to commence his settlement and improvements: And provided also, the time which the home- stead settler shall have served in the army, navy, or marine corps aforesaid shall be deducted from the time heretofore required to perfect title, or if discharged on account of wounds received, or disability incurred in the line of duty, then the term of enlistment shall be deducted from the time heretofore required to perfect title, without reference to the length of time he may have served : Provided, however, that no patent shall issue to any homestead settler who has not resided upon, improved and cultivated his said homestead for a period of at least one year after he shall commence his improvements as aforesaid. Section 2. That any person entitled under the provisions of the foregoing section to enter a homestead, who may have heretofore entered under the Homestead law a quantity of land less than one hundred and sixty acres, shall be permitted to enter under the provisions of this act so much land as, when HOW TO 8KCDKK PUBLK LANDS. added to the quantity previously entered, shall qoI exceed one hundred and sixty acres. Section 3. That in the case of the death oi' any person who would be entitled to a homestead under the provisions of the first section of this act, his widow, if unmarried, or in case of her death or marriage, then his minor orphan children, 1 guardian duly approved and officially accredited at the 1 depart- ment of the Interior, shall be entitled to all the benefits enu- merated in this act, subject to all the provisions as to settle nient and improvements therein contained : Provided, that if such person died during his term of enlistment, the whole term of his enlistment shall be deducted from the time heretofore required to perfect the title. Section 4. That where a party, at the date of his entry of a tract of land under the Homestead laws, or subsequently thereto, was actually enlisted and employed in the army or navy of the United States, his services therein shall, in the administration of said Homestead laws, be construed to be equivalent, to all intents and purposes, to a residence for the same length of time upon the tract so entered : Provided, that if his entry has been canceled by reason of his absence from said tract while in the military or naval service of the United States, and such tract has not been disposed of, his entry shall be restored and con- firmed : And provided further, that if such tract lias been disposed of, said party may enter another tract subject to the entry under said laws, and his right to a patent therefor shall be determined by the proofs touching his residence and culti- vation of the first tract and his absence therefrom in such service. Section 5. That any soldier, sailor, marine, officer, or other person coming within the provisions of this act may, as well by an agent as in person, enter upon said homestead : P vided, that the said claimant in person shall, within the time prescribed [six months from date of bntrt] commence settle- ment and improvement on the same, and thereafter fulfill all the requirements of this act. PATENTS. Section 6. That the commissioner of the General Land Office shall have authority to make all needful rules and regu- lations to carry into effect the provisions of this act." CHAPTER XXXIV. PATENTS. 1. These originated in the desire of the founders of the government to encourage invention, in the belief that the gen- eral welfare of the country would be promoted by such a stim- ulus to genius, and the power to grant patents was expressly bestowed on Congress. That this was a very wise fore- thought there is no doubt. The hope of reward has given birth to innumerable inventions, among which some have been of incalculable value to the country, increasing its wealth almost beyond our power to estimate. It is, however, worth considering if there may not be a limit to the usefulness of the system, in its present form, in the changed conditions of the country. It is often the case that what accomplished the greatest good in its proper day, is at length outgrown, and becomes an embarrassment, requiring to be either essentially modified or laid aside. 2. A patent right is an exclusive right, granted by an officer denominated the Commissioner of Patents, in conformity to law, to the inventor or discoverer of any new and useful article. The exclusive right is conferred by acts of Congress, on com- pliance of the inventor with certain conditions which are clearly specified in the law. The evidence that such exclusive right has been conferred on any individual, is contained in a document, called " letters patent," issued at the patent office in Washington; signed by the Secretary of the Interior, (for- merly by the Secretary of State), countersigned by the Com- PATENT8. 337 missioner of Patents, and sealed with the sen! of hie office. Thus protected, he alone can make, use and sell the article he has invented, for the term of fourteen years; and upon show- ing a good reason therefor, the commissioner will extend the term seven years longer, or Congress will pass a special act for that purpose. 3. This was the law up to 1861; and is still in force as to patents granted anterior to that date. But a new act was then passed, extending the term of an original patent to seventeen, instead of fourteen years, and prohibiting any extension of such patents. An inventor, before he can obtain a patent, must swear that he believes he is the inventor or discoverer of the art, machine. or improvement, for which he solicits a patent. He nni.-t ;i\-> give in writing a clear, minute description of it; and, when necessary, must make and deliver a model of his invention; which in all cases must be something new, unused and unknown before, or his application will be rejected. There is considera- ble expense attending the procurement of a patent right. 4. But when obtained, no person except the patentee, has any right to make, sell, or use the article patented, until the time has expired for which this exclusive right was granted, without the permission of the patentee. Any person doing 80 is liable to a heavy penalty, and may be prosecuted in the Cir- cuit Court of the United States; this court having original jurisdiction in all cases arising under the patent laws. But a writ of error or an appeal lies to the Supreme Court of the United States. 5. The Patent Office, when first established, was a bureau of the State Department, and the Commissioner of Patents acted under the direction of the Secretary of State Hut after the creation of the Department of the [nterior, in I s !!'. it transferred to it, became a bureau of the new department, and the commissioner now acts under the general direction ol it.- eecretary. 22 338 PATENTS. THE COMMISSIONER OF PATENTS 6. Is appointed by the President and Senate. His duties are best explained in the language of the law itself, which, in speaking of the creation and appointment of this official, says that his duties shall be " to superintend, execute and perform all such acts and things touching and respecting the granting and issuing of patents for new and useful discoveries, inven- tions and improvements, as are herein provided for, or shall hereafter be by law directed to be done and performed." He has the charge and custody of all books, records, papers, models, machines, and all other things belonging to the patent office; and has the privilege of sending and receiving letters and packages by mail, relating to the business of the office, free of postage. He has the power to appoint his clerks, examin- ers and subordinates; among whom are patent office agents, who may be appointed in not more than twenty of the princi- pal cities and towns in the United States. It is their duty to forward to the patent office all such models, specimens and manufactures, as shall be intended to be patented. 1. In cases of appeal from the decision of the commis- sioner, the appeal may be made to the board of examiners, or co the Chief Justice of the District Court of the United States for the District of Columbia. There is a seal for the patent office, which the commissioner keeps, and which he must affix co patents when granted, and to other papers and records issued from his office, which are wanted as evidence in other places. He is also authorized to publish a classified and alphabetical list of all patents issued at the patent office. This he fre- quently does, for the information of the public. CHAPTER XXXY. PENSIONS. Pensions are a provision, made by the general government, for the officers and privates of the army and navy disabled in the service of the country. They peril their lives for the pro- tection of the public, and it has always been regarded as just that a support, proportioned to the extent of injury received, should be given to them, or to those dependent on them in case of their death. It is properly a continuance of pay in consideration of the services rendered. It does not often amount to a full support, and is graduated by the amount each received, according to rank. A COMMISSIONER OF PENSIONS Was appointed and placed at the head of a bureau, at first in the War Department, but afterward transferred to the care of the Secretary of the Interior. It is a Pension Office, in fast. This commissioner is appointed by the President and Senate in the same manner as other important officers. It is his duty to carry into effect the pension laws. He is authorized to appoint pension agents in all the States and Territories, who receive and distribute the money due to pensioners in their several districts, the agents receiving from the government a percentage for their services. There has always been a large number on the list. At first they were the disabled soldiers and sailors of the Revolutionary War; then of the War of 1812 with England, followed in 1846 by the Mexican War. But all these were few comp with the number disabled in the Civil War. The amount (339) 340 PENSIONS. appropriated by Congress for the year 1873-4, for pensions was $30,4SO,000. The law carefully protects the pensions against frauds and forbids its attachment by any legal process what- ever. The nation is grateful to its brave defenders. The proper officials to whom all applications should be made, by letter or petition, in Washington, are, by a soldier having his discharge, to the Paymaster General; when the discharge paper is lost, to the Second Auditor of the Treasury; when by those who represent a deceased person, to the second Auditor of the Treasury; when for commutation of rations, to the same officer; when for pensions, or any matter connected with pen- sions, to the Commissioner of Pensions. Instructions have been prepared for all applicants, by the Commissioner of Pensions for the purpose of preventing fraud or misunderstanding. They are, in substance: INSTRUCTIONS. By the act of Congress approved July 14th, 1862, and amen- datory acts, pensions are granted as follows: 1. Invalids, disabled in the military or naval service of the United States, in the line of duty. 2. "Widows of persons who have been killed or have died in the military or naval service of the United States. 3. Children under sixteen, of the classes of persons on account of whose death widows are entitled; provided said widows have died, or have remarried. 4. Mothers of all classes of persons on account of whose death widows are entitled, provided said mothers were depend- ent on the deceased for support and no minor child survived. 5. Fathers, the same as mothers, in case of the death of the latter. 0. Brothers and sisters, under sixteen, provided they were dependent for support upon the person on account of whose decease they claim. The First Section of the Act of July 14th, 1862, showing the rates of pension to the several classes and grades, is as follows: pensions. : : i ] Be it enacted by the Senate and House of RepresentatWi s •of the United States of America, in Congress assembled, That if any officer, non-commissioned officer, musician, or private of the army, including regulars, volunteers, militia, <>r anj officer, warrant, or petty officer, musician, seaman, ordinary seaman, flotillaman, marine, clerk, landsman, pilot, or other person in the navy or marine corps, has been, since the fourth day of March, eighteen hundred and sixty-one, or shall here- after he, disabled by reason of any wound received or disease contracted while in the service of the United States, and in the line of duty, he shall, upon making due proof of the fact according to such forms and regulations as are or may be pro- vided by, or in pursuance of law, be placed upon the list of invalid pensions of the United States, and be entitled to receive, for the highest rate of disability, such pension as is hereinafter provided in such cases, and for an inferior disability an amount proportionate to the highest disability, to commence as here- inafter provided, and continue during the existence of such disability. The pension for a total disability for officers, non- commissioned officers, musicians and privates employed in the military service of the United States, whether regulars, volun- teers, or militia, and in the marine corps, shall be as follows, viz.: lieutenant-colonel and all officers of a higher rank, thirty dollars per month; major, twenty-five dollars per month; (Sap- tain, twenty dollars per month; first lieutenant, seventeen dol- lars per month; second lieutenant, fifteen dollars per month; and non-commissioned officers, musicians and privates, eight dollars per month. The pension for total disability for officers, warrant or petty officers, and others employed in the naval vice of the United States, shall be as follows, viz.: captain, commander, surgeon, paymaster, and chief engineer, res] ively, ranking with commander by law, lieutenant command- ing, and master commanding, thirty dollars per month; lieutenant, surgeon, paymaster, and chief engineer, res] ively, ranking with lieutenant by law, and passed assistant surgeon, twenty -five dollars per month: professor of mathe 342 PENSIONS. matics, master, assistant surgeon, assistant paymaster, and chaplain, twenty dollars per month; first assistant engineer and pilots, fifteen dollars per month; passed midshipman, midship- man, captain's, and paymaster's clerk, second and third assistant Sjineere, master's mate, and all warrant officers, ten dollars per month; all petty officers, and all other persons before named employed in the naval service, eight dollars per month; and all commissioned officers, of either service, shall receive 6iich and only such pension as is herein provided for the rank in which they hold commissions. Act of July 4, 1864. Various supplementary Acts have been passed by the Act of July 14, 1862, modifying in some particulars the provisions of previous legislation. By the Act of July 4, 1864, it is provided that biennial examinations will hereafter be made by one surgeon only, if lie is regularly appointed, or holds a surgeon's commission in the army. Examinations by unappointed civil surgeons will not be accepted, unless it can be shown that an examination by a commissioned or duly appointed surgeon is impracticable. Increased Pensions in Certain Cases. — A pension of twenty -five dollars per month is granted to those having lost both hands or both eyes in the military service of the United States, in the line of duty, and twenty dollars per month to those who, under the same conditions, shall have lost both feet, if such parties were entitled to a lower rate of pension under the act of 1862. This higher pension will date only from the 4th day of July, 1864, in case of pensioners already enrolled, or of applicants discharged prior to that date. Evidence of Muster-in. — In accordance with the 11th Sec- tion of the Act of July 4, 1864, evidence of the muster-in of the soldier will not be required in any case, but there must be positive record evidence of service. Evidence of muster-in in the case of commissioned officers is still required. Act of Junf, 6, 1866. The Supplementary Pension Act, approved June six, eigh- pensions. 343 teen hundred and sixty-six, provides increased rates ofpensii over those granted by the Act of July fourteen, eighteen hun- dred and sixty-two, in the following cases, viz.: 1. Twenty-five dollars per month to all those invalids enti- tled, under the Act of July fourteen, eighteen hundred and sixty-two, to a lower rate of pension, on account of service rendered since March four, eighteen hundred and sixty-one, " who shall have lost the sight of both eyes, or who shad have lost both hands, or been permanently and totally disabled in the same, or otherwise so permanently and totally disabled as to render them utterly helpless, or so nearly so as to require the constant personal aid and attendance of another person." 2. Twenty dollars per month to those invalids who, being entitled under like conditions to a lower rate of pension, " shall have lost both feet, or one hand and one foot, or been totally and permanently disabled in the same, or otherwise so disabled as to be incapacitated for performing any manual labor, but not so much so as to require constant personal aid and attention." 3. Fifteen dollars per month to those invalids who, under like conditions, "shall have lost one hand or one foot, or been totally and permanently disabled in the same, or otherwise so disabled as to render their inability to perforin manual labor equivalent to the loss of a hand or a foot." In order to obtain the benefits of the foregoing provision-, pensioners already enrolled will file an application in accord- ance with form F, appended hereto. Proof in addition to that on file with the previous application need not be forwarded, except as shall be specially required in each case, after the application is received. The applicant need only be examined by a pension surgeon when expressly required, on due notice from thisofhee. Applicants not already pensioned, who b«! : themselves entitled to the benefit of the foregoing provisio will specifically set forth such claim in their declarations, care fully stating the nature of the disability on account of wl such higher rate of pension is claimed. The declaration n • be made before some officer of a court of record, or before a 344 PENSIONS. pension notary designated by this office, as provided by the third section of the act of July four, eighteen hundred and sixty -four. The above specified increased rates of pension will be allowed only to those disabled since the fourth day of March, eighteen hundred and sixty-one, and will date only from the sixth day of June, eighteen hundred and sixty-six. Teamsters, Artificers, and other Enlisted Men, — not em- braced in the terms of the Act of July fourteen, eighteen hundred and sixty-two, or of Acts supplementary thereto, are, by the tenth section of the Act of June six, eighteen hundred and sixty-six, included in the administration of the pension laws, in the class of non-commissioned officers and privates. Minor Children to he Pensioned, vti Certain Cases, instead of the Widow. — The eleventh section provides that when any widow, entitled to a pension under previous Acts, has aban- doned the care of a child or children of her deceased husband, under sixteen years of age, " or is an unsuitable person, by reason of immoral conduct, to have the custody of the same," the pension shall be paid to the duly authorized guardian of such child or children, while under the age of sixteen years, and not to the widow. The proper proof in such case, as pro- vided by this section, is the certificate of the judge of any court having probate jurisdiction, " that satisfactory evidence has been produced before such court " to the effect above indi- cated. In presenting an application under this section, the guardians of the minor child or children will make a declara- tion in accordance with the appended form G-. Pensions Granted to Dependent Fathers and to Dependent Orphan Brothers.— By the twelfth section the provisions of the Act of July fourteen, eighteen hundred and sixty-two, are extended so as to include the dependent brother or brothers of a deceased officer, soldier or seaman, and the dependent father of such deceased persons, under like limitations as apply in the case of dependent sisters and mothers; but not more than one pension is granted on account of the same person, or to pknsions. 345 more than one of said classes. The forms prescribed for the latter cases may be used, with obvious variations, in appli tions made by dependent lathers or on behalf of dependenl brothers. Limitations as to Nv/mher and Date of Pensions. The thirteenth section declares that but one pension shall be granted to any person at the same time; and that when application is not made within three years after the death or discharge of the party on whose account a pension is claimed, such pension, if allowed, "shall commence from the date of filing the lasl paper in said case by the party prosecuting the same." This limitation applies to all classes of pensions. Evidence of Marriage of Colored Applicants. — The four- teenth section provides that habitual recognition of the marriage relation between colored parties — that is, in the absence of the usually required proof — when shown by "proof satisfactory to the Commissioner of Pensions," shall be accepted as evidence of marriage, and the children of such parties shall be regarded as if bora in lawful wedlock. When the usual proof of mar- riage can be furnished, it will be required as heretofore. When only evidence of cohabitation and mutual recognition can be adduced, as provided in this section, the testimony of two cred ible and disinterested witnesses will be required, who must state how long they have been personally acquainted with the parties, and for how long a period the latter are known to have recognized each other as man and wife. If such acquaintance is deemed to be of too recent date to warrant the acceptance of this testimony, or if there is reason to doubt, in any instance, that the marriage relation existed in good faith, more specific instructions will be issued, adapted to the circumstances of the particular case. Act of July 25. ISM. Provost Marshals, Enrolling Officers, and oth&rs Entitled to the Benefits of the Pension Laws.— The first section Act of July twenty-five, eighteen hundred and sixty-aix, extend- 346 TENSIONS. the benefits conferred by the pension laws to provost marshals, deputy provost marshals, and enrolling officers disabled in the line of their official duty as such, and to the widows or depend- ents of such officers in like manner. Declarations will be made in accordance with the instructions issned under the Pension Act of July fourteen, eighteen hun- dred and sixty-two, and supplementary Acts. The grade of such officers, for the purpose of determining the rates of pen- sions under this section, is fixed as follows: Provost marshals will rank as captains; their deputies as first lieutenants; and enrolling officers as second lieutenants. Increased Pensions to Widows, and Orphan Children Under Sixteen Years of Age. — The second section of this act allows to those who are or shall be pensioned as widows of sol- diers or sailors, two dollars per month additional pension for each child (under sixteen years of age) of the deceased soldier or sailor by the widow thus pensioned. On the death or remarriage of such widow, or on the denial of a pension to her, in accordance with the provisions of sec- tion eleven of the Act of June six, eighteen hundred and sixty- six, the same amount to which she would otherwise be entitled, under this and previous provisions, is allowed to the minor children. The number and names of the children, with their ages, must be proved by the affidavits of two credible and dis- interested witnesses. The provisions of this section only include the children of the widow, and not those of her deceased husband by a previous marriage. The widows of minor children "of officers are not entitled to this increase. Declarations for an increase under this section, if for the widow, will be made in accordance with form II, appended hereto; and if for minor children, according to form I. The pension certificate must be sent with all applications filed subsequently to September four, eighteen hundred and sixty- six. Increase of Pensions under Acts prior to July 4, 1862. — All pensioners under Acts approved prior to July fourteen, pensions. 347 eighteen hundred and sixty-two, are, by the third section of the present act, granted the same rights as those pensioned under acts approved at or since that date, so far as said A.ets may 1": applicable, with the exception of soldiers of the Revolution <>r their widows. This section applies only to pensioners who were such at the date of the approval of this Act. Declaration of claimants under this section will be made in accordance with the forms previously issued under Act of July fourteen, eighteen hundred and sixty-two, and subsequent pen- sion acts, with the necessary modifications, and the pension certificates will be returned. Invalid Pensions of Claimants Dying while their Aj>/>li- cations are Pending, the Evidence being Completed. — The fourth section of this act is construed in connection with the tenth section of the Act of July four, eighteen hundred and sixty-four, and the sixth section of the Act of June six, eigh- teen hundred and sixty-six, to which it is supplementary. If an applicant for invalid pension dies while his claim is pend- ing, the evidence having been completed, the pension, under the provisions of this section and of those sections of previous acts above referred to, is disposed of as follows: 1. If he left a widow, or minor child, or children under sixteen years of age, or other dependent relatives, and died of wounds received or of disease contracted in the service or in the line of duty, no invalid pension certificate will issue, but such widow or dependent relatives will receive a pension, in their own right, taking precedence in the order prescribed by law in other cases. 2. If the claimant left a widow or dependent relatives, but did not die of wounds received, or disease contracted in the service and in the line of duty, so that neither widow nor dependent relatives would be entitled to a pension on hie account, then the certificate will be issued in his name, and the pension paid to the widow or to the dependent relatives, as tho case may be, in the same order in which they would have been pensioned, if entitled, as set forth in the preceding paragraph. 348 PENSIONS. 3. If the claimant left no widow or dependent relatives, the certificate will issue in his name, and the pension will be drawn by his executor or administrator. Certain Accrued Bights Resetted under Repealed Enact- ments. — The fifth section reserves all rights that may have accrued under the fifth section of the pension Act of July four, eighteen hundred and sixty-four, and the third section of the pension Act of March three, eighteen hundred and sixty-five, though repealed by the first section of the Act of June six, eighteen hundred sixty-six. Widows Remarrying while their Claims are Pending, — Are entitled, under the sixth section, if their claims are other- wise valid, to receive pensions to the date of remarriage, if the deceased officer, soldier or sailor, on whose account they claim, left no legitimate child under sixteen years of age. Joseph H. Barrett, Commissioner of Pensions. Pension Office, August 4, 1866. Act of July 27, 1868. Section 1. — Dependent Relatives. — In this section prece- dence is given to the dependent relatives hereinafter mentioned, in the following order, to wit: First, mothers; secondly, fath- ers; thirdly, orphan brothers and sisters under sixteen, who shall be pensioned jointly; and the persons enumerated shall each be entitled in their order, after the death of the one pre- ceding. Sect. 2. — Invalids Disabled Subsequent to Passage of this Act. — This section specifies as to pensions by reason of disabil- ities incurred subsequent to the passage of this Act, and enume- rates the circumstances under which said disabilities must have been contracted. Sect. 3. — Unclaimed Pensions. — This section provides that pensions remaining unclaimed for fourteen months after the same have become due, shall be adjusted at the Pen- sion Agency instead of at the office of the Third Auditor; and PENSIONS. :,f<, tlu failure of any pensioner to claim his or her pension for thr,:e years, shall be deemed presumptive evidence thai tin same has legally terminated. On a new application, with evi- dence satisfactorily accounting for such failure, the pensioner may be restored to the rolls. Sect. 4 — Increase of Pensions of Widows and of chil- dren by a former Wife. — This section gives an increase of two dollars per month for each minor child of a deceased boI- dier, to commence from the death of their father, and continue until they severally attain the age of sixteen years; and pro- vides that the children of a former marriage shall be " entitled to receive two dollars per month, to commence from the death of their father, and continue until they severally attain the age of sixteen years, to be paid to the guardian of such child or children for their use and benefit; Provider/, how( y< /■, That in all such cases such widow is charged with the care, custody, and maintenance of such child or children, the said sum of two dollars per month for each of said children shall be paid to her for and during the time she is or may have been so charged with the care, custody, and maintenance of such child or chil- dren, subject to the same conditions, provisions and limitations as if they were her own children by her said deceased husband. Sect. 5. — Widows and Minors not Debarred, etc. — By this section no widow or guardian to whom an increase of pension lias been or may hereafter be granted on account of minor chil- dren, shall be deprived thereof by reason of their being main- tained or educated at the expense of the State or of the public. Sect. 6. — Extension of Limitation. — This section proi id. ■.- that all pensions applied for wirhin five years after the right thereto shall have accrued, and which have been or may be granted under the Act of July 14, 18G2, or Acts supplemen- tary thereto, shall commence from the discharge or death of the person on whose account the pension lias been or shall be granted; and in cases of insane persons and minors, who v. without guardians or other proper legal representatives pre- vious to said limitation, applications may be filed in ti. 350 PENSIONS behalf after its expiration. This section applies solely to cases in which the title to pension has accrued subsequent to March 4, 1861. Shot. 7. — Arrears. — In which notification of title to arrears of pension, under the foregoing section is provided for; and also that no claim agent or other person shall be entitled to compensation for services in making application for such arrears. Sect. 8. — Widow's Pension to Children, etc. — In which the requirement of the certificate of the court that satisfactory evidence has been adduced of the abandonment of the care of the minor child or children of a deceased soldier by his widow, or of her unsuitableness to have custody of them is dispensed with. The furnishing of satisfactory evidence thereof to the commissioner shall be sufficient to cause the suspension of said widow's pension. Sect. 9. — Pending Claim may he Completed by Heirs. — In which if any person entitled to a pension has died since March 4, 1861, his heirs or legal representatives shall be enti- tled to receive the accrued pension; provided no widow or minor child survives the applicant. Sect. 10. — Remarriage. — This section provides for pension to the widow or dependent mother, from the death of soldier to the date of claimant's remarriage, (provided no children under sixteen survive.) Sect. 11. — Extension of Time. — This section provides for the continuance in force of the Act of July 4, 1864, from the 4th July, 1867, for five years. Sect. 12. — Loss of an Eye. — This section allows twenty- five dollars as a pension for total loss of sight from wounds received or disease contracted in the service, though the pen- sioner may have had only one eye when entering the service. Sect. 13. — Pension by reason of Pig Jit Accrued since Rev- olution. — By this section all persons pensioned by reason of services rendered since the war of the "Revolution, and prior to Maich 4, 1861, are placed on the same footing with those pen- INDIAN AFFAIR8. :;,M sioned under Acts passed since that time; and grants eight dollars per month to the widows of revolutionary Boldiera and sailors now pensioned at less than that amount. Sect. 14. — Limbs to Officers. — By this section captains in the army and lieutenants in the navy, and those of Less rank, who have lost a leg or an arm in such service, shall be entitled to receive an artificial limb upon the same terms as privates in the army. Sect. 15. — Special Acts. — By this section all pensions granted by special Acts shall be subject to be varied in amount, according to the provisions and limitations of the pension laws. Sect. 16. — Repealing Clause. — By this section all Acts and parts of Acts inconsistent with the foregoing provisions of this Act be and the same are hereby repealed. CHAPTER XXXVI. INDIAN AFFAIRS. "When America was discovered, in 1492, the whole continent was thinly populated (except in some few regions where a considerable degree of civilization and skill in agriculture had been attained, as in Mexico and Peru) by roving tribes of natives, of unknown origin. These were called, by Europeans, Indians, from the erroneous idea of Columbus, and the nun of that age at first, that there was only one continent; and that they had reached the eastern shore of Asia, when Ajnerica was discovered. The whole of the region comprising our country was in the possession of a great number of these tribes. Their number, when permanent settlements began to bo made, is not known, but probably amounted, in all the vast territory, to only a 352 INDIAN AFFAIRS. few million— perhaps two or three. They divided the country between them, in an indefinite way, war and hunting being their chief occupations. They attempted very little cultivation of the soil. The settlements of the Indians were as indefinite and moveable as their boundaries, and they attached little value to land. Territory was acquired from them partly by force and partly by purchase. These last were usually made for a- nominal sum, and with little comprehension, on their part, of the importance and future effects of its alienation. As the settlements of Europeans extended, frequent and bar- barous wars, greatly exasperating the whites, arose as a revenge for private injuries, or in retaliation of encroachments on their hunting grounds. As these always ended, ultimately, in favor of the settlers, and the Indians were driven farther back, the country was taken possession of as the spoils of conquest. These desolating contests , and the easily-acquired vices of the whites constantly diminished their numbers. They were so inherently wild men that the conquered remnants usually withered and faded away under the process of civilization. When, after the War of the Revolution, the settlements came to be consolidated and extensive, under the rapid growth of the population, lands were reserved for these remnants; treaties were made with them, as with independent nations; and, from their improvidence and carelessness as to the economical pres- ervation of their resources, the indemnities allowed them for the lands to which they renounced all claim were paid to them in installments, or as annuities, by the government. This sys- tem has been continued to the present day, and has occasioned the establishment of the IM)IAN BURFAU OF THE INTERIOR DEPARTMENT. It is presided over by the Commissioner of Indian Affairs, appointed in the usual way by the President and Senate. Numerous Superintendents and agents are appointed to reside near the different locations assigned to the Indians, to conduct INDIAN AFFAIRS. the business under his supervision, and receive and distribute the goods and moneys given by treaty to each tribe. They gi ve bonds for faithfulness in the employment of funds destined for the Indians. They are appointed for four years, and report and account to the Department of the Interior. Except a few who are taxed, the Indians are not counted among our population as citizens. They have, therefore, no representative in Congress, nor, except the criminal law to some extent, are they amenable to other of our laws than such as the treaties have established. Their internal government is conducted by themselves alone, neither governor, judge, nor courts being established, as in other Territorial jurisdictions. They are difficult to control, however, not recognizing, as civilized people do (except a small number who are far on the way to civilization), the obligations of treaties and pledges. Dishonest and self-seeking men often take advantage of their ignorance and their love of ardent spirits and trinkets, to cheat and injure them. To remedy this as far as possible, white men are not permitted to reside on their reservations unless by special license of the government. Nor can they alienate their lands to white men not officials acting under government supervision. All pains are required to be taken by the government officers to promote their interests, and schools and missions are encour- aged among them, and agricultural implements are furnished so far as they can be persuaded to use them. In short, it is the benevolent and enlightened aim of the crovernment to act as the guardians of their true interests, to encourage mental and moral culture among them, and assist them toward the acquisition of the arts and comforts of civilized life. It will easily be comprehended that many difficulties oppo themselves to this effort with a race whose instincts are bo wild and fierce, and who adopt our vices so much more readily than our virtues, and are so easily influenced by bad and designing men. Still, progress is made, as will be seen in the case ot 23 354 INDIAN AFFAIKS. THE INDIAN TERRITORY. It is situated south of the 37th degree of north latitude, and west of the States of Arkansas and Missouri. Texas bounds it on the south. It has 71,127 square miles, and is about a third larger than the State of Illinois. It is very fertile, for the most part, and a beautiful region. It is inhabited, in great part, by Indians who have been transferred from the regions east of the Mississippi, mostly Cherokees, Creeks, Choctaws, and Seminoles. Some of these were removed by persuasion, and some by force, from their former homes, where they were disturbed by proximity to the rapidly increasing white population. Each tribe has its own section of the Territory. Here they practice their own customs unmolested, and conduct their own government. Many of them, especially the Cherokees, are intelligent and industrious. They have churches and schools and factories, highly-cultivated farms and good buildings. Improvement is so marked among them that it is not improb- able that they may at some future time become a State in our Union. At present they are amenable to the Circuit and District Courts of the adjoining States when certain crimes are committed by them against the whites in those States, but our courts have no authority over their relations to one another. The population of the Territory is 70,000. The entire Indian population of the country is over 300,000. They are scattered over the States and Territories between the Missouri river and the Pacific coast, and those outside the Indian Terri- tory are often at war with each other and with our citizens, requiring many troops and a large expense to keep them in subjection. It is probable that, as a race, they will soon become extinct, except, perhaps, those in the Indian Territory. They are uneasy, and dangerous neighbors to the whites in those sparsely-settled regions. The amount appropriated to the Indians by Congress for the year 1873-4, was $5,513,937, which was exclusive of their annuities, or funds invested for them, of which they receive the annual interest. CHAPTER XXXVII. CENSUS BUREAU. 1. A census is an enumeration, or counting, of the inlml itants of any country. History informs us that this was done in very ancient times. One of the books in the Old Testa- ment (Numbers) was named from the circumstance that it contains an account of the numbering of the Israelites, by the order of Moses. That numbering was a census of the peo- ple composing the Jewish nation. It not only gives us the total number of the people, but that of each tribe; much after our own mode of doing the same thing. We take ours by States, and we find the total of the whole nation. In ancient times a census seems to have been taken more for military than for any other purpose. This is one of the objects in the present day; but in modern times many uses are made of a census. It not only shows the military power of a nation, but when taken with the distinction of sex, and age, with an account of the births, marriages, and deaths during each year, it throws much light upon a variety of interesting topics; such as the longevity, the rate of mortality, the ratio of increase, and the average duration of human life. These, and man/ other important facts are obtained by a census. 2. In the United States the census is the only means by which Congress determines the number of Representatives each State is entitled to have in that body. Hence the Con- stitution itself makes provision for the enumeration of tho people once in ten years — called a decade. The firel was made. in 1700, the next in 1800, and so on every tenth year. If the number of any year ends with a cipher, we know that the United States census was taken, or will be taken, in that year, whether we look backward or forward. 3. Up to the present time, according to the provisions made (355) OKfl CENSUS BUREAU. iii the Constitution, a census has been taken nine times, and under the head of recapitulation (see index) we find what it was each time. We also find that from the first (1790), to the last (1870), the population had increased from 3,929,827, to 3S,838,180. Therefore it approximates very nearly to 40,000,- 000; indicating a growth unparalleled by any nation in ancient or modern times. We will next state how this great national work is performed. The Constitution simply declares that it shall be done, but the laws specify how it shall be done, and who shall do it. The United States Marshals are the officers designated by the law as the persons who shall make the enumeration of the peo- ple in each State and Territory; in addition to which they are also required to procure other statistical matter, as directed by Congress. 4. In order to accomplish this work, it is necessary to employ a number of assistant marshals, one of whom must visit every house in his district, and ascertain the number ot persons belonging to it, together with such statistical informa- tion as is required. This is all returned to the Marshal, and by him sent to the Department of the Interior at Washington, where, under the direction of the Secretary of the Interior, it is made into a report, and then laid before Congress, to be used by it in apportioning to the States their quota of Representa- tives. This apportionment is actually made in the Department of the Interior, and then laid before Congress for its examina- tion and approval. The Marshal appoints and commissions his deputies, who must be sworn to perform the duties assigned to them, to the best of their ability. 5. In the department of the Interior there is a board whose duty it is to superintend the work of taking the census. It prepares, prints, and sends to every Marshal the blanks to be used by him and his assistants; and when they have made returns of their work, the board arranges them preparatory to laying them before Congress. After this they are published, and make a valuable work of reference; for they contain a CEN8U8 BUREAU. ^57 vast amount of statistical information — 6uch as the Dumber of acres of land under cultivation, the number of bushels of grain of every kind produced in the year; the number of horses, cattle, sheep, swine, &c, raised; the number of manu- facturing establishments, and the amount of their productions; the number of churches, schools, colleges, &c; the number of deaf, blind, idiotic, and insane persons; together with much other matter, quite too voluminous for insertion here. 6. All this is done by order of Congress, and of course paid for from the United States Treasury. Elsewhere in this book (see index) we give a tabular state- ment of the population of each State and Territory, at each time the census has been taken by the United States. It shows the increase at each decade from 1790, the first time it was taken, to 1870— the last at this date. This table also shows the increase in the number of States, from the original 13 to the present 37, besides the Territories, which alone are larger than the original 13 States, and nearly as numerous. CHAPTER XXXVIII. THE DEPARTMENT OF AGRICULTURE Was established by an act of Congress, May, 1862. It ia not, like the other Departments of the Executive Branch of the government, superintended by a Secretary with a Beat in the President's Cabinet. Its Head is called The Gommissoner of Agriculture, and he is appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, like other civil offi- cers. The creation of this office is a recognition of the extreme importance of this industry to the prosperity and welfare of the nation. Our country is eminently an agricultural one; a* the interests confided to this department arc those oi a el •of the people more numerous than any other, and on the 358 THE DEPARTMENT OF AGRICULTURE. success of whose labors depends the well being of all. In proportion as this industry attains a high state of development, and is generally prosperous, do the professional, mercantile, and manufacturing classes increase in wealth. It is the found- ation on which they build. The great fertility of our country, and the breadth of area adapted to all the most useful products of the world, and the need of instruction, suggestion, and aid in properly adapting agricultural products to the soil and climate, by the large number of settlers in regions with whose peculiarities they are but partially familiar, give a special interest and value to this new Department. Its duty is to watch over this large field and make such suggestions to Congress in regard to legislation as shall seem called for; to disseminate such practical information among the people as it may be able to acquire by intelligent observa- tion in this and other countries; and the testing and dissemina- tion of rare and untried plants of other countries that promise to increase our agricultural resources. For experiments in the latter case, a propagating garden and grounds are provided, and the most skillful and intelligent officers, bringing all the lights of science to their assistance, devote themselves to the study of these plants, as to the soil and climate best adapted to them, the proper modes of culti- vation, and to acclimating them to our country. This branch of the department sends, to suitable sections of the country, such plants and seeds as it has reason to believe it will be profitable to introduce and cultivate. This usage, continued for many years, will, no doubt, contribute very greatly to the variety of useful products which add to our comfort and wealth. The department keeps skillful chemists and naturalists con- stantly employed to gather information of various kinds, that may be useful to agriculturists. The character of soils, the influences of climate, the best system of farming, the diseases of domestic animals, and plants and their cure, the best THE DEPARTMENT OF A( ; UK l 1. 1 I l.l,. mode of preserving crops .from the ravages of in ind many others are the subjects of careful investigation, and I information thus gained is freely communicated to the country at large. There is a statistical division, in which facts arc gathered from the whole country and published monthly. His Ben many useful purposes. It also collects data, for purposes of comparison and instruction, from foreign countries. Whatever facts it may be most useful for farmers to know, whatever crops it may be most profitable for them to produce, and whatever improvements in the modes of agriculture and in agricultural implements are discovered to be possible are communicated to all without cost. Agricultural education receives much attention from the department, and all the facts and influences that can aid m making farmers thoroughly intelligent in their own pursuit, are gathered and employed with effect. Agriculture cannot but improve immeasureably under this fostering care, and this Department is likely to become one of the most important and useful in the government. It is yet in its infancy, but has already accomplished much good. The commissioner reports annually to Congress. Be has power to appoint such officers as Congress considers necessary. In 1868 a line building for this department was completed -at a cost of $140,000. In contains a chemical laboratory with all the necessary apparatus and materials, and a museum, or col- lection of specimens, of value in the study of agriculture. store-rooms for seeds to be sent throughout the country. The beauty of the building and grounds adds a very attractive feature to the National Capital, and the Institution itself ifl b favorable comment on the wise and provident care bestowed by the government on the leading interest of the people. CHAPTER XXXIX. POST OFFICE DEPARTMENT AND POST MASTER GENERAL. This department of the government, whose head, the Post Master General, is a member of the Cabinet, exists by virtue of Section 8, Article 1st of the Constitution, where are these words: "Congress shall have the power to establish post offices and post roads." From small beginnings, in early colonial times, and contin- ued through the Revolutionary War, it has grown to be one of the largest and most important departments of the govern- ment. The security, speed, and cheapness of intercourse between all parts of the country and with foreign lands, is of the utmost importance to business and commerce; it encourges social intercourse and intimate relations among the people, and is of no small consequence in developing their intelligence and promoting their improvement. By successive laws of Congress it has been perfected to its present state of excellence. The duties connected with it are performed by many thousands of persons in every part of the country. They are of average intelligence and education, and must be trained to their work almost without personal instruc- tion or supervision, yet so complete is the organization, and so pervading the influence of the central power, the regulations so simple, clear, and precise, that mistakes are extremely rare, considering the great number of transactions, and instances of misconduct in office are probably less frequent than in any other branch of the public service, though employing persons well trained and under close surveillance. ■ The Post Master General is appointed by the President and the Senate for four years. His office is in the General Post Office at Washington. He has three assistants, appointed in (360) POST OFFICES DF.l'AliTMKNT. ,<\[ the same manner as himself. He has a seal of 1hh office, an impression from which must be affixed to the commission of every postmaster in the United States; and also to all coi of papers and documents that may be wanted from his offi This only can give them official value of the same importance as the original papers. He must give bonds as security for faithfulness in office, and take the usual official oath. He has the entire direction and management of the Depart- ment, and the appointment of all local postmasters (in law considered as his deputies), whose salary is less than $1,000 per annum. All others are appointed by the President and Senate. That its business may be more conveniently arranged and prepared for his final action, it is distributed among several bureaus, or minor departments as follows: THE APPOINTMENT OFFICK Includes the divisions of appointments; bonds given by postmasters, agents, and clerks; salaries and allowances, where they are not provided for by law; free delivery in cities; and the agency of blanks used in the extensive business and reports of the department. This office is in charge of the First Assistant Post Master General. THE CONTRACT OFFICE. This includes the divisions of contracts for carrying the mails, by persons or companies; the inspection of the entire process of carrying the mails, to secure their safe, regular, and prompt delivery; mail equipment, or the supply of all the material and conveniences for transportation of the mail, fur- nished by the department; special agents, and mail depreda- tions, which has the care of all violations of law and the con- duct and accounts of all agents employed for the suppression and prevention of abuses; and the Topographical, which has charge of maps and diagrams of mail routes, and geographical information, required for the various branches of the Bervioa. It is in charge of the Second Assistant Post Master (J en oral. 362 toot OFFICE DEPARTMENT. THE FINANCE OFFICE. This is separated into the divisions of Finance, which has charge of the entire cash receipts, transfers, and disbursements of the department; of postage stamps and stamped envelopes, newspaper wrappers, and postal cards; registered letters and seals; and the examination of Dead Letters and their return to the writers. Dead letters are those not taken out of the oliice to which they were sent. After being advertised three weeks in some newspaper near the office where they were sent, they are returned to the General Post Office, where they are examined; and if they contain money or valuable papers they are returned to the writers and an account of them kept at the General Post Office. The sums, so lost and taken care of, amount annually to tens of thousands of dollars. The Third Assistant Post Master General has charge of it. THE MONEY ORDER OFFICE. The Money Orders System furnishes very convenient and safe banking facilities for the transfer of money in small sums. It diminishes as much as possible the exposure of money to loss by theft or otherwise, through the plan of depositing in one office, and sending a certificate of such deposit which is good for the money at another office. Immense sums are so exchanged and business facilitated without any actual passage of the money from one point to the other. When it is neces- sary to preserve the balances it is done by, and at the risk of, the department. No more than fifty dollars can be sent in one order, nor more than three orders to the same person in one day. The number of these offices is more than 1,400. The rates of commission on money orders are, On orders not exceeding $10 5 cents. Over $10, and not exceeding $20 10 cents. " $20, " " " $30 15 cents. u $30, " " « $40 20 cents. H $^0, " » « $50 25 cents. No fractions of cents allowed in orders. POST OFFICE DErAKTMENT. When a money order has been lost or destroyed, a dnplii can be got, by the person who bought the order <»r by the 1 1 r son it was bought for, by applying either at the office where the order was bought or at the office where it should be paid. The Money Order Department is in charge of the Superintendent of the Money Order System. An international money order system, between the United States and Switzerland, went into operation September 1*1, 1869, whereby the exchange of Postal orders between the two countries is effected through the agency of two Post Office! termed International Exchange Offices. The Office of New York City being set apart for the United States, and that of Basle, in Switzerland, for that country. The amount drawn for cannot exceed fifty dollars in one order, three orders only can be obtained by the same person in one day. The system works satisfactorily, and will no doubt be extended to Great Britain, and perhaps other European Nations at an early day. THE OFFICE OF FORFIGN MAILS. It has the care of all foreign postal arrangements and the supervision of the ocean mail service. It is presided over by a Superintendent. THE AUDITOR OF THE TREASURY FOR THE POST OFFICE DEPARTMENT. This is a bureau of the Treasury Department, which, for convenience, is located in the General Post Office. To this officer is assigned the duty of auditing the accounts of the Po«1 Office Department, all communications relating to the accounts of postmasters, mail contractors, and other agents of the Department, are addressed to this officer. The head of so large and important a department of the public service is properly a chief officer of the government and has a seat in the cabinet 8(54 TO 6 " 1 * OFFICE DEPARTMENT. NUMBER OF POST OFFICES AND MILES OF POSr ROADS IN THE U. 8. £n 1790 there were but 75 post offices, and 1,875 m. of post-roads. 1800 « 903 a 20,817 a 1810 u 2,300 u 36,400 « 1820 a 4,500 u 72,492 u 1830 U 8,450 u 115,176 a 1840 tt 13,403 a 155,739 (I 1850 a 18,417 u 178,672 « 1860 u 28,498 a 240,594 u 1870 u 28,492 a 231,232 u POSTMASTERS GENERAL. Samuel Osgood, Mass., Sept. 26, 1789. Timothy Pickering, Mass., Aug. 12, 179L Joseph Habersham, Ga., Feb. 25, 1795. Gideon Granger, Ct., Nov. 28, 1801. Return J. Meigs, O., March 17, 1814. John McLean, O., June 25, 1823. William T. Barry, Ky., March 9, 1829. Amos Kendall, Ky., March 1, 1835. John M. Niles, Ct., May 18, 1840. Francis Granger, N. Y., March 6, 1841. Charles A. Wickliff, Ky., Sept. 13, 1841. Cave Johnson, Tenn., March 5, 1845. Jaccb Collamer, Vt., March 7, 1849. Nathan K. Hall, N. Y., July 20, 1850. S. D. Hubbard, Ct., Aug. 31, 1852. James Campbell, Pa., March 5, 1853. Aaron V. Brown, Tenn., March 6, 1857. Joseph Holt, Ky., March 14, 1859. Horatio King, Jan. 1, 1861. Montgomery Blair, Md., March 7, 1861. William Dennison, O., Oct. 1, 1864. Alexander W. Randall, Wis., July 15, 1866. J. A. J. Creswell, Md., March 5, 1869. " " reappointed March 17, 1873. Marshall Jewell, July 1874. CHAPTER XL. KATES OF POSTAGE IN THE UNITED STATES On each letter weighing not more than one-half ounce throe cents, and for each additional half-ounce or fraction thereof three cents. All packages containing matter not in itself chargeable with letter postage, but in which is enclosed or concealed any letter, memorandum, or other thing chargeable with letter postage, 01 upon which is any writing or memorandum; and manuscripts for publication in newspapers, magazines, or periodicals — three cents for each half-ounce or fraction thereof. Weight of packages limited to four pounds. On local or drop letters, at offices where free delivery by car- riers is established, two cents for each half ounce or fraction thereof; and where free delivery has not been established, one cent for each half ounce or fraction thereof. On seeds, cuttings, bulbs, roots and scions, one cent for each ounce or fraction thereof. Weight of packages limited to four pounds. On pamphlets and occasional publications, all transient printed matter, unsealed circulars, book manuscripts, proof sheets, corrected proof sheets, maps, prints, engravings, etc, one cent for each ounce or fraction thereof. Weight of pack- ages limited to four pounds. On samples of ores, metals, minerals, and merchandise, one cent for each ounce or fraction thereof. Weight of packag * limited to four pounds. On books, one cent for each ounce or fraction thereof. Weight of packages limited to four pounds. (805) 366 KATES OF POSTAGE TN THB UNITED STATES. All domestic matter, including newspapers, magazines and periodicals sent to actual subscribers from a known office of publication, must be prepaid by postage stamps affixed thereto. Newspapers issued weekly, or oftener, and sent from pub- lishers or news agents, to subscribers or dealers, two cents per pound; and if not issued as often as weekly, three cents per pound. Papers sent miscellaneously, and not regiJy-rlj' p^tage the same as on books. FOREIGN POSTAGE. FOREIGN POSTAGE. FOREIGN COUNTHIE8. Alexandria, Egypt, British closed mail via Southampton Asp in wail, U. D. packet* Australia, British mail via Southampton " " Brindisi " German mail, direct, via Brindisi Austria, including Hungary, German mail, direct " " •• " closed mail via England. Belgium, by direct steamers " via Great Britain Bermuda, U. S. packet* Brazil . Lottara per '/, 01 British mail. British Columbia (Letters unpaid 10 cents per V% oz.) Canada, England, Wales, Ireland and Scotland (unpaid 10c. $ /, oz.) Postal Cards to Canada or British Columbia one cent extra. Central America* Chili, via Panama China, via San Francisco " " Southampton - " " Brindisi Constantinople, German mail, direct " " closed mail, via England Cuba.U. S. packet* Denmark* East India, British, via San Francisco » " " British mail, via Southampton " " " " " " Brindisi Ecuador - , -- Egypt, except Alexandria British mail, via Southampton Falkland Islands, British mail, via Southampton France, direct* - Germany, via Hamburg or Bremen, direct " closed mail, via England Postal Cards to Germany one cent additional. Gibraltar, British mail, via Southampton Gold Coast, " " " " Great Britain and Ireland Greece, German mail, direct Guatemala, U. S. packet* - Havana, U. S. packet* - ,"""", — Hawaiian Islands, U. S. packet (Newspapers one cent per ounce).... Holland Honduras, via St. Thomas VmIL'ATu~™"iT"a Hong Kong, including Canton, Amoy, Swatow, and Foot how, v. o packet Hong Kong, British mail, via Southampton Italy" Jamaica, U. S. packet* Japan, U S. packet •if i, British mail, via Southampton Jei usalem, German mail, direct " " closed, via England Malta, British mail, via Southampton Mexico, IT. S. packet (by sea) Morocco, British mail, via Southampton Natal, " " " " Netherlands, same as Holland. Newfoundland -.--v" ".v V„"^" New South Wales, British mall, via Southampton. New Zealand Norwav, via Ensrlnnd and Christiana Panama, U. S. packet --:- Paraguay. TJ. 8. packet ( Newspapers 4 cents enen). Pern. British mail, via Panama. " Portugal, British mail, via Southampton 10 10 Ifl fJO 1 1. t 7 t 6 t8 10 15 28 t 6 t 6 N i we pn. I" ra i.ot ' ^ t 4 OS. •1 •-! 4 8 1* 8 4 :i 4 9 a 4 2 I 10 1 4 O •~s • 84 8 10 • 11 r 10 .» t ~\ 10 22 28 20 .j 20 « 16 4 10 n t6 + 7 16 i 16 t t 6 a +14 10 * 10 p 6 .. 10 18 10 28 tio 10 10 SB +11 tl-J 16 10 Ifl ae 6 16 lr. 10 10 Ifl ■3 16 368 REGISTERED AND DEAD LETTERS. FOREIGN POSTAGE— Continued. FOREIGN COUNTRIES. Prince Edward Island (Unpaid letters 10 cents each y 3 oz). Russia, German mail, direct " " closed mail, via England Sandwich Islands (Newspapers one cent per two ounces). . Shanghai, U. S. packet 6ierra Leone, British mail, via Southampton Spain, German mail, direct " via New Orleans* Sweden and Norway, by direct steamers for U. S Sweden, via England and Christiana Switzerland, via England " " Germany Vancouver*s Island (Letters, if unpaid, 10 cents per % oz.). West Indies, except otherwise stated, via St. Thomas Letters per % oz. 6 10 til 6 10 16 11 10 t 6 9 tio t8 t6 18 News pa- pers not exceed'g 4 oz. 2 6 7 2 4 6 2 2 4 4 3 2 4 * Denotes that the postage is the United States postage only, which must be prepaid on matter sent and collected on matter received. t Denotes that prepayment of postage is optional ; in all other cases it is compul. Bory. Great Britain and Ireland.— Letters wholly unpaid or insufficiently prepaid are subject on delivery, in addition to the deficient postage, to a fine of 6 cents in the United States and 3d. in Great Britain. Book manuscript and corrected proof may be sent at book-packet rate of postage. CHAPTER XLI. REGISTERED AND DEAD LETTERS. REGISTERED LETTERS. Within the last few years the Registered Letter Department has grown to enormous proportions. In former times the registering of a letter was only a notice to those handling it that it was valuable, the process being to simply paste a Reg- istered Letter Bill to the letter and place it among the ordinary letters. If any officer was dishonest and wanted the letter, all he had to do was to take it and destroy the bill, and the chances of detection were very slight. The fee was small and the safety smaller. Under the new system which has been in ope- ration some few years, and is copied from England, the safe REGISTERED ami DEAD LBTTEB8. | transmission and delivery of money ;ind valuables lb almoet certain. Only letters or other mail matter on which letter rates of postage are fully prepaid can be registered. Each postmaster is furnished with all the proper blanks, including the package envelopes and seals. The latter is a large whitish brown envelope, longer and broader than an ordinary official size envelope, and ''Registered Letter" printed in large red letters across the face. The seal is similar to a postage stamp, only larger, and is placed over the lap after the envelope Is sealed, and then cancelled. When a letter is presented for registration at any post office, the postmaster must require that the name and post office address of the writer thereof In- endorsed on its face; he must also see that the postage, a- well as the fee for registering, is fully prepaid by stamps affixed to such letter; he will then fill out a receipt, entering thereon the number of the letter, the date and name of his office, the name and address of the writer, and the address of the letter, sign and deliver it to the person presenting the letter. The postmaster then makes out his ''registered letter bill ,! and "return registered letter bill" each of which con- tains a full description of the letter consisting of add] and number. The registered letter bill is then placed in the package envelope with the letter. The package is then sealed up and the name of the post office for which it is des- tined, and the number and stamp of the mailing office are plainly marked upon the package. It is then ready for deliv- ery to the route agent or postal clerk upon whose route it properly belongs, who is required to give a receipt for it, and also to keep a complete record of it, as are all officers of the Department who handle registered matter in transit, lie must also take a receipt from the officer to whom he next delivers the package. The return registered letter bill is sent in an ordinary envelope in the regular mail to the office of final destination, which will, by reason of the fact that do registi letters are sent in through mails, and only in charge of p< clerks upon day trains, nearly always reach the office inadwmoe 24 370 REGISTERED AND DEAD LETTERS. of the registered letter; and the postmaster, then knowing that such letter is on the way, is on the lookout for it, and if it conies in due time signs the receipt and returns it to the mailing office. All this is done for a fee of only eight cents in addition to the regular postage. If a registered letter should not reach its destination in a reasonable length of time after the receipt of the return bill, the post master will notify the post master at the mailing office of the non-receipt of the letter. It then becomes the duty of the last mentioned officer to inform a special agent of the fact, who rill make out what is called a " tracer," which is a com- plete description of the letter, with blank space for each per- son who handled the original letter to state, from his records and receipts, exactly what disposition he made of it and whose receipt he holds; he then passes it along to the next. Thus by this complete chain of records and receipts, though it may reach from the Atlantic to the Pacific, a registered letter may be readily traced to its final destination, or until the records cease. If a break should occur in the chain and the loss be fastened upon any post office or mail, agent, the case is rigidly " investigated " by the proper officer, and if it appears that the Iojs occurs through carelessness, the loser is made to pay the value of the lost letter, and receive a severe reprimand, and if it should occur again is very apt to be dismissed the service. If the special detective is convinced that the missing letter is stolen, he then takes a different course and commences his system of " decoys," etc., to catch the thief, and is almost always successful, as the man who robs the mails always becomes careless, and grows bolder with each repetition of the offense. The amount and extent of the registered letter business may be judged when it is stated that during the month of January, 1874, at the post office in New York over sixty thousand reg- istered letters were received, nearly thirty thousand of which were for delivery in the city, and the rest for other places, New York being a distributing office. REGISTERED AND DEAD LETTERS, ;;7 | DEAD LETTERS. About all that people know or understand of the workings of the Dead Letter bureau of the Tost Office Department is that if a letter is not delivered in due time it is Benl to tin- Dead Letter Office, and there opened and returned to the writer. When, each year, they see the report of the Postma General, the amount of money and number of Letters thai are returned to the senders seems enormous, but when it ie con- sidered that millions of letters and thousands of dollars are carried and safely delivered correctly each year in the CTnited States, the number that fails of delivery, by contrast, does not seem so great. During the month of November, l v ~:). Dearly ten millions of letters were received and dispatched In New York City. Every effort is always made to return money or any arti- cles of value which may be found in dead letters. It is required that everything valuable shall be registered free when returned to the owners; but if for any reason it cannot be delivered to the rightful owner, it is held in the Department subject to the owners control for four years, and after that time it is conveyed to the Treasury, and goes towards decreasing the annual deficit in the Post Office Department. All letters which are properly stamped and addressed, and go to their des- tination, but are not delivered at the end of one week, by reason of the person addressed not being found, are advertised, either by publishing once in a daily or weekly paper, or by posting the list in a conspicuous place in the office. At the end 01 four weeks all then undelivered are sent to the dead letter office. The matter of advertising in newspapers is left to the discre- tion of the Postmaster General, and it is but few of the la offices that are allowed to do so. The compensation is fixed by law at one cent for each letter, which is to 1"' paid bv the per son receiving the letter; but by reason of the fact that by far the larger portion of those advertised arc no1 delivered, the expense is so great that but few offices can be allowed toadver- tise. All letters which are dropped into an office without 372 ATTORNEY GENERAL. stamps or only part paid, or the address is not readable, are sent at once to the Dead Letter office, except in some few offices where a bulletin board is provided for the purpose of displaying to the public letters of this character. When a letter which is wholly or in part unpaid, and upon which the address is legible, is found to contain a valuable enclosure a printed circular is sent to the party addressed requesting that the requisite amount of postage be forwarded in stamps and the letter will be forwarded to its proper address. A great many articles which are of value only to the send- ers or the persons for whom they are intended, such as little baby shoes, stockings, photographs, etc., etc., find their way to the Dead Letter office. Special effort is always made to deliver things of this character. Perhaps the little shoe or stocking may have belonged to some little one whose feet are still for- ever, and is being sent to a grandmother or some other near relation as a memento of the little one that is gone. Such articles as this may be of no possible value to anyone but the owners, but the post office authorities make as great an effort, even greater to deliver this class of articles, than they do money or jewels. At the present time in the Dead Letter office are great stores of small articles of very little or no value to any but the owners, waiting to be called for. CHAPTER XLII. ATTORNEY GENERAL. It will be readily perceived that, in a country developing so rapidly as ours, producing, thereby, an almost unbroken series of new situations, requiring a cautious application of old laws and the constant enactment of new ones, and so, a danger of confusion of legislative rules, that the President and his ATTORNEY GENERAL. •Cabinet would need a legal adviser of eminent ability, and <.f extensive acquirements in legal affairs, to give instructioD and counsel on various lines of action contemplated by tin- execu- tive branch of the government, and of the lawful course to be taken in the numerous particular cases constantly coming an for determination. Besides, various suits require to be insti- tuted or defended in the courts, by the government, and some officer is needed to prosecute or defend them in its name and interest. To answer these requirements, the office of Attorney Gen- eral was created by the first Congress in 1 7S9. He is a mem 1 ler of the Cabinet, is nominated by the President, and confirmed by the Senate, and is removable at the pleasure of the Presi- dent. He has an assistant and various clerks to aid him in the discharge of liis responsible duties. By an act passed in 1861 he is made Superintendent of all the Attorneys and Marshals in all the Judicial Districts of the United States. His office is at the seat of Government. The following is a complete list of the Attorneys General: ATTORNEYS GENERAL. Edmund Kandolph, Va., Sept. 26, 1789. William Bradford, Pa., June 27, 1794. Charles Lee, Va., Dec. 10, 1795. T. Parsons, Mass., Feb. 20, 1800. Levi Lincoln, Mass., March 5, 1801. Robert Smith, Md., March 2, 1805. John Breckinridge, Ky., Dec. 1806. Cfesar A. Eodney, Del., Jan. 20, 1807. William Pinckney, Md., Dec. 11, 1811. Richard Rush, Pa., Feb. 10, 1814. William Wirt, Md., Dec. 16, 1817. John McPherson Berrien, Ga., Mar. 9, 1829. Roger B. Taney, Md., July 20, L831. Benjamin F. Butler. \. Y .. Nov. 15, 1833. Felix Grundy, Tenn., July 7. L838. 374 PRESIDENTIAL ELECTORS. Henry D. Gilpin, Pa., Jan. 11, 1840. John J. Crittenden, Ivy., Mar. 5, 1841. Hugh S. Legare, S. C, Sept. 13, 1841. John Nelson, Md., July 1, 1843. John Y. Mason, Ya., Mar. 5, 1845. Nathan Clifford, Me., Oct. 16, 1846. Isaac Toucey, Ct., Jan. 21, 1848. Eeverdy Johnson, Md., Mar. 7, 1849. John J. Crittenden, Ky., July 20, 1850. Caleb Cashing, Mass., Mar. 5, 1853. Jeremiah S. Black, Pa., Mar. 6, 1857. Edwin M. Stanton, Pa., Dec. 14, 1860. Edward Bates, Mo., Mar. 5, 1861. James Speed, Ky., Dec. 1864. Henry Stanberry, O., July, 1866. William M. Evarts, N. Y., 1868. Eben E. Hoar, March 5, 1869. Amos T. Akerman, Ga., July 8, 1870. George H. Williams, Oregon, 1871. Edward Pierrepont, New York, 1875. CHAPTEE XLIII. PRESIDENTIAL ELECTORS. An Elector, in the sense of the Constitution, is one who has been appointed to choose or elect the President of the United States. Electors have been chosen in various ways. At first they were often appointed by the State Legislatures, or these passed a law directing their election by the people. This has gradually disappeared, and now the people, by law of Con- gress assemble on the first Tuesday after the first Monday in November preceding the close of a presidential term, and vote for the electors. The electors in each State are called its Electoral PRESIDENTIAL ELECTORS. College. They meet on the first Wednesday in December fol- lowing their election, in their respective States, and vote by ballot for a President and Vice-President, These cannot both, according to the Constitution, be citizens of the same St They count, certify, and seal these votes and send the Bealed package by a messenger, appointed for that express purpose, ti- the President of the United States Senate. On the Becond Wednesday in February following, the members of the Senate and House of Representatives assemble together, the pack- ages are opened and the votes counted in their presence, and the result is officially proclaimed. It is evident that this is now a mere form, and the President and Vice-President are virtually determined by the people in November. It i> not in harmony with the other parts of our system of government, which aims at simplicity and practical usefulness, and it will probably soon be dispensed with. It was originally designed, by those w r ho framed the Constitution, to act as a check to party spirit, and was expected to serve a very useful pur- pose. They felt the great importance attaching to the office of Chief Magistrate, on whom they had conferred so much power, and thought, by this means, to raise his election above disturbing influences. It was not expected that the candidates for those offices would come in question, in the popular elec- tions. The choice was designed to be left with the electors, with whom, being chosen by the people for that purpose, it was supposed they would feel safe in leaving it. It was believed that a select body of eminent men would act with more pru- dence and wisdom than the people at large. But the people felt themselves competent to judge for themselves, and have, like imperious sovereigns, imposed their choice on the Elecl so that that part of our constitutional machinery has become a dead letter. The people know their own mind.- better, and are more resolute in imposing their will on their representa- tives than was expected; and they have favorably disappointed the best hopes of those who believed most in their discretioi So we see that the failure of the Electoral System, planned 376 PRESIDENTIAL ELECTORS. by the Fathers of the Republic, is an honorable commentary on the ability of the people for self-government. Their success in making their own choice authoritative has led them to overlook the incongruity of the system, so that they have never resolutely required it to be abolished. Per- haps the idea that it might be useful in some important crisis of national affairs has had an influence to prevent interference with it. As its retention is attended with considerable expense, when questions of Economy come to take a leading place in public policy it is likely to be laid aside, in form, as well as in fact. The elections for President, Congressmen, Governors of the States and their Legislatures, determining the general policy of the government, and the class of men who shall be appointed to the various minor offices under its control; those who feel a strong interest in that policy from their judgment of its effect on the welfare of the country, or their desire to promote special measures; and those who are anxious to obtain or hold office, are very warmly interested in them. They divide into parties according to their views and exert themselves to the utmost to influence the result. Most human affairs have their good and bad side, and this is not an exception. This party warmth is useful in causing discussion, examination, and thought, and stirring up the people to a careful study of their institutions and the princi- ples of government, and the effect which particular measures may have on the public welfare. Its tendency, in this direc- tion is, to make all the people statesmen — a point of the high- est importance in a free government, where the People are Sovereign. The disadvantage is, that it often awakens an undue degree of passion and prejudice, the parties and men who are candidates for office abuse and misrepresent each other in order to destroy each others influence, when, perhaps, they are equally in earnest in seeking the good of the country. For this there is no apparent remedy, but in the intelligence and good sense of the people themselves. They must learn to bj HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. ;;77 careful and candid in their judgment of men and measu and to examine all sides of a question before rendering a decision. All should strive toward this intelligent moderal during important elections. CHAPTER XLIY. THE HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. The Presidents of the Continental Congress — as theLegisla- tive body of the United States was called up to 17*'.', when the new Constituion went in effect — were chosen by its members, which then consisted of only one House, in the same manner as the Speaker of the House of Representatives is chosen now; nor was his authority more extensive. He was simply the presiding officer of a legislative body; and one that had by no means the effective authority of our present Congress, although no body in the world ever more deserved the gratitude and reverence of all time; for it founded and gave direction and character to a great nation — it may be, the greatest the world will ever know. These Presidents had little, except the name, in common with the Presidents of the United States, as the Constitution made them. The Presidents Avere now to be appointed by the people, and become the depositaries of the Power of the Nation in Action. It was fit that, in a government deriving all its authority from the People, as the source of power, its Special Agent, its acting Representative, should be chosen by them. In the summer of 1788 three-fourths of the States had ratified the Constitution, and it became authoritative as the Fundamental Law of the country. The Continental Oongn therefore, closed its own career by ordering elections for the 378 HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. new Congress, and for the electors who were to appoint the first President. It directed that these elections should take place on the first Wednesday in January, 1789; that the electors should meet on the first Wednesday in February following, to discharge the duty to which they were appointed; and that, on the first Wednesday in March, (which, in that year, was the fourth,) Congress should meet, the President be inaugurated, and the new government be put in operation. This brought all these important events close upon the heels of one another; and on the 4th of March there was not a quorum of the Members of Congress assembled. The States lay far apart, and the roads were bad in those times, and at that season of the year. Though a bare quorum had gathered by the last of March, and many measures of pressing necessity were attended to, a full representation was waited for before the President elect was notified that they were ready for his inauguration; and that event took place only on the 30th of April. The presidential term, however, was considered to have legally commenced at the time previously ordered, and closed on that day of the year and month; so that it became the first day of our political year. It commences and closes the Presi- dent's term of office and ends the regular session of Congress First Election, 1789. There were but 69 electors, and the choice of George Wash- ington for President, and John Adams for Vice-President, was unanimous. He had declared, when resigning his commission as commander-in-chief, that he took leave "of all the employ- ments of public life," and only the earnest solicitations of the leading public men of the time, and their opinion that he alone could successfully inaugurate the new government* decided him to leave his cherished retirement. Washington's ambition was known to be free from spot or stain of self seek- ing, and his moderation and judgment were trusted in as the sheet anchor of a new government which many feared would become too strong for the liberties of the people. They HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL BLBOTK 379 dreaded an abuse of power; but they had do fear o'f Buch abuse while wielded by Washington. There was a Bolid foun- dation to Washington's tame, in his character. The presidential electors were mainly chosen by the State legislatures during the times immediately following the adop- tion of the Constitution. That instrument did not decide how they should be chosen, but left it to the discretion of the State governments. In some States conventions chose them, and the practice was various; but after a time it proved to 1"- more satisfactory to refer the choice directly to the people, and very soon the people themselves practically selected the President, the electors being pledged to the choice of the candidate favored by their constituents, so that their significance was lost. It is a proof of the popular character of our government. The system of electors indicated a fear of the people; a want of confidence in their judgment and self control. The elect- ors, it was supposed, would be wiser, less accessible to passion and caprice than those who elected them. The people Bel them quietly aside, and proceeded to do their own work them- selves, using the electors only to register their decision. Public men have seldom ventured to oppose the clearly formed and definite purposes of the people. The Second Election, 1792. Washington was again unanimously elected. He desired' to lay down the burdens of office; but so many perplexing questions and disturbing influences threatened the stability of the government that he could not be spared. His nam.- and character were a rock of strength. John Adams was re-elec Vice-President. Only 11 States had roted at the first electi North Carolina and Rhode Island not having then ratified 1 Constitution. They had now done so, and Vermont and I tucky had been admitted, so that there were 15 Stat at this election. There were 132 electors. Washington declined another election absolutely, and the government proved so suitable as to be fairly settled in the confidence ol the people. 380 history of presidential elections. The Third Election, 1796. Four persons were voted for at this election. John Adams received 71 electoral votes. Thomas Jefferson " 69 " " Thomas Pinckney " 59 " " Aaron Burr " 38 " a As, by the Constitutional provision regarding electors, the person having the largest number of votes became President, and the one who had the next in number became Vice-Presi- dent, Adams was now President, and Jefferson Vice-Presi- dent. Tennessee had now been admitted into the Union, and there were 16 States voting. Conflicting views on foreign policy, and vexing questions of internal administration began to exert a strong influence, and party spirit, for the next twenty years, was very bitter. Mr. Adams was a Federalist; Mr. Jefferson was an anti-Federalist. The Fourth Election, 1800. The same candidates were again in the field. The political parties had become clearly defined. Adams and Pinckney were the Federal candidates, receiving — Adams, 61, Pinckney 63, electoral votes, while Jefferson and Burr had each 73. They were of the anti-Federal, or Republican party. The election did not decide which of the two, Jefferson or Burr, should be President and Vice-President, and, by the provisions of the Constitution, the House of [Representatives decided it in favor of Jefferson. Party heats were so great that it took 7 days and 36 ballots to reach this result. It was felt that there was a defect in the Constitutional provision that left it undecided, in such a case, which of the candidates was the choice of the electors for President, and it resulted in the ratification of the 12th amendment before the next election. .The Federal party never regained the power of adminis- tration lost at this election, though they continued to be a strong opposition until the close of the war of 1812. But HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTION8. 381 an opposition, to criticize and point out faults, is often m useful out of office than in; and the Republican party was obliged to adopt substantially the general features of the policy pursued by their predecessors, while they added some very important ones of their own, in their disposition to favor popular rights. The Fifth Election, 1804. Thomas Jefferson and George Clinton were the candidates of the Republicans. Charles C. Pinckney and Rufus King of the Federalists. Jefferson was popular, and received 162 votes-- Clinton receiving the same. Pinckney and King received only 14 votes. The admission of Ohio, in 1802, made 17 States to vote at this election. The Federal party w T as much weaker than in the following election. The Sixth Election, 1808. James Madison was the Republican candidate for Presi- dent, and Geo. Clinton for Vice-President. Pinckney and King were again candidates on the part of the Federalists. Madison received 123 electoral votes. Clinton " 113 " Pinckney and King each, 47 " " Geo. Clinton died before the end of his term. There was I same number of States voting as in the previous election, viz.: 17. The Seventh Election, 1812. Madison was re-elected, with Elbridge Gerry as Vice P •■• dent. They each received 128 electoral votes. De Witt Clinton and Jared Ingersoll, the candidates oi the Federal party, received, Clinton 89, [ngersoll 57, rotes. Louis- iana having been recently admitted into the CTnion, there were now 18 States. War with England was formally declared this year. It had 382 HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. actually begun on the ocean sometime before. It was a very trying and painful presidential term, owing to the violent and injudicious opposition made to the measures of the govern- ment, and the unfortunate choice of generals for the first two years; yet the ultimate result was highly creditable to the standing and reputation of the United States, and put an end to the annoying and insulting interferences with our vessels and commerce that had brought it on. It was a war waged for the honor and inviolability of our Flag, which was ever after duly respected. The Eighth Election, 1816. James Monroe and Daniel D. Tompkins were the candidates of the Republicans, who now began to be called Democrats. The Federalist party was now near its end. It nominated Ruins King who received 34 electoral votes, Monroe obtain- ing 183. Indiana was admitted this year in time to vote, making 19 States. This period marked an important era in the internal history, as well as foreign relations, of the country. The period of trial for the Constitution was passed, and full confi- dence began to be felt in the system it had founded. The Ninth Election, 1820. Monroe and Tompkins were re-elected, the vote being sub- stantially unanimous, for the first and last time since Wash- ington. The close of this term made the Republican rule in the administration 24 years in succession, under three Presi- dents, each once re-elected, and all citizens of Virginia. Four new States had been admitted during the previous term, viz.: Mississippi, Illinois, Alabama, and Maine, so that 23 States took part in this election. The Tenth Election, 1824. Four candidates were in the field for the presidency at this election. Missouri having been admitted since the ninth elec- HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIO tion there were 24 States to vote. The whole cumber of i was 201; necessary to a choice, 131. The candidates and votes were as follows: Andrew Jackson '.)',» John Quincy Adams $4 Win. H. Crawford 4 1 Henry Clay 31 By the Constitution the House of Representatives was required to select the President from the 3 candidates having the highest number of votes. They were to vote by States, and a majority of States would elect. J. Q. Adams received the vote of 13 States, and was declared elected. John C. ( Sal- houn having received 182 electoral votes for the Vice-Presi- dency, was thereby elected to that office. 18 of the States appointed the electors by popular vote and 6 appointed them by their legislatures. The Eleventh Election, 1828. Andrew Jackson was elected President, and John C. Cal- houn re-elected Vice-President. John Quincy Adams and Richard Rush were also candidates for President and Vice-President, respectively. The contest was very hot and bitter. Jackson received 17s, and Adams 171 electoral votes. The Popular vote was 650,028 for Jack- son to 512,158 for Adams. The number of electors was the same as in the 10th election. The most violent excitement divided the north and the south on the tariff question, which culminated during this term in the "nullification ordinam which Jackson met with the decision and vigor for which la' was distinguished, ending in the submission of the ni Calhoun resigned his office as Vice-President, Dec. 28th, 1832. He was the leader of the nullifiers. Tine Twelfth Election, 1832. Jackson's vigorous dealing with nullification was highly approved by the people, and he was re-elected, with Martin Van Buren as Vice-President. 3SJ. HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. Henry Clay was the candidate of the Whig party for Presi- dent, and John Sergeant for Vice-President. Jackson received 682,502 popular, and 219 electoral votes. Clay " 550,189 " " 49 i( u Jackson's majority 132,313 170 Yan Buren received 189 electoral votes for Vice-President. Twenty-four States voted at this election. The Thirteenth Election, 1836. Van Buren was run, by the Democrats, for the Presidency, and Ki chard M. Johnson for the Vice-Presidency, against Wra. H. Harrison, Hugh L. White, Daniel Webster, and W. P. Mangum. Van Buren 's vote was 762,149 popular, and 170 electoral. Harrison and the others united was 736,736 popu- lar, and 124 electoral. The whole number of electors being 294, the number necessary to a choice was 148. Johnson failed by one electoral vote to be elected to the Vice-Presidency, and the case went to the Senate for decision, as directed by the Constitution. The remaining electoral votes for Vice-Presi- dent being divided between 3 candidates, Johnson was appointed by the Senate. Michigan and Arkansas having been admitted this year took part in the election, making 26 States. The Fourteenth Election, 1840. The Whig party this year concentrated on Wm. H. Harri- son for President, and John Tyler for Vice-President. The Democrats opposed them with Van Buren and Johnson again. The country had been passing through a financial crisis of extreme severity during the thirteenth presidential term, and this election, involving the decision of a financial policy, was very exciting. Harrison was an Ohio farmer, and, the Democrats said, " lived in a log cabin and drank hard cider." The Whigs took the hint, built log cabins to hold their campaign gatherings in, drank much hard cider, and sung stirring political songs. IIISTOKY OF PRESIDENTIAL Kl.l-.cil. Harrison's popular vote was 1,274,783 — his electoral rote Van Buren's " " " 1,128,702 Majority, 4r.,nsl 171 Tyler's vote as Vice-President was the same as Harrison's. Harrison died on the 4th of April, one month after hie inauguration, and John Tyler succeeded to the Presidency, 1 1 i - term was made remarkable by his disagreement with the m. a- ures of Congress, on financial questions. This was the first time a Vice-President had been called on to serve as a substitute for the President. There were 26 States taking part in this election. The Fifteenth Election, 1844. The slavery question entered into this election as a leading point. The Republic of Texas asked admission into the Union. As it would be certain to be a slave State, and many of the people objected to extending that institution while others favored it, the parties took it up; the Democrats favoring the admission, the Whigs opposing. James K. Polk was the candidate for President, and Go. M. Dallas for Vice-President, run by the Democrats. The Whigs opposed against them Henry Clay and Theod' Frelinghuysen. The vote for Polk and Dallas was 1,335,834, electoral vote 1 7" " " Clay and Frelinghuysen 1,297,033, " " 103 Polk and Dallas' majority, 38,601 This was the third time Mr. Clay had been defeated afi ■ candidate for the Presidency, to the great regrel of man of those who voted against him. The war with Mexico followed as a consequence of the pol icy of the United States government, decided upon in thia election. Texas had formerly been a pari of Mexico, and that country considered its admission into the dnion a- an sol of hostility to herself. 25 386 history of presidenti , elections. Sixteenth Election, 1848. The Whigs were successful in this election, owing to a divis- ion in the ranks of the Democratic party. The Whigs nomi- nated Gen. Zachary Taylor for President, and Millard Fill- more for Vice-President; the Democrats Lewis Cass for Presi- dent, and Wm. O. Butler for Vice-President; the Free Soil Democrats — who opposed the extension of slaver} 7 — Martin Van Buren for President, and Charles F. Adams for Vice- President. The vote resulted thus: Taylor and Fillmore's popular vote 1,362,024, electoral vote 163 Cass and Butler's " " 1,222,419, " " 127 Van Buren and Adams' " " 291,678. The third ticket secured no electoral votes. Four new States had been admitted into the Union since the 15th election, viz.: Texas, Florida. Iowa, and Wisconsin; and 30 States voted this year. Gen. Taylor died July 9th, 1850, one } r ear, four months, and four days after his inauguration, and Mr. Fillmore filled out his term of office. The Seventeenth Election, 1852. During the previous Presidential term the subject of slavery, and the strategy of politicians in favor of and against it, absorbed public attention. The repeal of the Missouri Com- promise of 1820 opened the whole question, and a trial of strength as to which side should occupy the new territory, was prepared for. The crisis of preparation had not been reached when this election occurred, and comparatively little interest was taken in it. The Democrats nominated Franklin Pierce for President, and Wm. R King for Vice-President; the Whigs chose as their candidates Gen. Winfield Scott for President, and Wm. A. Graham for Vice-President. Pierce and King received, of popular votes 1,590,490, of electoral, 254. Scott and Graham received, of popular votes, HISTORY OF I'KKSIDKNTIAr, KLECtlOVB. 887 1,378,589, of electoral, 42. Pierce's majority, on popular vote, 211,901, on electoral, 212. California had been admitted since the l(jth election, and there were 31 States to vote in this. This was the last election in which the Whig party nomi- nated a candidate. The contest in regard to Blare and free ter- ritory absorbing all the interest of the country, the parties were rearranged, those in favor of slavery, or wishing to l< that institution undisturbed, gathered to the Democratic party; while those wishing to actively oppose the extension of alai - ry to territory not yet occupied by it, united, under the name of the Republican party, the Whigs becoming extinct, as a party. The Eighteenth Election, l.^r>ii. The Democrats nominated James Buchanan, and John 0. Breckenridge for President and Vice-President; the Republi- cans, John C. Fremont and William L. Dayton. A third party, in favor of putting only native Americans in office, voted for Millard Fillmore and Andrew J. Donnelson. The result was the following: Popular vote for Buchanan and Breckenridge 1,803,029, electoral, 174. Popular vote for Fremont and Dayton 1,342,164, electoral, 114. Popular vote for Fillmore and Donnelson, 874,625, electoral, 8. Buchanan had only what is called a plurality popular vote; the two others united had a majority over him of 413,760 votes. A majority of electoral votes, however, was 1 L9, and he received 174, and a majority of 52 electoral votes over the others united. Only 31 States voted at this election. Mr. Buchanan was much blamed for not taking more vigorous measures to quench the secession movement that commenced in the last months of his administration. The contrast between his course and Jackson's in 1832 was very marked. The Nineteenth Election, I860. The Kepublican party nominated Abraham Lincoln tor President, and Hannibal Hamlin for 7ice-President The 388 HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL ELECTIONS. south, finding it impossible to uphold the slavery extension system against the growing Republican party, and the com- promise that had protected that system having been laid aside in 1850, must submit to the gradual extinction of slavery, or withdraw from the Union. They chose the latter, and favored the division of the Democratic party, which was still much the largest, into several parts. Three tickets of that party were run, against one in the Republican, which assured the election of Lincoln. The Northern Democrats voted mainly for Stephen A. Doug- las and H. V. Johnson; the Southern Democrats for John C. Breekenridge and Joseph Lane; and those who wished to stop the contest on the slavery question altogether, on both sides, v.i ted for John Bell and Edward Everett. The result was as follows: The vote for Lincoln and Hamlin was 1,866,452, electoral 180 " " Douglas and Johnson 1,370,157, " 72 " " Breekenridge and Lane 847,953, " 39 « " Bell and Everett 590,631, " 12 The three divisions of the Democrats together had a popu- lar majority of 947,289 over the Republicans, but the latter had a majority of 57 electoral votes over all the others united. Two new States had been admitted since the eighteenth elec- tion, Minnesota and Oregon, and there were 33 States voting. The census of 1860 gave the population as 31,148,048. All the votes cast at^his election amounted to 4,680,193, the largest number by more than 500,000 that had ever been known. The Southern States seceded within a few months, and the Civi] "War began. It was remarkable as the most gigantic war of its kind, perhaps of any kind, known in history; and for the obstinate bravery and resolution displayed on both sides. It continued, during this entire presidential term. The Twentieth Election, 1864. The election this year was confined to the States that had remained loyal to the Constitution and the Union. Eleven States had seceded. HISTORY OF PRESIDENTIAL i u < m The Republicans re-nominated Lincoln for President, with Andrew Johnson for Vice-President, The Democratic pa nominated Gen. Geo. B. McClellan for President, and Geo. 11. Pendleton for Vice-President. The result was as follow The popular vote for Lincoln and Johnson was 2,223,036 " « " " McClellan and Pendleton 1,811,764 Lincoln's popular majority 411,281 Electoral votes for Lincoln 212 " " " McClellan 21 Lincoln's electoral majority 191 The total number of popular votes was 4,034,7S9. Lincoln's vote at this election was the largest that had ever been casl for one candidate, though there were less votes cast by all parties by 600,000 than in the nineteenth election. Two new States, Kansas and West Virginia, had been admitted since the | vious election, which with the 11 in rebellion omitted, left 24 States voting. The civil war closed with the submission of the seceded States to the general government soon after Lincoln's re-inaug- uration; but he was assassinated about the same time, ou the evening of April 13th, 1865, and died on the following day, leaving a nation in mourning, and the civilized world Bfruck with horror. Andrew Johnson acted as President during the remainder of this term. Mr. Johnson's administration was marked by the great difference in the policy of r» Btrncting the seceded States adopted by him and by the Congress, by the limitations which the latter threw aroundhim,and the attempt to impeach him, which tailed by a few votes. The Twenty-First Election, L868. Gen. Ulysses S.Grant was nominated by the Repnbli for President, and Schuyler Colfax for Vice-President. The nominees of the Democratic party were Horatio B«y- mour and Francis P. Blair. 390 CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. Grant's popular majority was 309,588. Questions of recon- struction and finance were determined by this election, the people upholding the policy pursued by Congress since the close of the war. The Twenty-Second Election, 1872. Grant was nominated by the Republican party for Presi- dent, and Henry Wilson for Vice-President. The Democrats nominated Horace Greeley for President, and B. Gratz Brown for Vice-President. A second Democratic party had a ticket, nominating Chas. O'Connor and J. Q. Adams. Grant's popular majority was 762,991 ; and he received 218 electoral votes. 30 States gave him majorities, Pennsylvania reaching 137,000 majority in his favor. The whole popular vote at this election was 6,431,149. The colored people voted for the first time, under the amendment to the Constitution abolishing the distinction in citizenship in regard to color. The elections are now held on the same day in all the States, by a general law. The number of States voting at the 22d election was thirty-seven. This election set a final seal on the policy of the Republican party, leaving the country free to turn its attention to other questions relating to its internal interests. CHAPTER XLV. CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. For convenience of reference we insert a list of the members of the Cabinet in each administration from 1789 down to 1874, to which is added the name of the Vice-President of each presidential term, though he is not a member of the Cabinet. First Administration, from 1789 to 1797 — 7 years, 10 months, AND 4 DAYS. George Washington, Va., President. John Adams, Mass., Vice-President. (( a a a a a CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. 391 CABINET. Thomas Jefferson, Va., Secretary of State. Edmund Kandolph, Va., " " Timothy Pickering, Mass., " " Alexander Hamilton, N. Y., Secretary of the Treasury. Oliver Wolcott, Conn., " « « Timothy Pickering, Mass., Secretary of War. James McHenry, Md., Henry Knox, Mass., Second Administration, 1797 to 1801 — 4 years. John Adams, Mass., President. Thomas Jefferson, Ya., Vice-President. CABINET. Timothy Pickering, Mass., Secretary of State. John Marshall, Va., " " " Oliver Wolcott, Ct., Secretary of the Treasury. Samuel Dexter, Mass., " " " James McHenry, Md., Secretary of War. Samuel Dexter, Mass., Roger Griswold, George Cabot, Mass., Secretary of the Navy. Benjamin Stoddert, Md., " " " Third Administration, 1801 to 1809 — 8 tears. Thomas Jefferson, Va., President. Aaron Burr, 1ST. Y., Vice-President. George Clinton, K Y., " CABINET, James Madison, Va., Secretary of State. Samuel Dexter, Mass., Secretary of the Treasury. Albert Gallatin, Pa., " " " Henry Dearborn, Mass., Secretary of War. Bc-jamin Stodde? ' '.V- . -■— ' v of the Navy. cert St~: : . ... , Fourth Administration, 1809 to 1817—8 years. James Madison, Va., President. a a ii ii ii ii 392 CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. George Clinton, N. Y., Vice-President. El bridge Gerry, Mass., " CABINET. Robert Smith, Md., Secretary of State. James Monroe, Va., " " " Albert Gallatin, Pa., Secretarj of the Treasury. George W. Campbell, Tenn., " « « Alexander J. Dallas, Pa., " " " William Eustis, Mass., Secretary of War. John Armstrong, N. Y., " " " James Monroe, Va., " " " William H. Crawford, Ga., " « « Paul Hamilton, S. C, Secretary of the Navy. William Jones, Pa., " " " B. W. Crowninshield, Mass. " " " Ftfth Administration, 1817 to 1825 — 8 years. James Monroe, Va., President. Daniel D. Tompkins, N. Y., Vice-President. CABINET. John Q. Adams, Mass., Secretary of State. William H. Crawford, Ga., Secretary of the Treasury. Isaac Shelby, Ky., Secretary of War. John C. Calhoun, S. C, " " « B. W. Crowninshield, Mass., Secretary of the Navy. Smith Thompson, N. Y., " " « Samuel L. Southard, N. J., « « « Sixth Adivhnistration, 1825 to 1829 — £ years. John Q. Adams, Mass., President. John C. Calhoun, S. C, Vice-President. CABINET. Henry Clay, Ky., Secretary of State. Richard Rush, Pa., Secretary of the Treasury. James Barbour, Va., Secretary of War. Peter B. Porter, 1ST. Y., " " « Samuel L. Southard, N. J., Secretary of the Navy. CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. Seventh Administbation, 1829 to L887 — 8 trass, Andrew Jackson, Tenn., President. John C. Calhoun, S. 0., Vice-President. Martin Van Buren, K Y., " CABINET. Martin Van Buren, N. Y., Secretary of State. Edward Livingston, La., " " " Louis McLane, Del., " " " John Forsyth, Geo., " " « Samuel D. Ingham, Pa., Secretary of the Treasury. Louis McLane, Del., William J. Duane, Pa., Roger B. Taney, Md., Levi Woodbury, N. H., John II. Eaton, Tenn., Secretary of War. Lewis Cass, Mich., Benjamin F. Butler, K Y., " John Branch, N. C, Secretary of the Navy. Levi Woodbury, K II., " Mahlon Dickerson, N. J., " POSTMASTERS GENERAL, And for the first time considered members of the Cabinet, John McLean, 0. William F. Barry, Ky. Amos Kendall, Ky. Eighth Administration, 1837 to 1841 — 1 years. Martin Van Buren, N. Y., President, Richard M. Johnson, Ky., Vice-President. CABINEr. John Forsyth, Geo., Secretary of State. Levi Woodbury, N. H., Secretary of the Treasury. Joel R. Poinsett, S. C, Secretary of War. Mahlon Dickerson, N. J., Secretary of the Navy. James K. Paulding, N. Y., - " " Amos Kendall, Ky., Postmaster General. John M. Niles, Ct., " " (< a u (( ii il a a a a a a Wai « a I ii it 394 cabinets of all the presidents. Ninth Administration, March 4, 1841, to April 4, 1841. "William Henry Harrison, O., President. John Tyler, Va., Vice-President. CABINET. Daniel Webster, Mass., Secretary of State. Thomas Ewing, O., Secretary of the Treasury. John Bell, Tenn., Secretary of War. George E. Badger, N. C, Secretary of the Navy. Gideon Granger, N. Y., Postmaster General. Tenth Administration, April 6, 1841, to March 4, 1845. John Tyler, Va., (acting) President, by death of Harrison. cabinet. Daniel Webster, Mass., Secretary of State. Abel P. Upshur, Va., " " " John C. Calhoun, S. C, " " « Thomas Ewing, O., Secretary of the Treasury. Walter Forward, Pa., " " « John C. Spencer, N. Y., " " « George M. Bibb, Ky., " « « John Bell, Tenn., Secretary of War. John C. Spencer, N. Y., " " " James M. Porter, Pa., " " " William Wilkins, Pa., " " " George E. Badger, N. C, Secretary of the Navy. Abel P. Upshur, Va., " " " David Henshaw, Mass., " " " G. W. Gilmer, Va., " « « John Y. Mason, Va., " " « Hugh S. Legar6, S. C, Attorney-General. John Nelson, Md., " " Francis G. Granger, N. Y., Postmaster General. Charles A. Wickliffe, Ky., " " Eleventh Administration, March 4, 1845, to March 4, 1849. 4 years. James K. Polk, Tenn., President. George M. Dallas, Pa., Vice-President. CABINETS OF ALL THE I'KI M DI..NT8. 395 CABINET. James Buchanan, Pa., Secretary of State. - Robert J. Walker, Miss., Secretary of the Treasury. "William L. Marcy, N. Y., Secretary of War. George Bancroft, Mass., Secretary of the Navy. John Y. Mason, Va., " " « Cave Johnson, Tenn., Postmaster General. John Y. Mason, Va., Attorney General. Nathan Clifford, Me., " " Isaac Toucey, Ct., " " Twelfth Administration, March 4, 1849, to July 10, 1850 — 1 year and 4 months. Zachary Taylor, La., President. Millard Fillmore, N. Y., Vice-President. CABINET. John M. Clayton, Del., Secretary of State. George W. Crawford, Geo., Secretary of War. William M. Meredith, Pa., Secretary of the Treasury. William B. Preston, Va., Secretary of the Navy. Thomas Ewing, Ohio, Secretary of the Interior. Jacob Collamer, Vt., Postmaster General. Reverdy Johnson, Md., Attorney General. Thirteenth Administration, July 10, 1850, to March 4, 1S53. 2 years and 8 Months. Millard Fillmore, (acting) President by death of Taylor. No Vice-President. CABINEr. Daniel Webster, Mass., Secretary of State. Thomas Corwin, Ohio, Secretary of the Treasury. Charles M. Conrad, La., Secretary of War. William A. Graham, N. C, Secretary of the Navy. Alexander H. II. Stuart, Va., Secretary of the Interior. Nathan K. Hall, N. Y., Postmaster General. John J. Crittenden, Ky., Attorney General. Fourteenth Administration, March 4, 1853, to March 4. 1857. Franklin Pierce, N. II., President. 396 CABINETS OF ALT. THE PRESIDENTS. William P. King, of Ala., who was elected Vice-Presi- dent with Mr. Pierce, but died before he took his seat, and there was no Vice-President during Pierce's administration. CABINET. William L. Marcy, N. Y., Secretary of State. James Guthrie, Ky., Secretary of the Treasury. Jefferson Davis, Miss., Secretary of War. J. C. Dobbin, N. C, Secretary of the Navy. Robert McClelland, Mich., Secretary of the Interior. James Campbell, Pa., Postmaster General. Caleb dishing, Mass., Attorney General. Fifteenth Administration, March 4, 1857, to March 4, 1861. James Buchanan, Pa., President. John C. Breckenridge, Vice-President. CABINET. Lewis Cass, Mich., and Jeremiah S. Black, Pa., Secretaries of State. Howell Cobb, Ga., Philip F. Thomas, and John A. Dix, N. Y., Secretaries of the Treasury. John B. Floyd, Va., and Joseph Holt, Ky., Secretaries of War. Isaac Toucey, Ct., Secretary of the Navy. Jacob Thompson, Miss., Secretary of the Interior. Aaron V. Brown, Tenn., Joseph Holt, Ky., and Horatio King, Postmasters General. Jeremiah S. Black, Pa., and Edwin M. Stanton, Pa., Attor- neys General. Sixteenth Administration, March 4, 1861, to April 14, 1865, 4 years, 1 month, and 10 days. Abraham Lincoln, 111., President. Hannibal Hamlin, Me., Vice-President, first term, and An- drew Johnson, Tenn., Vice-President, second term. CABINET. William IT. Seward, N. Y., Secretary of State. Salmon P. Chase, Ohio, William P. Fessenden, Me., Hugh CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. -I 1 ? McCulloch, Ind., Secretaries of the Treasury. Simon Cameron, Pa., Edwin M. Stanton. Pa.', Secretaries oi War. Gideon Welles, Conn., Secretary of the Navy. John P. Usher, Ind., Secretary of the Interior. Montgomery Blair, Md., William Dennison, O., Postmas- ters General. Edward Bates, Mo., James Speed, Ky., Attorneys General. Seventeenth Administration, April 15, 1865, to [March 4,1809. Andrew Johnson, acting President. No Vice-President. cabinet. William H. Seward, N. Y., Secretary of State. Hugh McCulloch, Ind., Secretary of the Treasury. Edwin M. Stanton, Pa., Ulysses S. Grant, 111., and J. M. Scho- field, Secretaries of War. Gideon Welles, Conn., Secretary of the Navy. James Harlan, Iowa, Orville H. Browning, 111., Secretaries of the Interior. James Speed, Ky., Henry Stanbery, Ohio, William M. Evarts, N. Y., Attorneys General. William Dennison, Ohio, Alexander W. Randall, Wis., Post- masters General. Eighteenth Administration, March 4, 1869, to March 4, 1873. Ulysses S. Grant, 111., President. Schuyler Colfax, Ind., Vice-President, CABINET. Elihu B. Washburne, 111., Secretary of State. Hamilton Fish, N. Y., " " " George S. Boutwell, Mass., Secretary of the Treasury. John A. Rawlins, Secretary of War. William T. Sherman, " " " William W.Belknap, " " " Adolph E. Borie, Pa., Secretary of the Navy. George M. Robeson, N. J., " 398 CABINETS OF ALL THE PRESIDENTS. Jacob D. Cox, Ohio, Secretary of the Interior. Columbus Delano, O., " " " J. A. J. Creswell, Md., Postmaster General. Eben Rockwood Hoar, Mass., Attorney General. Amos T. Akerman, Ga., " " Nineteenth Administration, March 4, 1873, to March 4, 1877. Ulysses S. Grant, III, President. Henry Wilson, Mass., Vice-President. cabinet. Hamilton Fish, N. Y., Secretary of State. W. A. Richardson, 111., Secretary of the Treasury. B. H. Bristow, Ky., " " « W. W. Belknap, Iowa, Secretary of War. George M. Robeson, N. J., Secretary of the Navy. Columbus Delano, Ohio, Secretary of the Interior. J. A. J. Creswell, Md., Postmaster General. Marshall Jewell, Conn., " " George H. Williams, Oregon, Attorney General. Edward Pierrepont, N. Y., « u V,c< ft} * oc^Zsri* ' " UNITED STATES GOVERNMKNT. 399 UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT. 18T5. The Executive. ULYSSES S. GRANT, of Illinois, President of the United States Salary $50,000 HENRY WILSON, of Massachusetts, Vice-President of the United States, 10,000 The Cabinet. HAMILTON PISH, of New York, Secretary of State Salary $ ".inn B H BKISTOW, of Kentucky, Secretary of the Treus ury WILLIAM W. BELKNAP, of Iowa, Secretary of !»'«/•- ------ GEORGE M. ROBESON, of New Jersey, Secretary of the Aary COLUMBUS DELANO, of Ohio, Secretary of the Interior EDWARD PIERREPONT, of New York, Attorney-General MARSHALL JEWELL, of Connecticut, Postmaster-General 10,OUU The Judiciary. supreme court of the united states. MORRISON R. WAITE, Chief Justice Salary $10,600 Nathan Clifford, of Me., Associate Justice. Noah H. Swayne, of Ohio, Samuel F. Miller, of Iowa, David Davis, of Illinois, Stephen J. Field, of Cal.,AS80da William M. STRONG, of Pa., Joseph P. Bradley, ol N.J. Ward Hunt, of New York. Salary of Associates $10,000. Court meets first Monday in December, at Washil Ministers to Foreign Countries envoys extraordinary and ministers plenipotk v tl ml y COUNTRY. CAPITAL. MINISTERS. BALABT. AI'P't'd. Austria Vienna Hon. Godlove 8. Orth, Ind $12,000 1876 Brazil Rio Janeiro James R. Partridge, Md 12,000 1871 Chili Santiago Cornelius A. Logan, Kansas 10,000 1*. ■; china Pekin Frederick F. Low, Cal I2,ooo France Paris Elilm B. Washburnc, 111 17,500 Great Britain London Robert C. Schenck, Ohio 17,500 Italy Rome George P. Marsh. Vt 12,000 1861 Mexico Mexico John W. Foster. Indiana 12.0(H) Peru Lima Francis Thomas. Md 10,000 Germany Berlin J. C. Bancroft Davis 17,600 Russia St. Petersburgh ..George H. Boker, Pa 17,500 Spain Madrid Caleb Cashing, Muss 18,000 IB! » MINISTERS RESIDENT. Argentine Republic... Buenos Ayres... Julius White. Ill 7,600 1878 Belgium. Brussels J. R. Jones, 111 7,600.... Bolivia La Paz John T. Croxton, Ky 7,600 18 Central Amer. States.. San Jose George Williamson, La 10,000 18 Denmark Copenhagen M.J. Cramer, Ky 7,600 18 Ecuador Quito E. Ramsey Wing, Ky 7,500 — Greece Athens J Meredith Read, l'a 7,500... Hawaiian Islands Honolulu Henry A. Pierre. Mass 7,500 1 Japan Yeddo John A. Bingham, Ohio 13 Netherlands Hague Charles T. Gorham, Mich 7,500 Portugal Lisbon Benjamin Moran, Va 7,50 Sweden and Norway. .Stockholm C.C. Andrews, Minn Switzerland Berne Horace Rublee, Wis 7 "■ " Turkey Constantinople.. Hon. Horace Maynard, Tenn 7,500 Uruguay do all— and do more nor less — than the people would do, if it were possible for them to assemble in one great body and make the laws by which they wish to be governed. It was constituted as wisely, to guard against the errors to which humanity is liable, as the experience of the past per- mitted to the thoughtful and patriotic statesmen who had charge of the organization of the government, when the suc- cessful termination of the War of Independence left the inter- ests of a new Nation in their hands. England, from which they had mostly sprung, and which governed them until thai period, was in possession of the freest and most enlightened government of those times, in the Old World; and they copied from her institutions and general structure what they judged adapted to our circumstances; prudently avoiding untried experiments, as far as possible. 4. Congress, like the English Parliament, consists of two Houses, one, the House of Representatives, (answering to the English House of Commons) being directly elected, for a Bhort term, by the people, so as to express their views and interests as clearly as possible; the other, the Senate, (answering par- tially to the English House of Lords) appointed by the State Legislatures for a longer term, and from among statesmen of acknowledged ability and mature character and expend This was expected to supply the necessary check to hasty and ill considered action, as they were required to mutually agree on all laws enacted. 5. Both are required to assemble, at the same time, In the Capitol at Washington, on the tii-M Monday in December of each year. This is the regular session — extr bei 26 402 CONGRESS. occasionally called by the President when unusual circumstan- ces demand it. The members of the House of Eepresentatives are elected for two years, the members of the Senate for six. As the first contains by far the largest number, a Congress is said to exist for two years, and the 20th Congress would be the one existing during the 40th and 41st years of the Kepublic, dating from the first Congress in 1789. THE SENATE 6. Is composed of two persons, chosen by the legistature of each State, to represent it as a whole. It makes no differ- ence whether the State be large or small, whether population counts by the million or the thousand. The States are sov- ereign in their sphere, and this constitution of the Senate keeps that fact in view, operates against undue centralization of power, and oppression of the smaller States by the larger. 7. A Senator must be thirty years of age, must have been nine years a citizen, (he may have been born in a foreign State, and a citizen of it previously,) and must be a citizen of the State — (a voter in it) at the time of appointment. He is appointed for six years. The Senate is arranged in three classes so that the terms of one-third of the whole number shall expire every two years. They may be re-elected as often as the State legislatures choose. In one case, a Senator was continued thirty years in the Senate, without intermission. It has equal legislative power with the House of Representatives, except that it cannot originate laws for raising money, but it must approve and adopt all laws made by the House to render them valid. It has some powers that do not belong to the House. It confirms or rejects the nominations of the Presi- dent, to office, and the treaties he makes with foreign powers, and is the only High Court of Impeachment. 8. When the Senate meets to consider the nominations of the President to office, it is called an Executive Session, and only a majority of votes is required to approve or confirm them; but when a treaty is to be ratified, or judgment given C0NGRE88. |03 in a case of impeachment, a vote of two-thirds of the memb present is required. The Vice-President of the United States is the presiding officer of the Senate; hut in ease of a vacancv in that office, when he is acting as President, or it' he he absent, it ehooi a president from its own members. THE HOUSE OF REPRESENTATIVES 9. Is composed of persons elected by the people in the various States, in proportion to the number of inhabitants. A Representative is elected for a term of two years. He niu-t be twenty-five years of age, must have been a citizen of the United States seven years, and must be a citizen of the State he represents. This is often called the "Lower House," or popular branch of the National Legislature, as the Senate is sometimes called the " Upper House," because it is more Beleot and greater in dignity. 10. The House of Representatives has the sole power of presenting articles of Impeachment, and it alone can originate laws for raising revenue. A larger part of the laws are actually originated in it, because it is more numerous, its members bet- ter known to the people whom they immediately represent, and the people are better acquainted with them; and more peti- tions for particular laws are sent to them. Each repress ative is voted for by the people of his Congressional District alone, and not by all the people of each State; and he specially represents the views and wants of his District. In each branch of Congress, when a Bill, or plan of a law, has been passed, it is sent to the other House, where il referred to a Committee who examine it, and report on it to the House; by which it is discussed and adopted, amended, rejected according to its judgment, and returned to the Hi in which it originated. By this method every law is meant to be subjected to a careful and cool investigation, its detect - dis- covered and corrected, and its appropriateness clearly m manifest. Whoever will examine, with care and thorough: the whole structure of our government will everywhere die- 404 CONGRESS. cover traces of the same wisdom and watchful foresight. He will see reason for more admiration of the prudent statesman- ship of those who organized our institutions, and feel less sur- prised at the wonderful prosperity of the country, and at the strength of the government when subjected to the severest trial. Everything human is more or less imperfect, and we- shall never be without subjects of complaint, and opportuni- ties for improvement; but every American, well informed con- cerning his own and foreign governments, will discover many weighty reasons for self-congratulation and pride that our first statesmen and people were so wise and prudent in laying the foundation, and that their successors have built on it with so much skill. 11. The presiding officer in the House of Representatives is called " The Speaker," and is chosen by the House, at the the beginning of each Congress. He serves during its two years of existence. The Clerk of the House and its minor officers are chosen by its members — and each House makes, its own rules, or Parliamentary Laws. The term Congress properly covers both branches of the National Legislature; but, by custom, the members of the upper house are called Senators, and those of the lower Members of Congress, (com- monly abbreviated to M. C.) 12. The Compensation of Members of Congress was origi- nally fixed at eight dollars a day, but has, of late years, been several times changed. In 1856 it was made $3,000 per ses- sion, or $6,000 for a Congress of two years. In 1866 it was increased to $5,000 per session, and, in 1873 to $7,500 per session, the Speaker of the House, and the President of the Senate, by this last law, receiving $10,000 per year; but it produced so much dissatisfaction among the people that the law was changed at the following session, and they now receive $5,000 per annum. 13. The members of each house receive the same compen- sation. Mileage is allowed them in addition to the salary. This has been forty cents per mile, by the usual routes between CONGRESSIONAL DISTBIl 405 the members residence and Washington. In L805 it was reduced to twenty cents per mile, which Btil] Beams m adapted to the days of stages and slow traveling than to tin- modern improvements in rapidity and cheapness. They for merly enjoyed the franking privilege, so called, i. <■.: they could send letters and documents through the mails free. This was abolished in 1873, and they now pay their postage, the same as other people. 14. The first Congress under the Constitution mel in New York City, where two sessions were licit 1, when it was removed to Philadelphia. It remained there until 1800, when Wash- ington became the capital. The Capitol there, in which Con- gress meets, is one of the largest buildings in the world; and the offices for the different executive Departments art- immense structures. In 1874 there were 37 States ami there- fore 74 Senators. The number of Representative* was fixed by a law of March, 1873, at 292, at which number it will remain until the next census in 1880. CHAPTER XLVII. CONGRESSIONAL DISTRICTS — CONGRESSMEN. 1. Each State is entitled to a number of Representatives in Congress proportioned to its inhabitants; but, instead of count- ing the whole number together, and leaving all the people in the ytate to vote for all the representatives of thei r Stat.-. Lt is divided into districts, each containing the prescribed number entil to representation. The voters, then, in each district, Beled nominate the men they wish to vote tor— and thus they find it easy to send men they know and on whom they can rely to secure their interests. Besides, it is more convenient for them to meet and ascertain by consultation who would be u acceptable to the majority of those interested. Each Member of Congress, therefore, is chosen by a single district. 'I he tricting of States is done by their State Legislatm H P.ESSiTES". x-metinies a State is admitted into the Union before it has as many inhabitants as the law requires to one Congr - man, in which ease the law is relaxed, and they are permitted at least o?re Representative. Contiguous counties or towns are set apart in this way and numbered a- 1st. 2nd, 3rd. 6 Congressi nal District. In large cities as many wards, lying together, as include the requsite number, are erected into Dis- tricts. In case the nuinbe: : I _ —men allotted to a State is larger than the number of district-. I se in excess are voted for S :e at large. They are arranged as soon as possi- ble after every census, - that this does not often occur. In the Western States the number continuallv increases and ■ changes must be made after each census. By this means the balance of power gradually follows the emigration from East to "West. >NGRESSME>". 3. We have already remarked, in the chapter on Congress that, though the term Congressman properly applies to the members of both Houses, it is by common usage, confined to members of the lower House, those of the upper Huuse being . -inguished as Senators, so that the abbreviation M. C. (Mem- ber of Congress :« understood to specify a Representative. 4. These are the only members of any branch of the govern- ment who are chosen and elected directly by the people, and we may see herein the propriety of their having the control of all enactments for raising money, this being a point of vital inter - -" b : he people. The short term assigned them. 'two years,) and their election by Districts, enables the people to interfere very soon if their purse strings Irawn too widely open — a very - tory reflection to the economical. Any citizen, whether native or foreign born, may become a Member of Con- gress, if he can obtain the consent of the voters in his district; but he must have been a citizen during the previous seven years. It is an office of dignity and responsibility, and the welfare of the country depends on the wisdom of the people in their choice. CHAPTER XLVIII. CONGRESSIONAL LIBRARY. 1. In the capitol there is a large library, consisting f two parts; one part called the Congressional library, the other, the law library. The latter is made a part of the former b) act of Congress. Both are subject to the same laws and ru and both are supported by appropriations made by ( r --. This institution, called as a whole, w The Congressional Library," contains the works supposed to be useful t tors, but is not confined to their use alone. Its use has 1 •• extended to the judges of the Supreme Court; to all the h> of departments; to the Attorney General; to all the mem of the diplomatic corps, (foreign ministers ); to the seen-' of the Senate; to the clerk of the House of Representative* the chaplains of Congress, to all ex-Presidents, and to the solicitor of the Treasury. 2. It has a librarian, appointed by the President and Sen- ate, who is allowed to appoint two assistants. No book or map is allowed to be taken oat of the library by any person, except the President. Vice-President, members of the Se: and of the House of Representatives. People in general, who are interested to d< - . may obtain information from the books and records when properly author- ized, under such restrictions as the circumstances require. 3. Here are kept all the laws which have ever been enacted by Congress, together with a record ot' all its proco laws of all the different States, with many of those of fon countries; also a large collection of books on promiscuo jects, useful to Members of Congress aid to I - to administer the government. No where i - plete a history of the acts and proceedii - - rnment be found, as in the Congressional library at Washington. 408 COPYRIGHTS. This institution dates back to the year 1800, when an act was passed making the first appropriation of $5,000 for its establishment. The books purchased with this $5,000, with those belonging to both Houses, were placed together, and thus this library was commenced. CHAPTEE XLIX. COPYEIGHTS. A Copyright is an exclusive privilege given to any citizen, or resident in the United States to print, publish, or sell any book, map, chart, engraving, or musical composition of which he or she is the author or proprietor. This right is given by the laws of Congress. No State can give it. The object is to encourage authors, and to compensate them for their labors, which they could not be sure of obtaining if any one might publish and sell their productions. A copyright conveys all the rights of ownership, and may be bought and sold like other property. Directions for Securing Copyrights under the Revised Act of Congress, which took effect July 8, 1870. 1. A printed copy of the title of the book, map, chart, dramatic or musical composition, engraving, cut, print, pho- tograph, or a description of the painting, drawing, chromo, statue, statuary, or model or design for a work of the fine arts, for which copyright is desired, must be sent by mail, prepaid, addressed, " Librarian of Congress, Washington, D. C." This must be done before publication of the book or other article. 2. A fee of 50 cents, for recording the title of each book or other article, must be inclosed with the title as above,. and 50 cents in addition (or $1 in all) for each certificate of copyright OOFYBIGHTB. 4«»'.J under the seal of the Librarian of Gong ■/Inch will transmitted by return mail. 3. Within ten days after publication <>i * -.k-1 1 book or other article, two complete copies of the besl edition issued must be sent, to perfect the copyright, with the addri Librarian of Congress, Washington, D. I It is optional with those sending books and other articles to perfect copyright, to send them by mail or exprese ; but, in either case, the charges are to be prepaid by the Benders. Without the deposit of copies above required, the copyright la void, and a penalty of $25 is incurred. No copy is required to be deposited elsewhere, 4. No copyright hereafter issued is valid unless notice is given by inserting in every copy published, on the title p 'or the page following, if it be a book; or, if a map, chart, musical composition, print, cut, engraving, photograph, paint- ing, drawing, chromo, statue, statuary, or model or design intended to be perfected as a work of the fine arts, by inscrib- ing upon some portion of the face or front thereof, or on the face of the substance on which the same is mounted, the fol lowing words, viz.: Entered according to act of Congi in the year , by , vn fin- office of the Librarian of Congress, at Washington. The law imposes a penalty of $100 upon any person who has not obtained copyright who shall insert the notice " Ent according to act of Congress," etc., or words of the Bame import, in or upon any book or other article. 5. Any author may reserve the right to translate ordram- atize his own work. In this case notice should be given by printing the words, Eight of translation reserved, or, A rights reserved, below the notice of copyright entry, and noti- tying the Librarian of Congress of such reservation, to be entered upon the record. 6. Each copyright secures the exclusive right of publishing the book or article copyrighted for a term of twenty-eight years. At the end of that time, the author or designer, or his 410 COPYRIGHTS. widow or children, may secure a renewal for the further term of fourteen years, making forty-two years in all. Applications for renewal must be accompanied by explicit statement of own- ership in the case of the author, or of relationship in the case of his heirs, and must state definitely the date and place of entry of the original copyright. 7. The time within which any work copyrighted may be issued from the press is not limited by any law or regulation, but depends upon the discretion of the proprietor. A copy- right may be secured for a projected work as well as for a com- pleted one. 8. Any copyright is assignable in law by any instrument of writing, but such assignment must be recorded in the office of the Librarian of Congress within sixty days from its date. The fee for this record is fifteen cents for every 100 words, and ten cents for every 100 words for a copy of the record of assign- ment. 9. A copy of the record (or duplicate certificate) of any- copyright entry will be furnished under seal, at the rate of fifty cent each. 10. In the case of books published in more than one volume, if issued or sold separately, or of periodicals publibhed in numbers, or of engravings, photographs, or other articles pub- lished with variations, a copyright is to be taken out for each volume of a book, or number of a periodical, or variety, as to size or inscription, of any other article. 11. To secure a copyright for a painting, statue, or model or design intended to be perfected as a work of the fine arts, so as to prevent infringement by copying, engraving, or vend- ing such design, a definite description must accompany the application for copyright, and a photograph of the same, at least as large as "cabinet size," must be mailed to the Libra- rian of Congress within ten days from the completion of the work. 12. Every applicant for a copyright must state distinctly the name and residence of the claimant, and whether the right PRESIDING OFFICERS OF OONOB1 -11 T is claimed as author, designer, or proprietor. No affidavit or formal application is required. Up to 1S49 the Secretary of State had thi copyrights. It was then assigned t>» the newly created 1 K-- . ment of the Interior, and so remained until 1870, when it was transferred to the Librarian of Congress. CHAPTER L. PRESIDING OFFICERS OF CONGRESS. 1. These are the President of the Senate and the Speaker of the House of Representatives. The latter is chosen by ballot of the Members of the House. As this position gi him considerable influence over the course of legislation party having a majority in the House are careful to select one on whose sympathy with their views and aims they can rely. When there is nearly or quite a balance of parties, it becomes an important and difficult matter to adjust; and has, in a instances, required a long struggle to elect the Speaker. The result, in such a case, usually determines which shall control the general legislation of that. Congress. 2. The President of the Senate, under ordinary circumstan- ces, is determined by the Constitution, that instrument devolv- ing the office on the Vice-President. It is the only activeduty assigned him while the President is in condition to perform the duties belonging to that office. It seems to befit bis n tions, being the highest honorary place in the government below that of President, subjects him to no superior, and, from the part the Senate takes in the responsibilities of the Pr< dent, makes him acquainted with the gene;,! conduct of affairs; which may be an important advantage to him Bhould he be called to act as President. In the latter ".1 in i of the decease, resignation, or disability of the Vioe-Pn sid< 412 PRESIDING OFFICERS OF CONGRESS. the Senate proceeds to elect its President in the same way as in the House of Representatives, i. e.: by ballot, for a candi- date among its own members. 3. Their duties are to open every sitting of their respective Houses by calling the members to order at the appointed time, on the appearance of a quorum to cause the journal of the preceding day to be read, to preserve order and decorum during the deliberations, to decide questions of order that may arise, (from which an appeal may be taken to the House, at the instance of any two members,) to formally state, and call for the votes on, a question to be decided, and to declare the result of the same after the vote has been taken. This is the regular routine duty of a presiding officer. They, as the recognized Heads of their respective Houses, have the general oversight of its interests, and a general control of the conduct of its business. They examine the Journal to see that it is correct, may order the galleries and lobby to be cleared in case of any disturbance by spectators, and have general control over the unoccupied rooms in the capitol belonging to their respective Houses. They are required to sign all acts, addresses, and joint resolutions, and appoint the members of all committees whose appointment is not specially directed by the House to be otherwise made. In all cases of ballot the Speaker of the House must vote; but he is not required to vote in other cases unless there is a tie, (an equal number for and against,) when he must give the casting vote. The Presi- dent of the Senate may vote only in case of a tie. When the House of Representatives goes into Committee of the Whole, the Speaker leaves the chair, but appoints a chair- man to preside for the time being; and when the President of the United States is impeached before the Senate the Chief Justice of the Supreme Court presides. 4. Their duties are very distinctly defined in the rules adopted by each House for their guidance, but many opportu- nities for exerting great influence often arise, and many cases requiring great tact and judgment and an intimate knowledge PRESIDING OFFICERS OF CONGRESS, t|.: of Parliamentary Law. They receive a much larger Ba than ordinary Members of Congress. The following are the names of all the Speakers of the House of Representatives. A list of V^ce-Presidents i in the chapter devoted to that officer. Frederick A. Muhlenburgh, Penn., Jonathan Trumbull, Conn., Frederick A. Muhlenburgh, Penn., Jonathan Dayton, N. J., Theodore Sedgwick, Mass., Nathaniel Macon, N. C, Joseph B. Yarnum, Mass.- Henry Clay, Ky., Langdon Cheeves, S. C, Henry Clay, Ky., John W. Taylor, N. Y., Philip P. Barbour, Ya., Henry Clay, Ky., John W. Taylor, N. Y., Andrew Stevenson, Ya., John Bell, Tenn., James K. Polk, Tenn., Robert M. T. Hunter, Ya., John White, Ky., John W. Jones, Ya., John W. Davis, Ind., Robert C. Winthrop, Mass., Howell Cobb, Ga., Lynn Boyd, Ky., Nathaniel P. Banks, Mass., James L. Orr, S. C, William Pennington, N. J., Galusha A. Grow, Penn., Schuyler Colfax, Ind., James G. Blaine, Me., u u u 1789 to 1791 L791 u L793 IT:*:: u L797 1797 i * L798 1798 .. 1801 (( 1807 1807 (( 1811 L811 .. 1-14 1814 (( 1815 1815 (( L820 1820 « L821 1821 u 1823 1823 (< L825 1825 u L827 1827 .. 1835 1835 .. 1837 1837 u L839 1839 u L841 1M1 n L848 1843 u L845 1845 u 1M7 1M7 .. L849 L849 .. 1851 L851 >> L856 1856 H 1858 1858 u L859 I860 u L861 1861 % . 1863 . . L869 •• L878 1873 I • L875 CHAPTER LI. SUBORDINATE OFFICERS OF CONGRESS. 1. The Secretary of the Senate and Clerk of the House of Representatives, are the officers next in rank in the two bodies forming Congress. They are appointed by vote of their respective Houses. They are not necessarily selected from among the members of the Senate or House, as is the custom in case of the presiding officers, but may be chosen by the members at will. 2. Their chief duties are in connection with a record or journal of the proceedings of their respective Houses. This is an official and correct account of all the transactions of each body, is examined by the presiding officer, and read before the members for criticism and approval. They cause this journal to be printed and a copy be delivered to each member at the commencement of every session of Congress, as also to the Executive and to each branch of the Legislature of every State. So also they arrange, cause to be printed, and distribute to the members all the current documents of each House that may be useful to them in the discharge of their duties, as often as the case requires. All contracts for furnishing anything required by Congress, or for any labor done for it, are made with, or approved by, the Clerk of the House and Secretary of the Senate. 3. They act also as treasurers of the special, or contingent funds of Congress, from which payments are made on their order, after the accounts, on which the order is based, are approved by the Committee of Accounts; and give bonds in a large sum for the faithful use of these funds, making a detailed report of all expenditures. THE SERGEANT-AT-ARMS 4. Is a kind of police and executive officer, who aids or acts under the direction of the presiding officer in keeping order, and executes the commands of Congress. All arrests ordered (414) OONORKSS AT WOES. •} 1 ."■ by Congress are made by him or his deputies, and all legal processes served by him. lie bears a inner as the Bymbol of his office when on duty. lie keeps the account- of the pay and mileage of the members of Congress, prepares checks, and draws and pays the money to them. 5. The other officers are a Doorkeeper — whose bnsinesa it is to 6ee that only the proper persons gain admission to the sessions of Congress, and watches over, and is responsible for, the furniture contained in the rooms of the capitol placed in his charge — and a postmaster, whose business it is to superin- tend a postoffice kept in the capitol for the accommodation of members of Congress. Various clerks, deputies, and messen- gers are employed under most of these officers, to aid them in the discharge of their duties. CHAPTEH LII. CONGRESS AT WORK. 1. Congress is required by the Constitution to assembl the first Monday in December of each year. It may, by a law duly made to that effect, change that time, but no permanent change has ever been made. As soon after that time as a quo- rum of its members, which the Constitution declares shall be a majority of each House, has assembled eaeh Bouse pr to the election of officers (which, however, is done onlj other year,) and the arrangement of its commit ready for work. 2. As soon as the organization is ascertained to be complete the other House of Congress and the President are informed of the fact, after which propositions, or bills as they a **• of new laws, or repeals or revisals of old ones art Of these there is never any lack. They are taken a] for order, referred to an appropriate committee for examii a report is in due time made by the committee, di at such length as the members see cause for, in a 416 CONGRESS AT WORK. ner, and finally are voted on. Sometimes, if the members are not satisfied with the information presented on some point or points, they return them to the committee with instructions to investigate further, and make another report; sometimes they " lay them on the table," that is, put them aside for future action; or they accept, amend, or change them to meet their views, and then accept or reject them altogether. 3. When a bill has reached a vote and been accepted by the House in which it originated, it is sent to the other House, by which it is taken up, referred to a committee, usually passing- through substantially the same course and form of considera- tion as in the first case, laid aside, amended, accepted or rejected according to circumstances, and returned to the former House. If it is accepted by both they then send it to the President, who carefully considers it. If it meets his appro- bation, he signs and returns it to Congress, and it becomes the Law of the Land, and all to whom it refers are bound to obey it, it being the duty of the President to see that it is enforced. It is called an " Act of Congress," because it is the proper exercise of its law making authority, and because all such laws are preceded by the clause, " Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the United States of America, in Congress assembled." 4. If the President does not think it a suitable law, and is unwilling to assume the responsibility of signing it, he returns it to Congress, with his reasons for not doing so. If Congress is not satisfied with these reasons it may take another vote on it, and if the members in its favor amount to two-ttirds of each House, it becomes a law without the signature of the President. This power of the President to decline to sign a law of Congress is called his " Veto." Sometimes it is carried over the veto, and sometimes it fails for lack of the requisite number in its favor. 5. The larger part of Congressional laws are passed in this way, which is the regular Parliamentary form; but sometimes its authority is expressed by a Resolution instead of a bill. 00NQRESS AT WORK. 4)7 This is a kind of informal way of passing a law. though it usually takes that form because of tin- p< sculiar chara the subject of the Resolution; as an amendmenl to the Con- stitution would be commenced by a resolution passed by both Houses; but, as Congress has not the sole power over that question, it requiring the concurrence of three fourth* of the States, it is put in that form. When Borne demand ie \<< be made by Congress on the President, or on various officers of the government, and in a variety of other cases, a resolution has the force of law, disobedience to which would involve a penalty. Many resolutions merely express the view- of Con- gress, and are of force and value only on accounl of the respecta- bility and dignity of the bod}- expressing them. Some resolu- tions require to be passed in both Bouses to acquire legal force, and are then called Concurrent Resolutions. A bill must pass through the regular forms of printing, reference toa committee, report, placing in order on the records, and calling up at a proper time for consideration and decision. This is very proper to avoid hasty action before all the bearinga of the case have been examined; but wotdd consume to<> much time if required in every case. A resolution may lie debated and decided at once, and it facilitates the progress of busini in the class of cases to which it is applicable. G. The amount of business to be done by Congress ie immense. Each branch of the executive department makes a yearly report to it, which must be considered and suitable lawa passed; many hundreds of laws are commonly asked t<> !><• passed, repealed, or revised, by the President or the people; and all the interests of a great and growing country looked after. Those who are at a distance cannot always judge accu- rately of the difficulties it meets with in endeavoring to . satisfaction to all, nor of the different appearance which qu tions may present when closely examined and looked at on all sides, and Congress has a gnat deal of short-sighted criticism to bear. Congressmen cannot always tell what is besl m n othei 27 418 PUBLIC PRINTING. people, nor always find themselves able to do what they prefer, or judge to be best, and the account to which they are held is sometimes unjust; yet, on the whole they have always respected, and sought to serve, the views and interests of the people as a whole, and deserve much praise. The country has become prosperous and free under their legislation, and what the major- ity of the people clearly call for is always done for them. 7. The more carefully the people whom they represent watch them at work, and study the subjects they are required to legislate on, the less reason will they find for denunciation of them, and the more intelligently will they be able to lay out their work for them. They are the servants of the people, notwithstanding they seem to command and order, and are liable to be dismissed and turned out of place if they do not give satisfaction. They are men like ourselves, with interests, temptations, and weaknesses. We should aid them in their work, and assist them to walk uprightly by our intelligence and careful regard for reason and right. Our representatives will always, in character and conduct, present a fair statement of what we are ourselves. If we are just, honest, and high- minded they will not dare to be otherwise than faithful and true, and if we are intelligent we shall never put ignorant and vile men in office. So the Congress of the United States of America will always be a truly Representative Body. CHAPTER LIII. PUBLIC PRINTING. 1. Among the Institutions of the government is that head- ing this chapter. The amount of printing required to be done for Congress, the various branches of the government, and for the benefit of the people, is very great indeed. All the pro- ceedings of both Houses of Congress as recorded by the secre- taries are required to be printed under authority; since many copies are required by the members and for general purposes. PUBLIC PRINTING. 1 1 All the laws are printed in great numbers for circulation among the many millions interested ; and when a bill is proposed it requires to be printed for the use of the several hundred mem- bers who need it for examination and study, although it often never becomes a law. 2. The President's Messages, and all the reports of heads of departments and bureaus ; the reports and commissions of army and navy officers, of investigating committees, of various superintendents, agents, and government employees, and many other things are printed, sometimes only for use of Congn sometimes for extensive circulation. Thus it is easily seen that the government printing is a heavy expense, and a very Large part is indispensable ; though many believe that a judicious selection of documents and a careful study as to the number of some of them printed might largely reduce the expense, without injury to the public welfare. We do not wish to pay for the printing of documents that are never read. It is a waste of the people's money; yet, we must not forget that it is of the utmost importance that the people should become inti- mately acquainted with all the affairs of the government. Per- haps Congress is sometimes wiser than the people, and that many documents are wisely printed, and unwisely left unread by those most interested. Economy and intelligence are to be equally regarded. 3. Until 1860, the government hired men to do this work, and a printer was employed by each house of Congress. But great complaints were made of the enormous expense to which the country was subjected in this item of its exp snditures; and at the date named, Congress passed an act establishing a | eminent printing office, to be under the direction of a SU] intendent of public printing. The sum of $150,00(1 waa :l j >j »r- »- priated for the purchase of necessary buildings, machinery, and materials for the purpose. By the provisions of I made the superintendent's duty to overlook all the pul printing and binding, not only of Congress, but of all departments, and of the United States courts ; to pur all 420 SIGNAL, SERVICE. necessary materials and to employ all the workmen required. And that Congress may know how the establishment is con- ducted and at what expense, the superintendent is required to- report to Congress at the commencement of every session, the work done, the number of hands employed, and the exact state and condition of the establishment. He is prohibited from paying more for work done in this office than is given for the same services in private printing offices in Washington. 4. The superintendent is also charged with the duty of pro- curing all blank books, maps, drawings, diagrams, views, and charts, which may be ordered by Congress, or by the heads of departments and bureaus. But the superintendent himself is not left to act always as he may think proper, for in many cases lie must have the approval of the joint committee on printing of both Houses of Congress. 5. This is a very proper effort to curtail expenses. It remains to be seen how successful it may be. The constant watchful oversight of the Sovereign People can alone succeed in keeping all things in due order. When the representatives of the people become careless and wasteful the admonition of the people is never without its effect. CHAPTER LIY. THE SIGNAL SERVICE. 1. The present organization of this institution dates from the beginning of the civil war, and was originally purely mili- tary in its aims and purposes. It is still conducted by the War Department, and partly for its own purposes ; but its value to agricultural and commercial interests is constantly becoming more apparent and more extensive, and will probably, in the end, so overshadow its military relations as to reduce them to a very subordinate place in importance. The civil uses of this service are based on the science of meteorology, which is largely occupied with weather changes, the origin, SIGNAL SKRVICE. ! 2 ! progress, and laws of Storms. Its value to the people '"li- mits accurate prediction of changes in the weather, and the warning it is able to give, sometimes many hours or even days in advance, of dangerous storms. Its estimate of weather probabilities, based on observations reported daily from promi- nent points covering the whole country, are published in all the daily papers, usually found accurate, and are of great \ aim- to certain classes of the people. When a storm threatens to endanger the safety of shipping a signal is displayed in the port to give warning, and much property and many lives are often saved. It makes an accurate and scientific study of tin- weather and all the laws controlling its changes, by a large corps of enlightened and trained observers, all whose facts, constantly reported, systematized, and studied by competent persons, are likely to produce, in time, a most important and useful body of knowledge on that subject. 2. The objects of the Signal Service require its officials to be connected with the United States army, to have the ase of the Electric Telegraph, to be familiar with Meteorology, and skillful in the use of the scientific instruments employed in the study of atmospheric changes. By means of the telegraph, the army, though scattered over the whole country, and especially the frontiers and more inaccessible parts, may be alruosl instan- taneously, and all at the same time, communicated with. It would be possible, by telegraphs, signals, and railroads, to con- centrate the whole army from the numerous points when- its fragments are located, from Maine to Texas, and the Atlantic. to the Pacific, at one point in as short a time as it formerly took a body of soldiers to march a hundred miles. 3. It is a singularly striking instance of the vigor and effectiveness of control supplied by science, invention, am modern progress, by which our vast increase in numbers and in extent of territory are neutralized, the interest . iraer and habits of the people unified so that sectional jealou contests are made rare and slight, and the people of re parts of the country made practically better acquainted with 422 SIGNAL SERVICE. each other than formerly were the inhabitants of adjoining States. 4. Subordination and thoroughness of system are secured by its connection with the army, which probably also secures its advantages to the country at much less cost than would be the case were it an independent institution. The army is am- bitious to be as useful as possible to the country. There is a Signal School of Instruction and Practice at Fort Whipple, in Va., which is to this Service what the Military and Naval Academies are to the Army and Navy. The most suitable per- sons are selected from the army or especially enlisted, and care- fully schooled and tested through a sufficiently long period to render them fully competent for the delicate duties imposed on them. 5. There are about 90 Signal Stations, a few being located in Canada and the West Indies. The whole is under the direc- tion of the Chief Signal Officer, who reports to the Secretary of War. There is a large and carefully arranged organization, under constant supervision by competent persons. Several Boards of Examination are employed in selecting suitable persons for the different duties required in the Service, and in testing their advancement toward a thorough fitness for each position to be occupied. The first or lowest grade is for the " field " signal service, requiring a knowledge of army signals and telegraphy — this being the original military value of the institution — the second grade includes those who are competent to act as assistants to observers in the scientific or meteorological part of the work ; and the third (called Observer Sergeants) includes those who have so complete a knowledge of the scientific principles involved and of the use of the instruments employed as to be fitted to take charge of Stations of Observation, and make the constant and minute reports on which the conclusions of the Central Office are based. The Stations are from time to time inspected, and the whole system kept in the most accurate order. Very much depends, on the intelligence and unremitting attention of the Observers- SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. This is, probably, tlie beginning of a work of the great practical value tocommercc and agriculture. It will continu- ally expand and grow more exact and useful, and from i tioiis to the diffusion of important and useful knowledge we have placed it with the THE SMITHSONIAN INSTTI TTION. 1. Though there are no doubt many minor failures t.> meet the wishes, and secure the interests of the people and some, perhaps, that are really serious — though in these the people I a good share of the blame — the government has pursued an enlightened policy in respect to the encouragement of Science, and the diffusion of useful knowledge. "What it can properly do in the interest of the whole people has been dene The Smithsonian Institution is not wholly a governmenl establish- ment; but the official machinery by which it was at final set in motion, and is continued in operation, belongs to the gov- eminent. The funds with which it was founded, were fur- nished by an individual, and he a foreigner. The history runs thus: A noble-hearted Englishman, whose name was John Smithson, residing in the city of London, bequeathed all his property to the United States of America, for the purpose of founding in Washington an establishment to be known as the "Smithsonian Institution," for the purpose of increasing and diffusing knowledge among men. The United States acce] the bequest, and in 1846 passed an act for the purpose of c rying out the beneficent design of Mr. Smithson. This acl created "an establishment," as it is denominated in the the name before stated. It might have been called :l corpo tion, for it has perpetual succession, and many of the powers incident to a corporation. 2. By this act the President and Vice-President of the United States, the Secretary of State, the Secretary of the Treasury, the Secretary of War, the Secretary of the tfavj , Postmaster General, the Attorney General, and Chief Jus! the Commissioner of the Patent Office, and the M Washington- during the time they shall hold th( 424 REPORTS. offices, together with such other persons as they may elect honorary members — were constituted the establishment under the name of the Smithsonian Institution. 3. It is located at Washington, and is managed by a board of regents, composed of the Vice-President of the United States, the Chief Justice of the United States, the Mayor of Washington, three members of the Senate, and three members of the House of Representatives; together with six other per- sons. The board choose their own officers, and report their proceedings to Congress at each session thereof. 4. In order to carry out Mr. Smithson's noble design of founding this institution, rooms have been prepared for the reception of all objects of art, natural history, plants, and geological and mineralogical specimens which now or here- after may belong to the United States, and such as may here- after be obtained. These are classified and arranged so as to facilitate their examination and study. A vast collection has already been obtained and deposited in the institution, and it is constantly increasing by donations, by the researches and industry of its professors, and by exchanges made with kin- dred institutions at home and abroad. These are open to the examination of the public, and offer an opportunity to students and others to extend their scientific knowledge. This, together with the reports of its professors, of experiments and new discoveries, make it indeed an institution "for the increase and diffusion of knowledge among men." CHAPTER LV REPORTS. 1. Congress being the law-making power of the govern- ment, it is evident that, to know precisely what laws it is important to enact, to change, or to repeal, they should be kept well informed of all that is done by government officials, and the precise condition of every branch of the public service. REPORTS. The President's Messages are of the nature of reports made by the Chief Executive to the legislative body for its informa- tion and guidance. So it is enacted thai the Sei of State, Treasury, War, Navy, Interior, and Postmaster < reneral, together with the commissioners of the different b ireaus, and boards attached to these departments, shall annually report to Congress. Heads of departments report directly to Congn So do many of the commissioners who are at the head ot bureaus. Boards report to the heads of departments to which they are attached. 2. In this way Congress is kept advised of whatever is done in every department, bureau, or board, to which any of the public business is entrusted. These reports not only furnish the law-making power with such information as it needs, but serve as a check to any official misconduct. The annual reports of the Secretaries of the Treasury, War. and Navy, together with that of the Postmaster General, are State papers which rank in importance next to the annual message of the President. To them the people look for a detailed account of the state and condition of those great departments over which these Secretaries preside, and which so materially affect the pecuniary and other great interests of the nation. 3. The foregoing remarks upon reports, throw light upon the movements of the machinery by which the government is operated, and show how officials are held responsible to the superior power. In this connection we may notice another kind of reports, which come from another source. After each Congress has convened and organized, the President of the Senate and the Speaker of the House appoint what are denominated thestand ing committees of each of these bodies. When bills are presented to be passed into laws, or petition are sent in, they are always referred to the appropriate com- mittee, which examines them and reports to the body I Senate or House) their conclusions upon the m< ■» , ' r its, propriety or impropriety, of granting the petitioner ot passing the bill under consideration. 426 IMPEACHMENT. These reports generally govern the action of Congress when they come to vote upon the passage of the law. But that is not always the case; the body of either House may think differ- ently from its committee, and act contrary to its recommen- dations. CHAPTER LYI. IMPEACHMENT. 1. In the second article, section four, of the Constitution, these words are found: "The President, Vice-President, and all civil officers of the United States, shall be removed from office on impeachment for, and conviction of treason, bribery, or other high crimes and misdemeanors." 2. Impeachment is a procedure against office holders only, for the purpose of removing them from office. It inflicts no other punishment; but the guilty party may afterwards be prosecuted for his crime in a court of law, and punished in such manner as the law directs. 3. The House of Representatives alone can present charges looking to the trial of an officer of the government by impeach- ment. Its action, in such a case, is similar to that of a Grand Jury. It charges that the official has violated the law and should be tried, in order, if guilty, to be removed from office. It appoints a committee to conduct the prosecution before the Senate, to which these charges are presented. 4. The Senate alone has the power to try the accused party. When trying a case of impeachment it acts as a court, and from its decision there is no appeal. The President cannot pardon a criminal who has been impeached. "When the Presi- dent of the United States is tried, the Chief Justice of the Supreme Court presides, but in no other case. No person can be convicted in a trial of impeachment, unless two-thirds of the Senate concur in finding the accused guilty of the alleged offense. THE JUDICIAL DEPARTMENT. Tliis is the third Branch of the government, as determined by the Constitution, and is of supreme importance and dignit \ . Its sphere is to interpret the Constitution, to decide com versies, to try offenders and to pronounce sentence on them, to enforce rights, and to keep the whole organism of the government in proper place and proportion. It is attached to the governmental machinery as a Regulator. Without it the other Departments must be the judges of the extent of their own powers; the Constitution would be practically inoperative to prevent inharmonious or mischievious legislation; and the executive would possess the authority to try as well as punish offenses. The officers of this Department of the government an expected to be men of much weight and dignity of characl of wide legal culture, and are selected for, and continued in, office under such circumstances as to guarantee,' to a lair extent, the requisite distinction and impartiality. All this we shall see as we proceed to analyze Its different branches. These consist of the United State- Supreme Court, the Circuit Courts, the District Courts, and the Court oi Claims. The local courts in the District of Columbia, and the Territorial Courts, though similar to the Stat.' .Indicia; are connected, by their relations to the General Government, with this Department. The importance of this branch of the government hae become more evident as time has passed, and the conflict of parties has put the whole to test. The acrimonious party spirit our early post revolutionary history, which continu.il into Monroe's administration, was, in great pari, the result of • want of due confidence in, and respect for, the judiciary. Experience showed that our people were law abiding, and the Legislative and Executive powers, equally with the people, (427) 428 THE SUPREME COURT. were willing to submit to the official interpretation of the Constitution, and all ready to join hands to maintain its authority. CHAPTER LYII. THE SUPIEME COURT. 1. This is the highest tribunal in the United States. If the whole government be figuratively regarded as an arch this is the " Key Stono of the Arch " without which the whole struc- ture would crumble and fall. In all cases of dispute as to the moaning of the Constitution and the range of powers it con- fers, or implies, it has sovereign power to decide; and from that decision there is no appeal. Its declaration, as to the mean- inp- and application of' the Constitution and the body of stat- utes enacted under it, becomes the law of the land. It is the great bulwark against tyranical use of power, and conflicting enactments, whether by National or State Legislatures. 2. This court has one Chief Justice and nine Associate Justices, all appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate. They are appointed for life- or during good behavior; they may be impeached for bribery or other high crimes, and then removed from office. Thev may also resign ; but if they conduct themselves properly and choose to retain their offices, there is no power by which they can be removed, except the power of death. The Constitution itself makes this provision, in order that the judges may be removed as far as possible from the influence of party politics. It is therefore expected that their decisions will not be biased by party or political considerations; and it may not be amiss to say that the provisions for keeping the judges of the United States Courts in office for life, meets with almost universal approbation; and has caused many to hope that the States would alter their Constitutions and adopt the same plan; believing it to be the surest way of preserving a pure and THE SI I'UI.MI it, | |;|. independent Judiciary, on which depend the rights and liber- ties of every citizen of the common vealth. 3. This court holds but one terra in a year, which com* mences on the first Monday of Decern! er, in its antil it hit- disposed of the business before it. Its :;e6si >ns ar al firayi held at Washington, the capital of the nati >n; thoro it has in- to the Congressional and Lav/ Libraries, and to til the leparl ments and records of the government when aecessary. There is a class of causes \?hieh may be sominanced in this court. In these cases it has original jurisdiction. They an such as affect ambassadors, other pul li ; minister! . id i consuls; and those in which a State shall be a party. In »th?r .•.-. aes it has only appellate jurisdiction. The greater ,.art ., its . -ii.-i ness is to hear and determine appeals from inferior courts, mainly from the United States Circuit Courts- and in Bonn instances from the highest State courts. 4. It has not only original, but exclusive jurisdiction in causes where a State is a party, and v/hen procee r suite against ambassadors, or other public ministers or th lir lervants, are instituted. Its power to try appeals from lower courts, called appellate jurisdiction, gives it :iic position oi the high- est court in the nation. It has power also to restrain or to prohibit proceedings in the United States District Courts, when acting as courts of Admiralty; or in cases of maritime jurisdiction. Die judges of this court hold the Circuit Courts, and allot themselves among the judicial circuits. The practice and rules of procedure in this oouii are similar to those of the Courts of Chancery and King's Bencl in England. Issues of fact are tried by jury, the Bami other courts. OFFICERS 01 mi < "i BT. 5. The officers of this tribunal are the Judges, th< A.ttor aey General, a clerk, a crier, and a report, r. Oie thr named are appointed by the court 1 1 is the dut 430 THE SUPREME COURT. shal of the District of Columbia to attend this court, and to serve process issuing from it. An Attorney or Counsellor-at-Law, to be admitted to prac- tice in this court, must have been a practitioner in the Supreme Court of the State where he lives. 6. The following are the names of all the Chief Justices of the Supreme Court of the United States, from its establish- ment to the present time; with the dates of their appoint- ments, and the States from which they were appointed: John Jay, N. Y., Sept. 26, 1789. John Eutledge, S. C, July 1, 1795. William dishing, Mass., Jan. 27, 1796. Oliver Ellsworth, Ct., March 4, 1796. John Jay, N. Y., Dec. 19, 1800. John Marshall, Va., Jan. 27, 1801. Eoger B. Taney, Md., Dec. 28, 1835. Salmon P. Chase, O, Dec. 1864. Morrison E. Waite, O., Jan. 21, 1874. 7. The following are the names of the Associate Justices with the dates of their appointment and the States from which they were appointed: John Eutledge, S. C, 1789. William Cushing, Mass., 1789. Eobert H. Harrison, Md., 1789. James Wilson, Pa., 1789. John Blair, Va., 1789. James Iredell, N. C, 1790. ' Thomas Johnson, Md., 1791. William Paterson, N. J., 1793. Samuel Chase, Md., 1796. Bushrod Washington, Va., 1798. Alfred Moore, N. C, 1799. William Johnson, S. C, 1804. Brockholst Livingston, N. Y., 1807. Thomas Todd, Va., 1807. Gabriel Duvall, Md., 1811. THE SUPREME CODRT Joseph Story, Mass., 1811. Smith Thompson, N. Y., 1823. Robert Trimble, Ky., 1823. John McLean, O., 1829. Henry Baldwin, Pa., 1830. James M. Wayne, Ga., 1835. Philip P. P>arbour, Va., 1836. John McKinley, Ala., 1837. John Catron, Tenn., 1837. Peter V. Daniel, Va., 1841. Samuel Nelson, N. Y., 1845. Levi Woodbury, N. H., 1845. Eobert C. Grier, Pa., 1846. Benjamin R. Curtis, Mass., 1851. James A. Campbell, Ala., 1853. Nathan Clifford, Me., 1858. Noah H. Swayne, O., 1862. Samuel F. Miller, Iowa, 1862. Stephen J. Field, Cal. David Davis, 111., 1862. William Strong, Pa., 1870. Joseph P. Bradley, N. J., 1S70. Ward Hunt, N. Y., 1873. 131 CHAPTER LVIII. CIRCUIT COURTS. The next in dignity, power, and jurisdiction are the Ol States Circuit Courts. While the Supreme Court is always held in Washington, these are held in every State al Buch ti and places as special law of Congrt 38 directs. These an changed so as to accommodate both the people in and the judges of the Court. As now arranged, the Onion is divided into nine circuits, cadi circuit compri several States, according to the size and population of tlio 432 CIRCUIT COURTS. States. The places are arranged with reference to convenience of access by all the people in the circuit. This Court is similar in design and authority to the Supreme Court; indeed it is but a branch of it; the same officers pre- siding, and the same class of questions being adjudicated by it, viz.: those involving Constitutional Law; and this authority, so important to uniformity of interpretation of constitutional provisions, and to the enjoyment of rights guaranteed by that instrument to citizens of all the States, is made pervading — is carried within the reach of all. 2. The Circuit Courts are held by the Judges of the Supreme Court, who allot the circuits among themselves, and then travel each through his own circuit, until he has visited and held a session in every State which lies within it. A Judge of the Supreme Court is the presiding and supreme magistrate in every Circuit Court, but the Judge of the District Court of the district in which the Circuit is held, sits with the Judge of the Supreme Court, as Associate Justice. JURISDICTION. 3. These Courts have both original and appellate jurisdic- tion. Causes may be appealed from the District Courts to the Circuit. They also have concurrent jurisdiction with the State courts, where the matter in dispute exceeds the sum of $500, and the United States are plaintiffs; or where an alien is a party, or where the suit is between citizens of different States. They have exclusive jurisdiction in all cases of crimes against the United States, except where the law especially confers the power on other courts. It extends to all cases under the reve- nue laws of the United States. } 4. There is also a certain class of cases (too tedious to be described here in detail,) which may be removed from State and from District Courts, into these courts, and be tried and determined in the same manner as if they had been commenced here. The officers of Circuit Courts are, first, the Judges; second, vhe District Attorney of the district in which the court i» CIRC V IT C0DRT8. held; third, the Marshal of the district; and fourth, a Clerk, who Is appointed by the court. 5. It may he interesting, and perhaps useful to know how the different circuits are formed, and what States lie in each. They have been from time to time increased in number, as the number of the States increased. In b< cases States have been at first placed in one circuit, and afterwards detached and placed in another. 6. By the Acts of 1862 and 1863, the circuits were arranged as follows: First Circuit — Rhode Island, Massachusetts, Maine and New Hampshire (by Act of 1820.) Second Circuit — Vermont, Connecticut, New York (Act of 1837). Third Circuit — .New Jersey and Pennsylvania. Fourth Circuit — Maryland, Virginia, Delaware and North Carolina. Fifth Circuit — South Carolina, Georgia, Alabama. Mississippi and Florida. Sixth Circuit — Louisiana, Texas, Arkansas, Kentucky and Tennessee. Seventh Circuit — Ohio and Indiana. Eighth Circuit — Michigan and Illinois. Ninth Circuit — Wisconsin, Missouri, Kansas, Iowa and Min- nesota. Tenth Circuit — California and Oregon. But in 1866 this arrangement of the circuits was again changed; and this was done, we suppose, to make the circuits approximate nearer to the number of Associate .h\>\' reduced from nine to six by the same act; for, it was then enacted that hereafter there should be no more Associate Jus- tices of the Supreme Court appointed, until they were reduced (by death or resignation), to six. 7. The circuits by this last act were reduced to nine, and were arranged as follows: First and Second Circuits tu remain as before. 28 431 DISTRICT COURTS. The Third was made up of the States of Pennsylvania, New- Jersey and Delaware. The Fourth, of Maryland, Virginia, West Virginia, North Carolina and South Carolina. The Fifth, of Georgia, Florida, Alabama, Mississippi, Loui- siana and Texas. The Sixth, of Ohio, Michigan, Kentucky and Tennessee. The Seventh, of Indiana, Illinois and Wisconsin. The Eighth, of Minnesota, Iowa, Missouri, Kansas and Arkansas. The Ninth, of California, Oregon and Nevada. We have inserted both of these circuit arrangements, because one new State (Nebraska), has been admitted since the act passed. Others will soon come in, and very probably the old number of circuits and judges will be restored. CHAPTER LIX. DISTRICT COURTS. 1. We come now to the lowest grade of United States courts, excepting the local courts in the District of Columbia, and the Territorial Courts. A United States District Court is held by a District Judge in every district. Every State con- stitutes at least one district, several of the larger States are divided into two, and some into three. There are at the pres- ent time fifty-nine Judicial Districts, and consequently the same number of District Judges, District Attorneys, District Clerks and Marshals. The Judges, Attorneys and Marshals are all appointed by the President and Senate; the Clerks by the respective courts. TERMS. 2. By the law of 1789 every District Judge was required to hold four sessions a year, at such times and in such places as Congress directed. This is done to this day in a great major- ity of the States; but by later laws, in some of the districts only two or three sessions a year are required. DISTRICT COURTS. JURISDICTION. 3. These courts have exclusive jurisdiction in ;ill admiralty and maritime causes. These relate to maritime contracts, and to crimes against the laws of the United States, committed on the sea and on navigable lakes and rivers. It embraces in this country all contracts respecting vessels and navigation; such as chartering, repairing, and fitting tl em out, Beamen's wag etc. They have in some cases concurrent jurisdiction with the Circuit Courts, as in cases of piracy, and exclusive © gnizanoe of cases where seizures are made for a violation of the revenue laws, or laws relating to imports and navigation; and can- linst consuls and vice consuls where the amount claimed doe- nol exceed $100. In short, they have concurrent jurisdiction with the Circuit Courts, of all crimes against the laws of the United States, the punishment of which is not capital. The trial "t issues of fact in all causes except civil causes of admiralty and maritime jurisdiction, must be by jury. 4. Appeals are taken from these courts to the Circuit Courts. The judges are appointed like those of the Supreme Court, for life, or during good behavior, and receive various amounts as salary, some more and some less, according to the amount of services to be performed in their respective districts. 5. When vessels are captured in time of war. either by the public armed vessels or by private armed ships, the facts and circumstances of the capture must be brought before alt States Circuit or District Court for adjudication; when the vessel and cargo are either condemned as a prize, or restored to their owners. When either of these courts adjudicate Buch cases, it is called a Prize Court. We give the number of Judicial Districts in each State as they now exist, and the total number in all the St They are as follows: Alabama, 3. Mississippi, - Arkansas, 2. Missouri, 2. California, 2. Nevada, 1. Connecticut,!. New Eampshire, 1. 436 ADMIRALTY AND MARITIME JURISDICTION. Delaware, 1. New Jersey, 1 Florida, 2. New York, 3. Georgia 2. North Carolina, 3- Illinois, 2. Nebraska, 1. Indiana, 1. Ohio, 2. Iowa, 1. Oregon, 1. Kansas, 1. Pennsylvania, 2. Kentucky, 1- Rhode Island, 1. Louisiana, 2. South Carolina, 2. Maine, 1. Tennessee, 3. Maryland, 1. Texas, 2. Massachusetts, 1. Vermont, 1. Michigan, 2. Virginia, 1. Minnesota, 1. "West Virginia, 1. District of Columbia, 1. Wisconsin, 1. Total, 59, CHAPTER LX. ADMIRALTY AND MARITIME JURISDICTION. In ancient times — and long before this government existed — civilized and commercial nations had codes or laws which related especially to transactions upon the sea. Those respecting ships of war and warlike operations at sea were called the laws of Admiralty ; those respecting vessels engaged in commercial affairs were called Maritime laws ; and the courts empowered with jurisdiction to hear and try causes, or to take any judicial proceedings in those cases, were styled Courts of Admiralty and Maritime Jurisdiction. These laws, in many respects, differed so materially from the laws relating to affairs on land, that the authority and power to take proceedings in and adju- dicate upon them was conferred upon a particular class of courts. Hence we see the origin of the names of such tri- bunals. In this country the United States District Courts have been. ADMIRALTY AM) MAU1TIMI JURISDICTION. designated by the laws as the courts which shall ha. nal and exclusive authority to adjudicate this class of can-' an appeal from the District to the Circuit Courte may 1": taken. KIND OF CASES. The word Maritime designates that which relates to tin- sea, Yet, in the United States, cases which come within Admiralty and Maritime jurisdiction are not restricted to the sea, or to transactions relating to business or crimes done on it, but are made to embrace those which occur on navigable lakes and rivers, and include seizures made for the violation of the Laws of impost, navigation, or trade, suits for the recovery of men's wages, contracts for building, repairing or fitting out vessels, and, briefly, all contracts where the subject-matter relates to the navigation of the sea. The District Courts have Admiralty and Maritime jurisdiction in all these cases, without regard to the amount claimed, and in criminal as well as in civil suits. The foregoing remarks show the workings of our judicial system, as it applies to business done, and crimes committed upon the high seas. CHAPTER LXI. COURT OF CLAIMS. 1. This court was established by act of Congress in 1 The law reads thus : "A court shall be established to be called the Court of Claims, to consist of three judges, to !>,■ appointed by the President and Senate, and to hold their offices .luring good behavior; and the said court shall hear and determine all claims founded upon any law of Congress, or upon any regula- tion of an Executive department, or upon any contract expres or implied, with the government of the United States; wh may be suggested to it by a petition filed therein; and als claims which may be referred to said court by either h Congress." 438 COURT OF CLAIMS. 2. On the third of March, 1S63, the jurisdiction of this court was enlarged, and two additional judges appointed (making five), from the whole number of which the President was authorized to appoint one a Chief Justice for said court. 3. The mode of commencing proceeding before this tribu- nal is by petition ; in which the claimant must fully set forth his claim, how it arose, its amount, and the parties interested therein. After the case has been heard and determined, the court reports to Congress what its decision is, and if favorable to the claimant, a bill is passed for his relief. 4. It holds one session a year, in Washington, commencing on the first Monday in October, and continuing as long as the business before it requires. It not only tries claims against the government, but by its enlarged jurisdiction, conferred in 1863, it also tries counter claims and set-offs which the United States may have against the claimant. Appeals are taken from the Court of Claims to the Supreme Court of the United States, when the amount in controversy exceeds $3,000. 5. Before the establishment of this court, the only remedy persons having claims upon the government had, was by peti- tioning to Congress for relief; which experience proved to be a long, tedious, and expensive mode of obtaining their dues. The petition now goes to this court, where it is heard and adju- dicated in the same form, and by the same rules of procedure which are observed in other courts ; for Congress has conferred upon it all the powers commonly possessed by other courts of law. It also has a seal. 6. It has greatly facilitated the settlement of claims against the government, and has relieved Congress of a great amount of labor, which was urgently pressed upon it at every session. 7. In addition to the five judges, it has a Solicitor, an Assistant Solicitor, and a Deputy Solicitor, all of whom are appointed by the President and Senate; and are officers of the court, whose duty it is faithfully to defend the United States in all matters and claims before this court. DISTRICT ATTOBN] A bailiff, a clerk, a crier and messenger, all of whom are appointed by the court, make up the remaining officials. The claimants stand in the relation of plaintiffs, and the government in that of defendant. CHAPTER LXII. DISTRICT ATTORNEYS. These officers are next in rank to the Judges of the Circuit and District Courts with which their duties are connected. Their relation to the government, in the cla-s of cases that come before those courts, is the same as that of the Attorney General in the Supreme Court. They are it> official legal coun- selors in all cases involving the interests of the General Gov- ernment before the Circuit and District Courts in their several districts. They are appointed in the same manner; thai nominated by the President, and confirmed by the Senate. It is their duty "to prosecute in such district all delinquents for crimes and offences cognizable under the authority of the I i States, and all civil actions in which the United States shall he concerned." They are his clients, and he must enforce their rights, and defend them, in the same manner that any attorney protects and defends his client in any of the State court-. In case of necessity, he may appoint a substitute t<> act in place. All fees over and above what lie is allowed as COB | sation for his services, he must report and pay into the Unil States Treasury. 3. He must defend collectors of the customs a;-! other revenue officers in his district, when suits are brought them in their official capacity, and must report to the Solici of the Treasury the number of suit- determined and pendii in his district. And when prize cases have been defc - rti orare pending in the District Court of his district, hi report the state and condition of each case to flu - "t the Navy. 440 UNITED STATES MARSHALS. District Attorneys are appointed for four years, but may be removed at the pleasure of the President. Their compensation depends on the amount of business to be done in their respec- tive districts. When important ports of entry, such as New York or Boston, lie in their districts, their duties are very numerous, and they receive a corresponding compensation. CHAPTER LXIII. UNITED STATES MARSHALS. 1. United States Marshals are the ministerial officers of the United States courts. Their duties and responsibilities are very similar, and nearly identical with the duties and respon- sibilities of sheriffs in the courts of the several States. They are appointed by the President and Senate, for a term of four years. They appoint their own deputies, and their compensa- tion consists of fees instead of a salary; and depends entirely upon the amount of business they have to transact. There is a Marshal in every Judicial District in the United States, and there are fifty-nine of these districts in all. Every State forms at least one district, while the larger States are divided into two or three. 2. A District Court is held in every district; and it is the Marshal's duty to attend the sittings of these courts, and also those of the United States Circuit Courts, when they happen to sit in his district. The Marshal for the District of Colum- bia must also attend the sittings of the Supreme Court, and execute its precepts. We have said that they are the ministe- rial officers of the United States courts; for it is their duty to serve all writs and precepts emanating from them, whether of a civil or criminal character; and to execute the judgments and decrees of these tribunals ; and for this purpose they are authorized by law, (if necessary,) to command such assistance as they may need in the execution of their duties. Before they enter upon the duties of their office, they must be bound GRAND JURY. | | | to the United States for the faithful performance of thorn, and must solemnly swear to do them, without malice or partiality ; and that they will take only lawful fees. They are also belt! answerable for the delivery to their successor- of all prisoi who may be in their custody at the time of their removal, at the expiration of their term of office. 3. They also have the custody of all vessel* and goods seized by any officer of the revenue. It is their duty also to summon, and to pay jurors and witnesses in behalf of any prisoner to be tried for a capital offense, under the laws of the United States. In the remarks made under the head " Cen- sus," we stated that it was made the duty of the Marshals to superintend and direct the enumeration of the people; and to collect such statistical facts as the law requires. This they <1<> through deputies, whom they appoint for that special purp The United States Marshal is also required, on the firsl day of January and July of each year, to make a return of all the fees and emoluments of his office to the Secretary of the lute rior; and if they amount to more than $0,000 per year, he must pay the surplus into the Treasury of the United State.-. CHAPTEE LXIY. GEAND JUEY. 1. By turning to the fifth article of the amendments to the Constitution, you will find these words: - No person shall be held to answer for a capital or otherwise infamous crime, unless on a presentment or indictment of a Grand Jnry; except in cases arising in the land or naval forces, or in the militia. « in actual service, in time of war or public danger." Thi stitutional provision makes a Grand Jury a very im] agent or instrumentality in the execution of the law a safeguard of the liberties and rights of the people secures every person from the expense and disgrace of a for infamous crimes, unless a Grand Jury of hi.- countrymen 442 GRAND JURY. shall lind upon inquiry and investigation, that there are good reasons for believing that the person so charged has committed the alleged offense. 2. This provision not only protects those who are charged with these crimes against the laws of the United States, but those also who may be charged with such offenses against the laws of any State ; for no State can arrest and try any person for a capital or infamous crime without these preliminary pro- ceedings of a Grand Jurv; and should it do so, the United States Supreme Court would set its laws aside, as contrary to the Constitution of the United States. Here we see that the government is just as careful to protect its citizens from injus- tice by hasty judicial proceedings as it is to punish them after a fair and impartial trial. 3. A Grand Jury, when called to take cognizance of viola- tions of the laws of the United States, to find indictments ao-ainst those who are charged with them, is summoned by a judge of a United States court in the circuit or district where the alleged crime has been perpetrated; and it must take notice of all crimes against the laws of the United States, which may be brought to its knowledge, within the circuit or district in which it sits. Hence, if ordered by a Circuit Judge, its powers extend over all those States which lie in that circuit. But when ordered by a District Judge, its powers extend only to that district in which it sits, and a district never embraces more than one State, and in many cases a State is divided into two or three districts. 4. This shows us how much more extensive is the jurisdic- tion of a Grand Jury, when acting under the laws of the United States, than when acting under State laws. In the former it extends generally all over a State, and sometimes over several States. But in the latter it is confined to the county in which it sits. GRAND AND PETIT JURIES. A Grand Jury never acts but in criminal cases. A Petit Jury acts in both criminal and civil cases. The finding or GKAND JUKY. conclusion arrived at by a Grand Jury is called a presentment, or an indictment. The finding of a Petit dun is called its verdict. 5. Second, a Grand Jury sits alone (not in the pr< of the court), and deliberates upon such matters of a criminal character as it possesses knowledge of, or which may tx brought to its notice by the court or by other persons; and when it finds that great evils exist, and wrongs have i" perpetrated, it presents them to the court, and calls the atten- tion of the law officers to them; which is equivalent U> a recommendation that judicial proceeding.- should be com- menced to abate the evil, or to punish the wrong-doer. This is called a presentment of the Grand Jury. And when they find, upon such evidence as they hav< . a great crime has been perpetrated, or that they have i: 1 reason so to believe, and that it has been perpetrate! by Borne person specified, they report their finding or conclusion to the Court. This is called an indictment by the Grand .1 urv; after which the person so charged is arrested, if at large, and can be found, and is either imprisoned or held to bail tor his appearance at court to stand trial. 6. A Grand Jury never tries a case. It only say.- t«. I court by its presentment or indictment, that the case | sented, or the person indicted, ought to be brought before the court, and tried for the alleged wrong or crime. A Petit Jury sits with the court, hears the pleading- and arguments of counsel on both sides, li-t; -:i> to the evid< of witnesses; and then hears the charge of the judge, ac the law applicable to the case; alter winch they withdraw and deliberate alone upon the case, and it' they agree in a criminal case, their verdict is "Guilty," or "Not Guilty;" if in a civil suit, they say how much one party is indebted (if a' to the other. 7. The object aimed at in that article of the Constitul which stands at the head of this chapter, Is to protect | from false charges of crime, and hasty adjudication of Mich 444 LOCAL GOVERNMENTS. charges; for it substantially amounts to a declaration that no person shall be punished for a capital or infamous crime, unless one jury, before trial, shall, upon information and belief, charge him with the offense; and another, after trial, shall find him guilty of the alleged crime. The above remarks are as applicable to Grand and Petit Juries, acting under State, as those which act under the United States laws. CHAPTEK LXY. LOCAL GOVEKNMENTS. 1. The Supreme power in the United States is lodged in the general government, with its three branches : Legislative, Executive, and Judicial. The authority of this government, however, is restricted to the powers expressly conferred on it by the Constitution ; all other power being reserved to the States, or the people. The States also are sovereign in their own limits, over all questions not expressly assigned to the General Government. Instead of conflict of authority there is true harmony. The people elect the members of both the classes of legislators and executives, and both are equally employed in attending to the interests of the people confided to their care; the first to General, the second to Local interests. All the members and officers of each are the servants of the Sovereign People. 2. As soon as the general government was organized under the Constitution, there arose two parties. One wished to ren- der the General Government prominent in order to secure con- centration of strength and vigor of action ; the other desired to exalt the State governments in the fear that the general government might prove ambitious of too much power, and disregard the welfare of the people. As in almost all party platforms, both these seemed to take too narrow a view. Wash- ington was held to sympathize more with the first, Jefferson LOCAL GOVERNMENTS. 4.)., ■was the acknowledged leader of the second. Together : secured a very fair mingling of both these principles in the administration and general policy of the country. A Btrict adherence to the meaning and spirit of the ( lonstitution would not seem to give special favor to either, or allow a conflict of interests. 3. The Supreme Court, or the Judiciary, is the regulating, or reconciling element, which the Constitution set over tin- whole to see that no undue or improper action should defeat its purposes, and that no collisions of authority should occur. Its decision is final, it being the last resort in cases of appeal : and, as the only final and authoritative interpreter of Consti tutional Law, it may revise the action of all other branches of both general and local government, and put them in harmony. 4. It is plain that the authors of the Constitution intended to fuse the separate elements, or States, into one whole, when- general matters were concerned; and to leave those elements perfectly free and absolute control of all questions involving only their separate and local concerns. The People, and their welfare, are the aim and end of both organization-. The : session of power for ambitious ends by general. State, or muni- cipal organizations, or by individuals, was apparently as foreign to the thought of the whole Constitutional convention of 17^7 as it seems always to have been to the mind of Washington. That great man was the leader of clear-sighted and pure-minded statesmen, and whatever weaknesses and faults have existed ai any time (and there have always been an abundance <<( them, as there were in the times of Washington) among political leaders, it must be allowed that tin- Fathers had worth) who knew how to work correctly the problems left them by their predecessors. A single question proved quite unmanage- able to the sons, as it had before to the father., and had to be settled by an appeal to arms; but it demonstrated the Bfa of the people and the ability of our institutions to withstand the severest shocks. 5. The original States adopted the Constitution after deliD- 44fi LOCAL GOVERNMENTS. erate study, and all the States since admitted virtually do the same. Their general structure in their legislative, executive, and judicial arrangements is substantially the same as that of the General Government. The State Legislatures consist of two Houses, chosen in different ways, and for different terms ; the relations between them being similar to those of Congress. Every State has a governor, answering to the President of the United States, who is the executive officer of the State govern- ment. The courts in all are organized on the same principle as the Supreme Court of the general government. Although there are small variations from the model, in various States, they do not affect the general resemblance ; and, due allow- ance being made for the different subjects to be treated, the analysis of the general, or of any of State governments, will give a sufficiently correct view of all. 6. A State cannot make treaties with a foreign power, nor declare war against it. It cannot raise a revenue by duties on imports, nor control the postal service, or matters involving the interests of other States. It has therefore no Department for Foreign relations, its Secretary of State dealing only with State affairs. It has no Department of War, or Navy, and no Postmaster General. The Governor's signature is necessary to the validity of laws passed by the two branches of the legis- lature, and in most of the States he has a veto power similar to that of the President. He has an executive council answer- ing to the Cabinet. The courts are more numerous than those of the general government, to meet the wants of all classes of the people; ranging from a Supreme or Constitutional court, whose office it is to interpret and apply the constitution of the State; through all grades, of Common Pleas, Circuit, District, Police, and Recorder's courts down to neighborhood courts held by Justices of the Peace, or Aldermen. There are various others in different States for special purposes. 7. States are subdivided for purposes of local government into counties and towns ; and these into smaller portions for educational and other purposes. INDIVIDUAL STAT I 9. }|7 Thus the whole is like an extensive system of machi wheel being fitted to wheel. From the Lowesl to the big] the people of each local division have entire control over the subjects in which they only are interested ; and there is ?en little opportunity for the exercise of arbitrary power. I. • tive officers may be changed by election, or impeachment, it' they do not give satisfaction, or prove unfaithful; and as mam securities as it is possible to devise are provh led a^ain.-t abu or, if a majority in any State (or the United States) belli that an improvement can be made, there are constitutional and legal methods for securing it. Thus our country is insured against serious discontents for which no remedy is at hand; and from the revolution-, and internal disturbances that interrupt the progress, and de-trov the resources of so many other countries. It is a government of, for, and by the people. The value of any institution or office in the United States, from the school district and director to State legislature, Congress, governor, or President, is deter- mined by the relation it bears to the Public Welfare; and when it ceases to be useful there are, as there ought to be, legal means for laying it aside. CHAPTER LXYI. INDIVIDUAL STATES. The original thirteen States are here arranged in the i of size — the one having the largest ana being placed first They are ranked according to their pre* nt area, the claims oi some of them at first extending to territory Bince erected States; and one, Virginia, has been divided, lb r former ai would have ranked her as first. The States that follow are placed in the order of their admis- sion into the Union. 448 GEORGIA. GEORGIA. This State was the last settled of the original thirteen. It was founded in the benevolent anxiety of Gen. James Ogle- thorpe and others to relieve the distresses of the poor in England. Those imprisoned for debt were sent out in large numbers. "With this object was connected the desire to prevent the extension of the Spanish settlements in Florida, and the English government favored the undertaking. This class of settlers proving indolent and improvident, a better was attracted by laying off many towns, in the best locations, and offering fifty acres free to every actual settler. Many Scotch and Ger- man emigrants improved this opportunity, to the great advan- tage of the colony. Gen. Oglethorpe imitated the wise conduct of Penn, in his treaties with the Indians. He commenced his settlement at Savannah, in 1733, cheer- fully assisted by the South Carolinians, who were pleased to see a barrier placed between them and the Spaniards. Ogle- thorpe had several conflicts with them, and succeeded in protecting his colony. The introduction of slaves was at first forbidden ; but, as the colony seemed to fall behind the neigh- boring provinces for want of laborers, the restriction was removed. In 1752 the company gave up their charter, and Georgia became a royal province. It took part with the other colonies in resistance to the aggressions of the English minis- try, at the Revolutionary period, and its condition during the war was similar to that of North and South Carolina. Being new, and on the frontier, it was not conspicuous. The northern part of the State is uneven, the central and GEORGIA. 449 lower sections productive under a wise and careful culture, l>ut easily exhausted under Lad management. She has Long navi- gable rivers, and her manufacturing and commercial capabilil are excellent. The system of slave-labor and the misfortu of the Civil War have embarrassed her progress, but the energy of her people is fast raising her to her proper rank as B flourish- ing State. Georgia has an area of 52,009 square miles, equal to 33,285,760 acres. She was named after George II. The population in 1870 was 1,200,000, which entitles her to nine Representatives in Congress. The State lies in the fifth judicial circuit, and has two judicial districts; also four ports of entry — Savannah, Brunswick, St. Mary's, and Hardwicke; and two ports of delivery — Augusta and Sunbury. The capital is Atlanta. The State election is held on tin- first Tuesday in August. The Legislature meets on the second Wednesday in January. The enacting clause of her laws is : " Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the State of Georgia in General Assembly met ; and it is hereby enacted by the authority of the same." UNITED STATES SENATORS. William Few, from 1789 to 1793. James Gunn, u 1789 u 1801. James Jackson, il ( 1793 1 1801 u L795. L806. George Walton, u 1795 « 1796. Josiah Tatnall, a 1796 a 1 799. A. Baldwin, u ( IT:"; ( 1805 a << i^h;>. L807. J. Melledge, George Jones, << 1806 1807 u L809. 1807. W. H. Crawford, a L807 U 1 - 1 3. Charles Tait, u ( 1809 1 1813 U 1 - 1 :>.. 1 8 1 9. 29 450 NORTH CAROLINA. W. B. Bullock, William W. Bibb, G. M. Troup, John Forsyth, F. Walker, John Elliot, Nicholas Ware, T. W. Cobb, O. H. Prince, John P. King, W. Lumpkin, J. M. Berrien, A. Cuthbert, W. T. Colquitt, H. V. Johnson, W. C. Dawson, Robert Toombs, K. M. Charleton, Alfred Iverson, Joshua Hill, Foster Blodgett, Thomas M. Norwood, John B. Gordon, from 1813 to 1813. u 1813 < ' 1816. a ( 1815 < I 1829 < ' 1818. ' 1833. a ( 1819 ' I 1829 < ' 1819. ' 1837. a 1819 ' < 1821. a 1819 ' < 1821. « 1821 < ' 1823. a 1824 < < 1828. a 1828 < ' 1829. u 1833 < < 1837. a 1837 < ' 1841. a j 1825 ' t 1841 < ' 1829. ' 1851. a 1837 < 1 1843. u 1843 < < 1849. u 1848 < ' 1849. ii 1849 < < 1855. ii 1853 < < 1861. ii 1852 < < 1853. ii 1855 ' < 1861. ii 1871 ' < 1873- ii 1871 ' 1 1871. ii 1871 < ' 1877. ii 1873 < ' 1879. NORTH CAROLINA. A Florentine navigator, sent out by Francis I., King of France, first published an account of this region. He visited NORTH CAi:«»i IN A. j ;, | it in 1524. Eibault, a French protestant, Bent out wiih a colony by Admiral Coligni, in 15t;4, named the southern >•■ Carolina, from Charles IX. (in Latin Carolus), King of 1 The colony was not permanent. In 1585 Sir Walter Raleigh made an unsuccessful attempt to establish a colony on Roanoke Island. Some fifty years later the colonists of Virginia made a settlement in the limits of this State, called Albemarle. This territory was patented to a company of noblemen. The first colony, founded before this patent was issued, and enjoy- ing entire liberty, became an asylum from the religious intol- erance, almost universal at that time. In 1666 they numbered 800. Many French Huguenots, attracted by this freedom and the mild climate and extreme fertility of the soil, settled here and added greatly to the industrious and virtuous elements of tin- population. The revolutionary struggle was singularly bitter and bloody in this State and South Carolina, from the number and sanguinary character of the royalists and toriee, and from the partisan or guerrilla mode of warfare adopted. The majority were, however, determined and valiant patriots, and rendered it impossible for the British to establish a firm control over this part of the country. The eastern surface is low, the western mountainous, and much of the midland is covered with pine forests which pro duce large quantities of turpentine. The soil is favorable to agriculture. Yams, rice, and cotton, in addition to the a are raised with success. The fisheries in Albemarle Sound are an important source of wealth. A large number of mint are found in the State. Like most of the Southern Stal resources have been but partially developed. This is one of the original thirteen State-, and has an area of 50,704 square miles, equal to 32,450,560 acres, with a population of 1,069,614 (one-third colored), and entitled eight members of Congress. North Carolina, by act of I86fi was located in the fourth judicial circuit, which is comp of Maryland, Virginia, West Virginia, North Carolina, 452 NORTH CAROLINA. South Carolina ; and is divided into three judicial districts, called the districts of Albemarle, Pamlico, and Cape Fear. The collection districts, and the ports of entry and delivery in this State have been so often modified and discontinued that there is some uncertainty as to the number. There are, as near as we can determine, ten districts, ten ports of entry, and nine ports of delivery. Raleigh is the capital. There the Legislature meets bien- nially on the first Monday in November. The State election is held on the first Thursday in August. The enacting clause of the laws is as follows : " Be it enacted by the General Assembly of the State of North Carolina, and it is hereby enacted by the authority of the same." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Samuel Johnson, from 1789 to 1793. Benjamin Hawkins, " 1789 " 1795. Alexander Martin, " 1793 " 1799. Timothy Bloodworth, " 1795 " 1801. Jesse Franklm, u j ^ (t ^ David Stone, " 1801 " 1813. James Turner, " 1805 " 1816. Nathaniel Macon, " 1815 " 1828. James Iredell, " 1828 " 1831. Montford Stokes, " 1816 " 1823. John Branch, " 1823 " 1829. Bedford Brown, " 1829 " 1840. tit-it -d nr " i 1840 " 1853. Willie P. Mangum, u } ^ u ^ Robert Strange, " 1836 " 1840. "William A. Graham, " 1840 " 1843. William H. Haywood, " 1843 " 1846. George E. Badger, « 1846 « 1855. Asa Biggs, " 1854 " 1858. David 8. Reed, " 1855 " 1859. Thomas L. Clingman, " 1858 " 1861. NEW YOBS. Thomas Bragg, from 1859 to 1861. Joseph C. Abbott, u 1868 « 1873 John Pool, « 1868 " 1873 Zebulon B. Vance, a 1871 " 1-7;; Matthew W. Kansom, u " ls77 Augustus S. Merriman, a 1873 " 1879 NEW YORK. Tlie "Empire State" is very fortunately situated for the promotion of all the interests that form the basis of prosperity of a Nation. It contains the commercial metropolis of the country, which is connected, by its great navigable river, the Hudson, and the Erie canal, with the fertile interior and the commerce of the chain of great lakes in the west; while Lakes Ontario and Champlain furnish the means of profitable trade with Canada on the north. As its natural commercial facili- ties are unrivaled, so also, every auxiliary that can be furnished by art is employed to develop its resources and to attract trade and manufactures. Its river was discovered by the celebrated navigator, ( !aptain Henry Hudson, in 1609, and he gave it his name. Be was employed, at this time by the Dutch, who claimed and Betl i '1 the territory in the following year. They established posts on Manhattan Island, where New York now stands, and at Albany — calling the country in general. New Netherlands. They held it until 1644; laying claim, also, to Connecticut and New Jer- sey. Their rule was despotic, and when the Duke of Fork, afterward James II., King of England, Bent a squadron to enforce English claims to it. the inhabitants declined to n sist, and it became an English colony without a struggle. The city 454 NEW YORK. and colony received the name of New York and continued henceforth in English hands. Its position favored a steady growth in population and wealth ; and it took an active part in the Revolution. Its central position made it the pivot of the war, the leading struggles taking place in or near it. New York city was held by the British during most of the war, but the skillful strategy and watchfulness of Washington, and the valor of his officers and troops preserved the river in American hands throughout. It ratified the Constitution July 26th, 1788, and soon outstripped every State in all things, except education, no State being able to compare with Massachusetts in that respect. New York is the largest and richest city in the Union. The State abounds in salt and mineral springs, and its central and western parts are unexcelled for agriculture; while the eastern, more mountainous, but nearer to markets, and more abundant in water power, is equally favorable to grazing and manu- factures. Its area is 47,000 square miles, equal to 30,080,000 acres. The population in 1870 was larger than that of any other State, being officially stated at 4,364,411. It has thirty-three Mem- bers of Congress. It forms part of the second judicial circuit, and has three judicial districts; eleven ports of entry, and fourteen ports of delivery, with the privilege of eight or nine others if the Presi- dent of the United States deems them necessary. The Capital is Albany. The State elections are held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November, and the Legisla- ture meets on the first Tuesday in January in each year. The style of the enacting clause is: " Be it enacted by the people of the State of New York represented in Senate and Assembly.'* UNITED STATES SENATORS. Philip Schuyler, from 1789 to 1791. EufusKing, « < 1789 ' " 1796 1813 " 1825. Aaron Burr, " 1791 " 1797. NEW Y<>i;k. John Lawrence, from 1796 to 1800. John S. Hobart, it 1798 U 17: William North, U 1798 « L798. James Watson, u 1798 Resigned. Governeur Morris, u 1800 « L808. John Armstrong, <( I 1800 1 1803 1802. 1804. DeWitt Clinton, (( 1802 u 1803. Theodore Bailey, a 1803 u 1804. Samuel L. Mitchell, a 1804 a 1809. John Smith, e6 130-1 a 1813. Obadiah German, c€ 1809 a 1815. Nathan Sanford, a j 1815 ( 1825 1821. 1831. Martin Van Buren, it 1821 a 1829. Charles Dudley, u 1829 « 1833. William L. Marcy, « 1831 a 1838. Natli'l P. Tallmadge, a 1833 it 1844. Silas Wright, a 1833 a 1844. Daniel S. Dickinson, a 1844 a 1851. Henry A. Foster, u 1844 a 1845. John A. Dix, a 1845 a 1849. William H. Seward, u 1840 « 1861. Hamilton Fish, u 1851 « 1857. Preston King, a 1857 U 1868. Ira Harris, u 1861 u 1867. Edwin D. Morgan, a 1863 a is<59 Roscoe Conkling, « 1867 M L870. Reuben E. Fenton, u 1869 CI 1875. Francis Kern an, u 1875 (C L88L 456 PENNSYLVANIA. PENNSYLVANIA. " The Keystone State " has been eminently fortunate in three various ways. Its founder, William Penn, happily united benevolence and high political wisdom, with a thrifty and pru- dent economy, and possessed sufficient influence and tact to infuse his colony with his own qualities to a large degree, and the advantages acquired in the beginning, have shed their favoring influence on all its future, to the present time. Penn, as proprietor of his province, had almost kingly power; yet, as a law-giver, he acknowledged the liberties of the people, and accustomed them to many of the forms of self- government afterward incorporated into the Constitution of the United States. His just and conciliatory conduct toward the Indians, and the exemption of Pennsylvania from barbarous Indian wars, in consequence, proves the utility of the practice of unvarying justice and kindness toward them; and stands in strong and significant contrast with the opposite course, so often pursued, and with results so distressing. A colony was established by Penn in the southeastern part of the State, in the year 1682. The government was conducted by a governor, a council of three, and a House of Delegates, chosen by the people. The largest religious liberty was allowed, and punishment of crime was mitigated from the severity, cus- tomary in those times, to something like the mildness now practiced among us. The colony enjoyed seventy years of enlightened government, and prospered greatly. A large immigration of hardy and thrifty Germans and Swedes spread over the State and supplied, PENNSYLVANIA. |.,7 in Revolutionary times, the "fighting material " which the religious principles of the Quakers forbade them to furnish. The second eminent advantage of the State, was in it- .-. (1 tral position, the facilities furnished to commerce and trade the Delaware river on its eastern boundary, and the < Hrio, on the west, connecting it with the valley of the Mississippi. The third superiority, later in development in some of it.- features, relates to its wealth of resources. Lying mi'!.. between north and south, its climate is temperate and mild. Its soil on the eastern border and along the valleys of numerous rivers is of great fertiity; while its inexhaustible coal deposits are far more valuable in promoting I ady growth of her citizens in wealth than mines of gold. Iron, copper, zinc, marble and slate are, apparently, inexhaustible. Her railroads and canals furnish a suitable means for the devel- opment of these resources, and the transportation for all her valuable commodities to profitable markets, and prove her later citizens to have inherited the economic wisdom and thril the founder of their State. Pennsylvania valiantly bore the share in the struggles and sacrifices of the Revolution to which her position, her wealth and numbers, called her. Philadelphia — -"The City <>t" Broth- erly Love" (the name means this,) was the first capital of Republic. It was there that the Declaration of Independence was originated and signed. Its area is 46,000 square miles, equal to 29,440, acr The population in 1870 was 3,515,993, entitling her to twenty- seven Representatives in Congress. It is in the third judicial circuit; and forms two judicial districts. There are two ports of entry, and two collection districts. Harrisburg is the capital; the Legislature assem- bling on the first Tuesday in January, the State elections being held the second Tuesday in October. The enacting clause of her laws is: "Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the Commonwealth of 458 PENNSYLVANIA. Pennsylvania in General Assembly met; and it is hereby enacted by the authority of the same." UNITED STATES SENATORS. "William Maclay, Robert Morris, Albert Gallatin, James Ross, William Bingham, Peter Muhlenburgh, Samuel Maclay, Michael Leib, Andrew Gregg, Abner Lacock, Jonathan Roberts, Walter Lawrie, William Findlay, William Marks, Isaac D. Barnard, George M. Dallas, William Wilkins, Samuel McKean, James Buchanan, Daniel Sturgeon, Simon Cameron, James Cooper, Charles R. Buckalew, Richard Broadhead, William Bigler, Edgar Cowan, David Wilmot, John Scott, Simon Cameron, Wm. A. Wallace, from 1789 to 1791. « 1789 a 1795. a 1793 a 1794. a 1794 u 1803. a 1795 a 1801. a 1801 n 1802. « 1803 a 1808. a 1808 a 1814. a 1807 u 1813. a 1813 a 1819. u 1814 a 1821. a 1819 a 1825. ii 1821 a 1827. a 1825 a 1831. a 1827 u 1831. a 1831 a 1833. a 1831 a 1834. a 1833 u 1839. a 1834 u 1845. a 1839 u 1851. (1845 ii 1849. a ] 1857 ii 1861. (l867 ii 1873. u 1849 ii 1855. u 1863 ii 1869. « 1851 ii 1857. a 1855 ii 1861. u 1861 ii 1867. ii 1861 ii 1863. a 1869 u 1875. a 187* ii 1879. a 1875 a 1881. VIKOIMA. VIRGI NI A. "The Old Dominion," as this State lias been called, in familiar style, has certain high claims to such a distinctive appellation. It was the colony in which the tirst permanent settlement was made, and for fourteen years before the perils of the wilderness were encountered by the Puritan Fathers of New England, it confronted famine and Indian hostility. It- people were quite different in character from those of most of the other colonies. While many were from the Lowest dae a goodly number of the gentry and nobility of England v transplanted to this colony. Some were men of wealth, char- acter and influence; and the hereditary value of that element became conspicuous when revolutionary times came, and the colonial government, which had been from the first, kepi closely dependent on the royal will, being set aside, permitted to this class a free field of action. None were more eloquent, more zealous, more valiant or wise, during the " time that tried men's souls." The talents, patriotism, and wisdom of Wash- ington, Jefferson, Madison, Monroe, and many others almost equally useful, attest the quality of the Virginian Btoci of patriots, and shed honor on their native State It was settled in 1607, at Jamestown. The infant colony was long exposed to danger of destruction by Indian hostility ; but, favored by circumstances, grew up to strength, and became a protection to others. An almost constant Btrnggle was m tained with the royal governor, who were disposed to encrou on their liberties. Notwithstanding the number of d< and worthless gentlemen, and the dregs of the Englial lace, who entered as components into her population, M a 460 VIRGINIA. whole, they proved worthy of the republic they so largely helped to rear. Their best blood was spilled in its cause, and their material support was never withheld in time of need. This State is much varied in surface. In the southeast it is low and level ; in the west and northwest mountainous, with numerous large streams and fertile vallies, and a charming climate. Its mineral wealth of coal, iron and salt is very great; its water power for manufacturing purposes unsur- passed; and its commercial position everything to be desired. None of these advantages have been more than partially improved; and the future of the State is destined to be exceed- ingly brilliant. Old and flourishing colleges testify to the interest taken in education; and railroads and other means of internal development have already prepared the way for its greatness. She exports tobacco, flour, oysters, and cotton, and her agricultural wealth is constantly improving. Virginia is also one of the original thirteen States, and had an area previous to the division in 1862, of 61,352 square miles, equal to 39,265,280 acres; but after West Virginia was set off as a separate State, there were but 38,352 square miles left of this once great State, equal to 24,515,280 acres. The population in 1860 amounted to 1,596,318, which enti- tles the State to nine Members of Congress. By the division the number of Eepresentatives was cut down to nine; the new State receiving three out of the twelve. Population in 1870, 1,224,830. Virginia lies in the fourth judicial circuit, which by the act of 1866, was composed of this State, Maryland, "West Vir- ginia, and North Carolina and South Carolina. There were two judicial districts in this State, anterior to the division; the Eastern and the Western. There is now but one. There were also twelve collection districts in this State, and twelve ports of entry, all of which remain the same as they were before AVest Virginia was cut off, for they were all located on the Atlantic coast, or on the bays and rivers running into the Atlantic Ocean; there are also ten ports of delivery. Richmond is the capital. The State election is held on the VIKCINI \. .jr, i Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The Legi Lai meets on the first Monday in December. The enacting clause of the laws of Virginia is: " Beit enacted by the General Assembly." UNITED STATES SENATORS. William Grayson, Richard H. Lee, John "Walker, James Monroe, John Taylor, Stephen T. Mason, John Tazewell, Wilson C. Nichols, Abraham B. Venable, William B. Giles, Andrew Moore, Hi chard Brent, James Barbour, Armi stead T. Mason, John W. Eppes, James Pleasant, John Randolph, Littleton W. Tazewell, John Tyler, William C. Rives, Benjamin W. Leigh, Richard E. Parker, William II. Roane, William S. Archer, Isaac S. Pennybacker, James M. Mason, R. M. T. Hunter, John W. Johnston, John F. Lewis, Robert E. Withers, om L789 to 1790. « 1789 u 17!*!'. a 1790 .. 1790. a L790 u 1794, t 1792 a L794. u } 1803 it 1805. ( 1822 a L824. a 1794 u L803. a 1794 it L799. u 1799 « 1804. u 1803 a 1-1)4. a 1804 M L815. a 1804 U 1809. u 1809 a L815. u 1815 a L825. a 1816 a 1817. u L817 a L819. a 1819 a l--_' 2. a 1825 u L827. a 1824 (< 1832. a 1827 .. L836. (( ( 1832 ( 1S36 L834. hi:.. u 1*3-1 U L886. a is:;.; 1837 u u l-::7. 1841. u 1-41 u L847. a 1 - I- ». 1-17. a 1847 .. L861. « 1847 u L86L a 1870 .. 1-77. a 187" .. 1-7:. l( is 7:. . • 1881. 462 SOUTH CAROLINA. SOUTH CAROLINA. The first permanent settlement in this State was made in 1670, at Port Royal, where the French Huguenots had failed three-quarters of a century before. The noble company who had received a charter for the settlement and government of the Carolinas employed the celebrated philosopher, John Locke, to draw up a philosophical plan of goverment, which they attempted to carry into effect to the great annoyance of the colonists. It proved impracticable, and was finally aban- doned. The French introduced the culture of the vine with success, and rice was brought at an early day from Madagascar, the cultivation of which became extensive. Many vexations were endured by the colonists by the inju- dicious management of the proprietary government, and at length they, by petition, obtained a revocation of the charter, receiving, in 1720, a governor appointed by the crown. They endured for many years all the horrors of warfare with the Tuscarora Indians, whom they finally defeated and expelled Eutledge, Sumpter, and Marion were distinguished leaders of the patriots during the occupation of the State by the British forces; employing with success a partisan warfare, and defy- ing the efforts of a superior British force to hold the State in subjection. The climate has been likened to that of Italy, and the pro- ducts of the north and of the tropics are equally cultivated. The State abounds in agricultural and manufacturing resources, and has a fine commercial position. South Carolina is one of the original thirteen States, and SOUTH CAROLINA. ),;;; has an area of 29,385 square miles, making 18,806,400 with a population, in 1870, of 728,000, (over half colon which gives her five Members of Congress. By an act of 1866, South Carolina was located in the fourth judicial circuit; it is divided into two judicial districts, called the Eastern and Western. There are three collection districts in this state, and four ports of entry, to-wit: Georgetown, Charlestoii, Beanfori and Port Royal ; but no ports of delivery. The capital is Columbia. The State elections arc held <>n the fourth Monday in November. The Legislature meets on the third Wednesday in October. The enacting clause of the laws is as follows: "Be it enacted by the Honorable the Senate and House of Representatives, now met and sitting in General Assembly, and by authority of the same." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Pierce Butler, from j 1790 to 1796. ( 1802 a L804. Ralph Izard, « 1789 n 1795. Jacob Read, u 1795 a 1801. John Hunter, u 1796 u L798. Charles Pinckney, u 1798 a L801. Thomas Sumpter, « 1801 u L810-. John E. Calhoun. a 1801 u L802. John Gaillard, u 1804 ii 1826. John Taylor, a 1810 it 1816. ( 1816 ( 1826 U L823. William Smith, M u L831. William Harper, it 1826 it 1826. Robert J. Hane, a 1823 i. L832. Stephen D. Miller, u 1831 it L838. ( 1832 ( 1846 u hi:'. John C. Calhoun, u it 1850. William C. Preston, h 1S33 to L842. Daniel E. Huger, u L842 » ( L846. 464 MARYLAND. George McDuffie, from 1842 to 1846 Andrew P. Butler, a 1846 a 1857 Franklin H. Elmore, a 1850 a 1850 Robert "W. Barnwell, « 1850 a 1852 William Desaussure, a 1852 a 1852 Josiah Evans, a 1852 a 1858 James H. Hammond, a 1857 u 1860 James Chestnut, a 1858 a 1861 Arthur P. Hayne, a 1858. Thomas J. Robertson, a 1868 a 1877. Frederick A. Sawyer, a 1868 a 1873. John J. Patterson, a 1873 u 1879. M ARYL AN D. This territory at first was included in the patent to the Vir- ginia colony; but was, in 1632, re-patented to Lord Baltimore, an English nobleman, who had embraced the catholic faith, and sought, in the American wilderness, an asylum where he and his co-religionists might enjoy the freedom from persecu- tion denied them in England. It was called Maryland from the queen of Charles L, King of England. A part of this patent was covered by that subsequently made to "William Penn, and produced much trouble between the descendants of these men, and their respective colonies. A settlement was commenced, mainly by catholic gentlemen, in 1634, and called St. Mary's, on a branch of the Potomac. The wise liberality that distinguished the settlement of Penn- sylvania marked all the earlier history of Maryland. They cultivated friendly relations with the natives and with their neighbors. Lord Baltimore was liberal in his expenditures for MARYLAND. the growing colony, and gave them a liberal government When the civil war commenced in England, resulting in the death of Charles I. and the rise of Cromwell to power, the first troubles of the colonists of Maryland began, and continued until 1716, when the heirs of the original proprietor resumed their rights and maintained them until the Revolution. This State was one of the original thirteen, and gave a heart) support to the patriot side during the war for freedom. The surface of the country is, in great part, Ions and sandy; the climate agreeable and the soil favorable to agricultural pursuits. Her commercial position is excellent, being situated on either side of Chesapeake bay and bounded by the Potomac river on the west. The District of Columbia, containing tin- National Capital, was located on the last named river within her limits. Maryland has an area of 11,124 square miles — equal to 7,119,360 acres. The population in 1870 was 780,806, which gives her six Representatives in Congress. By an act of < Ion gress, passed in 1866, this State was put in the fourth judicial circuit, which is composed of Maryland, Virginia, West Vir- ginia, North and South Carolina. Maryland constitutes one judicial district; has ten ports of entry, viz.: Baltimore, Ches- ter, Oxford, Vienna, Snow-Hill, Annapolis, Nottingham, St. Mary's, Georgetown, and Havre de Grace ; and twelve porta of delivery. Annapolis is the capital. The State election is held ou the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The Legislature meets on the first Wednesday in January. The enacting; clause of the laws is as follows: " Be it enacted by the General Assembly of Maryland." UNITED STATES SENATOR. Charles Carroll, ) from n89 t0 im (of Carrollton) ) John Henry, a 1789 ' ' 1797 Richard Potts, a 1793 ■ • L796 John E. Howard, u 1796 ' < 1808 30 ±6(0 MARYLAND. James Lloyd, from 1797 to 1800. William Hindman, " 1800 " 1801. Robert Wright, " 1801 " 1806. ( 1803 " 1815. .; R. H. Goldsborough, a Samuel Smith, ( ^ u ^ Philip Reed, " 1806 « 1813. 1813 " 1819. 1835 <'< 1836. Robert G. Harper, " 1816 " 1816. Alexander C. Hanson, " 1816 " 1819. William Pinckney, " 1819 " 1822. Edward Lloyd, " 1819 " 1826. Ezekiel F. Chambers, " 1826 " 1835. Joseph Kent, " 1833 " 1838. John S. Spence, « 1836 " 1841. William D. Merrick, " 1838 " 1845. John Leidsker, " 1841 " 1843. James A. Pearce, " 1843 " 1862. t? a t i a i 1845 " 1851. Reverdy Johnson, " < J I 1863 " 1868. David Stuart, " 1849 " 1850. Thomas G. Pratt, " 1850 " 1857. Anthony Kennedy, " 1857 " 1863. Thomas H. Hicks, " 1862 " 1864. John A. J. Cresswell, « 1865 " 1867. Philip F. Thomas, " " 1867. George Vickers, « 1868 " 1873. William T. Hamilton, « 1869 " 1875. George R. Dennis, " 1873 " 1879. Win. Pinckney Wythe, " 1875 " 1881. NEW HAMI'SIUKE. i.;; NEW HAMPSHIRE. This State is often called "The Old Granite State," as well from its mountainous character as the resolute spirit of its inhabitants. It is small, having an area of only '.'.•_' v <» square miles, which make 5,939,200 acres. Its population in 1870 was 318,300, entitling it to three Representatives in Congress. The tirst settlement was founded at Dover, in L624, by tin- English. It suffered much from Indian wars, and its growth was slow. It was made a separate province in 1680, Laving previously been under the jurisdiction of Massachusetts. It was one of the original thirteen States, and took an active and Vigorous part in the Revolutionary War. Its soil is light and unfavorable to agriculture, but furnishes good pasturage and produces fine cattle. It contains the White Mountains, the highest in New England. Its streams are utilized for manufacturing purposes. Quarries of marble and granite abound. Minerals, and precious stones of several vari- eties are found in various parts of the State. The hardy and enterprising sons to whom it has given birth are to be found in every State in the Union. It lies in the first judicial circuit ; constitutes one judicial district; and is embraced in one collection district, and there- fore has but one port of entry. There are three porta of delivery. The capital is Concord. The Legislature assembles on the first Monday in June, the State election being held the Becond Tuesday in March. The enacting clause of the laws runs thus : - Be it ena by the Senate and House of Representatives in General Assem- bly convened." 40g NEW HAMPSHIRE. UNITED STATES SENATORS. Paine Wingate, from 1789 to 1793. John Langdon, " 1789 " 1801. Samuel Livermore, " 1793 " 1801. Simeon Olcott, " 1801 " 1805. James Sheafe, " 1801 " 1802. William Plummer, " 1802 " 1807. Nicholas Gilman, " 1805 " 1814. Nahum Parker, « 1807 " 1810. Charles Cutts, " 1810 « 1813. Jeremiah Mason, " 1813 " 1817. Thomas W. Thompson, " 1814 " 1817. David L. Morrill, " 1817 " 1823. Clement Storer, " 1817 " 1819. John F. Parrott, " 1819 " 1825. Samuel Bell, 1823 " 1835. 1825 " 1831. a Charles G. Atherson, Levi Woodbury, ( ^ u ^ Isaac HiU, " 1831 " 1835. Henry Hubbard, " 1835 " 1841. John Page, " 1836 " 1837. Franklin Pierce, " 1837 " 1842. Leonard Wilcox, 1842 " 1842. 1843 " 1849. 1852 " 1853. Benning W. Jenness, 1845 " 1846. Joseph Cilley, " 1846 " 1847. John P. Hale, } ^ u ^ Moses Norris, " 1849 " 1855. Jared W. Williams, " 1853 " 1854. John S.Wells, " 1855 " 1855. James Bell, " 1855 " 1857. Daniel Clark, " 1857 " 1866. George C. Fogg, " 1866 " 1867. James W. Paterson, " 1867 " 1873. Aaron H. Cragin, " 1867 " 1877. Bainbridge Wadleigh, " 1873 " 1879. NEW JEESEY. NEW JERSEY. This State was first settled at Bergen by the Swedes sent over by the christian hero-king, Gustavus A-dolphus, in tin- year 1638. They, however, soon fell under the control of the Dutch, who claimed the territory. The next settlement was made at Elizabethtown, from Long Island, in 1664. Not Jersey came into the hands of the English along with New- Netherlands, but soon became an independent province; Philip Carteret becoming its first governor, in 1C>()5. It was for some time under the control of the celebrated Quaker, William Penn, received a liberal form of government, and, not suffering from the Indians enjoyed prosperity for many years. Afterwards it passed through various vicissitudes in its government, was for a time joined to New York, but recovered its independent existence in 1738; and was one of the original thirteen Stat taking a very prominent part in the Revolution. Its territory, lying between New York and Philadelphia, was the field <>n which the hostile armies fought and manouvered, for some years. It ratified the Constitution unanimously, December 18th, 1787. It has been rewarded for its patriotism and devo- tion to liberty b} T unbroken prosperity. Its manufactures in a flourishing state. Its vicinity to the great commercial centres of the Atlantic coast; the mildness of it- climate, and the adaptation of its soil to the growth of fruit and vegetables have made it the Garden State of the Union. Its agricultural wealth is much increased by its abundant bedsof marl and peat. The extreme north is hilly and the extreme south Ion and sandy. Education receives much attention. It has an area of 8.3'in square miles, or 5.X-J4* 470 NEW JERSEY. The population, by the census of 1870, was 905,794, which gives her seven Representatives in Congress. This State lies in the third judicial circuit, and forms one judicial district. There are six ports of entry, and as mairy collection districts; and also eight ports of delivery. Its capital is Trenton. The State election is held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November, and the Legisla- ture assembles the second Tuesday in January. The form of the enacting clause is as follows: "Be it enacted by the Senate and General Assembly of the St3*e of New Jersey." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Jonathan Elmer, William Patterson, Philemon Dickerson, John Rutherford, Fred'k Frelinghuysen, Richard Stockton, Franklin Davenport, James Schureman, Jonathan Dayton, Aaron Ogden, John Condi t, Aaron Kitchell, John Lambert, Mahlon Dickerson, James J. Wilson, Samuel L. Southard, Joseph Mcllvaine, Thos. Frelinghuysen, Ephraim Bateman, Garret D. Wall, Jacob Miller, William L. Dayton, John B. Thompson, from 1789 to 1791. u 1789 a 1790. u 1790 a 1793. a 1791 u 1798. « 1793 a 1796. u 1796 a 1799. u 1798 u 1799. u 1799 a 1801. u 1799 u 1805. u 1801 it 1803. a 1803 a 1811. u 1805 a 1809. a 1809 a 1815. a 1817 a 1833. u 1815 it 1821. < 1821 \ 1833 a 1823. u 1841. a 1823 u 1826. a 1829 u 1835. u 1826 a 1829. a 1835 a 1841. a 1841 a 1853. a 1842 a 1851. a 1853 « 1863. MASSACHUSETTS ill William Pennington, from William Wright, " Robert F. Stockton, John C. TenEyck, Richard S. Field, James W. Wall, John P. Stockton, F. T. Frelinghuysen, Alexander G. Cattell, John P. Stockton, F. T. Frelinghuysen, Thos. F. Randolph, a it it a u a it a u a 1858 1853 1863 1851 1859 1862 1863 1865 1867 1866 1869 1871 1875 to 1858. L859. 1866. L858. L865. 1863. L863. L866. 1869. 1871. 1877. Ism. MASSACH USETTS. The " Bay State," so named from the deep encroachments of the sea on her eastern border, was settled in 1620, at Ply- month, by English Puritans; a class of sternly pious men, who abandoned England to find freedom of worship in the sa\ wilds of America. They were men of great resolution and intelligence, and succeeded in imbuing the new colony with a fair degree of their own virtue. They suffered much, at first, from deprivation of the comforts they hud left in England,and from the hostility of the Indians. They were too much i earnest to be tolerant, and persecutions of pretended witches of Quakers and Baptists, have given them an unenviable notoriety. This State was a leading one among the original thirteen, and the first to take up arms and to be invaded by i forces at the commencement of the War oi the K- solution. Her influence on the national character has been great 472 MASSACHUSETTS. This State is the first in the Union for cotton and woolen man- ufactures, its cotton mills alone employing about twenty-five thousand hands. In extent of all its manufactures it is third in the Union. The soil is sterile in great part, but the energy of the people finds abundant other sources of wealth. Com- merce and fisheries receive much attention, and produce much wealth. Education is carefully attended to, and its public school sys- tem a model for other States. She has an area of 7,800 square miles. Her population in 1870 was 1,457,351, and entitles her to eleven Members of Congress. It is in the first judicial circuit, and forms one judicial district. There are fourteen ports of entry, and twenty-five ports of delivery in this State. Boston is the Capital, the metropolis of New England, and an important center of intellectual and business energy. The Legislature meets on the first Wednesday in January, and the State elections are held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in January. The enacting clause is: "Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives, in General Court assembled, and by the authority of the same, as follows:" UNITED STATES SENATORS. Tristram Dal ton. from 1789 to 1791. Caleb Strong, u 1789 u 1796. George Cabot, a 1791 ii 1796. Theo. Sedgewick, ii 1796 u 1799. Benj. Goodhue, a 1796 .. 1800. Samuel Dexter, a 1799 u 1800. Dwight Foster, a 1800 a 1803 Jonathan Mason, « 1800 u 1803. John Q. Adams, a 1803 a 1808. Timothy Pickering, a 1803 a 1811. .lames Lloyd, a ( 1808 I 1822 a a 1813. 1826. Joseph B. Varnum, a 1811 a 1817. Christopher Gore, a 1813 (i 1816. OONNECTlci 1 Eli P. Ashmun, from L816 In 1818 Harrison Gray Otis, « 1817 .. L822 Prentiss Mellon, a 1818 .. L8i Elijah II. Mills, u 1820 .. L827. Nathaniel Silsbee, u 1826 it L8i Daniel Webster, a 1 L827 j L845 L841. is:.-. Rufus Choate. a 1841 .. L845. John Davis, u ( 1835 ( 1845 Cf L841. 1853. Isaac C. Bates, « 1S4 1 (4 L845. Robert C. Winthrop, u 1850 Li L861. Robert Rantoul, u 1851 U l 85 1 . Edward Everett, a 1853 .. L854 Julius Rockwell, « 1854 .. L8J *Henry Wilson, « 1855 .. 181 Charles Sumner, a 1851 .. 1-71. George S. Boutwell, a L873 (( 1-77. William Washburn, tt 1S74 « 181 Henry L. Dawes, a 1875 u 1--1 * Elected Vice President, and when inaugurated Mr. Boutwell elected to fill out the unexpired term. CONNECTICUT. This State takes its name' from ita principal ri entering from the north, runs through the State nearly in center. It was settled in It;: 1 ,:; from Maswichu tility of the valley of the Connecticut attracting them the perils of conflict with the [ndians, aud with the Dutch, settled where New York uow stands, who laid claim 1 The Dutch withdrew, the Indians were subdued inmany Woo 474 CONNECTICUT. battles, and a Puritan State — exceeding, if possible, the relig- ious strictness of the Massachusetts colony, and not behind her in energy, in virtue, in attention to education, and love of lib- erty — soon grew up to wealth and prosperity. A decisive battle in 1636, on the Mystic river, annihilated the Pequod Indians. Connecticut, in 1700, followed the example set by Massachu- setts in 1638, by founding Tale college, which, to this day, very fairly rivals Harvard in the former State. Both have contributed largely to the intelligence and culture of the Ameri- can people. It took a leading part in the Revolution; ratified the constitution June 9th, 1788; and has displayed the zeal in promoting the public good that has been so prominent in the cultivation of her educational and material interests. The surface of the State is uneven and rocky. Manufactures and commerce are the leading interests, although agriculture is not neglected. It is rich in minerals. Gold, silver, lead, iron, copper and bismuth are found, while marble, of fine quality, and granite abound. Its area is small, embracing only 4,674 square miles, or 2,991,360 acres. It has four representatives in Congress. The population in 1870 was 537,418. It is part of the second judi- cial circuit, and constitutes one judicial district. She has five ports of entry, and rive collection districts, with twenty-two ports of delivery. It has had two capitals ever since the first two colonies, established at Hartford and New Haven, were united; and holds her State election on the first Monday in April. The Legislature meets the first "Wednesday in May. The enacting clause runs thus: " Be it enacted by the Sen- ate and House of Bepresentatives in General Assembly con- vened." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Oliver Ellsworth, from 1789 to 1796. William S. Johnson. " 1789 " 1791. Boger Sherman, " 1791 " 1793. DELAWARE. S.M. Mitchell, f rom 1793 tn l7M Jonathan Trumbull, « 1795 « 17 , u; ' Uriah Tracey, « 1796 .. {m ' J. Hillhouse, « J7!)n « lgl0 C.Goodrich, « | S()7 « l8]; , S. "W. Dana, « lgl() « lvM ' David Doggett, « l813 t « lgl9 ] James Lanman, " 1319 k . j s .,- E. Boardman, " 1321 " i qqo H.W.Edwards, « i 8 23 « jj, 7 Calvin Willey, « 1325 " [833 Samuel A. Foot, " [827 •• 1833 G. Tomlinson, " |s;>j .. ] S .,- Nathan Smith, « 1333 u iSB5 ' John M. Kiles, « i 1835 " 1839. (1843 " 1849. Perry Smith, « 1837 « L843. Thaddeus Betts, " 1839 " 1840. J.W.Huntington, « 1840 " L847. R.S.Baldwin, " 1847 •• [35] Truman Smith, " 1849 « 1855. Isaac Toucey, « L852 « L857. Francis Gillette, « 1854 •• 1856. L.S.Foster, « '855 « 1867. James Dixon, " 1857 " 1869. Orris S. Ferry, " 1867 " L879. W. A. Buckingham, " 1869 « 1875. Wm. W. Eaton, « 1^75 " 1881. 1 ./ DELAWARE. Tli© first settlement of Delaware waa mad.- by I lee, 476 DELAWARE. in pursuance of the policy of the valiant Gustavus Adolphus, king of Sweden. European wars, in which he was engaged, and in which he lost his life in 1633, deferred the project, but it was carried into effect in 1638, near the present city of Wil- mington. They extended their settlements from the entrance of Delaware bay far up the river, until the Dutch, from New Netherlands, who claimed the country, attacked and reduced them to submission, uniting New Sweden, as it had been called, to their own colony, in the year 1655. It fell, with that col- ony, into the hands of the English in 1664. It was included in the grant made to William Penn, in 1692. It was long attached to Pennsylvania, but in 1703 received permission to form a separate government, on the wise and liberal plan pur- sued by Penn. This form of government continued through the Revolutionary war. The surface of the State is level, or gently undulating, the climate is agreeable, except that, in winter, the sea breeze is somewhat harsh; the soil is sandy but fertile. Grain and fruit are raised, peaches being produced in great profusion. Her commercial and manufacturing business is limited, and she is destitute of mineral wealth. It is next to Rhode Island in size, containing the small area of 2,120 square miles, or 1,356,800 acres. Population 125,015. UNITED STATES SENATORS. George Read, from R. Bassett, John Yining, Kensey Johns, Henry Latimer, Joshua Clayton, W. H. Wells. Samuel White. " J. A. Bayard, " (). Horsey, " N. Yan Dyke, " 1789 to 1793. 1789 u 1793. 1793 a 1798. 1794 a 1795. 1795 a 1801. 1798 « 1799. 1799 a 1804. 1813 a 1817. 1801 a 1810. 1804 a 1813. 1810 a 1821. 1817 a 1826. RHODE ISLAM i. C. A. Rodney, from 1 822 to L828. T. Clayton, u ) 1824 ( 1887 CI L827. .. L847. D. Rodney, (« 1826 u L827. H. Ridgely, « 18i' 7 .. 1829. L. McLane, « 1827 M 1829. J. M. Clayton, u j 1829 H L887. ( 1845 U 1849. A. Naudain, a 1830 U !-::»;. R. H. Bayard, a 1836 a L845. P. Spruance, « 1847 a 1853. John Wales, u 1849 u L851. J. A. Bayard, a 1851 u L864. M. W. Bates, a 1857 a 1859. J. P. Comeygs, u 1856 a 1857. W. Sanlsbury, u 1859 it 1871. G. R. Riddle, u 1864 U im;7. J. A. Bayard, « 1867 u 1869. Thomas F. Bayard, u 1869 u L881 Eli Saulsbury, « 1871 U 1877. I • RHODE ISLAND. This is the smallest of the States, having an area of but 1,306 square miles, or 835,840 acres. It was settled in 1636 by Roger Williams, and beoami avowed place of refuge for persecuted Christiana of all nan but especially for Baptists, among whom Mr. William.- wu a leader. It was chartered as a separate eolonj in 1644* and the excellent constitution framed under it lasted until L818. 478 RHODE ISLAND. was one of the original thirteen States and took an earnest share in the struggles of the revolution, though it was not represented in the convention that framed the Constitution, and did not ratify it until 1790. Its citizens are mainly engaged in the manufacturing and commercial pursuits for which their excellent harbors and streams furnish eminent facilities. It has always been pros- perous, its people being distinguished for industry and activity. Its population was, in 1870, 217,356. Rhode Island forms part of the first judicial circuit; consti- tutes one judicial district; and has three ports of entry, and seven of delivery. It has two capitals, having been originally formed of two separate colonies. These are Providence and Newport. The election for State officers is held on the first Wednesday in April. The Legislature is held twice in the year, in May and January. The style of her enacting clans© is: "It is enacted by the General Assembly, as follows." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Theodore Foster, Joseph Stanton, William Bradford, Ray Green, Charles Ellery, Samuel L. Potter, Benjamin Howland, James Fenner, Elisha Matthewson, Francis Malbone, C. G. Champlin, Jeremiah B. Howell, William Hunter, James Burrill, James D'Wolf, Nehemiah P. Knight, Asher Bobbins, Nathan F. Dixon, om 1790 to 1803. a 1790 ft 1793. a 1793 ft 1797. a 1797 a 1801. ft 1801 a 1805. ft 1803 a 1804. u 1804 a 1809. « 1805 u 1807. a 1807 a 1811. ft 1809 a 1809. « 1809 a 1811. a 1811 c< 1817. a 1811 ft 1831. a 1817 ft 1821. a 1821 ft 1825. « 1821 ft 1841. a 1825 ft 1839. ft 1839 ft 1842. James F. Simmons, William Sprague, John B. Francis, Albert C. Green, John II. Clarke, Charles T. James, Philip Allen, Samuel G. Arnold, Henry B. Anthony, William Sprague, Ambrose E. Burnside, " VERMONT. from I 1841 1 1857 to L84T. « L862. a 1842 u L844. a 1844 « 1845. (( 1846 .. L851. a 1847 H L858. it 1851 a 1857. a 1853 (l L859. u 1862 .. L863. u ( 1859 ( 1865 .. 31 . « 1-77. ii 1862 a 1875. tie, « 1875 a 1881. 17'.) *s\- VERMONT. This State received its name from the French name of its range of mountains, ("verd mont" meaning "Green Moun- tain.") It was settled in 1731, and was at first considered part of New Hampshire, and afterwards claimed by N York. These claims were vigorously resisted, but it bad no organized government until 1777. It did good service in the Revolution; but was not admitted into the Union until 1791, making the fourteenth State. Col. Ethan Allen at the head of 270 "Green Mountain Boys" took possession of I ■ Ticonderoga and Crown Point in the name of the < lontinental Congress, in 1775, and thus assured the northern water com- munication with Canada to the Americans. The climate of Vermont though cold, is pleasant and even, the soil fertile in the valleys, and the streams Bupplj excelli water power, which, however, is little used. M 480 VERMONT. produced in abundance, while its facilities for raising stock are equal to those of New Hampshire. Granite, marble of fine quality, and slate quarries abound. Its provision for edu- cation is very liberal. It has three representatives in Congress ; forms part of the second judicial circuit, and constitutes one judicial district. One port of entry and two of delivery are authorized to be named by the President of the United States. Montpelier is the capital. The State election is held on the first Tuesday in September, and the Legislature meets on the first "Wednesday in October. The enacting clause begins: "It is hereby enacted by the General Assembly of the State of Vermont." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Moses Robinson, from a Stephen R. Bradley, Elijah Paine, Isaac Tichenor, " Nathaniel Chipman, " Israel Smith, " Jonathan Robinson, a Dudley Chase, u James Fisk, William A. Palmer, Horatio Seymour, Samuel Prentiss, Benjamin Swift, Samuel S: Phelps, Samuel C. Crafts, William Upliam, " Solomon Foote, " Samuel S. Phelps, « 1791 to 1796. \ 1791 u 1795. 1 1801 ii 1813. 1795 a 1801. j 1796 a 1797. ( 1815 a 1821. 1797 it 1803. 1803 u 1807. 1807 u 1815. ( 1813 a 1817. \ 1825 u 1831. 1817 u 1818. 1818 it 1825. 1821 a 1833. 1831 a 1842. 1833 a 1839. 1839 a 1851. 1842 a 1843. 1843 i( 1855. 1851 a 1866. 1853 u 1854. KENTUCKY Lawrence JBrainard, from 18:. i to h Jacob Collamer, « 1855 « L8< Luke P. Poland, « 1865 " L867. George F. Edmunds, a I860 " L881. Justin S. Morrill, « 1867 " L879. 181 KENTUCKY. Kentucky was formed from the territory of Virginia, and in point of seniority is the fifteenth State of the American Union, having been admitted on the first of June, 1792. The sobriquet of "dark and bloody ground" applied to Kentucky is very suggestive ot the sanguinary conflicts of her pioneer population with the aboriginal lords of the soil. The celebrated Daniel Boone was among the first white men to explore the wilderness of Kentucky. The first white settle- ment was commenced at Boonesborough, about the year 1769. The area of the State is 37,680 square miles, equal to L ; 4.1 15,- 200 acres. The climate is mild, and adapted to the production of cereals, grapes, and fruits. The soil is very fertile. The Burface pre- sents a varied aspect in its several portions. The southeastern part of the State is mountainous, the central and northern por- tions are undulating, sometimes hilly. The river bottoms in- very productive. The State is well timbered. Apple, pear, peach, plum and various other fruit trees are cultivated with great success. The staple products are corn, tobacco and hemp. Horses, mules and cattle are raised. Kentucky aboni in bituminous coal, lead, iron pyrites, marble, freestone, g sum, and cliff limestone. 31 482 KENTUCKY. The population in 1870 was 1,321,000. She is entitled to ten representatives in Congress, is in the sixth judicial circuit and forms one judicial district, has one port of entry, Louis- ville, and two ports of delivery, viz.: Paducah and Columbus. Frankfort is the capital. The State elections are held on the first Monday in August. The Legislature meets on the first Monday in December, and is composed of two houses — the Senate consisting of 38 mem- bers elected for four years; and a House of Representatives elected for two years. The enacting clause of the laws is: "Be it enacted by the General Assembly of the Common- wealth of Kentucky." UNITED STATES SENATORS. John Brown, from 1792 tc ) 1805. John Edwards, a 1792 i 1795. Humphrey Marshall, a 1795 ( 1801. John Breckenridge, li 1801 a 1805. Buckner Thurston, a 1805 ti 1810. John Adair, a 1805 c< 1S06. -1806 a 1807. Henry Clay, it 1810 1831 i i 1811. 1842. a849 i 1855. John Pope, a 1807 i 1813. George M. Bibb, " 1 1811 1829 t i 1814. 1835. Jessie Bledsoe, a 1813 a 1815. George "Walker, a 1814 l 1814. William T. Barry, u 1814 i 1816. Isham Talbot, ' '{ 1815 1820 t i 1819. : 1825. Martin D. Hardin, it 1816 i 1817. -1817 i 1819. John J. Crittenden, « 1835 1842 ( < 1841. 1849. 1 1855 i > 1861. TENNESSEE. Richard M. Johnson, from j 1819 to L828. ( 1828 a L829. "William Logan, a 1819 u L820. John Rowan, « 1826 it L831. James T. Moorehead, tl 1841 u hi;. Jos'h R. Underwood, a 1847 a L853. Thomas Metealf, a 1848 u 1849. Archibald Dixon, « 1852 u 1855. David Meriwether, « 1852 a L858. J. B. Thompson, u 1853 a 1859. Lazarus "W. Powell, u 1859 >. 1865. J. C. Breckenridge, a 1861 U L861. Garrett Davis, a 1861 i i L873. James Guthrie, a 1865 « > 1868. Thomas C. McCreery, a 1868 « L879. John W. Stevenson, a 1871 (C 1877. TEN NESSEE. Tennessee belonged to the territory of North Carolina while a colony, and was settled by emigrants from it in 1 757. '1 built Fort Loudon in East Tennessee, but were destroyed, or driven away, by the Indians, in 1760. Settlement waa boob resumed, but continually harrassed by Indian attacks. In 1774 Ool. Lewis and Capt. Shelby attacked and defeated them. They remained quiet until after the Declaration ot [ndependei when the Cherokees were stirred up by Britiah emiasar From 1776 to 1779 three several expeditions were made against them, the Indians being decisively defeated each time. The Cherokees and Shawnees were warlike tribes, and oontini 4.84 TENNESSEE. for some years, to make occasional attacks on the settlements, which did not, however, prevent their steady growth. In 1789 North Carolina renounced her claim to the terri- tory, and in 1790 it became a separate province, being admitted into the Union as a Sovereign State in 1796, making the six- teenth, or the third admitted after the revolutionary war — Vermont, in 1791, being the first ; and Kentucky, in 1792, the second. This State has an area of 45,600 square miles, or 29,184,000 acres. It had a population in 1870 of 1,257,983. Tennessee is very agreeably diversified with mountain, hill and dale, containing within its limits fertility of soil, beauty of scenery, and a delightfully temperate climate. The State ia generally healthy. The soil in the main is good, and while among the mountains it is not arable, it is favorable for grazing, and stock is largely exported. Indian corn, tobacco, and cotton are the great staples. Gold has been found in the south-east portion of the State. Among the other minerals found here are iron in abundance, some lead, silver, zinc, marble of very fine quality, and various others. The State is entitled to ten Eepresentatives in Con- gress ; is in the sixth judicial circuit ; has three judicial dis- tricts ; and has two ports of delivery — Memphis and Knox- ville. , Nashville is the capital. The State election is held on the first Monday in A ugust, and the Legislature meets on the first Monday in October, once in two years. The Legislature con- sists of a Senate of twenty-five members, and a House of Rep- resentatives of seventy-five members. The enacting clause of the laws of this State is : " Be it enacted by the General Assembly of the State of Tennessee." UNITED STATES SENATORS. William Blount, from 1796 to 1797. wir n i i 1796 " 1797 ' William Cocke, j mg u ^ A A T V J 1797 " 1798 ' Andrew Jackson, j ^ u m5< OHIO. to 1815. Joseph Anderson, from 1797 Daniel Smith, « r , r Jenkin Whiteside, u mg it JJ« George W. Campbell, « 18]J .. Jesse Wharton, . 18u „ ^ John Williams, « 1815 tt John II. Laton, « 1818 „ Hugh L. White, « l825 , l84() ; *ehx Grundy, « 1829 u lvJii Ephraim H. Foster, « i 1838 - |v A. O.r. Nicholson, « l840 « l84a Alexander Anderson, " i 8 4q « jv.jj Spencer Jarnagin, « i 841 « M7 ' Hopkins L. Turney, « i 845 .< im John Bell, « 1847 „ lgi James C. Jones, « 1851 , v - 7 Andrew Johnson, « 1357 David T. Patterson, « is*;;, J. S. Fowler, « i 865 William G. Brownlow, " 1869 " 1875. Henry Cooper, « 157, « Is7L Andrew Johnson, " 1375 « Jvv j 1863. L869. L871. OH IO. The first permanent settlement in this important Stats was made on the 7th day of April, 1 788. Though this fine terril lay nearest to the most populous and enterprising of the or nal States, the intrigues of the French before the Revolution, the hostility to which they excited the [ndians, and the diffi- culties arising from the various claims vi' different State 486 ohio. the lands, which rendered titles insecure, prevented any per- manent settlement nntil about the time when the present Constitution of the United States was originated. All these difficulties were now removed, and emigration, long restrained, rushed like a flood down the Ohio. 20,000 persons, during this year (1788), passed down the river in pursuit of new homes. Cincinnati and many other places were settled about this time. From 1790 to 1795 there was much suffering from the hostility of the Indians ; but this period having passed, the settlements multiplied and grew apace. The settlers were, in large part, from New England ; accus- tomed to wring a thrifty living from a rocky soil ; and their industry soon brought great results from this more generous field. The population increased rapidly. In 14 years it amounted to 72,000 ; and was admitted into the Union with that number Nov. 29th, 1802. The climate is healthy and mild, the soil generally very fertile, and her inhabitants have made the most of it. Coal, iron, and marble are very abundant. Manufactures have not been much developed in this State, but they are steadily grow- ing. The lake on the north, and the river on the south, with more than 5,000 miles of railway and canals, furnish all the elements of a great and steady growth. It was, on its admission, the seventeenth State in the Union. It has an area of 39,964 square miles, equal to 25,576,960 acres. The population in 1870 was 2,622,214, entitling her to twenty Members of Congress. It is in the sixth judicial circuit, and forms two judicial districts, the Northern and Southern. This State has three ports of entry — Cleveland, Toledo, and Portland; and four ports of delivery, to be located where the President directs. The capital of this State is Columbus. The State election is now held on the second Tuesday of October. The Legisla- ture meets on the first Monday of January, biennially. The enacting clause of the laws is as follows: "Beit enacted by the General Assembly of the State of Ohio." LOUISIANA. John Smith, Thos. Worthington, Edward Tiffin, Return J. Meigs, Stanley Griswold, Alexander Campbell, Jeremiah Morrow, Joseph Kerr, Benjamin Buggies, William A. Trimble, Ethan A. Brown, Wm. Henry HarrisoD, Jacob Burnett, Thomas Ewing, Thomas Morris, "William Allen, Benjamin Tappan, Thomas Corwin, Salmon P. Chase, Benjamin F. Wade, George Ellis Pugh, John Sherman, Allen G. Thurman, UNITED STATES SENATORS. from a a « a a a it ii ii ii ii ii ii a a u a u u a a a Ism; J [ 1803 [1810 1807 1808 1809 1809 1813 1814 1815 1819 1822 1825 1828 1831 1850 1833 1837 1839 1845 1849 L851 1851 1861 1869 to u 1807. L814. L809. L810. L809. 1813. L819. 1815. L82L 1825. L828. 1831. 1837. 1851. L839. L849. L845. 1851. 1855. 1869. L861. L879. L881. LOUISIANA. The Spaniards, who found so much gold in other porta of the American continent, made repeated explorations "t" the region LOUISIANA. lying near the months of the Mississippi in the hope of dis- covering it there. Failing in this, they made no settlements. The French planned the establishment of a vast empire cover- ing the best territory now in the bounds of the United States, and explored the Mississippi and its tributaries with, untiring courage and zeal, both from the Great Lakes and from the mouth of the river. A few years after La Salle had perished in his bold wandering, a French naval officer, Lemoine D'lber- ville, formed the first settlement in Louisiana (so named after the French King, Louis XIV., by La Salle.) This was in 1699; but no great progress was made until the Mississippi Company was formed in France, under the idea that Louisiana was rich in gold and diamonds; when, in 1718, eight hundred persons emigrated from France and settled at New Orleans. In 1732 the colony contained, in all, seven thousand five hundred per- sons, and continued to prosper until 1763, when, by the peace of Paris, all the French possessions in America except the ter- ritory west of the Great River, were given up to England. This remnant soon passed to the Spaniards, and again to the French, from whom it was bought by President Jefferson for $15,000,000, in 1803. This purchase was regarded, even by Jefferson, as probably exceeding the powers of the government, under the Constitu- tion; but it was essential to the development, unity, and greatness of the country. The Mississippi Valley is the heart, of North America, and the use of the river as necessary to the value of the prairie States lying east of it, as to the defense and strength of the country. The possession of it could, alone, make the United States a great power among nations. Napo- leon' Bonaparte, then First Consul of the French Republic, designed, in ceding it to the United States, to give England, his relentless enemy, a powerful rival; but even his keen fore- sight could not have anticipated the wonderful growth in which the Louisiana Purchase was so necessary an element. The surface of Louisiana is low, and the southern part often overflowed by the high water of the rivers. Many island* LOUISIANA. I-;. of great fertility and beauty lie along the coast; one of them consisting of an Immense bed or mine of rock Bait Fruits grow to great perfection and orange trees are specially fruitful, a single tree often bearing 5,000 • .ranges. ( \,tton and cane sugar are the principal staples. New Orleans bae an extensive commerce, and manufactures will sometime find in it a profitable field. The palmy days of this, as of all the other Southern States, is in the future; her most valuable reeonj having been scarcely touched. New Orleans will naturally become the third great commercial city of the Onion, New York and San Francisco, only, being likely to take precedence of her. Louisiana was admitted into the Union April s th. 1 s 1l\ making the eighteenth State. She has an area of 46,431 square miles, equal t<> 29,715,840 acres. The population in 1870 numbered 732,731; she has six Representatives in Congress. Louisiana forms a part of the fifth judicial circuit, and stitutes two judicial districts, viz.: the eastern and western districts of Louisiana. This State has one collection district, denominated the district of New Orleans; which city is the only port of entry. The shores of the river < Hiio, and all the rivers emptying into the Mississippi, are attached to the dis- trict of New Orleans, though most of them do ool lie in the State. Several of the cities and towns on these rivers are made ports of delivery. Collection district- are doI always confined to one State. New Orleans is the capital. The Legislature meets on the first Monday in January, once in two yeare. The Siate elect is held on the first Monday in November. The enacting clause of her laws is as follows: "Be itena by the Senate and House of Representatives of th< B Louisiana, in General Assembly convened." UNITED STAT I - -l N LTOB8. Thomas Posev, October to December, 1818. T -d * ( 1812 to 1817. James Brown, from | M;i .. ^ 490 INDIANA. t Allan B. Macgruder, from 1812 to 1813. Eligius Fromentin, u 1813 u 1819. W. C. C. Claiborne, u 1817 a 1818. Henry Johnson, j 1818 ( 1843 u 1824. 1849. William Kelly, it 1822 a 1825. Dominique Bouligny, a 1824 a 1829. Josiah S. Johnston, it 1824 u 1833. Edward Livingston, it 1829 a lbdU Geo. A. Waggaman, (I 1831 it 1835. Alexander Porter, a 1833 a 1837. Kobert C. Nichols, a 1833 it 1841. Alexander Morton, a 1838 a 1842. Alexander Barrow, a 1841 a 1847. Charles M. Conrad, a 1842 a 1843. Pierre Soule\ a ( 1847 1 1849 a 1847. 7 a 1855. Solomon W. Downs, a 1847 a 1853. John Slidell, a 1853 a 1861. Judah P. Benjamin, a 1853 a 1861. John S. Harris, a 1868 a 1871. ¥m. Pitt Kellogg, a 1868 a 1873. J. R. West, a 1871 a 1877. INDIANA. 1. Indiana was first explored by the enterprising French Jesuits, who highly appreciated the beauty, resources, and grand future of the vast Mississippi valley. Wiser than their sovereign, Louis XIY., they would have taken firm and effectual possession of all this region, from the Great Lakes to the Gulf,. INDIANA. ,, (1 but Louis was too much occupied with his palaces, the Bplen dor of his court, the banishment of Protestant.-, and war with his neighbors t# lend a due support to their plans. Thej explored the region in 1682, formed a settlement at Vincennea in 1730, and made friends of the Indians. The career of the French, in Europe and America, was clucked by the extra gance of the Court, and disastrous wars; and this little colony remained for nearly three generations solitary and stationary in the wilderness; fraternizing with the Indians and enjoying life as only the French can under such dreary circumstances. 2. After the Revolution all this region was included in the Northwest Territory. The grim earnestness of the Americans in pushing their fortunes alarmed, without conciliating, the Indians, and for a long time a deadly struggle alone could pre- serve the growing settlements from total extinction. The brave and talented Tecumseh and his twin brother, the Prophet, made a desperate effort to drive back or exterminate the tiers; but they were conquered, and the Indians retreated, Btep by step, before the advancing flood of emigration. In 1809 Indiana was erected into a separate Territory, and admitted int.. the Union as a separate State on the 1 1th of Dec, 1* 1 •'-• It is 275 miles long by 135 in width. The surface is mainly level or gently undulating; the irregularities in the southern part. eeldom rising more than two hundred feet, but with a ro foundation to the soil, presenting many advantages to manu- factures along the streams; these facilities are increased by tin- extent and value of bituminous coal deposits which underlie nearly one- fourth of the area of the State 3. Indiana has a happier mixture of prairie and w Hand than any other western State. Its commercial facilities great. Reaching Lake Michigan on the northwest, Chica forms a fine metropolis for the northern parts; while the < ' on the south furnishes cheap transportation to Cincinnati Pittsburg toward the east, or New Orleans to the southwo Lying between the fertile and busy re-ions we~t and t eastern markets, it is crossed in all direction, by railroads, it 492 INDIANA. is in the centre of the most highly favored part of the Union, and its advantages and resources seem boundless. Its staple in agriculture is corn, but all the grains, vegetables, and fruits of the temperate zone are raised with success. The climate is mild, but it lies in the region of variableness in weather char- acterizing all the western States in its latitude. The resources of the State have been in a course of rapid and uninterrupted development for 60 years, but they are so great, and there are so many other inviting fields luring emi- grants further west, that a comparatively small part of its wealth has yet been reached. There is a magnificent provision for education, and its intelligent and enterprising citizens are worthy of the Great Republic. 4. Indiana was the nineteenth State in the Union. She has an area of 33,809 square miles, equal to 21,637,760 -acres. Her population in 1870 was 1,673,046, which entitles her to thirteen Representatives in Congress. Indiana is the seventh judicial circuit, and forms one judicial district. There is no port of entry in this State; but there are three ports of delivery, to-wit: Evansville, New Albany, and Madison- which are attached to the New Orleans collection district. ' The capital is Indianapolis. The State election is held on the second Tuesday of October. The Legislature meets only once in two years, on the first "Wednesday of January. The enacting clause of her laws is in these words: "Be it enacted by the General Assembly of the State of Indiana." UNITED STATES SENATORS. James Noble, from 1816 to 1831. W. Taylor, « 1816 a 1S25. W. Hendricks, u 1825 a 1837. N. Hanna, a 1831 a 1833. John Tipton, a 1833 u 1839. O. II. Smith, a 1837 a 1843. A. S. White, a 1839 a 1845. E. A. Hannegan, a 1843 a 1849. J. D. Bright, tt 1845 a 1852. MISSISSIPPI. J. "Whitcomb, C. W. Cathcart, John Petti t, G. K Fitch, H. A. Lane, D. Turpee, J. A. Wright, T. A. Hendricks, O. P. Morton, Daniel D. Pratt, Joseph E. McDonald, from u (( u u 77 Richard J. Oglesby, a 1873 " 1879 4<>7 ALABAMA. Thib State was, at first, held by Georgia under her colonial charter, but was given up to the general government, in 1802, for the sum of $1,250,000. It then became a part of tin- Mississippi territory, but was separated when Mississippi became a State, in 1817. It was settled in 1711, at Mobile, by the French, it being a part of the territory explored and claimed for Prance by La Salle in 1684. The Indian name of Alabama means " EL we rest." Its soil can scarcely be excelled for fertility in the world. It has every variety of climate, from the high and stern severity of a mountain region in the north, through all gradations, to the heat and luxuriant vegetation of the troj along the southern coast. The center abounds in coal and iron, and various other minerals are found in abundai Until the Revolution it wasahunting ground for the In.il.. Being then stirred up by British emissaries, and threatening the security of the frontiers, they were severely chastised After the return of peace, when the growing wealth and 32 49S ALABAMA. lation of Ihe original States excited them to enterprise, the territory invited population by its surpassing fertility, and it graduated to the importance of a sovereign State by admission into the Union, Dec. 14th, 1819, forming the twenty-second State. It has an area of 50,722 square miles, equal to 32,462,080 acres, and had a population in 1870 of 966,988, by which she is entitled to eight Representatives. It forms a part of the fifth judicial circuit, and is divided into three judicial districts, the Northern, Middle and Southern. It has one port of entry, (Mobile,) and two ports of delivery, viz. : Tuscumbia and Selma. The capital of the State is Montgomery. The State election is held on the Tuesday after the first Mon- day in November. The Legislature meets on the third Monday in November. The enacting clause of its laws is as follows: " Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the State of Alabama, in General Assembly convened." UNITED STATES SENATORS. William R. King, from ( 1819 ( 1846 to u 1844. 1852. John W. Walker, a 1819 a 1822. Henry Chambers, a 1825 a 1826. Israel Pickens, a 1826. Superseded ne year by — John McKinley, a ( 1826 1 1837 u (C 1831. 1841. Gabriel Moore, a 1831 « 1837. Clement C. Clay, « 1837 a 1841. Arthur P. Bagby, u 1841 a 1849 Dixon H. Lewis, u 1844 a 1847. Benjamin Fitzpatrick, a 1852 a 1861. Jeremiah Clemens, a 1849 it 1853. Clement C. Clay, Jr., a 1853 a 1861. Willard Warner, a 1868 a 1871. George Goldtliwaite, a 1871 a 1877. George E. Spencer, u 1868 U 1879. MAIM. MAINE. This State forms the northeastern boundary of the Republic, Canada and New Brunswick lying north and east. It was at first a province, granted by charter to Sir Ferdinand Gor| by the King of England, in 1638 ; but was united with Mas- sachusetts b} r purchase in 1652. It was settled by the English, at Bristol, in 1625. It was admitted as a State Into the Onion March 15th, 1820, being the twenty-third in order of admis- sion. It contains 31,766 square miles, or 20,.'):'.". 210 acres in area. In 1870 the population was 626,463. It has now five Representatives in Congress. The northern part of this State is almost a wilderness, and furnishes large quantities of lumber, which are ih>ated down her large rivers, and supplied, in great abundance, t<> the Atlantic seaports, and the West Indies. Ship-building is an extensive branch of industry, the great Length and irregular line of coast forming numerous harbors. It has extensive fisheries, and a large sea-faring population. Its numerous streams are highly favorable to manufactures, though compare tively little has as yet been done in this direction. The climate is severe and the soil somewhat sterile, bo that it ranks lo* an agricultural State. It has received comparatively additions to its population by foreign immigration; and it- inhabitants are mainly from the old English stock, and the State ranks high in morality. It depletes itself b\ furnishing, like many other of the older States, annually, a large uumber of vigorous, enterprising young men to settle the new and fertile regions of the west. It forms part of the first judicial circuit, and oonstit 500 MAINE. one judicial district. It has thirteen ports of entry, and thirty- two ports of delivery. The capital is Augusta, on the Kennebec river. The State elections are held on the second Monday of Sep- tember ; and the Legislature meets on the first Wednesday of January in each year. The enacting clause of its laws is : " Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Eepresentatives, in Legislature assem- bled." UNITED STATES SENATORS. John Holmes, from 1820 to 1833. John Chandler, " 1820 " 1829. Albion P. Harris, " 1827 " 1829. Peleg Sprague, " 1829 " 1835. Ether Shepley, " 1833 " 1836. John Buggies, " 1835 " 1841. JudahDana, " 1836 " 1837. Reuel Williams, " 1837 " 1843. George Evans, " 1841 " 1847. John Fairfield, " 1843 " 1847. Wynan B. S. Moore, " 1848 " 1848. James W. Bradbury, " 1847 " 1853. i 1848 " 1857. Hannibal Hamlin, " \ 1857 " 1861. ( 1869 " 1881. Amos bourse, 1857 " 1857. i 1flKQ a 1864. 1869. Lot M. Morrill, " 1861 " 1877. William P. Fessenden, " Lot M. Morrill, " Nathan A. Farwell, " 1864 « 1865. MISS01 i;i. MISSOURI. This State was first settled by the French, at or near the | ent capital, in the year 1719. Here a fort was established, -called Fort Orleans, and the neighboring lead mines v. worked the next year. St. Genevieve, the oldesl town in State, was settled in 1755, and St. Louis in L764. In L768 it. with all the territory west of the Mississippi, waa assigned by treaty to Spain. This territory was ceded hack to France in 1801, and with Louisiana was purchased by the United Si in 1803. It remained a part of Louisiana until the admission of the State of that name, when the remaining portion of that purchase was called Missouri. In 1821 it was admitted into the Union, forming the twenty-fourth State. This State has an area of 67,380 square miles, equal to 43,123,200 acres. Her population in 1870 was 1,715,000, entitling her to thir- teen Representatives in Congress. The climate of Missouri is variable; in winter the thermom- eter sinks below zero ; the summers arc excessively hoi ; the air is dry and pure. The State is quite as healthful as any in the west. The soil is good and of greal agricultural capabili- ties. The great staple is Indian corn. The other prodv cultivated largely are hemp, wheat, oats, tobacco. Sheep and cattle are considerably raised, and fruit culture is successful. This State is in the eight judicial circuit; and forms two judicial districts, the Eastern and Western. It has no | entry, and but one port of delivery, Bannibal. The capital is Jefferson City. The State election ifl held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November, and the Legislature meets on the last Monday oi' Deoemo >U2 MICHIGAN. enacting clause of the laws is: " Be it enacted by' Assembly of the State of Missouri as follows." UNITED STATES SENATORS. Thomas H. Benton, David Barton, Alexander Buckner, Lewis F. Linn, David R Atchison, Gratz B. Brown, Henry S. Geyer, Trusten Polk, James S. Green, Waldo P. Johnson, John B. Henderson, Charles D. Drake, Carl Schurz, . Francis P. Blair, Lewis V. Bogy, Frank M. Cockrell, from » u u u a u u a a u u a a u a 1821 1821 1831 1833 1843 1849 1863 1851 1857 1856 1861 1862 1867 1869 1871 1873 1875 to a a a a a a a a a a a « a a the General 1851. 1831. 1833. 1843. 1849. 1855. 1867. 1857. 1861. 1861. 1862. 1869. 1871. 1875. 1873. 1879. 1881. MICHIGAN. The name of this State is a contraction of two words in the Chippewa language, meaning " Great Lake," and was applied, by the Indians, to the two surrounding the lower peninsula. It was explored by Jesuit missionaries, who established nume- rous missions among various Indian tribes, and pushed their way, through perils a"nd fatigues, west to the Mississippi, which they followed far north and south; to be soon outstripped by the adventurous La Salle. Detroit was founded about 1701. MICHIGAN. The settlements made little progress under French rule ; and when, in 1703, it passed under English control, theconspii of Pontiac nearly destroyed them. It was uot till L706 that the United States government took possession of the fcerrit Its growth was much retarded by the war of 1812, when it endured, for two years, all the barbarities of Indian war. A territorial government was organized in 1805. In 1818 the lands were brought into the market, since which it- pr peri ty has been uninterrupted. It is remarkable in it- position, and eminently so by its resources. The southern peninsula is very productive. The northern peninsula contains the rich- est copper mines in the world, and unlimited supplies of iron, while the quantity of the finest lumber, and the facilities for transporting it are superior. The fish taken in its lake- are excellent and abundant ; its people are enterprising and intel- ligent; and its State authorities have established one of the best Universities in the Union. Its future promises to become equal at least to that of the most favored State. The Territory of Michigan was changed into a State pre- liminarily June 15, 1836, and was fully admitted to an equality with all the States January 26, 1837, making the twenty- fifth State (Arkansas was admitted on the same day). Ber area is 56,243 square miles, equal to 35,995„ r >2<> acres. The population in 1870 was 1,184,296, which entitles her to nine Representatives in Congress. By an act ol l^<<>'<. Michigan was located in the sixth judicial circuit; and forms two judicial districts, and has four collection distrieis and lour portsof entry, viz.: Detroit, Port Huron, Grand Haven, and Miehilimackinac; also five ports of delivery (if the President deem them q< sary). The capital is Lansing. The State election is held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The Legislature meets biennially on the first Wednesday in January. The enacting clause of the laws i- as follows: " Ti, of the State of Michigan enact.'' 504 ARKANSAS. UNITED STATES SENATORS. Lucius Lyon, from 1836 to 1839. John Norvall, a 1836 " 1841. Augustus S. Porter, a 1839 " 1S45. William Woodbridge, « 1841 " 1847. Lewis Cass, u 1845 " 1857. Alpheus Felch, u 1847 " 1853. Thomas Fitzgerald, a 1848 " 1849. Charles E. Stewart, a 1853 " 1859. Zachariah Chandler, a 1857 " 1875. Kinsley S. Bingham, a 1859 " 1861. Jacob M. Howard, a 1862 u 1871. Thomas W. Ferry, « 1871 " 1877. Isaac P. Christiancy, u 1875 " 1881. -flgHira dtJH fe ■35? iS 'M ARKAN S AS. Arkansas was originally a portion of the Territory of Louis- iana. It remained a part of that territory until 1812, when the present State of Louisiana was admitted into the Union. The remainder of the territory was then formed into the Mis- souri Territory, and so remained until 1821 when Missouri was admitted into the Union, and Arkansas was erected into a separate territory, bearing the present name. In 1836, a State constitution was formed at Little Rock, and Arkansas became a State in the Union. It constituted the twenty-sixth State. It has an area of 52,193 square miles, equal to 33,406,- 720 acres. The population in 1870 was 483,197, which entitles her to four Representatives in Congress. The eastern portion of the State, extending back one hundred miles from the Mis- sissippi, is generally a vast plain covered with marshes, swamps, ARKANSAS. and lagoons. The Ozark mountains which enter the north west part of the State divide it into two unequal parts, which the northern has the climate and productions of th< Northern States, while the southern portion, in climate and productions, resembles Mississippi and Louisiana. The L< lands of Arkansas are unhealthy, while the more elevated por- tions of the State will compare favorably with the mosl health ful and invigorating portions of the Northwest There great variety of soil in this State. While some portions, like the river bottoms, are exceedingly fertile, other parts are sterile and barren. The staple products are Indian corn, cotton and live Btock. Arkansas gives indications of rich mineral resources. This State lies in the eighth judicial circuit, and forms two judicial districts, the eastern and western. It has no ports of entry or delivery. The capital of the State is Little Rock. She holds her State election the first Monday in November. The Legislature meets but once in two years, on the first Monday in January. The enacting clause of the laws is: " Be it enacted by the Gen- eral Assembly of the State of Arkansas." UNITED STATES SENATORS William S. Fulton, Ambrose II. Sevier, Chester Ashley, William K. Sebastian, Solon Borland, Robert W. Johnson, Charles B. Mitchell, Alexander McDonald, Benjamin F. Rice, Powell Clayton, Stephen W. Dorsey, from L836 to L844. « 1836 (i L848. u 1844 .. 1-17. « 1848 .. L861. ti 1848 .. L853. « I-:.:: c< L861. u L861 .. 1861. u L868 .. 1-71. a L868 .. 1-7:'.. u 1-71 .. 1-77. a 1873 .. 1-7:'. 506 FLORIDA. FLORIDA. This peninsula was discovered by Ponce de Leon, a com- panion of Columbus, in 1512, on Easter Sunday, called by the Spaniards Pascua Florida, which, with the profusion of flowers found at this early season in that tropical region, caused him to name it Florida — "the flowery land." It was first colonized by French Huguenots, for whom Admiral Coligni desired to find an asylum in the new world, from the fierce bigotry of the times. The first settlers (1564) became discouraged and returned; the second colony, established in 1566, was destroyed by the Spaniards. These founded a settlement in 1565 at St. Augustine, which was the oldest town in the United States settled by Europeans. It remained in their hands until 1763, when, by the terms of the "Peace of Paris," it fell into the hands of the English. It was returned to Spain in 1783. It was acquired from Spain by treaty made with the United States in 1819, but the American authorities did not take posses- sion until July, 1821. The consideration given by our govern- ment was about five million dollars. It is a point running out from the Southeast border of our territory, of but little eleva- tion above the sea level, and swampy, but covered with an exuberant growth of vegetation with a chain of lakes from south to north through the center. The warmth of the climate, where no winter is ever known, promotes the growth of the rarest and most beautiful flowers; the clustering vines and dense foliage render its forests almost impenetrable, and its delicate mosses are the wonder and delight of the naturalist; while the splendid plumage of its tropical birds, flitting among the lemon and orange groves, laden at once with bud, flower and fruit, combine to add the scenery of the equatorial regions FLORIDA. to the homely but more useful vegetable growth and beantj our temperate zone. It is a resorl of invalids during I rigors of the northern winter, its otherwisi ive heal U tempered by the sea breezes from either Bide. With marshes drained and its vegetable growth Bubdued and guided by the industrious agriculturist, its Bupply of the fruits and other produetioni: of warm climates would be inexhausti- ble. It is but partially settled, and its agricultural, commercial, and manufacturing facilities but slightly developed. It- wealth of resources remain to reward the enterprise and industry of the future. The railroad connections between its cities and other States furnish a sufficient basis for improvement Florida was admitted into the Union, March 3, 1845; mal ing the twenty-seventh State. This State has an ana of square miles, equal to 37,931,520 acres. The population in 1870 amounted to 187,756. She has two Representative in Congress Florida lies in the fifth judicial circuit, and forms two judi- cial districts; and has seven ports of entry— St. Augustine. Key West, Apalachicola, Pensacola, Magnolia. St. John's River, and Fernandina; and two ports of delivery— Palatka and Bay Port. The capital is Tallahasse. The State election is held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The Legislature meets on the Tuesday after the first Monday in January. The enacting clause of the laws is: « Be it enacted h\ the Senate and House of Representatives of the State of Florida, in GtAeral Assembly convened." UNITED STATES SENATORS. David L. Yulee, from J. D. Wescott, Jackson Morton, S. R. Mallory, A. S. Welch, Thomas W. Osborn, Abijah Gilbert, Simon B. Conover, Chas. W. Jones, « a a a u u L845 to L861. L845 * i L851. L849 t< l -:.:.. 1851 » 1 L86L L869 u I860. L868 M L878. »» 1875. 1-::: (4 1879. 1875 1 I l-i. 508 iowa. IOWA. 1. The name of this State in the Indian tongue is said to mean " Tlds is the Land." Few States have a surface, soil, and position so uniformly excellent for all their different sec- tions. A high rolling prairie, well drained by streams, of great fertility, and almost no sterile or waste land; beautiful to look upon in its alternations of rise and fall, of prairie, stream, and timber; bounded on its extremes by the two mighty branches of the " Father of "Waters," with numerous smaller rivers hundreds of miles in length within its limits; its south- ern region underlaid by a vast bed of coal, its northern rich in deposits of lead; a climate free from the severity of Minnesota and Wisconsin winters, and from the intemperate heats of Missouri and Kentucky summers, it is a land to be satisfied with; and justifies the picturesque name given it by its ancient appreciative owners. 2. It was first visited by Europeans in 1673. Marquette and Joliet, two French Jesuit missionaries, whom the vast magnitudes of the North American continent seemed to stim- ulate like new wine, roamed alone over these immense dis- tances, preserved by their characteristic French cordiality from the suspicion and hostility of the numerous warlike Indian tribes — who everywhere received them with hospitality, treated them witli respect, and dismissed them with assistance — passed, in that year, down the Mississippi, and, landing a little above the mouth of the Moingona — which, from the similarity of sound, they corrupted into Des Moines, (Monk's River) — they fearlessly followed an Indian trail fourteen miles into the interior to an Indian village. Some tradition or prophecy had IOWA. forewarned the Indians of venerable white \ . and they were received at once as expected and honored meats. I newreligion they announced, and the authority of the king of France which they proclaimed, raised no remonstrance or ! tile feeling, and they were sent on their way down the river with the "Pipe of Peace." The grand visions of the future entertained by these and other French explorers were never realized by that nation. It was more than a hundred y< later that the first settlement was made by Julian I >u Buqne "ii the site of the present city of that name. He obtained a grant of 180,000 acres from the Indians, established a trading | and worked the lead mines, with great profit; but the time bad not come for dispossessing the Indians, and almost fiftj y< more passed before any other settlement was attempted. 3. In 1832 the Winnebagoes, Sacs, and Foxes united under the Winnebago chief, Black Hawk, to invade and repossess tin- lands in Illinois which they had ceded to the government Gen. Atkinson met and defeated them on the CTpper [owa, tab ing Black Hawk and his son prisoners. They were taken east, kindly treated, and set at liberty; and in the following year a treaty was made which ultimately extinguished the Indian title to the whole of Iowa, the Indians removing west of the Missouri. In the same year a settlement was made al Bur lington. The time for Iowa had come. In I s :'. I it wafi joined to the Territory of Michigan, in 1837 was reorganized a* : of the Wisconsin territory, and, in L838, became a Bepai territory with the capital at Burlington. March 8d, 1845, it was conditionally, and Dec. 28th, L846, fully admitted into the Union as a Sovereign State. In 1840 it had a population of over 40,000, in 1850 of nearly 200,000. A Bteadj growth followed, and she has now, probably, a million and a halt inhabitants. Four parallel lines of railroad pass entirety acres the State from east to west, three from north to south, ai various others are in process of building '"' 1 " n " in; lines. She is scarcely yet fully launched into h< er of greatness. When her virgin soil shall all be broken up and i 510 iowa. hidden wealth evoked by her intelligent and skillful agricul- turists, when the full tide of commerce on her two great rivers shall have set in to supplement her railroads, and mature organization shall have made all her resources available, she will take her proper place in the first rank of States in the Union, and her citizens will repeat with satisfaction and pride the Indian declaration, " This is the Land." Iowa was the twenty-eighth State, on its admission, in 1845. It has an area of 55,045 square miles, equal to 35,228,800 acres. The population in 1870 was 1,191,802, which entitles her to nine Representatives in Congress. This State lies in the eighth judicial circuit, and makes one judicial district. She has no port of entry, but has three ports of delivery, to-wit: Burling- ton, Keokuk, and Dubuque; all of which are attached to the collection district of New Orleans, in the State of Louisiana. Des Moines is the capital. The State election is held on the second Tuesday of October. The Legislature meets biennially on the second Monday in January. The enacting clause of her laws is in these words: "Be it enacted by the General Assembly of the State of Iowa." UNITED STATES SENATORS. George W. Jones, from Augustus C. Dodge, James Harlan, u James W. Grimes, Samuel J. Kirkwood, James B. Howell, " George G. Wright, " William B. Allison, u u 1848 to 1859. 1848 " 1855. j 1856 " 1865. i 1867 " 1873. 1859 " 1869. 1866 " 1867. 1870 " 1871. 1871 " 1877. 1873 " 1879. TEA TEXAS. This State forms the southwestern portion of the ("■ States. The first settlement in Texas wm made on Matagorda bay, under the French led by La Salle, in \*'^'>. It pa into the possession of the Spanish in the year L690. After the independence of Mexico, in 1 S22, Texas rema a Mexican province until the revolution of ls:^;, when it gained its independence. It continued an independent republic, mod eled on the United States, until 1845, when, the T> an Con gress having accepted the conditions imposed by thi I of the United States, it became the 29th State in the Union. It has an area of 237,504 square miles, equal to 152,002, acres. The population in 1870 was 797,500, which entil her to six members of Congress. This State embraces every variety of surface; mountain, plain, hill, and desert waste lie within its limits. The climate is free from the extremes of both the temperate and torrid zoi producing, in the north, many of (he products oi the b ate, and in the south many of those of the torrid / •. I variation in the temperature from the season of winter to I of summer is quite small, giving the State as equable fl clin as any in the world. While it shares the genial clin "sunnv South" it is free from all the deadly swamp • tions of the lower Mississippi States. The soil, on the wl is as fertile as any in the world. It famishes the natural pasture all the year round. ( Jotton in large quanti —Indian corn, wheat, rye. oats and other Bmall grains indigo and rice, are the staple products. The grape, mulbt and the vanilla, are indigenous and abundant I 512 TEXAS. is grown in vast quantities. Fruit is no less various and abun- dant than its other products. The peach, nectarine, fig, plum, quince and a great variety of berries flourish here. Oranges, lemons, limes and melons, grow well. Live stock of all varie- ties and in vast numbers fatten on the plains, and are shipped in all directions to supply every demand. Texas abounds in minerals. Rich silver mines are already worked successfully at San Saba. Gold in small quantities has been found west of the Colorado river. Coal is abundant. Iron is found in many parts of the State. There are also salt lakes and salt springs, copper, alum, lime, agates, chalcedony, jasper and a white and red sandstone. Texas lies in the fifth judicial circuit, and makes two judi- cial districts, the eastern and the western. There are three collection districts in the State. The respective ports of entry for these districts are Galveston, La Salle, and Brazos Santiago. To these are attached nine ports of delivery. The capital is Austin. The Legislature is composed of a Senate, elected for four years, and a House of Representatives, elected for two years. The sessions of the Legislature are biennial and are held in December. The Governor is elected fur four years. UNITED STATES SENATORS. Thomas F. Rusk, from 1846 to 1856. Samuel Houston, u 1846 a 1859. Pinckney J. Henderson, " 1857 a 1858. Matthias Ward, a 1858 u 1861. John Hemphill, a 1869 a 1871. Lewis T. Wigfall, a 1859 u 1861. J. W. Flannagan, a 1869 u 1875. Morgan C. Hamilton, tt 1871 a 1877. Samuel B. Maxey, a 1875 u 1881. WISCONSIN'. WISCONSIN. 1. Tlii s State was visited and crossed by the early French explorers about 1665, and a settlement was made at Green Bay in J669and soon after on the Mississippi, at Prairie -In Chi. n. It was the policy of these enterprising men to connect the French settlements on the lower St. Lawrence by a chain <>t stations on the lakes and rivers with the month <-t' the Mi sippi. This would have passed through the heart of the country and have laid open its chief resources al once. It a bold conception. We see it nowhere among the English explorers and settlers, who seemed not t<> like to lose Bight ol their ships; but it is quite in keeping with the grand and rapid genius of the French; and, as in so many other ca attempting too much they lost the whole The English, if slower, were sure, and consolidated their possessions on tin- coast, gradually pushing westward as they were able to hold their ground. 2. The French explorers have left traces of their u i i t i r i 1 1 ^r activity in the names of rivers and places, and even [ndian tribes, but the attention of their home government oon withdrawn from them. No further extention was givei settlement for near 150 years, notwithstanding it n of access from the south by the Mississippi river, and from east by the chain of great lakes. Very fortunately, a- it now seems, all this vast and valuable territory in the heart continent, equal, perhaps in irs natural wealth, to resources of the whole of Europe, was reserved to r labors and consolidate the beneficent power of a N tA Freemen, carefully trained and adapted to their high d< 33 * 5A4 WISCONSIN. 3. The tide of emigration flowed westward by way of the Ohio river, and the States south were settled and admitted into the Union long before Wisconsin received even a Territorial government. This occurred in 1836, and in 1840 the census gave it but little over 30,000 inhabitants. Population now flowed steadily to it and we find, in 1850, over 300,000 inhabitants. It was admitted into the Union in 1848, making the thirtieth State. Its high latitude probably had something to do with this deferred settlement, the milder winters of the more south- ern range of States attracting the emigrants first. The climate, however, has important advantages over the States in question, being drier, less changeable, and not so subject to extremes. It is very healthy, and probably the oldest man in the country was living, hale and hearty, in this State, a few years ago, at the patriarchal age of 139. The climate is milder than in the same latitude farther east. 4. The surface is a li^gh rolling prairie, open and mostly treeless, except near streams and bodies of water in the south, but in the north covered with timber. Vast ifcrests of pine grow on the northern slope, which is some 1,200 feet above the level of the sea. Some parts of the State fall 600 feet below that elevation; and a succession of ridges having a general direction east and west, separate the rivers flowing into Lake Superior, Green Bay, and Lake Michigan, while many streams flow southwest into the Mississippi. The State is 285 miles long by 255 wide. Its beautiful prairies, gratefully returning a bountiful harvest to the intelligent farmer; its numerous charming lakes and ponds; its remarkable commer- cial advantages by lakes and rivers, supplemented by canals and railroads; its great manufacturing facilities, and valuable min- eral deposits, give great promise to its future. Wheat is the leading agricultural staple, but all the grains, vegetables, and fruits of the Northern States well reward cultivation. It has an area of 52,924 square miles, equal to 34,511,360 acres. In 1870 the population amounted to 1,055,167, which gave her eight Members of Congress. Wisconsin lies in the seventh OALIFOKNIA. judicial circuit (which is composed of Wisconsin, Indiana and Illinois,) and forms one judicial district It has one collection district, one port of entry (Milwaukee,) and five porj of deliv- ery, viz.: Southport, Racine, Sheboygan, Green Bay and Depere. The capital of the State is Madison. The Legislature meets on the second Wednesday in January. The State election is on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The enacting clause of her laws is as follows: ''The people of Wisconsin, represented in Senate and Assembly, do enacl follows." UNITED STATES SENATORS Henry Dodge, Isaac P. Walker, Charles Durkee, James R. Doolittle, Timothy O. Howe, M. H. .Carpenter, Angus Cameron, from 1848 to L857. a 1848 .. l -.'..'.. u 1855 .. 1861. a 1857 M L869. 9 1861 .. !-:;.. a 186.9 « L875. « L875 « L881. CALIFORNIA Is said to have been visited by the Spaniards In L542, Sir Francis Drake, a celebrated English navigator, in L578 The first mission was founded by Spanish Catholics in L76 It was sparsely settled by Mexican rancheros, wh seopi themselves chiefly in raising cattle. In L846 I had been conducting an exploring party across th< and the Rocky Mountains, defeated in conjuncion wit modore Stockton, the Mexican forces in California, possession of it in the name of the dnited Si j to which it 516 CALIFORNIA. was definitely ceded by the treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo, Feb. 2nd, 1848; the United States government paying Mexico for that territory and New Mexico $15,000,000, besides paying $3,500,000 indemnity, due from Mexico to citizens of the United States. Scarcely had this arrangement been made, when it was pub- lished that California was rich in gold, and adventurers from all sections of the Union, and various countries of the Old World, rushed in like a flood. For some years, society there, composed in large part, of the wildest and most ungovernable elements of old communities, was like a seething volcano; but, to the immortal honor of American citizens, it was subdued by the superior resolution and summary vigor of the better class of emigrants from the States, and was admitted into the Union on the Tth of Sept. 1850, with a clause in its Constitution pro- hibiting slavery. The discussion in Congress on this point came near precipitating the Civil War that broke out ten years later. The difficulty between the slavery and anti-slavery parties was adjusted by compromise measures, for the time, but only served to allay the agitation produced by conflict of inter- ests and opinions, which was irreconcilable. California "The Golden," proved extraordinarily rich in precious metals and other minerals, as quicksilver, platinum, asphaltum, iron, lead, and rare qualities of marble. Its gold mines alone from 1858 to 1868 produced over $800,000,000. It is a broken country, traversed by two ranges of moun- tains. The valleys are exceedingly productive. They are unexcelled for wheat; all kinds of fruit grow in the great- est perfection; and the grape culture promises to equal, if not to excel, the products of the most famous vineyards of Europe. Surprising as is her mineral wealth, her agricultural possibilities are far greater, and her commerce is already immense, and bids fair, from her position and relations to Eastern Asia, and the western parts of South America, to rival that of the Atlantic States. The world was ripe for the discovery of these unparalleled CALIFORNIA. -j- treasures, and civilization was prepared to use them for good of mankind. The ready passage across the inhospitable deserts of the American continent, by mean railways, has already changed land will probably change -till more in the future) the course of commerce; and Ban Fran- cisco and New York may hope to rule, in large part, the commerce of the world. California is remarkable for the salubrity of its clin where the rigors of winter (save on the mountains), and the excessive heats of summer are equally unknown, and for the variety and magnitude of its natural curiosities. ( >t* tin- last the Yosemite valley and the Big Trees are tin- most prominent She has near 1,000 miles of railroad, and has mad.- ample pro- vision for education. Calfornia was the thirty-first State. It has an an a ..t 1--."~l' square miles, equal to 120,948,480 acres. The population in 1S70 was 560,285, entitling her to four Representatives in Congress. By act of 1866, this State, with Oregon and Nevada, con- stitutes the ninth judicial circuit, and forms two judicial districts. California has seven ports of entry, viz.: San Fran- cisco, Monterey, San Diego, Sacramento, Sonoma, San Joaquin and San Pedro; also, one port of delivery. Santa I'.arbara. California was obtained from Mexico by conquest in 1846. The capital is Sacramento. She holds her State election on the first Tuesday in September. Her Legislature inert- on the first Monday in December, but meets only once in two The enacting clause of her laws is: "The people of tli< 9l of California, represented in Senate and Assembly, «:■ I as follows." UNITED STATES SENATORS. John C. Fremont, from I860 to 1851. William M. Gwin, u 1850 « L861. John B. "Weller, a L851 •• 1857. H. P. Haun, u 1869 u [869. David C. Broderick, u 181 « L859. 518 MINNESOTA. Milton S. Latham, from 1860 to 1866. John Conness., " 1863 a 1869. Cornelius Cole, " 1867 u 1873. J. A. McDougall, 1861 a 1867. Eugene Casserly, " 1869 a 1875. Aaron A. Sargent, " 1873 u 1879, John S. Hagar, " 1875 Newton Booth, " 1875 a 1881 MINNESOTA. This State might be called the Mother of Rivers, since it contains the high watershed, or tableland, where the rivers sending their waters to two oceans, in three directions, have their sources. The head waters of the Mississippi, the St. Lawrence, and the streams flowing into the frozen ocean of the north are all found here. In 1680 the unwearied La Salle visited the head waters of the Mississippi, but this region was long left to the sole occupation of the Indians. Fort Snelling, near St. Paul, was built in 1819. No other territory was acquired, by extinction of the Indian title to the soil, until 1837; and in 1849 the civilized population gathered about the trading posts and missions amounted to less than 5,000. It then received a Territorial government. A consid- erable portion of the State having in 1851 been ceded, by treaty with the Indians, to the government, was immediately entered on by the settlers; and in 1858 it was prepared to take rank among the sovereign States. It was admitted in May of this year, by act of Congress. In 1862 the State passed through the appalling crisis of an Indian massacre of the outlying settlements. It began without warning, in the midst of fancied security, an$ before adequate DELLS OF THE ST. CROIX RIVER, MINN. MINNESOTA. protection could be forwarded, some 500 men, women, tad children were murdered with all the accompaniment* of savage cruelty. Some $3,000,000 of property w In a short time sufficient force was gathered to overpov savages, and they were in large part removed from the The surface is undulating and high, and the soil, in g part, extremely fertile. Portions are open and rolling prairie; the remainder heavily wooded. Thongh the winters are long and cold, the air is dry and invigorating, and the cli- mate healthy. It is specially favorable to the gr< iwth of wh< Commerce is favored by the Mississippi, n a visible to Si Paul, and by good harbors on Lake Superior, a€ well ae by numerous railways. Its provision for education ie excellent, and a State University at St. Anthony's Fall- promisee to form a suitable crown to its intellectual advantagi This, State was admitted into the Union on the 1 lth da May, 1858, and made the thirty-second State It ha- an .. of 83,531 square miles, equal to 53,459,840 acres. The popu- lation in 1870 amounted to 435,511. This State is entitled to three Members of Congress. It lies in the eighth judicial circuit, which is composed of Missouri, Iowa, Kansas, Arkansas and Minnesota. M nne- sota forms one judicial district, and has no porta of entry or delivery. St. Paul is the capital. The Legislature meets annually on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. Tin E election is held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in January. UNITED STATES SENATORS. Henry M. Rice, James Shields, Alex. Ramsey, Daniel Norton, Mort. S. Wilkinson, William Windom, S. J. R. McMillan, from 1857 to L868. tt 1>57 » i 1850. u 1863 | | i-::.. a 1865 u 1871. a 1859 » 1 1865. a 1871 u 1-77. a L875 u 1881. 520 OREGON. OREGON "Was discovered by Spanish adventurers in the sixteenth century. In 1792 Capt. Grey, of Boston, discovered the Columbia river and entered it, securing the sovereignty of the country to the United States by right of first exploration. It was more thoroughly explored by Lewis and Clark, appointed for that purpose by the United States government, in 1804—5-6. The northern part, (now Washington Territory,) was claimed by Great Britain, and the conflicting claims produced long and dangerous diplomatic contention, which was finally peaceably ended in favor of the United States. In 1811 a fur trading company established a fort and settle- ment at the mouth of the Columbia, which was taken posses- sion of by the English in the latter part of 1813. The coun- try was claimed by them until 1846, when the boundaries were settled by treaty; giving Oregon to the United States. Settle- ment from the States, however, commenced in 1839, and con- tinued to increase until 1848, when a territorial government was organized. The excitement consequent on the discovery of gold in California drew off many of its citizens; but was, in part, counteracted by the extraordinary inducements made to actual settlers. A State constitution was adopted by the people Nov. 9th, 1857, but it was not admitted, by act of Con- gress, into the Union, until Feb. 14th, 1859, making the thirty- third State. The surface of the country is divided by three ranges of mountains, the Cascade, Blue and Rocky mountains. The Cascade Range has the highest peaks found in the United States. The climate is mild near the coast, but more severe in OREGON. 52] higher eastern parts. The high eastern regions are rolcai containing vast traets of lava, entirely Bterile; the middle well adapted to grazing, in many parts. The valuable farming lands are in the western division, along the various tributary streams of the Columbia. Wheat is the great Btaple; • oats, and vegetables, are grown with success. Fruit produced in abundance. Its supply of coal and copper ifl to be unlimited; and it is specially celebrated for its extensive forests of gigantic trees. Manufactures and commerce an yet, undeveloped; but will be important in the future. Little has been done in the way of internal improvement. Oregon has experienced the disadvantage of growing np in the shade of her splendid neighbor, California, but ha I solidly prosperous future before her. It has an area of 95,274 square miles, equal 10 60,975,860 acres. The population amounted in 1870 to 90,922, which did not reach the number required to entitle it to a Member of Congress according to the fixed ratio. But every State ifl entitled to one member, whatever its population may be. By act of 1866, the States of Oregon, Nevada and California were constituted the ninth judicial circuit. Oregon forms one judi- cial district, and has one collection district, and one port of entry. The capital is Salem, where her Legislature meets onoe in two years, on the second Monday of September. The Bl election is held on the first Monday in June. UNITED STATES BENATOBS. Joseph Lane, Delazon Smith, Edward D. Baker, Benj. F. Harding, James W. Nesmith, Benjamin Stark, Geo. H. Williams, Henry W. Corbett, James K. Kelly, John II. Mitchell, from 1859 to L861. u L859 i{ I860. u 1863 1 1 L861. « L862. .. L861 « 1867. v. L861 •• L862. u L865 1 1 1871. .. 1867 1 • 1878. u L871 •• 1-77. u L8T3 1879. 522 KANSAS. KANSAS. 1. Nearly every State in the American Union has some- advantage that is peculiar to it, or that it shares in a degree so eminent as to distinguish it from all others. Kansas is not an exception, and some of these are exceedingly attractive. They enter, to some extent, into the painful and bloody history of its first settlement; the mighty tragedy of the Civil "War having enacted its prelude on her fertile plains. The Kansas and Nebraska Bill, in 1854, repealed the Missouri Compro- mise, and this territory was opened to a trial of strength between Freedom and Slavery; the contest being transferred from the floors of Congress and the Representatives of the people to the settlers of the soil, who were to determine whether slavery should, or not, exist in it, as a State. The attraction of a decisive political struggle was added to the many favorable features of position, climate, and intrinsic value. Southern people sought to introduce their peculiar institution, and northern people resisted. There was much disorder and bloodshed. Every effort was made, by strategy and force, on the one side and the other. The southern party was signally defeated and there was henceforth no hope of preserving to the slave States a balance of power in the national government, and the civil war followed, almost as a natural consequence. 2. Kansas is larger by more than 3,000 square miles than the whole of New England. It lies very near the geographical centre of the country, and stretches a friendly hand, by the Pacific Railroads, to both the Atlantic and Pacific States, A good part of her soil is declared to be much superior to that KANSAS. of ordinary prairie land in richness, and to average fonr I in depth. It is fairly watered and timbered, and freelj i duces everything, except the proper feropieal producte of the extreme south, that is grown in the United States. Tin- cli- mate is that of Virginia, without its excessive heat; which may, perhaps, be considered balanced by its occasional sively sharp and cutting winds in winter. These, howev< r, are tolerably rare, and the winters, for the mosl part, short and mild, the climate being, on the whole very healthy. [1 deposits of salt are exceedingly rich, and other mine] abound in various parts. Its commercial position is excellent, and its manufacturing capabilities all that the future will be likely to require. Its resources, under suitable development, cannot be considered inferior to any other equal area in the country; which is speaking in the strongest language we can command, considering what may be said of so many different localities. 3. The eastern surface is a succession of waves, or undula- tions, the valleys generally extending north and south. A nar- row section west of it, stretching across the State is more l< and the soil lighter. Beyond this long reaches of level, fertile, and well watered lands are adapted to flocks and herds. T are much higher than the river beds, the valleys of which abound in bottoms, beautiful in appearance and situation, and of inexhaustible fertility. Vast beds of coal, a g 1 quality and abundant quantity of iron ore, and petroleum and lead have been discovered. Corn and wheat are the leading sta] and it is believed that fruit culture will soon become a Lading interest of this promising State. Kansas was admitted into the Union as a State, Jan 1861, making the thirty-fourth State. Kansas has an 78,841 square miles, equal to 50,187,830 acres. The pop tion in 1870 was 362,812, giving her three Repreeentativei in Congress. This State is in the eighth judicial circuit, and forms one judicial district. It has no ports delivery. 524 WEST VIRGINIA. Topeka is the capital. The State election is held on the Tuesday after the first Monday in November. The Legislature meets on the second Tuesday in January. The enacting clause of the laws is as follows: " Be it enacted by the Legislature of the State of Kansas." UNITED STATES SENATORS. from James Henry Lane, Samuel C. Pomeroy, E. G. Ross, Alexander Caldwell, * Robert Crozier, James M. Harvey, John J. Ingalls, * Appointed by Governor to fill vacancy. u « u a a a 1861 to 1866. 1861 a 1873. 1866 a 1871. 1871 a 1877. 1877. u 1877. 1873 tt 1879. WEST VIRGINIA. This is the only State ever formed, under the Constitution, by the division of an organized State. The interests of West Virginia were always different from those of the eastern part; and when, at the commencement of the Civil War, the eastern part seceded, the western remained loyal and was erected into a separate State; thus realizing the ancient wish of its citizens. The act of Congress organizing it as a State was passed December 31st, 1862, with condition that it should take effect 60 days after proclamation of its admission by the President of the United States. This proclamation was issued April 21st, 1863; and it was admitted to representation in Congress as a sovereign State June 20th thereafter. A temporary gov- ernment without representation in Congress had been formed in May, 1862. It was the thirty -fifth State admitted into the Union. NK\ ADA. It ia varied in surface, from high mountain ranges, hill j undulating midlands, to level and rich river bottom I if nearly all available either for cultivation or grazing ; while iu valuable deposits of coal lie very near tin' Burface in Dearly all parts of the State. Iron abounds, ami timber "I - tin- b quality. Its manufacturing facilities air gnat, ; and it- and railroads, with the Ohio river on its northwestern border, furnish the means of making it one of the rich in the Union. The climate is healthy, and the scenery picturesque, and in places it rises to wild grandeur. It has an area of 23,000 square miles, or 14,7l'h.i aen The population, in 1870 was 445,616. This State baa now three Members of Congress. Wot Virginia was subsequently put into the fourth judicial circuit, and constitutes one judi< district. Parkersburg, also, was made a port of delivery. Wheeling is the capital. The State election is held on the fourth Thursday in October. The Legislature meets on second Tuesday in January. UNITED STATES SENATORS. Peter G. Van Winkle, from Waitman T. Willey, Arthur J. Boreman, H. G. Davis, Allen T. Caperon, urn 18«;:i to I860. a 1863 i . L871. a 1868 u L875. a L871 u L877. tl 1875 a I SSI. N E V A I.) A . "The Snowy Land "derives its name from the Sierra vada, or Snowy Range of mountains forming the eastern bo dary of California. It lies in the western part of tfa of the Great Salt Lake and among those mountains, in rocky bosom was found the stimulus that has ohai 526 NEVADA. of the Pacific slope, and the Rocky Mountain region, from a wild and dismal waste to populous and thriving States. Gold was found in moderate quantities among the mountains, and population began to scatter slowly over them about 1850, and soon settlers began to improve the valleys at the foot of the mountains on the east for agricultural purposes. Carson county was organized by the territorial government of Utah in 1854; but in June, 1859, rich deposits of silver were found ; and emigration began to pour in rapidly. In March, 1861, the Territory of Nevada was organized, and the same month, three years later, it was admitted into the Union, making the thirty-sixth State. The history of these States, so rich in precious metals, puts to the blush the fantastic fables of the Arabian Nights. The silver mines of Nevada are believed to be the richest in the world. The celebrated silver mines of Potosi, in South America, never produced over $10,000,000 a year, while in 1867, one mine in Nevada produced $17,5$0,900, and is thoniglit to be almost, or quite, inexhaustible. The climate, like that of Cali- fornia, is healthy; the seasons are divided into wet and dry, and agriculture is dependent on irrigation. With time and pains its products will be considerable. It has much wild and sublime scenery, and some natural curiosities; as Lake Mono, with its waters so sharply acid as to destroy cloth and leather immersed in it. Its gloomy surroundings, and the great dis- tance from the tops of the precipitous rocks surrounding its shores to the surface of the water lend an impressive and fear- ful character to its severe desolation. It lies below the reach of the winds, and no living thing can exist in its waters. It has an area of 63,473 square miles, or 40,622,720 acres. The population in I860, while yet a Territory, was 6,857. In 1870 it had increased to 42,491. In conformity with the Con- stitutional provision that every State shall have one Represent- ative in Congress, Nevada has one. This State lies in the ninth judicial circuit, and forms one judicial district, called the dis- trict of Nevada. KEBBASKA. OL'7 Carson City is the capital. The State election is held on the first Tuesday in November ; and the Legislature tneetc on first Monday in January. The enacting clause of the lawe is in the following words : ' k The people of the State of Nevada, ivpivsented in > and Assembly, do enact as follow-.'' UNITED STATES BBNATOB& James W.Nye, from 1865 to 1873. "William M. Stewart, " 1865 " 1875. John P. Jones, " 1873 " 1879. Win. Sharon, " 1875 « 1881. NEBRASKA 1. Formed a part of the Louisiana Purchase from the Freneh government in 1803. It received a Territorial govern- ment in 1854, and was, by the provisions of the Kan- braska Bill, equally with Kansas, exposed to the introduction of slavery; but the Southern people limited their efforts In that direction to Kansas, and Nebraska did not share in its disorder and bloodshed. 2. The greater portion of the country consists of a high, rolling prairie. The soil in the eastern pari of the Stab nearly the same as that of the adjoining portions of [owa and Kansas. It is a rich loam, finely pulverized, and admirably adapted to cultivation. The second district, Dear the of the State, is strictly pastoral. The third, <»r western - has a fair soil, but is destitute of timber, and insufficiently supplied with water. Throughout the fertile portion of the State, wheat, corn,' and other cereals, and vegetables and fruits yield lai^gi ly. \ herds of buffaloes formerly roamed over its prairies : but tl 52S NEBRASKA. are now mostly exterminated. The altitude of Nebraska secures to it a dry, pure, and salubrious atmosphere. Rain is not abun- dant, but, in the eastern part, is sufficient for the purposes of the agriculturist. Salt, limestone, and coal are found in various localities, and not improbably other minerals will be found in paying quantities. The State is too new to fully estimate all its resources and capabilities. 3. The educational advantages are good. The Common School System, modeled on that of Ohio, is well supplied with funds, embracing one-sixteenth of the public land, or 2,500,000 acres. 90,000 acres were given to endow a State Agricultural College, and 46,081 acres to the State University. Its commercial facilities are supplied by the Missouri River, the Pacific and other railroads, and are amply sufficient to develop its resources. The future of the State has many ele- ments of promise. No public debt impedes its growth, and within the last few years it has increased in wealth and popu- lation more rapidly than any of the adjoining States or Terri- tories. An unknown, but certainly not limited, amount of wealth still lies locked up in its soil, and its relation to ocean commerce by the mighty Missouri, and to inter-State trade by lying in the great traveled route between the Atlantic and Pacific States, with a remarkably fine, healthy climate, and the ease with which its soil is worked, contribute to form a power- ful attraction to labor and capital, and we have no reason to suspect any decrease in its rapid progress. 4. On its admission, in 1867, it was the thirty-seventh State. It has an area of 122,007 square miles, or 78,084,480 acres. Population in 1870, 123,000. It forms the ninth judicial district, and has no ports of entry or delivery. The capital is Lincoln. The State election is held on the gecond Tuesday in October. The Legislature meets on the Thursday after the first Monday in January. UNITED STATES SENATORS. John M. Thayer, from 1867 to 1871. Thomas W. Tipton, " 1867 " 1875. Phineas W. Hitchcock, " 1871 " 1877. A 1 rernon S. Paddock, " 1875 " 1881. in W - o en u o a z u (Y>I.oitAI>(>. COLORADO Was formed from parts of Kansas, Nebraska and Utah. It* Territorial government was organized by act of Oongn March 2nd, 1861. It is situated west of Kansas, on th< route from the Pacific to the Atlantic States^and od the divid. ing ridge, or backbone, of the continent. The rivers tii.-u find their head waters within the territory run southeast and south to the Gulf of Mexico, and southwest to the Gulf of Oalifi irnia. The surface is nearly equally divided between a plain, gently decending from the abrupt mountain wall of rock constituting the eastern flank of the Eocky Mountains and the mighty mass of that chain, with its peaks, rising nearly three miles above the surface of the sea-, nowforming an elevated plateau, and again sending off spurs and lateral ranges containing bean- tiful valleys, or, in a more lavish and genial mood, taking B wide circuit inclosing an immense sunken plain containing hundreds of square miles of charming, well watered tarn land called parks. Of these there are seven. It is a magnifi cent region, and contains all the elements of extreme mineral and agricultural wealth. It has mines of gold, Bilver, cop] lead, and iron. Coal abounds in all parts, oil flows from the wells with a little encouragement, and salt is easily obtained in some parts. An immense Boda-fonntain is fonnd near Col- orado City, called Fontaine qui Bouille (boiling fountain) and there are indications of cinnabar, platina, and precious The climate is fine, the general temperature like Southern Pennsylvania or Maryland; and, from the elevation, tie very dry and pure. The plain rises by imperceptible degrees to 5,000 feet, (about one mile,) above the level of the 34 530 COLORADO. the foot of the mountains. The numerous valleys, the parks, and much of the sloping plain, form as fine an agricultural region, with proper irrigation, as any State possesses, and much of the remainder furnishes excellent pasturage through the entire year. Occasionally heavy snow falls and for a few days extreme cold prevails, but these are exceptional years; and it does not lie long. Its effects can be guarded against with prudent care. Corn, wheat, and other small grains and vegetables reach their greatest perfection here. It furnishes excellent manufacturing facilities along the unfailing mountain streams in the valleys, and will no doubt ultimately unite with Montana and Southwestern Dacotah to supply the immense central part of our domain with all the products of manufacturing genius and skill. Denver the capital and principal city, is situated near the eastern base of the mountains, where these put on their severest and sublimest aspect. Clear lakes are set like stars, here and there, and the beautiful and grand in scenery are nowhere more striking, or more agreeably combined. The Territory contains 106,475 square miles in area, and the population in 1870 numbered 29,706. Several attempts have been made to obtain the admission of Colorado as a State into the American Union. An act to en- able the people to form a constitution and State Government was passed by Congress, March, 1864. The constitution, framed under this act, was rejected by the people of the terri- tory. Another constitution was framed and adopted in 1865, but a bill, passed by Congress for its admission, was vetoed by the President. Another attempt made in 1867 likewise failed by the President's veto; since which time it quietly remained under its Territorial government, until March 3, 1875, when it was admitted by Act of Congress. CHAPTEIi LXVII. MOTTOES AND NAMES OF THE STATE& United States — E Pluribus Unum. "Oul of Many, < hie." Alabama. — Has no motto. Name, from its principal I means "Here we rest," and denotes the satisfaction of the Indians with its agreeable landscape and climate. Arkansas — Regnant populi — "The people rule." Eas the Indian name of its river. Is called the " Hear State." California — Eureka, her Greek motto, means " I have found it." Derives her name from the bay forming the penin- sula of lower California. Colorado — Latin motto, Nil sine nu mint , means •• N'.. th- ing can be done without divine aid." Named from the river. Connecticut — Qui transtulit Sustinet, "lie who brought us over sustains us." Name from her river, which means, in the Indian tongue, "The long river." Is called the " Nutmeg State." Delaware — Motto, Liberty and Independence. Was named from Lord Delaware, an English statesman. Is called "The Blue Hen." Florida — Motto, "In God is our trust." Name from tic- abundance of flowers when discovered, on Easter Sunday. In Spanish Florida means flowery. Georgia — Motto, "Wisdom, justice and moderation." Named from George II, King of England when it was settled. Illinois — Motto, "State Sovereignty, National Onion." Name derived from an Indian tribe, also applied by them t.» Lake Michigan and her largest inland river. Mean- " We are the men." Is called the "Sucker State." Indiana — Has no motto. Name simm-sted by its numerous DO Indian population. It is called the " Boosier State." Iowa — Motto, "Our liberties we prize, our rights we will maintain." Its Indian name means "This is the Land." called the " Hawk Eye State." Kansas — Motto, Ad astrajper aspera, "To the Btars through difficulties." Name means " Smoky water," aid i- derih from one of her rivers. (581) 7)32 MOTTOES AND NAMES OF THE STATES. Kentucky — Motto, ''United we stand, divided we fall." Bears the Indian name of one of her rivers. The Indians termed it the " dark and bloody ground." It was the battle field of Northern and Southern Indians. Is called the " Blue Grass State." Louisiana — Motto, "Union and confidence." Named from Louis NIV, King of France. It is called "The Creole State." Maine — Latin motto, Dirigo, "I direct;" indicative of sovereignty. Was named for a province of France. Is called u The Pine Tree State." Maryland — Latin motto, Crescite et multiplicamini, " Increase and multiply." Name from the Queen of England, the wife of Charles I. Massachusetts — Latin motto, Ense petit placid am sub lib- ertate quietem, " By the sword she seeks placid rest in liberty," or "Conquers a peace." The name was acquired from an Indian tribe and the bay on her coast. Is called the " Bay State " from her numerous bays. Michigan — Latin motto, Tuebor, and, Si quceris peninsu- lam amcenam circumspice. "I will defend." "If you seek a pleasant peninsula, look around you." The name is derived from two Indian words meaning " Great Lake," by them applied to Huron and Michigan lakes. Is called " The Wolverine State." Minnesota — French motto, VEtoile du flora 7 , "The Star of the North." The name, meaning whitish water, (foam of the falls,) is derived from the Indians. Missouri — Latin motto, Salus populi suprema lex esto, "Let the welfare of the people be the supreme law." Named from her great river. It means " Muddy water." Mississippi — Has no motto. It is named from the river, whose name signifies "The Father of Waters." Nebraska — Motto, "Equality before the law." Its name is derived from one of its rivers, meaning "broad and shallow, or low." New Hampshire — Has no motto. It is named from & MOTTOES AND NAMES oF nil BTi .V.J county in England. Familiar name is "The old Granite State." New Jersey — Motto, "Liberty and Independence." Nai for the Island of Jersey on the coast of England. New York — Latin motto, Excelsior, "Higher." Named from the Duke of York. Is called "The Empire State." North Carolina — Has no motto. It was named for ( lharlei IX, King of France. It is called " The old North," or " The Turpentine State." Nevada — Latin motto, Volens et potens, "Willing and Able." It was named from its mountains. Spanish Dame means " Snowy." Ohio — Latin motto, Imperium in imperio, "An empire in an empire." It took its name from the river on its south boundary. It is familiarly called " The Buckeye State." Oregon — Latin motto, Alis volat propria, "She flies with her own wings." Name is derived from her principal river. Pennsylvania — Motto, "Virtue, liberty and independence." Named from "Win. Penn, "Penn's woods." [a called the " Keystone State." Rhode Island — Her motto is "Hope." Named from the Island of Rhodes, in the Mediterranean Sea. Is familiarly called " Little Rhodv." South Carolina — Latin motto, An i in is optbueque parati. "Ready in will and deed." Has the Lit in Dame of Chariei IX, of France (Carolus). Is known as the " Palmetto Btate. N Tennessee — Motto, "Agriculture, Commerce." Haa the Indian name of one of her rivers. She is called "The Big Bend State." Texas— Has no motto. Bab preserved it- Mexican nam.' Is called "The Lone Star State." Vermont— Motto, " Freedom and Unity." Hafl the French name of her mountains ( Verd Mont, "Green Maintain- " Virgin i a— Latin motto. Sic semper tyrannM, "fi with tyrants." Was named from Elizabeth of England, tat " Virgin " Queen. It is called " The Old Dominion." 534: T1IE NATIONAL DOMAIN. West Virginia — Latin motto, Montani semper llberi, " Mountaineers are always free." Retained the former name, when divided from Virginia." Wisconsin — Latin motto, Civilitas successit ba? i harum y "The civilized man succeeds the barbarous." Has the Indian name of one of her rivers. It is called " The Badger State." CHAPTER LXVIII. THE NATIONAL DOMAIN. 1. When the War of Independence closed, and the people and government had leisure to look about them and estimate their situation, they found the organized States covering the coast from Nova Scotia to Florida, (then in possession of Spain.) There was no vacant territory near the ocean; but west of the States — which run back only a few hundred miles — was a vast region, peopled by a few tribes of Indians and, in Kentucky and Tennessee, by a few hundred whites These with singular hardihood and self reliance, had not hesi- tated to brave a thousand perils to get possession of the charming valleys and fertile savannahs of the eastern part of the great Mississippi Valley. The settlements w T ere made near the mountains that skirted the western boundaries of the original States. Beyond, to the Mississippi river, extended as beautiful and fertile a territory as any land could boast; many times larger than the original territory, whose people, poor and few as they were, had fought for and w r on it by persistent bravery. It lay in virgin beauty and wealth, the prize of their strong hands and courageous hearts. The future of the new government once determined, and the fundamental Law of the Land adopted, they prepared to take possession by organizing a government over those already there, surveying and laying off the unsettled lands, and bringing them into market for sale and settlement. 2. The States had owned all the property, and held all the Till-: NATIONAL DOMAIN. real power, tip to the adoption of the present Constitution. It was now agreed that the unsettled lands Bhould be considered as the common property of the whole country, and be admin- istered by the General Government. It was doI withoul mnch difficulty, and many severe contests, thai this point was so settled. There were two parties; one headed by Alexander Hamilton who wished a strong, consolidated central govern ment; the other, afraid to confer on it too mnch power lest it should prove a tyrannical master, wished to preserve most of the substance of power in the State governments. They w led by Thomas Jefferson. The adoption of the Constitution was difficult, and the struggle over it perilous to the confeder- ation. It embraced the main views of the first party. But for the personal influence of Washington, who had pi over the Convention that framed it. and had, as it were, 1 its father, it could not have received the approval of the majority of the peoj)le. The people allowed their fean overruled by their trust in his wisdom and prudence. He alone it has been believed could haw put it.- machinery in successful operation; and the admirable manner in which the statesmen, in Congress and the executive offices, infused the spirit of freedom and moderation into the administration, following in the lead of the revered " Father of his Country," settled it in the confidence and affections of the people. 3. We have dwelt on this point because it is intimately related to the organization and government of the Territo and to the provision made for the increase of States. I' important that they should be in harmony with the orig ones, and there were no mean- of Becuring this and proi id against the future growth of governments, differing from t ! of the original State.-, but by giving the central power eral control over them. The Constitution conferred Congress. Ohio, and all the territory north of the Ohio ri i was obliged to wait till this point was Bettled, before be opened to the entrance of emigrant-. This n early erected into a separate government, by I 5o6 THE NATIONAL DOMAIN. the Northwest Territory. The region south of the river was treated in the same manner a little later. In 1800 the Missis- sippi Territory was organized; thus covering all the ground originally belonging to the New Republic. These were, as population increased, divided into sections, of convenient size for the purpose of local self government, and states created as fast as the requisite number of citizens had collected within such limits; and the remainder continued under the prelim- inary territorial rule. 4. In 1802, the vast region west of the Mississippi was bought of the French government. This extended the National Domain from the mouth to the head waters of this river, and westward, north of the Spanish possessions, to the Pacific ocean. Many new States and Territories have been formed from it. The process of multiplication has not yet ceased in this region. In 1819 Florida was purchased; a part of Mex- ico was obtained in 1848, and again in 1853; and the increase of territory continued by the acquisition of Alaska in 1867. This policy has become, in a manner, traditional, and it is not unlikely that it may be continued to some extent in the future. 5. The government of the territories is established by act of Congress; the President nominates and the Senate con- firms the Governor, Secretary, and Judges of the courts; and Congress passes all the general laws for the government of the inhabitants. A Territorial Legislature is elected by the inhabitants, which takes charge of all the local interests of the Territory. All these laws and organizations are temporary, and pass away when a State government is founded. Com- monly, an act of Congress authorizes the election of Delegates to a Convention for framing a State Constitution; though the Territorial Government sometimes takes the initiative. This constitution is then submitted to the popular vote of the citi- zens in the Territory; and if they favor it, presented to Con- gress for its approval. If it is in harmony with our usages, and republican principles, Congress accepts it, and, if the President does not see cause to veto it, a new State has come THE INDIVIDUAL TESBTTOBDCB. into existence. In this manner the number of the become nearly three times as numerous as at the beginning. CHAPTER LXIX. THE INDIVIDUAL TERRITORIES. The territories are here arranged in the order of seniority, the one which first received a territorial government taking the lead. The District of Columbia is older than any of them as acknowledged National property, the Louisiana Purch having been made since it was ceded to the general Govern. ment; but it was the last to receive a territorial organization, Congress governing it directly without giving it representation until 1871. It is placed last for that reason. NEW MEXICO Was visited at an early period by Spaniards, who, ezeited by the success of the followers of Cortez and Pizarro in dis- covering rich mines of gold and silver, sought the wealth in the dangers and hardships of travel which is more often, if more slowly, found as the reward of patient toil. An expe dition from Florida made the formidable overland journey to New Mexico, in 1537; and another from Mexico, alter visiting the Gila River, passed eastward beyond the Rio Grande in 1540. In 1581 its mineral wealth became known and a mission was attempted; but no settlement was made until L600, when formal possession was taken by an adequate army. The mil sions now became very successful and the mines were worl Many of the natives were considerably advanced In Bome oi the arts of civilization. In L680 the natives revolted, from the severe servitude to which they were subjected, and dr the Spaniards out of the country. They only rec 1 it in 1698. It was never very numerously peopled by whites. In 1846 it was conquered by General Kearney, and in 184€ to the United States by the treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo. 1 538 NEW MEXICO. difficulties of transportation and the wild and lawless char- acter of the inhabitants has prevented any extensive emigra- tion to it by Americans. It is an elevated table-land, nearly 7,000 feet above the surface of the sea, crossed by several ranges of mountains sometimes rising 10,000 feet above the general surface of the country. The atmosphere is dry; little rain falls; and agriculture is usually successful only with irri- gation. In the valleys, where this is employed, the fertility of the soil is marvelous. Often two crops are raised, on the same land, in the year. Wheat and other grains are raised in great perfection. Cotton is successful in some parts, fruit can be raised in abundance, and the soil is said to be specially favorable to the grape, the wine rivaling that of France. Gold and silver abound, but the mines have never been effectively worked for want of transportation and the requisite capital. Stock raising is a profitable occupation in this Terri- tory. Much of the land unfit for cultivation produces grass which cures in drying daring the hot months, and preserves all its nutricious qualities. Sheep and mules are extensively raised. When the Pacific railroad shall open the country to immigration, and order, industry, and capital make the most of its resources, it will be ranked among the favored parts of the Union. It has many natural curiosities, and much wild and beauti- ful scenery. The length of the Rio Grande, in its windings in the Territory, is about 1200 miles; and its valley from one to twelve miles wide. Its Territorial government was organ- ized in 1850. The population, in 1870, was 91,878. Many tribes of Indians roam over the territory and through Texas, Arizona, and northern Mexico. Most of the people are Roman Catholics. It includes an area of about 100,000 square miles. Every free white male inhabitant living in the territory at the time of its organization had the right of suffrage, that right being regulated in other respects by its legislative Assembij ■ UTAH. UTAH Was formerly a part of the Mexican territory of dp] ifornia, and was acquired by the United States in 1848, by the treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo. It was too distant, d< and dangerous a region for much settlement by Mexicans, and has little known history anterior to the explorations of I mont between 1843 and 1846. The first American settlement was made by the ftformi in July, 1847, and was supposed by them to be oul of the ter- ritory of the United States, and beyond the reach of possible interference. Here, in the depths of the desert, they deter- mined to build up a peculiar religious society embracing customs abhorrent to the views and institutions of modern civilized States. Their success was a surprise to the world, and probably to themselves; the capacity of the depths of the Great American Desert, as it was called, for cultivation, exceeding all previous expectation. But the war with Mexi then in progress, threw this, before inaccessible, deserl into tin- limits of the American Union; and the discovery of gold in the neighboring territory of California, throwing them aim midway between the old western settlements and the new I rado, subjected them to contact with, and interference by, tin- tide of modern civilization, as it flowed toward the sun; and in ten years from their firsl appearance in the I • Central Basin of the continent, they came again into hostile conflict with the established authorities they thought I finally escaped. Though their conflict with the Ohited 8l government, imbued with the habit- and prejudices with which they antagonized, was deferred h\ the troubles which precipi- tated the Civil "War, and their institutions remained m tially intact until that was past; the Pacific Railroad built through their territory, and, if they are no longer cuted, and their peculiarities opposed by deadly \'<". moral influence and dissolving power introduced by nn is more surely wasting away the foundations of thei and religious edifice. 510 WASHINGTON TERRITORY. Utah was organized as a territory by act of Congress Sept. 9th, 1850. Brighani Young, the head of the Mormon church, became the first governor. In 1854 it was vainly attempted to remove him; and in 1857 an army was sent to enforce Federal authority. A final conflict was avoided by compromise. In 1862 the Mormons attempted to get admission into the Union as a State, with their " peculiar institutions," but failed. A Territorial Government exists, but has little force, or vitality, while the Mormons are large in numbers. According to the habits of our people, conflict is avoided so far as possible, to •await the more peaceable and natural solution of the difficulty by moral forces. Utah is unique in one respect; though lying nearly a mile above the surface of the sea, and having a complete system of lakes and rivers, there is no visible connection of these with the ocean. It is a continent embosomed within the depths of a continent. The Great Salt Lake is 100 miles long by 50 broad, and its waters are very salt — three parts of the water producing one of pure salt. No fish can live in it. It receive* the contents of many considerable streams. Whether they are kept in subjection by evaporation alone, or have a concealed outlet to the ocean is unknown. The soil, though in its natu- ral state an apparent desert, is extremely fertile when irri- gated, and produces wheat and other cereals in great profu- sion. Its mountains are believed to be rich in silver and gold; but the Mormons have discouraged mining, and very little has been done in that direction. Cotton is highly successful in the southern settlements, and experiments with flax and silk culture have been very favora- ble. The climate is mild and healthy. Utah is a highly promising section of our national domain. Its population in 1870 was 86,786 ; its area about 87,500 square miles. WASHINGTON TERRITORY Was organized in 1853, and then contained a much larger area. It was at first a part of Oregon, and its meagre early WASHINGTON ! i RR] rORY. i i i history wa8 the same. The Straits of San Juan de Plica ■•• visited and named by a Spanish navigator in 177:.. T lish government claimed the territory north of the Colm and for some years there was a joint occupation by both i by special agreement. The difficulties concerning this dary came near involving the two nations in war, but it settled in 1S46, giving the United States the territory to 49th parallel of latitude. Vancouver [eland was assigned to Great Britain. Washington is estimated to contain, west of the ( river, where it flows down from British America, 22,000 square miles of arable land. There is much that is adapted onli grazing, and vast quantities covered with forests in the wild mountain regions of the eastern part of the territory. It has an almost inexhaustible supply of coal, and more less of the precious metals. The great distinction of Wash- ington territory is its forests. The warm ocean current- from the Indian ocean, after traversing the eastern coasts of A are thrown across the North Pacific against the western sho of North America, and effect an important modification in the severity and humidity of the temperature of out Pacific Blope. The climate is .much milder and more equable than in tin- same latitude east of the mountains, and the moisture ifi highly favorable to forest growth. It is the best ship building timber in the world. The trees are immense, often reaching a height of 300 feet with a diameter of 8 to Ii ; feet The portion of Washington territory lying west of th< ' cade mountains is rich farming land, heavily timbered; while east of the Cascades the country is open prairie, well « with small and thinly wooded valleys. The land immediately about Puget Sound is Bandy; not valuable for tanning though producing timber, but a little way hark is unrivaled in richm Corn does not thrive well, but wheat, oats, potatoes, A ■.. are very prolific. Large quantities of butter, eheese, and wool produced. There is little snow in the winter and thai melts away, except far up in the mountains. Waal 542 COLORADO TERRITORY. shares with Oregon the possession and use of the Columbia river. There are fine fisheries on the coast and excellent oys- ters, and these produce a considerable trade. Immense quanti- ties of lumber are exported to all parts of the Pacific coast of both North and South America, and even to Buenos Ayres on the South Atlantic. The French come here for their best and cheapest masts and spars. Thus we see that this corner of the Republic brings to the common stock of national treasures some of its best and most valuable material of wealth, and is prepared to whiten the Pacific with the sails of the unlimited commerce which is already beginning to grow up between us and the Asiatics. Puget Sound can float with ease the navies of the world on its peaceful bosom. The Northern Pacific railroad will originate here, probably, another great commer- cial emporium. Washington will, in due time, become a great and wealthy State. Its area is about 70,000 square un)es; i*nd the population in 1870 was 23,901. DACOTA H. DACOTAH. This territory received an organization- and government in 1861. It contains 240,000 square miles; and is greater in extent than all New England together with the great and wealthy States of New York and Pennsylvania; and po some peculiar advantages. The Missouri River passes from southeast bo north diagonally through it, navigable for its whole Length, a distal of more than a thousand miles; the Red River of the North skirts its eastern line, its valley being unrivalled for its rich- ness, and adaptation to the growth of wheat. Exoepl the extreme northern part it is said to have the dry, pure, and healthy climate of Southern Minnesota, with the Boil of Cen- tral Illinois. It is free from the damp, raw, and chilly weather prevailing in Iowa and Illinois, and from the embarrassments to agricul- ture often experienced in these States from ex© asive spring rains; while, in late spring and early Bummer, copious Bhon supply sufficient moisture to promote a rapid vegetable growth. The surface east and north of the Missouri is an undulating prairie, free from marsh, swamp, and Blough, traversed by many streams and dotted with innumerable lakes, of various sizes, whose woody and rocky shore.- and gravel bottoms Bupply the purest water, and lend the enchantment of extreme beauty to the landscape. It has all the conditions of climate. Boil, and trai tion for the most profitable production of the two gr "t American agriculture, wheat and corn. Wesl o ±± ARIZONA. the country becomes more rolling, then broken and hilly, until the lofty chain of the Rocky Mountains is reached. These mountains cross the southwestern section. A most desirable stock raising region is furnished here, and mining will flourish in the mountains. In 1870 it had a population of 14,181. Yankton is the capital. ARIZONA. The Spaniards visited the valley of the Colorado at an early day; but the distance from Mexico, and the warlike character of the Indians, did not favor settlement beyond what was gathered about the few missions that were constructed so as to answer for fortresses. The part of this territory lying between Sonora, (of which it formed part.) and California was acquired to the United States by the Gadsden treaty, made with Mexico Dec. 30th, 1853. The American government paid $10,000,000 for it. A Terri- torial government was organized Feb. 24th, 1863, and embraced part of New Mexico, containing, altogether, an area of 121,000 square miles, or 77,440,000 acres. Efforts had been made previously to settle the country and develop its mines; and an overland mail stage route was established. This proved a success; but the fierce hostility of the Apache Indians, and the desperate character of such whites as had gathered there, fleeing from justice in California and Sonora, discouraged the immigration of law-abiding citizens; and the breaking out of the Civil War withdrew the soldiers in garrison there for the protection of the country. After the war the main stream of emigration followed the line of the newly opened Pacific railroad. The development of the mines required capital and machinery and, though they are thought to be the richest in the world, nothing could be extracted from them by individuals without means. So the population has increased slowly, the census of 1870 giving 9,658. It is a strange and somewhat fearful land; in great part a region of desolate mountains and deep canons. There are Il>AII<>. many sections susceptible of cultivation that would prod immense returns under irrigation, but tnoel of the eff this direction have miscarried from the desolating r the Indians. The rainless season reduces the whole country to the semblance of a desert. It is. however, declare more arable land in proportion to its surface than NTew M. dco, or California; and will probably, in time, have a large and prosperous farming community. Cotton is easily cultivated, and sugar cane, in the lower part.-, produces abundantly. Grains, vegetables, and melons are produced in the great possible perfection, and mature in an incredibly shorl bu time. When the Apaches are subdued, and society is reduced t<> order, it will become a favorite resort of the thrifty farmers of the older States, and the diligent German and other fori immigrants. It contains many traces of a race that has disappeared : some of their dwellings yet remaining in a partially ruinous state. They were probably Aztecs, the race that ruled Mexico bei the conquest by Cortez, or are more ancient -till. Hide idols are found, and various indications of a barbarous worship. The completion of the Southern Pacific railway will intro- duce the hum of industry among its desolate mountains and along its numerous fertile valleys, and the acquisition of mouth of the Colorado, a large river opening into the hi of the Gulf of California, will give it a profitable comm< Arizona lies south of Utah, to which it is superior in the num- ber and size of its streams, its larger quantity of timber, and the amount of rain-fall in some parts, which is deemed, in some sections, sufficient to dispense with the I •li- gation. IDAHO. This territory was organized March 3rd, L868. U embraced a vast territory lying on both sidesof the main of the Rocky Mountains; but the eastern portion 35 546 MONTANA TERRITORY. been erected into the territory of Montana. It has about 90,000 square miles of territory, and had, in 1870, 14,998 inhabitants. Idaho has very little history prior to the organization of its Territorial government. Its chief attraction to settlers lies in its mines, as yet, and the population is floating, and, in large part, rough and sometimes disorderly. The difficulty of reach- ing it has prevented its rapid growth. It is exceedingly rich in the precious metals and this will, in time, attract a large population. The eastern and northern parts are very mountain- ous, abounding in wild and striking scenery and in natural curiosities. The soil in the southern, central, and western parts, is fertile, producing wheat and other small grain, and vegetables very successfully, but is unfavorable for corn from the late frosts of spring and the early cold of autumn. Snow falls to a great depth in the mountains; but the streams are numerous, and there is much choice farming land, which may, ultimately, serve to support its mining population. It runs from the northern boundary of Utah to the south line of British America; Washington Territory and Oregon, lying west. When railroads shall render it accessible, and open the way for its treasures to a market, it will be filled with an industrious and hardy population who will find all the ele- ments of a prosperity as great as any section of the Union enjoys. It has three beautiful lakes — the Coeur d' Aline, the Pen d' Oreille, and the Boatman — of some size, and navigable for steamers. Boise City is the capital. MONTANA TERRITORY Was organized May 26th, 1864. It lies among the Rocky Mountains, in part on the western slope, but extending into the eastern valleys; and contains the sources of the streams form- ing the Missouri river; while Idaho lies west among the Blue mountains where the tributaries of the Columbia rise. Montana abounds in mines of gold and silver; and these are said to be much richer than those of California. The average ALASKA TERRITORY. ■ , - yield of ores in the latter State is $20 per ton, but the average in Montana is stated to be four times that amount. Great ai is the yield of gold mines here it is declared that the ith which silver is separated from its combinations in the on- will make that branch of mining more profitable. Copper also abounds. This territory has several eminent advantages over other mining districts. It is reached by steamboats on the Missouri river, from St. Louis, without transhipment: naviga- tion being free to Ft. Benton, in the heart of Montana. The river voyage from St. Louis to Ft. Benton, is made in 86 days. There is a large and constant supply of water, a point of great difficulty in most of the other mining regions; and the country everywhere furnishes easy natural roads, the principal range of the Rocky Mountains not presenting the brokm and rugged character of most other ranges. Associated with this point is the important fact of great agricultural capability. It is one of the best grazing regions west of the Mississippi Small grain and fruit are grown with the greatest ease, as also the more important vegetables. There is abundance of tim!>er for all purposes of home consumption. The area is stated at 153,800 square miles. The population in 1870 was 20,594. ALASKA TERRITORY Was acquired to the United States by treaty with Russia in the year 1867, for $7,200,000. It is a vast region containing 394,000 square miles, with 24,000 inhabitants. It was first explored by command of Peter the Great of Russiain 1728. A government was first established on Kodiak island in 1790. In 1799 the Russian American fur company was chartered by the Emperor Paul. The northern portion is a tolerably compact body of mainly level country about 600 miles square, and a lineof OOSSt runs south for a long distance, including many islands. The Aleu- tian group of islands is included. The principal value of region to Russia was the fur trade. The annual export o( these 548 WYOMING TERRITORY. amounted to only a few hundred thousand dollars. American thrift will probably make much more of it. The country is much warmer than its high latitude would seem to imply — Sitka in the southern part having about the same mean temperature, by the thermometer, as Washington! It is, however, extremely damp. In one year there were counted only 66 entire days without rain or snow. The coast is broken with mountains. The peninsula of Alaska has some very high mountains — Mt. St. Elias and Mt. Fairweather being esti- mated at 15,000 to 18,000 feet above the sea. The islands of the Aleutian group are volcanic in origin. There are several rivers, the largest, the Yukon, or Kwickpak being 2,000 miles long, and navigable for 1,500 miles. There are vast supplies of timber, much being pine, found nowhere else on the Pacific coast. Vegetables, and some grains, may be raised without difficulty, and the soil, in parts, is rich. Abundant supplies of coal are believed to exist. The precious metals and iron, it is thought, are to be found there, but the country has been very imperfectly explored. In the lively and extensive trade that is likely to grow up with Japan, China, and the East Indies, it will no doubt be found of great value, and its resources contribute to the wealth of our country. WYOMING TERRITORY Was organized by act of Congress July 25th, 1868, and is the youngest of the territories. Its area is stated at 100,500 square miles, and it had a population, in 1870, of 9,118. The Pacific railroad passes through it, to which its settle- ment is probably mainly due. Montana lies on the north; Dacotah and Nebraska on the east; Colorado and Utah on the south, with the northern part of Utah and Idaho on the west. The main chain of the Rocky Mountains crosses it from northwest to southeast which maintain here the same general characteristic as in Montana, viz.: that of a rolling upland. Its outlying ranges are more broken. Most of the country is DISTRICT oi i 'N POLICY. citizens, and giving them covert support in withdrawn • territory from its proper owners, we took | when they naturally undertook to protect, or n made a war of invasion on them, employed our superior -kill and vigor to disarm their State, and took as much moreoftl territory as suited our purposes; in Bhort, thaj we picked a quarrel, and being the strongest bound and robbed them. 6. It cannot be agreeable to lovers of justice and defenders of equal rights, that there should be so much of truth in :■ statement as to render it impossible to clearly and distinctly prove the contrary. There was, however, an element of the necessary and unavoidable, even in this, that was i •-• in I monv with the previous system of acquisition than appeared on the surface. Texas presented, perhaps, the finest clim and the greatest facilities for money-making on the contim The Mexicans inherited the religion and hatred of protestants with the haughty, repelling spirit of the Spaniards, and wis to preserve the old Spanish policy of separating then from us by a broad barrier of desert and wilderness. They did not wish to settle Texas themselves, nor feel willing that any one else should. It is inevitable that enterprise and strength, impelled by self-interest, will disregard such wishes. A.mi cans are neither perfect nor magnanimous enough to Btand on ceremony when their interests are concerned. The best that can be said of them is that they are more moderate and - contained than any other people. Tin- necessities of the in tution of slavery required more territory t<> balance th< increase of free States, and this precipitated the movi that was inevitable sooner or later from other causes, [i the first patent of territory obtained in Texas, from the ki< can government, was by a native of Connecticut I • growth of commerce in the Pacific ocean, the agreeable din and fertile soil of California, and the unsettled, wilden of that region, caused the commercial nations of I look at it with longing eyes. The Monr in danger of being violated. England had fully pre] 554: ANNEXATION POLICY. a colony there when it was taken possession of by the Ameri- can forces. 7. Thus the enterprise and energy of the nation, which had still further developed its instinct, or anticipations and plans, of future greatness, required to use the vast resources of the Gulf region, and to extend settlements to the Pacific Slope in order to develop the mineral resources of that region and pre- pare to build up its commerce with Eastern Asia. The north- ern parts of Mexico were useless to her, since she had neither population to occupy them, nor strength to subdue the Indians who roamed over them in scattered bands. There is a justice and propriety which has the force of Natural Law in allowing the active and vigorous to take possession of the natural resources that others can not or will not develop. The earth was made for mankind as a whole, and what cannot benefit one race, another, that is able to employ it for its own and the general good, has some show of right in entering upon. That, at least, must be the justification of our ancestors in intruding themselves upon the lands and hunting grounds of the aborigi- nal inhabitants of America, and our only excuse for making war with the Indians, forcing them to part with their lands, confining them to reservations, and denying to King Philip, Powhattan, and Tecumseh the admiration and esteem we give to the patriotic defenders of our native land and natural rights. 8. It is to be regretted that the vast and valuable territory acquired from Mexico should be the spoil of conquest rather than the fruit of peaceful negotiation; but the eagerness of the speculator, the unreasonable pride and selfishness of the Mexi- can, and the peculiar requirements of our internal conflict over slavery put to silence, for a time, the voice of moderation and equity, and we annexed near 1,000,000 square miles of territory by force. The payment of $18,500,000, when we might have taken it without, was an indication that our ordinary sense of ' justice was not altogether quenched. 9. We may reasonably consider that this was exceptional, and that the confusion of judgment and the disorder consequent on the life and death struggle of the institution of slavery, ANNEXATION POLICY. which were in a few years to produce the moet terrible drfl war known to history, led us into the comparatively an aggression and violence that marked this annexation to our territorial area. Our traditional policy lb to acquire : and with a satisfactory remuneration, Buch territory national progress and development demand. It i.- oontrar] the spirit of our institutions to oblige the majority • inhabitants of any region not within our boundaries to fori part of the Republic. 10. Two annexations have been made since the V. war. Arizona was obtained by treaty and pnrcha " ico, in 1854, and Alaska by treaty and purchase from R in 1867. The first is valuable for its mineral treasures. It was useless to Mexico, though we gave $10,000,000 for it. It will ultimately be worth to us hundreds of millions, and ruins of an ancient people will be replaced by a thriving popu- lation of intelligent freemen. Alaska is specially valuable in relation to our future commerce with Asia, and for its fiahei and fur trade. Its internal resources are, as yet, scarcely known. 11. The superior stability of American institutions the love of law and order of the American people may m annexation desirable and profitable to the more volatile unsteady Southern States of America, but it is probable that no labored efforts to induce annexation will be tolerated by the mass of the people. We may fairly judge that we ha our natural boundaries; that the advancement of ne g governments in order and intelligence will Buffice to tection to the comparatively small numbers who , better field for their energies without than within the I i and that if any future annexation- are made it will purchase of uninhabited regions that may be more vain us than to their owners; or that, if any inhabited n incorporated into the Onion, it will be at the desire of its own inhabitants rather than of our are the special champions of popular and all ol shall never be likely to forget ourselves again ^ tar ,, the Mexican war, however pressing our d< CHAPTER LXXI. CENSUS STATISTICS. OJ"Cf coo m i-c COn — n I X CO • 55 in • E-£- i iOO ISO . 35 —. .00 ; 'o ■ «-i ' in CO il- ■ ojco ix oj CO i CO lO i 3j to i n ij" 01 ' CO n ■ -TXX ir.(- i ift PS i ion lofoo' lofoo lOi-X ,£-i-i o 00 o 0. 05 •t-H t- -t-J •n S-, s- h CC en -n c ID o ■►-> a o & 3D O 5X •X s SS5IS • o> — E- inir. ■ oi n -cr oocsoaoos a 31 n OJ -cr O.E- CO : ■icfo't- «cTl>*0 : 35 x co co oj x o c liClflr-r-MOHSiHCO CO — Q E- O CO CO O in C- — £- CO 3iJjjot-i'oo»;iOi-S Of CO - ■* lO Tt O 5 * GO COCOn t n -* 00 E- i !cc-TOjo»»3cococoinoj ^o»_co 5.oj c o n r-<55 3 '<^Yox'xE-n sfofn of • o m o oj oo co --■ e- oc oo — 35nnn £- 1" to OJ JgS"iff -fnof -■ - H E r, J X C C CC - 3 o oj sc 35 co 5S.io.3a5 co i-t Sn i- x e- e- o -t m m n oj in 3c co oj -cr o « l- 5i t- S 5) V O n o -cr e- co in co * Q l.O 35 -3" n OJ X l SS^FSs i-i WtfJSf c -cr' m' of©" of o't- > co co e- eg n rr m ■ i-i t- 95 -r int- xx o of**? w w 11 h O 2> CO lO ofocfoff t- oo o> CO 1 OHG$ooHSa SS :nt-riOW SSI ?* tH t-« 8 00 co e- £- oj cm o m OJ 35 35 33 CO n X co oo in t- in- n CO CC 05 CO 35 £- 35 CO 35 in -1" co ~. x 2 00 £ ' "-H TJC X co m co oj m m c cc^-5 is X •h m 35 OJ O! 3) O -1" £' CO 0J X X O i- 35 n 11 O m'£- 1" 13 1" CO 11 in CO 35 O 35 in 1 co oj co E in co I ii^o^fi* eo^i-i t- ' it'of x'£- CO X - " ■ co m 35 o oj ' on -i" in X£- 1" £- -rr in OJ CO n 35 in 0J OJ n 0J 35 O -TnX_0J f-in-in Oi--r co OOlc-t-; i - co' of of 3X O OJ -T 1" 33 35 -1" 0J £>ii in in 8S o X S2 q co co oj : CO X ' -T 01 1 1 n CO in CO Q OJ ■ in in i- in ci £- ! CO coor'oof-cf 1 Ci £- OJ X £- ^« CJCOI" oj m in -r CO 00 3100100 CO lO -T CO CO co in co in £— rfiooTLOo' r-i -cr in in co 0! 0J 35 lO N -1 n m £- 35 CO — 0) CO O i- r £- O'i-Oi n £- n CO x -a-oj E--1" 11 £- OJ35 0J CO O E- 0I_0J^ ol 3 t m 1 35 -i" in 1 in 1 — • x -T • cc» 1 £-c_in oi !o* Inn CO '1 >S2Sl S : X ; CD ! oj 35 co co m CO -T O O CO £-35£-n CO co— -'co'x'in X ■— X £- -a> n OJ in if -1 0J 11 OJ CO OJ 35 O CO n in CO of 35' o in O coir o CO 'SS s. o 35 Q w ij H w 02 H K « a H en 11 co -1" 35 nO ?1 ; «-«! as if- 1OXX ■ t- • -* 01 n ;0 ;in£-£- 1 CO 1 CO 35 00 1 £- 1J11I- COCO go s5 5 -- Sit-c/iiii5iirr: fig =3 n cjS.- a o 3 ^ .° *> A? « 1^ c: ti HJOiO n X T 35 n n CO CO fer5C 1 CO ! > CO O CO n i-n £-35 C0.np.£> -r of of in CO CO -T CO -1" OJ cox "? CO j * - n C5 C5 o O «n O .g^lllll^lll •* l-CC B 21— n 5« li+i 1 C o o— c» » ca c o o* S 3 PM,=5 co u a s 3—; cv>— cj. > 1 2 3 — s- cl ' d cs o a a " , 0) ■ CO ■ el O. C-^! J a D S.2 o " X » (3 CO U ^.ivSS > -c > o . 2 1*1 • v -"l 1 _ i. CJ cc! ca O to 5 s ^^oyaEos-Snini^niSSSSisss^fi^^^Kcon^ (556) CC '3 "Sed 3 =»iC 2 =■5^5 t'KNsrs si Alls i i< s. 1870 9,658 39,706 14,181 14,998 20,59-4 91,852 86,786 23,901 9,118 131,706 1 Si? aooo >Q C c. •.£ . 7. OSH ■ © 5? c* ih ,' i{3 at tt T-i ; i- s 00 it- IS o 1 QO l-H :3 ""■*-. lo; 8 00 t-l 1 « o is I s ,-1 00 w 2 o H 2 « t -1 c c s T < 1 J- 1 J e I s C J c c - T 7- — C ■*- Si f $ o o o -S * .2 g §§ s i i ° g - - - - « p 2 'C _ — ■ B ! a P R<3 o -c »5 to C o 3 <3 C *a if •" S = a -- S - - - o S3 i £ a GO o ? •- — '- B P a a a 12 s § o t) £ ft o — i-r », *> o o M = fi o B f | : 5 00 «•=■ - 09 S3 e> w — re Tt id i- r- 7 ga - - oo o; oo "-,o — x in — _— n c' o — r x as =•'—'(- x' — ci c o H. o o- t- R g C ~ OS . - = O if £ a o n is - • c p _• a a : - o !: s s sj a iz ; 1 A 3 i -i i : / E ■s •« - - - "5 w 3 (t — c ; I S e s — ^ j= o •p c £ - ::«= = - - ; - = ■ a, •- c — ■z -. a -z 3 -- a •a ? - c a z 1~ ft 2 - — ■_ i - . o £ — •- i - p •5 1 =-s2S e iJ 2 E — - ^ ."; ■- c S ja u g •c — — j. ~ ? - - t - • ' — = a ■7 S55s< >■ a a — a °" • •-co B £ 3 tO 3 c a i - - E 1 ► 1 5 •- — - .~ — 2 ~ r — ~ -* > ■ ■ - ■ = M . ■ ft = 3 = _ = » -r > z - I o a c ■fl* = — i — — 5 - _ : ■ a 5 . PART THIRD. THE PEOPLE AND THE GOVERNMENT 1. All government is professedly for the good of the people; but in point of fact, nearly every government that baa ever been instituted has been in the interest of an individual, a family, or a class. American statesmen, in forming our g ernment, admitted the superior rights of no man or class <>f' men. It was carefully organized to exclude all claims or p tenses of that kind, with a single exception, at lir>t, which afterward disappeared in the tempest of a civil war. Ti cutive, the various members of the government, and the law makers depend on the people for their elevation. At tir.-t they possessed only the dignity, privileges, and rights of the people at large, and, their term of office expired, they return to same level, honored, indeed, if they have been faithful Bervai if not, carrying to their dishonored graves the repro md contempt of their fellow-citizens, hut retaining, in neithi a vestige of the power and exultation over others t thed them when in office, the contrary of which BO often DM unworthy man respectable in a different form of governmenl 2. That the masses of the people would be able to ■ a true sovereignty without abusing it wae always doubted the trial was made in this country. A very res] of statesmen in the early day, of the Republic, sympi I >n (559) 560 THE PEOPLE AND THE GOVERNMENT. this doubt, and it even crept into the Constitution in the form of electors who were to choose the President; intimating a dis- trust of the wisdom and sound discretion of the voters in the choice of the Chief Magistrate. The liberty allowed to the Legislatures of the States to determine the manner in which electors should be chosen, while it recognized State authority on one side, on the other implied a hesitation to trust so important a matter directly to the people; and for a long time they were only indirectly consulted as to the choice of a President. 3. It was not, however, caused by a desire to keep power from them, but rather to avoid the unhappy effect of popular heat and rashness, so often observed in popular governments before attempted. This distrustful party first took control of the government, retained it during three presidential terms, and for many years afterwards formed an influential minority whose criticisms were of importance in establishing a traditional policy for the government. This party — the Federalists, headed by Washington and Hamilton — sought to found a strong and stable government that should be able to fully protect the country from foreign interference and domestic discord. Their control over the administration was somewhat abruptly closed by acts considered arbitrary, interfering with full freedom of speech and of the press — the " Sedition Laws " as they were called. Jefferson and the Kepublican party demanded the largest popular freedom, and had the conduct of the govern- ment for twenty-four years, impressing on its habits and policy the respect for the opinions of the people at large that has ever since characterized it. The people gradually gained control of presidential elections and practically set the electors aside, making and enforcing their own choice in general elections. 4. The exercise of popular sovereignty has gradually been enlarged, no qualification but that of age and nativity being now generally required, and the government may fairly be con- sidered to represent the views of a majority of the people, and not only of the native, but also of the foreign born; since the THE PEOPLE AND THE UOVKkNMKNT. great mass of the latter are, by naturalization, absorbed Into the mass of citizens. They come to make a permanenl hi with us, from a preference, as it is fair to assume, for republi- can institutions; and it is considered right that they Bhi have a voice in the conduct of them. Nor have the Ami rican people seen cause to regret their liberality in this n Citizens of foreign birth have usually proved as thoughtful and wise as the rest of the population, and as worths of citi- zenship. They bring to us wealth in their labor if not m tin ir purses, and soon become thoroughly American in their habits and sympathies. The government and the people cordially welcome them, and mid themselves the Btronger and richer by so doing. 5. It must not be forgotten that tin- strongest fears of pop- ular influence on the government, the stability of our institu- tions, and the maintenance of the good order necessary to the security of property and the general prosperity, were ent tained at the first; that the prophecies of the foreseen of evil have been almost uniformly false during its whole course; and that the relation between the people and the general govern- ment has constantly grown closer, to the great advantage of both. The first war into which the country was plunged a the Eevolution — that of 1812 — was comparatively n failure-, in its earlier part, for want of this mutual confidence, hater i people and the government have been more closely allied, and the government has been strong while the people have - their cherished ends gained. There has been continual advance in liberality of admini (ion, in etiiciency of organization, and in the corapletei social order. We have no reason to BUppose that a tend continued through a hundred years and favored l>. circumstances that are common to all nations in "in- to a degree never before known, will be changed. R ' may confidently expect that with increased intelligi rience, and prosperity that tendency will be Btr< Dgthened 3b' CHAPTEE I. SUFFRAGE AND CITIZENSHIP. 1. The right pertaining to citizenship, to vote for such officers as are elected by the people, is called suffrage. "When that right is acquired with respect to one class of officers it always extends to the whole, from petty town or city officials, to high officers of the State and United States government — all. in short, who obtain office directly from the people. 2. The Constitution defines who shall be regarded as citi- zens of the United States, and all such are declared by it to be aUo citizens of the State in which they reside. It declares " all persons, born, or naturalized in the United States, and subject to its jurisdiction " to be citizens. Indian tribes are mostly regarded as foreign nations, and have such rights as treaties give them, but are not taxed and do not vote; there- fore they are not regarded as citizens. 3. Yet suffrage does not belong to all citizens. The special regulation of the voting prerogative was not assumed by the ( !< institution, nor delegated to Congress, and it is generally conceded that it belongs to the State governments. The regu- lations in the States are not uniform, but in no State do women or minors vote. This cuts off a large part of the citizens, nearly three-fourths belonging to these classes. Minors are supposed, however, to be represented, as to their interests, by their guardians, and females by husbands or brothers. Some of the States make minor restrictions as to length of residence in the State, and require a certain amount of property to con- stitute a voter, and in some naturalization is not required — so that the range of the right of suffrage varies within small o o o limits, in different States. Whatever rule is adopted by the States has been accepted as the basis of suffrage for that State by the general government, when members of Congress and President and Vice-President are voted for. ■i. It seems to be a loose point in the regulations, otherwise so admirable, since it may work a considerable inequality (562) SUFFKAGE AND CIT I Z t N ~ 1 1 11 . under given circumstance.-; and. in Borne _-ht chai the policy of the government. It La a question worthy sideration whether there should not be an amendment to the Constitution establishing uniformity of auffrage in all the States. This point has caused much discussion in th< governments and various changes have i n, from tim< time, made in many of them. These haw been, usually, in the direction of liberality — tending to enlarge the scow suffrage. The property qualification, quite < imon in earlier times, is now rare. The fifteenth amendment, recently adopted, has largely increased the number of voti 5. The experience of the Republic, thus far, 1. a in favor of the doctrine that it is Bafe to trust the people with their own interests, and that the responsibilities of self-g eminent, when they are laid on them under the fa circumstances that exist among us, tend to improven instead of disorganization. Whether this will always be case it may not be safe to assume, and a prudent regard to ] sibilities should not be neglected; but we should not !■• that those who founded American liberty ran great ri>k anarchy in the eyes of their contemporaries. We ought to able safely to continue a policy of Buffrage which they int duced with results so fortunate. 6. Education needs to be encouraged, and this has alwi received much attention. It lb probable that but for th< liberal provision made in this respect, the fate of our g ment would have been very different ftianj had no early education, have been naturalized, and tl people born in the country have been made citizens. It remainder of the people had not been intelligent, it would doubt have been extremely dangerous. It has led to serious local interruptions of order and prosperity, bot have been, so far, tern pprary; and the general effect I to awaken ambition for education: the children < citizens have enjoyed the Bame facilitii intelligence necessary to a citizen; and the I Ot)i OCR CITIZENS OF FOREIGN BIRTH. when extended to the ignorant and degraded has seemed to pro. dace the general effect of destroying a dangerous class by raising them gradually to intelligence and self-respect and respect for the laws, by making them the political equals of those who are socially and intellectually far above them. 7. As we grow in numbers all influences like this take a wider range, and acquire more power, and sometimes produce different results, when they become extensive, from what waa the case when more limited, from the difference of influence in modifying causes; and there has always been fear of trouble from the extension of suffrage to too many ignorant persons. It is well to be cautious; but we ought to venture as far as possible for the sake of improving and elevating all classes of our people. 8. It is also a question worthy of attention if women who own property that is taxed ought not to possess the right of suffrage. The war that made us a Nation was begun because we refused to be taxed unless we could be represented, and have a vote in the body laying the taxes. The principle appears to be precisely the same; and what we fought for then should not be denied now. CHAPTER II. OUR CITIZENS OF FOREIGN BIRTH. Whatever fault we may sometimes find with the conduct of our government; however much self-seeking to the neglect of the public good there may be among officials; however many weaknesses, errors, and violations of law may call for our severest reprobation, and, in moments of depression, lead us to look gloomily and doubtfully toward the future; yet it is not to be denied that the Home of real Freedom is with us. Mis- management is but temporary, or limited, and easily admits of remedy, with time and care; our advantages are permanent and oue cmzKNH or •. iuktii. extensive. In eighty years the population has become nearly twelve times as numerous as at the beginning of thai pi riod, and this rapid growth in numbers has been matte ap largely from the disposition of foreigners to make a permanent home among us. Those who are oppressed, who suffer restraint in their interests or belief, or wish for a wider career for them- selves or their families — who want a five field for basil enterprise, for mental and moral development, or lull play for their abilities to influence their fellow men, come t<> us. 11. re they find fair opportunity for what may be lacking elsewhere They come here by millions; the poor, by industry, become rich; the oppressed leave persecutim^ and galling burd behind them ; and genius finds full play tor its aspirations in whatever direction its energies may In- turned. At the time of the last Census there wen- f>. .".f.f,.". If. j in the Union, and forming part of our population, of I birth. A large part of these have become citizens by Natural- ization. The remainder, or their descendants, if they remain here, will become citizens by that process, or by lapse of time. After they have become familiar with our institution, id and habits, they are incorporated with the bodj of our citizens and are a part of the Nation. The naturalized citizen may become, in time, a State officer, or member of Congress, ii can make himself acceptable to his fellow citizens ; or he i possibly live to see his son President of the CTnited Stab Congress alone has power, under the Constitution, I naturalization laws. Suffrage, or the right of voting, is lef the regulation of the States, within certain limits ; bn! ev< citizen, made such by law of the General Government, a citizen of the State in which he resides, and will aoqn within such times as State regulations shall determine, tin to vote. State laws regarding suffrage vary. Some Si aliens who are not citizens of the United Stab to tfa of sunrage and to other privileges; and most n zen to reside a prescribed length of time in the S- be 566 HOW TO BECOME A CITIZEN. .' can vote. A uniform regulation in all the States would be desirable. HOW TO BECOME A CITIZEN. Any alien, having arrived in the United States after the age of eighteen years, may be admitted to the rights of citizenship, after a declaration, upon his part, or oath or affirmation, before the Supreme, Superior, District, or Circuit Court of, or any court of record having common law jurisdiction in, an}'- of the United States, or of the territories thereto belonging, or before a Circuit or District Court of the United States, or the Clerk or Prothonotary of any of the aforesaid courts, two years at least before his admission, that it is his bona fide intention to become a citizen of the United States, and to renounce forever all allegiance and fidelity to any foreign prince, potentate, State or sovereignty whatever, and particularly by name, the prince, potentate, State, or sovereignty, whereof such alien may at any time have been a citizen or subject; if such alien has borne any hereditary title, or been of any of the orders of nobility in the kingdom or State from which he came, he must, moreover,, expressly renounce his title or order of nobility, in the court in which his application is made, which renunciation is to be recorded in such county; and the court admitting such alien must also be satisfied that he has continuously resided in the United States for five years, at least, immediately preceding his naturalization, and also within the State or Territory wherein such court is at the time held, at least one year immediately previous to such naturalization; and that during such five years he has been of good moral character, attached to the principles of the Constitution of the United States, and well disposed to the good order and happiness of the same ; the oath of at least two citizens of the United States is requisite to prove the fact "( such residence ; and, at the time of his application to be admitted to citizenship, he must make, upon oath or affirma- tion, the same declaration of renunciation and abjuration of allegiance to any foreign power, and also make oath or affirma- tion to support the Constitution of the United States ; all of ELECTIi which proceedings are to be recorded by the Clerk 01 otarv of the proper court. If any alien, having legally Sled his declaration of intenl to become a citizen and taken the necessary oath oraffirmati< die before he is actually naturalized, his widow and childi are entitled to all the rights and privileges of citizens, U] taking the required oaths or affirmations. Any alien arriving in the Qnited States under the eighteen years, and continuously residing therein until the time of his application for citizenship, may, after reaching the of twenty-one years, and having been a resident within the United States for five years, including the three jrears of hie minority, be admitted a citizen, without making tin- forma] declaration of intention required in other cases; hut at the ti of his admission he must make such declaration, and furtl satisfy the court, upon oath or affirmation, that, for the tl years immediately preceding, it had been his l>n,,,t u,l, [<■,•■ tion to become such citizen, and in all other respects n comply with the naturalization laws of the United Stab s, Severe penalties for counterfeiting any evidence of citizen- ship, or disposing of a certificate of naturalization to any ; son other than the one for whom it was issued, are imposed by act of Congress. CHAPTER TIT. ELECTIONS. 1. A pure democracy is a government in which all I pie who have the proper qualifications for voting ] dry take part— oi- have the right to do BO— in the dia public measures, and enactment of the laws. Thil ticable unless the State consist of a small number 1 ( and a representative democracy is substituted, in w masses of the people exercise the voting and ruling pr 568 ELECTIONS. tive by appointing a small number of substitutes to act in their place and represent them. This appointment of representa- tives is for the most part the only direct way in which the people of this country are able to take part in the government. Though the theory is that the people alone are sovereign, this is the only way in which sovereignty can exert itself. Even if present in a legislative assembly, they cannot discuss or vote unless they are Representatives, duly elected. 2. Elections, then, are of the highest importance. If a cit- izen would exert his sovereign authority, as one of the deposi- taries of power, he must take part in them. Representatives elected to make laws are expected to express the will of the majority of the people whom they represent. They are pledged, expressly or tacitly, to do so. If they disobey the will of their constituents, there is no immediate redress. They can be dis- placed only at the close of the term for which they were elected. There is some inconvenience and danger attending this method; though the fear of the displeasure of their constituents is usually sufficient to secure faithfulness. Where the people are numerous, (there are now more than 135,000 persons to each representative,) it becomes a matter of much interest to know what is their will. It is ascertained by the elections. The people vote for a candidate, or nominee, known to hold certain political principles. As men do not often see or think alike there is generally more than one principle, or system of views, regarding public measures, involved in every election, and therefore more than one candidate. The result of the vote shows the will of the majority. The same question generally occupies the attention of the whole country, and the elections to Congress determine the policy of the government, so far as legislation is concerned. 3. The same remarks apply to the election of the President and the members of the State governments. The choice of men for the State legislatures determines the policy and politi- cal principles of the State government, and as the majority in State legislatures appoint the Senators, the character of Con- RATIO OK REFRE8EN I \ li grcss and its measures arc influenced bj Stat | choice of the President is not, in theory, made directly, Electors are chosen, who afterwards vote for the P but it is understood that they will vote for a certain man; and it lias been so invariably their custom to do BO, thai tb< result is considered as settled by the direct vote of the people. Should the Electors do otherwise the people would be v< much surprised and displeased, and those Electors would 1. little prospect of appointment to office again. Verj fen I in office are willing to seriously offend their constituents, that practically, the people vote directly for the Pn sidenl and Vice-President they prefer. 4. Of all our elections none is considered of bo much impor tance as the Presidential. These come every four because the Constitution provides that the term for which a President is chosen, shall be four years. Our elections, both for the general and State governments, are by ballot, insto i of viva voce, (the living voice,) as in some countrii 9. The ballot is a small piece of paper, with the Dame of the candidate or candidates printed or written upon it. and then folded in such a manner as to hide them, bo that do one but the voter can tell what names are on his ballot A vote by viva voce, is when the voter, in the presence of the ins] of the election, audibly and clearly calls out the name of tin- candidate for whom he votes, and thus proclaims in the bearing of all present how he votes. But the ballot enables the vi to vote secretly if he chooses to do so. CHAPTER IV. RATIO OF REPRESENTATION 1. The ratio of representation Biroply means ti between the whole population of the United 6 ' whole number of their Representatives in < of course includes the ratio between the po 570 RATIO OF REPRESENTATION. ual State, and the Representatives it is entitled to; both being estimated upon the same basis, and determined by the same rule. 2. The distinctive characteristic of our government is, that it is a popular government. Its power is vested in the people. They elect their rulers, who are the servants of the people, and these rulers are expected to carry out the people's wishes. Upon such a system, it is a matter of the first importance, to distribute this power equally among all the people, and after having fixed upon the ratio between the whole population and the whole number of Representatives; or, in other words, after having determined how many members shall compose the lower House of Congress, the next step is to apportion these members among all the States in the ratio of their population. If one State has twice the nnmber of inhabitants that another has, it will be entitled to twice the number of Representatives in Congress. If one has ten times the inhabitants that another has, it will be entitled to ten times the number of Representa- tives, and so on; with this one exception, which is, that by a provision in the Constitution, every State, without regard to its population, is entitled to one Representative in the lower House. 3. The adjustment of this matter is all provided for in the Constitution, that is, in its general features; but it devolves upon Congress in every tenth year to re-adjust and re-appor- tion the Representatives among the several States, according to the population of each State as shown by the last census, which is taken every tenth year; and when the apportionment is once made, it remains the same for the next ten years, when the census is taken again, and a new apportionment is made. 4. Up to the present time (1874,) this has been done nine times. It was done the first time by the convention which formed the Constitution. That apportionment is found in the Constitution, and is as follows: To New Hampshire, 3 Pennsylvania, 8 Massachusetts, 8 Delaware, 1 RATIO OF BEFRE8ENTATTOK. ;,7 ] Khode Island, 1 Maryland, Connecticut, 5 Virginia, 10 New Yoxk, 6 North Carolina, New Jersey, 4 South Carolina, Georgia, 3 By this it will be seen that the first Congress consist. 'd of but 65 members. The Constitution also provided that Representatives Bhould not exceed one to every 30,000 people. The next year after tin- government went into operation, (1790,) the tii>i census was taken, and as soon as the result was known, a new apportion- ment was made. This was done in 1792, and wa> made opon the ratio of one Representative to every 33,000 of representa- tive* population. 5. In 1800, the second census was taken; and when < '"ti- gress made the apportionment, which was done in 1 B03, it did not change the ratio, but left it atone Representative to everj 33,000 of the representative population. In 1810, the third census was taken, and in lsll the ratio was fixed at one Representative for every 35,000 of the popu- lation. In 1820, the fourth census was taken, and in 1822 ( !ongr< at fixed the ratio at one Representative for every 47j" f the population. In 1830, the fifth census was taken, and in 1832 the rati.. was fixed at one Representative to every 47,<»nn of the popula- tion. In 1840, the sixth census was taken, and in L842 ( long again declared that the ratio should be one Representative t.. every 70,000 of the population. 6. In 1850, the seventh census was taken, and in conform- ity with the law passed this year, the number of memlx * The Representative population includes all free persons, white or b to which (according to the provisions of the OonstitutionXthree-flAhsol the slaves were to be added. But this proviso, now thai sta •'*>!- ished, has become a nullity. 572 RATIO OF REPRESENTATION. for the first time limited; the limit being 233; and the Secre- tary of the Interior was ordered to take the census returns, and divide the whole representative population by the number 233, and to make the quotient the ratio between the Representatives and the people. 7. We have never seen the result of the Secretary's esti- mate, but, taking the population of 1850 and dividing it by 233, would produce a quotient of nearly 94,000 ; and this we take as the ratio, after the time when it was done, 1852; that is, one Representative to every 94,000 of the population. 8. The eighth census was taken in 1860, and on it an appor- tionment was based, which allowed one Representative for every 127,000 of the population. In 1850 Congress adopted the principle of permanently fix- ing the number of members of Congress, to save the trouble of doing it as heretofore, every ten years. An act was passed limiting it to 233; but notwithstanding this limitation, it was provided that if any new State came in, it should have its member, which would add to the number. But this increase was to continue no longer than until the next apportionment, when the number was to fall back again to the old figure. In 1862 the law w r as modified to make the whole number of members consist of 241 after the 3d of March, 1863. In 1870 the ninth census was taken, and in 1872 Congress decided that after March 3d, 1873, the Representatives should comprise 292 members, being one Representative for every 135,239 of the population and apportioned them among the several States aa follows: Alabama, 8 Missouri, 13 Arkansas, 4 Nebraska, 1 California, 4 Nevada, 1 Connecticut, 4 New Hampshire, 3 Delaware, 1 New Jersey, 7 Florida, 2 New York, 33 Georgia, 9 North Carolina, 8 Mississippi, 6 Ohio, 20 RATIO OF REPRESENTATION. Illinois, 19 Oregon, 1 Indiana, 13 Pennsylvania, 27 Iowa, 9 Rhode [aland, 'J Kansas, 3 South Carolina, 5 Kentucky, 10 Tennessee, 10 Louisiana, 6 Texas, 8 Maine, 5 Vermont, 8 Maryland, 6 Virginia, 9 Massachusetts. 11 West Virginia, 8 Michigan, 9 Wisconsin, 8 Minnesota, 3 9. But it must be borne in mind that Congress hai the power to alter all this, and to enact that Congress Bhall consist of any other number of members, although it is not probable that this will be done soon. 10. The foregoing statements will show the general plan upon which the House of Representative is < stituted, and how the several States are constantly changing the Dumber of their Representatives, and their relative power and influence in Congress. This can be readily understood by remembering the fact that new States come into the Onion every few years, and that the population increases much more rapidly in the Wt ern States than in the Eastern, and that, consequently, tl West is rapidly gaining power in Congress, while the Atlantic States are losing it. 11. In the apportionment no regard is had to the Territo- ries or to their population. In this adjustment, the States and their population only are regarded, and the number of mem- bers ^s all given to the States. Every Representative fron Territory is an addition to that number, but it must be remem- bered that a Territorial member has no right to rote on any question, but has only the right to debate; and tor this r he is not, in the fullest sense, a member, and is not counted in adjusting the number of which the House is made to eon. CHAPTER Y. OATHS AND BONDS. 1. An oath is an appeal to God, by him who makes it, that what lie has said, or what he shall saj, is the truth. It is the most solemn form under which one can assert or pronounce anything. To utter a falsehood while under oath is perjury, a crime of the darkest hue. One which God has declared he will punish, and one which is made infamous, and punishable by fine and imprisonment by the laws of the land. 2. The Constitution (Art. 6, Sec. 3) requires that Senators and Representatives, and members of the several State Legis- latures, and all executive and judicial officers, both of the United States, and of the several States, shall be bound by oath or affirmation to support the Constitution. Then in the second article, section eight, the form of the oath required of the President before he enters upon his duties, is given in these words : " I do solemnly swear (or affirm) that I will faithfully exe- cute the office of President of the United States, and will to the best of my ability preserve, protect and defend the Consti- stitution of the United States." 3. This is all the Constitution savs about oaths; but it is enough to show that no man (unless he commit perjurv^ can accept office, either under the United States or any State gov- ernment, unless he in good faith will support the Constitution. But in the laws enacted by Congress, we find that not only official oaths are required; but in a great variety of other cases, men who transact business with the government are required to verify their accounts and statements with an oath. This is particularly the case with those who do business with the cus- tom house; such as merchants, shipowners, and masters of vessels. Many oaths must be put in the form of affidavits; that is, the oath must be written and signed by the deponent, that the statements made may be preserved. 4. The form of official oaths varies according to the nature (574) OATHS A.M. BOND of the duties to be performed by the deponent Theoath n be taken before the officer enters upon his duties. - neglect or refuse to do this, his acta will be illegal, and would make himself liable to punishment. After the late civil war broke out, Congress for the purpo* of preventing those who had voluntarily taken part in rebellion, from holding thereafter any oilier under the govern- ment, passed an act requiring every one before he could accept any office, either in the civil, military, or naval departments, to take an oath in the following form: 5. I, A. B., do solemnly swear (or affirm) thai 1 ha. voluntarily borne arms against the United States, since 1 I been a citizen thereof; that J have voluntarily given no aid, countenance, counsel or encouragement to persons engaged in armed hostility thereto; that I have neither Bought, un- accepted, nor attempted to exerci.-e tin- functions of am whatever, under any authority or pretended authority in b tility to the United States; that I have not yielded a volunl support to any pretended government, authority, power Constitution, within the United State.-, hostile or inim thereto. And I do further swear (or affirm) that to the | my knowledge and ability, I will supp >rl and defend the Con- stitution of the United States, agaiusl all enemies, foreign and domestic; that I will bear true faith and allegianct that I take this obligation freely, without any mental n tion or purpose of evasion, and that 1 will well and faithfully discharge the duties of the office on which 1 am about t.. So help me God." So strong and comprehensive an oath as this was nev< r ':•• required from any officer of the government. It an requirements of the Constitution, and substantial Lends all contained in any other form.- beretofon at once an oath of allegiance, an oath of Buppori stitution, and an oath to discharge faithfully the dnl office taken. This goes by the name of the Ti frequently "The Iron-clad Oath." 576 OATH8 AND BONDS. 6. The object of the test oath was, during the Civil War, to prevent the entrance into any office of a person who might be secretly unfriendly to the government, and use his position to the advantage of its enemies. So comprehensive and minute an oath would allow no chance of mental evasion to a con- scientious person, and would lay the offender under the liability of severe punishment. It is evidently proper to bind all offi- cers of the general and State governments under the strongest and most solemn obligation to a faithful and honest discharge of their duties. 7. Whoever receives an office in the United States, which is connected with the revenue in any way, so that public money passes through his hands, is required to give a bond as secu- rity for such money. These bonds give the government a claim on their property if the money is not accounted for according to the directions of the law. They are signed by one or more persons who must show that they have the means to pay the amount for which they become security. The amount of secu- rity required depends on the sums of money that are to pass through the hands of the official, or which is likely at any time to accumulate in his possession. The government takes all the care it can that there shall be no risk of loss of the public property, and the bond is designed to afford adequate security for all that any officer may have charge of. 8. By this means two important ends are gained. No per- son can get an office who has no friends and no reputation for uprightness sufficient to induce those that know him to risk their own property on his honesty and faithfulness. It was designed to be a sure means for the government of finding out who were to be trusted. If he has not property himself, so that he can secure his bondsmen to their satisfaction, he must have so high a character for integrity that they are willing to risk their money in his hands, or he cannot obtain an office. Security for public funds, and a high degree of personal worth are both expected to be gained by this requirement. On the whole, this works very well indeed, in both respects, GOVERNMENT BOSONS. but there seems no security, that is quite infallible, roguery, unless it be in the extreme care of the people, and their constant watchfulness over all the affairs of the country and all the men who represent them. It is difficult to make a ho so strong that a thief cannot get into it by lore- or stratagem, and rogues who wish to steal from the public funds may band together and help one another to get into office and then di\ ide what spoil they can secure; or nnforseen event.- may bring more money than was properly secured int<> an officer's hands, or those whose duty it is to see that he disburses the funds at the right times may be careless or dishonest. 9. The only sure way is to take care that none but men of proved integrity get into office, and to take all pains toeultn honesty in the community at large. The money losl bj government is probably much less in proportion than in the private business of the country. Great watchfulness ie really exercised, and when such a case occurs it is immediately known through the whole country. Not many men art- willing to run so much risk of punishment and public reprobation. much care, however, cannot be taken to prevent corruption in public life. It destroys the purity and soundness of oharaeti r on which our institutions are founded. A republic cannot exist without a hieh standard of virtue. 10. Every official is required to take an oath, or make a emn affirmation to discharge the duties of his office faithfully. Though we cannot expect to be quite secure against the trick- ery and insincerity of false and corrupt men. yet we 1 reason, on the whole, to congratulate ourselves on the genera] security of public property, and the watchfulness of the people over their servants in places of trust. CHAPTER VI. GOVERNMENT PRISONS. 1. The United States government has always endi continue, as it commenced, to rule with vigor, and to }•'■ * " i 578 PROCLAMATIONS. a wholesome respect for its own authority and the rights of all its citizens, while it has, beyond all other governments, proba- bly, that have ever existed sought to avoid arbitrariness and severity; keeping in mind the principle lying at the founda- tion of its institutions that it exists, not for itself, but for the good of the people. It has assumed that the people generally would not require coercion to submit to its regulations, and has not, therefore, made that ample provision for punishment and intimidation that is usual among governments. In confirmation of this we call attention to the fact that the general government does not own, and has never built, prisons for the confinement of offenders against its laws. Imprison- ment, as the mildest form of punishment, has, indeed, very often been inflicted, more often than any other form of punishment. How does this occur when they own no prisons? The answer is that they use the prisons of the States wherever they will allow it. This arrangement between the general and State governments has been made in nearly if not all the States; the United States paying for the support of their prisoners. 2. But in case any State should refuse to make such an agreement, the United States marshal of any district where a prisoner is to be confined, is authorized to procure some build- ing where the prisoners may be safely confined in the district where they have been tried and convicted, or where they have been arrested and are held for trial. This is a far more economical plan than it would be for the United States to build prisons all over the country, and then to employ keepers of them. It exemplifies the friendly relations existing between the States and the general government. CHAPTER VII. PROCLAMATIONS. 1. A Proclamation is an official notice published by one high in authority, for the purpose of giving reliable and author- PBO0LAMATIO1 itativc information to the people thai something has been d or will soon be done, which is important for them to that tl icy may act, or refrain from acting according information contained in the proclamation. These proclai tions arc made known to the country through the most exten- sive channels of information that can be used for conveying intelligence to everybody in the Republic In oar day, and in our country, the newspapers arc the best means that oai used for this purpose. But in ancient times, and before the art of printing was known, swift riders or runners were d patched to every part of the kingdom or country over which the proclamation was to be made known. These n carried it with them, and proclaimed it in the ears of all tin- people. 2. These documents are official acts brought before the people in due form and solemnity. Sometimes they are only recommendations; at others they have all the force of organic law, or the acts of Congress. It has, for some years, been the custom of the Executive to designate some dav toward the close of the year as i of thanksgiving, recommending the dav to be observed in i religious manner. Important changes in the commercial affairs between us and some foreign country are made known by the same method. 3. A memorable proclamation was mad.- by President Lincoln, in 1862, by which he made known to the country, and especially to the Southern States, that if they continued tl war against the United States for one hundred daysafl issuance, lie would then, in virtue of his authority «n- mander-in-chief of the army and navy, liberate the all the seceded States. At the expiration of the time. wi. was on the first of January. L868, be issued another pro tion, in and by which he did emancipate all theslavi State which had warred against the United 91 The blockading of our ports at thecommea civil *war, and the imposition of an embargo upon 001 580 COMMISSIONERS. ping, previous to the last war with. England, were both subjects which brought out proclamations from the President who then filled the Executive chair. 4. The above examples show the character of the cases which cause proclamations to be issued. In some instances they have the authority of law; in others they are merely recommenda- tions; and in others only communicate important intelligence in regard to our public affairs at home or abroad. CHAPTEE VIII. COMMISSIONERS. 1. As it is one purpose of this work to give a clear and complete account of the mode of conducting the affairs of the general government, we have thought it best to call attention to the class of officers named at the head of this chapter; and especially since persons acting under this title are assigned to a variety of duties, sometimes permanent and sometimes temporary. In the first place, they act as heads of bureaus in the various departments. These commissioners are permanent officials of the government, established and provided for by law; such are the commissioners of the land office, patent office, pension office, &c. 2. Another class of commissioners can hardly be considered officers, but rather temporary or special agents. In the multi- farious duties devolving upon Congress, the President, and all the departments, it not unfrequently happens that it is imprac- ticable for them to do certain things necessary to be done. The business to be transacted may be at a great distance from the capital, even in a foreign country. In these cases com- missioners are appointed to do such business. They have been appointed to negotiate a peace, to make treaties of various kinds between us and other powers, and to negotiate with the Indians for the purchase of their lands. The United States courts appoint them to take bail, or to take testimony to be OFFICIAL REGISTER. used on trials, and do various other things necessary in tri and proceedings before them. 3. Congress frequently appoints commissioners to obi information, or to investigate some matter on which tl expect to legislate. In all cases they must report their pro- ceedings, either to Congress, to the President, or to the head of the department under whose instruction they act Peri nent commissioners report once a year, or oftener if required, that Congress may know the condition of affairs in their respective bureaus. Special commissioners, after they 1 i performed the work assigned, make their report; after which their duties cease, and their commission cornea to an end. 4. The lowest grade of diplomatic agents are called com missioners. We are thus represented at the present time in the Republics of Hayti and Liberia. 5. By recent acts of Congress, the powers of commission- ers in some cases have been enlarged. They now i xamine persons charged with crimes against the laws of the 1 n States; hold them to bail, discharge them, or commit then prison; and do other magisterial acts, preliminary to the trial of the accused. When acting in such cases, they arc clothed with some of the powers of a court. CHAPTER TX OFFICIAL REGISTER 1. Congress, in 1816, passed an act authorizing and rehir- ing the Secretary of State, once in two years, to print and publish a book called "the official register," in which he l ordered to register the name of every officer and agent ot the government, in the civil, military and naval depart! including cadets and midshipmen, together with I mpe sation received by each; the names of the Stafc where born; and the name of the place when em] whether at home or abroad. 582 THE STARS AND STRIPES. To the list of persons employed in the Navy Department, the Secretary of the Navy is required to subjoin the names, force and condition of all the ships and vessels belonging to the United States, and when and where built. This work has been published and distributed, as the law directs, ever since the passage of the act, and is sometimes denominated " the blue book." It is a very convenient and useful publication, as it shows in compact form the whole offi- cial force of the government in each department, together with the cost of maintaining it. As it contains only names and dates and facts relating to persons, comparatively few would take the pains to read it, and but a small number is published. It can be found in the Congressional library at Washington, where twenty-five copies of each edition are deposited. CHAPTER X. THE STARS AND STRIPES. A nation's Flag represents its sovereignty. It i6 adopted by its supreme authority as a symbol or sign of itself, and wherever it waves the fact of the substantial control of that authority, at that point, is thereby asserted. If there is a struggle between two powers for control, the presence of the flag proves that the authority it represents still maintains itself, and its subjugation is declared by lowering its flag and by the substitution of another in its place. The flag is, therefore, an expression to the eye of the condi- tion of things; and attracts the sympathies and antipathies, the joys and sorrows, the hopes and fears of those interested in the sovereignty it represents. It is the rallying point of sen- timent and of energy. The affection and reverence bestowed on our country will light up into a patriotic flame at sight of its flag. It is associated with all the heroic deeds and achiev- ments that adorn our national history, and with the loss of all THE STARS LND BTRIP] those we honored and Loved who followed and foughl for gave their lives in its defense. ( >ur -Star Spangled Ba lias been a thousand times baptized in blood dearer to oe 'nan our own, and the sight of it recalls all these sacrifice fully made to establish or to preserve our institutions, I • ■ flag of the United States may well call forth more enthusiastic affection, pride, and hope than any other in the world; I'm- it symbolizes not only home, country, and associations dear to Americans, but the justice, liberty, and righl of Belf govern- ment that are dear to all mankind. Humanity at larse has a deep interest in it. Its history is this: Soon after the Declaration of ^depend- ence the Continental Congress appointed a committ .n fer with Gen. Washington and "design a suitable flag for the nation." After the painful and depressing defeat on Long Island, the retreat through the Jerseys and across the Dela- ware, when everything seemed lost for the new government, Washington suddenly struck the vigorous blows a! Trenton and Princeton that confounded the enemy and drove him hack to Staten Island. Congress and the country were cheered with a hope and a resolution that never afterwards failed them: for in the next campaign occurred the capture of Burgoyne, tal- lowed by the treaty with France; and the close of th>- war in our favor was henceforth only a question of time. In the month of Mayor early June, 1 777. following t gering blow Washington had given the British army in .' sey, the committee referred to above, and Washington, pleted the design for a flag. This was accomplished and the first flag made at the house of a Mrs. Ross, In AjcL Bt,P delphia. The house is still standing No. 239 B shop where she followed the " upholder" trad., as it ws called — the same as our upholstering. One day the Oom- mander-in-chief, Hon. Geo. Boss, a relativeof hers, and o rtain members of Congress, called on her. with a design foi thirteen red and white stripes, alternate with thi pointed stars— and requested her t<> make the Hag. S 584 THE STAKS AKD STEIPE8. sented but suggested that the stars would be more symmetrical and more pleasing to the eje if made with five points, and folded a sheet of paper and produced the pattern by a single cut. This was approved and she finished a flag the next day. Mrs. Ross was given the position of manufacturer of flags for the government, which descended to her children. This was the flag that led our armies to victory during the remainder of the war, waved over the crestfallen soldiers of Burgoyne and Cornwallis, and at the mast head of John Paul Jones on the English coast. In 1794 this flag was changed, though its chief features were retained. Congress then ordered that the flag should consist of fifteen stripes, alternate red and white, and fifteen stars, white on a blue field. There were then fifteen States. The stars and stripes were equal, and a stripe and a star were added with the advent of each new State. This was changed in 1818, as the States increased and the flag threatened to become too large, by reducing the stripes to thir- teen, representing the original Union, and the stars were made equal to the number of States. No change has since been made except to add a star whenever the union increased by the admission of a State. " The Star Spangled Banner," a stirring patriotic song which is to Americans what the " Marseillaise " is to the French, was composed by the author during the cannonade of Fort Mcllenry, near Baltimore, by the British fleet co-operating with an army which was to attack it, simultaneously with the fall of the fort, by land, Sept. 13th, 1814. The poet had gone on board the fleet under a flag of truce before the attack began, to negotiate about some prisoners, and was obliged to remain until the next day, the cannonade continuing during the night. If the fort surrendered Baltimore would be taken; and the fate of Washington, pillaged and burned .a few days before, filled the people with the anxiety which is expressed by the poet, to know if the flag still waved in the morning " over the Land of the Free and the Home of the Brave." The joy of all America may be conceived when Admiral Cockrane drew off his fleet GKKAT SEAL OF T1IK UNITED BTA1 and took the British army on board, while thi md Stripes" continued to float gaily on tin- b McHenry. CH APT Eli XI. THE GREAT SEAL OF THE UNITED BTA1 1. The use of seals to give authority to documents, establish their genuineness, comes down to as from :i ren antiquity. It is much easier to counterfeit a Bignatnn than the impression of a seal, and when both occur on a docu- ment it is considered fairly safe to 1"' relied on ae authority. They are usually emblematic of some event, or sentiment attaching to the history or prevailing tendency and a country. They are used on documents or pap led by the government. Some of the Departments hav< for their own use, in cases where the signature of the P dent is not required. If it is not affixed to the proper pa] they fail to become legal and have ao authority. 2. The usual mode of affixing the seal formerly was by placing melted wax on the paper and pressing the seal on it giving a fac simile or perfect representation of it. A required time and business increased with the growth of the country, Congress passed an act making it lawful to affix the seal by making the impression directly on paper. The custody of the Great Seal is with the v whose duty it is to affix it to all civil commi officers of the United States appointed by t! Senate, or by the President alone. But it is forbid affixed before the President has Bigned it. Tl without the signature has no value. It is as- genuineness of the President's signature. 3. The Secretary of State and all tl great departments, each have a seal of office which il ifl 586 GREAT SEAL OF THE HOTTED STATES. commissions, and to other instruments emanating from their respective offices. Several of the most important bureaus are required by law to have seals of office; for example, the Land Office and the Patent Office. When the United States gives a patent (title) to land, it must be sealed by the Land Office seal. A patent right must be issued under the seal of the Patent Office. 4. One of the most common and important uses of seals arises from the necessity people are often under to have copies of records, maps, and various other papers, the originals of which are in some of the departments at Washington, to be used as evidence in courts, where trials and other legal proceed- ings are pending. In order to provide for this necessity, Con- gress has enacted that copies of such records, maps and papers belonging to any of the government offices, under the signa- ture of the head of such office, or of its chief clerk, with the seal affixed, shall be as competent evidence in all cases as their originals would be. HISTORY OF THE GREAT SEAT,. 1. Soon after the formal establishment of the Republic by the Declaration of Independence, Benjamin Franklin, John Adams, and Thomas Jefferson were appointed a committee to prepare a seal. They employed an artist and furnished various devices; Jefferson combining them all at the request of the others. The paper still exists in the office of the Secretary of State at Washington. They reported Aug. 10th, 1776, but for some unknown reason, probably neglect, it was not acted on. In 1779 another committee was appointed, to make a device. They reported May 10th, 1780. It was not acceptable, and was recommitted, being again reported a year afterwards, but not adopted. In 1782 a third committee was appointed, but could not satisfy Congress in their report. It was then referred to the Secretary of Congress, Charles Thomson, who procured various devices that were unsatisfactory. After vainly striving to perfect a seal which should meet the approval of Congress, Thomson finally received from Jolm GEEAT sfai. 01 THE l.Mi . Adams, then in London, an exceedingly Bimple and appropri device, suggested by Sir John Prestwitch, a baronel of I West of England, who was a warm friend of America, and accomplished, antiquarian. It consisted of an escutcheon ing thirteen perpendicular stripes, white and red, with I chief blue, and spangled with thirteen stars; and. to greater consequence, he proposed to place it on the breast of an American eagle, displayed, without support emblem- atic of self-reliance. It met with general approbation, in and out of Congress, and was adopted in .lime, 1782; so it is man- ifest, although the fact is not extensively known, thai we indebted for our national arms to a title* 1 aristocrat of the country with which we were then at war. Eschew in;: all her aldic technicalities, it may be thus described in plain English: Thirteen perpendicular pieces, white and red; a blue field; ' escutcheon on the breast of the American eagle displayed, bold- ins: in his right talon an olive-branch, and in bis left a bundle of thirteen arrows, and in his beak a scroll, inscribed with I motto E Pluribus JJnum. For the crest, over the head the eagle, which appears above the escutcheon, a gulden glory breaking through a cloud, and surrounding thirteen forming a constellation of white star- on a blue field. Reverse. — A pyramid unfinished. In the zenith, an • • a triangle, surrounded with a glory. < >ver the i ye, I u Annuit Cceptis— "God has favored the undertakii the base of the pyramid, are the numeral Roman letfc MDCCLXXYI; and underneath the motto, \ Seculorutn—" A New Series of Ages " - denoting I order of things had commenced in the Western hemispb Thus, after many fruitless efforts, for nearly ail simple seal was adopted, aud yet remains the anno of tho United States. CHAPTER XII. THE ORIGIN OF LAW. 1. The origin of law varies with the character or class of the government under which it is made. Where all authority is concentrated in the hands of one man his will becomes law whenever expressed, or when expressed in some regular and formal way. More generally laws are originated, in our days, in civilized countries where there is a monarchial government, by the ruler in conjunction with representatives of the people or some classes of them. In point of fact, rulers are always obliged to regard the habits, traditions, and feelings of the people more or less, or they may be obliged by a revolution, or the intrigues of the ambitious founded on their discontent, to retire to private life. The real prominence of the people in their governments is constantly becoming greater in all civil- ized lands, and it seems highly probable that, before many generations have passed, all governments not founded on an acknowledgment of the Sovereignty of the People will be incapable of maintaining themselves. 2. In the United States of America the source of all authority, and the origin of all law, is in the people alone. The fact that laws are made by Representatives does not alter the principle at all. They are simply the substitutes or agents of the people. Where there are many people any other than a Representative Democracy is impossible. These are chosen from among their equals, and when their term of office has expired return to the common level. If they are ambitious of more than one term of office they must take special care not to offend the majority that first elected them. 3. The first signal exercise of the law making power by the people was in the adoption of the Constitution as the Funda- mental Law. This established the character of the govern- ment, prescribed the duties and limits of the legislative and executive branches, and organized a third branch to watch over the action of the other two and keep it in harmony with (588) nil. < 'Kit. in 01 LAW. the Constitution. This Instrument then became the sonrci foundation of all sj>,ci,._ usually ■appoints a chaplain, now of one denomination, and now <>f .another; it allows chaplains in the army and uavy, and ; vides them a salary ; and, of late years, the President mends a day of National thanksgiving to God once a year, tor the blessings we enjoy, and sometimes proclaims a day ol I ing and prayer. It shows all due respect to the religi beliefs among the people, but leaves all free to practice any form of it, or to reject them all. 3. Entire religious liberty is a rarity in the world, and is much more favorable to the purity and weighty inline religious teachings than a State religion. Many of the eoloi that afterwards became States, were founded by }•• *ho fled from religious persecution in the countries of tl I World, and multitudes have emigrated here to Becure fri in the enjoyment of their religious views and practia entire freedom to reject all religion if they could ooi any, though that is seldom the case. Our example has been much approved and is having much influence on other nations. TOLERATION OF 0FISION8, 4. Is characteristic of the American Government of the Press, or freedom to state any view, a man m is as complete as liberty in religious matters. ^ • r things are sometimes written and published of fce govem* 596 CHAPLAINS. and sometimes things that would do much harm if they were generally believed, and no notice is taken of it, unless some one sees fit to contradict it or prove it to be incorrect. If a man injures another's character by writing things that are false, he can be tried, and, if convicted, punished „by the courts. Yile and indecent writings are prohibited ; but other- wise there is entire freedom. Falsehood and error are left to be destroyed in a natural way by the truth. This is a great gain to the truth since error has often been protected, in other countries, by government authority, on the conviction that it was the truth, to the great prejudice of truth itself. 5. Although, during the Civil War, there was some restraint put upon the freedom of publishing things that might be hurtful to the government, the instances were not very numer- ous, and, at the close of the war the spirit of toleration was shown in a way very creditable to our peoj)le, and very praise- worthy in our government, which left the way open to a speedier reunion of sentiment and sympathy in the sections that had fought each other so bravely. The brave and resolute can afford to be just to each other, and to allow entire freedom of opinion to all. In this respect we have fairly earned the right to call ourselves a nation of freemen. CHAPTEE XV. CHAPLAINS. 1. Regard to the religious habits of a large number of the people has led Congress to appoint, or permit the appointment, of chaplains to supply such religious instruction and services in the army and navy as might be felt desirable by those con- cerned. Though chaplains are not properly officers of the govern- ment, they are employees of it, for they are appointed by its CHAPLAINS. authority, and paid from its treasury. Those in the arm? receive the same pay and emoluments as a major of ini or this was the compensation allowed by ad of I 1812. But by an act of 1862, it was fixed at $100 per month, and two rations per day, for those in the army or hospita the act of 1812, one chaplain was allowed b but by an act of 1861 (during the civil wax, regiment was allowed. Navy chaplains, in 1835, received SI.i'iki per year. Hut in 1860 this was raised to a lieutenant's pay; and this in I s ' ! $1,800 per annum. Chaplains in Congress receive $750 per annum. 2. The United States also employ a chaplain in the military academy at "West Point. From the foregoing it will be seen that in time of war, with one chaplain for every regiment, and one for every ship of v. and others in hospitals and military posts, quite a large num- ber of clergymen are employed by the government This provision for the religious instruction of those who cannot, from their peculiar position, attend the preaching the Gospel, or other religious services, i- certainly an indi tion that our government respects religion, and looi the spiritual as well as the temporal interests of it- army navy. 3. In the appointment of chaplains, the government pur- sues a liberal course. No particular preference i- given I ■denomination, but they are appointed from almost - ious sect, and allowed to conduct religious services aft forms of the church to which they respectively I Every body knows what the duties of a chaplain need not explain them here, and will only add that chaplain in the army in time of war has mnch I preaching and holding regular services. The - sick, and the dying, should be the particular i attention. He should not only minister religious i and consolation to them, but look after their p 598 COMPROMISES. Many of these clergymen, during the late most unfortunate civil war, distinguished themselves by their exertions to pro- mote the bodily comforts of those unfortunate men, as well as to give them religious instruction, not refusing to nurse the sick and wounded wherever they could relieve their pains or mitigate their sufferings. CHAPTER XVI COMPROMISES. 1. In a large and prosperous country there are very likely to arise antagonisms of interest and sentiment which will require the strong pressure of some common and more imper- ative interest to overawe and reconcile by a process of mutual concession, called Compromise. The States of the two sections — North and South — were unlike in several general respects ; but it was in nothing so marked as in regard to Slavery. This system was introduced in Virginia in the same year that the Plymouth colony was founded in Massachusetts, and spread to all the colonies, in time; but never was much practiced north of Maryland. In all the Southern colonies it took deep root from the first. It formed the subject of the most difficult COMPROMISE OF THE CONSTITUTION. 2. This compromise consisted of concessions made by each section. The North conceded the return of fugitives from their Southern masters, when escaped to the north, and an enumeration of three-fifths of the slave population in com- puting the representation in Congress. This was a great sacri- fice for that section to make, for its people were, at heart, deeply hostile to Slavery. Both their interests and sentiments made it important to exclude it from the new States where they were likely to settle in considerable numbers. But a close and strong union of the States was a vital point with them. Commerce, ( (t.MPKOMISI S. trade, and manufactures, to which they wen required resources and vigor in the centra] government, I maintain the public credit at home, and Becure safety abroad. The South conceded the final cloae of tin Trade at a given time (1808). ( tatside of the ( kmstitution it. at the same time, conceded the " Ordinance of 1787," bywhi Slavery was excluded from the territory north of the Ohio ri.. Thus the North and South divided the country between them. 3. This was, however, a very troublesome subject, and affected so many legislative questions as to be constantly ••••in- ing up for debate. The sentiments of the Northern people grew more hostile to the institution, and tin- South >N«>d on guard with growing apprehension ami anger, as thi feeling developed in the North ; and, at the same time, it became evident that the more rapid growth of the north population gave them an increasing preponderance ir ( sional representation. They jealously watched over the rights of the State governments from their fear of < executive interference, and industriously sought means to< their area and increase the number of Slave States. They always much assisted by a large party in the north of i: who cherished the Union and were fearful of its dissolnl They were ever pouring oil on the trouble! waters, and m< ating between the two extremes. THE MISSOIKI 00KFRO1OS1 . 4. The arrangement of the Slai erj question made in 1820, and took effect as to the Stat, of M Itonri in 1821. In the five years that followed the dose of tl with England there was great activity in settlement of unoccupied territory, and the country gave indicati • power of rapid development that has so Btrongly thai it since. The South foresaw the loss of its balai if too many of the new States were oi souri had included a clause in her Constitution. | the approval of Congress, prohibiting slavery. Tl South demanded should be Btricken ont It prodo 600 COMPROMISES. excitement and hot discussion throughout the country, and seemed to threaten the stability of the Union. Both sections were resolute in maintaining their principle, but both appre- ciated the necessity of strength in the government and harmony between the sections, and each made a sacrifice for the sake of these. Missouri was required to admit slavery, and the con- dition was annexed that no more Slave States should be formed north of its southern line. This was a concession trying to both sides. The North became a party to the extension of Slavery, and the South gave definite limits to her power of expansion. Each, however, gained something : the South a State above the limits before virtually fixed, and the North a definite and final limit to the extension of a hated institution. This was quite generally satisfactory, and for many years set that question at rest. 5. " Mason and Dixon's Line " was the term applied to the boundary between the Free and Slave States. This name origi- nated in colonial times. The royal grants to colonial propri- etors or companies were often very carelessly made, and those to Lord Baltimore, the founder of Maryland, and William Penn, the proprietor of Pennsylvania, were specially indefinite, giving rise to adverse claims that nearly produced war along the border. Commissioners were at length appointed, who employed Mason and Dixon, eminent English astronomers and surveyors, to establish the boundary, which they did satisfac- torily. The importance of the question settled, and the repu- tation of the surveyors for scientific accuracy, attached their name to the boundary permanently. It acquired political significance afterwards, as the boundary between Maryland, the most northern of the slave States, and Pennsylvania, the most southern of the original free States. When new States were formed, with the Ohio river as a boundary from its point of departure out of Pennsylvania, that name was extended in its application to the whole dividing line between the free and slave States — south or north of Mason and Dixon's Line mean- ing, in slave or free territory. COMPKOMI8E8. 6. After some years the sen t hern statesmen began i feel apprehensive of a loss of their equality of general government, so rapidly did the northern territoi up. They began to look for more territory, and fa the settlement, independence, and annexation of Texas. Thou long resisted, they succeeded in the election of 1M I, with I annexation and a probable war with Mexico as test questions, and added not only Texas but New Mexico and California to the territory wherein slavery, by the Missouri Comprom would be admissible. 7. Their satisfaction was not very durable. The discovery of gold in California tilled it with inhabitants these so largely from the free States, that in two yean from it- definite acquisition it petitioned for admission into the I i with a clause in its Constitution prohibiting Slavery. Thie w r as very exasperating to the South, and after a long and viol contest could be carried by the North only by the i the Fugitive Slave Law — a re-enactnicut of a pari of the < lorn- promise of the Constitution with provisions so vign effective, could they have been enforced, as t<> Ik-, in the big! degree, offensive to a considerable pari of the northern : Utah was given a Territorial government a- a concession t<> the South, and the Slave Trade was abolished in the District Columbia as her corresponding concession to the North. Th< were the four compromise measure- of L850, the n discussion lasting nearly a year, engendering great bitto on both sides, and failing t<> sati>fv either. 8. The attempt to enforce the Fugitive Slave Law pro ineffectual, in the end ; the rooted aversion "t' t ther people to Slavery, kept in abeyance before by less often promises, being fully aroused. This produced in I people a bitter indignation as showing a disposition t against a constitutional provision in their favor cured, in 1854, the repeal of the Missouri I oraprom famous " Kansas and Nebraska Bill," and bouj Slavery into Kansas. A civil war in that T< 602 TREASON. which resulted in the triumph of the Northern party. The extinction of Slavery was now apparently but a question of time, the hostility to it in the North becoming so out-spoken and averse to Compromises acceptable to the South, that they began to look forward to separation, which they endeavored to accomplish from 1860-5. A civil war, such as only Americans could wage, was carried on during these years. The resolution, bravery, and military talents of either side were never excelled ; but the resources of the North seemed inexhaustible. Her numbers, activity, and the inventive genius of her skilled arti- sans gave her an immense superiority. This war is a cause at once of pride and grief to every true American. In the contest Slavery, the cause of it, disappeared, the Constitution was amended, and the necessity of Compromises on this ques- tion forever ceased. CHAPTEE XVII. TREASON. 1. This is an offense aiming at the existence of the govern* ment; and in all other governments it has ever been customary to punish it with extreme severity. Many things are consid- ered to be of the nature of treason, and, as such, severely punished in most countries. The Constitution defines treason to be " levying war against the United States, or adhering to their enemies, giving them aid and comfort;" so that the highest or capital crime alone may be pursued with its penal- ties. This is another evidence of the extreme moderation of the founders of the government, which we have had occasion to notice so often in our examination. 2. An act of Congress passed April 30th, 1790, defines it in the same sense and orders that the convicted offender shall be hung. By another act passed 17th July, 1862, it was made discre- tionary with the court trying the case to put the offender to- POLITICAL GEOGRAPHY OF THE UNITED 8TA1 death, or to imprison him for not less than five fine him for a sum not less than ten thousand penalty for this crime, even in its mildest form, i thus showing how atrocious this offense is oonsidi r 3. None but a person owing allegiance to the United 81 can commit treason against them. The same acta which would be treason in a citizen would not be treason if perpi l>v a foreigner. " Misprision of treason " is the concealment of it I who knows it has been committed. This also ia a and is punishable by a seven years' imprisonment, tad a fine not exceeding one thousand dollars. 4. Any person tried for treason, must be indicted by a grand jury, and tried by a petit jury in the Circuit < lonrt ol the United States within three years utter the crime committed; otherwise it is barred by limitation or, in ■ , .\iw words, outlawed. CHAPTER XVIII. POLITICAL GEOGRAPHY OF THE ONITEDSTAI 1. Geography proper describes the general character country, as its rivers, bays, gulfs, plains, mountains ltd- ral divisions. Leaving this to other works we confiiM to those divisions made by the government for convenience in administering its affairs. Formerly there was a separation into North and South, "Mason and Dixon's Line," between which t! marked difference of governmental, social, and indnstl policy. The States south of that line might bold in those north of it that institution was illegal Thai ence was abolished by the thirteenth amendment I tution, as a result of the Civil War. Tl, l ar ges t tad these exist now — are those made by the POLITICAL GEOGEAPHT OF THE C7NTTED STAT: - CIRCUIT COURTS. _ These often comprise several States and are ch _ act of Congress, when the convenience of the Associate Judges of the Supreme Court, who preside over them requires it. The next largest political divisions are THE STATES. 3. These exercise - vereign powers in all matters . control has not been expressly delegated by the Constitution : the National Congress. The other political boundaries are ever liable to change, to meet the requirements of changing circumstanc. - These are definitely fixed, any change beir.^ very rare and unlikely after they are duly organized and admitted into the Union as St & Each of the original thirteen colonies became St fees, with the boundaries thev had as colonies at the time of the Revolutionarv War. The others received such boundaries as suited the convenience and wishe* of the people when they were admitted. Their object is to prevent the centralization of too much power in the general government, and to render legislation on local affairs and inter- ests more convenient, and more sat -factory to the people of each State. The State having the least number of inhabi: numbers between 40,000 and •" . : the one having the largest number contains between 4.0 ) and ". The number of the States determines the number of Senators in Congress, two being allotted to each; so that a State may be considered as a Senatorial District. DISTRICT COURTS ~ Produce another class of political div - - These attend to legal differences involving the laws of the general cfovernment. but of a secondarv class. Thev are more numer- ous than the Circuit Courts. In some States there is but one, and some have several, according to size and po: elation. ELECTION DIST 5. Another class of districts has been formed, for the pur- pose of collecting the duties on imported goods. These are POLITICAL GEOGRAPHY OF THE DOTTED -I A called "collection districts." They extend along, and eo the whole sea coast and the shores of navigable lake.- and In a few instances they are located inland, at points goods may be brought into the United - - by land. I collection district has a port of entry, and very ofta ports of delivery; also a collector of customs, and general, custom house. 6. Another class of collection districts was formed durii the late civil war. They grew out of the war. and v. I ib- lished for the collection of the tax termed the " internal revenue." which had to be levied to pay the war ex] These districts differ entirely, both in their objects and in the territory embraced within them, from those established for the purpose of collecting duties on imports, and correspond as practicable with the Congressional districts in eac!. E LASD DISTRICTS. 7. Land districts may also be noticed among these di In every State and Territory where there are public land- for sale, after they are surveyed and mapped, they are divided districts — two. three or four, in each State and Territory- convenience and economy may dictate. In each district a . offiee is established for the sale of the lands in said district LIGHT HOUSE DISTRICTS. 8. Again, the whole of our sea coasts, both on the Atlantic and Pacific oceans, together with the shores of the navigable lakes and rivers, are divided into twelve light honse diatr (or their number must not exceed that,) for the par] building, repairing, illuminating and superintending the 1 houses on all the coasts and shores wherever located 1 are the principal divisions we have to notice. It is im] to have a knowledge of them, for with such knowledge we better understand how government affairs are conducted. CHAPTER XIX. CHRONOLOGY OF THE U. S. FROM 1783 TO 18i2. 1783. Washington's army had lain in camp at Newburg, N. Y., since the •surrender of Cornwallis. The Preliminary treaty of peace was signed Jan. 20th, at Paris ; but it was not officially announced in the camp at New- burg, until April 19th ; just eight years from the Battle of Lexington that commenced it! July, — Congress prepared to disband the army, and Washington to resign his commission as Commander-in-Chief. " 21 — The great difficulty Congress had to contend with was raising money to pay the troops. Congress had no authority, under the Confederation, to lay taxes or impose duties. It exhausted its own credit in the issue of paper money which soon became of little value. It made some foreign loans, and persuaded the States, which alone could lay taxes, to raise a small sum. But this did not suffice to pay the army at last. Thert> was much suffering and discontent. On this day a body of soldiers, in largo part new recruits, who had comparatively little to complain of, without muskets, but wearing side arms, beset the doors of Congress in Philadelphia, for three hours. No violence was oftered. Congress adjourned to Princeton, N. J. Sept. 3 — The final and definite Treaty of Peace between England, France, and the United States, in which the independence of the latter was acknowledged, its boundaries defined, and various matters of interest arranged to the profit of the United States, was signed at Paris. Nov. 2 — A proclamation is issued by Congress for disbanding the army. " 25 — The British troops evacuate New York, and it is occupied by American troops under Gen. Knox. Dec. 4— Long Island and Staten Island abandoned by the British. Wash- ington takes leave of his officers, at New York. " 25 — He resigns his commission to Congress, in a public audience, given him at Annapolis, Md., where Congress was then sitting, and goes home to Mt. Vernon. Caesar Rodney, a signer of the Declaration of Independence, died this year. 1784. The want of public credit was very much felt. There was no authority sufficient to raise money to meet the interest, even, on the debt; and this produced great distress. (606) BISTORT OF Tin UNITED st \ li 9. Nov. 1— The Continental Congress meeta al Trenton, N..I. Rli Lee, of Va., is chosen President Oct. 4— A treaty with the Six Nations, who bad sided with thi during the war, was made at Ft. Bchuyler (formerly E I now Utica, N. Y.). Commerce begins to revive. Reciprocity treat trade with eastern Asia commenced this year by a from New York. Jan. —Congress adjourns to New York, where it continued to bo sessions for some years. Mar. 10— Thomas Jefferson appointed to till the place of Franklin ister to France; Franklin wishes to return bonus. He had I there nine years. July — Commercial treaties negotiated with Prussia, Denmark, Portu and Tuscany. The treaty with Prussia stipulated that, in caseol that country and the United States, there should be QO | " 13 — Stephen Hopkins, of R. I., a signer of the Declaration of Inde pendence, died. " 28 — Wm. Whipple, of N. II., a signer of the Declaration oi lnd< pend ence, died. u u — Treaties made with the Cherokees, Choctaws, and < iwi 1786. Financial troubles were now approaching a crisis. In tations from England had amounted to $30,000,000. The only $9,000,000. Paper money was depreciated bo much as t.. be -i value. Debt oppressed government and people; want of vigorous ant • ity was everywhere felt; and many disorders in Tennessee, ft ntw kj ■elsewhere, begin to threaten the internal peace of the country. June 19— Gen. Nathaniel Greene, an able commander in the Ft •■• armies, died. He manouvered against Cornwallis in Nortl South Carolina with great ability. Dec. 5— Shay's Rebellion broke out in Mass. That State money to aid Congress in paying the Interest on the f< The people felt unable to pay it They mobbed th< were dispersed by troops under Gen. Lincoln. Thl and one wounded, in an attack the Insurgents madeoi There was little other fighting. Fourt en ; condemned to death but afterward.- pardoned. 17-7. These and other events convinced the people thai an i.n: baaj in the government was necessary. It became clear tl. authority, alone, could answer the purpose. The States ■ 608 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. pendent of each other; but this produced conflicts and want of harmony. which nearly ruined them all. A congress of deputies to consider commercial questions, called by Va. had, in Sept., 1786, recommended a convention to revise the Articles of Confederation. Feb. 2 — The Continental Congress assembled, electing Gen. St. Clair, Pres- ident. " 12 — Congress approves the call for a Constitutional Convention. May 25 — The convention assembled in Philadelphia, and elected Gen. Geo. Washington, President. July 11 — The Continental Congress organize the Northwest Territory — north of the Ohio river. Preparations were immediately made for settling it. Sept. 28 — The Constitution, as signed by the members of the convention, laid before Congress, which sends it to the State Legislatures for approval. Arthur Middleton of S. C, and Thomas Stone of Md. signers of the Declaration of Independence, died, Jan. 1st and Oct. 5th, respectively. Dec. 7 — Delaware ratifies the Constitution. " 12 — Pennsylvania accepts the Constitution. 1788. July 4 — The anniversary of Independence is kept with great display, in Philadelphia, in special honor of the adoption of th? new Con- stitution. By the close of July nine more States had ratified the Constitu- tion, and it went into operation. Sept. 13 — Congress selects the first Wednesday of Jan. (1789) for the appointment of Presidential electors; the first Wednesday in February for their appointment of President and Vice President ; and March 4th (the first Wednesday that month) for the new gov- ernment to go into operation. 1789. Jan. 4 — Thomas Nelson, of Va., signer of the Declaration of Independence, died. Feb. 13 — Ethan Allen, of Revolutionary fame, died. April 30 — Washington inaugurated as first President. May 12 — A Tariff Bill for raising a revenue reported in Congress. This became a law, and went into effect Aug. 1st, 1789. • 20— The Department of Foreign Affairs (afterwards called State Department,) organized. The Treasury Department is next established, followed by the War Department, to which the Navy was joined for the present. The Judiciary was then constituted. Salaries, and the rules for parliamentary procedure were determined. The Postmaster gen- HISTORY OF Till. INI I 1,1) si .VI eral had long been an officer <>t' the governmi nt, and ■■ change than most of the others. This made Congress also passed a resolution to add ten amendi Constitution— which were submitted to the - ratified. Congress adjourned the lasl of September. The democratic tone of the government, and the spirit applli the interpretation of the Constitution by the first Ooogi generally prevailed ever since. That tone and spirit in republican. Kov. 8 — The President made a tour through V w England " 13 — North Carolina ratified the Constitution. Many Indian treaties were made this year. 1790. Jan. 8 — Congress reassembled. This session was scarcely Inferior in Inter est and importance to the first from the variety ol new quest required to be settled, and the more perfect development r » former ones. Feb. 8 — Provision was made for payment of the foreign debt. Mar. 1 — An act ordering a census to be taken was passed. H 34 — A naturalization law was originated. Apr. 15 — A patent law was constructed. » 30— Treason was defined and the penalty determined on. May29— The Constitution ratified by Rhode Island; making apttaewl - number of thirteen States. " 31— "An act to encourage learning" secured copyrights to aathon July 16— Three very exciting debates that had occupied much of the nine of Congress, had a bearing on the location of the National Capital, which was this day permanently settled. The President authorized to determine the site on the Potomac, and I • buildings erected so as t«. be reads foroccupation In 1800 v bly to this act Maryland and Virginia ceded the DUtrlctol I I bia to the United States. Gen. Putnam, a prave Revolutionary soldier, Benjamin Pi of Pa., Wm. Hooper, of U. C, and Francis Hopkins- all except Putnam signers of the Declaration of h. died this vear. The Territory South of the Ohio was organized tl financial system of the country was established, the si tion debated and settled In accordance with the com] Constitution, and the State debts transferred to tb« I Aug.l2-Con S ress adjourned to meet next In Philadelphia and U until 1800. . _ « 13-A treaty with the Creek Indians solemnly ratifi « ■*»■ 39 610 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. Dec. 6 — The Third Session of Congress commenced. The President con- gratulates Congress on the improvement of the finances, and the prosperity of the country. 1791. Feb. — The United States Bank established. It was to have a capital of $10,000,000 — its charter to run twenty years. " 4 — Kentucky voted admission into the Union in the next year (Jan. 1st, 1792). " 18 — Vermont having (Jan. 20th) ratified the Constitution and asked admission into the Union, it is granted this day. The immediate prosperity that followed the adoption of the Con- stitution of 1787, the strength, vigor, and moderation seen to be combined in its arrangement of the government, led most of the States to remodel their State Constitutions on it, in a short time. July, — The subscription to the stock of the National Bank is all taken in a few hours after the books are opened. Aug. — Great Britain first sends a minister to the United States Govern- ment. Sep.17 — An expedition of 2,000 troops, under Gen. St. Clair, starts from Ft. Washington against the Indians in the Northwest Territory. Nov. 4 — Gen. St. Clair is surprised and defeated by the Indians. There were 600 killed — the whole loss amounted to upward of 900. Several other smaller expeditions had been sent against the Indians in the course of the year. One, Gen. Harmer's, had been defeated. Internal taxes on spirits were first commenced this year. Benj. Harrison, of Va., a signer of the Declaration of Independ- ence, died this year. A voyage around the world, by way of Ore- gon, China, and the Cape of Good Hope, had opened wide fields to commerce. The first census was now completed. The Second Congress, assembled at Philadelphia, Oct. 24, was occupied in arranging the new ratio of Representatives. It was a very diffi- cult matter to settle from the sectional struggles that entered into the question. 1792. Feb. 16 — A bounty for fishing vessels provided. " 20— The Post Office Department reorganized. Apr. 2 — The establishment and regulations of the U. S. Mint are embodied in a law. " 14 — Act apportioning Representatives passed. This gave the next House of Representatives in Congress 105 members. May 8 — Laws organizing the Militia are passed. Dec. 8 — Henry Laurens, first President of the Continental Congress, died. The second presidential election this year resulted in the re-elec- tion of Washington and Adams. Washington received all the electoral votes — the anti-federalists opposing only Mr. Adams, BI8T0BT OF mi-: r\i n:i» BTAT1 whose electoral vote was 77, the candidate of u, receiving 50 Much seditious opposition u Carolina and Pennsylvania to the excise 1 1 i The President issued a proclamation against tb< m 1798. Jan. 24^-The proclamation of the French Republic i with a celebration in its honor. The close and friend 1) n of the United States with Prance, arising from theii the Revolutionary War, led the French ministi i of conduct inconsistent with the existence ol our friend tions with England. The U. S. Government decided neutrality— the people sympathized strongly with i u ington and his cabinet pursued a Btrict neutral course, in w the people finally acquiesced, and Genet's recall * \t obtained. Feb. 12— A Fugitive Slave law passed. July 23 — Roger Sherman, signer of the Declaration of Independent Oct. 8 — John Hancock, of Mass., the flrsl Bigner of the Declaratl Independence, died. This year laid the foundation of thi of neutrality or non-interference with the Euro] became the settled policy of the United The year was also distinguished ly the vie feeling. Dec. 2 — Congress assembles at Philadelphia " 31 — Jefferson resigns his seat in the Cabinet He^ State. 1794 Mar. 11— An act is passed for building lour Bhips of war, whicli foundation of our present navj Some hostile English "Orders in Council" led I fortifying the harbors of the country. " 22— The Slave trade is regulated by law, no American ■• allowed to supply slaves to another nation. The lm] slaves into this country had been allowed until tie Art. 1st, Sec. 9th, of the Constitution " 26— Asa retaliation on the British "Orders In Council" i all goods goin.i: to France in American . . was laid on all shipping which ntinued • • stopped all commerce for the present June r>— A law relating to neutrality passed in ' " 19— Richard Henry Lee, of 7a., died; Abraham < John Witherspoon, of N .J . later, all of Independance, died. July 16— An insurrection breaks out against the Pennsylvania, by an armed attack oo the ol 4W 612 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. army of 15,000 men was raised and marched into that region, tba appearance of which immediately restored order. Aug. 20 — Gen. Wayne inflicts a thorough chastisement on the Indians of Ohio, on the Maumee river. Nov. 4 — Congress again assembles. " 28 — Baron Steuben, a German, who had done us great service as as officer in the Revolutionary war, died, aged 61. 1795. This year a commercial treaty was negotiated with England, which was •he cause of violent demonstrations of the two parties. Only the firmness and moderation of Washington and his supporters saved the country from war with that power. Jan. 23 — Gen. Sullivan died. He had been an able Maj. Gen. in the Revo- lutionary war. " 29 — A more stringent naturalization law passes. May 19 — Josiah Bartlett, of N. H., signer of the Declaration of Independ- ence, died. Aug. 3 — A Treaty with the Northwestern Indians concluded, which closed the Indian war. Bept 5 — A treaty is concluded with Algiers, which closed a war with those pirates, whose attacks had been so disastrous to our commerce. Oet 20 — A treaty of boundaries, and which opened the Mississippi to nav- igation, is concluded with Spain. Dec. 7 — The fourth Congress meets. 1796. March 24 — The U. S. House of Representatives require the President to send them the papers relating to the British treaty. The Presi- dent declines, denying that they form part of the treaty making power. April 30 — The exciting struggle on the British treaty is closed, by a provi. sion made by the House of Representatives for carrying it into effect. June 1 — An act is passed admitting Tennessee into the Union. " 29 — A new treaty is made with the Creek Indians, and the Southern, as well as the Northern Indians, are pacified. Sept. 19 — Washington's Farewell address is issued, to let the people know that he would not accept office again. A presidential election was held this autumn, in which John Adams was elected President. Serious difficulties began to rise with France, which took great offense at the treaty with Great Britain. 1707. Feb. 3 — Mr. Pinckney, American Minister to France, was refused a recep- tion, by the French government, and obliged this day to leave the country. Much violence was done about this time, to American commerce, by the French. IIl>l"i;v OF Till, ran i D e Mar. 4-^John Adams is inaugurated President i f th< I " 25— A special session of Congress is called dertbci posture of our relations with Prance June 14— Congress imposed a One of $10,000 and ten j on any American who should engage in privateering, in any * against a nation with whom we were al p- July 3— The President transmits to Congress information of Bpaniafa troubles on the southern and western frontier. I wards discovered to have aimed al detaching the M Ohio valleys from the United States, and erecting them into independent power, in close alliance with Spain. Two new envoys are sent to Prance These eni nl mam months in Paris, treated with insolence and negli In this year Francis L. Lee, of 7a., Carter Braxton, ol Vi . and Oliver Wolcott, of Conn., signers of the Det taxation ■ pendence, died. 1798. The French government continues to labor to draw the Unite into a war with them against England. Two of the three Com ml are required to leave France. April 3 — The Mississippi Territory organized. " 14 — The navy is taken from the control of the B< cretar] a Navy Department with a Secretary, organized. June 12 — All commercial intercourse with France suspended In ant pation of war the naturalization law is amended ; an \ passed; and the navy and army largely strengthened. " 21 — The President announces the failure of the Commissi to France, to make peace. July 8— A limited naval warfare with France is authorized, and U. S. vessels of war go to sea. w 16 — An additional naval armament provided for. « 17— Washington accepts the appointment of Comman the Army, which is being raised in i rpectation of « —About this time some 865 armed vessels had been comm by the U. S. government, besides the regular navy, to m on the armed vessels of Franc. This armament « chiefly used for defense. Lewis Morris, of N. Y.. James Wilson, of Pa . an I • Del., signers of the Declaration of [ndepend( I 1798 At. the commencement of this year Congress provided foi tb an army of 40,000 men. Peb. 18— By invitation of the French government, I inates another embassy to Pi 614 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. Feb. 7— The French frigate l'lnsurgente captured in the West Indies by the U. S. frigate Constellation. April — The Legislature of New York abolishes Slavery in that State. Dec. 14— Gen. Washington's death, in the 68th year of his age. Win. Paca, of Md., a signer of the Declaration of Independence, died this year. A change in the government of France, and the vigorous action of the U. S. government in arming for war, induced the French to retreat from their unfriendly position and offer to arrange the difference. The refusal of our government to entangle themselves with European politics became a settled principle, of great value to us ; though it was strongly opposed by the Anti-Federalists. 1800. Jan. 23 — Edward Rutledge, of S. C, signer of Dec. of Ind. died. Feb. 1 — The U. S. frigate Constellation beats without capturing the French frigate La Vengeance. April 4 — General bankruptcy law passed by Congress. May 7 — The Territoiy of Indiana organized by act of Congress. " 10 — An act authorizing the election of a Territorial Assembly in the Territory of Mississippi, organized some years before, was passed July — The government is moved to the new capital at Washington. Oct. 1 — The envoys to France arrange a convention, or temporary treaty, which prevents the formal outbreak of war, though it had long continued to be waged on the sea. More than 50 vessels had been captured from the French this year. The gratitude of Americans to France for her aid, formerly, made a large part of the people very unwilling to declare war; but her arrogant demands and war on our commerce had the good effect to separate the country from all close alliances in Europe. Nov. — The fourth presidential election resulted in the defeat of the Feder- alist party, by the election of Thomas Jefferson as President. Its opponent, the anti-federalist, or Republican party, feared a strong central government ; yet when they came into power they adopted the same policy. Any other policy would have ruined the country. 1801. Feb. 16 — The Convention with France, to 7-emain in force eight years,, ratified. Mar. 3 — The Sixth Congress terminates, and with it the administration of President Adams. " 4 — Jefferson inaugurated President. The trial of the Constitution was now past. It was permanently settled in the respect of the people, and had made the country respected by other nations. The "Sedition Laws" passed in July, 1798, became inoperative at this time, by the provision accompanying them. They had been HISToKV OF TUB DOTTED BTATBB. framed for the suppression of dangerous political Intrl of war. Party spirit was exceedingly bitter al Hi. these laws produced much excitement, hut contrib of the government. June 10— The Basha of Tripoli declares war on the United - i " 14 — Benedict Arnold died in London. Aug. 6— The U. S. vessel of war Experiment, captur the Mediterranean Dec. 7— The Seventh Congress assembles. The reaction, al I public sentiment, produced by the French Revolution, the < of which resulted in a military despotism under Napoleon 1 parte, infused a spirit of moderation and caution into tie of the United States under the new party now in pon highly beneficial. Extreme news were checked, and no change was made in the general policy of the country 1802. Jan. 4 — The reapportionment of Representatives in Congress bj th< of 1800, was made. No change in the number of inhabitant! one Representative (one to every 88,000) was int] foundation of a Military Academy at West Point, N "i at. this time. April 14 — The Naturalization Laws, made very Btringenl in tl istration to correspond with a state of war, were lib I i April 30 — An act authorizing the formation ol a State Constitution in < >1 preparatory to its admission into the Union, i- ; May 3 — Washington, D. G, incorporated as a city. Oct. 16— Commerce on the Mississippi by American citis by the Spanish authorities at New Orleans. It became evident that the possession ol the Mississippi l. territory near it was of the highest importance i" the w< the West, and measures looking toward the acqnisitioi to be taken. A large reduction was made tins year in tin- public •: policy of economy in public expenditure becu of the administration. 1808 March 3— The anxiety of the people in regard to the as Mississippi leads Congress to invest the Presidenl with nary authority to negotiate, or use force, in his was authorized to call on the States to fornial need be. April 30— A treaty is concluded with Napoleon Bonap '»■*< of the whole of the Louisiana Territory for $15,000 Aug. 13— By a treaty with the Kaskaakia Indian^ a |ai opened to settlement. 616 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. Oct. 31 — The U. S. frigate Philadelphia ran on a sunken rock in the harhor of Tripoli, and was captured. The American fleet had captured or destroyed several Tripolitan vessels of war during the summer. Dec. 20 — The President takes possession of Louisiana. 1804. Feb. 2 — Geo. Walton, of Geo., signer of the Declaration of Independence, died. " 15 — New Jersey passes a law freeing all the slaves born in the State after the next 4th of July. " 16 — Lieut. Decatur, of the U. S. Navy, ran into the harbor of Tripoli in the night and burned the Philadelphia — captured by the Tri- politans, some time before. This done he withdrew in safety, in the sloop he had employed for the bold enterprise. July 11 — Alexander Hamilton, an eminent statesman, was killed in a duel with Aaron Burr, Vice-President of the United States. He was 48 years old and his death was considered as a public calamity. Aug. 3— Com. Preble attacks Tripoli, sinks two vessels, captures three more, and bombards the city. The city was blockaded during the remainder of the year and through the winter. Nov. 18— Gen. Philip Schuyler died at Albany, N. Y. Jefferson was re-elected President in this month. 1805. Great commercial prosperity marked this period. France and England were at war and most of the carrying trade fell to American vessels. The peaceful acquisition of Louisiana, and the prosperity of the west in con- sequence, contributed much to the development of the country. The grand era of progress in the United States began to dawn, though overcast by threatening difficulties with Spain and England. March — Chief Justice Chase having been impeached by the House of Rep- resentatives, was acquitted by the Senate. " 4 — Jefferson's second inauguration as President. June 3 — A treaty of peace made with Tripoli. A Territorial Legislature is authorized in the Territory of Orleans, and the Territory of Louisiana organized. June 11— The Territory of Michigan is organized. It was very thinly settled, but separated by so great a distance from the inhabited parts of Indiana Territory as to require a separate government. July 4 — Large cessions of land are obtained, by treaty and purchase, from the Indians. Most of their lands in Ohio, Indiana, and along the Ohio River were acquired in an equitable manner. Large ces- sions are obtained this year from the Creeks and Cherokees, who received a fair equivalent. Sept. 12 — Wm. Moultrie, a distinguished Revolutionary soldier, died. Measures are set on foot to purchase Florida from the Spaniards. HISTORY OF TIIK I ' M I hi » st.VI «; | 7 There seemed no alternative bul suchapurch war Dim cultieswith England began to increase Several Amerl sels with valuable cargoes are seized h\ the British. 1806. Jan. 16— Two million dollars are vi it imI thai the President mas commi negotiations with Spain for Florida. The British continu late our flag by impressing seamen on our vessels. March 26 — A retaliatory law was enacted by Congress forbidding the importation of certain English goods, to take effect in November in order to give time for negotiation. Provision was also made l"i increasing the army and navy. The summer of this year was disturbed, in the west, by rumors "i a design to separate the Louisiana Territory and Westen from the Union, by the establishment of an independent govi ment. Apr. 10 — Gen. Horatio Gates, an officer of the Revolution, died. Dec. — The session of Congress commencing the flrsl of this month largely occupied with a law forbidding the slave trade after I There was much violent debate but the law was enacted early in the next year. Robt. Morris, of Pa., on the 8th of May; Geo. Wythe, of Va , on the 8th of June; James Smith, of Pa., on the 11th of July, signers of the Declaration of Independence; and Gen. Henry Knox, u officer of the Revolution, on the 25th of Oct, died. Gen. Knoi was Secretary of War during Washington's administration. 1807. Feb. 10— An act for commencing the Coast Survey, and appropriat $50,000 for that purpose, is passed. The English had defeated and almost annihilated the French and Spanish navies, and became very tyrannical toward neutral nations, which begins to injure our commerce. Bonaparte retal- iates in the same spirit which doubles the difficulty. Mar. 18— A treaty made by American ambassadors with England rejected by our government because the British rein that British born citizens could become American citizens by naturalization. These the English government claimed the r of impressing from our vessels, which we denied. Jwne22— A British ship of war, the Leopard, fires Into the Amei Chesapeake while unprepared toresist,and tooksevei il n her. Three Americans were killed, and eighteen wound I U greatly exasperated the Americans. July2-The President ordered all English ships of war to k »*e Amen waters. Aug. 25— Com. Preble, of the U. S. navy, died. Sept. 15-Aaron Burr tried for treason, (hi- was the leader ol the 1 onspu 618 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. believed to have endeavored to detach the Mississippi Valley from the Union,) was acquitted for want of evidence, though gen- erally believed guilty. Nov. 26— Oliver Ellsworth, U. S. Chief Justice, died. Dec. 17 — Bonaparte's "Milan Decree " subjects American commercial ves- sels to seizure. " 22 — This and like British "Orders in Council" caused Congress to lay an embargo, forbidding any vessels to sail from our ports. 1808. Jan. 1 — The act of Congress, passed in the previous session, to carry out the provision of the Constitution to abolish the slave trade at this time, goes into effect to-day. Apr. 17 — Bonaparte orders the seizure and confiscation of all American vessels in France, or that should afterwards arrive there. Nov. 7 — The tenth Congress assembles again. Much discussion is had over the embargo, but it is finally determined to make it still more stringent and place the country in a state of defense. ' : — A presidential election this month results in the choice of James Madison for the next term. He was a republican, or democrat, in politics. 1809. Jan. 9 — An act is passed " more effectually to enforce the embargo." Feb. 3 — Illinois organized under a Territorial Government. " 27 — The embargo is partially repealed. Mar. 3 — The Tenth Congress closes, at the same time as the Administra- tion of Jefferson. Madison was inaugurated the next day. He served two terms. A w T ar with Great Britain was commenced in his first, and ended in his second term. " 9 — Thos. Haywood, of S. C, signer of the Declaration of Independ- ence, died. Apr. 19 — An arrangement of the difficulties with England concluded with the British Minister, Erskine, and, in the expectation of perman- ent peace, the Embargo and Non-intercourse acts cease by proc- lamation of the President. May 22 — An extra session of of the eleventh Congress meets. July 20 — News arrives of the rejection by the English government of the Erskine treat}-. Aug. 9 — The President forbids, by proclamation, all intercourse with Great Britain and France. Nov. 8 — A new English minister having been sent, his arrogant tone causes the U. S. government to decline further intercourse with him. 1810. Mar. 23 — Bonaparte orders the sale and confiscation of 132 American ves- sels (detained in France by previous decree) and their cargoes, and the same confiscation is ordered of all American vessels softer- HISTORY OF THE DOTTED - i.vi i -. ward entering French porta. The I were worth $8,000,000. Aug. 5— The French government announces the revocatio cation act, to take effecl Nov. 1. A deadly many years, going mi between N>polean B This hostility <>f France to American commerce w of the British "Orders in Council " against trading with France. England bad nearly <\ which, with impressment of Beamen, was the cause of the pn struggle. Our commerce was constantly growing, ■■■-; spirited, and resolved to have their rights and 1"L 1811. Feb. 26 — An act passed establishing naval hospitals. May 16— The American frigate President, and the British Bloop of w»r Little Belt, fire into each other. The Little Belt h 1 was a retaliation of the firing of the British ship Leopard on American Chesapeake, tour years before, and also ol thecaptui an American merchantman bound to Prance, off ' British vessel about this time. Several instances of [mpreatmonl, by the British, from American reseda, had latelj <"■ .::■ there was a feeling of great exasperation toward England English government had not yet made an\ atonement tor t). on the Chesapeake. June 1 — Gen. Eaton, prominent in the war with Tripoli, died. " 19 — Samuel Chase, Chief Justice of the I S . died. Aug. 2 — Wm. Williams, of Conn., died. The two laat m re sign) I Declaration of Independence. The relief of American commerce from outrages by th( ' proved delusive, and many grievous wronj .trend t Nov. 7 — Two twin brothers of the Shawaneee tribe of [ndian I and the Prophet) had been for jome yean engaged in (• - conspiracy among a large number ol Indian tribe- on :)■ western frontier to exterminate the whites. Gen. liar: is attacked by the Indians this day, at Tip; I defeated by Gen. Harrison. Dec. 2— The ratio of Representation is revised on the < I I s *" fixed at 35,000. 1M-J. Jan. —Various acts are passed for putting th tion for war. Apr. 4— An embargo is laid on American shipping, by " 8— Louisiana admitted into the [Jnion a- a Bl « 20— Geo. Clinton. Vice 1'" sident of the I'm 620 THE WAK OF 1812. June 4 — The Territory of Missouri organized. " 23 — The British government repeal the obnoxious " Orders in Council," but refuse to give up the right of search and impressment on American vessels. The American government refuses to be satis- fied with this ; besides, it had already declared war, June 18th. CHAPTEK XX. THE WAK OF 1812. We have stated in connection with the appropriate events, the causes of this war which had accumulated during the last rive years at a rapid rate. The seizure and captures of American vessels by Great Britain amounted to 917 ; by France to 558. Upwards of 6,000 cases of impressments were recorded in the American Department of State ; and in all these our Flag had been violated. It was estimated that about as many more had been made, of which no official information had been received. The Ameri- cans were averse to war and had long borne these injuries in the hope that a settlement might be reached by negotiation; but they insisted on the inviolability of our Flag, and the right of naturalization. On the commencement of hostilities 2,500 of these impressed sailors, claiming to be American citizens, refused to fight against America, and were impris- oned by the English government, where most of them were kept to the close of the war. Aug. 24 — The English government, however, had the magnanimity, when news arrived of the Declaration of War by the United States, to- allow all American vessels then in their ports six Aveeks to dis- pose of their lading and to depart undisturbed. The great success of the war on the American side was on the sea, where it was much more seriously detrimental and mortifying to the English than victories on the land would have been. The land forces were generally inefficiently conducted, though the close of the war was signalized by the victory of Gen. Jackson, at New Orleans, which was extremely gratifying to American pride. July 12— Gen. Hull, with 1,800 troops, invades Canada. Aug. 8 — After various mishaps, Hull retreats to Detroit. " 9 — Col. Miller defeats Tecumseh and a body of British troops at Maguaga. " 15 — Ft. Dearborn (now Chicago) was abandoned by its small garrison, by the orders of Hull. During their retreat they were attacked, and most of them massacred by the Indians. " 16 — Gen. Hull surrendered Detroit and all the military forces and stores in the territory to the British. He was afterward sentenced THE WAK mi L8 L2, to death by a court-martial, but pardoned by tl degraded from all military command. « 18— The U. 8. frigate Constitution,- Capt, Hull.. American arms by the capture of the English i; This vessel had challenged the American ous way. She had 79 killed and wounded, th 13. There were 10 impressed American seamen on to I Sept. 7 — The U. S. frigate Essex captures the Alert in 8 mln Oct. 13 — In another invasion of Canada by Gen. Van K much gallantry was displayed, an unexpected British n ment obliged the surrender of 700 men after 100 bad been killed and wounded. " 18 — The U. S. sloop of war Wa>p captures the British sloop Frolic, which was the strongest vessel. The Frolii b id 10 and wounded, the Wasp but 10. Both were capturi d bj i Bi 74 pounder the same day. " 25 — Capt. Decatur, of the frigate United State-, captui nian, a British frigate. British loss 104, American on Nov. 22 — The U. S. brig Vixen is captured by the English fi:. .'• E nth ampton. Both were afterward shipwreck) d A presidential election in this month secured there-election Madison. Dec. 29 — The U. S. frigate Constitution, Commodore Bainbrid the British frigate Java, off the coast of Brazil. Amerii 44, British 151. These naval victories with BO little lo much exultation in America, and much surprise and mort.il tion in England. The Americans were able Beam< n. and long burned to avenge the insults and contempt of the I navy. Americans are capable of extraordinary vigor when tli>>r oughly aroused. The operations on land had been much Int with by the strenuous and almost treasonable opposition ol anti-war party, and this continued to be ..;. embarr I dorinn nearly its whole course. The general disfavor with wb violent opposition was regarded, however, and ti, for the President, so embarrassed, procured bi 1818. Military operations this year were, in part, m< »ging The regular force amounted to about 55, passed authorizing the construction of four 71 gun ships, and fours; and for an increase of the uavy on the I Jan. 22— A disastrous enterprise at Frenchtown (now results in the loss of nearly I American Chester. The wounded were left by Gen Proctor, commander, to be massacred by the Indiana 622 the war of 1812. " 23 — Geo. Clymer, of Pa., signer of the Declaration of Independence, died. " 26 — An act of Congress authorizes the President to borrow $16,000,000. " 27 — He is authorized to issue Treasury notes to the amount of $5,000,000. Feb. 24 — Tbe Hornet captures the British brig Peacock, on the coast of South America. The Delaware and Chesapeake bays are blockaded by the British about this time. Mar. 4 — Madison is inaugurated for his second term. " 8 — The emperor of Russia having offered his services as mediator between the United States and England, the President appoints commissioners to treat for peace. Apr. 10 — The British attack Lewiston, Del., but are repulsed after having bombarded it several days. " 27 — Americans under Gen. Pike, capture York, Upper Canada, with a large quantity of stores. Gen. Pike is killed. May 1 — The British Gen. Proctor besieges Gen. Harrison in Fort Meigs. " 5 — Gen. Clay coming to his assistance Proctor retreats. Col. Dudley, making a sortie from Ft. Meigs, is drawn into an ambuscade and loses 650 men. He is himself mortally wounded. The British Admiral Cockburn barbarously ravages the shores of Chesapeake bfiy. " 27 — Ft. George, at Niagara, surrenders to the Americans, and Sir Geo. Prevost is repulsed from Sacketts Harbor, N. Y., by Gen. Brown. June 1 — The U. S. frigate Chesapeake captured by the British frigate Shannon. American loss 133 ; British loss about half as many. Capt. Lawrence of the Chesapeake is mortally wounded. " 6 — Gens. Chandler and Winder surprised in the night by the enemy they were going to attack. The two generals are taken prisoners, but their troops repulse the enemy and retire. " 23 — Col. Boerstler, in command of an American force of 600 men, is surrounded by a superior force at Beaver Dams and compelled to surrender. " 25 — Admiral Cockburn, failing in his attack on the American forces at Craney Island, Va.. lands at Hampton and commits many out- rages. July 31 — American Com. Chauncy lands at York, U. C, captures and destroys stores, and the British do the same at Plattsburg, on lake Champlain. Aug. 2 — Gen. Proctor with 1,000 British and Indians attacks Col. Croghan with 160 men, at Ft. Stephenson, Lower Sandusky, O., and is repulsed with a loss of 150. About this time the American frigate Essex, Capt. Porter, cruising in the Pacific ocean, captured 12 armed British whalers. Tin; w ai: OJ L812. " 18— The American sloop-of-war Aj In the 1 nel, captured 21 British merchantmen, but * by the Pelican after a severe engagement. " 30— Tecumseh had Btirred up the ( reek Indian- to w attacked Ft, Minis, which they Bel on Are and creing all but 20 out of 400 men, women and children. Sept. 3— The American hrig Enterprise captures the Boxer on the Maine. " 10— Perry's victory on Lake Erie. Be captures the wh vessels) of the enemy. His Laconic dispatch to Gen.B . " We have met the enemy, and they are otu Oct. 5— Battle of the Thames (Upper Canada). Gen. Han ing the Americans, defeated the British and Indian-, under Proctor and Tecumseh. The latter was -lain. The Bril about 600 in killed, wounded and prisoners; ti • killed and HO wounded. " " Commodore Chauncy capture- ."> British v- Nov. 2 — Gen. Coffee attacks the Creek Indian- at Tallusha! warriors are killed. " 9 — Gen. Jackson defeats the Indians at Tallade of them. Two other battles with the I adians occurred this and one in Dec. in which they were defeated with and little loss to the Americans. Yet bo spirited and n they as to require to he almost exterminated before thej make peace. " 11 — 1,200 Americans, under Gen. Boyd, engage 'i-h ui Lt. Col. Morrison, and are repulsed with a loss of 8 loss 180. Dec. 10 — Ft. George, at Niagara, evacuated and the town ot by the Americans. " 19 — Ft. Niagara is taken hy the British and [ndianswhoi garrison. Youngstown, Lewistown, the T and Manchester, all in N. Y., are burned, in retaliation destruction of Newark. « 30— The British hum Black Rock, Buffalo, thi fleet, and large quantities of provisions Gen I as a proper retaliation. The burning of Newark but was avenged tenfold. Naturalized irishmen British in our armies this year, wi re Ben! to I for treason. An equal number of Ei oned by the American government and notice nor of Canada that they should fate as our Irish soldiers. This had its remained simply prisoners of war. Thisclaim action on the part of the English joverui 624 THE AVAB OF 1812. the principal causes of the war, was, from this time, practically relinquished. In December an embargo was laid by Congress on American goods and provisions, to prevent their being employed to supply the British blockading force and armies. It produced great discontent in New England, where a large part of the people were dependent on commerce, and were thrown into great distress. There wis much factious, and even seditious, opposition to the government. 1814. The army operations had been unsuccessful in Canada during the last of the campaign, owing, it was thought, to the inefficiency of the com- manders, and perhaps partly to the want of experience of their subaltern?. Changes, that were proved much for the better, were made, and the cam paign of this year, in this quarter, showed a more honorable record. Since the commencement of the war till this year, the English government had been carrying on an immense European war, which was closed by the abdication of Bonaparte and his banishment to the island of Elba. They prepared for a more vigorous effort in America, by sending consider- able armies of the veterans of Wellington, who had conquered in Europe. They had received the impression that the opposition to the war and t.v republican party, would cooperate with them, and that the}- might re-estab- lish their dominion over their former colonies. But they did not comprehend American character. Party politics have always been conducted in a bitter and hostile spirit, but that hostility has not been directed against their institutions. Extreme attachment to these, and jealous care to preserve all rights guaranteed by the Constitution, has always led the opposition to a close and sharp criticism of all measures of the party in power differing from their own interpretation of Constitutional rights. When these institutions are really in danger all parties unite in a defense, the obstinacy and vigor of which carries everything before it. It stops at no obstacles, hesitates before no sacrifices, and counts no odds. This became apparent to the British during the summer, dispelled forever their dream of conquest, and led to a peace at the close of the campaign. The British sent 14,000 troops to Canada this spring, which was supported, in July and August, by a large reinforcement. A strong naval force, with a large body of troops, was sent to invade the heart of the country and cap- ture Washington. After failing in maintaining their ground here, they were directed against the gulf coast and the Mississippi river, ending in their decisive defeat by Gen. Jackson, at New Orleans, Jan. 8th, 1815, nine days before the treaty of peace, signed at Ghent, in Belgium, Dec. 24, was known in America. Mar. 24— A loan of $25,000,000 authorized by Congress. " 27 — Gen. Jackson's defeat of the Indians at Great Horseshoe Bend, Ala. This battle accomplished the subjection of the Creek Indians. Jackson had fought them on the 21st, 24th and 27th of THE w ai: 01 L812. Jan., when they came, near defeating him, but not* their fierce ami obstinate bravery, be i qoered each lii finally, nearly exterminated them " 28 — The brilliant career of the IS. frigate Earn \. III th( i'. is terminated by its capture, at Valparaiso, Chili, by the Brit frigate Phebe and another Bloop of war. " 30 — Gen. Wilkinson is repulsed in an advance into Canada,*! La< -lie, and is afterwards tried bycourl martial. Gen. Brown command of the Niagara frontier, and Gen [zard of northern N V. April 21 — The U. S. sloop of war Frolic captured bj the Hri t i - li frigate Orpheus. " 27 — The U. S. sloop of war Peacock captures the British Epervier with $118,000 specie on board May 7 — A British force captures and destroj a the American fort at • i N. Y., and carries off several trims. " 29 — The Americans capture a British fore at Band; < In I k, N I June 9 — The U. S. sloop of war Rattlesnake captured by ■ British ship. " 12 — The U. S. sloop Syren captured by a British 74 « 28 — The U. S. sloop of war Wasp captures the British lloopof war Reindeer, in the British Channel. July 3 — Gen. Brown captures Ft. Erie, near Niagara, V 0. " 5— Battle of Chippewa, Canada. Gens. Brown, Scott, and Rip* aboutS.OOO men, were opposed by the British Gen Riall with equal number of the veterans of Waterloo. Gen B them with such prudence and valor aa to conquer a largi force before Gen. Ripley could conic up to hil lid. It "'"» » splendid test of American mettle. Loss of the British Ml. 328. The British fall back to Ft, George, " 11 — The British make a descent on the coast of Maine. » 25— Gen. Scott engages a British force of seven times hil nun. holds his ground for some hours when Gen. Ripley l aid, and they drive the British from the field; DUl I 1,600 men left, while the British have 5,000, they retire next day. The British lost 878, the American- 860. Aug. 4 — Americans besieged in Ft Erie. « «— First meeting of the U. S. and English Oomml H* ' peace, who arranged the term- at the close of ' ' English were very high in their demands till the (mil much vaunted veteran troops. " 9— The British make an unsuccessful attack on Btonlnj A treaty is made with the Creek Indians. " 16— The British repulsed from Ft. Brie with the low of t*» men. The Americans lost bi. 40 626 THE WAE OF 1S12. " 20 — A British force lauded from the fleet in the Chesapeake, marches on Washington. " 24 — The battle of Bladensburg, near Washington. The Americans, much inferior in numbers, were defeated. The British, under Gen. Ross, entered Washington the same day. They destroyed much private property, as well as public stores, buildings and documents. Not deeming it prudent to remain, the British retreated from Washington to their vessels, leaving the people greatly exasper- ated at conduct unworthy of the army of a civilized nation. M 27 — Alexandria, Va., delivers up the public stores and shipping there and much merchandise as a ransom from plunder and burning. Sept. 1 — The U. S. sloop of war Wasp captures the British sloop Avon. After taking three other prizes in European waters, she disappeared and v as never again heard of— supposed to have foundered at sea. The British Gen. Prevost advances toward Plattsburg, N. Y., with 12,003 veteran troops. " 11 — The battle of Plattsburg. Com. McDonough, American, with 4 vessels, 10 gun boats and 850 men, captures the British Com. Downie's fleet of 4 vessels, 12 gun boats and 1,000 men. A simul- taneous attack by Prevost on Plattsburg miscarried by the failure of the fleet and panic of the soldiers. They return, in disorder, to Canada. " 12 — The British who had captured Washington, appear near Balti- more and land a force which repulses the Baltimore militia, and. next day advances toward the city; but the attack seems so formidable to them that they retreat in the night to their vessels and depart. The British admiral could not reduce Ft. M'Henry so as to co-operate in an attack on the city by water. The patri- otic song, "The Star Spangled Banner," was written during this bombardment of Fort M'Henry. Gen. Ross, the British com- mander, was killed soon after the landing of the troops. About this time various attacks are made at different places on the coast of New England, and the British pretend, by proclama- tion, to take possession of all of Maine east of the Penobscot river and annex it to New Brunswick. " 17 — A sortie is made from Ft. Erie and the works of the enemy sur- prised and taken with a loss to him of 1,000 men in killed, wounded and prisoners. Thus, in the midst of ravages and alarms on the coast, the destruction of our commerce, the stagnation of business, the financial difficulties of the government that almost amounted to bankruptcy, and Ihc complaints of the peace party, (which pro- duced much alarm by the calling of a convention of the New England States, in December of this year, at Hartford, Conn.,) the THE W \i: OF 1812. honor df the United BtateBwat preserved. The formld in Canada had been bullied and def< ated, the capture nl V- . . ton followed immediately i>\ the withdrawal of the In a strong point made which had its effeel In substantial)) the cause that had brought <>n the war, for the American treaty negotiations in progress. The British now tamed I attention to the Mississippi river and th of the frail Mexico. Nov. 7--^Gen. Jackson takes Pensacola from the British, who wen labor ing to raise the Indians to war again. Dec. 15 — A British fleet captures the flotilla on Lake Borgne, Li " 22 — 12,000 British troops land below New Orleans, and repv Americans. " 24 — The treaty of peace is signed al Ghent, bul la not known in America until Feb. following. 1815. Jan. 8 — Gen. Jackson, with only 0,000 men, bad Intrenched I in front of the British, who now made an assault on hi- , They were repulsed with greal slaughter, losing their Packingham, and near 2,000 men. Jackson lost bul 7 killed 6 wounded. Tbe British retreated to their vet « 15— The U. S. frigate President captured by four English ra Feb. 18— Ft. Bowyer, near Pensacola, Fla., invested bj the British ' It surrenders on the 21st. « 17— The treaty of peace which arrived al New York on the 11th bj the British sloop of war Favorite, ratified by the American eminent and Peace proclaimed. « 24— Congress authorizes the loan of Sis, -I "0,000, and the i treasury notes to the amount of $35,000,000 « 28— The naval war was continued some time longer. Tie I frigate Constitution captures two British vessel* ofwai Cyane and the sloop Levant. off the Island of Madeira 1 the U. S. frigate Hornet captured the British brig Penguin, on coast of Brazil. The British government, elated by their triumph their large army accustomed to conquer in Europe, and I set free from the blockade of the Continent, though! easy conquest of An erica. But all their attempts W Had peace been mad.' a little later the ,\n„ obtained much better terms. This war had be,,, waged under manj difficult^ can administration. The countrj and its Institutions, and there was no sud. reserved fund of w« iltli always found in an old and well organ! largely on commerce, which was slmo I desU 628 THE WAK OF 1812. naval force of Great Britain, and the embargo policy. Our navy -was gallant and successful ; but the government lacked the means, and the unanimous support of the people, requisite to increase it to the necessary strength. The administration did not act with the vigor and efficiency calculated to bring all sections and classes to its support, and the people had not yet the experience and knowledge of the value and strength of their own institutions needful to inspire confidence, so that they were critical and diffi- cult to please, and this spirit impaired the efficiency of nearly all government measures. What they undertook could be only imper- fectly done. The old soldiers of the Revolution were dead or unfit by age for good service, and time was necessary to train others and ascertain who had the necessary military capacity for conducting operations with success. Yet, under all these great difficulties, the United States came out of the war with the respect of the world, such as it had never before enjoyed. It became formidable to Europe as a great and vigorous power with which it was not safe to trifle. This was still more clear when the government declared war on the Dey of Algiers, one of the pirate princes of the North of Africa, which, for hundreds of years, had made war on the com- merce of all nations almost with impunity. Having violated their treaty with us, the President sent out an adequate naval force June 17-19— which captured two Algerine vessels of war, and threat- ened Algiers. The Dey, intimidated, immediately made peace, giving liberty to all prisoners without ransom, and full satisfaction for the injuries clone to our commerce. No Euro- pean nation had before so humbled these pirates, and it at once raised the credit of our government, and gained us respect and esteem. June 30— The last hostile act at sea took place in the Straits of Sunda, in the East Indies, where the U. S. brig of war Peacock captured the Nautilus, a British sloop of war. Thus the three American vessels at sea when the war closed, each came home crowned with laurels. The British vessels captured during the war num- bered 1,750— the American 1,683. The spirit and energy of the Americans, under all their embarrassments, gave an unmistakable indication of the future greatness and power of the United States. 1816. The last two years' experience had taught the government and the people many important lessons by which they hastened to profit. The coast was fortified, the navy increased, manufactures and commerce encouraged, and the best measures that the wisdom of the times could suggest, employed to restore the finances. The violently factious opposition of parties was much moderated by the confidence gained to our government and institu- HISTORY OF Till: I Mill. - lions, and the evident folly of excessive fears. The Second Itak was chartered for 20 years, with a capital of 185,000,000 Nov. 5 — Governeur Morris, an »*, this autumn, elected President. CHAPTER X X I. HISTORY OF THE l. S. FROM IM7 To 1-; Monroe's Adminisi ka i i. >n. A new era for America commenced witli this administration, or ratfcflr, reached its period of uninterrupted development; for the whole past hi*, tory of the country had heen a preparation for it, bat especially eo the war and its results. The failure of the French revolution, and, tin I the failure of Napoleon Bonaparte and the re-establishment of the old D archy in France, as a result of the excesses, first of the Preach repnl and then of the military interference of Bonaparte W Ith tb€ I I of things in Europe, had an important, influence in modifying the polit of the republican party in the Unite. i Slates; so that they came partially in Jefferson's administration, and completely by the close ■•: M • to follow the wise and vigorous policy pursued by Washington federal party; while the general government and the InstitUtloi country became deeply imbued with the regard to popular rights, • attention to the interests and will of the people that formed t J » . - leading of Jefferson and the original democrat, or, as It was then called, thi lican party. Thus the two points of supreme Important general government, and security to the people, were happily mingled and wrought into the spirit and form of our institutions The leading events of Monroe's two administrations were U given to internal improvements— among which maj be mentioi canal in New York, and the encouragements to manul sition of Florida from Spain, and a definite settlement of the si iverj tion(forthe next thirty years only, as ii proved,) by the M promise. Thepeople n<.\v began to feel and act togethi and material progress was rapid. 1817. Mar. 3— The observance of the neutrality laws strictly enjoined 00 I muss* of the United States by Congn " 4— James Monroe, the fifth President, inamruraf .1 With istration commences -the era..! g I reelll I w»» called. The bitterness of party controvi 630 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. June 24 — Thos. McKean, of Del., signer of the Declaration of Independ- ence, died. Dec. — Mississippi admitted into the Union, and Alabama erected into a territory. " — A war broke out with the Seminole Indians, on the borders of Florida. It came near involving us in a war with Spain. Inter- nal taxes are abolished by Congress. 1818. Mar. 18 — A law enacted giving pensions to indigent officers and soldiers. April 4 — The Flag of the U. S. rearranged ; the stripes to represent the thir- teen original States, the stars the present number of States. " 18 — Illinois is authorized to form a state constitution. May 24 — Gen. Jackson took Pensacola, Fla., from the Spaniards on account of the support given by them to the Indians. Oct. 20 — A treaty of commerce and for settling boundaries is made with England. 1819. Feb. 23 — A treaty for the session of Florida ratified by Congress, but not by the king of Spain until Oct. 20th, 1820. Mar. 2 — Arkansas organized into a territory. Dec. 14 — Alabama admitted into the Union. In this year commenced the discussion on the balance between the north and the south in relation to slavery. Missouri and Maine both desire admission as States. The discussion resulted in a settlement of the whole question Feb. 27th, 1821, by the appli- cation of the " Missouri Compromise " to the admission of that State. 1820. Feb. 15 — Wm. Ellery, of R. I., signer of the Declaration of Independence > died. Mar. 15 — Maine admitted into the Union. Aug. 23 — Com. Perry, the hero of Lake Erie, died in the West Indies. The 4th census was taken in this year. 1821. Mar. 4 — James Monroe inaugurated on his second term. " 22 — Com. Decatur died at Washington. Aug. 22 — Gen. Jackson takes possession of Florida as its Governor. The U. S. government paid $5,000,000 for Florida. The Spanish officers were reluctant and dilatory in giving up their places, and Gen. Jackson had occasion for his remarkably decisive action in deal- ing with them. The governor, Don Cavalla, refusing to give up certain papers according to the treaty, he sent him to prison until all the papers were produced, and banished six other Spanish officers who interfered with him. HISTORY OF Till: [JOTTED >l\ I I B. 1823. June — A commercial treaty is negotiated with 1 the U. S. schooner Alligator, en. band of pi] ' West Indies, captures one of their acho and n . five American vessels, ('apt. Allen is killed. The ports of the West India islands are opened to Amerl merce by the English government Com. Truxton, a meritorious naval officer — G i.. the hero of Bennington, Vt., — and Wm. Lowndes, a stati man died tli is year. A new arrangement of the ratio of Representation gfr»i aem- her of Congress to 40,000 inhabitants. 182::. Com. Porter makes a successful expedition against tin- \V< -i [ndian pirates. This year our government acknowledged the Independence of the E American Republics, and ministers were appointed to Mexico, Oolnn Buenos Ayres, and Chili. A treaty for the mutual suppression of the slave trade \ :•• t>y Great Britain and the United States. 1824. April — American and Russian commissioners settle the boundai between the two countries. Aug. 15 — Lafayette arrives from France. He was everywhere the guest of the people with the utmost affection and fl He spent a year visiting all parts of the Union. A presidential election this autumn does not result in achi and the House of Representatives made selection of John Adams, from the candidates, according to a provision of thi I stitution, anticipating such a ease. A protective tariff \s I this year to encourage cotton manufactun Administration of John Quinoy A DA MR 1886. Mar. 4 — J. Q. Adams inaugurated sixth President " "—An act of Congress establishes a navy yard at 1' • June 11— Dan. D. Tompkins, Vice-President with Monr Nov. 10— Com. McDonough, the hero of Lake ( hamplain. died 1836. July 4— John Adams and Thos. Jefferson, whose livi 1<"«' : the foundation and development of our Institution! eously died on this day. Sept. 11— Wm. Morgan, an anti-mason, mysterion ■">• ind » never again heard of. 032 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. 1827. An Anti-Mason party is formed, opposing secret societies. Much " polit- cal capital " is made of it. Jan. — The first considerable railroad was begun, and completed in May. It was nine miles long, a beginning of the wonderful transforma- tion that was to be produced by this agent. 1828. Feb. 11 — De Witt Clinton, governor of N. Y. and originator of the Erie canal, died. The tariff was amended and enlarged this year. This tariff was violently opposed in the South and produced the " Nullification Ordinances" of S. C, some time later. In the fall of this year Gen. Andrew Jackson was elected President. 1829. Feb. 29 — The Virginia Legislature passes a resolution denying the right of Congress to pass a protective tariff law. Mar. 4 — Andrew Jackson inaugurated as President. Dan. Webster makes his great speech against nullification. Jackson's Administration. 1829. May 19 — A treaty of friendship and commerce concluded with Brazil. " " — John Jay, exJ?resident of the Continental Congress, Chief Justice of the U. S., Governor of N. Y., etc., died. In purity of patriot, ism, moderation, and soundness of judgment, he came nearer to Washington than any of his contemporaries. He was above the reach of the violent party spirit that prevailed after Washington's retirement from public life. 1830. May 7 — A treaty made with Turkey gives U. S. commerce the freedom of the Black sea. The vigorous dealing of our government with the Barbary States secured the respect and friendship of Turkey. The important movement and interests of this year were connected with the progress of railroads (the first American built locomotive was made this year,) and the rapid rise of that great interest, and with the agitation produced by the nullification proceedings of South Carolina. That State claimed the right to pronounce upon, and disregard the enactments of Congress. This was subversive of the Constitution. It drew the " Key Stone " from the arch, and the whole structure of the Union would have fallen. No decisive action was reached till the year 1832. 1830. May 29 — The office of Solicitor of the Treasury created. 1831. Jan. 10 — The King of the Netherlands, being accepted as arbitrator of the HISTORY OF T1IK IMIKM SI A IKS. northern boundary between tin- United and the Bl sessions, by the two governments, decides the qm itioo in favor. July 4 — James Monroe, ex-President of the is..; Oct. 1 — A free trade convention meets a: Philadelphia. " 26 — A tariff convention meets al New Fork. There wr. delegates. It was the absorbing political topic of the time. 1832. April 1 — Tbe Black Hawk war breaks <>ut by the attack of the \\ inn goes, Sacs, and Foxes from the west bank of tie' M i t mippi on the settlers in Illinois, under the Indian chief, Black Hawk " 2 — The Creek Indians sell all their lands east of the Ml ilpplrlTcr to the U. S. May 5 — A commercial and boundary treaty concluded with M " 27 — A new ratio of representation based on the Btfc census member of Congress to 47,700 inhabitants. June 1 — Gen. Sumter, a South Carolina hero of the Revolution, dii " 9 — The cholera breaks out at Quebec, Lower Canada. the country, following the lakes and rivers and routes of tr . with fearful violence. July — The cholera breaks up Gen. Scott's army, on the way to met t Mack Hawk while in vessels on the lakes. « 9— Congress creates the office of Commissioner of Indian " 10— Naval hospitals established at Charlestown, Ha »klya, N Y., and Pensacola, Fla. « " —The President vetoes the bill rechartering the I - 'ik Aug. 27— Gen. Atkinson defeats the Indians and takes Black Hawk prisoner. Nov. 14— Chas. Carroll, of Carrollton, Md., last surviving signer of D of Ind., dies. " 19— An anti-tariff convention in S. ('. Issues the fine-; tion Ordinance." « 24— The Unionists of S. C. meet and pi ain-t this "Mi- Dec. 10— President Jackson issues a proclamation against th He followed word with deed, garrisoning the fori vessels of war into the harbor of Charleston, Hi- vigor left the nulliflers no hope of success, and Ihev Ba i mitted. " 18 — A commercial treaty concluded with Russia « 20— Gov. Hayne, of S. C, defies the President In ■ oo«nfe« pro ■ mation. " 28— J. C. Calhoun, of B. C, the Vice Presid. i President Jackson is reelected this ML Hil measures made him very popular. (!34 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. 1833. Feb. 12 — Henry Clay introduces a bill on the tariff compromising the points at issue between the manufacturing States and the South. Mar. 3 — It becomes a law, and gives general satisfaction. " 4 — President Jackson reinaugurated on his second term. May 20— The death of La Fayette, in France. June 1 — Oliver Wolcott, Sec. of the Treasury under Washington, dies. July 27 — Com. Bainbridge, a famous naval commander, dies. Sept. 30 — President Jackson removes his Sec. of Treas. W. J. Duane, for refusing to carry out his policy in regard to the U. S. Bank. The presence of the Indians in Mississippi, Alabama, Georgia, and Florida, produces so much conflict and so frequent a necessity for chastising them that they are in danger of total extermination. Gen. Jackson persuades Congress and the Indians to arrange for their removal to lands west of the Mississippi. Some of the Indi- ans quietly remove this year. Many resist, but all are finally persuaded to this course by Gen. Scott and others, except the Seminoles of Fla. 1834. Mar. 28 — Congress formally censures the President for his course in regard to the U. S. Bank. Oct. 28 — A conditional treaty made with the Seminoles at Payne's Landing, May 9, 1832, for their removal to the Indian Territory west of the Mississippi, was afterwards confirmed by the chiefs but rejected by the people. Gen. Thompson was sent, at this time, by Presi- dent Jackson to insist on their carrying out the treaty. Dec. 28 — A council of the Indians, called by Gen. Thompson, seemingly accept the terms of the President. 1835. Mar. 3 — Congress establishes branch mints in La., N. C, and Ga. May 14 — A treaty with the Cherokees purchases all their lands east of the Mississippi for $5,262,251, and ample lands in exchange in the Indian Territory. June 3 — Osceola, a Seminole chief, imprisoned by Gen. Thompson. July 6 — Chief Justice Marshall dies, aged 80. Dec. 16— A destructive fire in New York. $17,000,000 worth of property consumed. " 28 — The Seminoles killed their chief, Mathla, who had been promin- ent in making the obnoxious treaty, and suddenly attack a U. S. force under Maj. Dade. But one man out of 110 escaped. He was wounded and afterwards died. The same day Gen. Thompson and others were surprised and massacred. " 31 — Gen. Clinch is attacked by the Indians at Withlacoochee. He repulses them and retires. HISTORY OF Till. UNITED 8Ti 1886 Early in this yearthe Indians laid wa.tr the whole country, bun buildings and killing all who had not taken refugt in Jan. 20— A treaty of friendship and commerce concluded win. • tblk of Venezuela, South America Feb. —The U. S. Bank was chartered by the Legislature of !'i " 11— Gen. Gaines lands an army at Tampa H< Isrorroui the Indians on his march toward Fort King, He n pnlsod th« ..',. but his army is nearly starved. While the arm] la held tribe remove their families and effects Into the lmp< i swamps of the interior. Mar. 2 — The Texans proclaim their independence, Apr. 26— Wisconsin receives a territorial government " 21 — Battle of San Jacinto. Santa Anna taken priaoner. June 15— Michigan erected into a State, conditionally. " " — Arkansas admitted into the Union. " 23— A surplus revenue having accumulated it la loaned to ti S " 28— James Madison, the ex-President, dies, &j ed B6 July 4 — Office of Commissioner of Patents created. Sept. 15— Aaron Burr, an able but dishonest and disloyal merly Vice-President, dies, aged 81. The Creek Indians commenced hostilities in May of this ymr, in their usual fierce and barbarous manner. Get 8 ottandtheBta authorities of Geo. subdue them early in the Bummer. In the presidential election this fall Martin Van Bureo Dec. 15— The General Post Office and Patent oilier, with main and articles of value, are destroyed by fire. 1887. Jan. 16 — The U. S. Senate repealed and expunged tta resolution of Kama 24th, 1834, censuring President Jackson, aa bavin l»i» Constitutional powers when he ordered the public funds to be withdrawn from the U. S. Hank. Mar. 4 — Van Buren inaugurated President. Speculation having been carried to an extreme length t time, and somewhat arrested by the "specie circular 1 n payments for public lands to he made in coin, a revulsion, • ing great distress, and suspension of payments by the baa occurred this spring. May 3— The merchants of New York preaenl a memorial to thi Pi urging him to remit the regulations "t th< The President declines, hut calls an extl Aug. 4— Texas proposes annexation to the U.B. Thi to entertain the proposition. " 13— The banks resume specie paj menta Sept. 4— Congress assembled in extra session A portioa -urplui 036 HISTOKT OF THE UNITED STATES. revenue, which, by law of June 23d, 1836, was to be loan^ *o ft* States, is reclaimed to meet the current expenses of the govern- ment. " 29— A treaty made with the Sioux Indians for the purchase of then lands, 5,000,000 acres, for $1,000,000. Oct. 1— The Winnebagoes sell their lands for $1,500,000. « 12— Congress authorizes the issue of $10,000,000 in Treasury notes. « 21— Osceola, the Seminole chief, with 70 of his warriors, visits the camp of Gen. Jessup. They are detained, and Osceola was impris- oned in Ft. Moultrie, S. O, where, in a few months, he died. Dec. 25— The battle of Okee-cho-bee fought with the Seminoles in the swamps of Florida, by Col. Zachary Taylor. The Indians are defeated. The Magnetic Telegraph was patented in this year. 1838. Jan. 5— The President issues a proclamation enjoining neutrality on Amer- ican citizens, during the " Patriot war," or insurrection in Canada. June 12 — Iowa receives a Territorial government. Aug. 19— An Arctic exploring expedition, with six vessels, sails from Hamp- ton Roads, Va. The Cherokee Indians completed their emigration to the Indian Territory this year. 1839. Gen. Macomb makes a treaty early in this year with the Seminoles, which they very imperfectly kept. A difficulty with England in regard to our northeast boundary narrowly avoids war, but is, at length, peaceably adjusted. Dec. 2 — Congress assembles. « 4 — A Whig Convention prepares for the contest of the coming year by the nomination of Win. H. Harrison for the Presidency. Great discontent was felt with the financial policy of Van Buren's administration, and lively interest taken in the coming election, which made the campaign the most stirring and the noisiest ever experienced in this country. 1840. May 5— The Democrats renominate Van Buren for the Presidency. This year was chiefly memorable for the "Log Cabin and Hard Cider" election gatherings, and the extreme interest of the people in the elections, on financial grounds. June 30— Congress passes the sub-treasury bill recommended by President Van Buren, in 1837, but then rejected. Nov. — W. H. Harrison elected President, and John Tyler Vice-President 1841. Jan. 14 — Imprisonment for debts due the U. S. abolished. Mar. 4 — Harrison inaugurated ninth President. HISTORY OF THE DOTTED STATES. " 11 — The steamer President sails from New York Inn heard of. She had 109 passengers. «« 17 — The President calls an extra session of Con r tlnitu cial questions. • Apr. 4 — President Harrison died and John Tyler became acting May 31 — Congress convenes. June 25 — Gen. Macomb died. July 6 — The proceeds of the public lands ordered to be distributed to States. " 21— Congress orders a loan of $12,000,000. Aug. 9 — The Sub Treasury act repealed. " 16 — President Tyler vetoes the National Bank bill. " 18 — A general bankrupt law passed. Sept. 9 — A Second Banking Bill vetoed. This was the fourteenth time the veto power had been used; by Washington twice, M I times, Monroe once, Jackson live times. Oct. 11 — Failure of U. S. Bank under the Pennsylvania charter. 1842. June 25 — The new Ratio of Representation, based on the census of ; - gives one Member of Congress for every 70,600 inhabitant*. July 23 — Bunker Hill Monument finished and dedicated I stone was laid by Lafayette 17 years before. Aug. 20— The Ashburton treaty -with England, settling the N. E B on I ratified by the U. S. Senate. " 28— The U. S. fiscal year ordered to commence with July 1st Oct. 2— The U. S. sloop of war Concord wrecked on the African 00 " 14— The Ashburton-Webster treaty ratified in England 1843. Mar. 3— Congress appropriates $30,000 for building Mora tele- graph from Washington to Baltimore, (twas the beginning d that magnificent enterprise. Com. Porter, minister to Turkey, dies in Oonatantinop Apr. 18— Commences "Dorr's rebellion" in Rhode [aland. Aug. 26— The U. S. frigate Missouri burned, al Gibraltar, Spain. 1844 Feb. 28— A large cannon on board the war steamer Princeton, bural the President and others are visiting the roeael, kil Upshur and Gilmer, secretaries of war and n i *he May 6-The "Know-nothing" or American excitement produces a • riot in Philadelphia. July 7-Jo. Smith, the originator of the Mormon., kill. Nov. -The Democratic party elected James EL Polk for 1 chief question entering into the election wis on tie of Texas. It had been Bought for BOOK declined as certain to bring on a war with Hea MM, - • (»3S HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. sister republic, and much weaker than ourselves, had been con- sidered to be an unworthy act. The Whigs, with Henry Clay as their candidate for President, opposed it. It was carried, in great part as a pro-slavery measure, although the bitter and barbarous conduct of the Mexicans toward Texans and American citizens had something to do with it. 1845. Jan. 16 — A treaty made with China, ratified by the U. S. Senate. " 23— An act of Congress orders presidential elections to be held in all the States on the first Tuesday after the first Monday in November. Feb. 28 — Congress annexes Texas to the Union, by a joint resolution of both Houses. Mar. 3 — Florida admitted into the Union. " 4 — Mr. Polk inaugurated the tenth President. June 18 — Andrew Jackson died. The Congress of Texas accepted the conditions of the U. S. and it became a State in the American Union. July 30 — Gen. Taylor ordered to the frontier of Texas. Sept. 10— Judge Joseph Story, of the U. S. Supreme Court, died, aged 66. Dec. 15— A misunderstanding had long existed between the U. S. and Eng- land as to the northern boundary of Oregon. Much excitement is now produced by a speech and resolution of Mr. Cass, which seemed the prelude to war with Great Britain. 1846. June 18 — A treaty was negotiated by Mr. Packenham and Mr. Buchanan settling the northwest boundary satisfactorily. CHAPTER XXII. THE MEXICAN WAR Texas was a nearly uninhabited part of Mexico, lying between Louisiana and the Rio Grande river. It was a fertile region, with a fine climate. The Spanish possessors of Mexico, in the bigoted and bitter spirit that was traditional with the Spaniards toward protestants, and deeply hostile in feeling from the rather high-handed and vigorous proceedings of Gen. Jackson before and after the cession of Florida, did not encourage the set- tlement of Texas; preferring to be separated by a wilderness from the United States. In 1821 the Mexicans finally threw off the Spanish yoke and established an independent government. About this time the Americans, and especially those of the South, fore- seeing the probable spread of the northern part of the Republic to the Pacific, began to look with covetous eyes on the fine Savannas of Texas, aa THE Ml XICAN w \K. an excellent field for land spe, , and al ern area, so as to keep its balance in the aura the free States of the North, as they had been provided Compromise. It was believed i<> be the plan of Mr. Calhi far-seeing statesman, thoroughly in earnest in the mail and the political equality of the slave with the fi ment was' made by people from the United States. 1 grew to be numerous, and came in conflict with the rig i deans w< in their purpose to hold it, and bring its people under the doro in li strict Mexican law. The Americans resisted this with the seltli mination of ultimate separation from .Mexico, ami probable annex the United States. The Mexicans undertook to reduce them t" submission. Tin supported by bold and fearless adventurers from the Boat] resisted. The war commenced Oct. 2d, 1885, by a battle at Goni il< /. t"l lowed by various others. March 2d, 1886, the Texans formally Independence, which they maintained by force of arm Mar* h the United States government recognized the [ndependeno England did the same in 18 I -'. Propositions of annex ition bad 1" ■ to Presidents Jackson. A'an Buren, and Tyler, sui Bly.byth I government, but as often rejected by them as tending with Mexico; that power having distinctly aid repeatedly d< she should regard such a step as a declaration of war. The Democratic party regaining the ascendency in tie- i lection ,, made this annexation the issue of the presidential campaign. A maj of the people were in favor it. The Southern view, however, was nol alone in it- infill thil ion. Indignities and injuries had been inflicted by the M< ican citizens in that, country ; its haughty, ex< Lusive, ami unfrlen -awakened strong indignation; and He' Pacific coasl of Californ mining regions of the northern interioi of Mexico, both nearlj muni, were objects of desire to the American people Thus a wish • bounds of the Republic, ami to chastise an insolent ncighb with the ardent wishes of th<' pro-slaverj u tore mine on a war, somewhat ungenen usly, with * neighbor weak and disorganized for effectual resistance 1 United States. The whole plan, as afterward car.:, ,1 nut. «.■. thecabinetatWashingtonalmostbeforehostilitleBhad ictuallyc 1846 Mar. 38— Gen. Taylor take p, jition with a small an the Rio Grande opposite Matamoras 'I'!"- the ment regard as a declaration of war, tor which the] and were waiting. 040 THE MEXICAN WAK. Apr. 24— Hostilities commence by an attack on Capt. Thornton. He loses 16 men out of 63, and surrenders. May 8— The battle of Palo Alto. Gen. Taylor with 2,300 men defeats 6,000 Mexicans. Mexican loss 100 killed, 300 wounded ; American 4 killed 40 wounded. " 9— The battle of Resaca de la Palma. The Mexicans are totally defeated with a loss of about 600 ; the Americans lose about 160. Gen. La Vega, (Mexican,) taken prisoner. The Mexicans fled in total rout across the Rio Grande. The object of the war, so far as Texas was concerned, was gained ; but the Mexicans were still spirited, and California, Utah, and New Mexico were not gained. An invasion and march on the city of Mexico were the next steps. « 12— Congress ordered the raising of 50,000 men, and voted $10,000,000* to carry on the war. j u ly 6— Monterey, on the California coast is taken by the American navy under Com. Sloat. « 9 — Congress re-cedes the Virginia portion of the District of Colum- bia to that State. « 30— The tariff on imported goods is reduced. Aug. 3— President Polk vetoes the River and Harbor Bill. « 8 — He vetoes the French Spoliation Bill. « 18— Gen. Kearney takes possession of Santa Fe, New Mexico, and declared the IT. S. authority established over the people. " 22— California is at this time entirely in the possession of U. S. forces. Sept 5— Gen. Taylor, with 6,000 men, commences his march on Monterey. « 21— Gen. Worth, with 050 men, fights the Mexicans near Monterey. « 22— The "Bishops Palace," strongly fortified, is stormed and taken. The previous attacks were directed on the rear of Monterey. An. advance is now made in front with success. " 23 — The defenses are assaulted in front and rear. The city surrenders. Gen. Ampudia, the Mexican commander, had about 10,000 men and very strong fortifications. A truce of some weeks was agreed upon. Gen. Santa Anna having recently come into power, it was thought peace would be made. This proved delusive. Oct. 25— Tobasco bombarded by the U. S. fleet, and the Mexican vessels in the port taken or destroyed, j^ov. 14 — Tampico surrenders to Com. Connor. Dec. 25— Battle of Bracito. Col. Doniphan, with 500 men, defeats a Mexi- can force of 1,200. Mexican loss 200, American but 7 wounded, none killed. 1847. Jan. 8— The Mexican Congress votes $15,000,000 to carry on the war, to be raised on the property of the church. Feb. 23— The larger part of Gen. Taylor's army was withdrawn from him to support Gen. Scott in his march from Vera Cruz on the city of THE Mi.xc an \v.\i;. Mexico. Gen. Taylor, with onlj 4,600 n i n. i- attai ;.•■! Anna with 20,000 men. Banta Anna [g c pl< tely dcf loss in killed and wounded ol 3,000. American 450 wounded, £6 missing. Mar. 1— Gen. Kearney proclaims California annex. .1 to tie " 3 — A bill admitting Wisconsin into the I nion " 9— Gen. Scott landed 12,000 men at Vera I I " 18 — The cannonade of Vera Cruz comment " 26 — Vera Cruz capitulate-, to I ten. Scott. Apr. 18 — The battle of Cerro Gordo. Santa Anna i> defeated, H< 12,000 men. Gen. Scott 8,500. The Mexicans lost 1,100 in killed and wounded, and 3,000 prisoners. Gen. Scott losl In killed wounded, 430. The Mexicans were vigorously pursued Aju. and the city of Jalapa taken possession o£ " 22 — Gen. Worth takes possession of the town and east! May 15 — Puebla is entered. It is the Becond city in Mexico. Offers of peace were now made by the Americans but rej< the Mexicans. Aug. 11 — The army advances to the neighborhood of the city of M • " 19 — The battle of Contreras. Americans successful in CUttfc enemy's communications. The Americans march in the oigl attack a fortified camp which is carried at sunrise, A force 4,500, Mexican 7,000. Mexican loss in killed, wounded prisoners, about 4,000; American, 86. " 20— Cherubusco, a fortified hill, stormed ami taken by Gen Worth with 9,000 men. An armistice is now agreed on, and ; • offered, but the Mexicans still hold to their first terms, ami r- I to give up territory. Sept. 8— The Mexicans determine to yield only to absolute force, American army again advances. Battles of Hollo edi Casa Mata. The Mexicans are largelj superior in nural fight with determined valor, but areovercome Ameri « 18— Battle of Chapultepec. This fortress was the 1 to the City of Mexico. It was once the site of thi Montezumas." The Mexican force within and OUl 20,000. The American force 7,180 Mel wounded, prisoners and deserted, about M" A part of the army gained a foothold in the < it\ . : '•' " 14— Gen. Scott enters Mexico in triumph. Oct. 9— Battle of Buamantla. Banta Anna again defl «■ 18— Again at Attixco, with heavj loss. Santa Ann.; • • by his troops, and resigns his offli Nov. 11— The Mexican Congress assembles, and appohi ■•• • to treat for peace. 41 642 HISTORY OF THE U. S. 1848. Feb. 2 — A treaty of peace signed at Guadalupe Hidalgo (a town four miles from Mexico). " 23 — John Quincy Adams expires at Washington. May 20 — The treaty having been ratified by the President and Senate of the U. S., March 10, it was followed by that of the Mexican gov- ernment on this day. " 23 — Peace was proclaimed in the American camp. The war was now over. The Mexicans relinquished all claim to Texas, and ceded Upper California and New Mexico to the United States. In return the United States gave them $18,500,000 of which $3,500,000 was due by a former treaty to citizens of this country and paid them by our government. It will not be easy for an American to wholly condemn an act that gave us California and the fertile valleys and vast mining territory of the Pacific slope as well as New Mexico, or the chas- tisement which the Mexicans had merited for their barbarity; though he may blame the eagerness for the acquisition of territory and the support of slavery that led us to invade another country and humble her pride. The ability of Americans as soldiers would appear by this war to be unrivalled, and, in that view arouses our pride. The moral sense of the world must ever be shocked by war, though there seem many cases in which it is far the least of two evils. Our government was fairly generous so far as it dared be in dealing with the vanquished, as soon as its demands for territory were satisfied. It is also evident that this territory will be better developed and governed than would have been the case under Mexican rule. Aug. 14 — Oregon receives a Territorial government. Nov. — Gen. Taylor was elected President this month and Millard Fill- more Vice-President. 1849. Jan. 26 — Postal treaty with England concluded. Mar. 3 — Minnesota receives a Territorial government. " 4 — Gen. Taylor inaugurated President. May 7— Gen. Worth, a very gallant officer of the Mexican war, died. Sept. — A State Constitution is formed by the people of California, which excludes slavery. Dec. 31 — The Mouse of Representatives ballots 63 times for a speaker, and now elects Howell Cobb, of Geo. Gold was discovered in California, in Feb. 1848, and through 1849 emigrants — gold seekers — were arriving there by tens of thousands. By the end of this year it w r as a populous region. The mass of American immigrants were from the northern States, and disapproved of slavery, while the special end of the Mexican BI8T0E1 01 i in I . war was to procure more territory for thai institutl time u violent contest was waged in Congress over thai It was not ended until late in the followin I860. Jan. —Gen. Twiggs obtains the consenl oi the Semlnoli emigrate to the Indian Territory. Feb. 13— President Taylor sends the constitution of California I There were many threats ol secession in < was admitted free. Mar. 7 — Mr. Webster's great speech for the Union. May 8— The "Omnibus Bill " reported by Henry Clay. " 18 — A private expedition from the south under command ol ' invades Cuba. They are driven oil with a loss of 80 killed executed as pirates, on the 19th. The remainder returned I West on the 22d of the same month. Jul)' 9 — Death of President Taylor. Fillmore becomes acting Pn Sept. 9-20 — A committee of thirteen, of which Henry Claj had been appointed Apr. 19th, and they bad pn pared four m ures forming a compromise between the North and South slavery, which were debated and passed into law concurrence of the President: First, the South conceded t" the North the admission of California as a free State, and thi tion of the slave trade in the District "i Columbia; Second North conceded to the South a Btringent Fugitive Slav.- I the organization of Territorial Governments in New M and Utah without mention of slavery, hut in the understanding 'dial they were finally to form slave Stale-. The real fain « North, as anti-slavery was advanced two Steps, while the i Law could not be generally enforced i:i the North from thi cible aversion of the people to it, and the Southern peo| not sufficiently migratory in their habit- to Introduce distant regions not naturally adapted to that Institution - question was laid aside for the present Nov. 19— Richard M.Johnson, a former Vice-President <>\ the I B Dec. 16— A treaty of Amity and Commerce ratified with Bw L861. Mar. 3— A cheap postage law passed by Oongn John C. Calhoun, the most eminent of Southern St . 1852. June 28— Henry Clay, orator and Btatesman, died. Julv 3— A branch mint established at San Francisi Oct.24-Daniel Webster died. The- three were ti, esteemed statesmen of their day. Nov. —The seventeenth presidential election occurred. I was elected. He was the Democratic nomb was defeated. H44 HISTORY OF THE L'. S. 1853. Mar. 4 — Pierce inaugurated President. Aug. 11 — Proclamation of President Pierce against the invasion of Cuba by armed Americans. 1854. Mar. 23 — An important treaty of commerce negotiated with the empire of Japan by Com. Perry, which opened a new era in the progress of that country, and of United States commerce and influence in Asia. May 30 — The failure of the compromise measures of 1850 to realize the hopes of the South from the rapid development of anti-slavery views in the North caused the subject to be again agitated, and the Missouri Compromise, which stopped the formation of slave States- north of its south boundary line, was repealed ; the question of the admission of slavery into Kansas and Nebraska, both being north of that line, being referred by the famous " Kansas-Nebraska Bill " to the "squatters," or first settlers. This was called "squatter sovereignty." This measure gave satisfaction to the South, but was strongly reprobated by many of the Northern people. Both sides prepared to renew the contest there, and civil war raged in Kansas for near three years. Each side sought to secure its end which terminated in favor of the North. The South could not compete with it in numbers nor drive the extra numbers away. This was the last hope of the South for preserving equilibrium in the general government. The Democratic party in the North, anxious to soothe and concil- iate the South, and not holding so advanced opinions against slavery, was still strong enough to maintain itself in power in the administration; but the Republican party, formed about this time by the dissolution of the Whig party, constantly grew in numbers and influence, and, by the end of the next administration its numbers were so large and the ultimate result so certain that the South resolved on secession rather than give up their favorite institution. 1855. Feb. 24 — The Court of Claims, an important relief to Congress and to claimants against the government, was established in Washington, by Congress. 1856. Mar. 4 — A Free State Legislature assembles in Kansas. It adopted a con- stitution and prepared to apply for admission into the Union. Nov. —The eighteenth presidential election took place. James Buchanan was elected against J. C. Fremont and Millard Fillmore. Buchanan was the Democratic candidate ; Fremont, Republican, and Fillmore, American, or " kaow nothing " candidate. thk on II. u ai:. L857. Feb. 2— Nathaniel Hanks of Mass., a Republican, I House of Representatives. It had required two montha ballotings to settle this poinl ; indicating the near] of parties, and the final success of the Republii an element ii. popular branch of Congress Mar. 4 — Buchanan inaugurated President The next three years (after the decision of the K were marked by the unnatural quiet that forebodes th- Anti-slavery feeling was maturing in the North, and dii and secession tendencies in the South. 1858. May 11 — Minnesota admitted into the Union as a State 1859. Feb. 14— Oregon admitted into the Union as a State. The admission <>f these two without any corresponding ones in the South indie the strength of Northern sentiment, and that the South b I up the struggle in that way. John Brown's raid on Harper*! Perry, in this year, as showing the tone of Northern feeling, still further estranged the South from the Union. CHAPTER XXIII. THE CIVIL WAR Was the inevitable result of an antagonism of interest-, sentiments, and social structure in the two great sections of the Union— the North and the South. The foundation of these tendencies was laid before th 4 \< th of the new nation from England and other European powi I • - visions of the Constitution involved a compromise betw« D thi Norta the South; and a constant series of compromhl bo arranged from time to time, down to this period. The institution of slavery it was believed by many ofth fathers, would expire of itself ai oo distant time; but th cotton cultivated at the South, and the intimate relations bore to the social life, made it profitable and agreeable and they held to it with greal tenacity. Meanwhile the compi the Constitution grew more and more disagreeable to t ; requirement of that instrument— that persons held I (54:6 THE CIVIL WAR. and becoming fugitives in the North, should be returned by them — was objected to on humane and religious grounds, and they found slavery an industrial embarrassment. The enterprise and vigor of the northern pop- ulation gave their section a more rapid growth, and its political power became continually greater. But three ways of peacefully avoiding the conflict were open : the North must fully carry out the spirit of concession that gave birth to the Union, the South must consent, sooner or later, to abolish its peculiar institu tions, or they must agree to separate. Interest, habit, and the aristocratic pride of the South forbade the second; while, in the North, interest, relig- ious sentiment, and the workingman's pride as decidedly forbade the first. The natural relation of the two sections, especially by the Mississippi and Ohio rivers, so essential to the commercial interests of the Western States: the improbability of maintaining amicable intercourse, with slavery in the South, and fugitives from it to produce constant irritation; the apparent probability that, if the right of dissolution were conceded, the West, and the Pacific States would follow this example; and the convic- tion that the true interests of the whole country, internal and external* required an indissoluble Union, inspired the majority of the northern people to resist disunion at every cost. On the other hand, the South claimed the right to depart in peace. Thus, war was inevitable; nor can it be correctly affirmed that any party, or any generation, or either section of the Union, was properly responsible for so lamentable a result. Each section, generation, and party follows the line of its own interest, ideas, and habits. It is a law of humanity, and each sees therein its duty and pleasure. While interests do not clash very seriously, while ideas are not sharply and clearly defined, and while habits are yet unsettled, compro- mises may be readily effected. Humanity, taken together, in the most advanced society heretofore known to men, is not yet capable of views so hia;h, libera], and far-seeing as to free it from the possibility of such con- flicts. It will, however, reach that height, in the course of time. We could not reasonably have expected either the North or the South to have acted differently from what they did. While so gigantic a war was an immense evil ; to allow the right of peaceable secession would have been ruin to the enterprise and thrift of the industrious laborer, and keen- eyed business man of the North. It would have been the greatest calamity of the age. War was less to be feared. The Southerner, generous, warm blooded, accustomed to rule and make his own will the law of others in his home, courageous and fiery, could not give way. Besides secession would be less damaging to him. He would own the outlets to much of Northern commerce, he had a bond of union of the Southern States in the the common institution of slavery, and a monopoly of the world's cotton that must soon secure profitable alliances- in Europe. Secession was commenced peaceably, and the Southern gov- ernment fairly consolidated before the trumpet sounded to battle. The THE I iyii. \\.\i:. Democratic party, then in possession of the administra government, had long been in close relations with the - impossible for it to realize the momentous chara help sympathizing more or less with the views and f< i it was near the close of its period of rule; and ii lefl tin ment of the herculean difficulties of the situation to the ii istration of the Republican party. The whole countrj perhaps, as well as the Democrats, to realize the Bignifl taking place. It was a period of breathless waiting for n next. The signal was given by the South. Fort S lina, a national fort, was bombarded April 13th, 1861. [f shock. The North answered the summons by a note of defiance, and i tered for war. The South was better prepared, more alert, mon and secured, at first, many advantages. She also had th being on the defensive when the contest became close. B ran into years, the courage and iron resolution nftbe North did n< I She had the advantage of numbers, of the general government kith, and of naval force. Step by step she conquered, holding all grew skillful and wise by defeat, and, April 8th, 1865, the main arm; Confederates surrendered, and the war was over; the gallant - cumbed to the plucky North. It was a predestined conclusion. T States were necessarily the strongest, and their strength was support inspired by religious sentiment and enthusiasm. The Union, soil to the world and to civil liberty, was preserved, but at fearl Probably 500,000 lives were sacrificed altogether, on both eight or nine billions of dollars. The desolation of the South, wh been mainly the theater of these mighty conflicts; the extremi pecuniary circumstances and social life there: the affliction, to fi the subjection, however mild and temperate,: j under stances to be imposed, for the time, by the federal government; t! loss of valuable life to both sides; the immense debt of the ment, with the unavoidable demoralization of certain | everywhere, by the license of war, and many other evils form I of the picture. Yet, nothing could outweigh the value of the I'ni freed from the discordant element that now disappeared. It m before all wounds can be healed. When that time shall and South will be recompensed for all they have suffer 1-1.0. Nov. 6— Four parties contested this election: the Re] Abraham Lincoln — the Democrat « * ni J. C. Breckenridge. The old Whigi dangerous political strife, voted for John I **• 648 THE CIVIL WAR. elected. A simple majority of electoral votes would have been 157. He received 180. " 7 — News of Lincoln's election received in South Carolina with cheers for a Southern Confederacy. " 9 — An attempt made to seize the arms in Ft. Moultrie. " 10 — South Carolina Legislature propose to raise 10,000 men. Election of convention to consider secession ordered. Jas. Chester, U. S. Senator from South Carolina, resigned. " 11— Senator Hammond, of South Carolina, resigned. " 15 — Governor Letcher, of Virginia, calls an extra session of the Legis- lature. " 18 — Georgia Legislature appropriate $1,000,000 to arm the State. Major Anderson sent to Ft. Moultrie to relieve Col. Gardiner. " 19 — Gov. Moore calls an extra session of Louisiana Legislature. Dec. 1 — Florida Legislature order the election of a convention. Great secession meeting in Memphis, Tennessee. " 3 — Congress assembles. President Buchanan denies the right of a State to secede, and asserts the propriety of coercion. " 5 — Election of secession delegates to South Carolina Convention. " 10— Howell Cobb, U. S. Sec. of Treasury, resigned ; P. F. Thomas, of Maryland, appointed in his place. Senator Clay, of Ala., resigned. Louisiana Legislature orders the election of a Convention, and appropriates $500,000 to arm the State. " 13— Extra session of the Cabinet held to consider if Ft. Moultrie shall be reinforced. President opposed, and reinforcements not sent. " 14— Gen. Lewis Cass, IT. S. Sec. of State, resigns. J. S. Black, of Pa., appointed. " 17 — South Carolina Convention assembles. " 18— Crittenden Compromise proposed in U. S. Senate. " 19 — Gov. Hicks, of Maryland, refuses to receive Mississippi Commis- sioners. " 20 — South Carolina Convention unanimously adopts a Secession Ordi- nance. " 22 — Crittenden Compromise rejected in Senate Committee. " 24— People of Pittsburg, Pa., stop shipment of military stores, from the arsenal there, to Southern forts. Gov. Moore calls extra session of Alabama Legislature. Election to Alabama Convention; secession majority over 50,000. South Carolina Members of U. S. House of Representatives resign. " 25— Maj. Anderson abandons Ft. Moultrie for Ft. Sumter, Charleston Harbor. He has only 111 men. South Carolina Commissioners arrive in Washington. President Buchanan declines to receive them. " 28 — South Carolina authorities seize Castle Pinckney, Ft. Moultrie, U. S. Custom-House, and other government property, at Charleston. THE OTVTL WAK. « 29— John B. Floyd, U.S. Bee. of War, resigns. Joseph I! appointed. 44 31— South Carolina sends Commissioners to Slavi the organization oi a Southern Confederal 1861. Jan. 2— Gov. Ellis, of North Carolina, takes p< Georgia troops seize Fts. Pulaski and Jackson, and U. 8, An at Savannah. 44 4— Gov. Moore, of Ala., seizes Ft Morgan, and U. S. 2 Mobile. Fast Day by proclamation of President 44 7 — State Conventions of Alabama and Mississippi, ami S: tures of Virginia ami Tennessee assemble. <4 8 — Jacob Thompson, U. S. Sec. of Interior, resigns Fts J ihi and Caswell, North Carolina, Beized by State authoritii 41 9 — U. S. steamer. Star of the West, fired on in Charleston B . and driven away. Mississippi Convention adopt S. c* ssion Ordinani « 10 — Florida Convention secedes by vote of 62 to 7. Fl i ties seize Ft. McRae. M 11 — Alabama secedes by vote in Convention of 61 to N 1' Thomas, U. S. Sec. of Treasury, resigns. John A 1 1 The Governor of Mississippi siezes Forts Philip and J the Mississippi river; Forts Pike and Macomb, on Lake 1' train; and U. S. Arsenal at Baton Rouge. M 13 — Florida takes possession of Pensacola Navy Yard ami an- cas. Lieut. Slemmer, in command of Ft. Pickens, ord Com. Armstrong to deliver the Fort to Florida, refttl serves that important post to the government of the Union. 44 16 — Legislature of Arkansas call- a < ionvention. Col. 1 1 Carolina, demands of the President tie- surrender ol and is refused. Missouri Legislature order i sider secession. « 18— The Legislature of Virginia appropriai of the State. 4 19— Georgia adopts Secession Ordinance b) v. ' 21— Members of ( longress from Alabama n sign. 4 " Jefferson Davis resigns his seat in th< i - - •■ « 23— Georgia members of Congress resign. • 24— U. S. Arsenal, Augusta, Geo., seta 4 26— Louisiana Legislature pass - • SSionOr 4 29— Kansas the tliirtv-foiirtli State, admitted into tin • 30— North Carolina Legislature submits theqw fcalli vention to the people. C50 THE CIVIL WAE. " " Revenue cutters Cass, at Mobile, and McClelland, at New Orleans, surrendered to Southern authorities. Feb. 1 — Texas Convention passes Secession Ordinance, to be submitted to the people. Vote, 106 to 7. Louisiana government seize the U. S. Mint and Custom House, at New Orleans. " 4 — Peace Convention of Delegates from eighteen States, assembles at Washington; ex-President Tyler presides. " " Delegates from seceded States meet at Montgomery, Ala., to organize a Confederate Government. " " John Slklell and Judah P. Benjamin, U. S. Senators from Louis- iana, resign their seats. " 9 — Jefferson Davis and Alexander H. Stevens elected provisional President and Vice-President of Confederate States, for one year. " 13 — Electoral vote counted. Abraham Lincoln received 180 votes ; S. A. Douglas, 12; J. C. Breckenridge, 72; John Bell, 39. Majority required to elect, 157. " 18 — Ft. Kearney, Kansas, seized by Southern forces. " 23 — Gen. Twiggs, U. S. commander in Texas, delivered his army pris- oners of war, and U. S. property valued at $1,200,000 to Confederate authorities. " 28 — Territorial Government organized in Colorado. Mar. 1 — Gen. Twiggs expelled from the army. Peace Congress adjourned. " 2 — Territorial government organized in Dacotah and Nevada. " Revenue cutter Dodge surrendered to the South, at Galveston, Texas. " 4 — Abraham Lincoln inaugurated 14th regular President of the United States. " " The people of Texas having voted for the Secession Ordinance by 40,000 majority, the Convention declared the State out of the Union. " 5 — Gen. Beauregard takes command of Southern forces, at Charleston. " 6 — Ft. Brown, on the Rio Grande, surrenders to Confederate troops. Federal troops evacuated the fort and sailed for Key West, Florida. " Confederate Senate confirm nominations of President Davis to his Cabinet, viz. : R. Toombs, of Geo., Sec. of State ; C. S. Memminger, of South Carolina, Sec. of Treasury; L. P. Walker, of Ala., Sec. of War ; S. R. Mallory, of Fla., Sec. of Navy ; J. H. Reagan, of Texas, Postmaster Gen.; J. P. Benjamin, of La., Attorney General. " 11 — The Constitution of Confederate States adopted in convention at Montgomery, Ala. ; afterwards ratified by the several States. " 28 — Vote of Louisiana on secession — 20,448 for, 17,926 against — made public. " 30 — Mississippi Convention ratifies the Confederate Constitution, by 78 to 70. Apr. 3 — South Carolina Convention ratifies Confederate Constitution, by 114 to 6. HIM PHASE OF nil. u IB. Apr. 4 — Virginia Convention refuse to pn the people, by a vote of B9 " 7 — Intercourse between Ft, Bumter and Char! of Gen. Beauregard. CHAPTER X \ I V. FIRST PHASE OF THE WAR Each side hesitated to strike the first blow; but the Bouth, h prepared, and to end a suspense that threatened to be hurtful I cause, opened the conflict by the bombardment of 1 ' S ater. 1 now hastened preparations with vigor. Xet BO Long had been the intin. friendly relations, that neither could believe in a ton More than three months passed, during which frequent .-k:: curred; but the leaders avoided bringing on a genera] battle I forces advanced toward Washington, but Btopped short sending out small bodies to make trial efforts, and L r et poesi asion of lm| tant points. The battle of Bull Run was the first great, serious com: bravery of Southern troops would have been overcome bul foi .- tune reinforcement at the decisive moment The lead safe to pursue the vanquished Federals to Washington. T reserve force there. Thus, if they won a battle they lost tli> .. the capture of the national Capital — and the Union forci 9, though d gained the most important point — the protection of Washington. Both sides now recognized the magnitude of the ondertak indomitable resolution of their opponents; and the Deed of thoi disciplining their troops, of organizing all branches of the i naval service, and gathering stores, and distributing forc< - in i with the plan proposed by each. This period continued until Feb., 1862. The - N- from 42 vessels at the beginning of the war to about BOO at tin i preparatory period. These blockaded the Bouth and served for u attack. Two series of operations- were planned b) the 1 9 for the land forces: one in the Mississippi Valley and i In the meantime the Confederate leaders BBW thai II «U Impo invade the North as they had proposi d without Ion:.' pn armies. They organized with speed bul were thrown on the d 1881. Apr. 7— Steamer Atlantic, with troops and supplli from New York. « g_ The Federal Government notified South < 'a* would be sent to Maj. Anderson, b\ ■652 FIEST PHASE OF THE WAR. U. S. State Department refused to recognize the Commissioners from the Confederate States. " 11 — Troops are gathered in Washington, and oath of allegiance admin- istered. Confederate Commissioners leave Washington. Gen. Beauregard demands the surrender of Ft. Sumter. Maj. Anderson refuses. Bombardment of Ft. Sumter. •* 12 — This was the real commencement of the Civil War. Batteries were constructed on Morris and Sullivan islands, and Cumming's Point. The Confederate forces employ Ft. Moultrie, and a floating battery, in addition, against Ft. Sumter. The South Carolina Legislature appropriate $500,000 to arm the State. Ft. Pickens is reinforced by the U. S. government. « 14 — Fort Sumter was reduced to a mass of ruins, its fire silenced, and Maj. Anderson capitulated with the honors of war, and evacuated the fort, sailing for New York. Gov. Yates, of Illinois, called an extra session of Legislature to meet April 22. *' 15 — The President issues a proclamation commanding all in arms against the government to disperse in 20 days; calling also for 75,000 volunteers to defend Washington ; and the New York Leg- islature authorizes the raising of $3,000,000 for their equipment and support. The President calls an extra session of Congress, for July 4. «« 16— The governors of Kentucky, Virginia, Tennessee, and Missouri refuse to furnish troops, under the President's proclamation. The Confederate government calls for 32,000 men. " 17— The Virginia Convention, in secret session, adopt a Secession Ordinance, to be submitted to the people in May. The vote was 60 to 53. Virginia forces sent to seize U. S. Arsenal at Harper's Ferry, and Gosport Navy Yard, at Portsmouth. All the military power of the State of Virginia placed under the control of President Davis. Jefferson Davis issues a proclamation offering Letters of Marque and Reprisal to privateers against Federal commerce. * 18 — U. S. Arsenal at Harper's Ferry destroyed by Federal troops, to prevent its falling into the hands of the enemy. Col. Coke, with 400 of 25th Penn. regiment, arrives in Washington for its defense. " 19— U. S. steamer Star of the West seized at Indianola, Texas. Massachusetts troops on the way to Washington, attacked by a mob in Baltimore. Troops fired on the mob. Blood shed on both sides. FIKST PHASE OF nil. \\ ai:. President issues a proclamation declaring thi Carolina to Texas in a state of blockade. Military departmentof Washington coveri and Pennsylvania, put under command of Geo Patt City Council of Philadelphia appropriate |l,l unteers, and support their families. " 2&— Governor of North Carolina seizes U.S. Branch Mint, at Char;. Bridges and railroads in Maryland destroyed b) - prevent passage of troops to Washington. U. S. Navy Yard, at Gosport, and property worth - destroyed by the Federals in charge, to prevent their fall. the hands of the enemy. Eight vessels of war were d< one, the Cumberland, was lowed out, Massachusetts troops arrive at Fortress M onn Gov. Curtin calls special meeting of Penn. L April 30th. " 21 — Federal government takes possession of Philadelphia ilti- more railroad. Senator Andrew Johnson mobbed at Lynchburg, V*i " 22 — U. S. Arsenals in North Carolina and Arkansas seised. " 24 — Fort Smith Arkansas, seized. Cairo, 111., o I bv Dl troops. Maj. Sibley surrenders 450 U. S. troops to Col. Van I torn, I " 26 — Gov. Brown, of Geo., forbids payment of debts to Northern " 27 — A steamer at Cairo, loaded with military Btorefl for the S- «uth. seized. Blockade extended to ports of Virginia and North Carolina. « 29 — The Maryland House of Delegates votes againsl Governors Harris of Tennessee and Moore of Lou eminent property. May 1— The Legislature of N. C. and Tenn. prepare for formal sro -• « 3— President Lincoln calls for 82,714 additional A Fourteen companies of Kentucky troops offer th< government, though the Governor bad refused a 1< « 4— Gen. McClellan takes command of the department oft] « 6— Virginia admitted into the Confederacy. I '■»*• pass Ordinances of Secession. « 10— A rebel force in St. Louis surrenders to Capt Lyon. Gen. R. E. Lee takes command of Southern troop, in \ « 13— Convention called at Wheeling t" organize a i. k i4_Vessels with stores and property for He - " 15— Massachsetts offers U.S. Government $7.00 vM "- « 16— Gen. Scott orders the fortification of Arlington If « it— Confederates commenci' fortifying Harpers Ferry - 18— Gen. Butler takes command of Department of Virginia. (554: FIRST PHASE OF THE WAR. " 19— Sewalls Pt. attacked by U S. steamers. Two schoouei< witta Soutliern troops, captured. M 20— North Carolina formally secedes. Kentucky proclaimed neutral. " 21 — Southerners blockade the Mississippi at Memphis. u 24 — Alexandria and Arlington Heights occupied by Union troops. " 26 — Western Virginia voted largely in favor of the Union. " 27 — One hundred slaves fled to Fortress Monroe. Gen. Butler declared them " contraband " of war. " — Two steamers engage the rebel batteries at Acquia Creek. June 1 — Various skirmishes between parties of the hostile armies. " 3 — Senator S. A. Douglas, of Illinois, died. Battle of Philippi, Va. Union Col. Kelly wounded but victorious. Gen. Beauregard assumed command of Confederate forces at Manassas Junction. Voluntary contributions of northern States in aid of the Government over $32,000,000. Battle of Big Bethel. " 10— Three Federal regiments defeated. 16 killed, 41 wounded. " 11 — Skirmish at Romney. Wheeling Convention meets. " 14 — Harper's Ferry evacuated and burnt by Southern forces. " 15 — Confederate privateer, Savannah, brought, a prize, to New York. " 17 — Wheeling Convention of Unionists determine to make West Vir- ginia an independent State. " 18 — Battle of Booneville, Mo. Gen. Lyon defeats Confederate Gen. Price. " 20— At Cole Camp, Mo., Union men defeated; at Liberty, Mo., South- erners overcome. " 23 — Forty-eight locomotives of Baltimore and Ohio R. R. destroyed by Southern forces ; value, $400,000. " 26 — President Lincoln recognizes the Wheeling government as that of Virginia. " 29 — Southern privateer, Sumter, escapes through blockade at New Orleans. July 2 — Battle near Martinsburg, Va., Gen. Patterson, Union, and Gen. Jackson, Confederate. u 3 — Southern men captured at Neosho, Mo. Consisted of 94 men. " 4 — Southern forces seize Louisville and Nashville railroad. " 5— Congress assemble at Washington. President calls for 400,000 vol- unteers, and $400,000,000 to put down the rebellion. Battle of Carthage, between Sigel, Union, and Gen. Jackson, Southern. Gen. Sigel retreated. " 11 — Nine Southern Senators expelled from U. S. Congress. " 12— Battle of Rich Mountain, Va. Col. Rosecrans, Union, defeated Col. Pegram, taking 800 prisoners and his camp stores. u 13— Confederates under Gen. Garnett, defeated at Carrick's Ford, by Gen. Morris. Gen. Garnett killed. FIRST PHASE 01 THE w\i:. " 15— Col. Stuart, commanding Confederate cavalry, forces at Bunker Hill, Va., and Is defeated. " 16 — Skirmishes at Millville, Mo., and Barboursvilli ' - days. « 16— President Lincoln forbids commercial Intercourse with U « 23— Cherokee Indians take part with the Booth. " 28-Capture of Forts Battens and Clark. N . « D Be Com. Btringham. " 31-Gen Fremont proclaims freedom of slan erty of disunionists in Missouri. President mands it. , Sept. 1-Southerners defeated at BooaTlUe, Va . and to 36 (556 FIRST PHASE OF THE WAR. " 4 — Confederate Gen. Polk occupies Columbus, Ky. Southern forces, attempting to cross Potomac at Great Falls, repulsed. " 10 — Gen. Banks attacks Confederate Gen. Floyd, in intrenched camp, at Carnifex Ferry. Gen. Floyd retreats in the night. " 12 — Battle of Cheat Mountain, a Union victory. Col. J. A. Washing- ton killed. " 18 — Secession members of Maryland Legislature imprisoned. " 19 — Arrest of Gov. Morehead and others for treason, in Louisville, Ky. " 20 — Col. Morehead, Union, besieged, at Lexington, Mo., and compelled to surrender with over 2,000 men, after a fight of four days. Oct. 2 — Battle of Chapmanville, Va. Confederates defeated. " 3 — Battle of Greenbriar, Va. Federal success. " 4 — Confederate success at Chicamacomico, Va. Federals retreated. " 5 — Steamer Monticello drives Southern forces from Chicamacomico. " 7 — Confederate Iron Clad Merrimac appears at Fortress Monroe. " 11 — Confederate Commissioners Slidell and Mason escape from Charleston, S. C. " 16 — U. S. troops recapture Lexington, Mo. Battle of Pilot Knob, Mo. Unionists successful. " 21 — Battle of Balls Bluff. U. S. forces under Col. Baker, member of Congress, 1,900 strong, defeated with loss of 918 men. Col. Baker killed. Gen. Zolli coffer defeated by U. S. troops at Camp Wild Cat, Ky. " 25 — Gen. Kelly gains a battle against Confederates at Romney, Va. " 29 — U. S. naval and military force of 27,000 men and 75 vessels leave- Fortress Monroe for the South. Nov. 1 — Gen. Scott retires from command of the Union army. Gen. McClellan appointed Gen. in Chief. Gen. Floyd fails in his attack on Gen. Rosencranz, at Gauley, Va. " 2 — Gen. Fremont superceded by Gen. Hunter in Mo. " 4 — Houston, Mo., taken by Union troops. " 7— Com. Dupont and Gen. Sherman capture Forts Walker and Beau- regard, S. C, and occupy Beaufort and Hilton Island. Gen. Grant captured Confederate camp at Belmont, Mo., opposite Columbus. Reinforcements arriving he retired. " 8 — Mason and Slidell, Confederate Commissioners to Europe, were taken from British steamer Trent, by U. S. ship San Jacinto. On subsequent demand of the English government they were given up. " 10 — Union soldiers having been killed by inhabitants of Guyandotte, Va., the town was burnt in retaliation. " 15 — The San Jacinto arrived at Fortress Monroe with Slidell and Mason. " 23 — Bombardment of Pensacola, Fla., by Ft. Pickens and U. S. war vessels. " 27 — Gen. McClellan orders observance of the Sabbath in the army. FIRsi PHASE OF THE WAR. " 29 — Skirmish at Warsaw, Mo. Town partly destroyed. " 30— Fight at Salem, Mo. Southern forces defeated Dec. 3 — Congress met at Washington. " 4 — Two Congressmen and Senator Breckenridge ol K foe treason. " 5 — Naval engagement at Cape Hatteras Forces of U. S. army and navy reported very in ;ir 700,000 DO " 9 — Confederate Congress declares Kentucky a Stud' in thi South Confederacy. " 13 — Gen. Milroy defeats Confederate Col. Johnson, at Camp AJleghan) " 16 — Platte City, Mo., burnt by Southern forces. " 17 — More than 20 vessels, filled with stone, sunk at the antral Charleston and Savannah harbors. " 18 — Gen. Pope captured 1,300 Southerners and 1,000 - ir ins at Millford, Mo. « 31 — u. S. navy increased from 42 vessels at beginning of tin- war u> 246, of all kinds, up to this date. 1862. Jan. 1— Mason and Slidell leave Ft. Warren, Boston SarhOT, for England, «« 2 — Successof Unionists on Port Royal Island, n.;ir('h ti!' -i: B I " 4 — Gen. Milroy defeats Confederates at Buntersville, \ I « 7— Confederate defeat at Romney. U. 8. troops capttu la Tucker Co., Va. " 8 — Union victory by Gen. Palmer at Silver ( (reek, M ■ " 10— Humphrey Marshall defeated by Union troops In Kentucky. Senators Johnson and Polk of Mo., expelled from the I - - " 11— Simon Cameron, U. S. Sec. of War. resigned; B If . Stan appointed. Naval engagement on the Mississippi near the mouth of t: Union vessels superior. " 12—125 vessels and 15,000 troops, under Gen. Hurn-M- South. " 18 — Ex-President Tyler dies. " 19— Union victory at Mill Spring. Ky., by Gen. Bhoepl coffer and Gen. Crittenden Much spoil taken j '-:. / killed. " 27— Bishop Ames and Gov. Fish of X.-w York appotnU ons in the South, to look after the interests ol Union pi Confederate authorities refuse to receive tin DO 42 CHAPTEE XXY. THE SECOND PHASE OF THE WAR The previous period, though abounding in battles, so-called, were really skirmishes of detached bodies without any well defined plan. It covered much of the surface of all the Border States, but especially Virginia and Missouri, and was a trial of bravery and strategy in which both parties learned how to fight, and of what metal their opponents were made. The Second Period covered about eleven months — from the advance of the Federal armies on the South in West and East, in Feb., to the close of the year. This period is defined in its commencement, by the surrounding of the southern territory on nearly all sides by the Union forces, both naval and military; and the inauguration of aggressive movements both by sea and land ; and in its close by the failure of the two southern Generals, Bragg in the West, and Lee in the East, in the endeavor to break through this beleagering line. It was an immense and desperate conflict. In the West it began by the attack of Grant on Fts. Henry and Donel- son, followed up by the battle of Pittsburg Landing, and various other operations in Tennessee and Mississippi; the advance of McClellan on Richmond, and his campaign in the Peninsula, his failure and return to Washington; the strengthening of the Southern Army, and the advance of Lee northward into Maryland and his defeat there. The disasters to the Union army in Virginia served to check the successes of the Western Army under Grant, Sherman, Buell, Rosecranz and others; the Confed- erate forces in the West were increased under Bragg, who checked the advance of U. S. troops eastward at Chattanooga, and he himself assumed the offensive, by invading Kentucky. He was compelled to retreat again to Chattanooga. Thus there was an alternation of great successes and great reverses on both sides. The Union Army commenced with about 600,000 men, and the Southern with about 400,000. They both largely added to these during the cam- paign. Meanwhile the navy was not idle. A foothold was gained in South Carolina, and in North Carolina, as well as at Norfolk, Virginia, the mouth of the Missisippi was opened by Admiral Farragut, and New Or- leans captured. The compression of a vast naval and land force was applied in all directions, even west of the Mississippi. Missouri had been (jiiieied by driving the organized forces into the border of Arkansas, and inflicting on them a heavy blow at Pea Ridge. This, however, was not followed up ; the disasters to the Union cause in Virginia, and the rebound of the Confederates in East Tennessee, requiring concentration. The South had shown the most determined bravery, and great steadiness in disaster; and activity, and ability in making the most of circumstances. (658) SECOND PHASE OP THE WAS. The speed with which she collected other lei li within the campaign greath, impressed the authority Federal government. They were convinced that the i to till the ground, or employed in the fortification war, contributed much to the strength <>t the South concentrate all their resources on a given point with and to use all their best fighting material. A: their immense armies defied and the Northern 8 sion was discouraging. Hitherto slavery had uol been Intel much, in deference to the sentiment in the Border - the democratic party. The Onion administration determined the South by abstracting as much as possible of the t and to use it themselves. The issue of the Proclamation tion marks a Third Phase of the War. L863. Feb. 3 — The Federal government decides to treat crews of pi in arms, not as pirates, but as prisoners i " 5 — Jesse D. Bright, of Indiana, expelled from the 1 3 S " 6 — Com. Foote, acting in concerl with (Jen. Grant, op Tennessee river in Ky., and captures Fori Henry. " 8 — Gen. Burnside and Com. Goldsboron \ad war material on Roanoke Island, in Albemarle Bound " 10 — Gunboats of Confederate government taken it destn " 12 — Gen. Grant invests Ft. Donelson, on Cumberland rtvi r. i. *' 13 — Gen. Curtis advances to Springfield, Mo. U. S. Congress determine to construct 90 in . ■». . " 15 — Bowling Green, Ky., evaluated by Southern foi " 16 — Gen. Grant captures Ft. Donelson, with 18,800 prl " 18 — Gen. Curtis drives Confederates out of Missouri into a*a*. Confederate Congress assemble at Richmond I " 19— Jefferson Davis and A. H. Stevens elected i and Vice-President of Confederate States 1 " 21— Defeat of Union forces at Clarksville, N " 23 — Nashville, Tenn., occupied bj Union! « 27— Columbus, on the Mississippi, in K> , < >•> " 8-9 — Battle of Perryville, Ky. Southern army having I ".,,1 | D its advance and obliged to retreat before < i< n Bui U, turni I advance and inflicted a severe blow, but are forced t" l retreat. " 10 — Confederate cavalry, under Smart, make B raid on Chat Penn. They capture 500 horses and man] -ily return to Virginia. " 14 — One hundred thousand dollars sent to Sanitary Oomm San Francisco. " 15 — Battle near Richmond, Ky. « 19— Gen. Forrest defeated by Union forces, near Gallatin, Texas. " 22— Southern defeat at Maysville, Ark., by Gen. Blunt. « 24— An English steamer bringing military Btorea !.. the South, cap- tured. « 28— Confederates defeated by Gen. Herron, at I' « 30— Gen. Rosecrans supersedes Buell i:: KenLUCkj astronomer, died in S. C. Nov. 5— Gen. McClellan relieved of command in Va. by Qen 1 Attack on Nashville by Confederates. They are i « ii_Southern defeat at Garrettsburg, Ky., n G Exchange of prisoners effected. « 16— President Line. ,ln enjoins on soldiers in Damp SI ance of the Sabbath. " 17— Cavalry flghl near Kingston, N C. Southerner ■• 22— All political State prisoners releaeed bj I - •« 25— Newborn, N. C. attacked by Southern tm«.| " 28— Battle of Cane Hill. Ark. A. Union vi< Dec. 1— The Pittsburg Battery, captured OO the lVnii.-.la. reukcr Union force sent from Suffolk. 664 CAMPAIGN OF 1863. Dec. 5— Battle of Coffeeville, Miss. Southern loss was heavy. " 6— Gen. Banks' expedition for the South sailed for New Orleans. " 7 — At Prairie Grove, Ark., Gens. Blunt and Herron defeated Con- federates. Confederate Gen. Morgan captured several regiments of Western troops. " 8 — Steamer Lake City destroyed by Southerners. " 9 — U. S. troops burn Concordia, on the Mississippi. " 13 — Battle of Fredricksburg. A severe repulse to the Union army. Gen. Foster makes a cavalry raid into the interior of N. C, a success. Commodore Parker destroys Confederate salt works, five schooners and two sloops. " 17— Gen. Banks captures Baton Rouge, the capital of Louisiana. " 19— Confederates retake Holly Springs, Miss., and large stores with 4,000 bales of cotton. " 26 — Indians, engaged in the Minnesota massacre, hung — 38 in number. " 27 — Vicksburg attacked by Gen. Sherman and gunboats, unsuccessfully. " 31 — Battle of Murfreesboro, or Stone River, commenced with a Federal repulse. The Monitor that conquered the Merrimac, foundered at sea. Act of Congress admitting West Virginia into the Union as a sovereign State. This was to take effect 60 days after the Presi- dent's proclamation making this announcement. CHAPTEE XXYI. CAMPAIGN OF 1863. The preliminary Proclamation of Emancipation, issued Sept. 22d, 1862, was not to take effect for 100 days, or until Jan. 1st, 1863. Meanwhile the final details of the great operations, undertaken on both sides during 1862, were wound up. The bold efforts of the South, in the East and West, to transfer the war into the North, and indemnify themselves for the strict blockade of the coast by drawing supplies from the enemy, had resulted in defeat and withdrawal; not unaccompanied with booty, especially in the west, where Bragg's train of supplies was said to have been 40 miles long. The southern people had failed in the main point, yet they had gained much. Federal reverses in the east had stopped the victories in the west in mid career, both by withdrawing from those armies to the east, and adding to the Confederates from the same region. Grant and Sher- man failed at Vicksburg, and Buell at Chattanooga. Yet these reverses to the Union arms served to stimulate the north, and to demonstrate the energy, resources, and indomitable resolution of the CAMPAIGN 01 L8l National government, and to undeceive the South i - to tbi ■ of the great body of the Democratic part; from which tin 011 an invasion in force. Several of the ESurop have liked to support the South, seeing the formidable i General Government, drew back in fear, I ith 1 1 1 i ^ 1 > t l, . rn that her cause was really hopeless; bu1 Bhe w an unconquerable resolution to carry her point or perish ened her armies and prepared for another invasion. The Federal armies were now (Jan. 1868, tboul 901 navy consisted of near 450 vessels, a large Dumber being Iron-clads The great events of the campaign were Lee's invasion ol 1' and his retreat after the battle of Gettysburg, and (Irani \ burg and Chattanooga. The resolution of the South, enveloped in the embrace of so mighty an antagonist, was wonderful; the unfa spirit, and readiness of the northern people to furnish w wa* required for success was still more so. The whole South, si State, was the theater of many contests of more 01 l< M imp the main interest centered on the Mississippi river, at Chattan vicinity, and on Gen. Lee's army in Virginia or Pennsyli ii * congest of giants; yet, struggle as she might, the South M M the end of this year she was still strong, her armies were spirit unbroken. The Federal Government hud gained much step by step, inch by inch; and, in some parts, as in Virgin been gained many times over, in territory, had I Her general gain over the Confederate Btates la] l fatal process of exhaustion to which the vasl operation! government forced the South. Increase of numbers madi th< bloody and wasteful of life. The three leading events In this the capture of Vicksburg, (the battle of Chickam victory, but balanced by that of Chattanooga,) the baitl and the battle of Chattanooga— were all decisive against U yet leaving her strength for a long and vigoroui than • year and a half. 1868, Jan. 1-— The year opened with a Confederate su< An attack by sea and land resulted Inthecaptui the destruction of one vessel with of another, the Harriet Lane Com. RontAM his vessel. Confederate defeal at Lexington, Tenn Proclamation of Emancipation Issued bv P Long, but indecisive battle of stone Kivei i, :• r wounded, 8,000. « 8-Union army withdraws from before VI i •"»» retreats at Murfreesborough, Tenn GC6 CAMPAIGN OF 1863. " 7 — Springfield, Mo., successfully defended by Unionists. " 9 — 20,000 prisoners exchanged. •' 11 — A combined attack on Fts. Hindman and Arkansas Post by gun- boats and land forces, resulted in Union success — over 7,000 prisoners. " 12 — Three Federal transports and a gunboat captured on Cumberland river. " 13 — The Southern steamer, Florida, escapes from Mobile. « 17— $100,000,000 issued by the U. S. government in notes to pay the army. " 20 — Blockading vessels captured by Confederates, at Sabine City, Texas. " 22 — Attack on Vicksburg resumed. Gen. Porter dismissed from U. S. army. " 25 — A regiment of colored soldiers organized at Port Royal, S. C. " 26— Gen. Hooker succeeds Gen. Burnside, in command of the Union Army of the Potomac, and Gens. Sumner and Franklin are relieved from duty. The Confederate war steamer, Alabama, destroys one vessel and captures another. Feb. 1 — A second unsuccessful gunboat attack on Ft. McAllister. " 5 — Destruction of transports on Red River, La. Ft. Donelson repels Southern troops. " 12 — The Florida captures the Union merchant vessel, Jacob Bell. « 13 — The iron-clad, Indianola, runs the blockade at Vicksburg, and is captured. " 18 — Vicksburg bombarded by gunboats — ineffectually. " 21 — The Alabama, a Confederate cruiser, destroys two vessels on the African coast. " 25 — The Bureau of Currency and National Banks established by U. S. Congress. " 26— The Cherokees return to the Union, and abolish slavery. Twenty-eight cars, with stores, destroyed by Confederates, in Ken- tucky. " 28 — Confederate iron-clad, Nashville, destroyed in Ogeechee river, Geo. Mar. 1— Third fruitless Union attack on Ft. McAllister, Geo. " 2— U. S. Generals increased to 358. " 3— Congress authorizes loan of $900,000,000. These are called ten- forty's. The President authorized to suspend the writ of Habeas Corpus U. S. Assistant Treasurer provided by act of Congress. Territorial government organized in Idaho. Twc U. S. gunboats destroyed. " 5— Van Dorn (Confederate) captures Springfield, Tenn., and many prisoners. CAMPAIGN "I L8l Mar.G — Van Dora captun LderableUn " 7— Gen. Minty captures a Confederate cavalry I Term. " 10 — Colored troops captured Jacksonville, Florida " 14— Port Hudson, Mississippi river, attacked bj th. I fleet under Com. Farragut The flag ship disabled " 17— Gallant and successful exploit of Union cavalry at Cellj " 19 — An English steamer with arms for the BouU) Charleston. " 20— Defeat of Morgan (Confederate) at Hilton, Tenn " 25 — Two Union vessels lost before Vicksburg. " 28 — Confederate steamer Iris captured Dear Charleston, 9 I Apr. 1 — Admiral Farragut passes the batteries of Grand Gulf Great scarcity of many things in the Conl ness of the blockade, and extreme depreciation money. No cotton could lie sold. " 7 — An attack on Fort Sumter by nine Union iron clad- I worsted. The Alabama Confederate cruiser captures th< I 9 Star. " 10 — Two Union gunboats destroyed on Cumberland rii Van Dorn repulsed by Union Genera] Granger, at Franklli " 16 — Com. Porter runs the batteries al Vicksburg »ui i • tsfully. " 17 — Gen. Banks vanquished Southern troops at I. I >nd Lake, La. « 23— The Queen of the Wesl captured on Grand I. federate, surprised at McMinnville, Tenn. Bank Opelousas and Washington, Misa " 23 — Gen. Hunter informs Confederate authorities that must be treated as other prisoners of war. on pain " 24— Union defeat at Beverly, Va .. and victor!) - - : W and on Iron Mountain Railroad, M May 1— Gen. Grant defeated the Southern troop Gen. Pegram, Confederate, defeated at Monttcello A third defeat of Southern troop-, at South Q Unionists defeated al La Grange, Ark Battli Va., begins. " 2- Col. Grierson, of U. S. army, finished ■ raid through the interior of Mi~. T» Battle of Chancellorovillc continued [t Loss each side 15,000. " 8— Capture ofGrand Gulf, Mies bj Admiral P « a— Vallandigham arrested in Ohio for tn <»** 100 Secessionists of St. Louis sent Bowtb foi ft l 668 CAMPAIGN OF 1863. May 10— Stonewall Jackson, an able and brilliant Soutbern general, died of wounds received in battle. " 11 — Gen. Logan, Union, defeats Gen. Grigg at Farnden's Creek, Miss. Eacb bad about 5,000 men. " 12 — Gen. McPberson captured Raymond, Miss., from Confederates. " 13 — Yazoo City, and $2,000,000 property, captured by Union gunboats. Gen. Grant defeats Confederate army and captures Jackson, Miss. " 16 — Gen. Grant defeats Pemberton at Baker's Creek, Miss., witb beavy loss. Eacb bad about 25,000 men. Pemberton lost 4,000 men and next day 2,000 more. " 18— Grant commences seige of Vicksburg, Miss. " 26 — Gen. Breckenridge, Confederate, suffered defeat in Tennessee. " 29 — An immense train arrives in Gen. Banks' lines near Port Hudson : 600 wagons, 3,000 horses and mules, 1,500 cattle, 6,000 negroes. Gen. Banks fails in several attacks on Port Hudson. June 3 — A brilliant raid by a colored regiment in Soutb Carolina. " 11 —Forrest, of Confederate cavalry, defeated at Triune, Tenn. " 15 — President Lincoln calls for 120,000 militia, to repel Lee's invasion of Penn. " 18 — About 100,000 Soutbern forces enter Penn., near Chambersburg. » 20 — West Virginia admitted as a State into the Union. Missouri Leg- islature abolishes slavery. In this month the great events of the campaign, the taking of Vicksburg and opening the Mississippi river, and the failure of Gen. Lee's invasion by his loss of the battle of Gettysburg, are rapidly approaching the grand crisis. July — The first days of this month formed the crisis of the war. " 3— Gen. Lee, with 100,000 men, was defeated by Gen. Meade at Gettys- burg, Pa., with about equal numbers. Lee retreated into Virginia The Union losses at Gettysburg were 23,000. Lee had lost in his 17 days in the Free States 60,000 men altogether. " 4 — Vicksburg surrendered to Gen. Grant, after a seige of 41 days. In the battles immediately preceding, under Grant, and in this seige and capitulation, the South lost near 50,000 men. Grant's losses were about 9,000. Gen. Prentice defeated a greatly superior force at Helena, Ark. " 8 — Port Hudson surrenders to Gen. Banks, with 7,000 men. Morgan, of Confederate cavalry, invades Indiana and Ohio with 5,000 men. He is captured before he can return. " 13 — Great riot in New York city. " 17— Gen. Sherman defeats Johnson, and occupies Jackson, Miss. " 20— Two successful Union cavalry expeditions, in N. C. and Va. " 23— Battle of Manassas Gap. Unionists defeat a superior force. A Confederate victory at Richmond, Ky. " 31 — Confederates beaten in Kentucky. CAMPAIGN 01 1863. Aug. 1 — Two cavalry battles in Va. " 4— Disastrous loss of U. 8. steamer Ruth, on th< M " IS— Gen. Gilmore bombarded Ft. Sumter and ( month. " 17 — Successful cavalry raid into Mississippi to destrqj " 2-0 — Lawrence, Kansas, attacked and destroyed by gut ri A guerilla war was carried on very largely thii month, I and west of the Mississippi Sept. 1 — Knoxvillc, Tenn., captured by Gen. Burnslde Gen. Blunt defeated the Confi " 6 — Fts. Wagner and Gregg captured by Gen. Glim " 8 — Cumberland Gap taken by Gen. Burnslde. 2,000 pi " 10 — Little Rock occupii d by Union fori " 19-20 — A terrible battle is fought al Chickamauga (in Indian th< of Death,") in which Gen. Rosecrana with some I troops is severely defeated by Bragg, with about ! :-r»l losses about 15,000. Yet Bragg did notcaptm " 22 — Severe battle at Madison Court Souse, 7a Union " 28 — Gen. Burnaide repulses Confederates al Knoxville, Tenn Oct. 3 — Union troops throw Greek fire into Charleston, - " 5 — Chatanooga bombarded by Bra " 9 — Defeat of Wheeler's Confederate cavalry. In Tenn. " 14— Battle at Bristoe Station, Va. Favorable to 13 s troops. " 16— Gen. Grant takes command of the WeaU rn arm «• 17— The President calls for 300,000 more troops, " 21— A battle in Alabama, in Mississippi, and In Tenni " 27— Battle of Bro-wn's Ferry, near Chattanooga Conl \»»\m. " 28— Gen. Hooker takes Lookoul Mountain. " 31— Gen. Hooker gains the battle of Shell Mound Nov. —The main interest of the month gathers about I sive battle of Chattanooga, between Gena Qranl the forces to be spared on either Bide w< Chattanooga has been called, "The backd jfov. 5— Chattanooga bombarded by the Southern I Gen. Avery gains a Union victory al •• 6— The North is thrilled with indignation .imx-ruin to have been perpetrated in Southern prison! « 7— Gen. Meade drives Southern army aero-, the R ►" 11— The British government makes known an InU the North from Canada, bj I nnfi i « 15_Gen. Banks takes Corpus Chri-ti. 'I'. I •■ 17— Charleston continues to be Bh< lied Gen. Longstreel detached from Conf! with 15,000 men. to attack Burnslde. - 19— National Cemetery con tlyabwi 070 CAMPAIGN OF 1864. " 23-26 — Battles of Chattanooga and Lookout Mountain. Southern forces about 60,000, Grant's about 80,000. Confederate losses 10,000, Union, 5,616. It was a blow never recovered by the Confederacy. " 28 — Gen. Longstreet attacks Knoxville and is repulsed with loss. CHAPTER XXVII. CAMPAIGN OF 1864. There was a lull, for a time, in the tempest of war. The Confederate forces had lost ground that they could hardly hope to regain. The Missis- sippi river and Eastern Tennessee, both of supreme importance to the Confederacy, were in possession of the Union armies, which grew ever stronger. They were now about 1,000,000 men, and the navy had increased to over 600 vessels. This force was soon put in vigorous hands, that gripped fast what they once held. The misfortune of many commanders and continual changes, from political rather than military considerations, began to be well understood. Grant had gained so uniformly when others had failed, he was recognized as so tenacious and unwearied, that he received and held the confidence of the people and the government. This was a point of great importance for shortening the war; for the Southern people were still resolute, had still a vast country, were on the defensive in a smaller region than before, and could resist more effectively with a smaller army. It still made a most gallant and determined resistance which the vast resources of the national government did not enable them to overcome for a year and a half. The country was still covered with detached bodies of troops. A desultory war was maintained where strong armies failed to hold the ground, or were concentrated at a few points. The great move- ments were in Virginia and Georgia. The secondary in Tennessee, in Mis- sissippi, and Texas. It took a year to break the will of the Southern people after they were really conquered. This period covers the year 1864; 1865 furnishes only the dying struggles of the Confederacy, already mortally wounded. 1864. The bombardment of Charleston continued during the preceding month. Some cavalry movements were made, the President of the U. S. offered amnesty to all who would take an oath of allegiance, and Gen. Butler announced that the Confederate government refused to receive any more supplies for Union prisoners from the North. Jan. 7 — Three blockade runners captured. 11 — Two more were destroyed, making 22 in a few months. " 25— Mr. Vanderbilt, having presented a steamer worth $800,000 to the U. S. government, received the thanks of Congress. Feb. 1— The President of the U. S. ordered a draft of 500,000 men. OAMPAIGS 01 L864. Feb. 5— Two English steamers, with supp] « 9— Cotton worth $700,000 burned al Wllmi " 20— Negro troops cov.t the retreal of a defeated whit. I Olustee, Fla. " 88— The large armies being broken up orcoi of communication very much interrupted raids, aiming to break the lines of commui completely, to lay waste the country, and I were raising supplies for the Southern armi< were undertaken. Thai of Sherman to M Grierson and Smith, and manj Bmallerom this month. The damage to railroads and the were incalculable. 18 blockade runners and othci supplies to the South were destroyed during th< i Mar. 2 — Geu. Grant made Lt. General; the only our who I dignity since Gen. Washington — I by brevet. " 12— Gen. Grant made Commander-in-chief of th( I - " 15— The President of the U. S. calls for 200,000 mon " 25 — Confederate Gen. Forrest makes three assau with loss of 1,500 men, in vain. " 28 — A severe defeat inflicted on Southern fore. Apr. 4 — Gen. Marmaduke defeated by Gen. Sti i le, Unionist souri, Ark. " 8— Gen. Banks suffers reverses on the Red River, ai loss. " 12— Gen. Forrest takes Ft. Pillow and in the gari »ny being negroes. " 21— Salt works in North Carolina destroyed ralue $10( was indispensable to army operations, the utm- waa m*dt to ruin as many as possible. « 23 — Governors of Western States offer the \ S for 100 days. President aco pts them May 2—400 Union prisoners are broughl to Aj » 4— Gen. Grant crosses the Rapidan In V.i and in the Wilderness. Be, with l W,000 men 60,000. ii 5— Fighting in the Wilderness for i« Costs Grant 30,000 (5,000 were prlsoneri intrenched and familiar with the groan vorable to the Union army. « 6— Gen. Sherman confronts Geo. J man has near 100, ■ •'"' « 7— Lee retreats toward Spottsylvai '■ lows, fighting. (J72 CAMPAIGN OF 1864. To this date 150,000 Southern soldiers had been made prisoners during the course of the war. May 8 — Battle of Spottsylvania ; result indecisive. " 10 — Battle of Spottsylvania continued. Still indecisive. Losses to each side 10,000 men. " 12 — Lee and Grant fight again, without victory by either. " 13 — Sheridan destroyed Lee's depot of supplies in his rear, at Beaver Dam. " 15 — Sherman drives Johnson from Resaca after two days' fighting. " 21 — Lee is flanked at Spottsylvania, and retires to the North Anna. " 23 — Morgan (Confederate cavalry) enters Ky. with 4,000 men. " 25 — Sheridan rejoins Grant, after a brilliant series of daring deeds in the rear of Lee. Gen. Stuart, a very able Confederate cavalry leader, is killed in this raid. " 27 — Grant again flanked Lee, crossing the Pamunky to Hanovertown. June 1 — Battle of Cold Harbor, north of, and near, Richmond. It was fought with the utmost bravery and obstinacy, but gained no more decisive end than the destruction of men and material involved. This was very severe on Lee, from the smaller number he had to fall back on. " 7 — Abraham Lincoln renominated for the presidency of the TJ. S. " 14 — Gen. Polk (a Southern bishop) killed. " 15 — An unsuccessful assault for three days on Petersburg. Union losses 10,000 men. « 18— To this time Grant had lost 64,000 men— Lee 38,000 during this campaign. " 19— Steamer Kearsarge sinks the famous Alabama, on the coast of France. " 20 — Petersburg strongly reinforced by Lee. " 27 — Sherman, pushing Johnson at Keneshaw, meets a severe repulse. In one month he had driven Johnson 100 miles, fought six battles, and killed, wounded or taken prisoner 17,000 men. He followed Grant's principle, and " flanked " him. A retreat was the result. July 1— Public debt over $1,740,000,000. « 9— Gen. Early, with 20,000 Confederate troops, passes into Grant's rear, and makes a hasty march north into Maryland. This day he gained a victory over Gen. Wallace, but his losses were so great that he was hindered in his design of capturing "Washington, though within six miles of it at one time. He retreats, but soon turns back. " 18— President Lincoln calls for 500,000 more troops. " 19 — Gen. Averill (Union) gives Early a check, but finally falls back. " 20-22— Severe battles in the neighborhood of Atlanta, Geo. Gen. Sher- man victorious. Confederate losses in all over 15,000 ; Union about 5,500. Unioa Gen. McPherson killed. OAMl'AION 01 L864. Jul. 22 — A mine, made under the fortifications ol Bel It was charged with 8,000 lbs. of powder. " 88— Early sent a detachment into IVnn, which bunt ( u 80 — Gen. Stoneman defeated and taken prisoner Confederates. The mine exploded at Petersburg, blowing op i f<>rt and rison; hut, from unskillful management, provi 4,000 men were lost in killed, wounded and prisoni I A artillery attack was Kept up on P< tersburg through thia mouth. Aug. 2 — Gen. Banks puts all the negro* his n gion In the ermj Gulf, La.). " 3— Constant fighting at Atlanta. Hood (Confederate repn 44 5— Admiral Farragut enters Meddle bay with 18 '• rt» or destroys the vessels and forts. It was th Confederacy. 44 7 — Union Gen. Averill gains a complete vietnry a: M orfleld '•'• iVa 44 9 — Atlanta, Geo., bombarded hy Sherman's army. 44 11 — The Confederate vessel Tallahassee bOJ the course of Aug. 41 13 — Moshy, Confederate, captures an Immense supply tn ville, Va. 44 19 — Success of Southern forces before Petersburg. Took 8,00 44 21 — Lee fails to dislodge Warner, -who is destroying the Weldoo R K In three days Grant lost 4,500 men in this ondertak 44 31 — Gen. Howard, of Sherman's army, gains a decided victi borough, Geo. Sept. 2 — Gen. Hood evacuates Atlanta, Geo., a very Important pi Sherman at once occupies. Sherman had lust I in tl campaign, the Confederates 43,000. " 5 — Gen. Morgan, an active Southern cavalrj officer, Iskllh ville, Tenn. 44 12— Sherman sends away ail the families and burns ■ | I part Atlanta, preparatory to great and brillianl op< « 13— General Sheridan in the Shenandoah Vall< " 1G— A strong force of Confederate cavalry drive oil belonging to the Union army on .lane- river. 44 19— Sheridan defeats Early, (at Oquequan ing a loss of 8,000 men. 44 22— Sheridan again inflicts a loss of near I Hill, Va. " 29— Gen. Grant advances to within ten miles of Rl Gen. Price again invad< M >nrl. " 80— The blockading force captured and destroy) Oct. 5— A repulse of the BoUvhern fw 43 671 CAMPAIGN OF 1864. Oct. 7— The Confederate steamer Florida captured by the Wachusett, on the coast of Brazil. Sheridan, haying laid waste the Shenandoah valley, returns South. '• 8 Sheridan defeats the Confederates again in the Shenandoah valley. « 11 — Maryland votes for a constitution abolishing slavery. * 19— Sheridan annihilated Early, at Cedar Creek, by his famous "ride from Winchester," and rallying his men, after they had been defeated. Confederate refugees from Canada rob a bank in St. Albans, Vt. « 23 — Gen. Price defeated at Blue river, Missouri. « 27— Gen. Grant closes the active campaign by an extensive rcconnoi- sance. « 28— Gen. Blunt defeats Price and drives him out of Missouri. He returns no more. Nov. _Gen. Hood, in command of the forces in Georgia, withdrew from the neighborhood of Atlanta, for the purpose of destroying Sher- man's base of supplies, and invading Tennessee and Kentucky He had now about 40,000 men. Gen. Thomas was sent into Ten- nessee, by Sherman, with a strong force, to contend with him ; and Sherman, breaking away from his northern connections, com- mences his celebrated "march to the sea," in which he is lost to his friends for 40 days, but reaches Savannah in safety. " 4 — Johnsonville, Tenn., bombarded. 3 gunboats and 8 transports, with $1,500,000 of stores destroyed. " 8 — President Lincoln re-elected. Gen. McClellan resigns his com- mission. u 11 — A gunboat, the Tulip, blows up on Potomac river. Her boiler burst. « l3_Gen. Breckenridge attacks Gillem, near Morristown, Tenn., captur- ing his artillery, and several hundred prisoners. « 14 — Atlanta completely destroyed by Sherman, before his march South. « 16— Gen. Stoneman attacks Breckenridge, at Marion, Tenn., and cap- tures his artillery and 200 prisoners. Gen. Sherman starts for Savannah through the heart of the Con- federacy, with over 65,000 troops. He destroys railroads and lays the country waste wherever he is treated in a hostile manner. " 22 — Sherman's army reach Milledgeville, the capital of Georgia. The Gov. and Legislature hastily retire. The soldiers amuse them- selves by holding a mock legislature, passing loyal resolutions, &c. " 24 — The Union army in Ya., receive nearly 100,000 pounds of turkeys, sent from the North to supply them a Christmas dinner. " 25 — An attempt to fire New York city miscarries. " 30— Gen. Hood, Confederate, with 40,000 men, attacks Schofield, 18 miles from Nashville. Gen. Schofield had only 17,000 men Hood made four attacks, and was each time repulsed. He lost CONCLUDING I LMPAIOK. 6,000 men. At midnight Bchofleld retn • Kaahrille, joined Thomas, followed by Hood's army. Dec. 1— The U. S. navy has u'7l Teasels, carrying over I 51,000 men. It has captured 834 v< loringtl the war, 1,379—2(57 being steamers. " 5—65 blockade runners, ships and cargoes worth $ captured or destroyed by the U. S. navy, al \\ . \ « 8— Mr. Chase, ex-Sec. of the U. 8. Treasury, appointed Cblel Justice of the Supreme Court. 41 12 — Gen. Sherman's army reaches the rear of Savannah. Geo., which is occupied by the Confederate Gen. Hardee, with ].".,(nhi d u 13 — Gen. Hazen, of Sherman's command, captures Fl McA i near Savannah. It had been frequently attacked by gunboats \n\ m 15 — Gen. Rousseau defeats the Sou! hern forces under Forres! ll Mur- ireesborough, Tenn., with great loss. * 15-16 — Battle of Nashville, Tenn., in which Gen II t defeated by Gen. Thomas, Federal commander. II l"s tl\in^ troops pursued 200 miles. It was one of the I d t.h.-.v- of the war for the South. * 19 — President Lincoln calls for 300,000 volunteers to finish the M 20 — Gen. Stoneman, Unionist, captures forts and de s tro ys i ■'.: -.vrks, lead mines, and railway bridges at Saltvilh , East l> pnessee. Gen. Sherman summons Savannah to surrender. Geu II irdeo retreated in the night Gen. Sherman tak< xl day. CHAPTER XXVIII. CONCLUDING CAMPAIGN. The year 1864 closed in general disaster to the Coofed 'man had broken the Confederate power in Georgia, destroyed - tions with the Mississippi States, and taken Savannah <> D Thoi broken up Hood's army, in Tennessee, and Granl li- the Southern army in Virginia within Richmond and its Sheridan had dealt blow after blow on Early, In t) ■ ih N n and quite ruined his army. The future operations required the subjugation ofthe Insniof and South Carolina, the taking of a few forts on th< of Lee's army in Richmond. The only other ermj of stn i of Hood's forces, was in the Southern Interior. T was stronger than ever, both by sea and land. 1 much discouraged; their finances rained; their lighting men i abled, scattered, forced into submission, or, bopeleSi of ultitnslo su^ (576 CONCLUDING CAMPAIGN. had voluntarily withdrawn from the contest in so large numbers that the Confederate forces were everywhere inferior, and only upheld by the indom- itable pride and bravery inherent in the Anglo-American. They would submit only when necessity absolutely compelled them ; and thus saved their honor, in their own eyes. They had made a fatal mistake, and they reaped the full harvest of ruin. Yet, their prolonged resistance served to utterly annihilate slavery; raised the negroes to the honorable position of Defenders of the Union; and, the last of Jan., 1865, an amendment to the U. S. Constitution was prepared forever abolishing slavery in the country. In the end the blacks became citizens. "We have now but a short record to complete our View of the Civil War. The South had still over 100,000 men in arms, but they were surrounded, cut off from supplies, outnum- bered, and pressed with relentless vigor. This was Grant's policy. 1865. Jan. 14— Vessels are sent from Boston and New York with large supplies from the charitable, for Southern sufferers, in Savannah, Geo. « 15— Ft. Fisher, on the coast of N. C, captured by Gen. Terry, in con- junction with the U. S. fleet It is the last stronghold of the South on the sea. Edward Everett died, at Boston, Mass. « 16— The magazine at Ft. Fisher exploded, killing and wounding 300 Union men. « 17— A Federal monitor blown up by torpedoes, in Charleston Harbor r S. C. « 20— Corinth, Miss., evacuated by Southern troops. " 23— Gen. Hood surrenders his command in the Southern army to Gen. Taylor. « 28— Gen. Breckenridge becomes Confederate Sec. of "War. « 29 — Southern Commissioners seek an interview with President Lincoln at Fortress Monroe, in the interest of Peace. They failed to make any satisfactory terms. " 31— Joint resolution of Congress to amend the U. S. Constitution abol- ishing slavery (14th Amendment). Feb. —Nine States ratify the Constitutional Amendment in this month. •i 5— Grant suffers a repulse at Hatcher's Run. Loss 2,000 men. •< l7_Columbia, S. C, accidentally burned on its evacuation by Southern troops. A Confederate dollar (paper) worth but two cents in Rich- mond, Va. •« 18— Union troops take possession of Charleston, S. C, as a result of Sherman's march from Savannah north-eastward toward Rich- mond. Many buildings in Charleston burned in the destruction of Confederate stores by the retiring army. Gen. Lee in favor of arming the negroes for the defense of the South. It is declined by the Confederate government, until too late. CONCLUDING OAMFAIQS. Feb.25— 800 Southern soldiers desert, and come Into Union I Mar. a— Sheridan completely routs Gen, Early again, tak itroopg prisoners. " 4 — President Lincoln inaugurated for bis BOCond term. " 10— Qen. Bragg defeated, at Kingston, fl I " 15— Gen. Hardee (Confederate) defeated by Sherman's army. " 18 — The Confederate Congress adjourned. it never m< Battle of part of Sherman's army with Johnston, Confi 24,000 strong. Southern forces made six assaults which wen stood. After fighting and maneuvering 8 days, Johnston n having lost 3,000 men. Sherman lost [,646. 44 25— Ft. Steadman, near Petersburg, Ya., captured by Confi but was immediately retaken, with 2,000 prisoner!, This attai k was made by Lee, preparatory to evacuating Richmond. about 120,000 troops, Lee 70,000. " 29 — Sheridan commences an expedition to the rear <'f Rlchmoi off Lee's retreat South. " 31 — Sheridan attacked and hard pushed by Lee's for© - but at i. they fall back. Apr. 1— Sheridan, in turn, follows the Confederates, and drives then: Richmond. He takes more than 5,000 prisoners. 'I battle of Five Forks. It was fatal to Lee's retreat " 2 — Grant's forces make a grand assault. It is successful, prepares to evacuate Richmond. President Dai Is leave, fa tal in haste, for Danville, N. C. Gen. Lee commences bll in the night. " 3 — Richmond occupied by colored Federal troops. Tie \ thul-tho city in flames. " 4 — President Davis endeavors to make a -land against dl M* issues a proclamation from Danville. « 9_ Terms of surrender arranged by G intend L 44 10— Gen. Lee issues his farewell address to bis army. « 12 — Confederate army yielded prisoners of war at Appomatt I House, Virginia. 27,805 Confederate sold; Gen. Stoneman defeats a Conl. derate tone, at B Gen. Canby, Union, occupies Mobile, Ala. « 14— President Lincoln assassinated In Washington, by J I Mr. Seward stabbed in bed, but not killed. [• 15— Abraham Lincoln died at 7 a. m The wl mourning. Andrew Johnson assumes the office of l'r.-id. « 18— Paine, or Powell, who end. a. arrested at Mrs. Surratt's house In Waahla ' v "»** arrested. Gen. Sherman arranges preliminaries for the all U* 678 - CONCLUDING CAMPAIGN. remaining Confederate forces, with Gen. Johnston, commanding Southern army in N. C, with consent of Confederate Sec. of War and Jeff. Davis. It includes the basis of a general peace, and a policy of reconstruction. It is sent to the Federal government for their approval or rejection. Apr.19 — Funeral ceremonies of President Lincoln, at Washington. Funeral services are held all over the North. The body is carried in state to Springfield, 111., stopping at prominent places on the route; and visited by great numbers of the people. 700,000 were said to have been in the procession at New York. " 21 — Gen. Sherman's arrangement with Johnston disapproved by the government, and he is ordered to resume hostilities. Steamboat Sultana blows up on the Mississippi, and about 1,300 U. S. soldiers returning home were killed. " 24 — Gen. Grant visits Sherman. u 25 — J. W. Booth, the assassin of the President, taken prisoner near Port Royal, Va. Refusing to surrender, a soldier shot him, con- trary to orders. He died in 4 hours. No assassin ever met with more universal execration than Booth. Its necessary effect was to render the Reconstruction policy much more stern and painful to the South. " 26 — Johnston surrenders to Gen. Sherman all the Confederate troops in his command, on the terms granted Gen. Lee. " 29 — Arms and stores of Gen. Johnston's army delivered to U. S. author- ities, at Greensboro, N. C. May 2— Reward offered for capture of Jeff. Davis, of $100,000. He was, at first, believed accessory to the murder of President Lincoln " 3 — President Lincoln's remains arrive at Springfield, 111. " 4-9 — All the Confederate forces disbanded, or surrendered to U. S. officers, east and west of Mississippi river. * 10 — Jeff. Davis captured in Geo., in woman's clothes. GENERAL DATA. The number of volunteer troops to be mustered out of the Union army. May 1st, 1865, was 1,034,064. They were mostly discharged and paid in the next three months. The entire enlistments in the Federal army, during the whole war, were 2,688,523. Many were re-enlistments. It is believed that the whole number of individuals forming the armies was only 1,500,000. 75 per cent, were native Americans, 9 per cent. Germans, and 7 per cent Irish. Various nationalities made up the remaining 9 per cent. Of this million and a half 56,000 were killed in battle, 35,000 died in hospitals of their wounds received in battle, and 184,000 died in hospitals of disease. Many afterwards died, and others were ruined in health for life. It has been stated by the Adjutant General of the Confederate army, since the close of the war, that the available Confederate force during the entire OONCI.I war was 600,000, and thai they never had more than 200,000 In . «j any onetime. This would seem likelj to be ao m nearest to official data that we have. Be states the entir. the 1,000,000 men in the closing campaign to have i.. en reason to believe that the Confederates killed, and th< who died in hospital, was about 800,000. The entire amount expended by the National government, counties and towns, and contributed in other ways to Ihi tenance of the army, is computed at s-t,0ti(),(Mi I Southern army cannot be ascertained, hut it Is thought that Ihi and the destruction of property inflicted about an equal lots on :!. These losses in life and property are fearful; but they are t!.. Freedom and of Nationality. The genera] prosperity of the ■ hu made it richer than before, while natural Increase and Inn filled the places vacant by death. The South was hopeless and exhausted at the close of tl. been feared that a guerrilla war, the most desolating and all wars, would follow the defeat of the great armies. It destruction of what remained to the Southern people, and th>;. quietly to their fate. Various excesses and deeds ol hi * committed, but they were not sympathized with bj th< It was only the desperate and lawless class thai cami rally in war. Many of the influential Southern leaders COUU itable necessity, and themselves set the example. The poli< tion adopted by the National government, excluded, al Bret, all who I taken a part in the rebellion from political Influent small as it was, was alone to restore the Southern 9 the Union. It was, however, proposed to admit other-, botfa and classes, to participation in political action as thej thai trustworthy and loyal to the new order of thinj when it was felt to be quite safe, th< The most distasteful act of the Genen I I ament, to tl South, was clothing the blacks with the rigb the elective franchise, and assisted to rule DVCT their for was considered necessary, since they bad now no m them, to give them the power to protect th< something of influence and respectability by I advantage given them, they must take their cfa their own way. They bad been loyal to lh« I mended this policy to the government Th< North- settled in the South and the blacks mainly reo ments. This was the chief punishment lnfl n th. in retaliation for the war they had waged « a clemency quite unexampled in hletOIJ Ko bl I *M *•* «■ 680 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. laid clown their arras. The assassination of the beloved President Lincoln made the North thoroughly angry, but no vengeance was taken except on those believed to be immediately connected with the atrocious deed. The most lively indignation had long been felt at the dreadful treatment expe- rienced by prisoners of war in some of the prisons of the South ; but the government and the people contented themselves with the punishment of the governor of Andersonville prison, on due civil trial and conviction. On the whole, the conduct of the Northern people was extremely mag- nanimous. The dissolution of the Union would have been an irreparable loss to them ; they resolved not to suffer it; and, with extraordinary energy, they put in the field more than a million and a half of men, and near 700 vessels, to subdue it, and suffered no reverses to discourage them until this was done. When resistance ceased and the Union was secure, they exacted only the pledges necessary to keep it safe. Appreciating the unfortunate condition to which nearly all the before prosperous classes of the South were reduced, they aided them in their distress, ceased at once all hostile action, and left them to recover from their disasters under as favorable cir- cumstances as their own conduct warranted. The South naturally felt an affection for her Lost Cause, proportionate to the sacrifices she had made and the suffering she had endured for it. Time, and busy care to devel- op the vast resources that slavery had, in great part, neglected, would gradually restore them to right feeling, and the state of mind fitting them for citizenship. This, in part, has already taken place, and, by and by, the Bonds of the Whole Union will be more firmly cemented than ever before. May it be soon. CHAPTEE XXIX. HISTORY OF TILE U. S. FKOM 1865 TO 1874. May 13 — During the week ending with this day there was subscribed to the U. S. seven-thirty loan $98,000,000. It was an expression of the enthusiastic confidence of the people in the government and its resources. " 23-23 — Grand review of Gen. Sherman's army at Washington. There were 200,000 men. " 23 — Kirby Smith, the last leader of a Southern military organization, surrendered his command. " 30 — The great Sanitary Pair opened at Chicago. " 31 — Gen. Hood and his staff surrendered prisoners of war. June 1 — A day of fasting and national humiliation for the death of Presi- dent Lincoln. " 4 — Toombs, of Georgia, prominent in the early days of secession, shot BIBTOB mi' imi i, n \'Ha» himself to avoid arret treason. July 5— The four confederates of Booth, tbu were found guilty. They were hanged on <*« were Earold, Atzerott, Powell and Mrs. Bui " 11— Gen. R. E. Lee appointed president of the R Va. It was done by Southern people ai a mark • I furnish him a support; ho having lost his propertj ::i Sept. 20— The marking of the graves of r-\ixx> of tin- unforl ville prisoners completed. " 29— Cession of 1,000,000 acres of laud to the govt rnmeot by tin- <>Mge Indians, for $300,000. Oct. 20 — Champ Ferguson, noted for his crimes in gueriU . ing at Nashville, Tenn. Nov. 10 — Henry Wirz, the inhuman keeper of Ajlderoonvil .ng, after trial and condemation. Dec. 18 — Secretary Seward officially announces that the 13th A to the Constitution, abolishing Blavery in the I been adopted by three-fourths of the Bl law of the land. let;-; Jan. 1 — Third anniversary of Emancipation oel people. « 2— Funeral of Hon. Henry Winter Davis, 1 - S « 12 — The Kentucky University purchases the homes! *j « 33 — The 13th Constitutional Amendment reconsidered bj ture of New Jersey and passed. It had been rejectl ■! '■■•• I vioua year. " 25 — Kentucky refused to pass the i:',th Amendment. «< 31— Commissary and quartermaster wareh Kansas. $1,000,000 lost. Feb. 2— The Civil Rights bill passed thi - « H_The U. S. Sanitary Commission closed with an aanivi - ; . " 12 — Hon. Reverdy Johnson appointed Minister to I " 20 — Bill for re-admission of Ark. vetoed by the Pn tident, Inn o-immm) over his veto by a two-thirds vote. " 24 — The Bill for the admission of tin- other Shit. the President was likewise passed over his veto. July 4 — Horatio Seymour of N. Y. and F. 1'. Blair of Mo. nominated President and Vice-President by the Dem A political amnesty proclamation issued by the Pn " 16 — Admiral Farragut received with distinguished honor by Hie Qo of England. " 20 — A Bill to exclude the electoral votes of the Bouthen re-admitted vetoed by the President and passed 1 the veto. « 21— The 14th Amendment declared ratified, and I part of the tution. " 28 — Military government ceases in Arkansas, North and - *o- lina, Louisiana, Georgia, Florida and Alabama. Aug. 6— Jefl'erson Davis lands in Liverpool, fcngland. » is—XJ. S. steamers Wateree and Fredonla destroyed duria ■ quake at Lima, Peru; 40,000 lives were lost In this df .u» trophe. Sept. 7— Negro members of the Georgia Legislature expelled race, contrary to the 14th Amendment " 18-Battle with the Indians on Republican River. Lt B ™* others killed. » 19-Riot at Camilla, Geo., caused by hostility of Southern 1 1 the political privileges of the blacks M u J Ultod « 29-Gen. Reynolds, military governor ol Tel in that State for President, Texas not having This was in accordance with the law of Ooi Oct 17-^ie Legislature of Oregon withdraw! *• 14th Amendment. , . Nov.S-U. S. Grant and Schuyler Colfai elect, President, Popular majority 809,722 Elector. and Colfax, 214; for Seymour and Blair, 8 Bippi -d Texas did not vo^ JjdN ; The wliole popular vote was ..,.,,..< i- »" were chosen by the Legislature. - 27-TheIndmns defeated by Gen. Custar, on Jh. Kettle, the chief, and more than, hundred. lUW Dec. 1-Ft. Lafayette, N. Y., destroyed by I 086 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. " 3 — Political troubles in Arkansas, in which many murders are com- mitted. " 7 — Third session of the 40th Congress begins. " 15— A social gathering of the Union soldiers at Chicago. 1869. Jan. 7 — John Minor Botts, a statesman of Va., imprisoned by the Confed- erate government during the war for his Union sentiments, died. Feb. 27 — A joint resolution of Congress recommends to the States the adoption of the 15th Amendment to the Constitution. Mar. 4— Gen. Grant inaugurated eighteenth President. « " — First session of the 41st Congress commenced. " 13 — James Guthrie, a statesman of Ky., died. " 25— Hon. E. Bates, of Mo., Att'y Gen'l under Lincoln, died. May 15 — The Union Pacific Railroad was completed by joinijg the two ends at Ogden, Utah. Distance from Omaha to San Francisco 1904 miles. This completed the line of railroad joining the At- lantic and Pacific. The greatest triumph of engineering yet known was accomplished in the Nevada Mts., by carrying the road to a height of over 7000 feet in 105 miles. July 30— Hon. I. Toucey, of Conn., who had filled many offices in the State and United States government, died. Sept. 8— William B. Fessenden, of Me., a statesman of reputation, died. " 10— John Bell, of Ky., candidate for the Presidency in 1860, died. " 6— Gen. J. A. Rawlins, Sec. of War, died. He had been Gen. Grant's Chief of Staff during the war. Oct. 8— Franklin Pierce, of N. H., ex-President, died. Nov. 7— Rear Admiral Stewart, of U. S. Navy, died. Dec. 24— Edwin M. Stanton, of Pa., Sec. of War during most of the civil war, died. This year closes a most important era in the history of the United States, and of the world. The account with the civil war was definitely closed, and the final seal set on the policy of reconstruc- tion by the inauguration of Gen. Grant, and the continuance of the Republican party in power by the people, together with the readmission of most of the Southern States and the possibility of the reversal of the decision in regard to slavery done away by the adoption of the fifteenth Amendment to the Constitution, giving the elective franchise to the colored population. Much emphasis was given to all these things by the prosperity of the country, and the rapid reduction of the debt, by the generally wise conduct of the Southern people, and the slowly increasing prosperity of that section. These results reacted in other countries to strengthen the tendency to freer and more popular governments, and seem, in some respects to have introduced the Era of Republicanism. HISTORY OK T1IK IMTI ' However slow may be the change! in Un- to be made. 1870. Jan. 1— Ten years ago the cloud of civil war Mttlod di country, and threaten, d Its destruction. I been passed by nearly Bis years, and its ruin under the new and more thrifty growth of all tries even in the South. " 20— H. It. Revels, of Miss., is chosen tie ever represented a Btate in I tonj ress. " 23 — The U. S. steamer Oneida Bunk by collision with si the coast of Japan. 17(5 lives lost Feb. 22 — Hon. Anson Burlingame, head of the Chin 0m powers of Christendom, di irg, R Mar. 28— Gen. G. II. Thomas dies in Ban Francif " 30— The Sec. of State proclaims the ratification of thi I5ta \:,. '•'• Aug.14— Death of Admiral Farragut, at Portsm mth, N. II Sept. 7 — Recognition of the French Republic by 1 1 1 I - Oct. 12 — Death of Gen. R. E. Lee, formerly of th< ( 1871. Great changes have been taking place in Europe. T :n this day President G elected. " 9— A great fire in Boston, Mass. Loss* Olnbulldb merchandise. Insurance $50,000,0uo. In this month and December following Btorma "1 extremi caused great loss of life ami property. An overflow ol ii,. i Po, in Italy, rendered 40,000 persona hom< less. In v.. 80 vessels were wrecked, some islands were Inundated, and all their inhabitants drowned. It was noil., England and Ireland. " 29 — Horace Greeley, recent candidate for President of tin I B aged 62 years. Dec. 11 — The King of the Sandwich Island.-, Kami thanv iha V. dfc leaving no heir. " 12 — The actor, Edwin Forrest, dies, at Philadelphia. " 17 — Edward A. Pollard, editor and author, died Important investigations of ubtist- in Ni w York city lad Ifl conduct of the Pacific Railway air made this winter* and ma p healthy reforms inaugurated. The order of Patrons "t Hu becomes popular among agriculturists, and ipreadi rapidly, througli the coming year. 1873. Jan. 7,8,9— A dreadful snow storm occurs in Mini; r which 70 are lost. " 9 The ex-Emperor Napoleon III. dies at Chiselhurst, 1 aged 64 years. " 31— At Chicago, 111., Joel A. Matteson, « i governor I Feb. 1— M. F. Maury, formerly distinguished in the I dies at Lexington, Va. «< 9_j. w. Geary, ex-Governor of Penn., died at Hanrlsb " 15— Steamer Henry A. Jones burned in I lives lost. Mar. 3— Congress enacted a law increasing their pay, tb i and various officers of the government. It i whole previous term of the 42d CJoi 1871. This law waa very offensive to I " 4— The wreck of the Alaska mail steam, i at Portland, Oregon. All on board » 16— The Boston steamer, Grace [rving, founds I 690 HISTOKY OF THE UNITED STATES. • " 17 — Great fire at Lawrenceburg, Ky. " 19 — San Salvador, Central America, destroyed by an earthquake. Property destroyed estimated at from $12,000,000 to $20,000,000 ; and 500 lives lost. Apr. 1 — Steamer Atlantic wrecked near Halifax, N. S. 535 lives lost. May 5 — James Orr, American Minister to Russia, died, at St. Petersburg, aged 51. " 4 — An iron bridge at Dixon, 111., crowded with people witnessing a baptism, fell, killing and drowning 100 persons. " 7— Salmon P. Chase, Chief Justice of the U. S., died in New York, aged 65. " 8 — Hon. Gakes Ames, M. C, died at North Easton, Mass., aged 69. John Stuart Mill, a celebrated English philosopher and author, died at Avignon, France. " 80 — A second great fire in Boston, Mass. June 28 — Hon. Horace F. Clark, prominent in railway enterprises, died in New York. " 27- 'Hiram Powers, the distinguished American sculptor, died in Florence, Italy. " 29- -Jesse R. Grant, father of the President, died. July 4 — Severe storm, very destructive to crops in Ohio, Indiana, Wiscon- sin and Missouri. 20 persons drowned in Green Lake, Wisconsin. Aug. 2 — Great fire at Portland, Oregon. Loss $1,500,000. " 24 — A storm of unprecedented severity raged on the coast of British America, and, at the same time, on the coast of Mexico. More than 100 vessels were destroyed in and near the gulf of St. Law- rence. Some populous islands were quite laid waste. 176 sailing vessels and 12 steamers were lost in the Gulf of Mexico. Sept. 15 — The propeller Ironsides foundered in Lake Michigan. 31 lives lost. The Patrons of Husbandry organize about this time at the rate of near 1,000 granges a month. In this month commenced a most serious financial panic at New York, that spread over the whole country. Oct 26 — J. C. Hcenan, the prize fighter, died on the Union Pacific R. R. Nov. 6 — Gen. Sickles, U. S. Minister to Spain, telegraphs to Washington the capture of the Virginius by the Cubans. " 8 — Stephen R. Mallory, former Sec. of the Confederate Navy, died, aged 63. " 19 — John P. Hale, of N. H., a statesman of some celebrity, died. " 22— The steamship Ville du Havre run into and sunk by the Loch Earn in mid ocean. 226 lives lost. " 27— Richard Yates, ex-U. S. Senator and ex-Governor of Illinois, died at St. Louis, aged 55. Dec. 1— The 43rd Congress assembles for its first session. " 14 — Louis Agassiz, a distinguished naturalist and man of science, died u\ Cambridge, Mass. HISTORY OF THE r.MI! 1874 Jan. —The U. S. government narrowrj account of the taking of the Virginiusbj Cuban at i vessel was sailing under the American Bag which its capture. 54 men were Bhol as plral citizens. The Spanish government disavowed tl np the vessel, Dec. 10th, 1878. It was bo much dai sink while on the way to the United St " 2 — A Revolution in Spain overthrows the govern! Castelar. " 5 — The President sends a message to Cong] ish difficulty, now substantially settled. " 8 — U. S. Senate repeals the bill of March 3rd, 1878, Ina of members of Congress. " 9 — Hon. Caleb Gushing nominated Chief Justice <>i tl. rn» Court. " 14 — Nomination of Caleb Gushing retailed. " 17 — Death of the Siamese twins. *' 19 — Morrison R. Waite, of Ohio, was nominated by the In Chief Justice and confirmed afterward l>\ the S " 27 — Reliable intelligence ofthe death of David Livb explorer, reaches England. Feb. 4 — The seventh annual meeting of the National Ql > of Husbandry occurs in St. Louis, Mo - have been added during the year. The Exei ul that farmers had saved $8,000,000 during the year by tt - I ative system. Mar. 8 — Ex-President Fillmore died, in Buffalo, N \ " 11— Death of Hon. Charles Sumner, a distinguished *n »nd Senator from Mass., in Washington, He w is born in ; Mass., Jan. 6th, 1811, and was 68 years old Be* race which originated in the county of Cent, grandfather was a Major distinguished for valor in tionary army Charles Sumner graduated from B i in 1830, was' admitted to the bar In 1884, an I tinguished as a lawyer. Beei Dai S. Senate in 1851, in which he remained til! hi always conspicuous as one of the forem 41 24 — A bill increasing the currency I House of Representatives by l< tpv. 1-The U. S. debt officially Mate,! - *2 IXxamm of debt during March, 1874,18,188 « 14— The Senate bill increasing the currencj resentatives. Many protests from different | are presented against it as injurious 10 the credit at <* «* 692 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. the country. The discussion of this measure has occupied much of the time of Congress for some months. Apr.18— The funeral of Livingstone, the lamented African explorer, takes place in London, England, where his remains had arrived. He was interred in Westminster Abbey, as a mark of distinguished honor. « 17 — Gov. Wm. B. Washburn is elected by the Mass. Legislature to represent the State in the IT. S. Senate, made vacant by the death of Charles Sumner. " 22 — President Grant vetoes the Currency Bill increasing the issues of paper money, which defeats the measure, its friends in Congress not being numerous enough to pass it over the veto. " 24 — The Congressional committee on Transportation, after long and careful investigation, advised government oversight of Railroads,. but against government ownership. " 28— Congress voted $90,000 in aid of sufferers by the inundation of the lower Mississippi. May 7— $100,000 were added to the above sum for the same purpose. " 19 — The system of payments to informers in customs revenue cases, repealed. That system appeared to have been very grossly abused. " " The conflict in Arkansas ended in the retreat of Brooks and the reinstatement of Gov. Baxter. " u The New York Legislature passed a Compulsory Education Bill, which became a law in that state. June 1 — Mr. Richardson, Secretary of the Treasury, resigned. Gen. Benj. H. Bristow of Ky., was appointed to succeed him. " " The number of subordinate Granges of the Patrons of Husbandry is 19,492. The number of Patrons who are voters is estimated at 1,000,000. " 23 — Congress adjourned. The sums appropriated at this session for carrying on the government amounted to $189,784,340.25. The largest item was for the Post Office Department — over $41,000,000. - 24 — Postmaster-General, John A. J. Creswell resigned, and Hon. Mar- shall Jewell was appointed in his place " 25 — Telegraphic communication between the United States and Brazil introduced by congratulatory messages between the Emperor of Brazil and the President of the U. S. July 8 — Message of Gov. Davis of Minnesota to the Sec. of War, announ- cing the entire destruction of crops in man} - counties of that state by grasshoppers. " 14 — Another great fire in Chicago. Loss over $4,000,000. Gen Custer, commanding an exploring expedition in the Black Hills of Dacotah, reported discoveries of rich gold mines there. " 27 — An International Congress for mitigating the sufferings of war history OF I ill-; i miii, 9TAT1 by means of an International Code of I in Belgium. Aug.l9-A riot between whiles and blacks in Kentucky murders of blacks. The Got. called oul ill. ,,, order. Sept. 2—400 Mormons sail from England for this country a " 5— Gen. Sherman order. Military head quarters ol removed from Washington in si. Lon " 5— The one hundredth anniversary of the iir>t d tinental Congress in Philadelphia, celebrated " 7— Great fire at Meiningen, Germany. Loss in building* «J $3,000,000. " 13— Guizot, a celebrated French author a: man, dl " 14 — The white League, a secret organization opposed lo the . ••• chisement of the colored people, produced a conflict In N leans. 17 were killed and 82 wounded i: State government completely overthrown. " 16 — President Grant interfered by proclamation and i " 18 — was surrendered to the regular authorities, under ; Oct. 13 — Elections held in 6 states returned 12 demon more than the previous number Nov. 3 — Elections in 23 states give a Btrong democratic ; a reaction against the government A sen^e of tin- reform in various ways, and of greater purity and administration was wide spread. It lit growth of the Patron> of Husbandry, and political reaction. It was a significant r- buki A typhoon, or hurricane at Bong Cong, Cb stroyed 30,000 lives and $50,000,000 of property. Europe is making great political improvements In i ing the last three years, out of im electii oa to fl|| i the National Assembly, 152 have been republic archists, and in Russia the government I compulsory education. Dec. 1— The number of Granges in the United Si « 7— The last session of the {forty-third <'oin:r< President's Message Btrongly reenmmux specie payments. " 12— Kalakaua, King of the Bandwich Islands on a visit. He was received by tie I leal on • Congress on the 18th. « 21— Disturbances at Vicksburg, Miss . called oul the President. « 28— Gerrit Smith, a distinguiahed abolll died in New York, aged 7& 694 HISTOEY OF THE UNITED STATES. 1875. Jan. 1 — Monarchy was restored in Spain. Alphonso XII, son of the ex. queen Isabella, -was proclaimed King, and received the support of the army and navy. It was only a few months before that most of the European governments recognized the Spanish Republic. " 4— Gen. Sheridan took command of the Department of the Gulf, at New Orleans. On that day the Legislature of Louisiana was or- ganized, and United States troops, acting under the orders of the speaker and of Gov. Kellogg, ejected several members who, it waa alleged, were not entitled to seats. It produced much excitement throughout the country, the opposition denouncing it as an unex- ampled interference of the Federal Executive with State govern- ment. Congress sustained the action of the President, but exerted its influence to quiet the excitement in Louisiana, and a compro- mise was effected under which it gradually ebbed away. " 12 — Toung-tchi, Emperor of China, died, aged 19 years. The emigrants arriving at the port of New York during the year 1874, numbered 149,762; a decided falling off, the arrivals having for some years, amounted to 250,000. The governments of Ger- many are endeavoring to remove the causes of emigration which threatens to affect their resources seriously. Feb. 3 — A proposed reciprocity treaty with Canada, was rejected by the Senate. " 5— The civil rights Bill, adopted by the Senate during the last session, was amended by an omission relating to schools and adopted by the House. It was accepted by the Senate Feb. 27th, and signed by the President, March 1st. " 25 — A Republic was definitely recognized in France. Mar. 2 — A Bill increasing the Tariff was passed by the Senate. Gen. Lorenzo Thomas of the U. S. army died, aged 71. " 3 — A law admitting Colorado as a state was passed. " 4 — A law, passed in haste in the last hours of the session, restored the Franking Privilege to members of Congress until Dec. 1, and increased the postage on newspapers and packages for the people. The forty -third Congress came to a close. " 5 — The Senate convened in extra session in accordance with a call previously made by the President. G. S. Orth was confirmed U. S. Minister to Austria, and Horace Maynard U. S. Minister to Turkey. " 10 — A new treaty with Belgium was ratified. " 18— The Senate ratified the treaty with Hawaii, which renders the interests of the Sandwich Islands substantially identical with those of the United States. " 20 — A destructive tornado in Georgia caused great loss of life and property. HI8TOUY <>i mi i m n|, n Mar.24— The Senate, after officially approving th< in Louisana, closed it- special session. F. E. Spinner, Tinted Btatea Treasure] of Ind. was appointed liis Bnccessor. Apr.19 — The centennial anniver.-ar\ of the battli brated •with great interest This battle was th in the War of Independent tl oea and tb< were dwelt on by some of the mosl distinguished lit- cans, and honored hy the presence of the Pn sidenl ol States and many of its most eminent anthoritii " 23 — Three Steamers burned at New Orleans, in which flftj lost. " 28 — A fire at Oshkosh, Wis., destroyed a square mile of th< cltj I in property over $2,000,000. May 7 — A Bill for suppressing religious order- Introduce man Parliament. It subsequently became ■ law. The Steamship Schiller was wrecked on tbi Britain Three hundred and eleven lives wen " 10 — Centennial anniversary of the capture of Port Tic • Ethan Allen. " 15 — Attorney General Williams resigned and Jud pont was appointed his successor. 17 — John C. Breckenridgc, formerly Yin President of tb< I States, and a general in the Confederate army during ll • I War, died, aged 54. " 18— A fearful earthquake in New Qranada, South \ of Cucuta was completely destroyed; between thousand lives were lost and more than 18,000,1 destroyed. " 20— Celebration of the Mecklenburg, N 0, DecIamtJ a pesv dence, with great enthusiasm. " 30— The Steamer Vicksburg on a from Canada I was wrecked in a held of ice BO lives m n Junel7-Centennial anniversary of the battle of Bui brated with great eclat, [to most interesting ternal spirit manifested by the North and Bontl Several Southern State. W ( re n pr« sent.d by b " 30-Bu3iness failure- -it.ee .Ian 1, of this year reported al liabilities amounting in all t" ■ July 8-Gen. Frank P. Blair, .Tun . died it. St I « 18-Lady Franklin, widow of Sir John Franklin, It Arctic Explorer, died in England, agi d 7» Great loss of life and property . floods In two cities alone the da'. ' '«>.«»■ 696 HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES. and in the south of France at $75,000,000. Other parts of Europe have suffered heavily from the same cause. " 23 — Isaac Merrit Singer, inventor of the Sewing Machine of that name, died in London, England, aged 64. The most prominent political issue of the time is hard money and currency. A Democratic convention in Md., and a Republi- can convention in Minn., each, yesterday and to-day, adopted a hard money platform. Ohio and Pa. democratic conventions afterwards declared for paper money. " 31 — Ex-President Andrew Johnson died in Tenn., aged 67. He was recently elected U. S. Senator from Tennessee. Aug. — The Gov. of Tenn. appointed Hon. D. M. Key, to fill the vacancy in the Senate caused by Andrew Johnson's death. " 4 — Republican government in France was strengthened by the pas- sage of a Bill constituting a Senate. The census of population in Louisania, gives 850,390, an increase of over 15 per cent, since 1870. The excess of increase of colored over white population has been 45,668. The census in Wisconsin gives a population of 1,236,090, being an increase of 17% per cent, since 1870. " 26 — The Bank of California suspended payment. It has long been the leading bank in the Pacific States. " 27 — W. C. Ralston, president of the Bank of California, was drowned while bathing. Sept. 1 — Violent disturbances in Mississippi between whites and blacks result in many deaths. 7— The Governor of Miss, called on the President for federal aid to protect citizens and restore order. 698 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. CHAPTEE XXX. PAELIAMENTAEY EULES. We give in this chapter the Standing Rules and Orders for conducting business in the House of Representatives of the United States, as a proper compend of parliamentary rules for the people of the United States. They are naturally a standard of procedure in all public bodies in this country so far as the circumstances are parallel ; they have been carefully compiled and adopted by our highest popular Legislative Body during the course of more than three-quarters of a century, and may therefore be considered thoroughly well adapted to the genius of our people and the character of our institutions ; and they were originally based on Jefferson's Manual, compiled by him for the use, and at the request of the Senate when, as Vice-President of the United States, he became its presiding officer, and was digested by him from the usages of the English Parliament and other Legislative bodies in Europe. The value of this manual is attested by its use continued to the present day, so far as it is applicable. The Rules of the House are therefore rep. resentative of the wisdom of the Old World on this point as well as of the usages of the New. They deserve to be carefully studied by American citizens above any other body of parliamentary rules for several reasons besides those men- tioned above. Hardly any other will be likely to contain bo many points of adaptation to popular use; every one should be fairly acquainted with the prevailing usages that he may be ready to act his part well if called on to preside in any public meeting; all who read the reports of congressional doings require such acquaintance with parliamentary usage to fully appre- ciate many points in such reports, and these Rules are a fine illustration of the spirit of our government and the genius of the American people. PABLIAMEN I \X\ :. We see, in the most impressive manner, thai th< make Legislative work orderly, d< c iroua, and i i due care that what is done shall be w< 11 and carefullj are spared, in regulations, that every legislator shall have ih< ing all that is his special business to know ; and is taken to see that economy and faithfulnee all the officers of the government [fthis is nol alwaj is, at least, no fault in the wrrangements, ruUsand the people should know to what they m sentatives accountable, and thej will l» prepared of obedience or transgression, Tin Rules are just and . ! people see that they are properly observed. The House of Representatives baa 160 Roles, thi - Joint Rules of the House and Senate, regulating their i each other, number 22. Whatever of dill", rein-, unimportant after due allowance is made for the diffei constitution of the two bodies. The principles on which i are identical. STANDING RULES AND ORDKRS FOR < OND1 IN THE HOUSE OF REPRESENTATIVES • THE UNITED BTATE8 THE DUTY OK Till: si 1.AK1 B. 1. He shall take the chair every day precisely at the ' House shall have adjourned on the preceding >\iy i -hall Immi the members to order; and, on tin- appearance i f B quoi >«*•• the journal of the preceding day to be read. 2, He shall preserve order and decorum : may speak I in preference to other members, rising from bis seat for III i shall decide questions of order, subject to an app *7 two members— on which appeal no member shall unless by leave of the House. 3 He shall rise to put a question, but m iy s\ iti H 4. Questions shall be distinctly put in this form, are of opinion that (as the question may affimative voice is expressed, "As many sayi^." If the Speaker doubt, or a d, shall divide; those in the affirmative of tl their seats, and afterward, those in the I doubt, or a count be required by at 1. members, the Speaker shall name two m< m the members in the affirmative and i shall rise and state the decision to the 1 1 .^ 5. The Speaker shall examine and correct U> 700 i-akliamentary rules. He shall have a general direction of the hall, and the unappropriated rooms in that part of the capitol assigned to the House shall be subject to his order and disposal until the further order of the House. He shall have a right to name any member to perform the duties of the chair, but such substitution shall not extend beyond an adjournment. 0. No person shall be permitted to perform divine service in the cham- ber occupied by the House of Representatives, unless with the consent of the Speaker. 7. In all cases of ballot by the House, the Speaker shall vote ; in other cases he shall not be required to vote, unless the House be equally divided, or unless his vote, if given to the minority, will make the division equal ; and in case of such equal division, the question shall be lost. P. All acts, addresses, and joint resolutions, shall be signed by the Speaker ; and all writs, warrants, and subpoenas, issued by order of the House, shall be under his hand and seal, attested by the clerk. 9. In case of any disturbance or disorderly conduct in the galleries or lobby, the Speaker (or Chairman of the Committee of the Whole House,) shall have power to order the same to be cleared. OF THE CLERK AND OTHER OFFICERS. 10. There shall be elected at the commencement of each Congress, to continue in office until their successors are appointed, a clerk, sergeant-at- arms, doorkeeper, and postmaster, each of whom shall take an oath for the true and faithful discharge of the duties of his office, to the best of his knowledge and abilities, and to keep the secrets of the House; and the appointees of the doorkeeper and postmaster shall be subject to the approval of the Speaker; and, in all cases of election by the House of its officers, the vote shall be taken viva voce. 11. In all cases where other than members of the House may be eligi- ble to an office by the election of the House, there shall be a previous nomination. 12. In all other cases of ballot than for committees, a majority of the votes given shall be necessary to an election ; and where there shall not be such a majority on the first ballot, the ballots shall be repeated until a majority be obtained. And in all ballotings blanks shall be rejected, and not taken into the count in enumeration of the votes, or reported by the tellers. 13. It shall be the duty of the clerk to make and cause to be printed and delivered to each member at the commencement of every session of Congress, a list of the reports which it is the duty of any officer or depart- ment of the government to make to Congress; referring to the act or reso- lution and page of the volume of the laws or journal in which it may be contained, and placing under the name of each officer the list of reports required to be made, and the time when the report may be expected. 14. It shall be the duty of the clerk of tho House at the end of each PABU wn N : m:v i:i i session, to send a printed copj of the Journal! ti. and to each branch of the Legislator 15. All questions of order shall be noted by th and put together at the .•ml of the journal ■ 16. The clerk shall, within thirty daj i after th< Congress, cause to be completed the printing and prim members and delegates, of the Journal ol the II an accurate index of the same. 17. There shall be retained In the library of the use of the members there, and not to be withdrawn ti. ©f all the books and printed document* d< poeiu i in the libi 18. The clerk shall have preserved for each mem r u> extra copy, in good binding, of all the document! print either House at each future Bession ofO 19. The clerk shall make a weekly Btatemei bills (Senate hills inclusive) upon the Speaki th a brief reference to the orders and proceedings of th< II the date of such order and proceedings; which staU m for the use of the members. 20. The clerk shall cause an index to 1»' prep ired to ; every session of Congress, and to be printed and bound 21. All contracts, bargains, or agreements, relative i<> tl any matter or thing or for the performance of an) Representatives, shall be made with the clerk, or appi any allowances shall be made therefor bj tht Com mitt 22. It shall be the uuty of the sergeant at arm ing its sittings; to aid in the enforcement of order under l the Speaker; to execute the commandaof the II together with all such process, Issued by authority thereof, .i- dirccted to him by the Speaker. 23. The symbol of his office (the m at-arms when in the execution of his ofl 24. The fees of tin' sergeant-at^rma shall be for en two dollars; for each day's custody and n traveling expenses for himself or a -\- i >l u one-tenth of a dollar for each mile n< such officer or other person in the execution of such pi 25. It shall be the duty of the the pay and mileage of members, to pn pan so, to draw the money on such che< ka for I previously signed by the Speaker, and endo over the same to the memto r i ntitled :' 26. The scrireant-at-arms shall States, in a sum not less than five nor i the discretion of tin ■ Speaker, and with 702 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. approve, faithfully to account for the money corning into his hands for the pay of members. 27. The doorkeeper shall execute strictly the 134th and 135th rules, relative to the privilege of the hall. And he shall be required, at the com- mencement and close of each session of Congress, to take an inventory of all the furniture, books, and other public property in the several committee and other rooms under his charge, and shall report the same to the House; which report shall be referred to the Committee on Accounts, who shall determine the amount for which he shall be held liable for missing articles. 38. The postmaster shall superintend the post-office kept in the capitol for the accommodation of the members. OF THE MEMBERS. 29. No member shall vote on any question in the event of which he is immediately and particularly interested, or in any case where he was not within the bar of the House when the question was put. And when any member shall ask leave to vote, the Speaker shall propound to him the question, "Were you within the bar before the last name on the roll was called ? " and if he shall answer in the negative the Speaker shall not fur- ther entertain the request of such member to vote : Provided, however, that any member who was absent by leave of the House, may vote at any time before the result is announced. 30. Upon a division and count of the house on any question, no mem- ber without the bar shall be counted. 31. Every member who shall be in the house when the question is put, shall give his vote unless the House shall excuse him. All motions to excuse a member from voting, shall be made before the house divides, or before the call of the yeas and nays is commenced; and the question shall then be taken without debate. 32. The name of a member who presents a petition or memorial, or who offers a resolution for the consideration of the House, shall be inserted on the journals. 33. No member shall absent himself from the service of the House unless he have leave, or be sick and unable to attend. OF CALLS OF THE HOUSE. 34. Any fifteen members (including the Speaker, if there be one), shall be authorized to compel the attendance of absent members. 35. Upon calls of the House, or in taking the yeas and nays on any question, the names of the members shall be called alphabetically. 36. Upon the call of the House, the names of the members shall be called over by the clerk, and the absentees noted; after which the names of the absentees shall again be called over; the doors shall then be shut, and those for whom no excuse or insufficient excuses are made may, by order of those present, if fifteen in number, be taken into custody as they PARI, I AM i:nt\uy KM •appear, or may be sent for and taken Into custody, wl by special messengers to be appointed for that purp 37. When a member shall be discharged from custody bis seat, the House shall determine whether Buch dUx or without paying fees; and in like manner whether a di lii taken into custody by a special messenger, shall or -hall not defray the expenses of such special messenger. ON MOTIONS, THEIE l'l: ENCB, I 38. When a motion is made and seconded, it -hall I ! by the Speaker; or, being in writing, it shall be handed to the chair tad - aloud by the clerk, before debated. 39. Every motion shall be reduced to writing If the B| member desire it. Every written motion made to the Hou inserted on the journals, with the name of the member maku it be withdrawn on the same day on which it was submit-. 40. After a motion is stated by the Speaker, or read bj shall be deemed to be in the possession of the Hon e, but no drawn at any time before a decision or amendn 41. When any motion or proposition is made, the question, House now consider it?" shall not be put unless Ltlsdem member, or is deemed necessary by the Speak 42. When a question is under debate, no motion shall bo to adjourn, to lie on the table, for the previous question, t •certain day, to commit or amend, to postpone indefinitely motions shall have precedence in the order in which th« and no motion to postpone to a certain day, to commit, or post itely, being decided, shall be again allowed on the same d ly, I* same stage of the bill or proposition 43. When a resolution shall be offered, or a motion m subject, and different committees shall be prop I. th< taken in the following order: The Committee of the Whole House on tb mitteeofthe Whole House; a Standing Oomm 44. Amotion to adjourn, and a motion to hx the House shall adjourn, shall be always in order; l motion to lie on the table, shall be derided without d. 45. The hour at which every motion on the journal. rt rr 46. Any member may call for the division oi the main question is ordered, which shall propositions in substance so distinct that, stantive proposition shall remain tor the d. to strike out and insert shall be deemed >nd> out being lost, shall preclude neither amendment BOfl out and insert. h<" 704 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. 47. Motions and reports may be committed at the pleasure of the House. 48. No motion or proposition on a subject different from that under consideration shall be admitted under color of amendment. No bill or resolution shall, at any time, be amended by annexing thereto, or incor- porating therewith, any other bill or resolution pending before the House. 49. When a motion has been once made, and carried in the affirmative or negative, it shall be in order for any member of the majority to move for the reconsideration thereof, on the same or succeeding day ; and such motion shall take precedence of all other questions, except a motion to adjourn, and shall not be withdrawn after the said succeeding day without the consent of the House ; and thereafter any member may call it up for consideration. 50. In filling up blanks, the largest sum and longest time shall be first put. ORDER OF BUSINESS OF THE DAY. 51. As soon as the journal is read, and the unfinished business in which the House was engaged at the last preceding adjournment has been dis- posed of, reports from committees shall be called for and disposed of; in doing which the Speaker shall call upon each standing committee in reg- ular order, and then upon select committees ; and if the Speaker shall not get through the call upon the committees before the House passes to other business, he shall resume the next call where he left off, giving preference to the report last under consideration: Provided, That whenever any com- mittee shall have occupied the morning hour on two days, it shall not be in order for such committee to report further until the other committees shall have been called in their turn. On the call for reports from commit- tees on each alternate Monday, which shall commence as soon as the journal is read, all bills reported during the first hour after the journal is read shall be committed, without debate, to the Committee of the Whole, and together with their accompanying reports, printed ; and if during the hour all the committees are not called, then, on the next alternate Monday, the Speaker shall commence where such call was sus- pended: Provided, That no bill reported under the call on alternate Mon- days, and committed, shall be again brought before the House by a motion to reconsider. ."i'2. Reports from committees having been presented and disposed of, tin' Speaker shall call for resolutions from the members of each State and delegate from each Territory, beginning with Maine and the Territqry last organized, alternately ; and they shall not be debated on the very day of their being presented, nor on any day assigned by the House for the receipt of resolutions, unless where the House shall direct otherwise, but shall lie on the table, to be taken up in the order in which they are presented; and if on any day the whole of the States and Territories shall not be called, the Speaker shall begin on the next day where he left off the previous day: Provided, That no member shall offer more than one resolution, or one PARI I AMI N \ w:\ series of resolutions, all relating to the same and Territories Bhal] have been called. 53. A proposition requesting information from I United States, or directing i; to led by tli Executive departments, nr by the Po table one clay for consideration, unless other* raous eonsent of the Eouse, and all Buch pro| for consideration in the order thej were pi reports arc called for from select committees, and wh< shall cause the same to be delivered. 54. After one hour shall have been devoted to i and resolutions, it shall be in order, pending the i 6ion thereof, to entertain a motion thai the II pose of the business on the Speaker's table, and to I ■which being decided in the affirmative, the Speaker thai business on his table in the following order, \ 1st. Messages and other Executive communicatii 2d. Messages from the Senate, and amendment bills of the House. 3d. Bills and resolutions from the Senate on their first and that they be referred to committees and put and read a second time, no motion being made to < •ininit. thi ordered to their third reading unless objection be a if not otherwise ordered by a majority of the I! laid on the table in general He of hills on the v taken up in their turn. 4th. Engrossed bills and bills from the B< nate on their third 6th. Bills of the House and from the Senate on the B engrossment, or on being ordered I • a third n and considered in the order of time In which thej reading. The messages, communications and bills on posed of, the Speaker shall then proceed to call tie 55. The business specified in the 64th and 180th n no other part of the day, except by permission 56. The consideration of the unfinished bu may be engaged at an adjournment shall bt nal Of the next day is read, and at the MOW tin disposed of; and if, from any < nerbnaii be resumed as soon as such other business is dii eration of all other unfinished business shall class of business to which it belongs shall !»■ In or of i'i i obi N1 uro " • 57. When any member is about to speak ' 45 Tilt) PARLIAMENTARY RULES. to the House, he shall rise from his seat and respectfully address himself to " Mr. Speaker " — and shall confine himself to the question under debate, and avoid personality. 58. Members may address the House or committee from the clerk's desk, or from a place near the Speaker's chair. 59. When two or more members happen to rise at once, the Speaker shall name the member who is first to speak. 60. No member shall occupy more than one hour in debate on any question in the House, or in committee ; but a member reporting the measure under consideration from a committee may open and close the debate, provided that when debate is closed by order of the House, any member shall be allowed, in committee, five minutes to explain any amendment he may offer, after which any member who shall first obtain the floor shall be allowed to speak five minutes in opposition to it, and there shall be no further debate on the amendment; but the same privilege of debate shall be allowed in favor of and against any amendment that may be offered to the amendment ; and neither the amendment nor an amendment to the amendment shall be withdrawn by the mover thereof, unless by the unanimous consent of the committee. Provided further, that the House may, by the vote of a majority of the members present, at any time after the five minutes' debate has taken place upon proposed amend- ments to any section or paragraph of a bill, close all debate upon such section or paragraph, or at their election upon the pending amendments only. 61. If any member in speaking or otherwise, transgress the rules of the House, the Speaker shall, or any member may call him to order; in which case the member so called to order shall immediately sit down, unless per- mitted to explain ; and the House shall, if appealed to, decide on the case, but without debate ; if there be no appeal the decision of the chair shall be submitted to. If the decision be in favor of the member called to order, he shall be at liberty to proceed ; if otherwise, he shall not be permitted to proceed, in case any member object, without leave of the House; and if the case require it, he shall be liable to the censure of the House. 62. If any member be called to order for words spoken in debate, the person calling him to order shall repeat the words excepted to, and they shall be taken down in writing at the clerk's table; and no member shall be held to answer, or be subject to the censure of the House, for words spoken in debate, if any other member has spoken, or other business has intervened, after the words spoken, and before exception to them shall have been taken. 63. No member shall speak more than once to the same question with- out leave of the House, unless he be the mover, proposer or introducer of the matter pending; in which case he shall be permitted to speak in reply, but not until every member choosing to speak shall have spoken. 64. If a question depending be lost by adjournment of the House, and I AU.iAMr \ i \i:y i:( , revived on the succeeding day, no nembei who ikeil have »p.»keo *. preceding day seal] be permitted again to speak m i 65. While the Bpeaker la putting anj qui rtion . ji none shall walk out oi' or across the Hoc* . noi member is speaking, shall entertaia private diet oun*< . n ..• is speaking, shall pass between aim and the chair I remain uncovered during the session of the II person shall visit or remain by the l lerk'l table whili are calling, or ballots are counth 66. All questions relating to the priority of business I be decided without debate. OF OOMMITTKI -. 67. All committees shall be appointed by the 8 unless • specially directed by the House, in which case they Bhall I ballot; and if upon such ballot the number required by a majority of the votes given, the II ballot, in which a plurality of votes shall prevail number than is required to compose or complete a < Minn. an equal number of votes, the House shall proa ballots. 63. The first named member of any committee shall t« t! and in his absence, or being excused by the House, t: ber, and so on, as often as the case shall happen, unl< u a majority of their number, elect a chairman. 69. Any member may excuse himself from servh at the time of his appointment, if he is then a member ol mittees. 70. It shall be the duty of a committee to meet on U of its members, if the chairman be al meeting. 71. The several standing commit! report by bill or otherwise. 72. No committee shall sit during the Bittifl B special leave. 73. No committee shall be permit* expense, without first obtaining leave of th< H 74. Thirty-one standing commit* i - ihal 1 ■* l ment of each Congress, viz. : TO CONSIST 01 A Committee of Elections.— Nov 18, : A Committee of Ways and Me ms J in. A Committee on Appropriations Mar A Committee on Banking and Current j A Committee on the Pacific Railroad -M 708 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. A Committee on Claims.— Nov. 13, 1794. A Committee on Commerce. — Dec. 14, 1795. A Committee on Public Lands. — Dec. 17, 1805. A Committee on the Post Office and Post Roads.— Nov. 9, 1808, A Committee for the District of Columbia.— Jan. 27, 1808. A Committee on the Judiciary. — June 3, 1813. A Committee on Revolutionary Claims. — Dec. 22, 1813. A Committee on Public Expenditures. — Feb. 26, 1814. A Committee on Private Land Claims.— April 29, 1816. A Committee on Manufactures. — Dec. 8, 1819. A Committee on Agriculture. — May 3, 1820. A Committee on Indian Affairs.— Dec. 18, 1821. A Committee on Military Affairs.— March 13, 1822. A Committee on Militia. — Dec. 10, 1835. A Committee on Naval Affairs. — March 13, 1822. A Committee on Foreign Affairs.— March 13, 1822. A Committee on the Territories. — Dec. 13, 1825. A Committee on Revolutionary Pensions.— Dec. 9, 1825. A Committee on Invalid Pensions. — Jan. 10, 1831. A Committee on Railways and Canals. — Dec. 15, 1831; April 9, 1869. A Committee on Mines and Mining.— Dec. 19, 1865. A Committee on Freedmen's Affairs. — Dec. 4, 1866. A Committee-on Education and Labor. — March 21, 1867. A Committee on Revision of the Laws. — July 25, 1868. TO CONSIST OP FIVE MEMBERS EACH. A Committee on Patents. — Sept. 15, 1837. A Committee on Public Buildings and Grounds. — Sept. 15, 1837. A Committee of Revisal and Unfinished Business. — Dec. 14, 1795. A Committee on Accounts. — Nov. 7, 1804. A Committee on Mileage.— Sept. 15, 1837. TO CONSIST OP SEVEN MEMBERS. A Committee on Coinage, Weights and Measures. — Jan. 21, 1864: March 2, 1867. 75. It shall be the duty of the Committee of Elections to examine and report upon the certificates of election, or other credentials, of the mem- bers returned to serve in this House, and to take into their consideration all such petitions and other matters touching elections and returns as shall or may be presented or come into question, and be referred to them by the House. 76. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Appropriations to take into consideration all Executive communications and such other proposi- tions in regard to carrying on the several departments of the government as may be presented and referred to them by the House. In preparing bills of appropriations for other objects, the Committee on Appropriations shall not include appropriations for carrying into effect treaties made by the United States; and where an appropriation bill shall be referred to them for their consideration, which contains appropriations for carrying a treaty into effect, and for other objects, they shall propose such amendments as shall prevent appropriations for carrying a treaty into effect being included in the same bill with appropriations for other objects. TAKUAMI VI \l;v ];l | | -. 77. It shall also be the duty of the Oommitl thirty days after their appointment, al ever} ing on the first Monday of December, to report tie bills for legislative, executive and judicial ezp expenses; for consular and diplomatic expenses; i^r thi navy; for the expenses of (lie Indian Department; for the | invalid and other pensions; for the Bupporl of the Mi fortifications; for the service of tin- Postofflce Departnv . . : mail transportation by ocean steamers; or, in failure thereof, til- failure. And said committee shall have leave to report laid I erence only) at any time. 78. It shall be the duty of the Commitu f Clain eration all such petitions and matters or things touchii -%nd demands on the United States as shall be presented, of lb i -mo in question, and be referred to them by the House; and to report lb< ion thereupon, together with such propositions for relief therein u i shall seem expedient. 79. It shall be the duty of the Committee <>n Commerce t consideration all such petitions and matters or things touch ii merce of the United States as shall be presented, or shall • question, and be referred to them by the House; ml to repot to time, their opinion thereon. 80. It shall be the duty of the Committee on the Put. lie I into consideration all such petitions and matters or tb lands of the United States as shall be presented, or shall or DO l question, and be referred to them by the House; and I ion thereon, together with such propositions for relief therein n*1" them shall seem expedient. 81. It shall be the duty of the Committee on th< Roads to take into consideration all such petitions and m touching the postofflce and postroads as shall be presented, or in question, and be referred to them by the House; opinion thereon, together with such proposltionarelatiT* tb shall seem expedient. 82. It shall be the duty of the Committee for the ' to take into consideration all such petitions and m . the said District as shall be presented o* shall c referred to them by the House; and to report together with such propositions relative there* then expedient. 83. It shall be the duty of the Committee on the consideration such petitions and man, re or thl ceedings as shall be presented or may come In them by the House, and to report their opinion t propositions relative .thereto as to them shall 710 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. 84. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Revolutionary Claims to take into consideration all such petitions and matters or things touching claims and demands originating in the Revolutionary war, or arising there- from, as shall be presented, or shall or may come in question, and be referred to them by the House, and to report their opinion thereupon, together with such propositions for relief therein as to them shall seem expedient. 85. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Public Expenditures to examine into the state of the several public departments, and particularly into laws making appropriations of money, and to report whether the moneys have been disbursed conformably with such laws; and also to report from time to time such provisions and arrangements as may be nec- essary to add to the economy of the departments, and the accountability of their officers. 86. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Private Land Claims to take into consideration all claims to land which may be referred to them, or shall or may come in question ; and to report their opinion thereupon, together with such propositions for relief therein as to them shall seem expedient. 87. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Military Affairs to take into consideration all subjects relating to the military establishment and public defense which may be referred to them by the House, and to report their opinion thereupon ; and also to report, from time to time, such meas- ures as may contribute to economy and accountability in the said estab- lishment. 88. It shall be the duty of the Committee on the Militia to take into consideration and report on all subjects connected with the organizing, arming and disciplining the militia of the United States. 89. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Naval Affairs to take into consideration all matters which concern the naval establishment, and which shall be referred to them by the House, and to report their opinion thereupon ; and also to report, from time to time, such measures as may contribute to economy and accountability in the said establishment. 90. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Foreign Affairs to take into consideration all matters which concern the relations of the United States with foreign nations, and which shall be referred to them by the House, and to report their opinion on the same. 91. It shall be the duty of the Committee on the Territories to examine into the legislative, civil and criminal proceedings of the Territories, and to devise and report to the House such means as in their opinion may be necessary to secure the rights and privileges of residents and non-residents. 92. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Revolutionary Pensions to take into consideration all such matters respecting pensions for services in the Revolutionary war, other than invalid pensions, as shall be referred to them by the House. PAKI.IAM1 M \KV K( I 1 8, 93. It shall be the duty of the Committee on kraiidF take into consideration all such matters respecting invalid | referred to them by the House. 94. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Roada u into consideration all such petitions and matters or n. roads and canals, and the improvement of the navigation ol shall be presented or may come in question, and b the House, and to report thereupon, together with BUCta pi . tive thereto as to them shall seem expedient. 95. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Paten) rail subjects relating to patents which may be referred them; and report I opinions thereon, together with such propositions relativi th< seem to them expedient. 96. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Public Buildings and Grounds to consider all subjects relating to the public edifli within the city of Washington which may be referred to them their opinion thereon, together with such propositions rel . i as may seem to them expedient. 97. It shall be the duty of the Committee of Reviaal ind Dnflnii Business to examine and report what laws have expired, < ing, and require to be revived or further continued; also report, from the journal of last session, all such mat'.er- a- w. depending and undetermined. 98. It shall be the duty of the Committee ol Aocountc and control the expenditures of the contingent fund of the 11 resentatives ; also to audit and settle all accounts which m thereon. 99. It shall be the duty of the Committee on Mileage to ' and report the distance to the sergeant -at- arms for which each mem receive pay. 100. There shall be referred by the clerk to the meml mittee on Printing on the part of the Bouse, ail drawing! other papers which may at any time come before the House foi lithographing, or publishing in any way; which comn to the House whether the same ought, in their opinloi and if the House order the publication of the same, th shall direct the size and manner of execution of all such drawings, or other papers, and contract by agreeuu nt. such engraving, lithographing, printing, drawing, and col< ordered by the House; which agreement, in writing, said committee to the Com. aim f axcounl in all allowances for such works, and it shall be In tee to report at all times. 101. It shall be in order for the Committee on Enrolled B.lh an Committee on Printing to report at any time. 712 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. 102. Seven additional standing committees shall be appointed at the commencement of the first session in each Congress, whose duties shall continue until the first session of the ensuing Congress. COMMITTEES, TO CONSIST OF FIVE MEMBERS EACH. 1. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Department of State ; 2. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Treasury Department ; 3. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures aa relates to the Department of War ; 4. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Department of the Navy ; 5. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Post Office ; 6. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Public Buildings; and 7. A committee on so much of the public accounts and expenditures as relates to the Interior Department. 103. It shall be the duty of the said committees to examine into the state of the accounts and expenditures respectively submitted to them, and to inquire and to report particularly — Whether the expenditures of the respective departments are justified by law; Whether the claims from time to time satisfied and discharged by the respective departments are supported by sufficient vouchers, establishing their justness both as to their character and amount. Whether such claims have been discharged out of funds appropriated therefor, and whether all moneys have been disbursed in conformity with appropriation laws ; and Whether any, and what, provisions are necessary to be adopted, to pro. vide more perfectly for the proper application of the public moneys, and to secure the government from demands unjust in their character or extrav- agant in their amount. And it shall be, moreover, the duty of the said committees to report, from time to time, whether any, and what, retrenchment can be made in the expenditures of the several departments, without detriment to the public service; whether any, and what, abuses at any time exist in the failure to enforce the payment of moneys which may be due to the United States from public defaulters or others ; and to report, from time to time, such provisions and arrangements as may be necessary to add to the economy of the several departments and the accountability of their officers. It shall be the duty of the several committees on public expenditures to inquire whether any officers belonging to the branches or departments, respectively, concerning whose expenditures it is their duty to inquire, have become useless or unnecessary ; and to report from time to time, on PARLIAMKM Ai:Y KILES. the expediency of modifying or abolishing the the pay and emoluments of all officers ond< r d. and to report from time to time such a reduction or ii: ., , just economy and the public service may require, OF OOMM1 nil.- <>!• i in. w BO] * 104. The House may at any time, by a vote of a majority I bers present, suspend the rules and orders for the pui the Committee of the Whole House on the Btate of tbi ' for providing for the discharge of the Committe* ofthi W the Committee of the Whole House oo the Si further consideration of any bill referred to it. after a< I on all amendments pending and that may l>e offered. 105. In forming a Committee of the Whole Bouse, il kbsil leave his chair, and a chairman to preside in committee shall b by the Speaker. 106. Whenever the Committee of the Whole on fh< B or the Committee of the Whole House, finds Itself without the chairman shall cause the roll of the House to be upon the committee shall rise, and the chairman sh ill report the names of the absentees to the House, which shall he entered on the journal. 107. Upon bills committed to a Committee of the Whole House, bill shall be first read throughout by the clerk, and then I .1 aw debated by clauses, leavingthe preamble to be last ooni of the bill shall not be defaced or interline); but all amendment the page and line, shall be duly entered by the clerk on s as the same shall be agreed to by the committee, and House. After report, the bill shall again be subject to be debated «md amended by clauses, before a question to engross it be I 108. All amendments made to an original motion in comi »H bo incorporated with the motion, and BO reported 109. All amendments made to s report commit* the Whole House shall be noted and reported, as In the 110. No motion or proposition for a tax or charge n] be discussed the day on which it is made or offered sition shall receive its first discussion in s Commit* 111. No sum or quantum of tax or duty, Noted I Whole House, shall be Increased In the House until sition for such increase shall be first dlscu of the Whole House: and so In reap* I to the til 112. All proceedings touching appropriations discussed in a Committee of the Whole How 113. The rules of proceedings in the H dlbe< mittee of the Whole House, so far as thej may rule limiting the times of speaking; but any question until every member ch tog! 714 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. 114. In Committee of the Whole on the State of the Union, the bills shall be taken up and disposed of in their order on the calendar; but when objection is made to the consideration of a bill, a majority of the commit- tee shall decide, without debate, whether it shall be taken up and disposed of, or laid aside ; provided, that general appropriation bills, and, in time of war, bills for raising men or money, and bills concerning a treaty of peace, shall be preferred to all other bills at the discretion of the commit- tee ; and when demanded by any member, the question shall first be put in regard to them ; and all debate on special orders shall be confined strictly to the measure under consideration. OF BILLS. 115. Every bill shall be introduced on the report of a committee, or by motion for leave. In the latter case, at least one day's notice shall be given of the motion in the House, or by filing a memorandum thereof with the clerk, and having it entered on the journal ; and the motion shall be made, and the bill introduced, if leave is given, when resolutions are called for ; such motion, or the bill when introduced, may be committed. 116. Every bill shall receive three several readings in the House pre- vious to its passage; and the bills shall be dispatched in order as they were introduced, unless where the House shall direct otherwise; but no bill shall be twice read on the same day, without special order of the House. 117. The first reading of a bill shall be for information, and if opposi- tion be made to it, the question shall be, " Shall this bill be rejected ?" If no opposition be made, or if the question to reject be negatived, the bill shall go to its second reading without a question. 118. Upon the second reading of a bill, the Speaker shall state it as ready for commitment or engrossment ; and if committed, then a question shall be, whether to a select or standing committee, or to a Committee of the Whole House ; if to a Committee of the Whole House, the House shall determine on what day ; if no motion be made to commit, the question shall be stated on its engrossment ; and if it be not ordered to be engrossed on the day of its being reported, it shall be placed on the general file on the Speaker's table, to be taken up in order. But if the bill be ordered to be engrossed, the House shall appoint the day when it shall be read the third time. 119. General appropriation bills shall be in order in preference to any other bill of a public nature unless otherwise ordered by a majority of the House. And the House may, at any time, by a vote of the majority of the members present, make any of the general appropriation bills a special order. 1£0. No appropriation shall be reported in such general appropria- tion bills, or be in order as an amendment thereto, for any expenditure not previously authorized by law, unless in continuation of appropriations for PARLIAMI \ ! \KY Kl I.K-. such public works and objects as are already In progress, contingencies for carrying on the Beveral departmenU 121. Upon the engrossment of any hill making appropt for works of internal improvemeni of an] kind or description i in the power of any member in call for a division of ti. take a separate vote of the Boose upon each item of Impi appropriation contained in said hill, or upon such it. m - others collectively, as the members making tin- call a one-fifth of the members present second said call, it shall beth< the Speaker to make such divisions of the question, and put ' accordingly. 122. The bills from the Court of Claims shall, on I" Ing i kid I House, be read a first and second time, committed to a < omm Whole House, and, together with the accompanyii] 123. A motion to strike out the enacting words of a hill shall cedence of a motion to amend ; and, if carried, shall be consi alent to its rejection. Whenever a bill is reported from a Come the Whole, with a recommendation to strike nut the enacting such recommendation is disagreed to by the II "lie hill recommitted to the said committees without further action by thi 124. After commitment and report thereof to the H before its passage, a bill may be recommitted ; and should tui h ment take place after its engrossment, ami an amendment I • agreed to by the House, the question shall be again put ->n the . of the bill. 125. All bills ordered to be engrossed -hall be executed in ' hand. 126. No amendment by way of rider shall be received to any bilf third reading. 127. When a bill shall pass, it shall be certified by the clerk, not: day of its passage at the foot thereof. Lota I. OB I'KIVaii Bl BIJn BB. 128. Friday and Saturday of every week shall be sideration of private bills and private business, in | unless otherwise determined by a majority of the II 129. On the first and fourth Friday and Saturday calendar of private bills shall be called over (the ch miteeofthe Whole House commencing the call wb previous day,) and the bills to the passage of which then be made shall be first considered and disposed of again reached, after having been once objected I I aider and dispose of the same, unless Itshall least five members. OF BILLS <.N LEAVE ft.NI) RES 130. All the States and Territories shall be called I 71 6 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. resolutions on each alternate Monday during each session of Congress; and, if necessary to secure the object on said days, all resolutions which shall give rise to debate shall lie over for discussion, under the rules of the House already established; and the whole of said days shall be appropri- ated to bills on leave and resolutions, until all the States and Territories are called through. And the Speaker shall first call the States and Terri- tories for bills on leave; and all bills so introduced during the first hour after the journal is read shall be referred, without debate, to their appro- priate committees; provided, however, that a bill so introduced and referred shall not be brought back into the House upon a motion to reconsider. OF PETITIONS AND MEMORIALS. 131. Members having petitions and memorials to present, may hand them to the clerk, indorsing the same with their names, and the reference or disposition to be made thereof; and such petitions and memorials shall be entered on the journal, subject to the control and direction of the Speaker; and if any petition or memorial be so handed in, which, in the judgment of the Speaker, is excluded by the rules, the same shall be returned to the member from whom it was received. OF THE PREVIOUS QUESTION. 132. The previous question shall be in this form : " Shall the main question be now put?" It shall only be admitted when demanded by a majority of the members present; and its effect shall be to put an end to all debate, and to bring the House to a direct vote upon a motion to commit if such motion shall have been made ; and if this motion does not prevail, then upon amendments reported by a committee, if any ; then upon pend- ing amendments, and then upon tbe main question. But its only effect, if a motion to postpone is pending, shall be to bring the House to a vote upon such motion. Whenever the House shall refuse to order the main question, the consideration of the subject shall be resumed as though no motion for the previous question had been made. The House may also, at any time, on motion seconded by a majority of the members present, close all debate upon a pending amendment, or an amendment thereto, and cause the question to be put thereon ; and this shall not preclude any further amendment or debate upon the bill. A call of the House shall not be in order after the previous question is seconded, unless it shall appear, upon an actual count by the Speaker, that no quorum is present. 133. On a previous question there shall be no debate. All incidental questions of order arising after a motion is made for the previous question and pending such motion, shall be decided, whether on appeal or other- wise, without debate. OF ADMISSION ON THE FLOOR. 134. No person except members of the Senate, their secretary, heads of departments, the President's private secretary, foreign ministers, the Gov- PARL1AMK.N ! \K\ i;i ; ernor for the time being of any State, Benatoi i and Judges of the Supreme Court of the United of Claims, shall be admitted within the ball of the II tives, or any of the rooms upon the same floor or lead OF lei POB3 I I . 135. Stenographers and reporters, other than the the House, wishing to take down the debates, n .. Speaker to the reporters' gallery over the Sp i floor of the House; but no person shall be allowed the p gallery under the character of Btenographer or reporter with >ut ■ permission of the Speaker, specifying the part of him; nor shall said stenographer or reporter be admitte- unless he shall state in writing for what paper or p ., report; nor shall he be so admitted, or, if admitti his seat, if he shall become an agent to prosecute before Congress; and the Speaker shall give bis urn: this condition. UNFINISHED BUSINESS OF Till 136. After six days from the commencement i session of any Congress, all bills, resolutions, and n ated in the House, and at the close of the n< \t precedii undetermined, shall be resumed and acted on in tin- same tna . : an adjournment had not taken place. And all bu-in< the House at the end of one session shall he resumed at tin ment of the next session of the same Congress as if no adjou: taken place. MISCKU.ANK'M B. 137. Whenever confidential communications in tbr President of the United States, the House shall Im- -as, except the members, clerk, scrgeant-atarms, and (i *o con- tinue during the reading of such communicati directed by the House) during all debates and \ thereon. And when the Speaker, or any Other member, si <■ House that he has communications to make which he < • «*» be kept secret, the House shall, in like maimer, nication be made; the House shall then determine ■ communicated requires secrecy or n<>t, and take order > 138. The rule for paying witnesses summoned t<> a: House, or either of its committees, shall be as telle ness shall attend, the sum of two dollars; for Mi h mil coming to or going from the place of examination, Ibi each way; but nothing shall be paid lor traveling !.■ has been summoned at the place of trial 718 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. 139. Maps accompanying documents shall not be printed, under the general order to print, without the special direction of the House. 140. No extra compensation shall be allowed to any officer or messen- ger, page, laborer, or other person in the service of the House, or engaged in or about the public grounds or buildings ; and no person shall be an officer of the House, or continue in its employment, who shall be an agent for the prosecution of any claim against the government, or be interested in such claim otherwise than an original claimant ; and it shall be the duty of the Committee of Accounts to inquire into and report to the House any violation of this rule. 141. When the reading of a paper is called for, and the same is objected to by any member, it shall be determined by a vote of the House. 142. When a question is postponed indefinitely, the same shall not be acted upon again during the session. 143. Every order, resolution, or vote, to which the concurrence of the Senate shall be necessary, shall be read to the House, and laid on the table, on a day preceding that in which the same shall be moved, unless the House shall otherwise expressly allow. 144. The rules of parliamentary practice, comprised in Jefferson's Manual, shall govern the House in all cases to which they are applicable, and in which they are not inconsistent with the standing rules and orders of the House, and joint rules of the Senate and House of Representatives. 145. No standing rule or order of the House shall be rescinded or changed without one day's notice being given of the motion therefor ; nor shall any rule be suspended, except by a vote of at least two-thirds of the members present; nor shall the order of business, as established by the rules, be postponed or changed, except by a vote of at least two-thirds of the members present; nor shall the Speaker entertain a motion to suspend the rules, except during the last ten days of the session, and on Monday of every week at the expiration of an hour after the journal is read, unless the call of the States and Territories for bills on leave and resolutions has been earlier concluded, when the Speaker may entertain a motion to sus- pend the rules. 146. All election of officers of the House, including the Speaker* shall be conducted in accordance with these rules, so far as the same are appli- cable; and pending the election of a Speaker, the clerk shall preserve order and decorum, and shall decide all questions of order that may arise, subject to appeal to the House. 147. These rules shall be the rules of the House of Representatives of the present and succeeding Congresses unless otherwise ordered. 148. An additional standing committee shall be appointed at the com- mencement of each Congress, whose duties shall continue until the first session of the ensuing Congress, to consist of five members, to be entitled a M Committee on a Uniforn System of Coinage, Weights, and Measures ; " PAB3T.IAM1 Ml \KY u, : and to this committee ahall be referred all Ml!-, reaolui cations to the House upon that subjeei. 149. The names of members not voting on iinv < nil shall he recorded in the journal Immediatelj afu i l affirmative and negative, and the Bame record shall 1 gressional Globe. 150. It shall be the duty <»!' the Committee on the I *.n i Ji- take into consideration all such petitions and matters or thli railroads or telegraph lines between the Mississippi vuh> coast, as shall be presented or shall come in question, and I- them by the House, and to report their opinion then propositions relative thereto as to them shall seem i 151. It shall be the duty of tte Committee ot W* into consideration all reports of the Treasury 1>< partmi Dl and propositions relative to raising revenue and providing w *«» (• the support of the government as shall he t tion, and be referred to them by the Souse, and to report U thereon by bill or otherwise, as to them shall seem - committee shall have leave to r» port for i ommhmenl at an] I 152. It shall be the duly of the Committee on Bnnk Hunk! rencyto take into consideration all propositions n * «* the currency as shall be presented or shall come li referred to them by the House, and to report thereon by bi 153. It shall he the duty of the Committee on Mines sider all subjects relating to mines ami mining thai them, and to report their opinion thereon, together with men | relative thereto as may seem to them expedient 154. The allowance of stationery to each meml* r an.! of the value of seventy-five dollars tor a Ion for a short session of Congn 155. The hall of the Bouse shall not bo uwd fo the legitimate business of the House, nor shall th< - proposition to use it for any other purpose, or lor lh« i rule: Provided, That tins shall not Interfere with th< divine service therein, under the direction of th< - of the same for caucus meetings of the members, or u, the House may, by resolution, take part in ai observed therein. L56 There shall he appointed at the a standing Committee on Freedmen's Affair* I whose duty it shall be to take chai which shall he referred to them by th< 157 When an act has been approved by tl ber of copies shall be printed for the use of th, 158. Messages from the Senate and the Pi 720 PARLIAMENTARY RULES. giving notice of bills passed or approved, shall be reported forthwith from the clerk's desk. 159. Estimates of appropriations, and all other communications from the executive departments, intended for the consideration of any of the committees of the House, shall be addressed to the Speaker and by him submitted to the House for reference. 160. There shall be appointed to each Congress a Committee on Educa- tion and Labor, to consist of nine members, to whom shall be referred all petitions, bills, reports, and resolutions on those subjects, and who shall from time to time report thereon. 161. Pending a motion to suspend the rules the Speaker may entertain one motion that the House do now adjourn ; but after the result thereon is announced, he shall not entertain any other dilatory motion till the vote is taken on suspension. 162. Whenever a question is pending before the House, the Speaker shall not entertain any motion of a dilatory character except one motion to adjourn and one motion to fix the day to which the House shall ad- journ ; but the previous question on the engrossment and third reading of any bill or joint resolution shall not be ordered during the first day of its consideration, unless two thirds of the members present shall second the demand: provided, that this rule shall not apply to House resolutions offered in the morning hour of Monday : and provided further, that it shall not apply to any proposition to appropriate the money, the credit, or other property of the United States, except the regular annual appro- priation bills. btatetiob <•»• the world. CHAPTER XXXI. THE STATISTICS OF THE WORLD. Country. NORTH AMERICA. Arctic Region Bermuda Columbia (Brit.) Costa Rica Greenland Guatemala - Honduras Honduras (Brit.) Mexico Mosquito New Britain New Brunswick Newfoundland Nicaragua Nova Scotia Ontario Prince Edward Island... (Quebec San Salvador St. Pierre United States SOUTH AMERICA. Argentine Confederacy.. Bolivia Brazil Cayenne Chili Colombia Demarara, etc Ecuador Falkland Islands Paraguay ■ Patagonia Peru Surinam Uruguay Venezuel a WEST INDIA ISLANDS. Antigua ■ Bahamas • 46 Population. 12,000 54,600 160,00 10.IJUI 1,180,000 500,000 25,635 8,748,614 16,000 88G 146,586 100,000 1,630,842 1,19 78 , .. .. • 084, 11 ■* 040, 887, 120, :i?4. 84, 565, 000 • t.'i 86,419 Square miles. • 18,500 778,144 ■■ - • •• ••.t.t-jii ■ 21 120 8,578,882 8,23 • in Tltl. ' I ■ 11 ekmMk ' ■ ,\ !• I : ■ ■ I hu.j ■**•« 722 STATISTICS OF THE WORLD. Country. Barbadoes , Burin udas , Curacoa Cuba Dominica Grenada Guadaloupe, etc Hayti Jamaica Marti nk) lie Montserrat Nevis Porto Rico St. Bartholomew's St. Christopher, etc St. John's St. Lucia St. Martin's (S.) St. Thomas St. Vincent San Domingo Santa Cruz, etc Tobago Trinidad Turk's Island Virgin Islands EUROPE. Andorra Austria Belgium Denmark Faroe and Iceland France Germany Northern Confederation, Anhalt Bremen Brunswick Hamburg Hesse Darmstadt (N.) ... Lippe Detmold Lippe Schaumburg Lubeck Mecklenburg Schwerin.. Mecklenburg Strelitz Oldenburg Prussia Reuss Greiz Reuss Schleiz Saxe Altenburg -. -. Saxe Coburg Gotha Saxe Meiningen Saxe Weimar.. Saxony Schwarzb. Rudolstadt. .. Swarzb. Sondershausen. Waldeck Population. Southern Confederation. Baden Bavaria Hesse Darmstadt (S.)... Lichtenstein Wurteinberg Great Britain Gibraltar Heligoland Malta Greece 152,127 11,796 30,000 1,500,000 26,882 36,672 134,544 572,000 441,255 121,145 7,645 9,822 620,000 10.000 26,940 3,000 29,519 3,500 13,463 31,755 136.500 35,000 15,410 84,438 4,372 6,051 12,000 35,677,455 4,984,451 1,608,362 75,909 38,192,064 197,041 109,572 302,792 305,196 257,479 111,352 31,186 48,538 560,618 98.770 315,622 24,039,668 43,889 88,097 141,426 168,851 180,335 282,928 2,423,401 75,116 67,533 56,807 1,434,970 4,824,421 565,659 8,320 1,778,396 31,817,108 24,175 2,300 143,003 1,006,810 Square miles. Title of Ruler 166 580 43,383 290 133 534 11,718 6,400 322 47 50 3,895 25 103 72 250 11 37 131 18,000 81 97 1,754 450 57 149 240,381 11,373 14,734 40,258 209,428 1,026 74 1,425 156 1,280 438 171 107 5,190 1,052 2,469 136,806 145 320 510 760 956 1,404 5,779 374 332 433 5,912 29,373 1,690 62 7,532 120,769 2 115 18.347 Governor .. Governor .. Capt. Gen. Lt. Gov.... Lt. Gov Capital. President.. Capt. Gen President. . Adminis... Capt. Gen. Lt. Gov.... Adminis. Lt. Gov... President. Lt. Gov... Governor . President. President. Rep Emperor... King King President.. Duke Burgom... Duke Burgom... G.Duke... Prince Prince Burgom. . . G.Duke... G.Duke.... G.Duke Bridgetown. Hamilton. Wiliiamstadt. Havana. Rosseau. St. George. Basse Terre. Port an Prince. Spanish Town. Port Royal. Plymouth. Charlestown. San Juan. Gustavia. Basse Terre. Castries. Kingston. San Domingo. Christianstadt. Scarboro. Port Espana. Grand Turk. Road Town. Andorra. Vienna. Brussels. Copenhagen. King iBerlin Paris. Dessau. Bremen. Brunswick. Hamburg. Darmstadt. Detmold. Buckburg. Lubeck. Schwerin. New Strelitz. Oldenburg. Prince .. Prince.. Duke ... Duke ... Duke ... G. Duke. King.... Prince .. Prince .. Prince .. G.Duke.... King G.Duke Prince King Queen Governor .. Governor .. Governor .. King |Athens. Greiz. Schleiz. Altenburg. Coburg. Meiningen. Weimar. Dresden. Rudolstadt. Sonderhausen, Corbach. Carlsruhe. Munich. Darmstadt. Lichtenstein. Stuttgardt. London. Gibraltar. Heligoland. Malta. STATISTICS OP THE WO Countries. Ionian Islands... Italy ;; Monaco Netherlands ~_ Luxemburg Portugal " Azores and Madeira. Russia San Marino ■Spain " •Swuden " Norway " Switzerland Turkey ."." Montenegro Roumania Servia ASIA. Anam (C. China)... Arabia Borneo British India Burmah Ceylon China Japan Java Persia Siam Tartary Turkey in Asia AFRICA. Abyssinia Algeria Cape of Good Hope. Egypt Gambia Gold Coast Lagos Liberia Madagascar Morocco Natal Sierra Leone St. Helena Tripoli Tunis Zanzibar AU8TRALIA. New South Wales... Queensland South Australia Tasmania Victoria Western Australia... POLTNE8IA. Feejee Islands New Guinea New Zealand Philippine Islands.. Sandwich Islands ... Society Islands Population. 66,217 i2,0TO 199,958 19 618 7S,-loo,iM) 16,808 ■1.1.- 1,712,628 2,510,494 10,51 198 8,864,848 1,078,281 9,000,000 4,000,000 25,000,000 192,012,137 1.0m u mi 2,081,895 » 77,500.0(10 :;.Vi m i. .. i 14,168,416 11,000,000 6,288,990 7.870,000 16,468,000 8,000,000 -*,WI,846 666,158 7,466,000 262,000 110,000 717,500 5.000,000 2,750,000 188,108 41,407 6,444 750,000 ooo 447,690 200,000 .. .. 890,009 • Square mllei 1,006 - 46.710 21,218 • 190 94, 148, 51, 808, 640 BOO, i k|n ,517 454 n B,O00 9.567 • 1,600 Prim i li titinopU. I JtU Brap< ■ '■ Admii Admit \ Sullni. V ' ■ 1 Sultan ■ B Klnr *■ 724 CREEDS OF THE WORLD. STATISTICS OF THE RACE. The earth is inhabited by about 1,380,000,000 of inhabitants, namely: 380,000,000 of the Caucasian race, 300,000,000 of the Ethiopian, 580,000,000 of the Mongolian, 230,000,000 of the Malay races, and 1,000,000 of the American Indian. All these respectively speak 3064 languages, and possess 1,000 different religions. The amount of deaths per annum is 33,333,333, or 91,954 per day, 3730 per hoar, 60 per minute, or one per second. This loss is compensated by an equal number of births. The average duration of life throughout the globe is thirty-three years. One-fourth of its population dies before the seventh year, and one-half before the seventeenth. Out of 10,000 persons only one reaches his hundredth year; only one in 500 his eightieth; and only one in 100 his sixty-fifth. Married people live longer than unmarried ones, and a tall man is likely to live longer than a short one. Until the fiftieth year women have a better chance of life than men; but beyond that period the chances are equal. Sixty-five persons out of one thousand marry. The months of June and December are those in which marriages are most frequent. Children born in spring are generally stronger than those born in other seasons. Births and deaths chiefly occur at night. The number of men able to bear arms is but one-eighth of the population. AFRICANS IN AMERICA. It is estimated that there are some 14,580,000 persons of African descent on this conti- nent. In the United States they number 4,880,000; Brazil 4,300,000; Cuba and Porto Rico 1,500,000; South and Central American Rupublics 1,100,000; Hay ti 1,350,000; British Pos- sessions 800,000; French, 250,000; Dutch and Mexican 400,000. CREEDS OF THE WORLD. The population of the world is religiously distributed very nearly in the following proportions: Christians 388,600,000 Pagans 300,000,000 Buddhists 360,000,000 Mohammedans 165,000,000 Other Asiatic religions... 260,000,000 Jews 7,000,000 In Europe, America, Australia, and many of the Polynesian Islands, Christianity is the prevailing creed of every State. In Africa the only independent Christian States are Abyssinia and Liberia, while Christianity prevails in several European colonies. The largest empire of Asia— Russia— is also a Christian country. India, the third country in point of extent, is under the rule of a Christian government, and so is a large portion of Farther India. The Mohammedan countries in Asia are Turkey, Persia, Afghanistan, and the Khan- ates of Central Asia; in Africa — Morocco, the dependencies of Turkey (Egypt, Tunis, Tripoli) and a number of interior States. Buddhism prevails in India, Farther India, in manyparts of China, and in Japan. The governments of Burmah and Siam are Buddhist; the government of China adheres to the religion of Confucius; the religion of Japan is Sintooism. Judaism is represented throughout the civilized world. The JIandbuch der Vergleich- enden Statistik of G. "Von Kolb (Leipzig, 1868) gives the following as the number of Jews in the countries named : Germany, 478,500 ; Austria, 1,134,000 ; Great Britain, 40,000 ; France, 80,000 ; European Russia, 3.277,000 ; Italy, 30,200 ; Switzerland, 4,300 ; Belgium 1,500; Netherlands, 64,000; Luxemburg, 1,500 Denmark, 4,300 ; Sweden, 1,00«; Greece, 500; European Turkey, 70,000. The Jews in Portugal are estimated at 3,000; in Syria and Asiatic Turkey, 53,000 ; in Morocco and North Africa, 610,000 ; in Eastern Asia, 500,800; in America, 500,000. SUPPLEMENT. BY JUDGE J. O. I'< >WEB OP THE FniST DI8TB1OT OP Iu . LEGAL FOK.M-. FORM OF WILL. In the name of God, Amen. I, (give name of testator) of (residence), !•• mind and memory, do hereby make, publish, and d< to be my last Will and Testament, hereby n •• . ng md i void all former Wills by me at any time heretofl First — I order and direct my Executors, decease as practicable, to pay off and disci dues, and liabilities that may exist against me at ti • my decease. Second — I give and bequeath unto my wifi state property bequeathed, i TJiird — I give, and bequeath unto mj state property bequeathed.) Same form for cadi 1. gacy. Fourth — T hereby nominate and appoint. (Hi of person or persona select) In Witness Whereof 1 have bereunl this day of A. D. The above and foregoing instrument the d . 726 LEGAL FORMS. signed, sealed, published, and declared, by the said (name of testator), as and for his last Will and Testament, in presence of us, who, at his request, and in his presence, and in the presence of each other, have subscribed our names as witnesses. Name. Residence. Name. Residence. Note. — Must be signed by the testator before acknowledged by him to be his will — and must be signed by testator in pres- ence of witnesses — or acknowledged by him in presence of witnesses. Two witnesses are necessary. ARTICLES OP CO-PARTNERSHIP. This agreement, made and entered into this day of , 187 — , by and between of ? and , of - Witnesseth : that the said parties hereby agree to become partners in the business of at ■, for the term of years from the date hereof, under the firm name of . Said parties have each contributed the sum of dollars as the capital stock of said firm. Both parties are to devote their entire time and skill for the common benefit. All expenses of the business and all losses are to be borne in common, and the profits are to be equally divided. Books of account are to be kept, in which shall be entered all money received or paid, all purchases and sales of goods, and all matters of account relating to the business of the firm, which shall at all times be accessible to both. No money or other property shall be withdrawn by either partner, or applied to his own use, except with the written consent of the other partner; and in every such case the same shall be charged, and his share of the profits shall be reduced in proportion to the amount withdrawn. Once in each year a correct accounl Bhall fcx on the ledger of all stock property and of all debts and liabilities. At the close of the partnership alii; and stated, and the stock and property, and tl equally divided after payment of the liabil in. JSTo debt or claim of the firm shall be rel< out payment in fall, unless by consenl of both partni Neither partner shall have power to bind the firm in any case; and neither partner shall be withont the written consent of the other part] Witness our hands and seals this the day and written. Name Name - AGREEMENT TO CONTINUE A CO-PARTN KRSII I V As the partnership existing between the un expire on the day of . 1 v 7 agreed that said co-partnership shall continue upon the terms and conditions ae provided in the co-partnership for the farther term date of the expiration of said co-partner8hi| said articles. Witness our hand- (as in articles, givil AGREEMENT for DISSOLUTION of CO-1 BHIP. The undersigned hereby agree that I ing between them, as is witnessed by the A nership signed by us, be, and the same except for the purpose of final eettl< thereof, which may be settled by- settlement, then said co-partnership shall Witness, etc. ibove). 728 LEGAL FORMS. POWER OF ATTORNEY. Know all men by these presents, that I of , hereby make, constitute, and appoint of , my true and lawful Attorney, for me, and in my name, place, and stead, to (here state duty of Attorney) granting unto my said Attorney full power and authority to do and perform each and every thing necessary and proper to be done in the performance of his duty, as fully as I might or could do if personally present, hereby ratifying and confirming all the lawful acts of my said Attorney, done under and by virtue hereof. "Witness my hand and seal this day of A. D. 187—. Name [seal.] Note. — To be signed and acknowledged as a deed for the conveyance of real estate FORM OF SUBMISSION TO ARBITRATION. Know all men by these presents, that whereas a controversy is now existing between (name), of (residence), and (name), of (residence), touching (here state nature of controversy): Now, therefore, we, the said (here give names of parties), do hereby submit said controversy to the decision and arbitration of (here give names of three persons selected as arbitrators), of (here state residences), and do covenant each with the other that we will faithfully keep and abide by the decision and award that they, or any two of them, may make in writing — said award to be made and signed on or before (here give date). And it is agreed by the parties hereto, that the party that shall fail to abide by and observe said award, made in accord- ance with the foregoing submission, shall forfeit and pay to the other the sum of (here insert amount). "Witness our hands this day of A. D.- -Name. -Name. I.Ki.AI. I "KM-. AWAKI) OF AKiai &ATOH The undersigned to whose arbitration was mbi the matters in controversy between (here give oau more fully appears by their written submission hi Report that on the day of A.. D. 18 . been duly sworn according to law, and havinj parties day's notice in writing of the our meeting to consider said matter, we ]<• charge of our duty; said i name of parry | app (if by Att'y also so state,) and .-aid (name of part in person (if by Att'y also so 6tate.) And I allegations and proofs of said partiee, and the wii duced by them, and having examined the m versy submitted by them, do make and d< •■;.:■ our award. Here state findings of Arbitrators. Witness our hands this day "t* A. I). . GENERAL FORM FOR AGREEMENT. This Agreement made this day of by and between of and of . Witneaseth: That tl.. the consideration of there state oatore be (if money paid,) (if work or labor or d< be performed ..r delivered a- hereafter pi that i.-tate agreemenl of this party full;. And for the consideration above mentioi hereby agrees, that i In witness whereof, we hereto bo our seal this day and date firsl a. lie \ . : [» • 730 LEGAL FORMS. AGREEMENT FOR SALE OP PERSONAL PROPERTY. This Agreement, made this day of 187 — , between of and of . Witnesseth: That the said — in consideration of the agreements on the part of hereafter named, agrees to and with the said —that on or before the day of , 187 — , he will deliver to the said ■ at (state place of delivery,) the following property (state kind of property). And the said in consideration of the aforesaid agreements and promises on the part of the said , hereby promises and agrees to and with the said , that he will pay to him (state price to be paid) said payments to be made as follows (state how and when.) In witness whereof, we hereto subscribe our names and affix our seals this the day and year first above written. Name [seal.] Name [seal.] AGREEMENT FOR THE SALE OP REAL ESTATE. This Agreement, made this day of 187 — r by and between of and of . Witnesseth: That for and in consideration of the sum of dollars, to be paid by the said to the said— as follows (state manner of payment), the said hereby promises and agrees to convey by (state nature of conveyance, whether warranty or quit claim), the following described real estate situate in county, State of . (Give description of land.) And the said hereby promises to pay said the sum of ■ dollars as above provided. And upon the payment in full of said amount, then said conveyance is to be executed and delivered. In witness whereof, we hereunto subscribe our names and affix our seals this the day and date above written. Name [seal.] Name [seal.] Note. — To be executed and acknow estate. FORM OF LEASE. Agreement of Lease, made this between of. and of nesseth: That the Baid aj i pay to — dollars per t'.w the rent <>f • ises on (description of land. | The said agrees t" ase said ; purpose than , and not underlet thi written consent of . Till tOCOmi day of 187 . and continue until t: day of 1ST — . The nut to 1„- paid I said at . A failure to pay I m agreed, or to comply with any of the Btipo lease by , shall authorize the Baid sider the same forfeited; and he may tal premises without notice and without pr< bring his action a- allowed by law to • r j • In witness whereof, we hereunto subseril ur • affix our seals this the day and date firel Name \ ime ■ FORM OF DEED. This Deed, made tin's da 1*7 V nesseth: That for the consideration of of county, sell and convey unto of , all the following i county. State of [owa. Ilei the land) together with all thi and right of dower of the Baid gi And we hereby wan-ant the title persons whomsoever (or it' quit clain claim all our right, title and interest in the grantees herein. 732 LEGAL FORMS. "Witness our hands and seals this the day and date above written. Name [seal.] Name [seal.] The State of ) c County. f Be it Remembered, That on this day of- 187 — , before me a within and for said county and State, personally appeared , who personally known to me to be the identical person whose name affixed to the foregoing deed as grantor, and she acknowledged the same to be her voluntary act and deed, and the said , having been made acquainted with the contents hereof, and the nature of the above instrument having been fully explained to her, and having been examined by me separate and apart from her husband, acknowledged that she signed and executed the said deed freely and voluntarily, and without compulsion, and that she does not desire to retract the same. In witness whereof, I hereto set my hand and seal this the day and date last above written. Name [se al.] Note. — It is better in all cases to have two witnesses to the signatures, as the fact that such signatures are witnessed will never invalidate the conveyance; and in some States the instrument is void without such witnesses. MORTGAGE DEED. This Deed, made this day of , 187—, Wit- nesseth: That for the consideration of dollars, we of county, State of , hereby sell and convey unto of all the following described real estate, situate in county, State of — to-wit: (Here describe real estate.) And we hereby warrant the title to said premises against all persons whomsoever. This deed to be void, however, on condition pay. (State nature of indebtedness, time and manner of payment.) LEGAL Ft)] (If homestead say), and the property • homestead, we hereby expressly waive ail benefit of I stead and exemption laws, and consent that said prop be liable for the payment of Baid indebtedness. < H force and virtue. "Witness our hands and seals this the day and • written. Name [«»'-ai-] Name NEGOTIABLE NOTE. $200 Chicago, 111.. May 1st, Ltf One year after date, I promise t<> pay to the order of 1 Wei ty, two hundred dollars, with ten per eeot inter date, tor value recei ved . Name NON-NEGOTIABLE NOTE $200 Chicago, III- y One year after date. I promise to pay Felix Welt dred dollars, with ten per cent, interest from date, for received. Name . NOTE TRANSFERABLE BY DELIVERY. $200 On i« MX), M One year after date, I promise to pay Fell '• two hundred dollars, with ten per oent Inter I viliie received • Jfote.— If joint note say " v. [f joint mid "we or either of us.'' N line DUE BILL. Due Felix Welty, two hondred dollars, vain May 1st, 1873/ Name RECEIPT. Ohioago, 111 , U Keceived of Willis Moran one hundred doflan, in full of all 734 LEGAL FACTS. claims or demands, of each and every kind held by me against him. Name Note. — If in satisfaction or payment of any particular claim, to state. UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA LIBRARY Los Angeles This book is DUE on the last date stamped below. MAY 2 5 lyfiO MAR 1 5 19^1 M 2 4 mi DECE v REC'D LD-URD a 0CU3«* Form L9-32m-8,'58(5876s4)444